Vol. 57
JANUARY 1981
No. 1
THE
Pan-Pacific Entomologist
SPECIAL ISSUE
IN HONOR OF
HUGH B. LEECH
KAVANAUGH and ARNAUD — Hugh Bosdin Leech — A Curator’s Curator _ 3
ZIMMERMAN — Reticulate Evolution in Colymbetes (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) _ 43
PERKINS and SPANGLER — A Description of the Larva of Helocombus bifidus (Coleop¬
tera: Hydrophilidae) _ 52
YOUNG — Predaceous Water Beetles of the Genus Desmopachria Babington: The
leechi-glabricula Group (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) _ 57
SPANGLER — Two New Genera, Two New Species of Bidessine Water Beetles from
South America (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) _ 65
BROWN — Key to the World Genera of Larinae (Coleoptera, Dryopoidea, Elmidae),
with Descriptions of New Genera from Hispaniola, Colombia, Australia, and
New Guinea _ 76
GORDON — New Species of North American Hydroporus, niger-tenebrosus Group (Cole¬
optera: Dytiscidae) _ 105
STEINER and ANDERSON — Notes on the Natural History of Spanglerogyrus albi-
ventris Folkerts, with a New Distribution Record (Coleoptera: Gyrinidae) _ 124
BROWN — A Distributional Survey of the World Genera of Aquatic Dryopoid Beetles
(Coleoptera: Dryopidae, Elmidae, and Psephenidae sens. Lat.) _ 133
WOLFE and MATT A — Notes on Nomenclature and Classification of Hydroporus Sub¬
genera with the Description of a New Genus of Hydroporini (Coleoptera:
Dytiscidae) _ 149
MATTA and WOLFE — A Revision of the Subgenus Heterosternuta Strand of Hydro¬
porus Clairville (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) _ 176
( Continued on back cover )
SAN FRANCISCO, CALIFORNIA • 1981
Published by the PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
in cooperation with THE CALIFORNIA ACADEMY OF SCIENCES
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist
EDITORIAL BOARD
T. D. Eichlin, A. R. Hardy, Co-Editors
S. Kuba, Editorial Asst.
P. H. Arnaud, Jr., Treasurer H. B. Leech
R. M. Bohart E. S. Ross J. A. Chemsak
Published quarterly in January, April, July and October with Society Proceedings
appearing in the October number. All communications regarding nonreceipt of num¬
bers, requests for sample copies, and financial communications should be addressed
to the Treasurer, Dr. Paul H. Arnaud, Jr., California Academy of Sciences, Golden
Gate Park, San Francisco, California 94118.
Application for membership in the Society and changes of address should be ad¬
dressed to the Secretary, Ronald E. Somerby, Insect Taxonomy Laboratory, Cali¬
fornia Department of Food and Agriculture, 1220 “N” St., Sacramento, CA 95814.
Manuscripts, proofs and all correspondence concerning editorial matters should
be addressed to either Dr. Thomas Eichlin or Dr. Alan Hardy, Insect Taxonomy
Laboratory, California Department of Food and Agriculture, 1220 “N” St., Sacra¬
mento, 95814.
The annual dues, paid in advance, are $12.00 for regular members of the Society,
$7.00 for student members, or $15.00 for subscription only. Members of the society
receive The Pan-Pacific Entomologist. Single copies of recent numbers are $3.75
each or $15.00 a volume. Write to the treasurer for prices of earlier back numbers.
Make all checks payable to The Pacific Coast Entomological Society.
The Pacific Coast Entomological Society
OFFICERS FOR 1981
D. Kavanaugh, President P. H. Arnaud, Jr., Treasurer
J. E. Hafernik, Jr., President-Elect R. E. Somerby, Secretary
Statement of Ownership
Title of Publication: The Pan-Pacific Entomologist.
Frequency of Issue: Quarterly (January, April, July, October).
Location of Office of Publication, Business Office of Publisher and Owner: Pacific Coast Entomological Society,
California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, California 94118.
Editors: T. D. Eichlin and A. R. Hardy, Insect Taxonomy Laboratory, California Dept, of Food and Agriculture,
1220 N St., Sacramento, California 95814.
Managing Editor and Known Bondholders or other Security Holders: None.
This issue mailed 19 June 1981
Second Class Postage Paid at San Francisco, California and Additional offices.
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist (ISSN 0031-0603)
PRINTED BY THE ALLEN PRESS, INC., LAWRENCE, KANSAS 66044, U.S.A.
IN HONOR
HUGH B . LEECH
Hugh B. Leech, retired curator at the California Academy of Sciences
and noted specialist in the aquatic Coleoptera, was, for many years, a very
active force in the Pacific Coast Entomological Society. Through his energy
and support the society has grown and prospered. In recognition of this,
and on the occasion of his 70th birthday, recently passed, the Pacific Coast
Entomological Society dedicates this issue to Hugh B. Leech.
Many persons were interested in contributing to this issue, but the editors
have selected papers on water beetles as being perhaps most appropriate.
All of Hugh’s friends, whether they are represented in this issue or not,
extend their congratulations and best wishes.
Fig. 1. Hugh Bosdin Leech. Photograph taken at the California Academy of Sciences in
1951 by Edward S. Ross.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 2-42
HUGH BOSDIN LEECH— A CURATOR’S CURATOR
David H. Kavanaugh and Paul H. Arnaud, Jr.
Department of Entomology, California Academy of Sciences,
Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, CA 94118
It is with great pleasure that, on the occasion of his seventieth birthday,
we present the following brief biography of our friend and colleague, Hugh
B. Leech.
Hugh Bosdin Leech was born on May 10, 1910 at Kamloops, British
Columbia, the son of Daniel Herbert Leech and Olive Roberta Shepherd.
His early years spent in rural surroundings, amid the beautiful mountains
and valleys of southern British Columbia, have clearly had a profound and
lasting impact on his view of life in general and the way he has chosen to
live.
He received his early schooling at Lakefield Preparatory School in Lake-
field, Ontario, Vernon Preparatory School in Vernon, British Columbia, and
Salmon Arm High School in Salmon Arm, British Columbia. He went on
to earn a B.S.A. degree from the University of British Columbia, Vancou¬
ver, in 1933 and concluded his formal education in 1938 with a M.Sc. degree
from the University of California at Berkeley.
In 1932, Hugh met Frances Orchid Quail of Fernie, B.C., while both were
attending the University of British Columbia. Married in Fernie in March
1936, they now have a daughter (Mary Kathleen, in Walnut Creek, Califor¬
nia), three sons (Robin, in Edmonton, Alberta; Tom, in Novato, California;
and Bill, in Costa Mesa, California) and 6 grandchildren living in both Can¬
ada and the United States. Hugh brought his family to California in 1947,
and he became a naturalized U.S. citizen in 1955.
Hugh’s interest in natural history, and insects in particular, began at an
early age and was encouraged by his parents (Leech, 1948). His first profes¬
sional position in entomology was in 1929, as a laboratory assistant for the
Canada Department of Agriculture at the Field Crop Pests Laboratory in
Vernon, British Columbia. During the years 1930-1947 and when not at¬
tending university in Vancouver or Berkeley, he held various technical po¬
sitions with the Forest Entomology Laboratory in Vernon. It was during
this period that he met, worked with, and was influenced by the late Ralph
Hopping, whom he acknowledges (Leech, 1942) as his mentor in system-
atics.
In 1947, Hugh joined the Department of Entomology at the California
Academy of Sciences as Assistant Curator and began an association which,
4
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
to the great benefit of the Academy and its collections, the field of-insect
systematics, and several generations of insect systematists, continued for
28 years. He retired in May, 1975 as Associate Curator, Department of
Entomology, and was immediately appointed Curator Emeritus, the position
he now holds.
As any of his many colleagues will agree, Hugh Leech is second to none
as a curator. The record of his stewardship for the collection in his charge
is unsurpassed, a model for his contemporaries and successors. Under his
care and attention, the Academy’s Coleoptera collection became one of the
best curated in the world and therefore of international importance in sys¬
tematics. His willingness and promptness in making material available on
loan as well as his attentiveness and helpfulness to visitors to the collection
have been his trademark. Few curators have had so complete a grasp of
contemporary research in their field as Hugh. He routinely followed up on
initial loans to researchers with subsequent loans of newly acquired or pre¬
pared material — unsolicited, but always welcome additions. He saw to it
that any changes in nomenclature and/or classification which appeared in
the literature were quickly reflected in the organization of the Academy’s
collection.
Certain of Hugh’s personal traits are especially well suited to curatorial
work. He is orderly and precise, tough-minded, independent, but with a
keen sense of humor which permits him to keep details in perspective. He
is also a superb correspondent, adept at handling the kinds of exchange that
characterize the curator’s role as interface between collection resources
(both specimens and information) and the users of those resources. A trust¬
ing person, Hugh has been willing to take a chance on the unproven. Con¬
sequently, he has been extremely helpful to students or others just getting
started in insect systematics by providing information or loaning specimens
when other curators might have refused to do so; and he has done much to
foster careers in entomology through his continued encouragement to col¬
leagues, both young and old.
Always interested in literature and writing, Hugh worked hard at building
and organizing the entomological libraries at the Academy. The Coleoptera
section in particular is especially strong due to his efforts. Perhaps more
importantly, he has been an incredible bibliographic resource to his many
friends and associates. His command of the literature and ease in providing
the key reference in a particular situation have saved many a fellow worker
hours which could have been lost in searching through indices and abstracts.
His many thorough and detailed book reviews and notices on newly pub¬
lished works (see Appendix A) have been of further service to his col¬
leagues.
Although he has always put his curatorial work first, Hugh’s exceptional
interest and abilities in both research and fieldwork are well known and
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
5
respected by his colleagues (see Appendix C for a list of taxa named in his
honor). His research has ranged widely over the order Coleoptera (see
Appendices A and B) but has centered mainly on the families of aquatic
beetles. As with everything he does, Hugh’s published works reflect care
and precision, as well as a keen eye for details and differences. A recognized
authority on several hydradephagan families, as well as the Hydrophilidae,
perhaps his best known work is that with H. P. Chandler (Leech and Chan¬
dler, 1956) on the aquatic beetles of California. To date, he has described
over 50 beetle taxa as new (see Appendix B) — the first ( Agabus vancou-
verensis Leech) in 1937, the most recent (two species of Hygrotus ) in 1966 —
in an impressive series of papers dealing mainly with western North Amer¬
ica.
Hugh has always had great interest in the history of entomology and in
entomologists. He is today one of our best single resources on the history
of entomology, at least for western North America. His close personal as¬
sociations with so many entomologists — including M. A. Cazier, W. C. Day,
D. G. Denning, J. W. Green, J. L. Gressitt, R. Hopping, P. D. Hurd, Jr.,
E. L. Kessel, E. R. Leach, E. G. Linsley, E. S. Ross, J. Schuh, G. S. Smith,
R. L. Usinger, E. C. Van Dyke, F. X. Williams, E. C. Zimmerman, and many
others — span several generations and a period of great change in our field.
His detailed biographies of and tributes to deceased colleagues (see Appendix
A) provide us with unique and lasting insights into their careers and lives.
His concern for the artifacts that make history more tangible, more real, is
reflected in his work on and frequent additions to the historical files of the
Academy’s Entomology Department and of the Pacific Coast Entomological
Society.
From his early start in entomology to the present, Hugh has maintained
a continued interest in fieldwork. Early in his career, he collected intensely
in southern British Columbia. Subsequent opportunities for travel permitted
him access to other parts of western North America. He collected in main¬
land Mexico with E. S. Ross in 1948 and Baja California in 1958-1959 and
again in 1963 with P. H. Arnaud, Jr. A particularly productive trip was one
to Arizona in July and August, 1952 with J. Wagener Green (see Fig. 2 for
some results). However, most of his collecting has been done in California
and adjacent states. He has enjoyed collecting either alone or with friends.
A close friend and frequent field companion was the late W. C. Day, noted
mayfly enthusiast.
As at home in the field as ever, Hugh still enjoys collecting and is usually
willing to spend some time in this pursuit at the drop of a hat. Much of his
recent effort, as in past years, has been spent collecting insects in the area
of his home and, specifically, in rearing insects inhabiting dead wood. He
is rapidly accumulating a wealth of information on insect/host plant asso¬
ciations and interspecific interactions.
Hugh officially donated his collection to the California Academy of Sci-
6
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 2. Dr. Edwin C. Van Dyke and H. B. Leech examining part of the collection made by
H. B. Leech and J. W. Green on their expedition to Arizona, July-August, 1952. Photograph
taken by Edward S. Ross at the California Academy of Sciences, September 5, 1952.
ences in 1947. At that time, it contained over 30,000 water beetle specimens,
including Gyrinidae, Hydrophilidae, and Limnebiidae from the collection of
Charles W. Leng. In subsequent years and as a result of his continued
productive field activity, he has deposited an incredible amount of additional
material in the Academy collection; and accession records of this institution
indicate that these contributions now total almost one-quarter of a million
specimens. This legacy of carefully prepared and well documented material
stands in fitting tribute to his outstanding contribution through fieldwork.
During his career, Hugh has been affiliated with many professional soci¬
eties, including the American Institute of Biological Sciences, California
Academy of Sciences (Fellow), The Coleopterists Society (Executive Coun¬
cil member), Collectors Club (New York), Entomological Society of British
Columbia (Past Secretary-Treasurer and Editor), Pacific Coast Entomolog¬
ical Society, Sierra Club, Society of Sigma Xi, and Society of Systematic
Zoology. However, his association with the Pacific Coast Entomological
Society (PCES) has been a long and fruitful one which deserves special
attention.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
7
Hugh’s first contact with the Society was in 1931, when he subscribed to
volume 7 of The Pan-Pacific Entomologist. He was elected to Society mem¬
bership at the November meeting, 1947, and to Honorary membership in
December 1975. He served as Co-editor of The Pan-Pacific Entomologist
(PPE) (with P. D. Hurd, Jr.) for volumes 26 (1950) through 29 (1953). He
was Vice-President of the Society in 1955 and President in 1956, served four
successive three-year terms on the PCES Publications Committee (1952-
1963), has been a member of the PPE Editorial Board since 1954, and was
Chairman of the Historical Committee for many years prior to his retirement
in 1975. In addition, he reviewed many_books for the Society with written
reviews and/or actual displays of books at Society meetings; and he was
active in circulating duplicate reprints and other literature among Society
members. Perhaps most conspicuous among his functions for the Society
was as a gracious, informative, and helpful host at the Academy for all
attending monthly meetings of the Society.
Following his retirement, Hugh and Frances moved into a log house on
44 acres of land on Howell Mountain, just east of Angwin, in Napa County,
California. He keeps himself in excellent condition, working his gardens
with hand tools and hours of his labor. He leads a hard and relatively un¬
cluttered life — just the way he likes it; and there are plenty of plants and
animals, especially insects, around to entertain and surprise him as they
always have.
For his outstanding achievements, for his vital part in our Society for
almost 50 years, and for being such a helpful and generous colleague, we
salute Hugh B. Leech — a Curator’s Curator!
Acknowledgments
We thank Roberta L. Brett, Helen Court, L. Gail Freihofer, and Vincent F.
Lee for technical assistance in the preparation of this manuscript. Frances
O. Leech, Robin E. Leech, and Edward S. Ross have provided important
information for which we are especially grateful. E. S. Ross also reviewed
and commented on the manuscript.
Literature Cited
Leech, H. B. 1942. New or insufficiently known Nearctic species and subspecies of Agabus
(Coleoptera, Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 74(7): 125-136.
Leech, H. B. 1948. Daniel Herbert Leech, 1878-1941. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C. (1947),
44:36-38.
Leech, H. B., and H. P. Chandler. 1956. Aquatic Coleoptera (Chapter 13). Pp. 293-371, figs.
13.1-13.67. In Usinger, R. L., Aquatic insects of California, with keys to North Amer¬
ican genera and species. University of California Press, Berkeley and Los Angeles,
x + 508 pp.
8
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Appendix A
Bibliography of the Entomological Publications of Hugh Bosdin Leech
(through 1977)
This bibliography lists all known, published, entomological contributions
by Hugh B. Leech in chronological order. It has been compiled from
a handwritten manuscript list that was loaned by Leech to the De¬
partment of Entomology. We have edited the Leech manuscript ex¬
tensively, added some titles, and modified others to a consistent style.
All items have been checked against the originals except for item 84
(which was not available to us). Untitled notes presented in the Pro¬
ceedings of the Pacific Coast Entomological Society (PCES) and in
other publications are provided with titles cited within brackets. Some
bracketed titles cited from the Proceedings of the PCES are quoted
from E. Gorton Linsley’s “Fifty Years of The Pan-Pacific Entomolo¬
gist” (Pan-Pac. Entomol., 50(4): 3 09-4 15), while others are original.
We list remarks and notes presented by Leech at meetings of the PCES
and published in the Proceedings of this Society under his authorship,
because we feel that this information should be attributed to him, even
though it appears in minutes signed by successive Society secretaries.
Dates of publication are given at the end of individual numbered entries
when such data were cited in the Leech manuscript.
1930
1. Notes on Phymatodes vulneratus LeC. with a new host record (Co-
leoptera, Cerambycidae). Can. Entomol., 62(9): 191-192. Published
September 27.
1931
2. Notes on new methods of collecting beetles. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C.,
(1930), 27:11-12. Published March 21.
3. Coleoptera by “smoking” stumps. Bull. Brooklyn Entomol. Soc.,
26(1): 12. Published April 2.
4. Drosophila funebris as a host of the fungus Stigmatomyces. Proc.
Entomol. Soc. B.C., 28:19-20. Published Fall of 1931, probably No¬
vember.
1934
5. Almost a cannibal. Bull. Brooklyn Entomol. Soc., 29(1):41. Published
February 17.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
9
1935
6. The family history of Nicrophorus conversator Walker. Proc. Ento-
mol. Soc. B.C., (1934), 31:36-40. Published February 23.
7. An occurrence of Trichocera garretti Alex, and a larval predator
(Diptera[,] Trichoceridae and Coleoptera, Staphylinidae) . Can. Ento-
mol., 67(8): 182-183. Published August 31.
8. British Columbian records of Carabidae and Hydrophilidae (Coleop¬
tera). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 11(3): 120-124. Published October 8.
1936
9. A rare Aphodius. Bull. Brooklyn Entomol. Soc., 31(2):56. Published
April 16.
10. (by G. R. Hopping and H. B. Leech). Sawfly biologies. 1. Neodiprion
tsugae Middleton. Can. Entomol., 68(4):71-79, pis. 4-5. Published
May 9.
11. [Bessa selecta possible parasite of larch sawfly]. Can. Insect Pest Rev.,
14(2): 99.
1937
12. Correction. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1936), 33:34. Published Feb¬
ruary 27.
13. [Insects (or near relatives) of economic importance recently noted in
British Columbia]. Orthoptera: Periplaneta australasiae (Fabr.). Proc.
Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1936), 33:46. Published February 27.
14. (by G. R. Hopping and H. B. Leech). [Insects (or near relatives) of
economic importance recently noted in British Columbia]. Hymenop-
tera: Mesoleius tenthredinis Morley. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C.,
(1936), 33:47. Published February 27.
15. A new North American Agabus, with notes on other species. (Co¬
leoptera: Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 69(7): 146-150, figs. 1-4. Pub¬
lished July 3 1 .
16. Notes on certain names in use in the vespilloides group of Nicrophorus
Fab. (Coleoptera: Silphidae). Bull. Brooklyn Entomol. Soc., 32(4): 156-
159. Published October 7.
1938
17. A new species of Gyrinus, with a note on Dineutus robertsi Leng.
(Coleoptera, Gyrinidae). Can. Entomol., 70(3):59-61. Published April 2.
18. Hibernation of the cerambycid Plectrura spinicauda Mann. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 14(2):69. Published June 13.
10
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
19. A new species of Coelambus from California (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae).
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 14(2): 84-86. Published June 13.
20. Descriptions of three new species of Agabus from Hudson Bay. (Co¬
leoptera: Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 70(6): 123-127, figs. 1-4. Pub¬
lished July 2.
1939
21. (by Ralph Hopping and H. B. Leech). Summary report of British Co¬
lumbia section. Ann. Rep. Forest Insect Surv., 1938:10-11.
22. On some Nearctic species of Agabus , with the description of a new
species. (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 71(10):217— 221 , figs.
A-C. Published November 3.
23. Three new species of Nearctic rove beetles from the Pacific Coast
(Coleoptera, Staphylinidae). Can. Entomol., 71(12): 258—26 1 , figs. 1-
3. Published December 30.
1940
24. Dineutus in California (Coleoptera, Gyrinidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
16(2): 74. Published May 23.
25. Description of a new species of Laccornis, with a key to the Nearctic
species (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 72(6): 122-128, pi. 8.
Published June 29.
1941
26. Note on the species of Agabinus (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae). Can. Ento¬
mol., 73(3): 53. Published April 5.
27. The species of Matus, a genus of carnivorous water-beetles (Coleop¬
tera, Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 73(4):77-83, figs. 1-8 on pi. 6. Pub¬
lished May 31.
28. Collecting of the rare water beetle Laccornis cliff ormis (LeC.) by the
late Ch. Roberts. Can. Entomol., 73(4): 96. Published May 31.
29. The male of Hydroporus coelamboides. Can. Entomol., 73(4):96. Pub¬
lished May 31.
30. Descriptions of two new species of water beetles of the genus Hydro¬
porus from California (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
17(3): 129-132, figs. 1-9. Published July 31.
31. The generic name Thermonectus Dejean (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae).
Can. Entomol., 73(11): 197. Published December 5.
32. [Book review]. British water beetles. Ann. Entomol. Soc. Amer.,
34(4): 808. Published December 19.
33. The dates of publication of two articles on Coleoptera by John L.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
11
LeConte, issued in 1845. Entomol. News, 52(10): 290-291. Published
December 30.
1942
34. [Obituary]. Ralph Hopping (1868-1941). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C.,
(1941), 38:2-4, 1 pi. Published February 7.
35. [Announcement of the deaths of Ralph Hopping and F. C. Hennessey].
Entomol. News, 53(2):60. (data supplied by H. B. Leech).
36. The dates of publication of certain numbers of the Proceedings of the
Entomological Society of British Columbia. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C.,
(1941), 38:29-36. Published February 7.
37. Mandibular shapes in water beetles of the genus Thermonectus (Co-
leoptera, Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 74(3):56, figs. 1-2. Published
March 31.
38. Dimorphism in the flying wings of a species of water beetle, Agabus
bifarius (Kirby) (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Ann. Entomol. Soc. Amer.,
35(l):76-80, figs. 1-3. Published April 21.
39. Female mutillids eating butter. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 18(2):89. Published
April 29.
40. New or insufficiently known Nearctic species and subspecies of Aga¬
bus (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 74(7): 125-136, pi. 10.
Published August 26.
41. Key to the Nearctic genera of water beetles of the tribe Agabini, with
some generic synonymy (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Ann. Entomol. Soc.
Amer., 35(3):355-362, pi. 1. Published September 30.
42. Agabus ontarionis Fall. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 39:22. Published
October 10.
43. Hemichroa crocea (Fourcroy). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 39:35. Pub¬
lished October 10.
44. Gyrinus pectoralis LeConte. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 39:35. Pub¬
lished October 10.
45. Dr. F. Guignot’s synonymy of Agabus dispositus Guignot (Coleoptera:
Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 74(10): 194. Published November 18.
1943
46. Fall flight of Bruce’s measuring worm, Oporophtera bruceata Hulst.
(Lepidoptera, Geometridae). Can. Entomol., 75(1):20. Published Feb¬
ruary 18.
47. Black flour beetle, Tribolium madens Charp., in British Columbia
(Coleoptera, Tenebrionidae). Can. Entomol., 75(2):40. Published
March 10.
12
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
48. Berosus exilis LeConte a Hemiosus (Coleoptera, Hydrophilidae). Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 19(2): 6 1-62. Published May 22.
49. Further note on Thermonectus (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae). Can. Ento¬
mol., 75(8): 145. Published September 17.
50. Culicoides gigas R. & H. at Vernon, B.C. (Diptera: Ceratopogonidae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 40:23. Published September 20.
51. Marathyssa inficita Walker at Oliver, B.C. (Lepidoptera: Phalaeni-
dae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 40:25. Published September 20.
52. Miscellaneous records of beetles in British Columbia (Coleoptera: Hy¬
drophilidae, Elateridae, Buprestidae, Lathridiidae, Chrysomelidae,
Curculionidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 40:26-27. Published Sep¬
tember 20.
53. Tropisternus paredesi, neuvo coleoptero acuatico palpicornio de Na-
yarit, Mexico (Coleoptera, Hydrophylidae [sic!]). Rev. Soc. Mex. Hist.
Nat., 4(1-2): 17-20, figs. 1-6.
54. (by G. R. Hopping, H. B. Leech, W. G. Mathers, and C. V. G. Mor¬
gan). [The larch sawfly in the Okanagan Valley and Trinity Valley
district, British Columbia]. Can. Insect Pest Rev., 21(2):258.
55. (by W. G. Mathers, H. B. Leech, and C. V. G. Morgan). [Parasitism
of the larch sawfly by Mesoleius and Tritneptis in British Columbia].
Can. Insect Pest Rev., 2 1(2): 258.
56. (by Geo. R. Hopping, H. B. Leech, and Cecil V. G. Morgan). The
larch sawfly, Pristiphora erichsonii (Hartig) in British Columbia, with
special reference to the cocoon parasites Mesoleius tenthredinis Mor-
ley and Tritneptis klugii (Ratzeburg). Sci. Agric., 24(2):53-63, fig. 1.
1944
57. List of six species of gyrinid water beetles collected by J. L. Gressitt
in China and Japan. (Coleoptera, Gyrinidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
20(1): 22. Published January 31.
58. Spring flight of Atimia dorsalis (Coleoptera, Cerambycidae). Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 20(1): 30. Published January 31.
59. Laccophilus shermani, a new species of water beetle from Arizona and
Texas (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Entomol. News, 55(l):4-6.
60. The cerambycid beetle, Phymatodes dimidiatus, in cedar structural
timbers. Can. Entomol., 76(10) :211. Published November 10.
61. Death of Gustaf Falkenstrom. Can. Entomol., 76(10):211. Published
November 10.
62. [Recent literature]. Stoneflies of southwestern British Columbia, by
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
13
William E. Ricker; British Columbia dragonflies with notes on distri¬
bution and habits, by F. C. Whitehouse; The caddis flies, or Trichop-
tera, of Illinois, by Herbet [sic!] H. Ross; Comparative external mor¬
phology, phylogeny, and a classification of the bees (Hymenoptera) ,
by Charles Duncan Michener; British Columbia Provincial Museum,
Handbook Series. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:front cover verso.
Published December 8.
63. Corrections, vols. 38 & 40. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:front cover
verso. Published December 8. (unsigned note).
64. Virtual absence of vespine wasps in the summer of 1944 (Hymenop¬
tera, Vespidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:4. Published Decem¬
ber 8.
65. Note on Dalopius tristis and D. insulanus (Coleoptera, Elateridae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:25. Published December 8.
66. Eucorethra underwoodi at Summerland, B.C. (Diptera: Culicidae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:36. Published December 8.
67. The flea beetle Orestioides robusta in British Columbia (Coleoptera:
Chrysomelidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:36. Published Decem¬
ber 8.
68. Campylenchia latipes on aster (Homoptera: Membracidae) . Proc.
Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:36. Published December 8.
69. The bug Corythucha padi on bracken fern. (Hemiptera: Tingidae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 41:36. Published December 8.
70. Summary report of Forest Insect Survey, British Columbia and west¬
ern Alberta. Ann. Rep. Forest Insect Surv., Forest Insect Invest.,
1943:62-68. Received by mail at Vernon, B.C., January 17, 1945.
1945
71. A few additions and corrections to R. E. Blackwelder’s “Checklist of
the coleopterous insects of Mexico, Central America, the West Indies,
and South America. Part I.” Entomol. News, (1944), 55(10): 266-268.
Published January 25.
72. On three species of Agabus recorded from the State of Montana (Co¬
leoptera, Dytiscidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 21(1): 16.
73. The specific characters and distribution of Agabus vancouverensis and
A. hypomelas (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae). Can. Entomol., 77(5):77-78.
Published September 10.
74. Three new species of Nearctic Deronectes (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae).
Can. Entomol., 77(6): 105-1 10, figs. 1-4. Published November 2.
14
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
75. Summary report of the Forest Insect Survey, British Columbia and
Rocky Mountain National Parks. Ann. Rep. Forest Insect Surv., For¬
est Insect Invest., 1944:62-70. Published in November.
76. [Recent literature]. An annotated list of the Scolytoidea of Washington,
by Gordon K. Patterson and Melville H. Hatch; Field crop insects in
the Prairie Provinces, Bulletin No. 5, published by Line Elevators
Farm Service; A source-book of biological names and terms, by Ed¬
mund C. Jaeger; Checklist of the coleopterous insects of Mexico, Cen¬
tral America, the West Indies and South America, by Richard E.
Blackwelder. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:front cover verso. Pub¬
lished December 8. (unsigned book reviews).
77. Eros thoracicus in British Columbia (Coleoptera: Lycidae). Proc.
Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:2. Published December 8.
78. Aphodius alternatus in British Columbia (Coleoptera: Scarabaeidae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:2. Published December 8.
79. British Columbia and Alberta records in E. C. Lerch’s “A list of Ho-
moptera from Ontario.” Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:8. Published
December 8.
80. Holopleura marginata in British Columbia (Coleoptera: Cerambyci-
dae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:18. Published December 8.
81. Agabus confertus eating chironomid larvae (Coleoptera, Dytiscidae,
Diptera). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:18. Published December 8.
82. Limonius rufihumeralis in British Columbia (Coleoptera: Elateridae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:26. Published December 8.
83. Stenichnus ovipennis in British Columbia (Coleoptera: Scydmaenidae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 42:28. Published December 8.
1946
84. On writing articles for the Proceedings of the Entomological Society
of British Columbia. (Mimeographed; 25 or more copies sent out on
January 14, 1946, 8 pp., 1 table. Produced at the Forest Insect Labo¬
ratory in the Court House, Vernon, B.C.) Published January 14.
85. Remarks on some Pacific Coast species of Tropisternus (Coleoptera:
Hydrophilidae). Can. Entomol., (1945), 77(10): 179-184, figs. 1-5. Pub¬
lished March 28.
86. Flights of Nymphalis calif ornica Bdv. in British Columbia and Alberta
in 1945. Can. Entomol., (1945), 7(11):203. Published April 18.
87. British Columbia and Rocky Mountain National Parks. Ann. Rep. For¬
est Insect Surv., Forest Insect Invest., 1945:61-67. Published in No¬
vember.
88. Forest insect survey [British Columbia (interior)]. Dom. Dept. Agric.,
Forest Insect Invest., Bi-Mon. Progr. Rep., 2(5):3.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
15
1947
89. [Recent literature]. Tenthredinoidea of Southeast Asia with a general
zoogeographical review, by Rene Malaise. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C.,
(1946), 43: title page verso. Published February 4.
90. [Recent literature]. The butterflies of Washington. By Ben V. Leigh¬
ton. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1946), 43 Title page verso. Published
February 4.
91. [Recent literature]. The North American clear- wing moths of the fam¬
ily Aegeriidae. By George P. Engelhardt. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C.,
(1946), 43 Title page verso. Published February 4.
92. A list of twenty species of spiders collected at Salmon Arm, B.C. Proc.
Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1946), 43:22. Published February 4.
93. Rearing of Agromyza albitarsis and its parasite Opius sp. (Diptera:
Agromyzidae, and Hymenoptera: Braconidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc.
B.C., (1946), 43:22. Published February 4.
94. A few records of spiders from British Columbia and Alberta. Proc.
Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1946), 43:22. Published February 4.
95. List of some Philonthus from British Clumbia [sic!] (Coleoptera:
Staphylinidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1946), 43:23-24. Published
February 4.
96. Local abundance of the wasps Chlorion atratum and Megastizus uni-
cinctus (Hymenoptera: Sphecidae and Bembicinae). Proc. Entomol.
Soc. B.C., (1946), 43:32. Published February 4.
97. [Recent literature]. Bibliography of biographies of entomologists. By
Mathilde Carpenter. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1946), 43:46. Pub¬
lished February 4.
98. [Ecological and collecting notes]. [Early spring collecting on north
ends of buildings in barnyards]. Coleopt. Bull., 1(2): 19.
99. Noted Coleopterist dies. Coleopt. Bull., 1(3):23.
100. Collecting in southern British Columbia: finding of the water beetle
Deronectes spenceri. Can. Entomol., (1946), 78(1 1-12): 198-200. Pub¬
lished April 3.
101. Crow eating Serica beetles (Coleoptera, Scarabaeidae). Can. Ento¬
mol., 79(1):4.
102. British Columbia and Rocky Mountain National Parks. Ann. Rep. For¬
est Insect Surv., Forest Insect Invest., 1946:77-86. Received by mail
at San Francisco October 16.
103. California tortoiseshell ( Nymphalis californica Bdv.), British Colum¬
bia. Can. Insect Pest Rev., 25(1):3.
104. A looper (Geometridae), British Columbia. Can. Insect Pest Rev.,
25(1):45.
105. Forest tent caterpillar ( Malacosoma disstria Hbn.), British Columbia.
Can. Insect Pest Rev., 25(1):48.
16
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
106. Spruce budworm (Ar chip s fumifer ana Clem.), British Columbia. Can.
Insect Pest Rev., 25(1):56.
107. Western balsam bark beetle {Dryocoetes confusus Swaine), British
Columbia. Can. Insect Pest Rev., 25(1): 59.
108. Douglas-fir beetle ( Dendroctonus pseudotsugae Hopk.), British Co¬
lumbia. Can. Insect Pest Rev., 25(1):63.
109. Douglas-fir tussock moth ( Hemerocampa pseudotsugata McD.), Brit¬
ish Columbia. Can. Insect Pest Rev., 25(1): 63.
110. Western hemlock looper {Lamb dina fisc ellaria lugubrosa Hist.), Brit¬
ish Columbia. Can. Insect Pest Rev., 25(l):65-66.
111. Larch sawfly {Pristiphora erichsonii Htg.), British Columbia. Can. In¬
sect Pest Rev., 25(1):67.
1948
112. Bidessus leachi, a new species of dytiscid water beetle from northern
California (Coleoptera). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1947), 44:11-12,
figs. 1-3. Published February 16.
113. Chrysis smaragdicolor from the nest of Osmia longula (Hymenoptera:
Chrysididae and Megachilidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1947),
44:27, fig. 1. Published February 16.
114. Elm gall aphid eaten by Evening Grosbeak (Aphididae: Eriosomati-
dae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1947), 44:34. Published February 16.
115. [In memoriam]. Daniel Herbert Leech, 1878-1941. Proc. Entomol.
Soc. B.C., (1947), 44:36-38, fig. 1. Published February 16.
116. New distributional records of Deronectes spenceri (Coleoptera: Dy-
tiscidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1947), 44:38. Published Febru¬
ary 16.
117. Serica sericea and S. anthracina defoliating wild rose (Coleoptera:
Scarabaeidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1947), 44:38. Published
February 16.
118. Anthidiellum robertsoni and its nest (Hymenoptera: Megachilidae).
Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1947), 44:39, figs. 1-2. Published Febru¬
ary 16.
119. The W. H. A. Preece collection of Cerambycidae. Proc. Entomol. Soc.
B.C., (1947), 44:39. Published February 16.
120. [Various keys to aquatic beetles]. In Usinger, R. L., Ira La Rivers,
H. P. Chandler, and W. W. Wirth, Biology of aquatic and littoral
insects. (A syllabus for Entomology 133). Univ. Calif. Press, Syllabus
Ser., Berkeley, 244 pp. (mimeographed). Published March 8.
121. Collecting in southern British Columbia: hilltop to lakeshore for bee¬
tles. Can. Entomol., (1947), 79(6): 105-108.
122. Some Nearctic species of palpicorn water beetles, new and old (Co-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
17
leoptera: Hydrophilidae). Wasmann Collect., 7(2):33-46. Published
March 24.
123. A Psitherus insularis queen in a Bombus mixtus nest. Can. Entomol.,
(1947), 79(7-8): 134. Published in May.
124. Sarcophaga rapax reared from Prionus calif ornicus . Can. Entomol.,
(1947), 79(7-8): 141. Published in May.
125. Helops regulus in a wasp’s nest. Can. Entomol., (1947), 79(7-8): 141.
Published in May.
126. Acetic acid odor from Stenolophus fidelis. Can. Entomol., (1947),
79(7-8): 141. Published in May.
127. Records of three species of Dytiscidae new to the United States (Co-
leoptera). J. Kans. Entomol. Soc., 2 1(2): 65. Published May 20.
128. Contributions toward a knowledge of the insect fauna of Lower Cali¬
fornia. No. 11. Coleoptera: Haliplidae, Dytiscidae, Gyrinidae, Hydro¬
philidae, Limnebiidae. Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)24(1 1):375-484, pis.
20-21. Published June 11.
129. Ralph Hopping collection now in the California Academy of Sciences.
Coleopt. Bull., 2(6):56-57. Published in September.
130. Collecting larvae of two species of Ditylus (Oedemeridae). Coleopt.
Bull., 2(7):66-67. Published in October.
131. [Book notice]. The naturalist’s lexicon, a list of classical Greek and
Latin words used or suitable for use in biological nomenclature, with
abridged English-Classical supplement. By Robert S. Woods. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 24(3): 130. Published October 14.
132. Host records for Calopus angustus LeC. (Oedemeridae). Coleopt.
Bull., 2(8) :75. Published in October.
1949
133. [Book notice]. Insect natural history. By A. D. Imms. Pan-Pac. Ento¬
mol., (1948), 24(4):211. Published January 27.
134. The Canadian Forest Insect Survey. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol.
Soc., 197th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 25(l):37-38. Published
March 17.
135. Some Nearctic species of hydradephagid water beetles, new and old
(Coleoptera). Can. Entomol., 80(1- 12): 89-96, figs. 1-11. Published
June 9.
136. [Book review]. Coleoptera of Tristan da Cunha, by Per Brinck. Co¬
leopt. Bull., 3(3): 48. Published July 11.
137. The occurrence of a hollyhock-seed eater, Noctuelia rufofascialis, at
Vernon, British Columbia (Lepidoptera: Pyralidae). Proc. Entomol.
Soc. B.C., (1948), 45:25-26, figs. 1-2. Published July 28.
138. Introduction into British Columbia of two species of Japanese Cer-
18
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
ambycidae (Coleoptera). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1948), 45:26. Pub¬
lished July 28.
139. [Book notice]. [S. W. Geiser’s fascinating book “Naturalists of the
frontier”]. Coleopt. Bull., 3(4):63-64. Published August 29.
1950
140. Addendum to an article “Some Nearctic species of hydradephagid
water beetles, new and old (Coleoptera).” Can. Entomol., (1949),
81(9):233.
141. New species and subspecies of Nearctic water beetles (Coleoptera:
Dytiscidae and Hydrophilidae) . Wasmann Collect., (1949), 7(6): 243-
256, figs. 1-6. Published January 13.
142. A winter crane-fly, Trichocera annulata, at Vernon, B.C. (Diptera:
Trichoceridae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1949), 46:4. Published
May 15.
143. Forgotten collectors. Coleopt. Bull., 4(3):44-46. Published in June.
144. [Book notice]. The Siphonaptera of Canada. By George P. Holland.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 26(2): 80. Published June 27.
145. Cartodere filum in California (Coleoptera: Lathridiidae) . Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 26(2): 94. Published June 27.
146. [Book notice]. The nature of natural history. By Marston Bates. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 26(4): 160. Published December 29.
1951
147. [Editorial notes]. Notes on writing sentences; E. C. Van Dyke hon¬
ored. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 27(1):36. Published March 31. (unsigned no¬
tices).
148. Carbon tetrachloride is dangerous. Lepid. News, 5(l-2):6.
149. (by E. O. Essig, P. D. Hurd, Jr., D. D. Jensen, H. B. Leech, E. G.
Linsley, J. W. MacSwain, R. C. Miller, R. L. Usinger, and E. C. Van
Dyke). The history of the Pacific Coast Entomological Society. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 27(3):97-119, figs. 1-4. Published September 25.
150. Seal contest. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 27(3): 139. Published September 25.
(unsigned note).
151. [Book notice]. Bulletin of Animal Behaviour. (Journal of the Associ¬
ation for the Study of Animal Behaviour). Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
27(4): 147. Published December 28.
152. The sucking lice, by G. F. Ferris. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 27(4): 148. Pub¬
lished December 28. (unsigned note).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
19
1952
153. Oligomerus ptilinoides in California (Anobiidae). Coleopt. Bull., 6(1):
14. Received by mail at California Academy of Sciences on March 28.
154. [Book notice]. The scrub-typhus and scrub-itch mites (Trombiculidae:
Acarina) of the Asiatic-Pacific Region. By H. Womersley. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 28(3): 130. Published July 31.
1953
155. Entomological bibliography of Edwin C. Van Dyke. Pan-Pac. Ento¬
mol., 29(2): 89-97. Published June 25.
156. [Partial descriptions of Rhantus signatus (Fabricius)? and Gyrinus gal-
apagoensis Van Dyke]. Pp. 32, 35. In Van Dyke, E. C., The Coleop-
tera of the Galapagos Islands. Occas. Pap. Calif. Acad. Sci., 22, 181
pp., pis. 1-7. Published July 15.
157. [Book notice]. American Megalodacne (Erotylidae). Pan-Pac. Ento¬
mol., 29(3): 126. Published August 25.
158. [Book notice]. Systematic studies in Plecoptera. By William E. Ricker.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 29(3): 137. Published August 25.
159. [Book notices]. Genera Insectorum. Fascicule 192, Carabidae subfamily
Carabinae, by G. Vacher de Lapouge. Fascicule 210, Endomychidae,
by H. F. Strohecker. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 29(3): 179. Published Au¬
gust 25.
160. [Book notice]. Longicorn beetles of China. By J. Linsley Gressitt. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 29(3): 180. Published August 25.
161. [Book notice]. Plant diseases in orchard, nursery and garden crops.
By E. Gram and A. Weber. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 29(3): 180. Published
August 25.
162. [Recently published]. The Coleoptera of the Galapagos Islands, by
Edwin C. Van Dyke; Some new and noteworthy Aphidae from western
and southern South America (Hemiptera-Homoptera), by E. O. Essig;
and The California Academy — Lingnan Dawn-Redwood Expedition,
by J. Linsley Gressitt. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 29(4):200. Published Decem¬
ber 18.
1954
163. [Book notice]. A check list of the genera and species of Mallophaga.
By G. H. E. Hopkins and Theresa Clay. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(1):34.
Published March 30.
164. [Parasites and nest associates of Vespula in Marin County, California].
In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 229th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
30(1):80. Published March 30.
20
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
165. [Gift to Society from F. C. Hottes, and the bruchid Stator limbatus
at Clear Lake, California]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 232nd
meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(1): 85-86. Published March 30.
166. [Resignation as co-editor of Pan- Pacific Entomologist]. In Proc. Pac.
Coast Entomol. Soc., 230th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(1):88.
Published March 30.
167. [Obituary of the late Dr. E. C. Van Dyke in a Japanese Entomological
journal; Balsa wood with cossonine weevils presumably of Neotropical
origin]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 233rd meeting. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 30(1): 90. Published March 30.
168. Leptidiella brevipennis (Mulsant) reared from toy on (Coleoptera: Cer-
ambycidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(2): 158. Published June 24.
169. [Book notice]. The tortoise beetles of China (Chrysomelidae: Cassi-
dinae), by J. Linsley Gressitt. Ann. Entomol. Soc. Amer., 47(2):264.
Published August 17.
170. [Book notice]. The coconut rhinoceros beetle ( Oryctes rhinoceros )
with particular reference to the Palau Islands. By J. Linsley Gressitt.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(3):208. Published September 30.
171. [Book notice]. Fleas, flukes and cuckoos. By Miriam Rothschild and
Theresa Clay. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(4):234. Published November 18.
172. [Book notice]. The taxonomy, phases, and distribution of the genera
Chortoicetes Brunn. and Austroicetes Uv. (Orthoptera: Acrididae). By
K. H. L. Key. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(4):246. Published November 18.
173. [Book notice]. The grasshoppers and locusts (Acridoidea) of Australia.
Volume 2: Family Acrididae (subfamily Pyrgomorphinae). By James
A. G. Rehn. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 30(4):262. Published November 18.
174. [Historical note]. [Clermont Livingston collection of Lepidoptera and
Coleoptera]. Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 51:12. Published November 30.
1955
175. A new genus for Cyphon robustus LeConte (Coleoptera: Helodidae).
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 3 1(1): 34. Published March 24.
176. [Rearing records for Trichomagdalis conspersus and Anthocomus
franciscanus ]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 235th meeting. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 3 1(1): 37. Published March 24.
177. [Rearing records for Cerambycidae and Anobiidae]. In Proc. Pac.
Coast Entomol. Soc., 236th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 31(1):40.
Published March 24.
178. Crepuscular habit of Anoplocephalus criberifrons (Scarabaeidae: Dy-
nastinae). Coleopt. Bull., 9(1):6.
179. (by H. B. Leech and J. Wagener Green). Plant association data for a
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
21
few Arizona and New Mexico Coleoptera (Cleridae, Meloidae, Chrys-
omelidae, Cerambycidae). Coleopt. Bull., 9(2): 27-28.
180. Emergence of the cicada Okanagana tristis Van Duzee (Homoptera:
Cicadidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 31(2):61. Published June 30.
181. Records of water beetles from Manchuria and Siberia (Coleoptera:
Dytiscidae, Hydrophilidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 3 1(2): 80-82. Pub¬
lished June 30.
182. Cheesecloth flight trap for insects. Can. Entomol., 87(5):200. Published
July 15.
183. [Book review]. A manual of the dragonflies of North America (An-
isoptera) including the Greater Antilles and the provinces of the Mex¬
ican border. By James G. Needham and Minter J. Westfall, Jr. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 3 1(3): 108. Published September 23.
184. [Book notices]. Morphology and biology of Sturmia harrisinae Co-
quillett (Diptera), a parasite of the western grape leaf skeletonizer, by
Owen J. Smith, Paul H. Dunn, and John H. Rosenberger; The mega¬
chiline bees of California (Hymenoptera: Megachilidae), by Paul D.
Hurd, Jr., and Charles D. Michener. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 31(4): 185-
186. Published December 16.
185. [Book notice]. Forest entomology in Hawaii. An annotated check-list
of the insect faunas of the various components of the Hawaiian forests.
By Otto H. Swezey (edited by R. H. Van Zwaluwenburg). Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 3 1(4): 192. Published December 16.
186. [Book notice]. The evolution and taxonomy of the Sarcophaginae
(Diptera, Sarcophagidae). By Selwyn S. Roback. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
3 1(4): 192. Published December 16.
187. [Book notices]. A revision of the Psychodidae (Diptera) in America
north of Mexico, by Larry W. Quate; A systematic study of the genus
Aphytis Howard (Hymenoptera, Aphelinidae) with descriptions of new
species, by Harold Compere. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 31(4): 198. Published
December 16.
188. [Book notice]. The carabid beetles of Newfoundland, including the
French Islands of St. Pierre and Miquelon. By Carl H. Lindroth. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 3 1(4): 204. Published December 16.
189. Macrancylus littoralis (Broun) in California, with a note on Phloeo-
phagus protensus (Wollaston) (Coleoptera: Curculionidae). Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 31(4): 191-192. Published December 16.
1956
190. Orr’s records of beetles eaten by the pallid bat. Coleopt. Bull., (1955),
9(4): 52. Published in January.
191. [Recent literature]. The blowflies of California (Diptera: Calliphori-
22
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
dae), by Maurice T. James; The carpenter bees of California (Hyme-
noptera: Apoidea), by Paul D. Hurd, Jr. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 32(1):35.
Published March 14.
192. [Collections received by the Department of Entomology of the Cali¬
fornia Academy of Sciences]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc.,
244th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 32(1): 49-50. Published March 14.
193. Leech had good hunting, too. Acad. News Letter, 195:4. Published by
California Academy of Sciences on or about March 6.
194. [Book review]. The beetles of the Pacific Northwest. Part I: Introduc¬
tion and Adephaga. By Melville H. Hatch. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
32(3): 138-142. Published August 24.
195. (by H. B. Leech and H. P. Chandler). Aquatic Coleoptera (Chapter
13). Pp. 293-371, figs. 13.1-13.67. In Usinger, Robert L. (edited by),
Aquatic insects of California, with keys to North American genera and
California species. University of California Press, Berkeley and Los
Angeles, x + 508 pp., illus. Published September 10.
196. [Recent literature]. Taxonomic appraisal and occurrence of fleas at the
Hastings Reservation in Central California, by Jean M. Linsdale and
Betty S. Davis; The Frankliniella occidentalis (Pergande) complex in
California (Thysanoptera: Thripidae), by Douglas E. Bryan and Ray
F. Smith; The larval trombiculid mites of California (Acarina: Trom-
biculidae), by Douglas J. Gould; and A revision of the genus Pselap-
trichus Brendel (Coleoptera: Pselaphidae), by Robert O. Schuster and
Gordon A. Marsh. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 32(4): 174. Published Novem¬
ber 8.
197. [Recently published]. Gyrinidae. A monograph of the whirlygig beetles
of Southern Africa. By Per Brinck. Coleopt. Bull., 10(3):54. Published
November 29.
1957
198. [Obituary]. Harry Phylander Chandler (1917-1955). Pan-Pac. Ento¬
mol., 33(1):3 1—33 . Published March 22.
199. [Sphinx moth, Arctonotus lucidus Boisduval attracted to light]. In Proc.
Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 246th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
33(1):46. Published March 22.
200. [Collecting at Junipero Serra Peak, Santa Lucia Mountains,
California]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 250th meeting. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 33(1):50-51. Published March 22.
201. [Recently published]. A revision of the Gyrinidae (Coleoptera) of the
Ethiopian region. I. By Per Brinck. Coleopt. Bull., (1956), 10(6):85.
Published May 7.
202. [Recently published]. A revision of the Gyrinidae (Coleoptera) of the
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
23
Ethiopian region. II. By Per Brinck. Coleopt. Bull., (1956), 10(6):96.
Published May 7.
203. Redescription of Haliplus mimeticus Matheson with a note on H. tum-
idus LeConte (Coleoptera: Haliplidae). Wasmann J. Biol., 15(1): 153—
157, fig. 1. Published June 19.
204. [Book notice]. The armored scale insects of California, by Howard L.
McKenzie. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 33(3): 108. Published September 26.
205. [Recent publications]. [List of four items published in the University
of California Publications in Entomology in 1956]. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
33(3): 120. Published September 26.
1958
206. Distribution records for Grypidius leechi (Curculionidae). Coleopt.
Bull., (1957), ll(Fall and Winter) :78. Received by mail at San Fran¬
cisco May 8.
207. [Book notices]. Evolution and classification of the mountain caddis-
flies, by Herbert H. Ross; Annotated catalogue of African grasshop¬
pers, by H. B. Johnston. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 34(3): 124. Published
July 22.
208. [Book notice]. Mosquitoes of North America (north of Mexico). By
Stanley J. Carpenter and Walter J. LaCasse. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
34(3): 137. Published July 22.
209. [Recent publications]. California wasps of the genus Oxybelus (Hy-
menoptera: Sphecidae, Crabroninae), by Richard M. Bohart and Evert
I. Schlinger; The thrips of California, Part I: suborder Terebrantia, by
Stanley F. Bailey; The typical muscid flies of California (Diptera: Mus-
cidae, Muscinae), by Bruce F. Eldridge and Maurice T. James; The
conopid flies of California (Diptera), by Sidney Camras and Paul D.
Hurd, Jr.; The Embioptera of California, by Edward S. Ross. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 34(3): 138. Published July 22.
210. [Book notice]. Fishing with natural insects. An angler’s guide to useful
and interesting information about many common insects and a few
imitation lures that fishermen use for bait. By Alvah Peterson. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 34(3): 145. Published July 22.
211. [Recently published]. Observations on the habits of Sty lops pacifica
Bohart, by E. G. Linsley and J. W. MacSwain; The Neotropical
species of the “subgenus Aeschna ” sensu Selysii 1883 (Odonata), by
Philip P. Calvert; A synopsis of hymenopterous parasites of Mala-
cosoma in California (Lepidoptera, Lasiocampidae), by Robert L.
Langston. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 34(3): 153-154. Published July 22.
212. [Book notice]. Taxonomist’s glossary of genitalia of insects. Edited by
S. L. Tuxen. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 34(3): 154. Published July 22.
24
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
213. [Book review]. The water beetles of Florida, by Frank N. Young. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 34(3): 167-168. Published July 22.
214. Exact data for certain locality labels used by F. E. Blaisdell. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 34(3): 172-174. Published July 22.
215. [Book notices]. A list of Coleoptera from the vicinity of Willapa Bay,
Washington, by Melville H. Hatch and Trevor Kincaid; The grasshop¬
pers and locusts (Acridoidea) of Australia, volume III, family Acridi-
dae: subfamily Cyrtacanthacridinae, tribes Oxyini, Spathosternini, and
Praxibulini, by James A. G. Rehn. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 34(4): 20 1-202.
Published December 5.
216. A record of Agabus semivittatus LeConte from California (Coleoptera:
Dytiscidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 34(4):215-217. Published December 5.
217. Synonymy of Dinoderus pubicollis Van Dyke (Coleoptera: Bostrichi-
dae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 34(4): 230-231. Published December 5.
1959
218. [Book notice]. Monograph of the Tenebrionidae of southern Africa,
vol. I. (Tentyriinae, Molurini. — Trachynotina: Somaticus Hope). By
C. Koch. Coleopt. Bull., (1958), 12(l-4):58. Published January 27.
219. Bibliography of Gordon F. Ferris. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 35(1): 29-50.
Published March 25.
220. [Osmia ribifloris Cockerell at Mill Valley, California]. In Proc. Pac.
Coast Entomol. Soc., 257th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 35(1):53.
Published March 25.
221. [Stator limbatus (Horn) a nuisance to campers]. In Proc. Pac. Coast
Entomol. Soc., 261st meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 3 5(1): 60. Published
March 25.
222. Field notes on some California species of Anthaxia and Melanophila
(Coleoptera: Buprestidae). Wasmann J. Biol., 17(1): 157-158. Pub¬
lished June 19.
223. Notes on a few species of Pacific Coast Cerambycidae. Coleopt. Bull.,
13(2):42-46. Published June 27.
224. (by H. B. Leech and Milton W. Sanderson). Coleoptera. Chapter 38,
pp. 981-1023, figs. 38.1-38.94. In Edmondson, W. T. (edited by),
Fresh- water biology, Second Edition (First Edition edited by Ward,
H. B., and G. C. Whipple). John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York.
Complimentary copy to author received by mail at San Francisco on
August 21.
225. [Book review]. A new entomological journal. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
35(3): 168. Published August 18.
226. (by H. B. Leech and Sinclair H. Farris). Achaetoneura datanarum
reared from Antheraea polyphemus in British Columbia (Diptera:
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
25
Tachinidae). Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 56:22. Published November
4.
227. Earliest record of Carabus nemoralis in San Francisco, California.
Coleopt. Bull., 13(4):98. Published December 30.
1960
228. [Report on a recent winter collecting trip to the Cape region of Baja
California, Mexico]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 263rd meet¬
ing. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(l):42-44. Published March 18.
229. [ Cuterebra latifrons Coquillett]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc.,
263rd meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(1):41. Published March 18.
230. [Photography of Metriona bicolor (Fabricius)]. In Proc. Pac. Coast
Entomol. Soc., 264th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(1):46. Published
March 18.
231. [Loan of W. H. Edward’s letters]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc.,
267th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(1):51. Published March 18.
232. [Correspondence files of E. R. Leach and Owen Bryant]. In Proc. Pac.
Coast Entomol. Soc., 267th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(1):51. Pub¬
lished March 18.
233. [Visit with The Rev. Edward Guedet]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol.
Soc., 267th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(1):51. Published March 18.
234. [Prediction by Owen Bryant of mercury vapor lights as best insect
attractant light]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 267th meeting.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36( 1): 5 1 . Published March 18.
235. [Recent literature]. The Galapagos Islands, a history of their explora¬
tion, by Joseph Richard Slevin. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(2):68. Published
June 15. (unsigned listing).
236. [Recent literature]. The Scolytoidea of the Northwest. Oregon, Wash¬
ington, Idaho and British Columbia, by W. J. Chamberlin. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 36(2):74. Published June 15. (unsigned listing).
237. [Recent literature]. Obligatory and facultative insects in rose hips: their
recognition and bionomics, by W. V. Balduf. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
36(2): 98. Published June 15. (unsigned listing).
238. [Recent literature]. Cynipid galls of the Pacific Slope (Hymenoptera:
Cynipoidea), an aid to their identification, by Lewis H. Weld. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 36(2): 104. Published June 15. (unsigned listing).
239. [Book review]. The beetles of the Pacific Northwest. Part II: Staphy-
liniformia, by Melville H. Hatch, with the collaboration of Milton W.
Sanderson and Gordon Marsh. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 36(3): 141-142.
Published August 9.
1961
240. [Recently published]. [Four titles of publications listed]. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 37(1): 52. Published March 24. (unsigned listing).
26
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
241. [Book notice]. Dictionary of word roots and combining forms. Com¬
piled from the Greek, Latin, and other languages, with special refer¬
ence to biological terms and scientific names. By Donald J. Borror.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 37(1):52. Published March 24.
242. [Collecting trips by Borys Malkin and P. D. Hurd, Jr.]. In Proc. Pac.
Coast Entomol. Soc., 269th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 37(1):61— 62.
Published March 24.
243. [Exhibition of two books]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 271st
meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 37(1):64. Published March 24.
244. [Set of Entomological Newsletter donated to Historical files]. In Proc.
Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 272nd meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
37(1): 65. Published March 24.
245. Note on two editions of J. C. Bradley’s 1919 paper “An entomological
cross-section of the United States.” Pan-Pac. Entomol., 37(2):84. Pub¬
lished June 14.
246. [Book notice]. Forest and shade tree entomology. By Roger F. An¬
derson. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 37(2): 143-144. Published June 14.
247. (by H. B. Leech and Joe Schuh). Graphoderus perplexus (Sharp) in
California (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 37(4):234.
Published November 7.
1962
248. [Book notices]. The Aphidoidea of the Middle East, by F. S. Boden-
heimer and E. Swirski; Check-list and bibliography on the occurrence
of insects in birds’ nests, by E. A. Hicks; Wonder-workers of the
insect world, by H. J. Herbert, foreword by Lucy W. Clausen. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 38(1):28. Published March 28.
249. [Book notices]. A monograph of the immature stages of Neotropical
timber beetles (Cerambycidae), by E. A. J. Duffy; Mites or the Acari,
by T. E. Hughes. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 38(l):39-40. Published March 28.
250. [Recent literature]. [List of five items published in the University of
California Publications in Entomology, 1958-1961]. Pan-Pac. Ento¬
mol., 38(1) :43. Published March 28.
251. [Recent literature]. [Two publications listed]. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
38(1):48. Published March 28.
252. [Book notice]. Modern insecticides and world food production. By F.
A. Gunther and L. R. Jeppson. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 38(1):55. Published
March 28.
253. [Book notice]. Bionomics, systematics, and phytogeny of Lytta, a ge¬
nus of blister beetles (Coleoptera, Meloidae). By R. B. Selander. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 3 8(1): 62. Published March 28.
254. [Book notices]. Insect migration, by C. B. Williams; Collecting, pre-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
27
serving and studying insects, by Harold Oldroyd. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
38(1):62. Published March 28.
255. [Exhibition of two new books]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc.,
273rd meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 38(1):65. Published March 28.
256. [Science Fair judging]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 274th meet¬
ing. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 38(1): 66. Published March 28.
257. [Book notice]. The ground-beetles (Carabidae, excl. Cicindelinae) of
Canada and Alaska. Part 2. By Carl H. Lindroth. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
38(1):73— 74. Published March 28.
258. [Book review]. A manual of common beetles of eastern North Amer¬
ica. By Elizabeth S. and Lawrence S. Dillon. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
38(2): 112-115. Published June 29th.
259. [Discovery in books]. Soil animals. By D. Keith McE. Kevan. Pac.
Discovery, 15(4):31. Published June 29.
260. [Discovery in books]. Pacific Insects. Official organ of the program
“Zoogeography and Evolution of Pacific Insects,” published by the
Department of Entomology, Bernice P. Bishop Museum, Honolulu.
Pac. Discovery, 15(5):31. Published August 28.
261. Live Buprestis aurulenta in boards of a house built in 1923 (Coleop-
tera: Buprestidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 38(3): 159-161, figs. 1-3. Pub¬
lished September 27.
262. [Book notice]. The Cerambycidae of North America. Parts I— III . By
E. Gorton Linsley. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 38(4): 2 14. Published Decem¬
ber 28.
263. [Book notice]. The Anobiidae of Ohio (Coleoptera). By Richard E.
White. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 38(4):214. Published December 28.
1963
264. [Discovery in books]. The strange lives of familiar insects. By Edwin
Way Teale. Pac. Discovery, 16(1):32. Published January 9.
265. [Recent literature]. Biological characteristics of the mutillid subgenus
Photopsis Blake and their systematic values (Hymenoptera), by Wil¬
liam E. Ferguson; A re visional study of the bees of the genus Perdita
F. Smith, with special reference to the fauna of the Pacific Coast,
(Hymenoptera, Apoidea), Part V, by P. H. Timberlake. Pan-Pac. Ento¬
mol., 39(1): 18. Published March 29.
266. [Book notice]. Revision des hydrocanthares d’Afrique (Coleoptera
Dytiscoidea). By Felix Guignot. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 39(1): 18. Pub¬
lished March 29.
267. [Notice of the death of Gordon Stace Smith]. In Proc. Pac. Coast
Entomol. Soc., 278th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 39(1):59. Published
March 29.
28
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
268. [Notice of the death of Mrs. Ralph Hopping]. In Proc. Pac. Coast
Entomol. Soc., 281st meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 39(1):62. Published
March 29.
269. [Collection of beetles received from Burdette E. White]. In Proc. Pac.
Coast Entomol. Soc., 281st meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 39(1):62.
Published March 29.
270. [Notice of the death of Georg Pronin]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol.
Soc., 282nd meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 39(1):63. Published March 29.
271. Centrodera spurca (LeConte) and two new species resembling it, with
biological and other notes (Coleoptera: Cerambycidae). Proc. Calif.
Acad. Sci., (G Dallas Hanna Anniversary Volume), (4)32(7): 149-218,
figs. 1-28. Published May 20.
1964
272. [Book notice]. A catalogue of the Nearctic Chalcidoidea (Insecta:
Hymenoptera). By Oswald Peck. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 40(1): 10. Pub¬
lished March 30.
273. [Book notice]. Insect pathology. An advanced treatise. Volume 1. Ed¬
ited by Edward A. Steinhaus, with seventeen contributing authors.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 40(1): 12. Published March 30.
274. [Recent literature]. [List of four items from the University of Utah
Biological Series ]. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 40(1):20. Published March 30.
275. [Book notice]. Experiments in genetics with Drosophila. By Monroe
W. Stickberger. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 40(1):32. Published March 30.
276. [Book notice]. A review of the biological control attempts against in¬
sects and weeds in Canada. Commonwealth Agricultural Bureaux,
Farnham Royal, Bucks, England. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 40(1):60. Pub¬
lished March 30.
277. A new species of Agabus from the Death Valley region of California
(Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Coleopt. Bull., 18(3):79-82, figs. 1-6.
278. [Lawrence W. Saylor collection of scarabaeid beetles now in the Cal¬
ifornia Academy of Sciences]. Acad. Newsletter, 299: [3]. Published
late October or early November, (unsigned note).
279. [Acquisition by the California Academy of Sciences of the J. R. Heifer
collection of Buprestidae] . Acad. Newsletter, 301: [5]. January, 1965
issue. Published December 24. (unsigned note).
1965
280. [Recent literature]. The skippers of the genus Hesperia in western
North America with special reference to California (Lepidoptera: Hes-
periidae). By C. Don MacNeill. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 41(1):29. Published
March 4.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
29
281. [Recent literature]. The ecology and morphology of Thinobius frizzelli
Hatch, an intertidal beetle, by Trevor Kincaid; The staphylinid genera
Pontomalota and Thinusa, by Trevor Kincaid. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
41(1):53. Published March 4.
282. Haliplus subguttatus Roberts from Washington and Oregon (Coleop-
tera: Haliplidae). Wasmann J. Biol., 22(2):323-329, figs. 1-4. Published
May 24.
283. [Recent literature]. The Cerambycidae of North America. Part IV,
Taxonomy and classification of the subfamily Cerambycinae, tribes
Elaphidionini through Rhinotragini; Part V, Taxonomy and classifi¬
cation of the subfamily Cerambycinae, tribes Callichromini through
Ancylocerini; by E. Gorton Linsley. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 41(2): 113.
Published June 11.
1966
284. [Recent literature]. The ground-beetles (Carabidae, excl. Cicindelinae)
of Canada and Alaska. Part 3. By Carl H. Lindroth. Pan-Pac. Ento¬
mol., 42(1): 24. Published March 3.
285. (by John L. Carr and H. B. Leech). The rediscovery of Agabus audeni
Wallis, and a note on Agabus coxalis Sharp (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae).
Can. Entomol., 98(5): 544-550, figs. 1-18. Published in May.
286. Ochthebius bruesi Darlington in California and Utah (Coleoptera: Hy-
draenidae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 42(2): 137-139, figs. 1-3. Published
June 14.
287. [Book notice]. Index Litteraturae Entomologicae, Series II: Die Welt-
Literatur fiber die gesamte Entomologie von 1864 bis 1900. Band I,
A-E. Von Walter Derksen und Ursula Scheiding. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
42(2): 155. Published June 14.
288. Descriptions of the larva and pupa of Necydalis cavipennis LeConte
and the pupa of Ortholeptura insignis Fall (Coleoptera: Cerambyci¬
dae). Occas. Pap. Calif. Acad. Sci., 57, 13 pp., figs. 1-13. Published
June 30.
289. The pedalis- group of Hygrotus, with descriptions of two new species
and a key to the species (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Proc. Calif. Acad.
Sci., (4)3 3(1 5): 48 1-498, figs. 1-14, pi. 1 (colored). Published July 8.
290. A note on two editions of S. S. Haldeman’s descriptions of insects in
the Stansbury Report (Lepidoptera, Hymenoptera, Hemiptera (s. lat.),
Orthoptera, Coleoptera). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 42(3): 208-2 10, figs. 1-2.
Published August 30.
291. A British Columbia record for Xenos peckii Kirby. J. Entomol. Soc.
B.C., 63:40. Published December 1.
292. Were they hydrophilids? (Coleoptera). Coleopt. Bull., 20(4): 128. Pub¬
lished December 22.
30
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
1967
293. Georg Pronin (1898-1962). J. Lepid. Soc., 21(l):74-76. Published Feb¬
ruary 21.
294. The cicadellid Parabolocratus viridis attended by the ant Formica ( F .)
altipetens (Homoptera: Cicadellidae and Hymenoptera: Formicidae).
Wasmann J. Biol., 24(2):279-280. Published in March.
295. Historical material. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 306th meeting.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 43(1): 93. Published April 11.
296. [Book review]. The beetles of the Pacific Northwest. Part IV: Macro-
dactyles, Palpicornes, and Heteromera. By Melville H. Hatch and col¬
laborators. Quart. Rev. Biol., 42(1):70. Issue for March.
297. (by H. B. Leech and Perez Simmons). Roy Seymour Wagner, 9 No¬
vember 1895-15 October 1958. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 43(2): 134-136, 1
fig. Published July 14.
298. (by H. B. Leech and G. A. Sugden). Solenobia triquetrella Hiibner,
a flightless parthenogenetic moth, in British Columbia (Lepidoptera:
Psychidae). J. Entomol. Soc. B.C., 64:56-59, figs. 1-6. Published Au¬
gust 1.
1968
299. [Recent literature]. Facsimile editions of standard works. — A history
of entomology, by E. O. Essig; A textbook of arthropod anatomy, by
R. E. Snodgrass; Handbook of the mosquitoes of North America, by
Robert Mathewson. Pan-Pac. Entomol. (1967), 43(4): 273. Published
February 28.
300. [Recent literature]. A classification of the large carpenter bees (Xylo-
copini) (Hymenoptera: Apoidea). By Paul D. Hurd, Jr., and J. S.
Moure, C.M.F. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 44(1): 68. Published June 28.
301. [Announcement of the death of Father Edward F. Guedet, and the
illness of Dr. F. X. Williams]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc.,
313th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 44(1):80. Published June 28.
302. Distribution of the cerambycid beetle Er gates pauper Linsley. In Proc.
Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 315th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
44(1): 86. Published June 28.
303. [Recent literature]. Comparative behaviour of bees of Onagraceae. —
I. Oenothera bees of the Colorado Desert, II. Oenothera bees of the
Great Basin, III. Oenothera bees of the Mohave Desert, California, by
E. G. Linsley, J. W. MacSwain, and P. H. Raven; The genus Baris
Germar in California (Coleoptera, Curculionidae) , by Edward E. Gil¬
bert. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 44(1):86. Published June 28.
304. John Wagener Green — September 18 [sic!], 1889-June 20, 1968. The
Casual Crier [Calif. Acad. Sci., Mimeograph], 2(1):2. Published July 1.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
31
1969
305. John Wagener Green (September 25, 1889-June 20, 1968). Entomol.
News, 79(10): 284.
1970
306. Copelatus glyphicus (Say) and Suphisellus bicolor (Say), water beetles
new to California and presumably introduced (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae
and Noteridae). Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)37(6): 237-247, figs. 1-8.
Published March 6.
307. [Slides and comments on a common lampyrid beetle und of Mr. Jack
Balfour-Browne]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 324th meeting.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 46(1): 67. Published March 19.
308. [Gift of photographs to historical files by Mrs. Roxana Ferris]. In Proc.
Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 329th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
46(1):71. Published March 19.
309. Gnophaela latipennis trapped by flowers of milkweed (Lepidoptera:
Pericopidae). In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 329th meeting. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 46(l):71-72. Published March 19.
310. [Two recently published books]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc.,
330th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 46(l):73-74. Published March 19.
311. Grooved entomology. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 331st meet¬
ing. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 46(l):76-77. Published March 19.
312. [Acquisition to historical files of over 1,000 glass lantern slides from
Stanford University]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 331st meet¬
ing. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 46(1): 78. Published March 19.
313. The aegeriid Ramosia fragariae in a flight trap, and the interpretation
thereof. J. Lepid. Soc., 24(3): 189. Published August 3.
314. Vasco M. Tanner — A lifetime with beetles. Great Basin Natur.,
30(4): 2 13-2 15. Published December 31.
1971
315. Flight from the surface of water and skimming: beetles, with comments
on bugs and flies (Coleoptera, Heteroptera, Diptera). Wasmann J.
Biol., (1970), 28(2): 237-244. Published in January.
316. [Two new publications]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 333rd
meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(1):72. Published April 13.
317. [Valuable material received for the society archives]. In Proc. Pac.
Coast Entomol. Soc., 337th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(1):78.
Published April 13.
318. [Book review]. The Kodiak Island refugium, its geology, flora, fauna
and history. Thor N. V. Karlstrom and George E. Ball, editors. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 47(1):83. Published April 13.
32
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
319. [Book review]. Directory of Coleoptera collections of North America
(Canada through Panama). Written, compiled and edited by Ross H.
Arnett, Jr., and G. Allan Samuelson, assisted by Gerard E. Flory,
Edward C. Mignot, C. Dietrich Schaaf, Eric H. Smith. Pan-Pac. Ento-
mol., 47(2): 100. Published June 8.
320. [Book notice]. Gall midges of economic importance. Vol. VIII. Gall
midges — Miscellaneous. By W. Nijveldt. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(2): 116.
Published June 8.
321. [Book notices]. [Four facsimile printings of standard works]. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 47(2): 122. Published June 8.
322. [Book review]. An English-Classical dictionary for the use of taxon¬
omists. Compiled by Robert S. Woods. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(2): 126.
Published June 8.
323. [Book review]. The comparative anatomy of the male genital tube in
Coleoptera. 1969 reprint without change. By David Sharp and Fred¬
erick A. G. Muir. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(2): 145. Published June 8.
324. [Discovery in books]. The natural history of Mendocino. By Jacques
R. Heifer. Pac. Discovery, 24(4):32. Published June 17.
325. (by H. B. Leech and Ian Moore). Nearctic records of flights of Cafius
and some related beetles at the seashore (Coleoptera: Staphylinidae
and Hydrophilidae). Wasmann J. Biol., 29(l):65-70, fig. 1. Published
June 23.
326. [Book notice]. Ecology, behavior, and adult anatomy of the albida
group of the genus Epicauta (Coleoptera, Meloidae). By Richard B.
Selander and Juan M. Mathieu. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(3): 183. Pub¬
lished September 21.
327. [Book notice]. The natural history of Mendocino. By Jacques R. Hei¬
fer. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(3):214. Published September 21.
328. [Book notice]. The new field book of freshwater life. By Elsie B. Klots,
drawings by Suzan Noquchi [sic!] Swain. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
47(3): 2 19. Published September 21.
329. [Book notice]. Introduction to zoology. By Theodore H. Savory. Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 47(3):242. Published September 21.
330. [Book notice]. The pocket encyclopaedia of plant galls in colour. By
Arnold Darlington. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(3):243. Published Septem¬
ber 21.
331. [Book notice]. Beetles. Written and illustrated by Wilfrid S. Bronson.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(3):243. Published September 21.
332. [Book notice]. The bionomics of blister beetles of the genus Meloe
and a classification of the New World species. By John D. Pinto and
Richard B. Selander. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 47(3): 243. Published Septem¬
ber 21.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
33
333. [Book notice]. Practical entomology. A guide to collecting butterflies,
moths and other insects. By R. E. L. Ford. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
47(3):244. Published September 21.
334. [Book notice]. The distributional history of the biota of the Southern
Appalachians. Part I: Invertebrates. Edited by Perry C. Holt, with the
assistance of Richard L. Hoffman and C. Willard Hart, Jr. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 47(3):244. Published September 21.
1972
335. F. C. Hottes, 1899-1970. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 338th
meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 48(1):67. Published May 5.
336. Death of E. R. Leach. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 341st meet¬
ing. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 48(1): 74. Published May 5.
337. On the photocopying of entomological literature. In Proc. Pac. Coast
Entomol. Soc., 342nd meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 48(1):76. Published
May 5.
338. The Australian sod fly Altermetoponia rubriceps (Macquart) in Marin
County, California. In Proc. Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 342nd meeting.
Pan-Pac. Entomol., 48(1):76— 77. Published May 5.
339. [Items received for historical files in 1971]. In Proc. Pac. Coast Ento¬
mol. Soc., 343rd meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 48(1):78.
1973
340. [Observations based on the Society’s biographical forms]. In Koc.
Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 349th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
49(1): 92.
341. [Book review]. Monografia da tribo Ibidionini (Coleoptera, Ceramby-
cinae). Partes I- VI. By Ubirajara R. Martins. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
49(2): 101. Published July 11.
342. (by Marius S. Wasbauer and H. B. Leech). A biological note on two
species of Ageniella from California (Hymenoptera: Pompilidae). Pan-
Pac. Entomol., 49(2): 182-183. Published July 11.
343. [Book review]. American entomologists. By Arnold Mallis. Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 49(3):28 1-282. Published October 19.
344. [Book review]. Monographic der Familie Platypodidae Coleoptera. By
Karl E. Schedl. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 49(3): 282-283. Published Octo¬
ber 19.
1975
345. [Book notice]. The biology of Tribolium with special emphasis on ge¬
netic aspects. By A. Sokoloff. Pan-Pac. Entomol., 51(1):48. Published
June 12.
34
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
1977
346. [Apparent resistance of some tenebrionid beetles to cyanide]. In Proc.
Pac. Coast Entomol. Soc., 375th meeting. Pan-Pac. Entomol.,
53(1):77.
Appendix B
New Taxa of Coleoptera Proposed by Hugh B. Leech
ADEPHAGA
Family Haliplidae
Haliplus leechi subsp. carteri, 1949, Can. Entomol., (1948), 80( 1—12): 90 .
T-D: Prince Rupert, British Columbia, Canada, July 8, 1944 (N. Carter).
Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5777.
Haliplus stagninus, 1949, Can. Entomol., (1948), 80(1- 12): 89-90, fig. 1.
T-D: Kamloops, British Columbia, Canada, August 1, 1937 (Geo. J. Spen¬
cer). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5776.
Family Dytiscidae
Agabus antennatus , 1939, Can. Entomol., 71(10):217— 218. Remarks: nom.
nov. for Agabus clavatus LeConte, 1859 ( nec clavatus Latreille, 1804).
Agabus browni, 1938, Can. Entomol., 70(6): 126-127, fig. 4. T-D: Churchill,
Manitoba, Canada, July 1, 1937 (W. J. Brown). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent.
Type No. 4356.
Agabus colymbus, 1938, Can. Entomol., 70(6): 125-126, figs. 1-2. T-D:
Churchill, Manitoba, Canada, June 23, 1937 (W. J. Brown). Can. Nat.
Collect., Ent. Type No. 4357.
Agabus hoppingi, 1942, Can. Entomol., 74(7): 135, fig. 9. T-D: Gray Mead¬
ow, Lot 13, Tulare County, California, U.S.A., July 3, 1913 (Ralph Hop¬
ping). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5354.
Agabus hudsonicus, 1938, Can. Entomol., 70(6): 123-124, fig. 3. T-D:
Churchill, Manitoba, Canada, July 7, 1937 (W. J. Brown). Can. Nat. Col¬
lect., Ent. Type No. 4355.
Agabus lutosus subsp. mimus, 1942, Can. Entomol., 74(7): 132-133. T-D:
Library lily pond on the campus of the University of British Columbia,
Vancouver, British Columbia, Canada, January 28, 1931 (Hugh B.
Leech). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5356.
Agabus nectris, 1942, Can. Entomol., 74(7): 133-135, fig. 5. T-D: a weedy
ditch, Lumby, British Columbia, Canada, September 20, 1939 (Hugh B.
Leech). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5355.
Agabus pandurus, 1942, Can. Entomol., 74(7): 128-129, fig. 1. T-D: Eel Riv-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
35
er, Pepperwood, Humboldt County, California, U.S.A., May 16, 1938
(Hugh B. Leech). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 5316.
Agabus pisobius, 1950, Wasmann Collect., (1949), 7(6):246-248, fig. 4. T-D:
ephemeral pond at an elevation of 2,000 feet, Creston, British Columbia,
Canada, March 18, 1947 (Gordon Stace Smith). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent.
Type No. 6153.
Agabus rumppi, 1964, Coleopt. Bull., 18(3):79— 80, 82, figs. 1-6. T-D: 2.7
miles east of Death Valley Junction, elevation 2,200 feet, Inyo County,
California, U.S.A., May 18, 1958 (Norman L. Rumpp). Calif. Acad. Sci.,
Ent. Type No. 8815.
Agabus solus, 1950, Wasmann Collect., (1949), 7(6):248-250, fig. 2. T-D:
latitude 61°58'N, longitude 141°03'W, elevation 3,200 feet, a pond near
Beaver Creek, Alaska, U.S.A., August 27, 1944 (Goef B. Leech). Calif.
Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 6155.
Agabus vancouverensis, 1937, Can. Entomol., 69(7): 146-148, figs. 1-3. T-D:
Hollyburn Ridge, 3,000 feet, Vancouver, British Columbia, Canada, June
28, 1931 (Hugh B. Leech). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 4218.
Agabus vandykei, 1942, Can. Entomol., 74(7): 129-130. T-D: Yosemite, Cal¬
ifornia, U.S.A., August, 1935 (Edward S. Ross). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent.
Type No. 5317.
Agabus velox, 1939, Can. Entomol., 7 1 ( 1 0) : 2 1 9—220 , figs. A-C. T-D: Chur¬
chill, Manitoba, Canada, August 18, 1937 (W. J. Brown). Can. Nat. Col¬
lect., Ent. Type No. 4545.
Bidessus leachi, 1948, Proc. Entomol. Soc. B.C., (1947), 44:11-12, figs. 1,
3. T-D: Mendocino County, California, U.S.A., May 29, 1922 (E. R.
Leach). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 5837.
Bidessus youngi, 1948, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)24(11): 392-393, fig. 12.
T-D: lagoon, twenty miles north of Comondu, Baja California, Mexico,
July 23, 1938 (A. E. Michelbacher and Edward S. Ross). Calif. Acad.
Sci., Ent. Type No. 5463.
Deronectes dolerosus, 1945, Can. Entomol., 77(6): 109-1 10, fig. 4A-B. T-D:
Coalinga, California, U.S.A., March 5, 1937 (Hugh B. Leech). Calif.
Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 5455.
Deronectes spenceri, 1945, Can. Entomol., 77(6): 105-106, fig. 2A-C. T-D:
13 Mile Lake, Dog Creek Road, northwest of Clinton, British Columbia,
Canada, October 11, 1943 (Hugh B. Leech and Cecil V. G. Morgan). Can.
Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5636.
Deronectes titulus, 1945, Can. Entomol., 77(6): 106-108, fig. 3A-B. T-D:
Green Valley, Brewster County, Texas, U.S.A., July, 1926 (J. Wagener
Green). U.S. Nat. Mus., Ent. Type No. 76878.
Hydroporus bidessoides, 1941, Pan-Pac. Entomol., 17(3): 130-132, figs. 7-9.
T-D: Caspar, Mendocino County, California, U.S. A., December 16, 1939
(Jacques R. Heifer). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 4978.
36
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hydroporus laetus, 1949, Can. Entomol., (1948), 80(1- 12): 90-92, figs. 2,
10-11. T-D: stream adjacent to Lake Hope, Vinton County, Ohio,
U.S.A., August 30, 1945 (W. C. Stehr). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No.
5940.
Hydroporus rossi, 1941, Pan-Pac. Entomol., 17(3): 129-130, figs. 1-3. T-D:
Pigmy Forest, Fort Bragg, Mendocino County, California, U.S.A., May
5, 1938 (Edward S. Ross). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 4976.
Hydroporus tademus, 1950, Wasmann Collect., (1949), 7(6):243-245. T-D:
Vernon, British Columbia, Canada, September 11, 1937 (Hugh B. Leech).
Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 6151.
Hygrotus diversipes, 1966, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)33(15):482-483, 485-
486, figs. 2, 5-6. T-D: 8.5 miles northwest of Midwest, Dugout Creek,
Natrona County, Wyoming, U.S.A., July 27, 1964 (Hugh B. Leech). Calif.
Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 9048.
Hygrotus fontinalis, 1966, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)33(1 5): 490-495, figs.
4, 13. T-D: Travertine Hot Springs, 2 miles southeast of Bridgeport, al¬
titude 6,700 feet, Mono County, California, U.S.A., August 11, 1962
(Hugh B. Leech). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 9049.
Laccophilus shermani, 1944, Entomol. News, 55(l):4-6. T-D: Bear Canyon,
Santa Catalina Mountains, Arizona, U.S.A., January 2, 1938 (Edwin C.
Van Dyke). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5553.
Laccornis pacificus, 1940, Can. Entomol., 72(6): 123, 125, figs. 4, 6. T-D:
stream, Salmon Arm, British Columbia, Canada, May 24, 1937 (Hugh B.
Leech). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5053.
Matus ovatus, 1941, Can. Entomol., 73(5):79, 81-82, figs. 1-2, 6-7. T-D:
Lexington, Massachusetts, U.S.A., May 1, 1926 (Darlington; John
George Gehring Collection). Mus. Comp. Zool., Ent. Type No. 25257.
Matus ovatus subsp. blatchleyi, 1941, Can. Entomol., 73(5):82. T-D: Brigh¬
ton, Okeechobee, Florida, U.S.A., June 16, 1929 (Darlington; P. J. Dar¬
lington Collection). Mus. Comp. Zool., Ent. Type No. 25258.
Family Gyrinidae
Gyrinus hoppingi, 1938, Can. Entomol., 70(3): 59-60. T-D: Tributary to
Vance Creek, Trinity Valley, British Columbia, Canada, September 17,
1937 (Hugh B. Leech). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 4302.
POLYPHAGA: HYDROPHILOIDEA
Family Hydrophilidae
Anacaena sternalis, 1948, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)24(11): 447-448. T-D:
San Jose del Cabo, Baja California, Mexico (from collection of Charles
W. Leng). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 8136.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
37
Berosus blechrus, 1948, Wasmann Collect., 7(2):38-40. T-D: Fort Davis,
Texas, U.S.A., March 29, 1946 (J. Wagener Green). Calif. Acad. Sci.,
Ent. Type No. 5911.
Berosus ( Berosus ) dolerosus, 1948, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)24(1 1):433—
434, fig. 13. T-D: in pool, Rosario, Baja California, Mexico, June 17, 1938
(A. E. Michelbacher and Edward S. Ross). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type
No. 5465.
Cymbiodyta dorsalis subsp. columbiana, 1948, Wasmann Collect., 7(2):46.
T-D: muddy spring alongside the Trans- Canada Highway, about a mile
west of the side road to Walhachin, British Columbia, Canada, Sep¬
tember 11, 1945 (Hugh B. Leech). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No.
5757.
Cymbiodyta pacifica, 1948, Wasmann Collect., 7(2):43-45. T-D: Langley,
British Columbia, Canada, February 1, 1935 (Kenneth Graham). Can.
Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5756.
Enochrus hamiltoni subsp. pyretus, 1950, Wasmann Collect., (1949),
7(6):255. T-D: Bad Water, Death Valley, Inyo County, California,
U.S.A., April 14, 1938 (John J. du Bois). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type
No. 6173.
Enochrus hamiltoni subsp. pacificus, 1950, Wasmann Collect., (1949),
7(6):253-255. T-D: salt water lagoon at Huntington Beach, Orange Coun¬
ty, California, U.S.A., July 19, 1943 (George P. Mackenzie). Calif. Acad.
Sci., Ent. Type No. 6159.
Enochrus horni, 1950, Wasmann Collect., (1949), 7(6):250-252, fig. 6B. T-D:
Norton’s Pond, Salmon Arm, British Columbia, Canada, September 5,
1937 (Hugh B. Leech). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 6157.
Enochrus ( Methydrus ) rossi, 1948, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)24(11): 451-
452. T-D: Coyote Cove, Concepcion Bay, Baja California, Mexico, July
24, 1938 (A. E. Michelbacher and Edward S. Ross). Calif. Acad. Sci.,
Ent. Type No. 5467.
Hydrochus ouelleti, 1948, Wasmann Collect., 7(2):36-38. T-D: St. Remi,
Quebec, Canada, May 20, 1920 (J. Ouellet). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type
No. 5909.
Hydrochus setosus, 1948, Wasmann Collect., 7(2):35-36. T-D: Chicago, Il¬
linois, U.S.A., April 17, 1934 (D. Lowrie). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type
No. 5908.
Tropisternus ( Pristoternus ) orvus, 1946, Can. Entomol., (1945), 77(10): 183—
184. T-D: Mendocino, California, U.S.A., August 16, 1940 (Jacques R.
Heifer). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 5635.
Tropisternus ( Pristoternus ) paredesi, 1943, Rev. Soc. Mex. Hist. Nat., 4(1-
2): 17-20, figs. 1, 3, 5. T-D: en un charco en la cuenca del rfo, altura de
600 a 900 metros (2,000 a 3,000 pies), Sierra de Zapotan, Nayarit, Mexico,
38
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
noviembre de 1942 (Eugenio Paredes). Coleccion Nacional de Insectos
Mexicanos de la Escuela N. de Ciencias Biologicas, Instituto Politecnico,
Mexico, D. F., Mexico.
POLYPHAGA: STAPHYLINOIDEA
Family Staphylinidae
Coprophilus sexualis, 1939, Can. Entomol., 71(12):259-261, fig. 1. T-D:
flying in University woodlot, Vancouver, British Columbia, Canada,
March 20, 1939 (Anges M. Gwyn). Can. Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No.
4884.
Dacnochilus fresnoensis , 1939, Can. Entomol., 71(12):261, fig. 3. T-D: Fres¬
no, California, U.S.A., June 5, 1931 (R. S. Wagner). Calif. Acad. Sci.,
Ent. Type No. 4930.
Trigonodemus fasciatus, 1939, Can. Entomol., 71(12):258-259. T-D: Van¬
couver, British Columbia, Canada, March 26, 1933 (Hugh B. Leech). Can.
Nat. Collect., Ent. Type No. 4883.
POLYPHAGA: DASCILLOIDEA
Family Helodidae
Sarabandus, 1955, Pan-Pac. Entomol., 31(1):34. T-S: Cyphon robustus
LeConte, 1875, by orig. des.
POLYPHAGA: CHRYSOMELOIDEA
Family Cerambycidae
Centrodera autumnata, 1963, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)32(7): 173-178, figs.
8-11, 13, 15-16, 18. T-D: Mill Valley, Marin County, California, U.S.A.,
August 16, 1949 (Hugh B. Leech). Calif. Acad. Sci., Ent. Type No. 8526.
Centrodera dayi, 1963, Proc. Calif. Acad. Sci., (4)32(7): 178-181, 183-184,
figs. 4, 7, 9-11, 13-15, 17. T-D: Scott River at Klamath River, Siskiyou
County, California, U.S.A., August 1, 1949 (W. C. Day). Calif. Acad.
Sci., Ent. Type No. 8527.
Appendix C
Some Taxa Named in Honor of Hugh B. Leech
CLASS ARACHNIDA
Order Araneae
Family Gnaphosidae
Cesonia lee chi Platnick and Shadab, 1980 (Mexico).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
39
CLASS INSECTA
Order Diplura
Family Japygidae
Evalljapyx leechi Smith, 1960 (California).
Order Ephemeroptera
Family Baetidae
Baetis leechi Day, 1954 (California).
Order Hemiptera
Family Reduviidae
Stenolemopsis leechi Wygodzinsky, 1966 (Mexico).
Order Coleoptera
Family Bostrychidae
Dendrobiella leechi Vrydagh, 1960 (Mexico).
Micrapate leechi Vrydagh, 1960 (Mexico).
Family Buprestidae
Anthaxia leechi Cobos, 1958 (California).
Chrysobothris leechi Barr, 1974 (California).
Conognatha leechi Cobos, 1959 (Chile).
Family Cantharidae
Chauliognathus limbicollis subsp. leechi Wittmer, 1967 (Mexico).
Dis codon leechi Wittmer, 1959 (Ecuador).
Malthodes leechi Fender, 1951 (California).
Troglomethes leechi Wittmer, 1970 (California).
Tylocerus leechi Wittmer, 1953 (Philippine Islands).
Family Carabidae
Pericompsus leechi Erwin, 1974 (Mexico).
Trechisibus leechi Ueno, 1972 (Peru).
Family Cerambycidae
Callidium leechi Linsley and Chemsak, 1963 (California).
Canonura leechi Dillon, 1956 (Arizona).
Derobrachus leechi Chemsak and Linsley, 1977 (California).
Juninia leechi Lane, 1966 (Peru).
Neocompsa leechi Martins, 1970 (Peru).
Family Chrysomelidae
Euryscopa leechi Monros, 1952 (Texas).
Phyllobrotica leechi Blake, 1956 (California).
Timarcha cerdo subsp. leechi Jolivet, 1948 (Oregon).
Family Coccinellidae
Hyperaspis leechi Miyatake, 1961 (China).
Toxotoma leechi Gordon, 1975 (Peru).
40
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Family Curculionidae
Alcidodes lee chi Haaf, 1962 (Philippine Islands).
Cryptolepidus leechi Ting, 1940 (California).
Grypidius leechi Cawthra, 1957 (Colorado).
Listronotus leechi Sleeper, 1955 (British Columbia).
Family Dytiscidae
Hydaticus leechi Sato, 1961 (Borneo).
Family Eucnemidae
Fornax leechi Cobos, 1965 (Chile).
Family Gyrinidae
Macrogyrus leechi Mouchamps, 1951 (Irian Barat).
Family Haliplidae
Haliplus leechi Wallis, 1933 (British Columbia).
Family Hydraenidae
Ochthebius leechi Wood and Perkins, 1978 (California).
Family Hydrophilidae
Chaetarthria leechi Miller, 1974 (California).
Cymbiodyta leechi Miller, 1964 (Washington).
Elophorus leechi McCorkle, 1965 (British Columbia).
Epimetopus leechi Rocha, 1969 (Brazil).
Hydrochar a leechi Smetana, 1980 (New Mexico).
Paracymus leechi Wooldridge, 1969 (Mexico).
Family Lycidae
Plateros leechi Nakane, 1971 (Formosa).
Xylobanus leechi Nakane, 1971 (Formosa).
Family Malachiidae
Attalus leechi Marshall, 1957 (Arizona).
Family Monommidae
Hyporhagus leechi Freude, 1955 (Mexico).
Family Nitidulidae
Thalycra leechi Howden, 1961 (British Columbia).
Family Scarab aeidae
Acoma leechi Cazier, 1953 (Mexico).
Glaphyrocanthon viridis subsp. leechi Halffter and Martinez, 1964 (Mex¬
ico).
Isonychus leechi Frey, 1969 (Colombia).
Liogenys leechi Frey, 1967 (Peru).
Onthophagus leechi Frey, 1959 (New Zealand).
Family Staphylinidae
Acrolocha leechi Hatch, 1957 (British Columbia).
Acylophorus leechi Smetana, 1971 (Missouri).
Ecbletus leechi Moore, 1965 (California).
Olophrum leechi Hatch, 1957 (British Columbia).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
41
Philonthus leechensis Hatch, 1957 (British Columbia).
Quedius leechi Smetana, 1971 (Arizona).
Stenus leechi Puthz, 1974 (Mexico).
Family Stylopidae
Stylops leechi Bohart, 1941 (British Columbia).
Family Tenebrionidae
Edrotes leechi Doyen, 1968 (Utah).
Eleodes leechi Tanner, 1961 (Utah-Colorado state line).
Gyriosomus leechi Kulzer, 1954 (Chile).
Heliofugus leechi Freude, 1960 (Chile).
Hemasodes leechi Freude, 1967 (Brazil).
Nyctopetus leechi Freude, 1959 (Chile).
Philorea leechi Kulzer, 1956 (Peru).
Family Throscidae
Throscus leechi Cobos, 1967 (Australia).
Order Trichoptera
Family Lepidostomatidae
Lepidostoma leechi Denning, 1962 (Mexico).
Order Diptera
Family Asilidae
Metapogon leechi Wilcox, 1964 (Mexico).
Family Bombyliidae
Eclimus leechi Hall, 1954 (California).
Family Ceratopogonidae
Culicoides leechi Wirth, 1977 (California).
Family Platypezidae
Agathomyia leechi Kessel, 1961 (California).
Family Scatopsidae
Colobostema leechi Cook, 1978 (California).
Family Scenopinidae
Pseudatrichia leechi Kelsey, 1969 (California).
Family Tabanidae
Esenbeckia leechi Philip, 1978 (Mexico).
Family Tachinidae
Erycia leechi Curran, 1932 (British Columbia).
Family Tipulidae
Gonomyia leechi Alexander, 1964 (California).
Tipula leechi Alexander, 1938 (British Columbia).
Order Hymenoptera
Family Andrenidae
Perdita leechi Timberlake, 1968 (Mexico).
42
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Family Braconidae
Ecphylus leechi Marsh, 1965 (California).
Microgaster leechi Walley, 1935 (British Columbia).
Family Ichneumonidae
Cubocephalus molaris subsp. leechi Townes and Gupta, 1962 (British
Columbia).
Family Pompilidae
Dipogon leechi Wasbauer, 1960 (California).
Family Tenthredinidae
Pristophora leechi Wong and Ross, 1960 (British Columbia).
Family Tiphiidae
Krombeinia leechi Allen and Krombein, 1964 (Mexico).
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 43-51
RETICULATE EVOLUTION IN COLYMBETES
(COLEOPTERA: DYTISCIDAE)
James R. Zimmerman
Dept, of Biology, New Mexico State University, Las Cruces 88003
An unusual situation was discovered in a recent revision of the Colym-
betes of North America (Zimmerman, in press). Species problems in the
genus proved to be particularly vexing and unusual, and the relationship
between 2 western species is most intriguing and seems worthy of reporting
separately. This issue of this journal which is dedicated to Hugh Leech who
provided much of the material for the study of these two species is a par¬
ticularly appropriate time and place to present this interesting relationship.
Colymbetes species are some of the larger and more derived members of
the subfamily Colymbetinae (Sharp 1882, Balfour-Browne 1950). The North
American species are easy to recognize because of their size (up to 20 mm)
and the transverse grooves on the elytra (Figures 10, 13). There are 7 species
in North America and about 13 in Eurasia. Three are found in both hemi¬
spheres. It is a holarctic group with no representatives south of North Africa
and the Arabian Peninsula.
The North American species can be separated into 3 groups. Three
species, dolobratus Paykull, exaratus Leconte (not of authors), and sculp-
tilis Harris readily fall into one group and dahuricus Aube and paykulli
Erichson fall into another. The 2 species of this report, densus Leconte
(=exaratus of authors) and strigatus Leconte occupy an intermediate po¬
sition to those two groups. The separation is based mainly on the structure
of the male pro- and mesotarsi, but there are other characters which support
the groupings.
Geographical Distribution
C. strigatus and densus are found from southern California to southern
Alaska. Each is composed of 2 geographical races (Fig. 1). C. 5. strigatus
extends from the vicinity of San Diego to near San Francisco. It appears to
be mainly confined to inland localities with the exception of old records
from near San Diego and Los Angeles. It occurs in both mountainous re¬
gions and comparatively low-lying areas in the Central Valley. Nowhere is
it common.
C. 5. crotchi Sharp, the northern race of strigatus, is found from Mon¬
terey County to Humboldt County in a narrow band hardly more than 50
44
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
miles inland. It can be found in estuarine habitats along the coast and in
pools in the low coast ranges nearby.
Intergrades between the two races of strigatus are common in the area
surrounding San Francisco Bay. They are easy to detect because of the
marked differences (for the genus, that is) between the races. Actually, the
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
45
Table 1. Comparison (mm) of 8 mensural characters in Colymbetes strigatus and densus.
Subspecies
influences of crotchi on strigatus can be found on numerous specimens
which occur some distance from the zone of intergradation. This influence
shows not only in the male tarsi, but also in mensural characters (Table 1).
C. d. densus is the most widely distributed of the 4 races of these 2
species. Its range is from southern Alaska to Oregon and inland to Alberta
and Wyoming. It intergrades with d. inaequalis Horn in southeastern Ore¬
gon and Siskiyou County, California.
The known distribution of d. inaequalis is limited to 2 separated areas-
one in the northern Sierra Nevadas including Mt. Lassen, and the other in
Humboldt County on the coastal lowlands and at a few sites slightly more
inland. Specimens from the two areas are quite similar and do not appear
to merit sub specific separation. The gap between them may be due more to
lack of collecting than any real discontinuity in distribution. It is evident,
however, that two contrasting habitats are used by the two populations.
As far as is known, the two species, strigatus and densus, are allopatric
to one another. The Sierra populations of d. inaequalis and s. strigatus
approach each other and may occur together, but these rather rare taxa
have not yet been taken together. Also, d. inaequalis and s. crotchi are
both found in Humboldt County, but there is still a separating gap of 50 to
75 miles.
Species Limits and Anatomical Relationships
The unusual feature of these 2 species is that strigatus crotchi bears a
closer anatomical relationship in most characters to densus inaequalis than
to 5. strigatus. If it were not for the unmistakable series of intergrades
between s. crotchi and s. strigatus, one would surely conclude that s.
crotchi was an allopatric conspecific relative of d. inaequalis.
46
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
\
Figs. 2-5. Lateral views of aedeagi of subspecies of Colymbetes densus and C. strigatus.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
47
Figs. 6-9. Protarsi of 6) C. s. strigatus from Fresno Co., 7) C. 5. strigatus from Yolo Co.,
8) C. s. strigatus from San Diego Co., and 9) C. s. crotchi from Marin Co.
48
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 10-13. Fig. 10. SEM of discal area of the elytra of female of C. d. inaequalis from
Humboldt Co. Fig. 11. SEM of female pronotum of C. d. inaequalis from Humboldt Co. Fig.
12. SEM of pronotum of female of C. s. crotchi from Marin Co. Fig. 13. SEM of discal area
of the elytra of male of C. sculptilis.
The relationship is apparent through their size, shape, sexual characters,
and in habitat utilization. Table 1 is a comparison of 8 mensural characters
including the length of the aedeagus. In all of those characters 5. crotchi is
closer to d. inaequalis than to the two samples of s', strigatus. Configuration
as well as overall length of the aedeagus is more similar also (Figs. 2-5).
The most striking character is the nature of the male pro- and mesotarsi.
There are 2 distinct types of tarsal adornment in Colymbetes as indicated
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
49
Fig. 14. Diagram of reconstruction of probable isolation and subsequent joining of popu¬
lations leading to present situation in C. densus and C. strigatus.
in the introduction. The most common and probably the ancestral type is
the condition with enlarged flattened “palettes” — rounded adhesive discs
as seen in Figure 8. This is the type found in the southernmost populations
of 5. strigatus. Populations to the north show a transition in the basal row
of palettes. The size of the terminal disc decreases and tends to become a
double row of 25 or more (Figs. 6, 7). This condition is what Leech rec¬
ognized in his key to the California species (Leech and Chandler 1956).
The other type of adhesive structures and probably the derived condition,
is that found in the dahuricus group. The adhesive structures take the form
of over a hundred or more stout setae with slightly expanded tips.
There is an intermediate condition, however, and it is found in both races
of densus and in strigatus crotchi. The basal group of adhesive structures
in these are setae, but the distal ones are palettes (Fig. 9). The cline in size
and number of palettes in s. strigatus appears then to be introgression of
the genes for the setal form from s. crotchi.
Other characters which intergrade in strigatus are the shape and length
of the aedeagus, overall size, the amount of secondary mesh on the prono-
tum, and the degree of swelling of the frons next to eye above the antennal
base.
Intergradation in densus is seen primarily in two characteristics, both
sexual. The two races are so similar in other characters that it is quite
difficult to find differences. The aedeagus of d. densus is distinctive in that
it is strongly curved laterally before the apex while that of d. inaequalis is
50
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
only slightly so (Fig. 3,4). Intermediates to these conditions can readily be
recognized with experience. The females of d. inaequalis have the elytra
duller (velvety) than any other North American Colymbetes. This is due to
the widening of the elytral grooves and the strong development of the sur¬
face microreticulation on the interspaces between the grooves (Fig. 13). In
its most extreme form this condition covers the anterior 4/5 or more of the
elytron. The intergrades have variable amounts of the elytron so affected.
The condition is found to some degree in a few females from throughout the
range of d. densus.
Characters which indicate a close affinity between d. inaequalis and 5.
crotchi are seen in the male tarsi, frons swollen above the antennal base,
the pale subsutural line, in the similarity of the size and shape of the ae-
deagus, and the general size and shape of the whole animal. In fact, there
are only 2 characters which permit ready separation, but fortunately these
are ones that are easily evaluated. The smooth pronotum of 5. crotchi in
contrast to the pebbled surface on that of d. inaequalis (Figs. 11, 12) is a
character that can be discerned even in the field with but a hand lens and
serves as an excellent indicator of the presence of mixing or not. The smooth
pronotum is a character unique to 5. crotchi and can be used to separate it
from any other North American Colymbetes.
The second feature is the previously mentioned velvety appearance of the
female elytra in d. inaequalis, but which is not present in s. crotchi. It, of
course, is useful only in comparing females, but in many species of
dytiscids only the male serves in verification of intergradation.
Evolutionary Considerations
The evidence is clear that C. strigatus is composed of two rather different
races. The southern race, strigatus, would readily be placed in the sculptilis
group of species, i.e., the group with only palettes on the male tarsi; but 5.
crotchi is so similar to densus, which has setae (which seem to be a derived
character) as well as palettes, that one would include it with that species if
there were not intergradation between these two.
One has to conclude that crotchi originally was derived from ancestral
densus, separated from that species, and has subsequently come into con¬
tact with strigatus and in the absence of any reproductive barrier merged
with it. The geographical positions of the 4 taxa support this view. The
possible sequence of events is diagrammed in Figure 14.
Originally strigatus and densus were separate species. At this time we
lack enough evidence to show their probable origins, and it is even possible
that densus arose from ancestral strigatus. The reverse seems improbable
because of the greater number of derived characters in densus.
C. densus divided into 2 populations and later the southern one of those
divided again. The first division led to a group which could use not only
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
51
mountainous areas, but also low-lying coastal ponds including the brackish
water in quiet estuaries along the California coast. The second division
resulted in what are now recognized as d. inaequalis in the north and s.
crotchi in the south. C. d. inaequalis occupies both inland and coastal areas
as we see today, but s. crotchi encountered strigatus inland and in the
absence of reproductive barriers interbred with it.
As interpreted here, ancestral strigatus is apparently derived from the
sculptilis group. The origin of the ancestral densus is problematical. Ap¬
parently it has no sister-species in the Old World, because no species has
been reported from there which have both setae and palettes on the male
tarsi. The presence of setae, larger size, and darker pigmentation are char¬
acters which link densus and s. crotchi to dahuricus and paykulli and not
to the more pleisomorphic sculptilis group.
It is possible that ancestral densus, which contained what is now inae¬
qualis and crotchi is a vicariant of ancestral strigatus. If so, it had under¬
gone considerable differientiation as evidenced by the male tarsi, expansion
of the frons, larger size, and aedeagi. The fact that 5. crotchi does not show
any evidence of intergradation with d. inaequalis supports the view that the
former had become specifically distinct from the latter. It is true that there
exists a slight gap between the ranges of the two, but even so some of the
specimens I have examined should show admixture. The gap is due to lack
of collecting and does not reflect the real distribution in my opinion. It would
be much better if sympatry or intergradation could be shown, however.
It still appears 5. crotchi had differentiated into a separate entity and has
now reunited with 5. strigatus with the introgression of characters into the
latter and separation from d. inaequalis. A pattern of hybridization and
reticulate evolution is thus realized.
If intermediates are found between crotchi and inaequalis, then all four
geographical entities will be included in strigatus. With the evidence at
hand, I am hesitant to make a nomenclature change. Those who feel that
one species disappears when a speciation event occurs will differ with my
interpretation of this situation, but as yet I can not accept that view of
species and their evolution.
Literature Cited
Balfour-Browne, F. 1950. British Water Beetles. Vol. 2, Ray Society, London.
Leech, H. B., and H. P. Chandler. 1956. Aquatic Coleoptera, In Usinger’s Aquatic Insects
of California. Univ. California Press, Berkeley and Los Angeles.
Sharp, D. 1882. On aquatic carnivorous Coleoptera or Dytiscidae. Sci. Trans. Roy Dublin
Co., 2:179-1003.
Zimmerman, J. R. 1980. The use of multivariant analysis in the study of species problems
in the sculptilis group of Colymbetes (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae). Coleop. Bull., 34:
213-226.
Zimmerman, J. R. In press. A revision of the Colymbetes of North America. Coleop. Bull.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 52-56
A DESCRIPTION OF THE LARVA OF HELOCOMBUS BIFIDUS
(COLEOPTERA: HYDROPHILIDAE)
Philip D. Perkins and Paul J. Spangler
Department of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution,
Washington, D.C. 20560
Helocombus Horn is one of the few Nearctic genera of aquatic hydrophi-
lids for which the larval stage is not yet described. The species of this
monotypic genus, H. bifidus (LeConte), inhabits eastern North America,
ranging from Labrador south to Florida and west to Minnesota. This wood¬
land pond species is one of the more infrequently collected hydrophilids in
spite of having a large geographical distribution. Larvae described herein
were reared from adults collected by Spangler from a woodland pond in
Seth State Forest, Talbot County, Maryland.
First-instar larva (Figs. 1-7). — Total length 3.6 mm; width of prothoracic
segment 0.5 mm. Color creamy yellow with sclerotized areas light yellowish
brown. Integument of abdomen covered with short, dense hairs.
Head quadrangular (Figs. 2, 3), 0.54 mm wide, 0.38 mm from labroclypeus
to occipital foramen. Frontoclypeal suture absent. Stem of ecdysial cleavage
lines very short, frontal branches delimiting U-shaped frons. Head capsule
with setae as illustrated (Figs. 2, 3).
Labroclypeus (Figs. 4, 5) asymmetrical, a pair of prominent teeth on right
and on left side, midregion with numerous, small, irregular teeth; tooth on
left side as large as tooth on right side, or nearly so.
Antennae (Fig. 4) 3-segmented, slightly longer than stipes. First antennal
segment slightly longer than second, without setae. Penultimate antennal
segment with a large sensillum and numerous smaller sensilla at apex. Ulti¬
mate antennal segment small, cylindrical, terminating in flagelliform setae
and sensilla.
Mandibles (Fig. 2) symmetrical, prominent, sharply pointed apically; in¬
ner margin with two teeth, distal larger than proximal; inner margin serrate
from apex of mandible to distal tooth; inner margin between proximal tooth
and base of mandible with sparse, short spicules.
Maxilla (Figs. 2-4) with stipes longer than combined lengths of palpifer
and palpus; stipes with four large, apically bifid setae on inner margin.
Palpifer with a large seta on inner margin near base, two long setae on
ventral surface (Fig. 3), and a sensory lobe at anteromedial angle. Palpus
3-segmented, with numerous sensilla at apex.
Labium (Figs. 4-7) extending as far forward as apex of stipes. Mentum
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
53
Figs. 1-3. Helocombus bifidus first-instar larva. Fig. 1, Habitus (60x). Fig. 2, Head, dorsal
aspect (150x). Fig. 3, Head, ventral aspect (150x).
54
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 4, 5. Helocombus bifidus first-instar larva. Fig. 4, Mouthparts and anterior margin
of head, dorsal aspect (170x). Fig. 5, Labroclypeus and mentum (875x).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
55
Figs. 6, 7. Helocombus bifidus first-instar larva. Fig. 6, Apex of labium, dorsal aspect
(630x). Fig. 7, Labium, ventral aspect (410x).
56
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
with numerous spicules on dorsal surface (Fig. 5). Palpiger with apicodorsal
spicules (Fig. 6). Ultimate segment of palpus twice length of penultimate;
penultimate segment with long apicodorsal spines; ultimate segment with
long spines near midlength, sensory structures apically.
Prothorax broader than long, with dorsal setae as illustrated (Fig. 1).
Prosternal sclerite broader than long. Meso- and metathoracic sclerites
equal in length, combined length subequal to length of prothorax.
Legs 4-segmented, subequal to length of mandibles; trochanter about half
as long as coxa; femur slightly longer than tibiotarsus; tarsal claw single, half
as long as tibiotarsus, with two basal setae.
Abdomen (Fig. 1) with 8 distinct segments, ninth and tenth segments
reduced; segments 1-8 without tubercles or projections; eighth tergum rep¬
resented by superior valve of stigmatic atrium, a large, oval sclerite with
small apicomedian emargination. Ninth tergum trilobed, median lobe large,
with two short and two long setae on caudal margin; lateral lobes indistinct,
with four setae. Spiracles present. Mesocerci prominent, conical, with a
large apical seta.
Comparative notes. — Helocombus first-instar larvae are most similar to
those of Cymbiodyta, but differ in several respects, including: 1) shape of
the labroclypeus, Helocombus having tooth on the left side as large as that
on the right side (Fig. 5), whereas in Cymbiodyta the left tooth is smaller
than the right; 2) setae on the medial surface of the stipes are bifid at their
apices in Helocombus, non-bifid in Cymbiodyta ; 3) mandibles of Helocom¬
bus have a patch of small spicules on medial surface between base and
proximal tooth, Cymbiodyta lacks these spicules; and 4) Helocombus larvae
have a prominent seta on the anterior margin of each side of the head,
midway between the labroclypeus and mandibular articulation, Cymbiodyta
larvae lack these setae.
Larvae of Helocombus will key to the genus Cymbiodyta at the second
alternative of couplet 11 in Chandler’s key (1956, pp. 339-341). The follow¬
ing couplet will separate the two genera:
1. Labroclypeus with tooth on left side smaller than tooth on right
side . Cymbiodyta Bedel
Labroclypeus with tooth on left side equal in size to tooth on right
side . Helocombus Horn
Literature Cited
Chandler, H. P. 1956. Aquatic Coleoptera. In : Usinger, Aquatic Insects of California with
Keys to North American Genera and California Species. Berkeley and Los Angeles,
ix + 508 pp.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 57-64
PREDACEOUS WATER BEETLES OF THE GENUS DESMOPACHRIA
BABINGTON: THE LEECHI-GLABRICULA GROUP
(COLEOPTERA: DYTISCIDAE)
Frank N. Young
Biology Dept., Indiana Univ., Bloomington, 47405
The small, seed-like species of Desmopachria (s. str.) are often almost
indistinguishable except by the male external genitalia. D. glabricula Sharp
and the species related to it are separable from other groups by the strongly
sclerotized aedeagus and the complex parameres. They differ from the type-
species of Desmopachria ( nitida Babington) in having the parameres com¬
pacted, not bifid, and from the convexa-grana Group in lacking free spurs
on the parameres.
Hugh B. Leech, of the California Academy of Sciences, first recognized
the complexity of the genitalia in the small species of Desmopachria more
than 30 years ago. He kindly turned over to me his dissected specimens
from Florida which clearly demonstrated that at least three species were
then lumped under the name Desmopachria grana (LeConte). In the inter¬
vening decades, I have assembled material of these “tiny mites” as they
were once called by David Sharp. In recent years, the widespread use of
the black-light traps (UV traps) has greatly increased the available material.
I am happy to name the following new species and to add its name to that
of the group in honor of Hugh B. Leech in recognition of his many contri¬
butions to the study of the aquatic Coleoptera.
Desmopachria leechi, new species
Diagnosis. — A small brownish Desmopachria, 1.3 to about 1.52 mm long
by 0.8 to about 1.0 mm wide near the middle of the elytra. Smaller and less
coarsely punctate both above and below than D. convexa (Aube), but almost
indistinguishable from D. grana (LeConte) except for the coarse setate
punctation of the last visible abdominal sternite in both males and females.
Male external genitalia diagnostic (Fig. 4).
Holotype male. — Total length 1.52 mm; greatest width near middle of
elytra about 1 .0 mm; width of pronotum at base 0.72 mm; width of pronotum
at apex 0.56 mm; length of pronotum at midline about 0.35 mm. Ovate
somewhat attenuate behind and moderately convex in lateral profile. Head
moderately coarsely, irregularly punctate on vertex and clypeus; clypeus
rounded in front, distinctly margined. Disk of pronotum about as coarsely
punctate as vertex of head but with punctures denser along anterior margin
58
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
and at sides of base as usual; pronotal margins distinct; base of pronotum
strongly recurved at outer (humeral) angles as in grana. Elytra about as
coarsely punctate as pronotal disk but punctures more regularly distributed
in irregular rows along suture and near base becoming more irregular, shal¬
lower, and sparser laterally and more irregularly distributed apically; no
indication of a sutural stria; discal stria of coarser punctures not conspicu¬
ous. Venter punctate much as in grana ; hind coxae more coarsely but more
shallowly punctate than disk of pronotum; prosternal process much as in
grana, similar in the sexes; most of venter inconspicuously punctate except
for last visible abdominal sternite which is coarsely punctate at apex, along
posterior margin, and in middle with light colored setae; middle of sternite
feebly impressed. Color much as in grana; dorsum nearly uniformly yel¬
lowish brown, narrowly darker along bases of pronotum and elytral suture;
thorax and head slightly lighter than elytra (feebly bicolorus); venter brown¬
ish yellow, darker along joints and sutures as usual.
Allotype female. — Very similar to male. Total length 1.52 mm; greatest
width near middle of elytra 1.0 mm; width of pronotum at base 0.72 mm;
width of pronotum at apex 0.56 mm; length of pronotum at midline about
0.32 mm. Last visible abdominal sternite with coarse punctures and light
colored setae much as in male.
Holotype, allotype, and two male paratypes from: FLORIDA: Alachua
County, Gainesville, 1-7 August 1956, BLT (UV trap), L. A. Hetrick
(FSCA).
Other paratypes. — FLORIDA: Alachua County : Gainesville, BLT, 13-
14 July 1978, F. N. Young (1 male UMMZ). Flatwoods east of Gainesville,
4 October 1937, F. N. Young (1 male UMMZ). Tiger Bay east of Gainesville,
19 September 1938, F. N. Young (4 males, 1 female). Collier County: Canal
near Everglades, 15 August 1959, F. N. Young (1 male). Dade County:
Timms Hammock near Homestead, 24 February 1919, H. S. Barber (1 male
NMNH). Royal Palm State Park, 16 March 1924, W. S. Blatchley (1 male,
PUC). Homestead, 15-16 August 1973, BLT, R. N. Baranowski (2 males,
3 females FSCA). Homestead, June 1929, P. J. Darlington, Jr. (1 male
MCZ). Miami, 13 September 1960, BLT, P. E. Briggs (1 male FSCA). Royal
Palm State Park, 20 July 1938, F. N. Young (1 male). Canal Southeast
Florida City, 9 July 1962, F. N. Young (2 males, 1 female). Franklin County:
Dog Island, 16 April 1947, F. N. Young (4 males, 2 females). Glades County:
Near Harrisburg, 7 August 1972, F. N. Young (3 males, 6 females). Hills¬
boro County: Tampa, 23/4, C. V. Riley Collection (1 male NMNH). Lee
County: Fort Myers, 18 March 1921, W. S. Blatchley (1 male PUC). Liberty
County: Ditch 10 miles southeast Telogia, 7 May 1971, F. N. Young (1
male). Monroe County: Big Pine Key, pools in pinelands, 9 September 1941,
F. N. Young (1 male, 2 females). Big Pine Key, 1-3 July 1978, BLT, L.
Strang (10 males and females FSCA). Everglades National Park, 30 July
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
59
1969, BLT, C. A. Adamson (1 male, 1 female FSCA). Sarasota County :
Sarasota, 5 March 1920, John G. Gehring Collection (13 males, 2 females
MCZ). Taylor County : J. D. Sherman and Frederich Blanchard collections,
(6 males MCZ). Ex J. D. Sherman Collection (7 males AMNH). Volusia
County : Pool west of Daytona Beach, 10 August 1979, F. N. Young (1
male). County ?: “Florida, Stephens ville, J. D. Sherman Collection,” (9
males NMNH).
GEORGIA: Appling County : Little Satilla R. north of Bristol, 28 August
1961, F. N. Young (1 male). Lowndes County. Valdosta, J. D. Sherman
Collection, 1920 (1 male NMNH).
MISSISSIPPI: Jackson County. Ocean Springs, 24 June 1931, Henry
Dietrich (1 male CU). Horn Island, 11 August 1944, light trap (1 male, 3
females CU).
SOUTH CAROLINA: Kershaw County : Camden, 18 June 1929, P. J.
Darlington, Jr. (2 males, 2 females MCZ).
Desmopachria glabricula Sharp
Desmopachria glabricula Sharp, 1882. Biologia Centrali- Americana. Insec-
ta. Coleoptera 1 (Part 2), p. 18. (Guatemala, Paso Antonio, 400', Cham¬
pion).
Diagnosis. — A small, brownish Desmopachria about 1.3 to 1.4 mm long
by about 0.96 to 1.0 mm wide at about middle of elytra. Very similar to
grana and leechi, but punctation finer and color probably darker when fully
mature. Last visible abdominal sternite nearly smooth, transversely im¬
pressed similar to grana, not setate-punctate as in leechi. Male external
genitalia diagnostic (Fig. 2).
Besides the syntypes, I have seen specimens from Costa Rica, British
Honduras, and Panama. Sharp (1887, p. 752, supplement to op. cit.) added
specimens from the Pearl Islands (Panama) to the original syntypes which
are females. A male from the latter group of specimens has genitalia of the
nitida type with divided parameres. The female cotypes match well with
specimens from other Central American localities, but the Pearl Island spec¬
imens are more coarsely punctate — particularly along base and sides of
pronotum and on the elytra.
I designate as Lectoholotype a female in the BMNH.
Figs. 1-12. Dorsal Outlines and male external genitalia of species of Desmopachria of the
leechi-glabricula Group. Fig. 1. Desmopachria glabricula Sharp, lectoholotype dorsal outline.
Fig. 2. Same, external genitalia of a male from Costa Rica. Fig. 3. Desmopachria leechi n.
sp., holotype dorsal outline. Fig. 4. Same, external genitalia of holotype. Fig. 4a. Same, lateral
outline of aedeagus. Fig. 5. Desmopachria strigata n. sp., holotype dorsal outline. Fig. 6.
60
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Same, external genitalia of holotype. Fig. 7. Desmopachria flavida n. sp., holotype dorsal
outline. Fig. 8. Same, external genitalia of holotype. Fig. 9. Desmopachria zimmermani n.
sp., holotype dorsal outline. Fig. 10. Same, external genitalia of holotype. Fig. 11. Desmo¬
pachria volvata n. sp., holotype dorsal outline with color pattern roughly indicated by stippling.
Fig. 12. Same, external genitalia of male at left from above as in copulatory position; at right
aedeagus and paramere viewed from below in copulatory position. All external male genitalia
have been slightly spread apart before drying and, except for figure 12, are shown from above
as in the copulatory position.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
61
Desmopachria flavida, new species
Diagnosis. — A small, light yellowish brown species about 1.4 to 1.5 mm
long. Greatest width near basal Vs of elytra about 1.0 mm. Similar to grana
but less regularly oval in dorsal outline and much less coarsely punctate
both above and below. Male external genitalia diagnostic (Fig. 8).
Holotype male. — Total length 1.4 mm; greatest width near basal Vs of
elytra 1.0+ mm; width of pronotum at base 0.76 mm; width of pronotum at
apex 0.52 mm; length of pronotum at midline 0.24 mm. Ovate, widest at
basal Vs of elytra, somewhat attenuate behind. Head very finely, sparsely
punctate on front and clypeus; clypeus just detectably truncate in front;
clypeal impressions shallow, inconspicuous. Pronotal disk punctate about
as on head; coarser basal punctures very sparse except toward sides; an¬
terior transverse row of coarser punctures almost obliterated at middle.
Elytral punctation relatively fine, somewhat coarser than on disk of prono¬
tum; discal stria of slightly larger punctures distinct but not conspicuous.
Hind coxae finely, sparsely punctate, the punctures about as coarse as those
of head; nearly smooth between punctures, shining. Last visible stemite
almost smooth, transversely impressed across middle. Color light yellowish
brown above and below, narrowly darker along elytral suture and bases and
along some sutures and joints.
Allotype female. — Very similar to male in punctation and color. Total
length 1.5 mm; greatest width near basal Vs of elytra 1.0+ mm; width of
pronotum at base 0.76 mm; width of pronotum at apex 0.52 mm; length of
pronotum at midline about 0.30 mm.
Holotype and allotype from: MEXICO: Nayarit, Ixtlan del Rio, 22 Sep¬
tember 1953, Borys Malkin (CAS). Paratypes: Nayarit, 25 miles S.W.
Tepic, 23 November 1958, Hugh B. Leech (1 male FSCA). Cuernavaca
(Flohr), ex cotypes of D. circularis Sharp, Biologia Centrali-Americana
material (1 male, 2 females BMNH).
Desmopachria zimmermani, new species
Diagnosis. — A small reddish brown Desmopachria about 1.3 to 1.4 mm
long by about 0.92 to 0.96 mm wide near middle of elytra. Body form short,
subovate, somewhat attenuate behind. Punctation finer than in grana. Meta¬
sternum and hind coxae rather coarsely, but shallowly and sparsely punc¬
tate. Color generally yellowish brown or brownish yellow, the elytra slightly
darker reddish brown and very much darker along suture and bases of
pronotum. Hind coxae somewhat darker light reddish brown. Appendages
light brownish yellow. Male external genitalia diagnostic (Fig. 10).
Holotype male. — Total length 1.36 mm; greatest width near middle of
elytra 0.92 mm; width of pronotum at base 0.76 mm; width of pronotum at
apex 0.48 mm; length of pronotum at midline 0.28 mm. Head finely, sparsely
62
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
punctate, somewhat more finely so than in grana', clypeus rounded ante¬
riorly, distinctly margined. Pronotal disk about as finely, but more sparsely
punctate than vertex of head; as usual, punctures along anterior margin and
base coarser, but all punctures finer than in grana. Elytra with basal punc¬
tures coarser and more regularly seriate than those on pronotal disk but
distinctly finer than in grana. Venter punctate much as in grana ; last visible
abdominal stemite appearing nearly smooth with only a few visible punc¬
tures, much as in grana. Color much as described above.
Allotype female. — Total length 1.4 mm; greatest width near middle of
elytra 0.96 mm; width of pronotum at base 0.76 mm; width of pronotum at
apex 0.56 mm; length of pronotum at midline about 0.24 mm. Very similar
to male.
Holotype, allotype, and 9 paratypes from: MEXICO: Sinaloa, 8 miles
east of Concordia, 8 April 1975, J. R. Zimmerman (NMSU). Paratype:
MEXICO: J. R. Zimmerman, Sinaloa, San Bias, 26 July 1968. P. J. Spangler
(1 male NMNH).
I take pleasure in naming this species for James R. Zimmerman of New
Mexico State University.
Desmopachria volvata, new species
Diagnosis. — A small Desmopachria about 1.3 to 1.5 mm long and about
0.9 to 0.96 mm wide near middle of elytra. Similar to grana in shape but
more convex in lateral profile. Punctation finer throughout. Last visible
abdominal stemite nearly smooth, transversely impressed just before apex
as in grana. Elytra and pronotal disk vaguely clouded with darker color,
and outer coxal laminae and edges of epipleurae dark brown. Male external
genitalia diagnostic (Fig. 12).
Holotype male. — Ovate, slightly attenuate behind; convex in lateral pro¬
file. Total length 1.36 mm; greatest width near middle of elytra 0.96 mm;
width of pronotum at base 0.72 mm; width of pronotum at apex 0.5 mm;
length of pronotum at midline about 0.28 mm. Head and clypeus finely,
sparsely punctate; clypeus rounded in front, distinctly margined. Pronotal
disk appearing almost impunctate with some coarser punctures along an¬
terior margin and base as usual. Elytra finely and shallowly punctate — the
punctures sparse and becoming smaller and sparser toward sides and apex;
discal stria with some coarse punctures, but inconspicuous. Venter with
metasterum and coxae very finely punctate but with some irregular micro¬
sculpture. Abdomen appearing almost impunctate; last visible abdominal
sternite smooth, shining, transversely impressed just before apex. Head
brownish yellow on clypeus and front, the base darker brown. Pronotum
brownish yellow at sides with disk vaguely infuscated with reddish brown.
Elytra with suture dark brown (piceous) and bases narrowly dark brown;
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
63
base and outer margins brownish yellow; disk with vague dark brown cloud.
Venter with hind coxae dark brown, metasternum reddish yellow, and ap¬
pendages, abdomen, epipleurae, and sides of elytra brownish yellow with
inner edges of epipleurae very dark brown (piceous).
Allotype female. — Very similar to male. Total length 1.48 mm; greatest
width near middle of elytra 0.72; width of pronotum at base about 0.96 mm;
width of pronotum at apex 0.56; length of pronotum at midline about 0.32.
Holotype, allotype, and 2 paratypes from: PANAMA: Albrook Forest
Site, BLT at 100 feet elevation, 9-10 May 1968, R. S. Hutton. Five other
Paratypes from same locality but other dates (NMNH).
Desmopachria strigata, new species
Diagnosis. — Larger, more convex, more coarsely punctate on elytra, and
with different body shape from other members of group. Length about 1.6
to over 1.8 mm; greatest width near basal Vs of elytra about 1.1 to 1.2 mm.
Male external genitalia elaborate with a strigate area suggesting a stridula-
tory mechanism (Fig. 6).
Holotype male. — Ovate, not very attenuate behind. Total length 1.84 mm;
greatest width near basal Vs of elytra 1.2 mm; width of pronotum at base
0.96 mm; width of pronotum at apex 0.6 mm; length of pronotum at midline
about 0.44 mm. Head moderately finely, sparsely punctate; clypeus some¬
what more densely punctate than front, rounded in front, and distinctly
margined. Pronotum punctate on disk about as coarsely as on front of head;
less densely punctate than clypeus; more coarsely punctate across front
margin and coarsely and irregularly punctate along base. Elytra more
coarsely and closely punctate at bases and along suture than pronotum;
punctures separated by less than their diameter near suture on bases and
deeply impressed; irregular in shape but rarely confluent; shallower and
sparser laterally and apically as usual. Metasternal wings and hind coxae
coarsely, deeply, but sparsely punctate; punctures on coxae separated by
more than their diameter. Abdomen almost smooth; last visible stemite
transversely impressed across base and acutely so just before apex, the
surface nearly smooth but with some coarser punctures and with some se-
tate punctures at middle of penultimate visible sternite. Elytra reddish
brown with head and pronotum uniformly light brownish yellow. Elytra
deeper brown or piceous along suture and bases. Venter with hind coxae
about same color as elytra; most of rest of venter, appendages, epipleurae,
and sides of elytra light yellowish brown.
Allotype female. — Similar to male. Total length 1.76 mm; greatest width
near basal Vs of elytra 1.2 mm; width of pronotum at base 0.96; width of
pronotum at apex 0.72 mm; length of pronotum at midline 0.4 mm.
64
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Holotype, allotype, and 17 paratypes from: BRAZIL: Mato Grosso, Cor¬
umba, presumably collected at light, collection of A. Zimmermann (ZSBS).
The holotype male of this series may be slightly abnormal in shape, but
all the males have similar genitalia, and both males and females approximate
in varying degrees the dorsal outline.
Abbreviations
Abbreviations used in this manuscript are as follows: FSCA, Florida State
Collection of Arthropods, Gainesville, FL; UMMZ, University of Michigan
Museum of Zoology, Ann Arbor, MI; NMNH, U.S. National Museum of
Natural History, Washington, DC; PUC, Purdue University Collection, W.
Lafayette, IN; MCZ, Museum of Comparative Zoology, Cambridge, MA;
AMNH, American Museum of Natural History, New York, NY: CU, Cor¬
nell University Collection, Ithaca, NY; NMSU, New Mexico State Uni¬
versity Collection, Los Alamos, NM; ZSBS, Zoologische Sammlung des
Bayerischen Staats, Miinchen, Germany; BMNH, British Museum (Natural
History), London, United Kingdom.
Contribution from the Zoological Laboratories of Indiana University aid¬
ed by grants from the NSF, NIH, and the Indiana University Foundation.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 65-75
TWO NEW GENERA, TWO NEW SPECIES OF BIDESSINE WATER
BEETLES FROM SOUTH AMERICA
(COLEOPTERA: DYTISCIDAE)
Paul J. Spangler
Department of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution,
Washington, D.C. 20560
Each of the two new genera and species described below are represented
by a single male specimen. Hoping more specimens could be obtained, I
have kept these specimens since they were collected 11 years ago. Because
no more specimens of these unique beetles have been obtained I describe
them here and dedicate this article to Hugh B. Leech, my friend and fellow
water beetle enthusiast, on the occasion of his 70th birthday.
Hughbosdinius, new genus
Body form (Fig. 1) elongate-oval; lateral margins moderately discontin¬
uous between pronotum and elytra; dorsum moderately convex. Head with¬
out transverse cervical stria or suture behind eyes; clypeus not thickened
nor margined. Ultimate and penultimate segments of labial palpi broadened,
subtriangular. Pronotum with narrow, lightly impressed, incurved plicae not
connected by a transverse groove; sides narrowly evenly margined from
base to apex. Scutellum concealed. Elytra without basal plicae or sutural
striae; narrowly evenly margined laterally; epipleura shallowly excavated
basally, without transverse subbasal carina. Prosternum strongly longitu¬
dinally carinate on midline; process narrow between midcoxae, apical por¬
tion broad, indistinctly but slightly depressed medially and margins indefi¬
nite, sides parallel, apex broadly rounded. Intercoxal process of
metasternum narrow, the lateral margins continuous with metacoxal cavi¬
ties. Metasternum deeply, transversely, and broadly depressed behind me-
socoxae. Metacoxal processes not strongly incised at middle; with very
narrow median longitudinal groove terminating on anterior margin of inter¬
coxal process of metasternum; coxal lines slightly converging anteriorly.
Last abdominal sternum moderately concave apicomedially. Anterior and
middle tarsi pseudotetramerous; third tarsal segment moderately bilobed.
Tarsal claws long, slender, and equal in length. Protibiae evenly arcuately
rounded on apex (Fig. 5). Metatibial spurs straight. Metatrochanter and
metafemur typically bidessine, not enlarged (Fig. 6). Male genitalia com¬
plex, with parameres jointed; median lobe slightly modified hydroporine
66
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Hughbosdinius leechi, n. gen., n. sp., habitus view.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
67
type. Dorsum moderately finely densely punctate. Integument with opales¬
cent sheen especially on elytra, metasternum, and second abdominal ster¬
num.
Type-species. — Hughbosdinius leechi, new species.
Etymology. — Hughbosdinius, named for Hugh Bosdin Leech, in honor of
his 70th birthday, in respect for his many excellent contributions to our
knowledge of aquatic Coleoptera, for his years of encouragement and his
selfless response to endless requests for assistance in all groups of insects.
Gender: masculine.
Hughbosdinius leechi, new species
(Figs. 1-6)
Holotype male: Body form (Fig. 1) elongate-oval. Length 2.5 mm; greatest
width 1.5 mm. Color reddish brown; head and pronotum concolorous. Ely¬
tron indistinctly vittate-fasciate, with dark reddish-brown vittae as follows:
a sutural, three on disc, and three lateral maculae in a row (an interrupted
lateral vitta); vittae interrupted in humeral area, on lateral third just anterior
to midlength, on lateral two-thirds just posterior to midlength, and mostly
terminated in a transverse fascia well before apex. Integument of elytra,
metasternum, and second abdominal sternum with opalescent reflection in
certain light. Venter reddish brown.
Head shining, smooth between fine, sparse punctures; punctures on disc
separated by about 4 or 5 times their width; clypeal punctures indistinct;
with slender yellowish setae arising from the punctures. Antenna slender,
segments not compactly attached. Clypeus not thickened nor margined.
Labrum sparsely finely punctate and narrowly deeply emarginate apico-
medially. Ventral surface of head very finely and sparsely punctate.
Pronotum arcuate laterally, sides finely evenly margined for entire length;
base moderately bisinuate; apicolateral angles acute; posterolateral angles
obtuse; punctures coarser than those on head, sparse on disc, slightly closer
laterally; discal punctures separated by 5 or 6 times their width; shallow,
thin, strongly incurved plicae on base extending forward about one-third
length of pronotum; sparse, slender, yellowish setae arising from punctures.
Prosternum strongly longitudinally carinate on midline. Prosternal process
narrow between midcoxae; apical portion broad, about three times wider
than narrowest width between midcoxae; indistinctly but slightly depressed
medially and margins indefinite; sides parallel; apex broadly rounded; sur¬
face finely densely punctate. Apex of prosternum broadly rounded and ex¬
tending almost to midlength of mesocoxae. Mesosternum typical, unmodi¬
fied. Intercoxal process of metasternum separated from posterior part of
metasternum by a deep, transverse, broad depression (Fig. 4).
Scutellum hidden.
Figs. 2-6. Hughbosdinius leechi, n. gen., n. sp. Fig. 2, Male genitalia, ventral view. Fig.
3, Paramere, medial view of apex. Fig. 4, Metasternum in profile, Fig. 5, Protibia, outline.
Fig. 6, Metatrochanter and metafemur, ventral view.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
69
Elytron without basal plicae or sutural stria; arcuate and margined lat¬
erally; apex moderately rounded. Surface punctate similarly to head but
punctures coarser and slightly denser; punctures on disc separated by 2 or
3 times their width; each puncture bearing a long, slender, yellow seta.
Cuticle between punctures microalutaceous. Epipleuron shallowly excavat¬
ed basally; without a carina; surface microalutaceous; sparsely, finely punc¬
tate almost to apex.
Venter mostly microalutaceous. Metacoxal plates microalutaceous; with
coarse, seta-bearing, sparse punctures (except posteromedially); punctures
separated by 2 or 3 times their width. Abdominal sternum 2 finely microal¬
utaceous; sterna 3, 4, and 5 mostly smooth; sterna 3 and 4 each with a
transverse row of seta-bearing punctures near posterior margin. Front and
middle coxae moderately densely, moderately coarsely punctate. Hind tro¬
chanter smooth except for a few punctures. Femora smooth except for a
few coarse sparse punctures. Front and middle legs pseudotetramerous;
first, second, and third segments broad, bearing dense pads of setae modi¬
fied as cupules; fourth segment minute, hidden between lobes of third seg¬
ment. Tarsal claws slender, elongate, and equal in length. Front, middle,
and hind tibiae each with a fringe of long natatory setae on inner and outer
surfaces. Front tibia with apex arcuately rounded (Fig. 5). Metatibial spurs
moderately long, straight. Metatrochanter and metafemur unmodified, typ¬
ical bidessine type (Fig. 6).
Male genitalia complex with parameres jointed and hydroporine median
lobe as illustrated (Figs. 2 and 3).
Etymology. — leechi, named for Hugh B. Leech for the reasons mentioned
under the generic etymology and in appreciation for his advice and assis¬
tance with numerous aspects of my studies of aquatic beetles through the
years.
Type-data. — Holotype male: VENEZUELA: Barinas: Obispo, 25 Feb.
1969, P. and P. Spangler. USNM Type No. 76698, deposited in the National
Museum of Natural History, Smithsonian Institution, Washington, D.C.
Habitat. — The type-specimen was collected along the margin of Rio Mas-
parro in a pool of standing water; elevation 183 m.
Youngulus, new genus
Body form (Fig. 7) elongate-oval; lateral margins moderately discontin¬
uous between pronotum and elytra; dorsum moderately convex. Head with¬
out transverse cervical stria or suture behind eyes; clypeus not thickened
nor margined; ultimate and penultimate segments of labial palpi unmodified,
cylindrical. Pronotum with narrow, lightly impressed, incurved plicae not
connected by a transverse groove; sides narrowly evenly margined from
base to apex. Scutellum concealed. Elytra without basal plica (or with ex-
70
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 7. Youngulus franki, n. gen., n. sp., habitus view.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
71
tremely faint indication of one); sides narrowly evenly margined laterally;
epipleuron shallowly excavated basally, without transverse carina. Proster¬
num slightly and moderately broadly elevated on midline before procoxae;
process rather broad, shallowly depressed medially and unmargined, sides
slightly converging posteriorly, apex obtusely rounded. Intercoxal process
of metasternum narrow; the lateral margins continuous with those of middle
coxal cavities. Metacoxal processes not strongly incised at middle; with
narrow medial longitudinal groove terminating at hind edge of metasternum;
coxal lines very slightly divergent anteriorly. Last abdominal sternum with
very shallow medial and lateral depressions. Anterior and middle tarsi pseu-
dotetramerous; third tarsal segment moderately bilobed; pro tarsal claws
short, slender, unequal, outer (anterior) claw only about half as long as inner
claw; mesotarsal and metatarsal claws long, slender, and equal in length.
Protibiae strongly emarginate on apex (Fig. 11). Metatibial spurs long and
slender, inner spur longer and strongly curved with apex directed away from
body. Metatrochanter and metafemur greatly enlarged, inflated, closely at¬
tached (Fig. 12) and the two appearing as a robust wedge-shaped structure.
Male genitalia with parameres jointed; median lobe typical hydroporine
type. Dorsum moderately finely densely punctate. Integument with opales¬
cent sheen especially on elytra, metasternum, and second abdominal ster¬
num.
Type-species. — Youngulus franki, new species.
Etymology. — Youngulus, named for Frank N. Young who has contributed
many excellent studies on aquatic beetles of the Western Hemisphere, and
whose work on the bidessine dytiscids enabled me to recognize this new
genus. Gender: masculine.
Youngulus franki, new species
(Figs. 7-12)
Holotype male: Body form (Fig. 7) elongate-oval. Length 3.0 mm; greatest
width 1.8 mm. Color reddish brown; head and pronotum concolorous. Ely¬
tron indistinctly vittate-fasciate, with dark reddish-brown vittae as follows:
a sutural; three vague, narrow ones on disc; and three lateral maculae in a
row (an interrupted lateral vitta). Elytral vittae interrupted in humeral area,
on lateral area, on lateral third just anterior to midlength, on lateral two-
thirds just posterior to midlength and mostly terminated in a transverse
fascia well before apex. Integument of elytra, metasternum, and second
abdominal sternum with opalescent reflection in certain light. Venter reddish
brown.
Head shining, smooth between moderately fine, sparse punctures; punc¬
tures on disc separated by about 3 to 5 times their width; clypeal punctures
fine and moderately punctate; with slender yellowish setae arising from the
72
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 8-12. Youngulus franki, n. gen., n. sp. Fig. 8, Male genitalia, ventral view. Fig. 9,
Paramere, medial view of apex. Fig. 10, Metasternum in profile. Fig. 11, Protibia, outline.
Fig. 12, Metatrochanter and metafemur, ventral view.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
73
punctures. Antenna slender, segments not compactly attached. Clypeus not
thickened nor margined. Lab rum sparsely finely punctate and broadly deep¬
ly emarginate apicomedially. Ventral surface of head smooth.
Pronotum arcuate laterally, sides finely evenly margined for entire length;
base moderately bisinuate; apicolateral angles acute; posterolateral angles
obtuse; punctures coarser than those on head, sparser on disc and more
dense posteriorly and laterally; discal punctures separated by 1 to 4 times
their width; shallow, thin, strongly incurved plicae on base extending for¬
ward about one-third length of pronotum; sparse slender yellowish setae
arising from punctures. Prosternum slightly and moderately broadly elevat¬
ed on midline before procoxae; process rather broad, shallowly depressed
medially and unmargined, sides slightly converging posteriorly, apex ob¬
tusely rounded, surface finely densely punctate; apex obtusely rounded and
extending almost to midlength of mesocoxae. Mesosternum typical, un¬
modified. Intercoxal process of metasternum on same plane as posterior
part, not interrupted (Fig. 10).
Scutellum hidden.
Elytron without basal plica (or with extremely faint indication of one);
arcuate and margined laterally; apex moderately rounded; surface punctate
similarly to head but punctures coarser and slightly denser; punctures on
disc separated by 1 or 2 times their width; each puncture bearing a long,
slender yellow seta; cuticle between punctures microalutaceous; epipleuron
shallowly excavated basally, without carina, surface microalutaceous and
sparsely finely punctate almost to apex.
Venter mostly microalutaceous. Metacoxal plates microalutaceous; with
coarse seta-bearing punctures (except posteromedially), punctures separat¬
ed by 1 or 2 times their width. Abdominal sternum 2 finely microalutaceous;
sterna 3 and 4 smooth except each with two irregular anterior rows and two
irregular posterior rows of seta-bearing punctures. Front and middle coxae
finely, moderately densely punctate. Hind trochanter smooth except for a
few punctures. Front femur practically impunctate on ventral surface; mid¬
dle femur with several rows of coarse punctures along front and hind mar¬
gins; hind femur with few fine seta-bearing punctures. Front and middle legs
pseudotetramerous; first, second, and third segments broad, bearing dense
pads of setae modified as cupules; fourth segment minute, hidden between
lobes of third segment. Protarsal claws slender, unequal; outer (anterior)
claw only about half as long as inner claw. Mesotarsal and metatarsal claws
long, slender, and equal in length. Front, middle, and hind tibiae each with
a fringe of long natatory setae on inner and outer surface. Front tibia with
apex strongly emarginate (Fig. 11). Metatibial spurs long and slender; inner
spur longest and strongly curved, apex directed laterally away from body.
Metatrochanter and metafemur greatly enlarged, inflated, closely attached
(Fig. 12) and the two appearing as a robust wedge-shaped structure.
74
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Male genitalia complex with parameres jointed and median lobe typically
hydroporine as illustrated (Figs. 8, 9).
Etymology .—franki, named for Frank N. Young, whose previous publi¬
cations on the Bidessini allowed me to recognize this new genus, new
species, and for numerous favors and gifts of specimens in past years.
Type-data. — Holotype male: COLOMBIA: Meta: Villavicencio (10 km
south), 3 and 4 Mar. 1969, P. and P. Spangler. USNM Type No. 76699,
deposited in the National Museum of Natural History, Smithsonian Insti¬
tution, Washington, D.C.
Habitat. — The type-specimen was collected in a shallow, weedy, roadside
ditch; elevation 305 m.
Discussion
The two new genera described here key to the genus Bidessodes in
Young’s (1967) key to the American genera of bides sine dytiscid beetles.
However, members of the genus Hughbosdinius may be distinguished from
members of the genus Bidessodes and all other bidessine dytiscids known
to me by the distinctive, very deep, transverse, broad depression of the
metasternum directly behind the mesocoxae; by the strong longitudinal Ca¬
rina on the midline of the prosternum; and the broad, subtriangular penul¬
timate and ultimate segments of the labial palpi. Members of the genus
Youngulus may be distinguished from all other bidessine dytiscids known
to me by the greatly enlarged, inflated, wedge-shaped, combined metatro¬
chanter and metafemur; by the long slender metatibial spurs; and the inner
spur which is the longer and is strongly curved with the apex away from
the body.
The following couplets substituted in place of the second rubric of couplet
13 in Young’s (1967) key will distinguish the genera Hughbosdinius and
Youngulus from Bidessodes.
1. Intercoxal process of metasternum separated from posterior part of
metasternum by a very deep, transverse, broad depression; pro¬
sternum strongly longitudinally carinate on midline on anterior
half; penultimate and ultimate segments of labial palpi modified —
broad and subtriangular; Venezuela . Hughbosdinius Spangler
Intercoxal process of metasternum continued posteriorly uninter¬
rupted and on same plane as posterior part; prosternum not lon¬
gitudinally carinate; ultimate and penultimate segments of labial
palpi unmodified . 2
2. Metatrochanter and metafemur greatly enlarged, inflated, closely
attached; the two appearing as a robust, wedge-shaped structure;
Colombia . Youngulus Spangler
Metatrochanter and metafemur normal, not enlarged, inflated, nor
wedge-shaped; Central and South America . . . Bidessodes Regimbart
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
75
I am very grateful to the administrators of the Smithsonian Institution’s
Research Foundation for SI Grant No. Sg0633100 for the financial support
for fieldwork during which time the new taxa described above were col¬
lected. For assistance with the South American fieldwork and for reviewing
and typing this manuscript I thank my wife Phyllis M. Spangler. I also
extend my thanks to Mrs. Elaine R. Hodges, Smithsonian Institution staff
artist, for preparing the illustrations in her usual lucid and attractive style.
Literature Cited
Young, F. N. 1967. A key to the genera of American Bidessine water beetles, with descriptions
of three new genera (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae, Hydroporinae). Coleopt. Bull., 21:75-84.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 76-104
KEY TO THE WORLD GENERA OF LARINAE (COLEOPTERA,
DRYOPOIDEA, ELMIDAE), WITH DESCRIPTIONS OF
NEW GENERA FROM HISPANIOLA, COLOMBIA,
AUSTRALIA, AND NEW GUINEA
Harley P. Brown
Dept, of Zoology and
Stovall Museum of Science and History, Univ. of Oklahoma, Norman, 73019
The most recent attempt to construct a key to the world genera of Larinae
or Larini (he considered them but a tribe) is that of Hinton (1940). His key
included 11 genera. Since that time, Deleve (1963) has described the genus
Potamolatres based upon a new African species, resurrected Potamocares
Grouvelle (1920) and placed in it some of the African species considered
Hydrethus by Hinton (1937), erected the genus Potamogethes for the re¬
maining African species formerly placed in Hydrethus, and erected the ge¬
nus Omotonus for the African species previously in Potamophilinus. Deleve
(1967) also noted that Freyiella Bollow (1938) was synonymous with Po¬
tamophilinus. Freyiella had not been included in Hinton’s key anyway,
perhaps because of the wartime delay in publication or distribution of Bol-
low’s paper. Hinton also omitted Potamophilops from his key, but stated
that it would run to Hexanchorus , with which he thought it was probably
synonymous. (He had not seen the wing venation or the distinctive larva.)
The keys of Coquerel (1851), Grouvelle (1896), and Deleve (1963), though
limited in coverage, are all of value. It was Coquerel’ s key that gave me the
clue to the existence of one of the new genera described below ( Pseudodi -
sersus ). A second new genus ( Ovolara ) came to light because of biogeo-
graphical probability: it seemed unlikely that the genus Hydrethus would be
restricted to Madagascar and Australia; furthermore, the fact that one Aus¬
tralian species was initially described in the genus Lutrochus, which is very
different from most Larinae, made me very suspicious of its generic des¬
ignation. The aedeagus figured by Sato (1973) for beetles he thought to be
Potamophilus papuanus (Carter) was sufficiently different from that of other
species of Potamophilus to lead me to guess that it represented a new genus.
The impetus for the construction of a key came from my discovery of the
new genus Hispaniolara and the necessity to describe it in relation to all
other known genera. Since the literature is so scattered and illustrations so
hard to find, I am taking the liberty of reproducing a number of figures which
should be helpful to the reader in addition to my own drawings.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
77
Key to World Genera of Larinae
1 . Each elytron with 2 accessory striae at base between sutural
and second stria; prosternum broadly truncate or feebly
rounded posteriorly (Figs. 1, 14) .
. . . (Africa, Madagascar) (35 spp.) Potamodytes Grouvelle 1896
la. Each elytron with only one accessory basal stria or none
between sutural and second stria; pro sternum tapering to a
subacute apex . 2
2 (la). Elytra with no accessory basal striae . 3
2a. Each elytron with one accessory basal stria . 9
3 (2). Pronotum on each side with a longitudinal carina or sulcus
on basal third . 4
3a. Pronotum without a carina or sulcus on each side . 5
4 (3). Pronotum broadest at base, without transverse impressions;
elytral intervals convex; pro sternum very broad between
coxae (Fig. 2) .
. (Japan, Malaysia) (3 spp.) Dryopomorphus Hinton 1936
4a. Pronotum constricted at base, with a transverse impression
on each side at apical third; elytral intervals flat; prosternal
process long (Figs. 3, 15) . (South America, West
Indies, Central America to Texas) (7 spp.) Phanocerus Sharp 1882
5 (3a). Pronotum without transverse impression (Figs. 4, 16) .
. (Costa Rica to Ecuador) (2 spp.) Disersus Sharp 1882
5a. Pronotum with a distinct transverse impression in ante¬
rior third . 6
6 (5a). Pronotum with a deep, median, longitudinal impression from
base to transverse impression and with posterior angles bi-
dentate (Figs. 5, 61-64) .
. (Colombia) (1 sp.) Pseudo disersus, new genus
6a. Pronotum without such a median longitudinal impression and
with posterior angles simple . 7
7 (6a). Middle femur longer than body width (Figs. 6, 17, 49-57) . .
.... (West Indies: Hispaniola) (1 sp.) Hispaniolara, new genus
7a. Middle femur shorter than maximum body width . 8
8 (7a). Hind wing with a closed anal cell; large, over 6 mm long
(Figs. 7, 18) .
. (Brazil, Argentina) (1 sp.) Potamophilops Grouvelle 1896
8a. Hind wing without a closed anal cell; smaller, less than 5 mm
long (Figs. 8, 19) . (South America, Cen¬
tral America, Fesser Antilles) (7 spp.) Hexanchorus Sharp 1882
9 (2a). Pronotum on each side with a sublateral longitudinal carina
or sulcus on at least basal fifth . 10
78
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 1-4. Fig. 1. Potamodytes ochus, 7.5 mm. (From Hinton, 1948, Fig. 12.) Fig. 2.
Dryopomorphus nakanei, 3 mm. (Drawn from photograph by Nomura, 1958, PI. I, Fig. 4.)
Fig. 3. Phanocerus clavicornis, 2-3 mm. (From Hinton, 1940, Fig. 56.) Fig. 4. Disersus
longipennis, 8.5 mm. (From painting by Ramona Kaatz of specimen from near Buenos Aires,
Costa Rica.)
9a. Pronotum without basal carinae or sulci . 11
10 (9). Body oval or elliptical; antennal club compact; prostemum
with anterior margin produced (Figs. 9, 20, 27, 29, 58) .
. (Australia) (2 spp.) Ovolara, new genus
10a. Body elongate; antennal club not compact; prostemum with
anterior margin not produced (Figs. 21, 28, 30) .
_ (New Zealand, Australia) (8 spp. — additional species
from Chile are being described elsewhere) Hydora Broun 1882
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
79
Figs. 5-9. Fig. 5. Pseudodisersus goudotii, 7 mm. Pronotum. (From Coquerel, 1851, PI.
15, Fig. 10.) Fig. 6. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., 6.75 mm. Fig. 7. Potamophilops sp., 6.5 mm.
(From painting by Mary Catron of specimen from Estreito, Maranhao, Brazil.) Fig. 8. He x-
anchorus gracilipes, 3. 5-4.0 mm. (From Hinton, 1940, Fig. 20.) Fig. 9. Ovolara australis, 3.5
mm. (From Carter and Zeck, 1929, PI. Ill, Fig. 17.)
80
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 10-13. Fig. 10. Lara avara, 7.5 mm. (From painting by Ramona Kaatz of specimen
from Latah Co., Idaho.) Fig. 11. Stetholus elongatus, 5. 3-6.0 mm. (From Carter and Zeck,
1929, PI. II, Fig. 16.) Fig. 12. Potamogethes sp., 5.3 mm. (From Deleve, 1966, Fig. 5.) Fig.
13. Potamophilus papuanus, 6-7 mm. (From Carter, 1930, PI. IV, Fig. 1.)
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
81
1 l(9a).
11a.
12(1 la).
12a.
13(12a).
13a.
1 4( 1 3 a) .
14a.
15(14).
15a.
16(14a).
16a.
17(13).
17a.
18(17a).
18a.
19(18a).
Pronotum with rugosities (wrinkles); large (over 6 mm long)
. (Madagascar) (1 sp.) Potamolatres Deleve 1963
Pronotum without rugosities . 12
Hind wing with a radial cross-vein (Figs. 10, 22) .
. (western North America) (2 spp.) Lara Le Conte 1852
Hind wing without a radial cross-vein . 13
Hind wing with veins 2AX and 2A2 separate and distinct (Figs.
24-26) . 17
Wing with veins 2AX fused with 2A2 (= vein 2A1+2 in Fig. 23)
. 14
Aedeagus with basal piece greatly reduced, less than one
fourth as long as penis (Fig. 31) . 15
Aedeagus with basal piece rather well-developed, at least one
third as long as penis (Fig. 35) . 16
Elytra with humeri prominent and projecting; striae feeble,
effaced in scutellar region; prosternal process with sides sub¬
parallel in basal two-thirds (Figs. 23, 32, 34) .
. (Africa) (5 spp.) Omotonus Deleve 1963
Elytra with humeri not projecting; striae distinct, accessory
striae always visible; prosternal process subtriangular or ta¬
pering from base (Figs. 12, 33, wing venation as in Fig. 23)
. (Africa) (4 spp.) Potamogethes Deleve 1963
Abdominal segments subequal (wing venation as in
Fig. 23) . (Madagascar) (3 spp.) Hydrethus Fairmaire 1889
Abdominal segments 1+2 conspicuously longer than 3+4+5
(Figs. 35, 36, 41) . (Southeast
Asia, East Indies) (11 spp.) Potamophilinus Grouvelle 1896
Pronotum bilobed, with anterior lobe more convex and sep¬
arated from posterior lobe by a shallow V-shaped depression;
hind wing with vein 3AX joining 2A proximal to closed anal
cell (Figs. 11, 24) .
. (Australia) (1 sp.) Stetholus Carter and Zeck 1929
Pronotum not bilobed; hind wing with vein 3AX joining 2 A at
or along margin of the closed anal cell (Figs. 25, 26) . 18
Pronotum evenly convex, with lateral margins reflected up¬
ward and resembling a gutter (Figs. 25, 31) .
. (Africa) (4 spp.) Potamocares Grouvelle 1920
Pronotum not evenly convex; with distinct impressions; lat¬
eral margins not gutter-like . 19
Elytral apices divergent and acute; aedeagus with penis and
parameres not fused basally and with both tapering conspic¬
uously from base toward apex (Figs. 13, 26, 37, 39, 42, 43,
59, 60) .
. . . (Europe to East Indies) (5 spp.) Potamophilus Germar 1811
82
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
CL
Figs. 14-17. Fig. 14. Potamodytes tuberosus, venation of wing, after Forbes (1926). (From
Hinton, 1940, Fig. 4.) Fig. 15. Phanocerus clavicornis, wing. (From Hinton, 1940, Fig. 57.)
Fig. 16. Disersus longipennis, wing. Fig. 17. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., wing. Like Disersus,
but with 2 A joining 3 A before dividing.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
83
M 2-/4 1 ^
+ ZA, +3Ai
Figs. 18-21. Fig. 18. Potamophilops sp., wing. AC — closed anal cell. Like Disersus but
with 1A more complete. Fig. 19. Hexanchorus gracilipes, wing. (From Hinton, 1940, Fig. 12.)
Fig. 20. Ovolara australis, wing. Fig. 21. Hydora sp., wing. Differs from Ovolara chiefly in
having veins 2Aj and 2A2 fused (?), so that only one vein occurs between 1A and 2A3+3AX.
84
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 22-25. Fig. 22. Lara avara, wing; rc-v = radial cross-vein. (From Hinton, 1940, Fig.
1.) Fig. 23. Omotonus notabilis, wing. Venation is essentially similar in Hydrethus, Pota -
mogethes, and Potamophilinus. (From Deleve, 1963, Fig. 28.) Fig. 24. Stetholus elongatus,
wing. Vein 3AX joins 2A before it divides. Fig. 25. Potamocares burgeoni, wing. (From Deleve,
1963, Fig. 31. In the caption to Deleve’s figures, this one is labeled Hydrethus proximus, but
his discussion on p. 445 makes it evident that his Figs. 30 and 31 were inadvertently reversed.
The venation of Hydrethus is essentially like that shown in Fig. 23.)
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
85
Figs. 26-35. Fig. 26. Potamophilus acuminatus, wing. The venation of Parapotamophilus
n. g. is approximately the same as this. (From Hinton, 1940, Fig. 2.) Fig. 27. Ovolara australis,
antenna. Fig. 28. Hydora obsoleta, antenna. Fig. 29. Ovolara australis, prosternum. Fig. 30.
Hydora picea, prosternum. Fig. 31. Potamocares jeanneli, pronotum. (From Hinton, 1937,
Fig. 19.) Fig. 32. Omotonus notabilis, prosternum. (From Deleve, 1963, Fig. 7.) Fig. 33.
Potamogethes major, prosternum. (From Deleve, 1963, Fig. 14.) Fig. 34. Omotonus notabilis,
aedeagus; bp — basal piece. (From Deleve, 1963, Fig. 2.) Fig. 35. Potamophilinus foveicollis ,
aedeagus. (From Bollow, 1938, Fig. 26c.)
19a. Elytral apices not conspicuously divergent or acute; aedeagus
with penis and parameres fused basally, subparallel, both
somewhat expanded in apical third (Figs. 38, 40, 44-47) . . .
. (New Guinea) (1 sp.) Parapotamophilus new genus
Hispaniolara, new genus
(Figs. 6, 17, 49-57)
Form. — Very elongate, slender, subparallel; subcylindrical (Fig. 6).
Vestiture. — Clothed with very short and inconspicuous but dense hairs.
86
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 36-45. Fig. 36. Potamophilinus foveicollis, abdomen. (From Bollow, 1938, Fig. 24.)
Fig. 37. Potamophilus acuminatus, abdomen. (From Bollow, 1938, Fig. 42.) Fig. 38. Para-
potamophilus gressitti n. sp., abdomen. Fig. 39. Potamophilus acuminatus, male, abdominal
sternite 6. (From Bollow, 1938, Fig. 43.) Fig. 40. Parapotamophilus gressitti n. sp., male,
abdominal sternite 6. Fig. 41. Potamophilinus foveicollis, male, abdominal sternite 6. (From
Bollow, 1938, Fig. 25.) Figs. 42, 43. Potamophilus acuminatus , aedeagus, lateral and dorsal
aspects. (From Bollow, 1938, Fig. 44.) Figs. 44, 45. Parapotamophilus gressitti n. sp., aedea¬
gus, lateral and dorsal aspects.
Head. — Not capable of being retracted into thorax beyond eyes. Antenna
(Fig. 49) 11-segmented, rather short and compact; basal segment longest,
slightly curved, apically inflated, with posterior surface fitting snugly over
eye and bordered by long, decurved setae that fit over eye; segment 2 sub-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
87
globular and also bordered by long setae matching curvature of eye; seg¬
ments 3-11 forming a rather compact club. Mandible (Fig. 50) with 1 sub¬
acute subapical and 2 subacute apical teeth; outer basal angle with a
digitiform lobe; molar process well-developed and bearing transverse ridges;
prostheca membranous but bordered mesally with a pectinate row of rather
short setae. Maxilla (Fig. 51) with palp 4-segmented and stipes with a well-
developed palpifer; galea and lacinia separate and densely spinose. Labium
(Fig. 52) with palp 3-segmented; prementum with palpiger; ligula expanded
laterally; mentum and submentum transverse.
Pronotum. — Basal angles acute; with a subapical transverse groove; with¬
out longitudinal sulci or carinae; margined laterally.
Elytra. — Striate and punctate; without accessory striae and without ca¬
rinae.
Hind wing. — (Fig. 17) Without radial cross-vein; with a closed anal cell;
veins 2AX and 2A2 fused; 1A incomplete or discontinuous between cross¬
vein cu-a and wing margin.
Prosternum. — (Fig. 53) Very short in front of anterior coxae; process
long, without median longitudinal carina.
Mesosternum transverse, with a narrow groove for reception of prostemal
process; this groove expanded posteriorly.
Metasternum subquadrate, ratio of length to width at least 2:3; with a
median longitudinal impressed line.
Abdomen. — Sternite 1 longest, 2 noticeably shorter than 1 but longer than
3, 3 slightly longer than 4, 4 and 5 subequal, 6 small and largely obscured
by hairs from 5. Sternites 1-3 with posterior margins straight, those of 4
straight in male but broadly emarginate in female, that of 5 convex but with
a narrow apical notch or emargination, those of 6 rather broadly and dis¬
tinctly emarginate in male (Fig. 54) but narrowly and feebly emarginate in
female. Spiracles of segments 4 and 5 greatly enlarged and directed poste¬
riorly.
Legs with front coxae transverse and trochantin distinctly visible; front
and middle legs with femora very compressed in anteroposterior plane and
expanded dorsoventrally, with middle femur greatly elongated (longer than
body width across humeri). Front and middle legs, when extended at right
angles to body axis, can fit rather tightly together, but are widely separated
from hind legs. Claws without teeth.
Male genitalia (Figs. 55, 56) slender and elongate, with basal piece well-
developed and much longer than parameres; penis much longer than para-
meres.
Female genitalia (Fig. 57) with relatively elongate coxites and styli.
Etymology. — The generic name is feminine and is derived from Hispan¬
iola, the island on which it occurs, combined with Lara, the type-genus of
the subfamily Larinae.
88
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Type-species. — Hispaniolara farri Brown, new species, which is de¬
scribed below.
Hispaniolara farri, new species
(Figs. 6, 17, 49-57)
Holotype male. — (Fig. 6) Body about 3 times as long as wide; widest at
apical fourth of elytra and across elytral humeri. Length 6.75 mm; width
2.1 mm.
Coloration. — Dorsum dark brown to black, elytra slightly lighter than
head and pronotum. Golden pubescence of occipital portion of head and
most of body may confer a lighter cast when seen from certain angles.
Venter somewhat lighter than dorsum, especially on metasternum. Cuticle
feebly shining.
Head. — Width across eyes 1.3 mm. Occipital region rounded and slightly
swollen; frons shallowly excavated on each side near antennal base; anterior
margin of frons feebly bisinuate; anterior margin of clypeus broadly convex,
with the angles broadly rounded. Lab rum densely covered with erect golden
hairs, anterior margin shallowly and arcuately emarginate at middle, with
angles broadly rounded. Antenna as figured (Fig. 49), not reaching base of
pronotum. Mandible as in Fig. 50. Maxilla (Fig. 51) with palp dark, short,
and stout; segments 2 and 3 apically expanded; segment 4 a little longer
than wide and obliquely truncate, the apical sensory surface being shallowly
concave, oval in outline, and lighter in color. Labium (Fig. 52) with ligula
densely covered with pale, stiff hairs, those on the lateral lobes being re¬
curved; palp short and stout, with segment 3 rather dark except at flattened
apical sensory surface.
Pronotum broadest at base (1.8 mm), 1.2 mm long, tapering arcuately
from base, almost to apex; slightly flared at apex, which is 1.2 mm wide.
Anterior margin feebly arcuate; posterior margin bisinuate on each side.
Transverse impression medially at apical fourth and laterally at apical
eighth, forming an anterior collar that conforms to contours of occipital
portion of head. With shallow excavations laterally in basal quarter, and
with very feeble median longitudinal impression from base to transverse
impression; on each side with a feeble prescutellar impression which ex¬
tends anterolaterally.
Elytra more than 4 times as long as pronotum (5.5 mm: 1.2 mm); broadest
across humeri and near apical fourth. Sides subparallel, slightly constricted
near middle where hind femora fit against sides; apices independently round¬
ed and slightly divergent. Lateral margins smooth and feebly explanate to¬
ward apices. Humeri slightly gibbous. Elytral intervals essentially flat. Su¬
tural intervals narrow at base, gradually widening in basal third. Strial
punctures round to subquadrate, becoming feebler and shallower apically
so that on apical sixth they have virtually disappeared.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
89
Hind wing with venation as figured (Fig. 17).
Scutellum slightly broader than long (0.30 mm:0.25 mm), almost flat, and
with vestiture like that of elytra.
Venter with prosternum and abdominal sternite 6 as figured (Figs. 53, 54).
Legs long and slender; front femur 2.0 mm, tibia 2.0 mm; middle femur
2. 5-2. 6 mm, tibia 2.25 mm; hind femur 1.8 mm, tibia 1.6 mm; each tarsus
1.25 mm. Front and middle femora blade-like. Middle tibia glabrous except
for narrow longitudinal band of tomentum on me sal margin.
Genitalia as figured (Figs. 55, 56). Aedeagus 1.5 mm long, 0.17 mm wide,
subparallel; penis slightly shorter than basal piece and fully twice as long
as parameres, expanded beyond parameres to width of basal piece, with
exposed portion decurved and tapering to a subacute apex.
Female externally similar to male except as follows: pronotum slightly
narrower at base (1.7 mm); abdomen with sternite 5 broader and less con¬
vex, and sternite 6 with posterior margin narrowly and feebly emarginate
at middle. Genitalia as figured (Fig. 57).
Types. — Holotype-male, DOMINICAN REPUBLIC: Dist. La Vega:
mountain stream w. Jayaco, elev. 1170 m, 10/X/1971, Harley Brown, de¬
posited in Stovall Museum of Science and History, Norman, Oklahoma.
Allotype, same data as type, deposited with holotype; genitalia on slide
Hifa-FGl. Paratype: male, DOMINICAN REPUBLIC: Dist. La Vega: Rio
Lo Candango w. Bonao, elev. 1025 m, 10/X/1971, Harley Brown, dissected
and with parts mounted on slides Hifa-Agl, Hifa-Anl, Hifa-Avl, Hifa-Wl,
deposited with holotype. One larva with same data as paratype, deposited
with holotype; to be described elsewhere.
Etymology . — The species is named in honor of Dr. Thomas H. Farr, who
served the Institute of Jamaica long and well, and was gracious host to many
a visiting biologist.
Discussion. — Hispaniolara is proportionately the slimmest or lankiest
member of the Larinae, bearing slight resemblance to the rather chunky
little Phanocerus, the only other member of the subfamily known from
Hispaniola. Geographically, the next closest larine neighbor is Hexanchorus
caraibus, 600 miles away on Guadeloupe. In both structure and habits,
Hispaniolara is much more like Hexanchorus than like Phanocerus, al¬
though Hexanchorus is also much smaller and relatively broader than the
new genus. Both Hexanchorus and Phanocerus differ from Hispaniolara
in lacking an anal cell in the hind wing. In size, Hispaniolara is comparable
to Lara, Disersus, Pseudodisersus, and Potamophilops, but our western
montane Lara is strikingly different from the 4 neotropical genera in both
habits and structure. Adults of Lara are not even aquatic, whereas I have
observed Hispaniolara and Potamophilops in shallow, fast water, appar¬
ently employing the remarkable respiratory mechanics described by Stride
(1955) for their African cousin, Potamodytes. The presence of an accessory
90
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
elytral stria will serve to separate Lara from the 4 neotropical genera. Al¬
though Hispaniolara bears a superficial resemblance to Disersus, it differs
in having a transverse pronotal impression, differently formed antennae,
and much longer middle femora. Hispaniolara appears to be closest to Po-
tamophilops and Pseudo disersus, though it differs from them in pronotal
and elytral contour, shape of middle tibiae, details of wing venation, and in
having unusually long middle femora. Both male and female genitalia are
distinctive and somewhat intermediate in form between those of Hexan-
chorus and Potamophilops.
The larva of Hispaniolara, which is clearly different from all other known
larine larvae of the New World, will be described elsewhere. In many re¬
spects, it resembles larvae of such elmine genera as Stenelmis and Neo-
cylloepus.
Ovolara, new genus
(Figs. 9, 20, 27, 29, 58)
Form. — Ovate, convex.
Vestiture. — Entire surface rather densely covered with short, mostly de¬
cumbent hairs.
Head. — Rounded, capable of being retracted within thorax to eyes; de¬
flected so as to be barely visible from above. Width of head capsule across
eyes subequal to width of pronotum at apex. Antenna (Fig. 27) short, not
reaching beyond middle of pronotum; 11-segmented, inserted at front mar¬
gin of eye; segment 1 longest and fitting over surface of eye, segment 2
ovoid, segments 3-11 gradually enlarging to form a rather compact club;
segments 6-10 broader than long. Mandible with 2 or 3 sharp, chisel-like
apical teeth, an ear-like outer lateral lobe, and a prominent, hemispheric,
medially directed basal lobe that apparently serves a molar function; pros-
theca broad and membranous but with spinose apex. Maxilla with palp 4-
segmented; stipes with well-developed palpifer; cardo well-sclerotized and
with a deep notch on outer margin; galea and lacinia densely spinose, lacinia
at apex with several rows of decurved spines. Clypeus transverse and dis¬
tinct. Labrum transverse, with apical margin densely spinose, angles round¬
ed. Labium with palps short and 3-segmented; prementum with palpigers;
ligula expanded laterally and densely spinose; both mentum and submentum
transverse.
Pronotum. — Broader than long; with basal margin bisinuate, basal angles
acute, anterior margin arcuate, lateral margins feebly sinuate near base,
then broadly arcuate to apex; with sublateral longitudinal carinae in basal
fifth; without transverse impressions; disk rather evenly convex except for
a feeble median elevation at base which becomes a feeble impression near
middle; surface rather finely punctate.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
91
Scutellum. — Relatively small, about as wide as long, with rounded sides;
very feebly raised.
Elytra. — Much broader across humeri than base of pronotum; widest at
or near humeri, which are rather prominent; twice as long as wide and about
3.5 times as long as pronotum. With an accessory stria between sutural and
second stria in basal fifth. Strial punctures relatively large and distinct, most
of the striae extending to margin. Intervals rather flat, none being elevated
to form carinae. Margins broadly arcuate to apex; elytral apices conjointly
rounded.
Hind wing. — Without radial cross-vein or closed anal cell; with veins 1A,
2A1? 2A2 rather well-developed; cross-vein cu-a present (Fig. 20).
Prosternum. — Anterior margin produced beneath head; length between
anterior margin and procoxal cavity greater than breadth of prostemal pro¬
cess; process medially carinate, subacute at apex and relatively broad be¬
tween procoxae (Fig. 29).
Me so sternum. — Short and transverse, with a deep, median, V-shaped ex¬
cavation in anterior % to accommodate prosternal process.
Metasternum. — Transverse, twice as wide as long; with a median longi¬
tudinal groove; each side broadly convex.
Abdomen. — Tapering arcuately from base to rounded apex; width at base
more than 3A of length; 5 visible segments (only females seen); segments 1
and 5 longest and subequal, 2 perceptibly shorter than 1, 3 sightly shorter
than 2, and 4 perceptibly shorter than 3; all segments broadly convex; punc-
tation similar to that of metasternum.
Legs. — Relatively short and stout; femora not flattened or bladelike; fe¬
mur of front leg grooved on antero ventral surface for reception of tibia;
femora of middle and hind legs grooved thus on posterior surface; claws
without teeth.
Genitalia. — (Only females seen) Both coxites and styli relatively slender
and elongate (Fig. 58).
Etymology . — The generic name Ovolara is feminine and is derived from
a combination of the Latin word ovum, referring to the egg-like shape of
the body, and Lara, the type-genus of the subfamily Larinae.
Type-species. — Lutrochus australis King (1865, p. 159).
Discussion. — Although originally described in the genus Lutrochus Er-
ichson, which is not even a member of the family Elmidae, and later moved
to Hydrethus Fairmaire, Ovolara would key to Hydora Broun in the key
provided by Hinton (1940), and is probably closest to that genus. Members
of both genera are much smaller in size than most members of the subfamily,
and approximate the dimensions of such neotropical forms as Hexanchorus
and Phanocerus. Ovolara differs from Hydora in being more robust and
ovoid in shape, in having a much more clavate antenna, the pro sternum
produced anteriorly, and different wing venation (e.g., veins 2AX and 2A2
92
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 46-50. Fig. 46. Parapotamophilus gressitti n. sp., female genitalia. (From Sato, 1973,
Fig. 10.) Fig. 47. Parapotamophilus gressitti n. sp., mandible. Fig. 48. Parapotamophilus
gressitti n. sp., prosternum. Fig. 49. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., male, antenna. Fig. 50. His-
paniolara farri n. sp., male, mandible.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
93
Figs. 51-58. Fig. 51. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., male, maxilla. Fig. 52. Hispaniolara farri
n. sp., male, labium. Fig. 53. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., male, prosternum. Fig. 54. Hispan¬
iolara farri n. sp., male, sixth abdominal sternite. Fig. 55. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., male
genitalia (aedeagus), lateral aspect. Fig. 56. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., aedeagus, dorsal aspect.
Fig. 57. Hispaniolara farri n. sp., female genitalia. Fig. 58. Ovolara australis (King), female
genitalia.
94
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
are both present and distinct and cross-vein cu-a is present, whereas in
Hydora 2AX and 2A2 are represented by a single vein and cu-a is lacking).
From Stetholus, the only other genus of Larinae known from Australia
besides Hydora and Ovolara, it differs in being much smaller, ovate rather
than elongate and subparallel, in having the pronotum with sublateral cari-
nae at base, the prostemum produced beneath head and rather long anterior
to coxae, and more clavate antennae. Judging from the body contour and
leg structure, I would surmise that the habits and ecology of Ovolara would
approximate those of Phanocerus, which is essentially riparian, rather than
those of such aquatics as Hispaniolara, Potamophilops, and Potamodytes
(cf. Stride, 1955).
Another species assigned to Ovolara is Hydrethus leai Carter 1926.
Parapotamophilus, new genus
(Figs. 38, 40, 44-48)
Form. — Elongate, subcylindrical; broadest near humeri, tapering gradu¬
ally toward elytral apex.
Vestiture. — Surface rather densely covered with short, inconspicuous
hairs.
Head. — Retractile within thorax to eyes; width of head capsule across
eyes only slightly greater than width of pronotum at apex. Antenna 11-
segmented, short, not reaching beyond middle of pronotum; inserted at front
margin of eye; segment 1 longest, apically tumid, extending less than half
way over surface of eye; segment 2 ovoid, longer than broad; segments 3-
11 enlarging to form a rather compact club; segments 4-10 broader than
long. Mandible (Fig. 47) strong, with subacute apical and blunt medial or
subapical tooth; outer margin in basal half bearing rather long, suberect
setae; with a prominent, rounded, medially-directed basal lobe that presum¬
ably serves a molar function; prostheca membranous but with a pectinate
median border of erect hairs on spines. Maxillary palp 4-segmented with
apical segment flared into a shallow cup directed anteriorly; stipes with well-
developed palpifer; cardo well-sclerotized; galea and lacinia separate and
subequal, each densely spinose at apex. Clypeus transverse, less than half
as long as labrum. Labrum transverse, with anterior angles expanded and
rounded, and covered by a dense brush of curved setae; anterior margin
bisinuate and densely covered with very short, suberect setae. Labium with
palps short and 3-segmented, the apical segment somewhat flattened in
anteroposterior plane; prementum with palpigers; ligula expanded laterally
and rather densely setose; both mentum and submentum transverse; gula
slightly elongate, longer than combined submentum and mentum.
Pronotum. — Slightly broader than long; broadest near base; basal margin
bisinuate; basal angles bidentate; anterior margin subtruncate; lateral margin
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
95
arcuate from sub-basal tooth anteriorly, but slightly sinuate near apex; with¬
out longitudinal carinae or sulci and without transverse grooves or impres¬
sions; on each side with a shallow lateral excavation or impression near
base and another near apex, and with a small, shallow prescutellar impres¬
sion.
Scutellum. — Slightly longer than wide; triangular with all sides rounded;
very feebly convex.
Elytra. — Much broader across humeri than base of pronotum; widest at
humeri and in basal third; more than twice as long as broad and more than
3 times as long as pronotum. Humeri prominent. With an accessory stria
between sutural and second stria in basal fifth. Strial punctures distinct but
partially obscured by pubescence. Intervals rather flat, none being elevated
to form carinae. Lateral margins subparallel in basal third, then sinuate at
edge of first abdominal stemite where hind femora may be appressed to
sides; feebly explanate. Elytral apices slightly divergent and independently
rounded.
Hind wing. — Venation essentially like that of Potamophilus (Fig. 26);
without radial cross-vein; with closed anal cell; with separate veins 1A, 2AX,
and 2A2; vein 3AX joining 2A at proximal margin of anal cell.
Prosternum. — Anterior margin not produced; length from anterior margin
to procoxal cavity very short; prosternal process subequal in width to di¬
ameter of eye and twice as long as wide, raised medially and along antero¬
lateral margins, tapering from basal third to subacute apex (Fig. 48).
Mesosternum. — Short and transverse, completely divided medially by
excavation to accommodate prosternal process.
Metasternum. — Transverse, about twice as wide as long; broadly convex
on each side of median longitudinal groove.
Abdomen. — With 5 visible sternites in female, 6 in male, tapering poste¬
riorly from apex of stemite 2; segment 1 longest, 2-4 progressively shorter,
5 subequal to 4; male with posterior margin of segment 5 arcuately emar-
ginate, that of segment 6 narrowly emarginate (Figs. 38, 40).
Legs. — Relatively long and slender; front and middle legs with femora
and tibiae slightly flattened; femora not grooved for reception of tibiae;
claws without teeth.
Genitalia. — Male with aedeagus elongate, ca. 4 times longer than wide,
sides subparallel; penis and basal piece subequal in length; penis slightly
longer than parameres, inflated and complex at apex, consisting of 2 dissim¬
ilar portions or lobes: a broader ventral one which is spoon-shaped, sub-
apical, with its ventral surface concave, and a smaller apical portion which
is reflexed dorsally and deeply excavated laterally to accommodate apices
of parameres; parameres fused at base, with apices expanded into lateral
cushions (Figs. 44, 45). Female genitalia with coxites short and stout; styli
96
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
short and less than one-fourth as wide as coxite at apex; struts rather short
and stout, expanded at both ends (Fig. 46).
Etymology. — The generic name Parapotamophilus is masculine and is
formed by adding the prefix para (Greek word meaning near ) to the generic
name Potamophilus (Greek for “river-lover”).
Type-species. — Parapotamophilus gressitti, new species, which is de¬
scribed below.
Discussion. — Parapotamophilus n. g. is probably closest to Potamophi¬
lus, whose geographic range extends from the East Indies to Europe and
which it greatly resembles, the general appearance and wing venation being
almost identical. It differs from Potamophilus in mandibular structure, hav¬
ing 2 blunt rather than 3 sharp teeth, in having the abdomen tapering rather
than abruptly rounded, in having the elytral apices rounded rather than
acute, and most importantly in the form of the male genitalia and the as¬
sociated abdominal sternite 6. In Potamophilus the penis and parameres
taper to rather slender apices, and are separate; the basal piece tapers from
apex to base; sternite 6 is very short and broad with a stout median anterior
process and a very broadly emarginate posterior margin (Fig. 39). In Par¬
apotamophilus the penis and parameres are subparallel with bluntly lobate
apices, and are fused at the base; the basal piece is long and subcylindrical;
sternite 6 is proportionately longer and narrower, with a slender anterior
median process and a narrowly emarginate posterior margin (Fig. 40). Par¬
apotamophilus is also quite similar to Potamophilinus in general appearance
and dimensions, and the latter genus is well represented in Southeast Asia
and the East Indies. Potamophilinus differs from the new genus in wing
venation (veins 2AX and 2A2 are combined rather than separate), abdominal
structure (sternites 1 and 2 are much longer than the remaining segments as
in Fig. 36), and genitalia; sternite 6 of the male is rather like that of the new
genus but much longer, the anterior median process being exaggerated (Fig.
61); the aedeagus is also somewhat like that of Parapotamophilus but with
the penis and parameres separate, abruptly arched at base, very long and
slender, and less complex at apex (Fig. 35).
Parapotamophilus gressitti, new species
(Figs. 38, 40, 44-48)
Potamophilus papuanus (Carter). Sato, 1973, Pacific Insects 15(3/4): 468,
figs. 9-10.
Holotype male. — Length 6.7 mm; width 2.4 mm. Widest across elytral
humeri.
Coloration. — Dorsum dark brown to black, feebly shining. Venter mostly
dark brown to black and more conspicuously pubescent than dorsum; meta¬
sternum and coxae somewhat lighter; abdominal sternite 6, the median por-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
97
tion of 5, and posterior margin of 4 at middle testaceous. Legs reddish to
dark brown.
Head. — Width across eyes 1.3 mm. Vertex feebly convex. Antennae with
segments 1 and 2 lighter than 3-11. Clypeus 6 times wider than long, with
anterior margin straight. Labrum about twice as wide as long, with apical
half paler. Mandible as figured (Fig. 47). Maxillary palp subequal in length
to antennal segments 1+2, with apical segment dark brown. Labial palp
subequal in length to apical segment of maxillary palp, not visible from
above; apical segment brown, with apex convex. Submentum and gula cov¬
ered with rather long golden hairs.
Pronotum. — Length 1.5 mm; greatest width 1.7 mm in basal half, basal
angles feebly bidentate, not acute. Lateral sub-basal excavation with ante¬
rior margin bordered by hairs which form a feeble oblique ridge or brow
(very inconspicuous on the holotype, but quite noticeable on some para-
types). Surface smooth, finely punctate; pubescence inconspicuous.
Prosternum. — As shown in Fig. 48.
Elytra. — Length 5.4 mm; width 2.4 mm across humeri.
Abdomen. — As shown in Figs. 38 and 40.
Legs. — Front femur 1.6 mm, tibia 1.7 mm, tarsus exclusive of claws 1.1
mm. Middle femur 1.8 mm, tibia 1.95 mm, tarsus 1.0 mm. Hind femur 1.7
mm, tibia 1.7 mm, tarsus 1.0 mm. Middle tibia at inner apex with a small,
blunt spur, which appears to be a secondary sexual character. Middle leg
differs from front and hind legs in having tibia and tarsus more flattened and
less pubescent. Otherwise, legs are devoid of noticeable spines or unusual
features.
Aedeagus. — Length 2.25 mm; greatest width (basal piece) 0.4 mm. Par-
ameres with lateral apical cushions bilobate and occupying distal third (Figs.
44, 45).
Female. — Slightly larger than male; length 6.75 mm, width 2.5 mm. Ab¬
domen with segment 6 withdrawn beneath 5; segment 5 with posterior mar¬
gin narrowly emarginate at middle. Middle tibia at inner apex without spur.
Otherwise similar to male. Genitalia as illustrated in Fig. 46.
Etymology. — The species is named in honor of Dr. Judson Linsley Gres-
sitt, who collected the type-series and who has contributed so much to our
knowledge of phytophagous beetles of New Guinea.
Types. — Holotype male: NEW GUINEA: N.E., Wonenara, 6°40'S,
145°55'E, 1450 m, light trap, 14/VI/66, J. L. Gressitt; deposited in Bernice
P. Bishop Museum, Honolulu, Hawaii. Allotype: same data as holotype,
deposited with holotype. Paratypes: 50 with same data as types; 28, same
except Gressitt & Wilkes.
Discussion. — Stetholus papuanus Carter was described from 7 specimens
taken by C. T. McNamara at 1300 ft. on Mt. Lamington, Northeast Papua
(Carter, 1930). This species was transferred to Potamophilus by Hinton
98
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
(1935, p. 173). The specimens upon which I base the description of the new
genus Parapotamophilus and the species P. gressitti were examined by
Sato (1973) and assigned by him to Potamophilus papuanus (Carter). My
initial reason for assuming that gressitti is distinct from papuanus was that
Carter described the pronotum thus: “. . . the posterior angles bidentate,
formed by a deep subcircular excision, each tooth acute . . . His figure
of papuanus (Fig. 13) agrees with this description, showing two acute and
prominent teeth. In gressitti the posterior angles are feebly and inconspic¬
uously bidentate, the teeth not acute, and the excision could hardly be said
to form the bidentate condition since both teeth occur at or near the pos¬
terolateral border of the excision. Examination of one of Carter’s syntypes,
kindly sent to me by Dr. C. M. F. von Hayek of the British Museum (Natural
History), bears out the accuracy of Carter’s description and illustration.
Fortunately, this syntype happened to be a male. Although the apices of
both penis and parameres are missing, the structure of the aedeagus (Figs.
59, 60) is typical of Potamophilus, rather than Parapotamophilus . I might
add that it was Sato’s figure of the aedeagus of what he thought to be P.
papuanus that led me to suspect that the specimens he examined repre¬
sented a new genus, since the aedeagal structure was so different from that
of other species of Potamophilus.
Pseudodisersus, new genus
(Figs. 5, 61-64)
Form . — Oblong .
Vestiture. — Covered with fine, dense pubescence above and below and
on legs.
Pronotum. — (Figs. 5, 61) Transverse; narrowed anteriorly; with a deep,
anterior, transverse impression and a distinct, median, longitudinal impres¬
sion extending from base to anterior transverse impression; sides narrowly
margined; posterior angles bidentate; posterior margin raised medially.
Elytra. — Long and narrow; slightly broader across humeri than pronotum;
tapering from humeri; acute and slightly divergent at apices; without acces¬
sory striae; intervals only slightly raised, none carinate.
Hind wings. — Venation like that figured for Disersus (Fig. 16); without
radial cross-vein; with closed anal cell; vein 1A interrupted between cross¬
vein cu-a and wing margin; veins 2A1 and 2A2 fused; vein 3AX joining 2A3
on posterior margin of anal cell slightly distal to base of cell.
Prosternum short in front of coxae; with anterior margin reflected; pro¬
cess very broadly triangular and shallowly excavated, rounded at apex.
Me so sternum transverse, with deep subcircular excavation to accom¬
modate prosternal process extending to posterior margin.
Metasternum divided by a narrow, median, longitudinal groove; disk
broadly and rather shallowly excavated on each side of midline.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
99
63
O.S
Figs. 59-64. Figs. 59, 60. Potamophilus papuanus, aedeagus in dorsal and lateral aspects,
drawn from syntype in British Museum (Natural History). Apices of penis and parameres
apparently broken off. Figs. 61-64. Pseudodisersus coquereli n. sp. Fig. 61. Pronotum, dorsal
aspect; Fig. 62. Female genitalia; Figs. 63-64. Aedeagus in dorsal and lateral aspects.
Abdomen with only 5 visible segments in both sexes; segments 1-4 pro¬
gressively shorter; tapering from posterior margin of segment 2 to narrow
apex; segment 1 on each side with a longitudinal carina extending from
mesal anterior margin of coxal cavity to apical (posterior) third, feebly ex¬
cavated between carinae.
100
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Legs very compressed and flattened; hind legs shortest and least flattened;
tarsal claws without basal teeth.
Genitalia. — Aedeagus of male (Figs. 63, 64) long and slender; basal piece
long and well-developed; penis long and slender; parameres not fused, long
and slender but shorter than penis, acute at apex. Female genitalia (Fig. 62)
with both coxites and styli short; coxites broad at base; struts long and
slender.
Etymology. — The generic name is masculine and combines the prefix
pseudo, meaning false, with Disersus, the genus from which it is being
extracted.
Type-species. — Pseudodisersus coquereli, new species, which is de¬
scribed below.
Pseudodisersus coquereli, new species
(Figs. 61-64)
Size. — Length 6. 4-6. 8 mm; width 2. 1-2.4 mm.
Coloration. — Body dark reddish brown, darker on head and thorax; an¬
tennae testaceous to brown.
Head. — Smooth, rounded, without noticeable impressions; finely punc¬
tate and pubescent. Antennae short, subequal in length to width of head
across eyes; pubescent. Clypeus short and transverse, 6 times broader than
long; anterior margin straight, bordered by a row of curved, eyelash-like
setae. Labrum transverse, 3 times broader than long; angles rounded; an¬
terior margin bordered by a fringe of pale hairs. Mandible not prominent,
with only 1 apical tooth visible in pinned specimens. Maxillary palp pubes¬
cent, rather inconspicuous; segment 4 subequal in length to segment 3 but
darker in color, with sensory apex diagonal, subcircular, and flattened or
feebly concave. Labium with long, pale hairs arising from mentum, pre-
mentum, and subapical segment of palp; palp with distal segment dark,
compressed, and similar in size to sensory apex of maxillary palp. Gula
slightly transverse, narrower than mentum, subequal to postmentum, with
all 4 margins emarginate.
Pronotum. — (Fig. 61) Length 1.3-1. 5 mm; width 1.95-2.20 mm. Median
longitudinal impression bordered on each side by a rounded, slightly diag¬
onal prominence extending from basal quarter to apical quarter. On each
side, between this prominence and the lateral margin with another rounded
longitudinal prominence parallelling the lateral margin. Also on each side,
posterior to submedian prominence and parallelling posterior margin, with
a low transverse ridge culminating submedially in a conspicuous, dorsally
projecting, digitiform prominence just anterior to scutellum. Anterior margin
collar-like, feebly bisinuate; posterior margin bisinuate on each side; on
each side with posterior angle acute and depressed, sub-basal tooth raised
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
101
and forming posterior end of lateral marginal flange; sides converging ar-
cuately from sub-basal tooth to apical collar, in apical tenth parallel; anterior
angles rectangular.
Scutellum triangular, elongate, raised posteriorly.
Elytra more than 2 times longer than wide (5. 5:2. 4 mm); humeri not very
prominent.
Legs pubescent except middle tibia and distal half of outer surface of hind
tibia, which are glabrous. Measurements: front femur 1.7 mm, tibia 1.9 mm,
tarsus except claw 1.25 mm; middle femur 2.0 mm, tibia 1.75 mm, tarsus
1.25 mm; hind femur 1.9 mm, tibia 1.65 mm, tarsus 1.15 mm.
Male genitalia as figured (Figs. 63, 64); penis subequal in length to basal
piece, slightly expanded and laterally flanged beyond tips of parameres,
apex feebly decurved and bluntly rounded; parameres two-thirds as long as
penis, tapering from base to acute apex, curved feebly inward at apex.
Female. — Like male, but with metastemum and abdominal segment 1
more shallowly excavated, and with abdominal segment 5 rounded at apex.
Last abdominal tergite also with apex rounded, instead of acute as in male.
Genitalia (Fig. 62) with each coxite bearing about 8 apical or subapical,
erect, blunt, spinose setae in addition to a few, short, ordinary setae.
Habitat. — Though Coquerel (1851) states that Goudot’s specimens were
close to water on moist rocks in the middle of a fast-flowing river along with
adults of Hexanchorus cordillierae (Guerin) 1843, I would suspect from the
morphology of those I have examined that adults of Pseudodisersus co-
quereli n. sp. are typically submerged in fast, shallow water as described
by Stride (1955) for Potamodytes tuberosus.
Types. — Holotype: male, COLOMBIA, Sharp Coll., 1905-313. Allotype
female: COLOMBIA, Bogota, Sharp Coll., 1905-313. Paratypes: 5 with
same data as holotype; 4, COLOMBIA without further data (2 from H. E.
Hinton Coll, but not collected by him); 1, Andes. Location of types: Ho¬
lotype, allotype, and 8 paratypes in British Museum (Natural History), 2
paratypes in Stovall Museum of Science and History, Norman, Okla.
Etymology. — The species is named for Dr. Jean Charles Coquerel, whose
description enabled me to determine that the specimens he had examined
represented a new genus.
Discussion. — When Sharp (1882) erected the genus Disersus for D. lon-
gipennis Sharp 1882, he noted that Potamophilus goudotii Guerin 1843 also
belonged to his new genus, but did not mention Potamophilus cacicus Co¬
querel 1851. Sharp was primarily concerned with separating these neotrop¬
ical species from the European Potamophilus, and concentrated upon ven¬
tral characters such as prosternal and mesostemal configuration. Following
suit in employing ventral characters, Grouvelle (1896) transferred P. cacicus
to Disersus and created 3 new genera, Potamophilops, Potamophilinus, and
Potamodytes. Zaitzev (1910) and Blackwelder (1944) continued to list Ion-
102
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
gipennis, goudotii, and cacicus as members of the genus Disersus. Hinton
(1940) presumably had not examined specimens of goudotii when he pre¬
pared his key, for he made no mention of this species although the key
character he used to distinguish Disersus (absence of an anterior, trans¬
verse, pronotal impression) would exclude goudotii from the genus. Ap¬
parently Hinton also failed to notice that Coquerel (1851) employed this
character in his key to separate goudotii from cacicus. It was this feature
of Coquerel’ s key that alerted me to the fact that goudotii might require the
creation of a new genus.
Pseudo disersus n. g. differs from Disersus, Lara, Hydora, and Phano-
cerus in having the pronotum with a distinct transverse impression in the
anterior third and bidentate posterior angles. From Hexanchorus, Hispanio-
lara, and Potamophilops it differs in having a deep, median, longitudinal
pronotal impression. In size, shape, and general aspect, Pseudodisersus
most resembles Potamophilops from central Brazil. The genitalia are dis¬
tinctive, but probably closest to those of Disersus.
Guerin (1843) described Potamophilus goudotii from specimens collected
by Justin Goudot from the Rio Chipalo in New Grenada during September
and October of 1842 and deposited, I presume, in the Paris Museum. Co¬
querel (1851) apparently redescribed the species from the same material. I
have not seen these specimens, nor have I been able to determine just where
the Rio Chipalo is located. From Sharp (1882) and Blackwelder (1944), I
gather that it is in Colombia, in some mountainous region. Fortunately, the
British Museum (Natural History) has a number of specimens from the
Sharp Collection identified as members of this species, and it is upon this
material that I have based my descriptions. Since Coquerel’ s description
indicates that Goudot’ s specimens were larger than those I have seen (7 mm
long, 2.5 mm wide as compared with 6. 4-6. 8 mm long and 2. 1-2.4 mm
wide), and apparently differ from my description in details concerning the
pronotum, I presume that they represent a different species of Pseudodi¬
sersus, and it is appropriate that I describe the new one. If future compar¬
ison of the two series indicates that they represent a single species, the type-
species of Pseudodisersus will become P. goudotii (Guerin) 1843 instead of
P. coquereli Brown. If the descriptions are accurate, goudotii (Fig. 5) differs
from coquereli (Fig. 61) in having the pronotum with posterior angles acute
and raised and the median longitudinal impression with elevated edges, as
well as in being larger as mentioned above.
I have collected several larvae in mountain streams near Bogota, Colom¬
bia, which are probably those of Pseudodisersus. They will be described
elsewhere. The larva from Bolivia tentatively attributed to Disersus by Hin¬
ton (1940) in his key to larval elmids probably represents Pseudodisersus
instead.
The creation of this new genus necessitates a few changes in the definition
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
103
or diagnosis of the genus Disersus; that given below is from Sharp (1882),
with features added which differentiate this from related genera.
Disersus Sharp 1882
(Figs. 4, 16)
Diagnosis. — Body elongate, clothed with short, dense pubescence. La-
brum very broad, wider than clypeus. Antennae widely separated at base,
1 1 -segmented, with basal segment elongate, segment 2 simple, almost trans¬
verse, 3-11 subequal. Anterior coxae very widely separated. Prostemum
subtriangular, extremely short in front of coxae. Mesocoxae also widely
separated. Mesosternum with large, deep excavation to accommodate pro-
sternal process extending to metasternal border. Legs long; anterior femora
especially elongate; tibiae compressed. Pronotum transverse, narrowed an¬
teriorly; without anterior, transverse impression; posterior angles simple
and acute; posterior margin not raised. Scutellum not raised. Elytra with
humeri not prominent and not much broader than base of pronotum; without
accessory striae; divergent and acute at apex. Hind wings (Fig. 16) without
radial cross-vein; with closed anal cell; vein 1A interrupted between cross¬
vein cu-a and wing margin; veins 2At and 2A2 fused; vein 3AX joining 2A3
on posterior margin of anal cell distal to base of cell. Abdomen with 5 visible
segments; segments 1-4 progressively shorter. Male genitalia very elongate
and slender; basal piece longer than penis; penis longer than parameres.
Female genitalia with coxites short and broad; styli short.
Acknowledgments
I wish to acknowledge assistance as follows: Dr. C. M. F. von Hayek,
British Museum (Natural History), for the loan of specimens from Colom¬
bia, New Guinea, Australia, and New Zealand; Dr. G. A. Samuelson, Bern¬
ice P. Bishop Museum, for the loan of specimens from New Guinea; Ms.
Karen Herbst for photography and inking of drawings; the Faculty Research
Committee of the University of Oklahoma for Polaroid film which has been
indispensable in recording far more features, especially of dissections
mounted on microscope slides, than can be included in the published pa¬
per. I also express my appreciation of the many artists whose work is re¬
produced here, particularly Mary Brown Catron and Ramona Kaatz Garcia.
Literature Cited
Blackwelder, R. E. 1944. Checklist of the coleopterous insects of Mexico, Central America,
the West Indies, and South America. Part 2. U.S. Natl. Mus. Bull., 185:189-341.
Bollow, H. 1938. Monographic der palaearktischen Dryopidae mit Beriicksichtigung der ev-
entuell transgradierenden Arten (Col.). Mitt. Munch. Entomol. Ges., 28:147-187.
Broun, Thomas. 1882. Alteration of generic names. Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist., (5)9:409.
104
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Carter, H. J. 1926. Revision of the Australian species of Anilara (Fam. Buprestidae) and
Helmis (Fam. Dryopidae) with notes and description of other Australian Coleoptera.
Proc. Linn. Soc. New South Wales, 51:50-71.
Carter, H. J. 1930. Australian Coleoptera. Notes and new species. VII. Proc. Linn. Soc. New
South Wales, 55(2): 179-190, PI. IV.
Carter, H. J., and E. H. Zeck. 1929. A monograph of the Australian Dryopidae. Australian
Zool., 6(l):50-72, Pis. I- VII.
Coquerel, Charles. 1851. Monographic du genre Potamophilus. Rev. Mag. Zool., (2)3:591—
603, PI. 15.
Deleve, Joseph. 1963. Contribution a l’etude des Dryopoidea. V. Note sur les divisions gene-
riques des Larinae d’Afrique (Coleoptera Elminthidae) et descriptions d’especes nou-
velles. Bull. & Ann. Soc. Roy. Entomol. Belg., 99(30):43 1-458.
Deleve, Joseph. 1966. Dryopidae et Elminthidae de 1’ Angola. Publ. Cult. Companhia de Dia-
mantes de Angola, Lisboa, 76:39-62.
Deleve, Joseph. 1967. Contribution a l’etude des Dryopoidea (Coleoptera). XIX. Notes di-
verses et descriptions d’especes nouvelles. Bull. Ann. Soc. Roy. Entomol. Belg.,
103:414-446.
Fairmaire, L. 1889. Diagnoses de Coleopteres Madecasses. Ann. Soc. Entomol. Belg. 33,
Compt. Rend., 90-96.
Forbes, W. T. M. 1926. The wing folding patterns of the Coleoptera. J. N.Y. Entomol. Soc.,
34:42-68, 91-139.
Germar, E. F. 1811. Neue Schrift. d. Naturf. Gesellsch. z. Halle, 6:41, PI. 1, Fig. 6.
Grouvelle, A. 1896. Note sur les subdivisions generiques des potamophiliens (Col.). Bull.
Soc. Entomol. France, 1896:77-79.
Grouvelle, A. 1920. Dryopidae, Georyssidae et Heteroceridae. Voy. Alluaud-Jeannel, Result.
Sc. Coleopteres, 3(15): 193-228, PI. 9.
Guerin-Meneville, F. E. 1843. Insectes nouveaux, observes sur les plateaux des cordillieres
et dans les vallees chaudes de la Nouvelle-Grenade. Rev. Zool., 1:12-22.
Hinton, H. E. 1936. New Dryopidae from the Japan Empire. Entomol., 69:1-5.
Hinton, H. E. 1937. New African Larinae (Coleoptera, Dryopidae). Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist.,
Ser. 10, 19(1 10): 289-304.
Hinton, H. E. 1940. A monographic revision of the Mexican water beetles of the family
Elmidae. Novit. Zool., 42(2):217-396.
Hinton, H. E. 1948. Coleoptera: Dryopidae and Elmidae. London, Brit. Mus. (Nat. Hist.)
Expedition to South-west Arabia. 1937-38, 1:133-140.
King, Rev. R. L. 1865. Description of Australian species of Georyssides and Parnides. Trans.
Entomol. Soc. New South Wales, 1:158-161.
LeConte, J. L. 1852. Papers on Coleoptera: Synopsis of the Parnidae of the United States.
Proc. Phil. Acad. Nat. Sci. Hist., 6:41-45.
Nomura, Sizumu. 1958. Notes on the Japanese Dryopoidea, with two species from Saghalien.
Toho-Gakuho, 8:45-59.
Sato, Masataka. 1973. Notes on dryopoid beetles from New Guinea. Pacific Insects, 15(3—
4);463— 47 1 .
Sharp, David. 1882. Heteroceridae, Parnidae, Georyssidae. Biol. Centrali-Amer., Insecta,
Col., 1(2): 116-141.
Stride, G. O. 1955. On the respiration of an aquatic African beetle, Potamodytes tuberosus
Hinton. Ann. Entomol. Soc. Amer., 48(5): 344-351.
Zaitzev, P. 1910. Fam. Dryopidae. In Junk, W. and S. Schenkling, Coleopterorum Catalogus,
Pars 17, pp. 1-47. Junk, Berlin.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 105-123
NEW SPECIES OF NORTH AMERICAN HYDROPORUS,
NIGER-TENEBROSUS GROUP (COLEOPTERA: DYTISCIDAE)
R. D. Gordon
Systematic Entomology Laboratory, IIBIII,
Agricultural Research Sci. & Educ. Admin., USDA1
The information presented here is part of a doctoral dissertation entitled
“A revision of the niger-tenebrosus group of Hydroporus (Coleoptera: Dy¬
tiscidae),” completed in 1969. As with many such theses, the likelihood of
seeing it published in the entirety becomes more remote as time goes by.
Therefore I welcome the opportunity to publish at least the most critical
portion as a tribute to Hugh Leech.
When I was an enthusiastic collector of water beetles as a student at
North Dakota State University, Hugh Leech was one of my idols. I was
positively impressed with the quality of his published work and can still
recall the sort of trepidation with which I composed my first letter to him.
Better still, I can recall the thrill of receiving his prompt reply, and being
amazed at the length of it. I can now well appreciate the amount of time he
must have spent in responding to an unknown amateur. That was the first
of many such letters over the years, and no matter what my questions were,
or what specimens I might send or request, or what literature I might need,
the response from Hugh Leech was always the same: prompt, complete,
and unfailingly encouraging. Several years have passed since then, and I
am, hopefully, slightly further along as a taxonomist, but Hugh remains a
very special person to me. Rarely is one privileged to work contempora¬
neously in the same research area with a person as universally respected as
Hugh, and I am grateful to have had the opportunity. I dedicate this paper
to him, for without his encouragement and help, it might never have been
initiated.
Fall (1923) wrote the first revision of the niger-tenebrosus group which
is the only complete treatment of that group. Much of the difficulty en¬
countered by Fall in separating species still exists; examination of male
genitalia has alleviated the problems somewhat, but the group remains prob¬
ably the most difficult among all of the North American Dytiscidae. The
niger-tenebrosus group is one of 4 groups proposed by Fall (1923) for North
American members of the genus Hydroporus Clairville. Sharp (1882), in his
monograph on the Dytiscidae of the world, split Hydroporus into 8 groups,
and Fall modified Sharp’s system for the North American species. The other
3 groups of North American Hydroporus are: the pulcher-undulatus group,
106
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
oblitus group, and vilis group. Members of the niger-tenebrosus group are
nearctic, palearctic, or holarctic in distribution. Most New World species
are found in Canada and the northern United States with a few species
ranging south to Florida, Texas, and Arizona. One species is reported from
northern Mexico.
Larson (1975) published an excellent work on the Dytiscidae of Alberta,
in which he dealt with those species of the niger-tenebrosus group occurring
in that province. Larson described 3 new species, H. hockingi, H. criniti-
coxis and H. carri.
Type-material included herein has been deposited with the following in¬
stitutions or individuals (abbreviations listed are used in the text): California
Academy of Sciences (CAS); Frank Young, Indiana University (FNY); J.
R. Zimmermann, New Mexico State University (JRZ); Museum of Com¬
parative Zoology, Harvard University (MCZ); Robert Gordon (RDG); North
Carolina State University (NCS); Ohio University (OU); Field Museum of
Natural History (FM); Cornell University (CU); American Museum of Nat¬
ural History (AMNH); University of Idaho (UID); U.S. National Museum
of Natural History (USNM). The number of paratypes examined from each
locality is listed in front of each new locality.
Hydroporus boreus, new species
(Figs. 1, 2)
Holotype male. — Length 4.85 mm, width 2.10 mm. Form obovate, widest
posteriad to middle of elytra (Fig. 1). Head yellowish rufous with faint traces
of two triangular spots between the eyes; palpus and undersurface of head
yellowish rufous; antenna yellowish rufous, last four segments dark apically.
Pronotum yellowish rufous. Elytron light brown. Undersurface and legs
yellowish rufous.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by twice their diameter.
Pronotum faintly alutaceous; fine punctures on disc separated by twice
their diameter, punctures becoming nearly contiguous laterally and poste¬
riorly; equal in width to base of elytra; hind angle recurved; lateral margin
narrow, slightly wider than an anterior pro tarsal claw; pubescence fine,
almost lacking.
Elytron with alutaceous sculpture nearly absent, strongly shining; coarse¬
ly and densely punctured, punctures much larger than pronotal punctures,
separated by less than their diameter; pubescence fine and sparse; lateral
margin ascending in basal third.
Metasternal wing and plate and first two abdominal sterna with large
coarse punctures. Metacoxal process truncate at apex. Pro- and mesotarsi
narrowly dilated, three-fourths as wide as tibia, basal segment largest, sec¬
ond and third segments progressively smaller. Protarsal claws equal, ante-
1
Fig. 1. Habitus. Hydroporus boreus, n. sp.
108
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
rior claw just perceptibly thicker, claws half the length of last tarsal segment.
Aedeagus tapered from base to apex, the tip curved downward (Fig. 2).
Allotype. — Length 4.00 mm, width 1.90 mm. Similar to holotype except
dorsal surface dull, elytron definitely alutaceous with punctures much small¬
er than male. Pro- and mesotarsi dot dilated; protarsal claw simple.
Variation. — Length varies from 3.90 to 5.00 mm. The females average
slightly smaller than the males. In some specimens the pronotum appears
narrower than the elytra at the base, and the sides of the pronotum are not
as arcuately rounded as in more typical specimens.
Holotype. — Aklavik, N.W.T. (Northwest Territories), July 28, 1932, Lot
308, collected by Owen Bryant (CAS).
Allotype. — 60-75 mi. N of Rampart House, Alas. (Alaska), 23.6.12, J. M.
Jessup (USNM).
Paratypes. — Total 21, 5 same data as for holotype (CAS). 10, Aklavik,
N.W.T. (Northwest Territories), Aug. 13, 1932, Lot 319, collected by Owen
Bryant (CAS). 4, Aklavik, N.W.T., Aug. 20, 1930, Lot 108 (CAS) (USNM).
2, Umiat, Alaska, 5- VI-47, collected by K. L. Knight (USNM).
Comparative notes. — This species does not resemble any other in the
niger-tenebrosus group. As the groups are now defined it must fall here by
virtue of the truncate metacoxal process, but it most resembles some mem¬
bers of the pulcher-undulatus group. Of the members of the niger-tenebro¬
sus group it most nearly resembles dentellus, but it is distinguished by the
obovate shape, coarse elytral punctures of the male, and the protarsal claws
equal in length in the male.
The specific name refers to the northern distribution of this species.
Hydroporus leechi, new species
(Fig. 3)
Holotype male. — Length 5.50 mm, width 2.90 mm. Form elongate-oval,
widest at middle of elytra, sides nearly parallel in basal one-half of elytra.
Head piceous with a narrow, rufous, basal border; palpus fuscous, apical
segment piceous; undersurface of head reddish yellow; antennal segments
dark brown apically, reddish yellow basally. Pronotum black, lateral border
rufopiceous; legs, sides of abdominal sterna and apex of last abdominal
sternum rufous.
Head alutaceous, punctures fine, separated by less than to 4 times their
diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; disc densely punctured, punctures separated by
their diameter or slightly more, coarser marginal punctures contiguous or
nearly so, forming longitudinal wrinkles near lateral margins; equal in width
to base of elytra; hind angle abrupt, a right angle; lateral margin narrow,
about the width of a protarsal claw; pubescence fine, sparse.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
109
5
Figs. 2-5. Male genitalia of Hydroporus spp. Fig. 2, H. boreus (dorsal view). Fig. 3, H.
leechi (dorsal view). Fig. 4, H. signatus youngi (dorsal, ventral views). Fig. 5, H. signatus
signatus (dorsal, ventral views).
110
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Elytron not as strongly alutaceous as pronotum, shining; punctures finer
than on disc of pronotum, separated by their diameter or less; pubescence
fine, longer and denser than on pronotum; lateral margin broadly ascending
in basal one-third.
Metasternal wing and plate strongly alutaceous, indistinctly punctured;
abdominal sterna coarsely and densely punctured, especially so laterally.
Metacoxal process truncate at apex. Pro- and mesotarsi strongly dilated,
slightly wider than tibia, second pro tarsal segment widest, rounded. Pro-
tarsal claw elongate, equal in length, not sinuate, slightly longer than last
tarsal segment. Aedeagus long, slender, tapering to a point, side slightly
sinuate (Fig. 3).
Allotype. — Female not known.
Variation. — The type series does not vary except for length 5.35-5.50 mm
and width 2.80-2.90 mm.
Holotype. — San Mateo Co., California, Edgemar district of Pacifica, 4.6
mi. south of San Francisco Co. line; permanent pond E side Skyline Blvd.,
9-X-1967, Hugh B. Leech (CAS).
Paratypes. — Total 3. 2, UNITED STATES: California: same data as for
holotype (CAS) (USNM); 1, San Mateo Co., California, Skyline Pd., Ill- 16-
51, D. Rentz (CAS).
Comparative notes. — This species keys best to columbianus Fall in Fall’s
(1923) key to species. The male protarsal claw is as long or longer than the
last protarsal segment, and the punctures of the metasternal wing nearly
invisible in leechi. The male protarsal claw is Vi or less the length of the
last protarsal segment, and the punctures of the metasternal wing are distinct
in columbianus.
The specific name is in recognition of Hugh Leech’s life-long contribu¬
tions to water beetle systematics.
Hydroporus signatus youngi, new subspecies
(Figs. 4, 6)
Holotype male. — Length 4.15 mm, width 2.40 mm. Form oval, widest at
middle of elytra. Head rufous with traces of two dark triangular spots be¬
tween the eyes; palpus and undersurface of head rufous, last segment of
maxillary palpus piceous apically; antenna piceous, first two segments tes¬
taceous. Pronotum piceous, rufopiceous laterally. Elytron piceous, humeral
angle paler, traces of posterior marginal and subapical pale spot present.
Undersurface black; legs rufous; third through fifth abdominal sterna rufous
at sides, sixth sternum rufous at apex and sides.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by twice their diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; punctures on disc separated by twice their diame-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
111
ter, coarser marginal punctures nearly contiguous; equal in width to base
of elytra; hind angle abrupt, slightly recurved; lateral margin moderate, one
and a half times as wide as an anterior pro tarsal claw; pubescence fine, very
sparse.
Elytron alutaceous, feebly shining; densely punctured, punctures slightly
smaller than discal pronotal punctures, separated by their diameter; pubes¬
cence fine, denser on apical third; lateral margin straight from base to apex.
Metasternal wing and plate and first two abdominal sterna coarsely punc¬
tured. Metacoxal process truncate at apex. Pro- and mesotarsi moderately
dilated, as wide as tibia, segments equal in width. Pro tarsal claws equal,
both claws sharply bent at base, nearly parallel to tip, sinuate on inner
margin, as long as last tarsal segment. Aedeagus slightly constricted at mid¬
dle, anterior portion bulbous, apical projection very short (Fig. 4).
Allotype. — Length 3.80 mm, width 2.00 mm. Similar to holotype except
dorsal surface dull, elytron strongly alutaceous and minutely punctate; pro-
and mesotarsi not dilated, pro tarsal claw simple.
Variation. — Length varies from 3.90 to 4.20 mm in the male; 3.85 to 4.15
mm in the female. The markings on the elytra are more distinct in some
individuals than in others. A series from Scott’s Pond at Bloomington, In¬
diana, are lighter in color than normal and has elytral markings more dis¬
tinct.
Holotype. — Beltsville, Maryland, 8-VII-1961, P. J. Spangler, USNM
(72156). J
Allotype. — Same data as for holotype (USNM).
Paratypes.— Total 219. UNITED STATES: ALABAMA: Mobile, VI-5-
27, Darlington (MCZ); Mobile Co., Loding (MCZ); Novulicla?, VI-16-1931,
H. P. Loding; Camp Rucker, Ozark, 31-XII-1942, J. G. Franclemont (FNY);
Tumblin Gap (USNM), District of Columbia: Piney Branch, 2-5-05, DH
Clemons collector (USNM): WASHINGTON, Coll. Hubbard and Schwarz
(USNM). FLORIDA: Liberty County, 5.3 mi. S Bristol, VI-II-54, S Brown-
F N Young (FNY). GEORGIA: Decatur County, Flatwoods, 2.7 mi. NE
Faceville, VI-II-54, S Brown-F Young (FNY); Floyd County, Cave Spring,
IX-4-49, F N Young (FNY); Fulton County, Fort McPherson in Atlanta,
III-3 1-43 , F N Young (FNY); Hart County, Nuberg, IX-I-1943 (FNY); Ra¬
bun Co., July (CAS). INDIANA: Brown Co., IV-21-56, J. R. Zimmerman
( JRZ) ; Monroe Co., Bloomington, IV-26-56, V-ll-56, V-12-56, V-17-56, V-
22-56, VI-25-56, VII-1-56, VII-30-56, IX-8-56, X-5-56, X-ll-56, XI-13-56,
XII-3-56, X- 11-55, X- 18-55, J. R. Zimmerman (JRZ); Monroe Co., Hilltop
Pond, 1-29-50, F N Young (FNY); Monroe County, Scott’s Pond at Bloom¬
ington, X-II-49, VII-2-50, 11-24-51, IV-8-51, 11-11-52, IV-17-52, V-3-52, VI-
1-52, F N Young (FNY); Noble Co., X-26-56, J. R. Zimmerman (JRZ).
MARYLAND: Beltsville, 8-VII-1961, P. J. Spangler (USNM); Beltsville,
112
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Goldfish Pd., 9-V-1965, Robert Gordon (RDG); Friendship, 24-IV-1965, 8-
V-1965, Robert Gordon (RDG); Garrett Co., Deep Creek L., 13-VI-1965,
Robert Gordon (RDG); Marlboro, U. of Md. Tob. Fm., 25-V-1965, 29- VI-
1965, Robert Gordon (RDG); C&O Lock at Plummer’s Isl., VI-29- 1960, VII-
5-1960, IX-1-1960, P. J. Spangler (USNM); Potomac R., 16-V-1965, Robert
Gordon (RDG); Rosehaven, 27-III- 1 965 , 7-VIII-1965, Robert Gordon
(RDG). MISSOURI: Ashland, V-8-1955, P. J. Spangler (USNM); Columbia,
VIII-6-1953, P. J. Spangler (USNM); 5 mi. S Columbia, VIII-20-1953, M.
C. Grabau (USNM); Maramec Spring, St. Hiway 8, VII-2 1-1958, P. J. Span¬
gler (USNM). NEW JERSEY: Camden Co., VI-16-29, J. W. Green (CAS);
Lakehurst, 9-1-01 (USNM); Lakehurst, V-2-27 (MCZ). NORTH CAROLI¬
NA: N.C. (MCZ); Raleigh, 9-March-02, F. Sherman Jr. (NCS); Raleigh, 29-
April-03, C. S. Brimley (NCS); Swain Co., Bryson City, 8 mi. SW, V-18-
57, J. R. Zimmerman (JRZ). OHIO: Athens Co., 15- VI-1960, 15-VII-1960,
J. Stanley (OU); Armitage, Athens Co., VI-7-1951, P. J. Spangler (USNM);
Athens Airport, Athens Co., 5-16-1950, 5-21-1951, 5-22-1951, 5-23-1951, VI-
3-1951, Paul J. Spangler (USNM); Champaign Co., Cedar Run, July 24,
1964, J. L. Williams (USNM); 10-21-50, Jackson, Jackson Co., P. J. Span¬
gler (USNM); 11-5-50, 5 mi. W of Chillicothe, Ross Co., P. J. Spangler
(USNM). PENNSYLVANIA: Annville, Water Works, 6- VI-1965, Robert
Gordon (RDG); Stony Creek, Lebanon Co., VI-22-1953, P. J. Spangler
(USNM). SOUTH CAROLINA: Clemson College, IV-22-1928, 24 Nov.
1929, 12 Jun. 1930, 15 Mch. 1931, 24 Mch. 1931, D. Dunavan coll. (USNM);
Rocky Bottom, Pickens Co., 14 May 1931, 20 Sept. 1931, D. Dunavan coll.
(USNM); Walhalla, 24 Mch. 1929, D. Dunavan coll. (USNM); Windsor, 25
Nov. 1933, David Dunavan (USNM). TENNESSEE: Bluegrass, 31-X-40,
G. Keener (CAS). VIRGINIA: Mt. Vernon, Fairfax Co., VIII-1-1919, E.
Shoemaker collector (USNM); Fredskbg., 7-73, 9-93, 3-19-99, 3-30-99, 9-2-
00 (USNM); Giles County, pond near Mt. Lake, VII-22-1959 (FNY); Ivy,
June 1933, F. E. Winters (CAS); Beaver Pond Mt. Lake, 22-VIII-41, A. C.
Cole (CAS); Warm Springs, 10-6 (USNM); Washington, 15-V-1965, Robert
Gordon (RDG). WEST VIRGINIA: Swimming Pool, Droop Mt., June 9,
1933 (FNY); Smoke Hole, Pendleton Co., Aug. 7-30, J. G. Needham (FM)
(CU); Ripley, 6-25-1930, P N Musgrave (FM) (CU).
Comparative notes. — A comparison of the male genitalia (Figs. 4, 5) is
necessary to separate youngi from typical signatus Mannerheim (to which
it will go in Fall’s key 1923) with certainty, but the two can usually be
distinguished when seen in series. H. youngi is larger and the punctures on
the pronotal disc and elytra are much more dense, the metasternal plate is
coarsely punctured and nearly equal to the metasternal wing in this respect,
while nominate signatus has the punctures of the metasternal plate distinctly
smaller than on the metasternal wing. Color differs considerably in typical
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
113
6
Fig. 6. Distribution of H. signatus signatus (lined area) and H. signatus youngi (dotted
area).
examples of the two subspecies. H. signatus has the head usually a uniform
piceous, whereas youngi has either a plain rufous head or more typically
with two dark triangular spots between the eyes. The elytron in youngi is
much darker than signatus and the form is more regularly oval. The nom¬
inate form and youngi intergrade in New Jersey and Indiana (Fig. 6).
The specific epithet is a genitive of the surname of Frank Young, to whom
I dedicate this subspecies in recognition of his contributions to water beetle
taxonomy.
114
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hydroporus simplex, new species
(Fig. 7)
Holotype male. — Length 5.25 mm, width 2.80 mm. Form elongate oval,
widest at middle of elytra. Head piceous with pale clypeal margin and pale
posterior transverse band; palpus and entire undersurface of head rufous;
antenna rufous; segments piceous in apical third. Pronotum black, paler
laterally. Elytron brown. Undersurface black except abdomen rufous, legs
rufous.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by one or two times their
diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; fine punctures on disc separated by twice their
diameter, punctures becoming coarser laterally, nearly contiguous; equal in
width to base of elytra; hind angle abrupt; lateral margin wide, two and one-
half times as wide as an anterior protarsal claw; pubescence fine, sparse.
Elytron alutaceous, shining; finely and densely punctured, punctures
equal in size to basal pronotal punctures, separated by less than their di¬
ameter; pubescence fine, sparse; lateral margin ascending in basal third.
Metasternal wing and plate and first two abdominal sterna coarsely punc¬
tured. Metacoxal process just perceptibly protruding at apex. Protarsus
slightly dilated, much narrower than tibia, third segment narrower than first
and second, parallel sided; mesotarsus not dilated. Protarsal claws unequal,
anterior claw slightly shorter, thickened, claws half the length of the last
tarsal segment. Aedeagus parallel sided, narrowing to a blunt point in apical
fourth (Fig. 7).
Allotype. — Length 5.00 mm, width 2.80 mm. Similar to holotype except
for the equal and unmodified protarsal claws.
Variation. — No apparent variation is evident in the short type series. A
single aberrant female has only two tarsal segments on the left protarsus
with normal claws appearing on the second segment.
Holotype. — Pinecrest, Tuolumne Co. (California), 13-VII-1948, collected
by P. H. Arnaud (CAS).
Allotype. — Same data as for holotype (CAS).
Paratypes. — Total 8. Same data as for holotype (CAS) (USNM).
Comparative notes. — Males of this species can be separated easily from
males of other species in the same size range by the very narrow protarsus.
It is closest to subpubescens LeConte and columbianus Fall, both of which
have the protarsus as wide or wider than the tibia. Females can be separated
from columbianus by size, which averages nearly 1 mm less than colum¬
bianus. Females of subpubescens are dull dorsally while females of simplex
are as shiny as the male. If the rufous abdomen proves to be a constant
character, it will easily separate this species from all other western members
of the group. If this species is restricted to California and bordering states,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
115
9 10
Figs. 7-10. Male genitalia of Hydroporus spp. Fig. 7, H. simplex (dorsal, ventral views).
Fig. 8, H. utahensis (dorsal, ventral views). Fig. 9, H. hirsutus (dorsal, ventral views). Fig.
10, H. californicus (dorsal, ventral views).
as may well be the case, subpubescens is the only species with which it
may be confused.
The specific epithet refers to the lack of any outstanding morphological
characteristic in this species.
116
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hydroporus utahensis, new species
(Fig. 8)
Holotype male. — Length 4.50 mm, width 2.50 mm. Form elongate-oval,
widest at middle of elytra. Head rufopiceous with a pale posterior transverse
band; gena black, rest of undersurface of head rufous; antenna rufopiceous,
first two segments rufous. Pronotum rufopiceous becoming rufous laterally.
Elytron slightly paler than pronotum. Undersurface black; legs rufous; faint
rufous spot present on lateral margin of the third abdominal sternum.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by one and one-half times
their diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; fine punctures on disc separated by twice their
diameter, coarser and nearly contiguous laterally and posteriorly; equal in
width to base of elytra; hind angle abrupt; lateral margin wide, three to four
times as wide as an anterior protarsal claw; pubescence fine, very sparse.
Elytron alutaceous, shining; densely and evenly punctured, punctures small¬
er than basal punctures of pronotum, separated by their diameter; pubes¬
cence fine, sparse; lateral margin slightly ascending in basal third.
Metasternal wing and plate and first two abdominal sterna coarsely punc¬
tured. Metacoxal process slightly angulate at apex. Pro- and mesotarsi
slightly dilated, narrower than tibia, segments one and two subequal in
width, third segment slightly narrower. Protarsal claws equal, unmodified,
half the length of last tarsal segment. Aedeagus long, slender, with a con¬
striction in basal third, tapering gradually to a rounded tip (Fig. 8).
Allotype. — Length 4.35 mm, width 2.30 mm. Similar to holotype except
dorsal surface slightly more alutaceous; punctures of elytron smaller, less
distinct; pro- and mesotarsi not dilated; protarsal claw simple.
Variation. — One male in the type series is only 4.35 mm long, the rest are
as for the holotype. The metacoxal process is flat in some specimens and
perceptibly angulate in others. One male in the series is strongly alutaceous
and dull in appearance.
Holotype. — Utah Lake East Side (Utah), No. 196 Exp., 7-6-41 NE, Elv.
4000 W, collected by H. P. Chandler (CAS).
Allotype. — Utah Lake East Side (Utah), No. 192 Exp., 7-6-41 NE, Elv.
4000 SW, collected by H. P. Chandler (CAS).
Paratypes. — Total 5. Same data as for holotype (CAS) (USNM).
Comparative notes. — This species resembles despectus Sharp and hir-
tellus LeConte. The broad constriction of the aedeagus in the basal third is
a characteristic not shared by either despectus or rusticus, both of which
have that portion of the aedeagus either not constricted, or with a feeble
constriction occupying the basal two-thirds. The lateral margin of the prono¬
tum is wider in utahensis than any of the related species. The punctures of
the pronotum and elytra are fine in utahensis, much finer than those of
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
117
despectus, the gena is piceous or at least considerably darker than the
submentum of utahensis, whereas the gena and submentum are the same
color in despectus. The form of utahensis is more elongate than that of
hirtellus and the elytral punctures, while nearly as fine as in hirtellus, are
not nearly as dense. H. similaris Fall may also be confused with this species,
but similaris males have the anterior protarsal claw distinctly shorter than
the posterior.
The species name refers to the state in which the material was collected.
Hydroporus hirsutus, new species
(Fig. 9)
Holotype male. — Length 3.90 mm, width 1.90 mm. Form elongate, nearly
parallel sided, widest at middle of elytra. Head piceous with clypeal margin
and posterior transverse band rufous; last segment of maxillary palpus and
gena piceous, rest of undersurface of head rufous; antenna rufopiceous, first
two segments rufous. Pronotum piceous becoming rufopiceous laterally.
Elytron brown. Undersurface black; legs rufous.
Head alutaceous; punctures moderately coarse, separated by one or one
and one-half times their diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; moderately coarse punctures on disc separated by
twice their diameter, nearly contiguous posteriorly and laterally; equal in
width to base of elytra; hind angle abrupt; lateral margin moderate, one and
one-half times as wide as an anterior protarsal claw; pubescence fine,
sparse.
Elytron slightly alutaceous, strongly shining; coarsely and evenly punc¬
tured, punctures larger than those on pronotum, separated by their diame¬
ter; pubescence fine, quite dense, particularly so laterally and posteriorly;
lateral margin very slightly ascending in basal third.
Metasternal plate finely punctured; metasternal wing and first two abdom¬
inal sterna coarsely punctured. Metacoxal process angulate at apex. Pro-
and mesotarsi narrowly dilated, not as wide as tibia, segments one and two
equal, third segment smaller. Anterior protarsal claw slightly shorter than
posterior, protarsal claw half the length of last tarsal segment. Aedeagus
constricted in basal third, gradually narrowing to a blunt point in apical third
(Fig. 9).
Allotype. — Length 4.00 mm, width 1.90 mm. Similar to holotype except
alutaceous sculpture more evident on elytron; pro- and mesotarsi not dilat¬
ed; protarsal claws equal in length.
Variation. — A few specimens in the series are slightly more alutaceous
than the holotype. The degree of pubescence varies slightly but this is prob¬
ably the result of handling the specimens.
118
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Holotype. — Mt. Goethe, Fresno Co., Calif. (California), 9-VII-1952,
12,600 ft. elev., collected by Peter Raven (CAS).
Allotype. — Same data as for holotype (CAS).
Paratypes. — Total 14. Same data as for holotype (CAS) (USNM).
Comparative notes. — This species most nearly resembles pervicinus Fall
and calif ornicus, new species. It can be separated from pervicinus by the
piceous last segment of the maxillary palpus and by the much finer punc-
tation of the metasternal plate. The male protarsal claws are nearly equal,
whereas in pervicinus the anterior protarsal claw is much shorter than the
posterior. H. hirsutus, new species, can be separated from californicus by
the narrow, elongate shape and much denser pubescence, both dorsally and
ventrally.
The type series was taken at an altitude of 12,600 feet, and the species
may possibly be restricted to high elevations. The specimens are unusually
pubescent, in this respect resembling some of our small arctic species.
The specific epithet refers to the unusually distinctive pubescence.
Hydroporus californicus, new species
(Fig. 10)
Holotype male. — Length 3.85 mm, width 2.00 mm. Form oval, widest
anteriad to middle of elytra. Head piceous with posterior transverse rufous
band; gena and last segment of maxillary palpus piceous, rest of undersur¬
face of head rufous; antenna piceous, first two segments rufous. Pronotum
piceous becoming rufopiceous laterally. Elytron brown. Undersurface
black, legs rufous.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by twice their diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; moderately coarse punctures on disc separated by
twice their diameter, coarser and nearly contiguous laterally and posteriorly;
equal in width to base of elytra; hind angle abrupt, slightly recurved; lateral
margin twice as wide as an anterior protarsal claw; pubescence fine, very
sparse.
Elytron alutaceous, shining, evenly punctured, punctures larger than on
pronotum, separated by their diameter; pubescence fine, very sparse; lateral
margin ascending slightly in basal third.
Metasternal plate finely punctured; metasternal wing and first two abdom¬
inal sterna coarsely punctured. Metacoxal process slightly angulate at apex.
Pro- and mesotarsi slightly dilated, narrower than tibia, segments one and
two equal, third segment slightly narrower. Protarsal claws nearly equal in
length, anterior claw just perceptibly shorter, claws half the length of last
tarsal segment. Aedeagus narrow, feebly constricted medially, enlarged api-
cally before tapering to a blunt point (Fig. 10).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
119
Allotype. — Length 3.8 mm, width 2.00 mm. Identical to holotype in all
respects except that the pro- and mesotarsi are not dilated.
Variation. — The degree to which the metacoxal process is produced var¬
ies from just perceptibly angulate to definitely so.
Holotype. — Mono Co., Cal. (California), round pond on ridge S of Leavitt
Mdw., 13-VII-1963, collected by H. B. Leech (CAS).
Allotype. — Same data as for holotype (CAS).
Paratypes. — Total 22, 21, same data as for holotype; 1, California, Men¬
docino Co. Univ. Cal. Range Exp. Sta., pond by deerpen, about 4 mi. NE
of Hopland, 30- VI-1963, collected by H. B. Leech (CAS) (USNM).
Comparative notes. — This species is closest to hirtellus LeConte in ap¬
pearance. In series it averages obviously smaller than hirtellus. The elytral
punctures are coarser and not as dense. The punctation of the metacoxal
plate in hirtellus is coarse, not appreciably different than the punctures of
the metasternal wing and first two abdominal sterna. In californicus the
punctation of the metacoxal plate is fine, much finer than metasternal wing
or first two abdominal sterna. H. californicus may also be confused with
hirsutus, new species, but see comparative notes under hirsutus.
The species name refers to the state in which the type material was col¬
lected.
Hydroporus fatigus, new species
(Fig. 11)
Holotype male. — Length 4.25 mm, width 2.25 mm. Form elongate oval,
widest at middle of elytra. Head rufopiceous with pale posterior transverse
band; palpus rufous, terminal segments darker; undersurface of head rufous
with gena darker; antenna rufopiceous, first two segments rufous. Pronotum
piceous, becoming paler laterally. Elytron brownish piceous, humeral angle
paler; undersurface black; legs rufous with femora darker medially. Third
and fourth abdominal sterna rufous laterally.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by twice their diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; fine punctures on disc separated by two or three
times their diameter, punctures slightly larger at margins, separated by their
diameter; equal in width to base of elytra; hind angle abrupt; lateral margin
wide, twice as wide as an anterior protarsal claw; pubescence fine, sparse.
Elytron alutaceous, shining; moderately coarsely punctured throughout,
punctures slightly larger than basal pronotal punctures, separated by their
diameter; pubescence fine, sparse; lateral margins slightly ascending in basal
third.
Metasternal wing and plate and first two abdominal sterna coarsely punc¬
tured. Metacoxal process strongly angulate at apex. Protarsus slightly di-
120
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
lated, narrower than tibia, segments equal in width; mesotarsus not dilated.
Protarsal claws equal, anterior claw slightly thickened, claws less than half
the length of last tarsal segment. Aedeagus narrow, pinched at basal third,
narrowing to a blunt point apically (Fig. 11).
Allotype. — Length 4.20 mm, width 2.00 mm. Similar to holotype in all
respects except that the color of the abdomen is entirely rufous; protarsus
not dilated, protarsal claws simple.
Variation. — Size ranges from 3.90 to 4.30 mm in length, 1.90 to 2.10 mm
in width. The rufous abdomen of the allotype female is not constant for all
specimens. The color of the abdomen varies from rufous to black. An oc¬
casional specimen lacks the distinctive pale humeral angle.
Holotype. — Abbotsford, B.C. (British Columbia), roadside ditch, 14-IX-
45, collected by Hugh B. Leech (CAS).
Allotype. — Abbotsford, B.C., 29-V-40, collected by H. B. Leech (CAS).
Paratypes.— Total 67. CANADA: BRITISH COLUMBIA: Abbotsford,
29-V-40, 14-IX-45, H. B. Leech (CAS); Salmon River, Glenemma, 15-VII-
49, H. B. Leech collector (CAS); Fraz. Val., J. D. Sherman collection
(USNM); Lac-le-Jeune, Kamloops, 23-V-1933, A. C. Thrupp (CAS); Tran-
quille Lake, near Kamloops, 27-VIII-1939, G. J. Spencer (CAS); Langley,
26-1-1935, 17-IV-35, 23-VI-35, K. Graham (CAS); Lumby, 19-IX-1937, 16-
IX- 1939, 25-11-1943, 25-IX-1943, 8-IX-1944, H. B. Leech (CAS); Metlakatla,
Rev. Keene collection (USNM); Salmon Arm, 22-VIII-1929, 2-IX-1929, 7-
X- 33, 5-IX-37, Hugh B. Leech (CAS); Vancouver, 29-III-30, VI-11-30, 5-
IX-1932, Hugh B. Leech (CAS); Wynndel, 25-VII-47, G. S. Smith (CAS).
UNITED STATES: MONTANA: 2 mi. W Corvallis, Ravalli Co., V-20-
1952, A. A. Hubert. OREGON: Corvallis, J. D. Sherman collection
(USNM); Corvallis, 20-V-1938, Hugh B. Leech (CAS); Crescent, Klamath
Co., 10-IX-1950, Malkin & Thatcher (FM); Ft. Klamath, Klamath Co., 13-
VIII- 1950 (FM); Curry Co., VI-12-1954, R. K. Benjamin (USNM). WASH¬
INGTON: Chase Lake, 25-VII-1954, B. Malkin (FM); Mason Co., Cush¬
man, VI-22-1919, F M Gaige (FNY); Shohomish R., 5-23-92 (USNM).
Comparative notes. — This species is grouped with similaris Fall and lon-
giusculus Gemminger and Harold by the strongly angulate apex of the meta-
coxal process. H. longius cuius is slightly smaller, flattened dorsoventrally,
and has the elytral punctures much finer than fatigus. The elytra of lon¬
gius cuius are yellowish brown while the elytra of fatigus are usually nearly
piceous. H. similaris males can immediately be separated from fatigus
males by the short anterior protarsal claw. The females are difficult to sep¬
arate, but fatigus characteristically has a distinct pale yellowish humeral
angle which similaris lacks.
The specific epithet refers to the amount of effort “fatigue” expended
before this species was finally segregated from similaris.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
121
Figs. 11-13. Male genitalia of Hydroporus spp. Fig. 11, H.fatigus (dorsal, ventral views).
Fig. 12, H. elusivus (dorsal, ventral views). Fig. 13, H. spangleri (dorsal, ventral views).
Hydroporus elusivus, new species
(Fig. 12)
Holotype male. — Length 3.40 mm, width 1.80 mm. Form elongate oval,
widest anterior to middle of elytra. Head rufopiceous, slightly paler on clyp-
eal margin; palpus and entire undersurface of head rufous; antenna rufopi¬
ceous, first two segments rufous. Pronotum rufopiceous becoming paler
laterally. Elytron brown. Undersurface rufopiceous; legs rufous; third
through sixth abdominal sterna rufous laterally.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by twice their diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; fine punctures on disc widely separated, punctures
becoming coarser laterally, separated by less than their diameter; equal in
width to base of elytra; hind angle abrupt; lateral margin wide, three times
as wide as an anterior pro tarsal claw; pubescence fine, very sparse.
Elytron alutaceous, shining; coarsely punctured, punctures subequal in
size to basal pronotal punctures, separated by slightly less than their di¬
ameter; pubescence fine, very sparse; lateral margin slightly ascending in
basal third.
Metasternal wing and plate and first two abdominal sterna coarsely punc¬
tured. Metacoxal process truncate at apex. Pro- and mesotarsi slightly di¬
lated, almost as in female, narrower than tibia, segments equal in width.
Protarsal claws equal, anterior claw slightly thickened, claws half the length
of last tarsal segment. Aedeagus tapering from base to apex, ending in a
blunt point (Fig. 12).
122
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Allotype. — Length 3.60 mm, width 1.90 mm. Similar to holotype except
dorsal surface more alutaceous. Pro- and mesotarsi slightly narrower than
male, protarsal claws simple.
Variation. — No apparent variation is evident in the short type series.
Holotype. — Rumney, N.H. (New Hampshire), IV-22-1926, collected by
P. J. Darlington (MCZ).
Allotype. — Same data as for holotype (MCZ).
Paratypes. — Total 2. Same data as for holotype (MCZ) (USNM).
Comparative notes. — This species most nearly resembles tartaricus
LeConte from which it may be separated by the spacing of the elytral punc¬
tures. The punctures are much closer together in elusivus, and the male
protarsus is much narrower than in tartaricus. The specific epithet refers
to the apparent scarcity of this species which I have seen from a single
locality.
Hydroporus spangleri, new species
(Fig. 13)
Holotype male. — Length 3.40 mm, width 1.80 mm. Form obovate, widest
posterior to middle of elytra. Head piceous with a pale posterior transverse
band; palpus and entire undersurface of head rufous; antenna rufopiceous,
first two segments rufous. Pronotum piceous becoming paler laterally. Ely¬
tron brown. Undersurface black; legs rufous; third abdominal sternum with
rufous spot laterally.
Head alutaceous; punctures fine, separated by one or two times their
diameter.
Pronotum alutaceous; fine punctures on disc unevenly spaced, punctures
becoming coarser laterally, separated by less than their diameter; equal in
width to base of elytra; hind angle slightly rounded; lateral margin narrow,
less than twice as wide as an anterior protarsal claw; pubescence fine, very
sparse.
Elytron alutaceous, shining; coarsely and evenly punctured, punctures
equal in size to basal pronotal punctures, separated by less than their di¬
ameter; pubescence fine, sparse on disc, becoming more dense laterally and
posteriorly; lateral margin slightly ascending in basal third.
Metasternal wing and plate and first two abdominal sterna coarsely punc¬
tured. Metacoxal process angulate at apex. Pro- and mesotarsi slightly di¬
lated, narrower than tibia, segments two and three equal in width, third
segment narrower. Protarsal claws equal, unmodified, claws half the length
of last tarsal segment. Aedeagus with sides nearly parallel, tapering to a
point in apical third (Fig. 13).
Variation. — The two males in the type series show no apparent variation.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
123
Holotype. — Lambs Canyon nr. S (Salt) Lake City (Utah), VI-30- 1949,
collected by G. K. Todd (USNM 72155).
Allotype. — No female available for study.
Paratype. — Total 1. Same data as for holotype (USNM).
Comparative notes. — H. spangleri most nearly resembles occidentalis to
which it keys in Fall (1923). The elytron is much more coarsely and densely
punctate than occidentalis, and the male genitalia of spangleri have the
aedeagus very slender and obviously constricted medially, while the aedea-
gus of occidentalis is comparatively broader and not constricted, or if con¬
stricted, then feebly and broadly so. The holotype and a single paratype are
the only specimens seen to date. The specific epithet is a genitive of the
surname of Paul Spangler, to whom I am indebted for much help and en¬
couragement in studies of water beetles.
Literature Cited
Fall, Henry C. 1923. A revision of the North American species of Hydroporus and Agaporus.
Privately printed. 129 pp.
Larson, David J. 1975. The predaceous water beetles (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) of Alberta:
systematics, natural history and distribution. Quaest. Entomol., 11:245-498.
Sharp, David. 1882. On aquatic carnivorous Coleoptera or Dytiscidae. Sci. Trans. Roy. Dublin
Soc. (ser. 2), 2: 279:1003.
Footnote
1 Mailing address: % U.S. National Museum of Natural History, Washington, D.C. 20560.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 124-132
NOTES ON THE NATURAL HISTORY OF SPANGLEROGYRUS
ALBIVENTRIS FOLKERTS, WITH A NEW
DISTRIBUTION RECORD
(COLEOPTERA: GYRINIDAE)
Warren E. Steiner, Jr. and Joseph J. Anderson
% Dept, of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution, Washington, D.C. 20560
The whirligig beetle Spanglerogyrus albiventris Folkerts (Coleoptera:
Gyrinidae) was originally described from a series of 11 specimens taken
from undercut banks of large streams at two localities in the Red Hills region
of southwestern Alabama (Folkerts, 1979) and was reported to be uncom¬
mon at those sites. The species was placed in a separate subfamily because
of its unique structure. Our interest in this small, aberrant gyrinid prompted
a trip to the type-locality in April 1980 and resulted in the following report
on its natural history. These observations may be helpful in future studies
of gyrinid phylogeny and origin.
New Locality Record and Specimens
An intensive search of the type-locality near Peterman, Monroe County,
yielded only 2 specimens of Spanglerogyrus albiventris, a female collected
1 1 April and a male on 17 April. Unusually heavy spring rains before and
during our stay caused considerable flooding of streams in the area and we
associated this with the low number of specimens taken. However, on 19
April at a nearby locality in Conecuh County (13 km E. Evergreen) we
discovered a concentration of members of this species and took a series of
85 specimens (26 3 3 , 59 $ $ ) in about an hour of collecting.
This collection indicates that S. albiventris can be locally much more
abundant than originally thought. The collection site represents the first
record for the species in Conecuh County; it lies between and south of the
two previously recorded sites and is within the presumed range figured by
Folkerts (1979).
Cursory examinations of sex ratios in members of other gyrinid genera
demonstrate that the high proportion of females to males is a common con¬
dition within the family.
Habitat
The large series of S. albiventris was collected midday at a shaded stream
8-12 m wide, with steep, mossy banks; surrounding soil is sandy and the
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
125
creek has a sand and gravel bottom. This is like the habitat described by
Folkerts for the type-locality, but at this new site most of the beetles were
concentrated near the mouths of two small tributaries (1-2 m wide) and up
along the margins of one of them for more than 50 m; beyond that there
were few suitable microhabitats, i.e. small undercuts and hollo wed-out
pockets in the bank. Highest concentrations were taken at the points of land
at the confluence of the small creeks and main stream even though suitable
microhabitats seemed equally distributed elsewhere along the margin of the
large stream. Beetles were fewer in number and occurred in smaller isolated
clusters as we sampled up the small creeks and fewer along the edge of the
larger stream as we worked upstream and downstream from the mouths of
the smaller ones. The absence of similar small tributaries at the type-locality
might explain the low abundance at that site.
Our observations on the concentration of S. albiventris indicate that the
presence of small tributaries to larger streams is probably an important
factor in the maintenance of local populations of the species. We believe
the larval habitat may be up the small streams rather than along the margins
of the large ones. We did not find larvae, nor do we know when they are
present. A few of the females examined contained 1-3 eggs, although most
had none, suggesting that the eggs recently had been deposited.
We collected the beetles by wading in the stream and closely examining
the margins where small shaded excavations of 5-10 cm in the bank or
spaces among root tangles provided shelter from the current. Spangler o-
gyrus members usually were seen swimming rapidly on the water surface
in these situations, singly or in clusters of up to 12 individuals depending
on the size of the hollow or pocket. They were captured with a dipnet
brought up to the surface from below. After being disturbed by the net,
beetles not caught soon reappeared at the same spot.
The easy visual detection of specimens at this site, contrary to the ob¬
servation by Folkerts, may have been due to the higher than normal water
level; most of the larger shelflike undercut banks were submerged, thus
forcing the beetles higher to more exposed habitats. On the other hand,
relatively open microhabitats may be preferred. The species is apparently
diurnal; activity in captive specimens decreases at night. The unpigmented
venter, which may help to avoid visual detection from below by predators
such as small fish, would be of particular advantage to a surface-dweller in
open areas during the day. By comparison, species of Gyretes, which have
a dark colored venter, are most often found under deep, shelflike banks
where illumination is low.
Small body size may allow clusters of S. albiventris to utilize smaller
spaces unsuitable for larger gyrinids and thereby allow them to avoid com¬
petition with the other species along the same stream bank. We collected
Gyretes sp. at this locality in places similar and adjacent to those of S.
126
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
albiventris, but usually in larger, deeper pockets in the bank where S. al-
biventris rarely was found. Dineutus discolor Aube also was taken nearby,
in wide open areas, usually protected from strong current behind log-jams.
Behavior
We were able to observe the activity of S. albiventris both in the field
and in captivity and to compare its behavior to that of members of three
other gyrinid genera. In addition to the unusual jumping behavior described
by Folkerts (1979), we noted some peculiarities not seen in other gyrinids.
When associated with ecologic and structural features, these characters may
be of help in understanding the position of Spanglerogyrus in the phylogeny
and origin of the Gyrinidae.
Swimming. — The characteristic gyrating motion of gyrinids on the water
surface is noticeably jerky and more rapid in S. albiventris, probably due
to the comparatively small body size. The flat ventral surface of the body
makes the beetle float like a bubble on the surface tension, having most of
its body mass above water. Most larger gyrinids are convex ventrally and
have relatively greater body mass below water level.
The single female taken 11 April was kept alive in a glass jar and closely
observed for several days. The jar, 5 cm in diameter and 10 cm deep, con¬
tained water 5 cm deep and some emergent roots and pine needles from the
stream. Swimming normally the beetle pursued a circular path 1-2 cm in
diameter and made 2-4 revolutions per second. The beetle swam clockwise
for an average of 4-12 revolutions, then reversed abruptly and swam coun¬
terclockwise for as many revolutions. This pattern was broken occasionally
when the beetle would spin out in an exploratory manner, usually returning
to the same spot to resume circling.
Diving. — Diving beneath the water surface, an evasive tactic often seen
in other larger gyrinids, was observed also in S. albiventris. The small size,
convex body form, and light build of these beetles appear to make them
more bouyant; the captive specimens swam vigorously to remain submerged
and soon bobbed back to the surface to resume gyrating. Members of S.
albiventris made no attempt to cling to a root in order to stay submerged as
is common in other gyrinids (Hatch, 1925a). The individuals observed sel¬
dom dived and appeared to do so only when highly agitated. In the field,
specimens swam in wide zigzag paths and scattered when we approached,
but dived only when directly disturbed. They dispersed temporarily along
the stream margin but did not stray far from the pocket which they happened
to be inhabiting; because of their comparative frailty it is possible that these
beetles have a greater risk of being swept downstream by the current.
Feeding. — Spanglerogyrus albiventris is apparently a general surface
scavenger and predator as are other members of the family; the gyrating
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
127
habit aids the beetles in finding food particles. Bread crumbs dropped on
the water were drawn inward by the circling of the beetle and were eaten
as the beetle continued to swim. Group feeding on larger pieces of food was
observed when we placed 15 beetles (from the series collected 19 April) in
a jar and offered them some baetid mayflies. Several beetles surrounded
and chewed at a floating mayfly while holding it with their front legs. One
specimen of S. albiventris that had died in captivity was partially eaten by
the others.
Some specimens preserved in alcohol immediately after collecting were
dissected and gut contents were examined. Small fragments of dark colored
insect (probably dipteran) exoskeleton were found.
Resting. — After feeding, the beetles swam to an emergent stem or root,
or side of the glass jar, and climbed upward, then immediately turned around
and rested with the head downward just above the water line. This habit
and position probably facilitate rapid re-entry to the water. We were not
able to observe S. albiventris at rest in the field (other than floating mo¬
tionless on the water surface), but members of Gyrinus, Gyretes and Di-
neutus spp. were observed resting on emergent roots or in moss along the
stream banks; the head-down position was rarely assumed, and does not
seem to be characteristic of these genera.
Walking. — The long and relatively unmodified middle and hind tarsi of S.
albiventris allow these beetles to be more agile out of water than members
of other gyrinid groups. Captive specimens were observed walking steadily
up stems and rootlets and across the glass surface of their container, and
are capable of turning around on narrow stems such as pine needles. When
walking the ventral surface is elevated, with only the tips of the tarsi con¬
tacting the substrate. All legs are used in walking, in the manner of cursorial
insects.
On several occasions we saw a beetle reach the top of a stem and attempt
to take flight, hit the side of the jar and fall to the water to resume swimming.
The beetles spread their wings and took flight without jumping off the stem.
The jumping behavior described by Folkerts (1979) is apparently used as a
method of escape; we observed it only when beetles were caught in the net
or placed on the ground.
Members of Dineutus often cling to floating leaves or emergent stems but
rarely leave the water completely (Folkerts and Donovan, 1973) and we
observed them doing so only under highly crowded captive conditions; the
beetles that climbed available stems did so clumsily and often fell back into
the water.
Members of stream-dwelling species of Gyrinus and Gyretes frequently
climb up stems and twigs to rest and do so with proficiency (Folkerts and
Donovan, 1973). The climbing is accomplished, however, by pushing with
the short, flattened middle and hing legs and pulling with the long forelegs;
128
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
the body is not elevated above the substrate. We observed members of
Gyretes iricolor burrowing through moss on the banks of the streams, but
neither this nor any of the above modes of terrestrial locomotion approach
the actual walking of S. albiventris.
Unique Structural Features
Spanglerogyrus, which represents a monotypic subfamily, has many
structural characters not present in members of other gyrinid taxa. Some of
these may be considered highly derived, while others are plesiotypic, being
present in other members of the Adephaga but not in other gyrinids. For
comparison, Gyrinus, Dineutus, and Gyretes spp. plus representatives of
some tropical genera were briefly examined; these genera represent each of
the 3 tribes of the subfamily Gyrininae. Some important characters of Span¬
glerogyrus not previously recognized are noted.
An obvious difference in members of Spanglerogyrus is the lack of ventral
excavations to receive the legs when folded. Distinct, trough-like excava¬
tions, particularly for the forelegs, are present in all members of the Gy¬
rininae; members of Spanglerogyrinae have a nearly flat ventral surface.
The shape of the dorsum in lateral view is also not as streamlined as in
other gyrinids. These features of the general body form seem more typical
of terrestrial beetles, and are probably associated with the walking behavior.
The anterior coxal cavities, however, are like the type described by Bell
(1966) for other Hydradephaga.
The mesostemum has an unusual shape and form: the posterior process
between the mesocoxae comes to a narrow point, and the mesocoxae are
nearly contiguous. In gyrinines this process is broadly bilobed (with a me¬
dian emargination at the apex) and widely separates the mesocoxae. The
anterior median carina in members of Spanglerogyrus is also absent in gy¬
rinines. Since this mesostemal form is also distinct from that of other
adephagans, it is considered here as an apotypic feature of Spanglerogyrus,
but this is uncertain; further comparative studies in this area are needed.
The form of the metastemum is also radically different; it is relatively
long and evenly transverse, whereas in gyrinines it is constricted and arcuate
between the mesocoxae and the anteriorly expanded metacoxal plates. A
distinct transverse sulcus on the metasternum, a character absent or weakly
developed in other Hydradephaga (Bell, 1966), is present in Spanglerogyrus
members. The metacoxal plates in Spanglerogyrus members are shorter and
truncate anteriorly, and the femoral excavations are narrow and are oriented
laterally rather than ventrally. These characters seem more carabid-like and
are considered primitive.
The middle and hind legs in Spanglerogyrus members are modified for
swimming differently than those of gyrinines, but seem to be equally effi-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
129
cient structures in both groups. In the gyrinines the tibiae and tarsi are
shortened and flattened for swimming; in spanglerogyrines the tibiae have
become greatly modified, while the tarsi, though equipped with long nata¬
tory hairs, have remained relatively unmodified. The long-fringed, oarlike,
dorsal extensions of the tibiae in members of Spanglerogyrus are not known
in any other aquatic beetles and must be considered as highly derived struc¬
tures. The front tibiae, on the other hand, possess a primitive feature in
having a distinct apical spur. Gyrinines possess at most a tuft of setae, but
no protibial spurs. The front tarsi of male Spanglerogyrus are not strongly
dilated and possess relatively few adhesive hairs, another feature considered
less derived (Brinck, 1977).
In addition to the dorsal and ventral eyes being narrowly separated in
spanglerogyrines, the dorsal eye is much larger than the ventral one; in
gyrinines the reverse is true or the two eyes are roughly equal in size. In
the hypothesized descent of the Gyrinidae, single compound eyes became
divided as an adaptation for surface swimming, then the bridge between
them widened as the dorsal eye moved upward. Extant Spanglerogyrus
members possess the intermediate, less derived condition.
The apical visible abdominal sternum in spanglerogyrines is divided me¬
dially into two overlapping lobes, whereas gyrinines have an entire, broadly
rounded or pointed abdominal apex. In both gyrinid subfamilies, this apical
sclerite is the 8th sternum; the homologous sclerite in other known adeph-
agans, usually also divided, is reduced and hidden beneath the 7th sternum,
which is the apical visible sternum in these groups. An exposed and divided
8th sternum, a character unique to S. albiventris, might be considered a
specialized (derived) feature. However, reduction, retraction and fusion of
sclerites are generally considered to be derived states, while a more com¬
plex, unmodified condition implies an ancestral form. It seems more prob¬
able that the exposed, divided 8th sternum in S. albiventris is a plesiotypic
character, retained since the origin of the gyrinid line.
The whiplike setae on the outer apical angle of the elytra are also unique
structures. There are two equal adjacent setae on each elytron; they appear
as single setae in dried specimens unless teased apart. In a surface-swim¬
ming beetle of small size they may be functional in keeping the water from
covering the abdominal apex by breaking up the meniscus of surface tension
around that region. Some gyrinines possess sharp spines along the apical
margin of the elytra; these do not seem homologous to the setae in span¬
glerogyrines and probably have a protective function. We consider the ely-
tral setae in S. albiventris to be a specialized apotypic feature because of
their apparent functional nature, but it is possible that these setae are ho¬
mologous to the tactile setae of the elytra in Carabidae. There are numerous
tactile setae on the clypeus of S. albiventris ; these are not typical of other
known Hydradephaga. The presence of these setae and the other carabid-
130
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
like features in Spanglerogyrus members suggests a terrestrial origin of the
Gyrinidae independent from other Hydradephaga, as was postulated by Bell
(1966).
The presence of a setose median lobe in the male genitalia of Spangler¬
ogyrus members is an unusual feature; median lobes in other gyrinids have
no setae or accessory structures (Tranda, 1972). Although setose genitalia
are generally considered a primitive feature, these short, re torse setae seem
to be a specialized feature of male Spanglerogyrus. Also, the median lobe
is not dorsoventrally flattened as in members of Gyrininae. The relatively
reduced number of setae on the parameres also suggests an apotypic con¬
dition.
Conclusions
Many of the characters that give members of Spanglerogyrus their
uniqueness seem to be related to small size, which is considered here as an
apotypic character among the Gyrinidae. The extreme reduction in size is
probably the result of specialization for a niche not occupied by other sym-
patric gyrinid species. We think the ability to walk and the associated phys¬
ical features have been retained in Spanglerogyrus members because of the
need for greater agility in a surface-swimming beetle with a smaller body
size, which would be more vulnerable to sudden changes in its stream mar¬
gin habitat. At the same time, spanglerogyrines have acquired natatory ap¬
pendages (the oarlike meso-and metatibiae) equal in efficiency to the mod¬
ified legs in other gyrinids.
The large dorsal eye which is not widely separated from the ventral eye,
though considered a primitive condition, would also be advantageous for a
small-sized surface swimmer. If Spanglerogyrus beetles live in small mi¬
crohabitats close to the stream bank and are diurnal, as our observations
suggest, a large, laterally oriented dorsal eye would be more useful than a
smaller eye with a more dorsal orientation, as it would be easier for the
beetles to orient themselves in a small semi-enclosed area while swimming
and feeding.
We agree with Folkerts (1979) that the Spanglerogyrus taxon represents
an early offshoot of the ancestral gyrinid line, but we do not think that the
genus can truly be referred to as “primitive.” Many of the apotypic char¬
acters of the genus (oarlike tibiae, whiplike elytral setae, form of the meso-
sternum, retorse setae of the median lobe, resting habit and jumping behav¬
ior) are not found in other known gyrinids and are not likely to have been
features possessed by an early ancestral gyrinid. Although members of
Spanglerogyrus do have plesiotypic structural and behavioral features that
might be expected in an ancestral gyrinid, with its many other derived fea¬
tures it would not represent an example of the ancestral gyrinid form. We
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
131
therefore suggest the unusual taxon Spanglerogyrus represents the plesion
of Gyrinidae in terms of branching sequence, but has since acquired many
autapotypic features.
The relatively primitive features of spanglerogyrines within Gyrinidae,
however, may be useful in determining the origin of the Gyrinidae among
the Adephaga. The walking behavior, setose clypeus, metasternal form, and
structure of the hind coxae are more carabid-like than dytiscoid, supporting
the view of Bell (1966) that the Gyrinidae arose directly from a terrestrial
adephagan form, rather than an aquatic one. The male genitalia of gyrinids
have characters that are generally considered to be plesiotypic, i.e. the
dorsoventrally flattened, symmetrical, trilobed condition (Tranda, 1972).
Asymmetry and reduction of the parameres are characteristic of caraboids,
haliplids, and dytiscids, indicating that these groups are more closely related
to each other than any of them are related to the Gyrinidae. This is contrary
to the view of Hatch (1925b) and Crowson (1955), who have placed gyrinids
near the Dytiscidae.
The complex of plesiotypic characters in S. albiventris implies a very
early origin in adephagan evolution. We feel that the gyrinid line arose from
a carabid-like terrestrial ancestor which gave rise to two main lines, the
modern caraboids and the gyrinids. The dytiscoids and haliplids were per¬
haps a later offshoot of the caraboid line. In this proposed phylogeny, the
Gyrinidae would be removed from the “Glabricomia” as defined by Bell
(1966) and would become an earlier branch from primitive adephagan stock.
An early common ancestor of modern Adephaga could have been similar to
the one hypothesized for Bell’s Glabricomia, but probably had male geni¬
talia of the symmetrical, trilobed type, and an exposed and divided 8th
abdominal sternum.
These ideas will be tested as more information is gathered from detailed
studies of other aspects of life histories and internal structures. The discov¬
ery of the larva of Spanglerogyrus will be of great interest, in that it will
provide another set of character states with which to analyze adephagan
relationships.
Acknowledgments
We are grateful to Terry L. Erwin and Marc G. Roth for their many
helpful suggestions in reviewing the manuscript. Paul J. Spangler kindly
confirmed our identifications of the associated gyrinid species and offered
much encouragement during this study. Special thanks are due to Mary
Love Smith for her generous hospitality given during our stay in Alabama.
Literature Cited
Bell, R. T. 1966. Trachypachus and the origin of the Hydradephaga (Coleoptera). Coleopt.
Bull., 20(4): 107-1 12.
132
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Brinck, P. 1977. Evolution and taxonomy of Andogyrus Ochs (Coleoptera: Gyrinidae). Ento-
mol. Scand., 8:241-269.
Crowson, R. A. 1955. The natural classification of the families of Coleoptera. N. Lloyd,
London, 187 pp.
Folkerts, G. W. 1979. Spanglerogyrus albiventris, a primitive new genus and species of Gyr¬
inidae (Coleoptera) from Alabama. Coleopt. Bull., 33(1): 1-8.
Folkerts, G. W., and L. A. Donovan. 1973. Resting sites of stream dwelling gyrinids (Co¬
leoptera). Entomol. News, 84(6): 198-201.
Hatch, M. H. 1925a. An outline of the ecology of Gyrinidae. Bull. Brooklyn Entomol. Soc.,
20(3): 101-1 14.
Hatch, M. H. 1925b. Phylogeny and phylogenetic tendencies of Gyrinidae. Pap. Mich. Acad.
Arts. Lett., 5:429-467.
Tranda, E. 1972. Uber die Morphologie der Geschlechtsanhange der Taumelkafer (Coleoptera:
Gyrinidae). Acta Zool. Cracov., 13:141-147.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 133-148
A DISTRIBUTIONAL SURVEY OF THE WORLD GENERA OF
AQUATIC DRYOPOID BEETLES (COLEOPTERA:
DRYOPIDAE, ELMIDAE, AND
PSEPHENIDAE SENS. LAT.)
Harley P. Brown
Dept, of Zoology, and
Stovall Museum of Science and History, Univ. of Oklahoma, Norman 73019
Since dryopoid beetles are so widely distributed, are commonly present
throughout the year, and are often highly diagnostic of water quality, they
are gaining increased attention. This is especially true in the United States
because of legal requirements for environmental assessment. The Nearctic
fauna is reasonably well known (Brown 1975, 1976), although a number of
species await description. Not surprisingly, the European members of the
group are even better known, but it is no simple matter to learn what lives
where, even in Europe. The world picture is infinitely more discouraging:
the literature is scattered and difficult to track down. The most recent at¬
tempt at a comprehensive catalog or checklist is well over half a century
old (Junk and Schenkling 1910, 1914). Blackwelder’s supplements to Leng
(1920) and his checklist for the rest of this hemisphere (1944) with its ex¬
tensive bibliography (1957) are of tremendous help, but a large portion of
our present taxa have been described subsequent to his work. Hinton, who
contributed most to our knowledge of Neotropical dryopoids, died before
achieving his goal of monographing the South American elmids. I know of
no one on the scene today who is familiar with that diverse fauna, much
less the dryopoids of the world. Deleve would have been the logical person
to monograph the Ethiopian elmids and dryopids, but he, too, died before
accomplishing such a task. My own collecting has been limited to western
Europe, South America, Central America, and the West Indies, in addition
to the United States, and I confess to but a superficial acquaintance with
the riffle beetles of these regions. My knowledge of the dryopoids of Aus¬
tralia, Asia, Africa, etc. is derived almost exclusively from such literature
as I have been able to assemble. This paper is a summary of what I have
gleaned. It could save others a great deal of time and effort. If readers note
omissions or errors, I should greatly appreciate their kindness in informing
me of such.
Taxonomic history poses problems for those who wish to organize or list
taxa, and the history of dryopoids is perhaps more confusing than most.
Since details will soon appear in forthcoming sections of the Catalog of the
134
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Coleoptera of America North of Mexico (Brown, in press), I shall present
here only what is necessary for the reader to use the major literature. For
much of its history, most of the group was treated under the family name
Parnidae, which later became Dryopidae. The psephenids have held family
status for over a century, though some authors have considered them but
a subfamily of Dryopidae as recently as 1939. Nor is the composition of the
family Psephenidae settled at present: each of the groups treated here as
subfamilies is placed in a separate family by such workers as Bertrand
(1972). To make matters even worse, the members of two of these subfam¬
ilies (Eubrianacinae and Eubriinae) are put by Arnett (1963) and Bertrand
(1972) in another superfamily, the Dascilloidea. They are not original or
unique in this. Bertrand also treated elmids as but a subfamily within the
Dryopidae, and retained Lutrochus in this family, whereas virtually every¬
one else accords the elmids family status and most have followed Hinton
(1939) in transferring Lutrochus to the Limnichidae. It now appears that
Lutrochus merits a family of its own, but I shall not deal with that issue
here. As for the elmids, many authors in recent years had been employing
the family name Elminthidae for them until Steyskal (1975) clarified the
proper derivation as Elmidae.
At the generic level, considerable confusion stems from the fact that, for
a long time, many species of Helichus were placed in the genus Dry ops,
whereas many Dry ops were called Parnus. However, some Helichus were
also described as Parnus, and four genera ( Parygrus , Pachyparnus, Po-
matinus and Potaminus ) were created for portions of the present genus
Helichus. Somewhat comparable mix-ups occurred between the Palaearctic
genera Elmis and Limnius, and members of many genera around the world
were originally assigned to one or the other of these two. Until quite re¬
cently, those species now in the genus Limnius were called Lat(h)elmis,
members of the genus Oulimnius being placed in Limnius.
To minimize confusion, I am omitting synonyms from the distribution
tables. For the benefit of readers who wish to reconcile these tables with
previous lists, however, I am listing major synonyms, etc. in Table 5.
Eventually, I expect to publish a world checklist of species, but that is
beyond the scope of this survey. The present paper is intended to provide
an overview of the distribution of those genera which have been described
to date. Additional genera are in the offing. I am in the process of describing
several new Neotropical genera of elmids and dryopids, and am either de¬
scribing or planning to describe larvae representing 2 new genera of eubriine
psephenids (or eubriids) — one from Central America and one from India.
Thus, although the tables are presumably up to date, they are far from
complete. The numbers of species will also change, of course. Most of my
new species in process of or awaiting description are Neotropical and Nearc-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
135
Table 1. Distribution of species of Dryopidae.
136
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
tic, but we may expect many more from China, Australia, and numerous
other regions. Certainly South America will still yield many.
The tables list for each genus the number of species known from the
various zoogeographic realms. For the most part, this is quite satisfactory,
but problems arise with species whose distribution straddles a boundary.
Instead of complicating tabulation by listing such species in both realms, I
have simply attempted to assign them to what I think to be the more ap¬
propriate realm. In brief, the regions included in the realms, with a summary
of their dryopoids, are as follows:
NE ARCTIC (North America from the Mexican highlands northward):
dryopids — 3 genera with 12 species; elmids — 1 genus with 2 species of Lar-
inae plus 24 genera with 84 species of Elminae; psephenids — 1 species of
Eubrianacinae, 1 genus with 7 species of Psepheninae, and 4 genera with 8
species of Eubriinae.
NEOTROPICAL (Mexican lowlands, Central America, West Indies and
South America): dryopids — 8 genera with 61 species; elmids — 6 genera with
20 species of Larinae plus 30 genera with 295 species of Elminae; psephen¬
ids — 1 species of Eubrianacinae, 4 genera with 17 species of Psepheninae,
and 5 genera with 19 species of Eubriinae.
PALAEARCTIC (Eurasia south to the Himalayas, Afghanistan, Iran, etc.,
and Africa north of the Sahara Desert): dryopids — 4 genera with 42 species;
elmids — 3 genera with 5 species of Larinae plus 24 genera with 137 species
of Elminae; psephenids — 2 genera with 11 species of Eubrianacinae, 2 gen¬
era with 5 species of Psepheninae, 1 species of Psephenoidinae, and 5 genera
with 7 species of Eubriinae. Of the 24 species of psephenids, only one
(Eubria palustris ) occurs north or west of China, the remaining 23 occurring
in China and Japan and having their affinities primarily with the Oriental
fauna. Surprisingly, however, a fossil species of Eubrianax has been re¬
ported from France.
ETHIOPIAN (Africa including and below the Sahara Desert plus Mada¬
gascar): dryopids — 8 genera with 38 species; elmids — 6 genera with 53
species of Larinae plus 25 genera with 265 species of Elminae; psephenids —
1 genus with 6 species of Eubrianacinae, 1 species of Psephenoidinae, and
1 genus with 4 species of Eubriinae.
ORIENTAL (Asia south of the Himalayas, southern China, Taiwan, the
Philippines, Indochina, Sri Lanka, the Malay Archipelago and Indonesia):
dryopids — 7 genera with 78 species; elmids — 3 genera with 13 species of
Larinae plus 18 genera with 130 species of Elminae; psephenids — 17 species
of Eubrianax, 2 genera with 2 species of Psepheninae, 5 species of Pse-
phenoides, and 5 genera with 11 species of Eubriinae.
AUSTRALIAN (Australia, Tasmania, New Zealand, New Guinea and re¬
lated islands): dryopids — 3 genera with 5 species, none of which are in
Australia itself; elmids — 7 genera with 14 species of Larinae plus 7 genera
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
137
Table 2. Distribution of species of Elmidae: Larinae.
138
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 3. Distribution of species of Elmidae: Elminae.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
139
Table 3. Continued.
140
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 3. Continued.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
141
Table 3. Continued.
142
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 3. Continued.
with 101 species of Elminae; psephenids — 2 genera with 7 species of Eubri-
inae.
Distribution maps, though not feasible for this paper, would bring out
features not evident from the tables. For example, maps would show that
the dryopoid fauna of the West Indies is obviously derived from South and
Central America. There is virtually no overlap between Cuba and Florida,
or any indication of transport to Cuba by drift from the mouth of the Mis¬
sissippi River. Hinton (1965) makes this point quite effectively.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
143
Table 4. Distribution of species of Psephenidae.
144
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 4. Continued.
In scanning the tables, I am impressed with the fact that most of the
genera are endemic, or confined to one realm. This fact, too, would be much
more conspicuous if distribution maps were included for each species. Of
the 159 genera, not one can be considered truly cosmopolitan. Most nearly
cosmopolitan is the dryopid Helichus, with the elmid Stenelmis a close
runner-up. The only psephenid in the running would be Eubrianax. One
conclusion I draw from the extensive endemism and the failure of any
species, or even any genus, to become cosmopolitan, is that dryopoid bee¬
tles are unlikely to become of major economic importance as pests.
The only instance of successful intercontinental hitchhiking by a dryopoid
that I know about is Dryops viennensis, a European species which has
become established along the St. Lawrence River of eastern Canada. Un¬
doubtedly there are other transplants not yet detected or reported, but if
they were pests they would probably have been noticed.
I have mentioned above the difficulty posed by species whose geographic
ranges straddle boundaries between adjacent realms, and suggested that
distribution maps for each species would serve to clarify the situation. Per¬
haps a bit of discussion is in order. Among the Larinae I do not list Phan-
ocerus as Nearctic, although one of the widely-distributed Neotropical
species extends into Texas. Among the Elminae, Xenelmis occurs in Ari¬
zona, and the number of Nearctic species would be increased for such
genera as Cylloepus, Heterelmis , Hexacylloepus and Neoelmis if I included
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
145
Table 5. Sources of confusion: synonyms, homonyms, and genera of other families which
have been listed as dryopoids.
Afropsephenium Paulian 1946 — not a psephenid, or even a dryopoid
Alloparnus Broun 1893 = Protoparnus
Aptyktophallus Steffen 1957 = Normandia
Awadoronus Kono 1934 = Zaitzevia
Betelmis Matsumura 1916 = Mataeopsephus (Psephenidae)
Chelonarium Fabricius 1801 — Chelonariidae, a dryopoid family
Drupe us Lewis 1895 — Ptilodactylidae, another dryopoid family
Dryopidius Grouvelle 1896 = Elmomorphus
Dryopomorphus Hinton 1936 — shifted to Elmidae: Larinae
Dry ops Leach 1817 = Helichus
Eure a LeConte 1853 = Ectopria
Eurypalpus LeConte 1852 = Psephenus
Fluvicola DeKay 1844 = Psephenus
Freyiella Bollow 1938 = Potamophilinus
Furcipalpus Guerin 1861 = Dicranopselaphus
Gridelliana Bollow 1939 = Potamodytes
Grouvelleus Zaitzev 1908 = Grouvellinus
Helminthopsoides Del'eve 1954 = Elmidolia
Helmis Bedel 1878 = Elmis
Lareynia DuVal 1859 = Elmis
Lat(h)elmis Reitter 1883 = Limnius
Limnius Erichson 1847 = Oulimnius
Lutrochus Erichson 1847 — Limnichidae or Lutrochidae, other dryopoid families
Macroeubria Pic 1916 — Ptilodactylidae, another dryopoid family
Mataeopsephenus Zaitzev 1908 = Mataeopsephus
Microdes Motschulsky 1859 = Grouvellinus
Neosolus Carter & Zeck 1929 = Austrolimnius
Oberonus Casey 1893 = Pelonomus
Pachycephala Broun 1881 = Hydora
Pachyparnus Fairmaire 1888 = Helichus
Parnida Broun 1880 = Protoparnus
Parnoides Kuwert 1900 = Pelonomus
Parnus Fabricius 1792 = Dry ops
Parygrus Erichson 1847 = Helichus
Philhydrus Duftschmidt 1805 = Elmis
Placonycha Horn 1880 = Eubrianax
Pomatinus Sturm 1853 = Helichus
Potaminus Lacordaire 1854 = Helichus
Pseudochelonarium Mequignon 1935 — Chelonariidae, another dryopoid family
Spineubria Nakane 1952 — Ptilodactylidae, another dryopoid family
Stenelsianus Hinton 1934 = Stenelmoides
Tychepsephenus Zaitzev 1908 = Tychepsephus
Udorius Broun 1882 = Hydora
Ulimnius Grouvelle 1896 = Oulimnius
146
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Mexican species that extend across the border. These genera, together with
Elsianus and Neocylloepus, are really Neotropical, and it seems a bit in¬
appropriate to list them as Nearctic at all. This is also the case for a number
of genera that are really Oriental, but which extend up into eastern China
and Japan and thus qualify as Palaearctic. I have already pointed out the
psephenids in this category; examples of elmids are Dryopomorphus, Gra-
Phelmis, Grouvellinus, Leptelmis, Ordobrevia, Zaitzevia, and Zaitzeviaria,
none of which range westward into Europe. Of these, Ordobrevia and Zait¬
zevia extend, instead, across into western North America, as do Cleptelmis
and Optioservus. In the case of Optioservus, and perhaps Cleptelmis as
well, movement across the Bering Strait land bridge was probably from
Nearctic to Palaearctic rather than the reverse, since Optioservus is widely
distributed across North America and represented by 13 species, whereas
in the Old World it seems confined to Japan. For Ordobrevia and Zaitzevia,
on the other hand, the migration was almost certainly from the Old World
to the New. Some relationships of this sort can, of course, be surmised from
the tables. The 2 “Palaearctic” species of Potamodytes, as one might sus¬
pect, are escapees from the Ethiopian realm, one into Egypt, the other into
the Arabian Peninsula.
The absence of dryopids from the continent of Australia is noteworthy.
It suggests that the family did not arise until after the geological isolation
of that land mass. Equally interesting to me is the only major generic linkage
between Australia and any other realm — the elmid genus Austrolimnius . It
is well represented in both Australia and South America. Furthermore, one
of the species from southern Australia is more closely related to a couple
of species in Chile than to any of its fellow Australian species (Hinton, 1965,
1968). When one takes into account the fact that these beetles are very
intolerant of environmental diversity, that they disperse very slowly and are
unlikely to be transported by accident, this situation presents very cogent
evidence of the ancient connection between these two continents. While
discussing Austrolimnius , I might add that Hinton (1971) stated that it was
the dominant elmid genus of New Guinea as well as Australia, but none of
the species from New Guinea has yet been described.
In my association with them for over 20 years, I have noted the greater
diversity of riffle beetles in tropical streams as compared with streams in
temperate zones, and the reduction in variety as one ascends higher among
the mountains. Near the snow line, at least in our Rockies and the Mexican
sierras, there is but a single species left. When assembling data for the tables
presented here, at first I took for granted that the greater numbers of Neo¬
tropical genera and species than Nearctic ones, for example, reflected this
same principle. Perhaps they do, but the evidence is not as overwhelming
as I initially thought. In the case of the Neotropical taxa, one cannot tell
from the tables what proportion represent temperate rather than tropical
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
147
climates. Essentially everything from Chile would be from temperate zones,
and a disproportionate portion of Brazilian specimens described thus far
have come from the southernmost regions, which are not genuinely tropical.
Again, maps would help resolve the issue. Unfortunately, however, all too
many species are known only from the original description, with no more
precise locality data than “Brazil” or “Argentina.”
One thing shown clearly by the tables is the large number of genera rep¬
resented by only one species. In this category are 7 of the 18 dryopid genera,
6 of 20 Larinae, 29 of 96 Elminae, and 9 of the 25 psephenids, for a total of
51 out of 159 genera — approximately one-third.
This impresses me as a very high proportion. So far as I can judge, it
does not simply reflect a tendency on the part of dryopoid taxonomists to
be splitters, although it is possible that this plays a minor role. It is also
probable that additional species will be described for some of these genera,
but I think the proportion of genera represented by unique species will
remain quite high. Undoubtedly, at least some of these are relicts — the last
survivors of groups formerly more widespread and diverse. Although a few
of them are widely distributed, e.g. Ancyronyx and Dupophilus, most of
them are apparently confined to rather small areas and restricted habitats.
Some may be extinct by the end of this century. They will not receive the
attention given the dodo or the passenger pigeon, but we riffle beetle buffs
will mourn their loss as well as the loss of the delightful habitat that sus¬
tained them.
Literature Cited
Arnett, R. H. , Jr. 1963. The beetles of the United States. Catholic Univ. Amer. Press, Wash¬
ington, D.C., 1 1 12 pp.
Bertrand, H. P. I. 1972. Larves et nymphes des Coleopteres aquatiques du Globe. Imprimerie
F. Paillart, Paris., 804 pp.
Blackwelder, R. E. 1944. Checklist of the coleopterous insects of Mexico, Central America,
the West Indies, and South America. Part 2. Bull. U.S. Natl. Mus., 185:189-341.
Blackwelder, R. E. 1957. Checklist of the coleopterous insects of Mexico, Central America,
the West Indies, and South America. Part 6. Bull. U.S. Natl. Mus., 185:927-1492.
Brown, H. P. 1975. A distributional checklist of North American genera of aquatic dryopoid
and dascilloid beetles (Elmidae, Dryopidae, Limnichidae, Chelonariidae, Heteroceridae,
Psephenidae, Ptilodactylidae, Cyphonidae, Georyssidae). Coleop. Bull., 29(3): 149-160.
Brown, H. P. 1976. Aquatic dryopoid beetles (Coleoptera) of the United States. Biota of
freshwater ecosystems, identification manual No. 6. U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency, Cincinnati, Ohio, 82 pp.
Brown, H. P. (in press). A catalog of the Coleoptera of America north of Mexico. Family:
Dryopidae. Family: Elmidae. Family: Psephenidae. U.S. Dept. Agric. Agric. Handbook
Number 529.
Hinton, H. E. 1939. An inquiry into the natural classification of the Dryopoidea, based partly
on a study of their internal anatomy. Trans. Roy. Entomol. Soc. London, 89:133-184.
Hinton, H. E. 1965. A revision of the Australian species of Austrolimnius (Coleoptera: El¬
midae). Aust. J. Zool., 13( 1):97— 172.
148
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hinton, H. E. 1968. The subgenera of Austrolimnius (Coleoptera: Elminthidae). Proc. Roy.
Entomol. Soc. London (B), 37(7-8): 98- 102, PI. 1.
Hinton, H. E. 1971. Some American Austrolimnius (Coleoptera: Elmidae). J. Entomol. (B),
40(2): 93-99, PI. 1.
Junk, W., and S. Schenkling. 1910. Coleopterorum Catalogus. Pars 17: Dryopidae, Cyatho-
ceridae, Georyssidae, Heteroceridae. W. Junk, Berlin, pp. 1-47.
Junk, W., and S. Schenkling. 1914. Ibid., Pars 58: Dascillidae, Helodidae, Eucinetidae. p.
3-20.
Leng, C. W. 1920. Catalogue of the Coleoptera of America north of Mexico. John D. Sherman,
Jr., Mt. Vernon, N.Y., 470 pp.
Steyskal, G. 1975. The family-group names based on the name of the genus Elmis Latreille
(Coleoptera). Proc. Entomol. Soc. Wash., 77(l):59-60.
NOTICE
This special issue of The Pan-Pacific Entomologist will be available for
$10.00 from The Pacific Coast Entomological Society, % Dr. Paul Arnaud
Jr., California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco,
California 94118.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 149-175
NOTES ON NOMENCLATURE AND CLASSIFICATION OF
HYDROPORUS SUBGENERA WITH THE DESCRIPTION
OF A NEW GENUS OF HYDROPORINI
(COLEOPTERA: DYTISCIDAE)1
G. William Wolfe
Dept. Entomology and Economic Zoology, Cook College-Rutgers
University, New Brunswick, New Jersey 08903
and
James F. Matta
Dept. Biol. Sciences, Old Dominion University,
Norfolk, Virginia 23508
Nearctic species of Hydroporus Clairville were last revised by Fall
(1923). He considered Oreodytes Seidlitz and Deronectes Sharp to be sub¬
genera of Hydroporus. His subgenus Hydroporus had four species groups:
niger-tenebrosus (= subgenus Hydroporus ) (48 nearctic species); pulcher-
undulatus (50 species); oblitus (9 species); and vilis (17 species).
Subsequent American workers have treated nearctic species on a regional
basis and in various ways. For example, Hatch (1953), dealing with the
fauna of northwestern America, referred Deronectes species ( sensu Fall)
to the subgenus Potamonectes Zimmermann, put Oreodytes quadrimacu-
latus Horn in the subgenus Deronectes and put the vilis, oblitus and pul-
cher-undulatus group species in the subgenus Heterosternus Zimmermann.
Young (1954), working on Florida water beetles, referred the pulcher-un-
dulatus species to Sternoporus ( =Heterosternus , preoccupied) and the
niger-tenebrosus species to Hydroporus (5. str.). Leech and Chandler
(1956) and Anderson (1962), working on California and Utah species re¬
spectively, accepted Oreodytes and Deronectes as genera. Larson (1975),
dealing with the Alberta fauna, felt that the various species groups of Hy¬
droporus probably deserved subgeneric status but treated all species under
Hydroporus (including Deronectes and Oreodytes ) because the groups were
inadequately defined. Zimmerman and Smith (1975) partially revised nearctic
Deronectes and treated it as a genus, but added that Hydroporus was a
heterogeneous assemblage of species and that there were significant differ¬
ences between the species groups within it.
Hydroporus has been a dumping ground for unrelated groups of species
and this is especially true of the pulcher-undulatus species group ( sensu
Fall) which consists of approximately 50 species. There are three species
150
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
groups within the pulcher-undulatus group that we feel require subgeneric
or generic status: pilatei-triangularis group (2 species); pulcher group (13
species); and undulatus group (about 35 species). All three are probably
limited to the Nearctic Region.
Use of subgenera seems especially warranted within Hydroporus. Opin¬
ions vary concerning desirability of using subgeneric names. Misuse (over¬
use) of them in the past has contributed to a great deal of nomenclatural
confusion.
We have elected to use subgeneric names in certain situations for several
reasons. (1) Hydroporus is a large, diverse genus and there are a number
of distinct lineages within it that are more closely related to each other than
any single group is to an excluded group. Although subgeneric differences
are not of the same magnitude as generic differences, many subgenera are
still readily recognized in the field (even by nonspecialists). (2) In speciose
genera, such as Hydroporus, subgeneric designations allow specialists to
conveniently refer to specific parts of a genus. (3) Although informal species
group names may sometimes be just as convenient, subgeneric names are
already available.
Here we discuss nomenclatural problems of Hydroporus, especially as
they pertain to the pulcher-undulatus group ( sensu Fall); describe a new
genus of Hydroporini, and review species assigned to it.
Nomenclature
There has been considerable confusion over the authorship of the genus
Hydroporus. Most authors have cited either Clairville or Schellenberg or
both. Helvetische Entomologie was published anonomously in 2 volumes
(1798 and 1806). The section dealing with aquatic Adephaga appears in vol¬
ume 2. The volumes are arranged with one page in German and the facing
page in French. According to Andrews (1939), Clairville only translated
Schellenberg’ s work. However, according to Mequignon (1940), Clairville
wrote both volumes and Schellenberg only did the illustrations. Mequig-
non’s evidence is rather persuasive, especially where it concerns segments
of the prefaces of volumes 1 and 2. Furthermore Schellenberg died in 1806.
Therefore, based on evidence available to us we believe that Clairville
should be recognized as author of Hydroporus.
There have been numerous type designations, summarized by Leech
(1948), that are invalid for various reasons: Dytiscus depressus Fabricus
and Dytiscus duodecimpunctatus Fabricius (not originally included spe¬
cies); Dytiscus parvulus Linnaeus (species inquirendum); and Dytiscus
palustris (on Clairville’ s list as Dytiscus sexpustulatus', Fabricius, however,
the synonym wasn’t noted in the type designation).
The type of Hydroporus is Hyphidrus pubescens Gyllenhal, designated by
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
151
Guignot (1946). Zaitzev (1953) designated Dytiscus erythrocephalus Linnae¬
us as the type of Hydroporus, but Guignot’ s designation has priority.
The genus Hydroporus has been variously divided into a number of sub¬
genera. Des Gozis (1914) described Suphrodytes as a monotypic subgenus
to include Hydroporus dorsalis Fabricius and this is still accepted by most
workers. Zimmermann (1919) described the subgenus Heterosternus basing
the separation of this group from Hydroporus ( s . str .) on the shape of the
medially produced postmetacoxal process, the prosternal process, and the
vittate or fasciate color pattern. His group of 37 species, although composed
primarily of nearctic pulcher-undulatus species ( sensu Fall), also included
species now assigned to the vilis and oblitus species groups {sensu Fall)
and the palearctic Hydroporus picicornis. Although Zimmermann didn’t
designate a genotype, the figure of the metacoxal process characteristic of
Heterosternus was that of Hydroporus concinnus LeConte ( =wickhami
Zaitzev).
There have been several type designations for Heterosternus. Leech
(1950) designated Hydroporus concinnus LeConte as the type of Hetero¬
sternus stating correctly that the designation of Guignot (1945) wasn’t valid.
However, Guignot (1942) stated (concerning Zimmermann’ s description of
Heterosternus ), “II designe done ainsi implicitement, mais formellement,
l’espece concinnus LeC. comme le type du nouveau sous-genre.’’ This is
a valid type designation according to article 69 (a) iii. Finally Guignot de¬
finitively designated the type again in 1949.
Falkenstrom in 1930 described Sternoporus as another new subgenus,
within Hydroporus. Although without formal designation, he used Hydro¬
porus longicornis Sharp as a standard of comparison and it seems obvious
that this should be considered the type.
Guignot (1931, 1942) incorrectly stated that Falkenstrom designated H.
longicornis as the type of Sternoporus. This is a valid type designation
according to Article 69(a)iii. Guignot (1931) also put Sternoporus in syn¬
onymy with Heterosternus Zimmermann. He then described a new subge¬
nus, Neoporus, with Hydroporus hebes Fall as the type-species. His major
diagnostic character was the medially produced metacoxal process which
was straight-edged on each side, not sinuate.
Strand (1935) recognized that Heterosternus Zimmermann was a hom¬
onym and proposed the name Heterosternuta. Falkenstrom (1938) stated
that because Heterosternuta Strand was feminine and Strand hadn’t rede¬
fined the subgenus when he proposed the name that a new name was nec¬
essary and he therefore proposed Heterostethus. Subgeneric names do not
have to agree in gender with their species and name changes do not require
a redefinition, so Heterostethus was unnecessary.
Guignot (1942) pointed out that Heterosternuta also wasn’t necessary
because the name Sternoporus Falkenstrom (1930) was available. Brinck
152
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
(1943), apparently unaware of Guignot’s 1942 paper, realized that Het-
erostethus Falkenstrom was itself a homonym and suggested retaining Het-
erosternuta with Hydroporus concinnus LeConte as the type, but this was
not necessary at this time because Sternoporus Falkenstrom had priority as
Guignot had already synonymized Sternoporus and Heterosternus.
In 1945, Guignot created the subgenus Hydroporinus (type Hydroporus
neglectus Sturm) and he also synonymized Neoporus Guignot with Ster¬
noporus Falkenstrom. He then created the subgenus Circinoporus with
Hydroporus cimicoides Fall as the type. This indicates Guignot didn’t un¬
derstand how closely related Hydroporus cimicoides was to H. hebes Fall,
Guignot’s type for Neoporus. In fact, Young (1954) indicates that H. hebes
may intergrade with both H. cimicoides and H. lobatus. Although Guignot
didn’t give a formal definition of Circinoporus, he did indicate diagnostic
characters in a key.
In 1947 Guignot included five more species in Hydroporinus. One of these
was H. longicornis, the type of Sternoporus. Although Sternoporus had prior¬
ity over Hydroporinus, Guignot continued to use the name Hydroporinus
for this group (including the type of Sternoporus ) but he also continued to
apply the name Sternoporus to some nearctic species.
Later Guignot (1949) acknowledged this mistake. He then took Hetero-
sternuta out of synonymy with Sternoporus ; Neoporus out of synonymy
with Sternoporus', synonymized Hydroporinus with Sternoporus and de¬
scribed a new subgenus, Hydroporidius (type Melanarius Sturm). There¬
fore, he recognized seven subgenera within Hydroporus: Hydroporus
Schellenberg (type pubescens Gyllenhal); Hydroporidius Guignot (type
melanarius Sturm); Sternoporus Falkenstrom (type longicornis Sharp);
Suphrodytes Des Gozis (type dorsalis Fabricius); Neoporus Guignot (type
hebes Fall); Circinoporus Guignot (type cimicoides Sharp) and Hetero-
sternuta Strand (type concinnus LeConte).
Palearctic workers have generally continued to use at least the first four
of these subgenera (see, for example, Franciscolo, 1979; Freude et al, 1971;
Zaitzev, 1953), and Zaitzev (1953) also used Hydroporinus as including lon¬
gicornis. Galewski (1971) however, used none of the subgenera. Nearctic
workers have generally ignored these groups although the name Sternopo¬
rus has been applied to Fall’s pulcher-undulatus group (see Young, 1954).
The net effect of Guignot (1949) was to isolate the pulcher-undulatus
species ( sensu Fall) in the last three subgenera {Neoporus, Circinoporus
and Heterosternuta ), because he separated Sternoporus and Heteroster-
nuta. Neoporus contained H. superiorus, uniformis, hebes and consimilis;
Circinoporus was monotypic with cimicoides’, and Heterosternuta con¬
tained the remaining species.
We are synonymyzing Circinoporus and Neoporus. These two subgeneric
names are obviously synonyms when respective types are considered as
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
153
we discussed above. Furthermore we are moving all species within
Heterosternuta, except the 13 pulcher group species, to Neoporus.
The pulcher group species, in this sense, constitute the subgenus Het¬
erosternuta (which has been revised, Matta and Wolfe, 1981). These species
form a monophyletic unit and deserve subgeneric rank. One other European
work has a direct bearing on taxonomy of nearctic groups. Franciscolo
(1979) described a new monotypic genus of Hydroporini, Sanfilippodytes,
from a cave in Mexico. The type-species, S. sbordonii Franciscolo, has re¬
duced eyes, is depigmented and the prosternal process does not reach the
metasternal process. Genitalia and the metacoxal process structure strongly
suggest that Sanfilippodytes may be congeneric with other nearctic vilis group
species currently included in Hydroporus. The relationship between vilis
group species and Sanfilippodytes needs to be studied carefully.
The following list summarizes our concept of subgeneric status within
Hydroporus :
Hydroporus Clairville 1806. Type Hyphidrus pub e see ns Gyllenhal by sub¬
sequent designation, Guignot (1942).
S. G. Suphrodytes Des Gozis 1914. Type H. dorsalis Fabricius by mono-
typy.
S. G. Heterosternuta Strand 1935. Type H. concinnus LeConte {=wick-
hami Zaitzev) by subsequent designation, Guignot (1942).
nec Heterosternus Zimmermann (1919),
nec Heterostethus Falkenstrom (1938).
S. G. Sternoporus Falkenstrom 1930. Type H. longicornis Sharp by sub¬
sequent designation, Guignot (1931).
Hydroporinus Guignot 1945. Type/7, neglectus Sturm by original des¬
ignation.
S. G. Neoporus Guignot 1931. Type H. hebes Fall by original designation.
Circinoporus Guignot 1945. Type H. cimicoides Sharp by original des¬
ignation.
S. G. Hydroporidius Guignot 1949. Type H. melanarius Sturm by original
designation.
Balfour-Browne (1940) also recognized Graptodytes Seidlitz, Stictonectes
Brinck, and Scarodytes Des Gozis as subgenera of Hydroporus. How¬
ever, more recent palearctic workers recognize those three taxa and
Metaporus Guignot and Porhydrus Guignot as distinct genera.
Falloporus, new genus
Diagnosis. — Among nearctic hydroporine groups, Falloporus is imme¬
diately recognizable by its enlarged fourth or fourth and fifth antennal seg¬
ments (Figs. 14-21), protarsal cupule (Fig. 32), and subapical setae of the
154
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 1-6. F. triangularis: Fig. 1. Scott Co., TN. Fig. 2. Blount Co., TN. Fig. 3. Van
Buren Co., TN. Figs. 4-6. Baldwin Co., AL.
parameres (Figs. 11-12). In addition, the metastemal process does not touch
the mesosternum (Fig. 27), there are no pronotal stria, and the prostemum
is declivitous, but not at all protuberant (Fig. 27).
Description. — Form elongate oval (length twice width); sides subparallel,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
155
Figs. 7-10. F. pilatei : Fig. 7. Gilchrist Co., FL. Figs. 8-9. Lauderdale Co., TN. Fig. 10.
Miller Co., G A.
pronotum and elytra continuous; rather depressed. Color variable with dark
fascia which vary from small spots to complete coalescence (Figs. 1-10).
Surface shining, but with microreticulation; entire dorsal and ventral sur¬
face, palps, antennae and metafemora densely covered with “button-like”
156
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 11-13. Fig. 11. F. pilatei. a. dorsal view of aedeagus and parmeres. b. apical (pos¬
terior) view of deflected tip of aedeagus. c. lateral view of aedeagus and parameres. Fig. 12.
F. triangularis, a. dorsal view of aedeagus and parmeres. b. apical (posterior) view of deflected
tip of aedeagus. c. lateral view of aedeagus and parameres. Fig. 13. F. triangularis ovipositor.
sensilla (Figs. 29-31). Scattered large setigerous punctures separated by
three times their width (Figs. 29-30).
Head broadest at posterior portion of eye; front and back margin of eye
shallowly emarginate. A series of coarse punctures at anteromedial comer
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1 157
Figs. 14-22. Figs. 14-19. F. triangularis. 14. Female antenna. 15. Male antenna, Benton
Co., TN. 16-19. Male antenna (segments 3-6). 16. Sauk Co., WI. 17. Lincoln Co., MS. 18.
Blount Co., TN. 19. Macon Co., AL. Figs. 20-21. F. pilatei, male antenna (segments 3-6).
20. Macon Co., GA. 21. Miller Co., GA. Fig. 22. F. triangularis. Inner view of sclerotized
lobes of proventriculus. a. oval, toothed outer lobe. b. inner valve-like ciliate lobe. c. side view
of outer lobe showing medially projecting tooth.
of eye. Clypeus not thickened, slightly margined laterally; labrum emargin-
ate, with dense golden setae medially. Mandibles with reduced medial teeth,
no medial fringe of setae (Figs. 24-25). Maxillary palps four segmented; last
segment distinctly emarginate apically, its length approximately equal to the
basal three segments combined. Ligula subtriangular in ventral view, mi-
cropunctate with a few sparse slender setae (Fig. 23a); a row of stout spines
along dorsal anterior edge (Fig. 23b). Mentum strongly lobed anteriorly,
lobes rounded, not arcuate; medial portion between labial palps produced
(Fig. 23b). Labial palpus four segmented, last segment distinctly notched.
Antennae with fourth or fourth and fifth segments variably broadened (Figs.
14-21).
Pronotum slightly more than 2 times broader than long, very narrowly
margined, lateral bead about 10-15% width of second antennal segment.
Pronotum without posterior lateral stria, anterior lateral angles produced
and subacute, posterior lateral angles rather sharp. A small pore-like open¬
ing present at each ventral anterolateral corner of pronotum. Prosternum
declivitous but not at all protuberant or rugose (Fig. 27). Prosternal process
lanceolate, widely margined laterally, distinctly longitudinally convex medi¬
ally; apex moderately acute; extending between mesocoxae and fitting in
158
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 23-25. Fig. 23. F. pilatei. a. Ligula and mentum, ventral view (250x). b. Apical-
dorsal edge of ligula showing arrangement of spines (250x). Figs. 24-25. Ventral view of
mandibles (a, right mandible; b, left mandible). 24. F. triangularis. 25. F. pilatei.
metasternal sulcus. Mesosternum and metasternum distinctly separated
(Fig. 27). Metafurca rather well developed (Fig. 26). Proventriculus of hy-
droporine type: outer lobes oval, with transverse teeth; inner lobes valve¬
like and ciliate (Fig. 22).
Scutellum concealed. Elytra widest in basal third, edges often parallel in
basal third; in side view straight, not ascending at base; epipleura gradually
narrowing posteriorly; epipleural width at anterior edge of second abdominal
sternite about 40% its basal width; no humeral carina on epipleura; no inner
ligula. Metasternum with a deep longitudinal sulcus medially for 50-75% of its
length (Fig. 27). Anterior and posterior edges of metacoxal plate subparallel;
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
159
metacoxal lines extending anteriorly to metasternum, almost parallel (not di¬
verging anteriorly). Posterior metacoxal process posterolaterally produced,
covering base of hind trochanters, concave on each side of middle; medially
produced, metacoxal cavities totally separate (Fig. 28). Metafemoral base not
touching metacoxal process. Metafemur appearing somewhat shining but
evenly covered with modified sensilla (micropunctate), with barely percep¬
tible sparse median line of setigerous punctures; posterodorsal edge cari¬
nate.
Protarsus and mesotarsus pseudotetramerous. Male protarsus slightly
broadened with cupule containing many foliate sensillae (Fig. 32). Anterior
male protarsal claw not modified; evenly curved and tapered from base to
apex. Parameres broadest at base, strongly tapered towards apices with long
subapical setae ; aedeagus strongly ventrally deflected and subacute apically
(Figs. 11-12). Ovipositors (Fig. 13) with anteriorly extended strut, valvifer
absent.
Type-species. — Hydroporus triangularis Fall (1917:170).
Etymology. — This genus is named in honor of Henry C. Fall. He made
many significant contributions to knowledge of North American water bee¬
tles.
Gender. — Masculine .
160
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 27-28. Fig. 27. F. triangularis. Metasternal process and prosternum, pro- and
mesocoxae removed. Note sulcate metasternum; metasternum not attaining mesosternum; and
non-protuberant prosternum (lOOx). Fig. 28. F. triangularis. Metacoxal apex (200x).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
161
Figs. 29-32. F. triangularis. Fig. 29. Metacoxa (115 x). Fig. 30. Elytron (115x). Fig. 31.
Elytron (2000x). Fig. 32. Protarsus with basal cupule (arrow) (160x).
Taxonomic Notes
Subgeneric status was first considered for Falloporus. This might seem
more consistent since Heterosternuta and Neoporus are kept as subgenera
and they are substantially larger groups (13 and 35 species respectively).
However, based on mesosternum-metasternum relationships, subgeneric
status within Hydroporus is untenable because Falloporus is more closely
162
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 33. 1-12 indicate measurements made for phenetic analysis. Area H encloses area
from which SEM photographs were taken (see Figs. 30-31).
related to other genera in Hydroporini. Each of these more closely related
groups (excluded from Hydroporus ) justifiably deserves generic status and
Falloporus is at least as distinct from each of them as they are from each
other.
Among Hydroporini, we have examined all species of Heterostemuta and
Neoporus and the mesosternum and mestasternum always contact each other
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
163
Table 1. List of OTUs with locality and identification data.
164
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 1. Continued.
ventromedially. Sharp (1882) and Balfour-Browne (1940) have shown that
the mesosternum and mestasternum contact in Hydroporus s . str., Laccor-
nis Des Gozis, Oreodytes, Graptodytes, Stictonectes, Scarodytes, Porhy-
drus, and Metaporus. Fall (1923) and Zimmerman and Smith (1975) have
shown that a few nearctic Deronectes have contacting segments. Non-con¬
tacting segments are known in Paroster Sharp, Antiporus Sharp, Nectrosoma
M’Leay, Megaporus Brinck, Hygrotus Stephens, and most Deronectes
(Sharp 1882). We also found the non-contacting conditions in Peschetius
Guignot and Falloporus.
A detailed discussion of hydroporine phylogeny is the subject of another
paper (in preparation), however, it can briefly be stated that there is strong
evidence that non-contact between the mesosternum and metastemum is an
apotypic condition. This indicates Falloporus does not belong in Hydro¬
porus ; instead, it shares a more recent common ancestor with other Hydro-
porini genera. Since Falloporus is at least as distinct as other nearctic and
palearctic genera, we have elected to raise it to generic status. Falloporus
is probably most closely related to Hygrotus or Deronectes.
Phenetics
Extreme variation in color pattern and antennal modification suggested
the possibility of one highly variable species rather than two distinct species.
Therefore, a cluster cluster, ordination, and discriminant analysis were per¬
formed on specimens of both presumed species of Falloporus.
All available specimens of Falloporus have been examined and at least
a representative sample of specimens from each collection, but usually the
entire collection, were measured for 14 characters. Measured characters
used are depicted in Fig. 33: 1; total length (TL), 2; total width (TW), 3;
median pronotal length (MPL), 4; lateral pronotal length (LPL), 5; head
width (HW), 6; interoccular distance (ID), 7; frons width (FW), 8; femur
length (FL), 9; width of 4th antennal segment (4W), 10; length of 4th anten¬
nal segment (4L), 11; width of 5th antennal segment (5W), 12; length of 5th
Table 2. Average of each OTU for measured variables. N = sample size. See text for other abbreviations.
ON
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
Table 2. Continued.
Os
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
167
oooooooooooooooooonaaaaaBBa a a a a a a □□□□□□ □□□
Fig. 34. Dendrogram resulting from cluster analysis. Squares are F. triangularis, circles
are F. pilatei ; open figures are females, closed figures males.
antennal segment (5L). Degree of pronotal color (PC) and elytral color (EC)
were also numerically coded. Male 4th and 5th antennal segment shape was
also recorded but since both males and females were used in the analysis
these characters were not used. Each collection was divided by sex because
of the sexual dimorphism exhibited by members of Falloporus and all mem¬
bers of a single sex from one collection made up an OTU. A total of 39
collections produced 55 OTUs and these are listed in Table 1 with their
collection localities. Before clustering and ordination were performed, the
39 collections were identified as pilatei, triangularis, or ‘intermediate.’ Our
identifications were based primarily on the characters presented by Fall
(1923) for distinguishing the two species.
Values for each variable in each OTU were averaged and these data are
reported in Table 2. These values were used to calculate a similarity coef¬
ficient matrix. The Canberra metric (Lance and Williams, 1967) was chosen
because it is not affected by the entire range of characters in the data set,
but only reflects those groups being compared (Sneath and Sokal, 1973).
This was thought desirable because of the presence of characters exhibiting
extreme sexual dimorphism. The similarity matrix was subjected to both
cluster analysis (group average) and ordination (PCORD technique) in order
to examine the relationships between the OTUs. Neither cluster analysis
nor ordination is preferred for the study of population variation and when
both are used additional insight is gained into the relationship between the
OTUs.
168
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
4-0
2-0-
o
X
CO
X
<
-2.0
-4.0-l___^^_
< I
-2.4 -1.2
T
0
▲
A
A A
A A *
A
aa
▲
A
A
▲
A
A
A
A
I
1.2 2.4
AXIS 1 (xlO1)
35
Fig. 35. Ordination of 55 OTUs on the first two principal coordinates. Triangles are F.
triangularis , circles are F. pilatei', open figures are females, closed figures males.
The result of the cluster analysis is presented in Fig. 34. The primary
grouping (at similarity level 0.874) is of the two putative phena. Within these
two major phena, OTUs are grouped into clusters of males and females. A
single OTU (53), triangularis female from Blount Co., TN, was misclassified
by the cluster analysis. Males from the same collection (52) were correctly
classified.
This result supports the two species concept. Alternative results (e.g.
three major clusters with the ‘intermediates’ clustering by themselves or
severe mixing of the previously designated pilatei and triangularis OTUs
in the same cluster) would have supported the single species concept.
A principal coordinate analysis was performed on the similarity matrix
and an ordination of the OTUs on the first two coordinates is shown in Fig.
35. The efficiency of the coordinates decreases rapidly because of the sexual
dimorphism exhibited by members of Falloporus. The first two coordinates
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
169
36
Fig. 36. Distribution of F. triangularis (squares) and F. pilatei (circles).
(28. 138 and 19.397) explain 47.5% of the variance in the similarity matrix. The
pattern in Fig. 35 indicates that the primary separation of species occurs along
the first axis with some minor separation along the second axis.
An examination of the loading matrix indicates that length (TL), width of
the 4th antennal segment (4W), and pronotal color (PC) load heavily on the
first coordinate while both 4th and 5th antennal segment width (4W and 5W)
load heavily on the second coordinate.
The ordination produced an interesting grouping of pilatei OTUs (cen¬
troid; Axis I = 0.0, Axis II = +2.0). These collections are all from the
southern coastal plain, but not all collections from this area are included in
the grouping. These collections appear to be specimens of pilatei which have
unusually reduced pronotal coloration. The collections which we had a priori
identified as ‘intermediate’ did not fall in the area between the two phena as
would have been expected if they represented true intermediate forms. They
were rather uniformly distributed within each major grouping.
Two OTUs (52 and 53) which we identified as triangularis fell into the
170
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
pilatei group; one of these (53) was misclassified by cluster analysis. Reex¬
amination revealed that pronotal coloration is about as in members of
triangularis, but length and width of the fourth and fifth antennal segments
are slightly larger than would be expected in triangularis. These OTUs (males
and females from the same collection) may represent hybrids between the
two species or may simply be extreme examples of Falloporus triangularis .
Discriminant analysis indicated that the most reliable characters for
separating the two species were size, antennal width, and antennal length
(although there was some overlap in these characters). Pronotal coloration,
which we have found to be a fairly reliable character for separating species
of Falloporus and which was also important in both clustering and ordination,
was not heavily weighted in the discriminant analysis. This was probably
due to high interpopulation variation within each species. Although dis¬
criminant analysis did not emphasize pronotal coloration, classification by
these techniques indicated 2 phena and in this respect was still in close
agreement with the results of the cluster and ordination analysis. There
were several exceptions. According to discriminant analysis, OTU’s 5 and 6
(originally identified as 7 male and 3 female pilatei ) were a mixture of both
species or possibly represented an intermediate population. OTU 52 which
was misclassified by ordination analysis and OTU 53 which was misclassified
by both cluster and ordination analyses, were both classified correctly by
discriminant analysis.
All three analyses indicate that there are two distinct phena and we
conclude that the statistical evidence does not support synonomization at
this time. Furthermore, the phena appear to prefer different habitats. Fal¬
loporus triangularis is more common in streams with undercut banks and
is usually found in upland situations. Falloporus pilatei usually occurs in
sluggish swampy rivers or streams or in adjacent pools, and occasionally in
dangling roots of shrubs in swamps. It is typically found on the coastal
plain.
A Key to Falloporus Species
1. Fourth and fifth male antennal segments broadened (Figs. 20-21);
pronotum more broadly infuscate (Figs. 7-10) . pilatei
Only fifth male antennal segment distinctly modified (Figs. 14-19);
pronotum less broadly infuscate (Figs. 1-6) . triangularis
Falloporus triangularis (Fall) NEW COMBINATION
Hydroporus triangularis Fall, 1917:170.
Diagnosis. — This species is distinguished from Falloporus pilatei by the
lack of modification of the 4th antennal segment of males (Figs. 14-19) and
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
171
by the less infuscate head and pronotum (Figs. 1-6). In dorsal view the
aedeagal apex of triangularis is slightly more truncate than that of pilatei
(Figs. 11a and 12a).
Description. — Males — Size (N = 51), length = 3.80 (3.39 to 4.26);
width = 1.82 (1.64 to 2.05); L/W = 2.09. Form elongate oval, tapered pos¬
teriorly, widest at middle or just anterior; pronotum and elytra continuous.
Lateral edges of pronotum gradually curved inward toward anterior angles,
bead extremely fine, not broadened anteriorly; much narrower than second
antennal segment. Prosternum declivitous (Fig. 27), not angularly protuber¬
ant. Prosternal process lanceolate, bluntly pointed, clypeus not thickened,
metasternum sulcate (Fig. 27). Fifth antennal segment variable but distinctly
broadened apically, usually appearing somewhat triangular.
Color pattern variable but almost always maculate (Figs. 1-6). Head usu¬
ally uniformly yellowish orange, sometimes variably infuscate bordering
eyes. Pronotum usually uniformly light yellowish orange, sometimes with
narrow infuscation along anterior and posterior edge. Elytral pattern with
variable light and dark fascia; sutural stripe usually vague, but sometimes
distinct or completely lacking; extending along basal edge to varying degrees
to form basal infuscation which is seldom connected to middle dark fascia.
Middle and apical dark fascia often extending from suture to lateral margin
and usually not connected to each other. The middle fascia is sometimes
isolated from the sutural stripe and narrower than usual, sometimes even
broken into two isolated spots. Apical fascia also sometimes greatly re¬
duced. Apices of elytra yellowish. Venter yellowish orange.
Microreticulation evident; dorsal and ventral surfaces usually densely
micropunctate (Figs. 29-31). Punctation of head extremely fine and dense;
coarser punctures in shallow depressions at anteromedial corners of eyes.
Pronotal punctation extremely fine and dense, coarser punctures along an¬
terior edge and scattered across disc; coarser punctures in discal area sep¬
arated by two to three times their width. Elytral punctures approximately
as coarse as coarser pronotal discal punctures, separated by two to three
times their width (Fig. 30); vague discal longitudinal series of denser punc¬
tures evident. Metacoxa and metasternum with scattered punctures,
coarsest on metasternum, microreticulation evident (Fig. 29).
Anterior protarsi not appreciably broadened, with distinct circular cu-
pules at basal end of first segment (Fig. 32). Aedeagus with ventral portion
deflected apically, much shorter than parameres; parameres with long sub-
apical setae (Fig. 12).
Females — Size (n = 43), length = 3.92 (3.44 to 4.26); width = 1.87 (1.67
to 2.00); L/W = 2.09. Similar to male. Antennae not modified. Ovipositor
as in Fig. 13.
Type locality. — Sauk City, Wisconsin.
Type data. — Fall (1917) states that his description of triangularis was
172
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
based on four males and six females from Sauk City, Wisconsin. These were
supposed to have been collected for Mr. J. D. Sherman by Mr. W. S.
Marshall. There is a series of four specimens of triangularis (two males and
two females) in the H. C. Fall collection at the Museum of Comparative
Zoology, Harvard University. All bear collection labels for Sauk City, Wis¬
consin. Additionally one has the date represented as VIII — 9.
One male, which we have designated as the lectotype, bears labels as
follows: (1) Sauk City, Wisconsin; (2) a male symbol; (3) TYPE triangularis
( triangularis is handwritten); (4) M.C.Z. type 23962; (5) H. C. FALL COL¬
LECTION; (6) Handwritten Lectotype label with GWW in the lower left
corner. The other three specimens have been designated paralectotypes and
handwritten paralectotype labels (with GWW in the lower left comer) have
been affixed to the pins.
Range. — This species ranges from Wisconsin to the southern Gulf coastal
plain (Fig. 36).
Habitat. — This is a lotic species, preferring undercut banks of clear water
streams. Teneral specimens were collected in August. The gut contents of
one of the specimens which we dissected contained a ceratopogonid pupa.
Falloporus pilatei (Fall) NEW COMBINATION
Hydroporus pilatei Fall, 1917:170.
Diagnosis. — Distinguished from triangularis by enlarged 4th antennal
segment (Figs. 20-21) and generally darker coloration of the head and prono-
tum (Figs. 7-10). In dorsal view, the aedeagus of pilatei is slightly more
apically tapered than that of triangularis (Figs. 11a and 12a).
Description. — Males — Size (N = 31); length = 4.02 (3.79 to 4.31);
width = 1.81 (1.65 to 2.05); L/W = 2.22. Prostemum, body form and most
morphological characters as in triangularis except 4th and 5th antennal
segments modified, appearing triangular (Figs. 20-21).
Coloration darker than triangularis (Figs. 7-10). Head infuscate around
eyes. Pronotum broadly infuscate. Discal area appearing lighter. Elytra with
light and dark fascia; sutural stripe distinct, extending along basal edge to
form basal fascia. Middle dark fascia broad, extending from sutural stripe
to the lateral margin, often connected to basal dark fascia, thus breaking the
basal yellowish fascia into two isolated spots. Apical dark fascia connected
to sutural stripe, sometimes expanded so light fascia between it and middle
dark fascia are reduced to restricted lateral spots. Apices of elytra yellowish.
Ventral surface orange.
Protarsi not appreciably broadened, with circular cupule at the base of
the tarsal segment. Anterior protarsal claw not modified; aedeagus and par-
ameres as in Fig. 11.
Females — Size (N = 38); length = 4.08 (3.67 to 4.36); width = 1.89 (1.69
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
173
to 2.05); L/W = 2.15. Similar to males, antennal segments unmodified;
ovipositor very similar to that of trinagularis.
Type locality. — Winnfield, Louisiana.
Type data. — Fall’s 1917 description of pilatei was based on a unique male
from Winnfield, Louisiana, collected by Mr. G. R. Pilate. The specimen
bears the following labels: (1) Winnfield VI-17 La.; (2) TYPE pilatei {pilatei
is handwritten); (3) M.C.Z. Type 23944; (4) H. C. FALL COLLECTION;
(5) Hydroporus pilatei Fall (handwritten); (6) a handwritten lectotype label
with GWW in the lower left corner. The speciment is very teneral.
Range. — Gulf and Atlantic coasts from North Carolina to Texas and north
to Tennessee (Fig. 36).
Habitat. — Unlike triangularis this species appears to prefer swampier
habitats and sluggish streams. Specimens have been collected from dangling
roots of marginal shrubs and from submerged vegetation on gently sloping
banks. Teneral specimens were collected in June and October.
Summary
Clairville is recognized as the author of Hydroporus and the correct type-
species is Hyphidrus pubescens designated by Guignot (1946). Within Fall’s
pulcher-undulatus group: Circinoporus is designated a synonym of Neoporus ;
Heterosternuta is recognized as the valid name for pulcher group species
(type H. concinnus = H. wickhami)\ and the name Neoporus is applied to
all other species except pilatei and triangularis. A new genus, Falloporus,
is described for pilatei and triangularis because these species are phylo-
genetically out of place in Hydroporus. The primary evidence for removal
from Hydroporus is that the mesosternum and metasternum contact each
other in all species groups and subgenera of Hydroporus, but do not contact
in Falloporus. Non-contacting segments is considered apotypic and this
indicates Falloporus has a more recent common ancestor with other Hy-
droporini genera than it does with Hydroporus.
It was initially suspected that pilatei and triangularis were actually a
single variable species; however, a phenetic analysis (cluster, ordination and
discriminant analysis) distinguished two phena. All but one specimen from
suspected hybrid zones and all specimens that were a priori considered inter¬
mediate in appearance were readily classified into two phena by the analysis.
Statistical evidence can never prove there are, in fact, two species; however,
here it is of sufficient strength that synonymizing pilatei and triangularis
would be unwise.
Falloporus keys to couplet 15 in Leech and Chandler’s (1956) Dytiscidae
key and may be separated using the following interpolation:
15. Prosternal process not protuberant (Fig. 27); male with fourth or
fourth and fifth antennal segments enlarged (Figs. 14-21); male
protarsal cupule present (Fig. 32); length greater than 3.3
Falloporus
mm
174
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Prostemal process usually protuberant (if not protuberant then
length less than 3.3 mm); male with fourth and fifth antennal
segments not enlarged and protarsal cupule absent . 15a
15a. Hind angles of pronotum rectangular or obtuse .
. (in part) Hydroporus
Hind angles of pronotum acute . (in part) Deronectes
Acknowledgments
Hugh Leech’s taxonomic and nomenclatural Dytiscidae studies have pro¬
vided a solid basis for this and other studies. Mr. W. Steiner (Smithsonian
Institution) and Drs. F. N. Young (Indiana University), G. Folkerts (Auburn
University), W. Hilsenhoff (University of Wisconsin) and P. J. Spangler
(Smithsonian Institution) generously loaned specimens. Mr. N. Stone (Mu¬
seum of Comparative Zoology, Harvard University) arranged for type spec¬
imen loans from the H. C. Fall Collection. Technical work involved with
specimen preparation for scanning electron microscope use was provided
by Ms. Mary Jacque Mann and Mrs. Susan Braden. Dr. Spangler also allowed
extensive use of his personal library of Dytiscidae literature. Mr. R. E.
Roughley (University of Alberta) and Drs. F. C. Thompson (USDA, Smith¬
sonian Institution) and T. Erwin (Smithsonian Institution) reviewed the
manuscript and provided critical, but always helpful and constructive, sug¬
gestions.
Literature Cited
Anderson, R. D. 1962. The Dytiscidae (Coleoptera) of Utah: keys, original citations, types
and Utah distribution. Great Basin Nat., 22:54-75.
Andrews, H. 1939. The generic names of British Carabidae, with a checklist of British species.
in The generic names of British insects. Published by Roy. Entomol. Soc., 6:153-192.
Balfour-Browne, F. 1940. British Water Beetles. Vol. I. London. Bernard Quartich, Ltd., 375
pp., plates I-V.
Balfour-Browne, F. 1940. The generic names of British Hydradephaga, with a checklist of
the British species. Part 7. 196-209. in The generic names of British Insects prepared
by the committee on generic nomenclature. Published by Roy. Entomol. Soc. Lond.
41 Queensgate, S.W. 7.
Brinck, P. 1943. Zur Kenntnis der Arten der Hyphydrus orientalis Gruppe. Forh. K. Fysiogr.
Sallsk Lund, 13(1943) 1944:124-133.
Clairville, J. 1806. Entomolie Helvetique. V2. Zurich, 247 pp.
Falkenstrom, G. 1930. Kritische bemerkungen iiber einige Dytisciden-arten, III. Zool. An-
zeiger, 87:21-39.
Fall, H. C. 1917. New Dytiscidae. J. N.Y. Entomol. Soc., 25:163-182.
Fall, H. C. 1923. A revision of the North American species of Hydroporus and Agaporus.
Mt. Vernon, N.Y., 129 pp.
Franciscolo, M. E. 1979. Fauna D’ltalia. Vol. XIV. Coleoptera, Haliplidae, Hygrobiidae,
Gyrinidae, Dytiscidae. Officine Grafiche Calderini-Bologna, 804 pp.
Freude, H., K. W. Harde, and G. A. Lohse. 1971. Die Kafer Mitteleuropas. Band 3. Adephaga
2, Palpicornia, Histeroidea, Staphylinoidea. Goecke and Evers, Krefeld, Germany,
365 pp.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
175
Galewski, K. 1971. Klucze do Oznaczania owadow Polski. Czese XIX. Chrzaszcze-Coleop-
tera. Zeszyt 7. Plywakowate-Dytiscidae. Warszawa. Panstwowe Wydawnictwe Nau-
kowe, 112 pp.
Des Gozis, M. 1914. Tableau de determination des Dytiscides, Noterides, Hyphydrides, Hy-
grobiides ed Haliplides de la fauna franco-rhenane. Misc. Entomol., 21:97-112.
Guignot, F. 1931. Notes sur quelques Dytiscides. Misc. Entomol., 33:5-7.
Guignot, F. 1942. Dix-septieme note sur les Hydrocanthares. Soc. D’Etud. Sci. Nat. Vau-
cluse, 16-21.
Guignot, F. (1943)1945. Dix-neuvieme note sur les Hydrocanthares. Bull. Soc. D’Etud. Sci.
Nat. Vaucluse, 14:5-9.
Guignot, F. 1946. Genotypes des Dytiscoidea et des Gyrinoidea. Rev. Fr. d’Entomol., 13:11 2—
118.
Guignot, F. 1947. Faune de France. 48. Coleopteres Hydrocanthares. Paris. Paul LeChevalier,
12 rue de Touron, 286 pp.
Guignot, F. 1949. Note sur les Hydrocanthares (vingt-neuvieme note). Bull. Inst. Roy. Sci.
Nat. Belgique, 25(26): 1-18.
Hatch, M. H. 1953. The Beetles of the Pacific Northwest. Part I. Introduction and Adephaga.
Univ. Wash. Publ. Biol., 16:198-231.
Lance, G. N., and W. T. Williams. 1967. Mixed data classification programs. I. Agglomerative
systems. Aust. Comput. J., 1:1-6.
Larson, D. J. 1975. The predaceous water beetles (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) of Alberta: Sys-
tematics, natural history and distribution. Quaest. Entomol., 11:245-498.
Leech, H. B. 1949(1948). Some nearctic species of hydradephagid water beetles, new and old.
(Coleoptera). Can. Entomol. 80:89-96.
Leech, H. B. 1950. Addendum: Some nearctic species of hydradephagid water beetles, new
and old. (Coleoptera). Can. Entomol. 81:233.
Leech, H. B., and H. P. Chandler. 1956. Aquatic Coleoptera, pp. 293-371, in Usinger,
R. L., Aquatic Insects of California. University of California Press. Berkeley, Los
Angeles. 508 pp.
Matta, J. F., and G. W. Wolfe, 1981. A revision of the subgenus Heterostemuta Strand
(Coleoptera: Dytiscidae: Hydroporus). Pan-Pac. Entomol. (in press).
Mequignon, A. 1940. Observations sur quelques noms de genre. IV. Un point de bibliography:
Clairville ou Schellenberg? Bull. Soc. Entomol. Fra., 45(1): 16-18.
Sneath, P. H. A., and R. R. Sokal. 1973. Numerical taxonomy. The principles and practice
of numerical classification. Freeman, San Francisco, 573 pp.
Strand, E. 1935. Revision von Gattungsnamen Palaearktischer Coleoptera. Folia Zool. Hydro-
biol. Giga, 7:282-299.
Young, F. N. 1954. The water beetles of Florida. Univ. Fla. Studies. Biol. Sci. Ser., V.5; ix
+ 238 pp.
Young, F. N., and G. Longley. 1976. A new subterranean aquatic beetle from Texas (Coleop¬
tera: Dytiscidae — Hydroporinae). Ann. Entomol. Soc. Amer., 69(5): 787-792.
Zaitzev, F. A. 1953. Fauna of the U.S.S.R. Coleoptera; Vol. IV. Amphizoidae, Hygrobiidae,
Haliplidae, Dytiscidae, Gyrinidae. Zool. Inst. Acad. Sci. USSR. New Ser. No. 58, 401 pp.
Zimmermann, A. 1919. Die Schwimmkaffer des Deutschen Entomologischen Museums in
Berlin-Dahlem. Arch. Naturg., 83(1 2): 68-249.
Zimmerman, J. R., and A. H. Smith. 1975. A Survey of the Deronectes (Coleoptera: Dytis¬
cidae) of Canada, the United States and North Mexico. Trans. Amer. Entomol. Soc.,
101:651-722.
Footnote
1 Portions of this work were completed during graduate study at the University of Tennessee
and during a postdoctoral fellowship at the Smithsonian Institution.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 176-219
A REVISION OF THE SUBGENUS HETEROSTERNUTA STRAND OF
HYDROPORUS CLAIRVILLE (COLEOPTERA: DYTISCIDAE)1
James F. Matta
Dept. Biol. Sciences, Old Dominion University,
Norfolk, Virginia 23508
AND
G. William Wolfe
Dept. Entomology and Economic Zoology, Rutgers University,
Cook College, Box 231, New Brunswick, New Jersey 08512
The nearctic species of the genus Hydroporus Clairville were last revised
by Fall (1923). Since Fall’s 1923 revision there have been several regional
treatments (Young, 1954; Leech and Chandler, 1955; Gordon, 1965; Larson,
1975) and several new species have been described in the nearctic fauna.
Also, Gordon has revised the niger-tenebrosus group (1969). Despite these
studies, much remains to be done, including the clarification of species
variation in several groups. The description of the larval forms and the
development of life history data for most species is still to be completed.
The members of the holarctic genus Hydroporus are widespread and oc¬
cupy a variety of aquatic habitats. They are commonly encountered at the
margins of lakes and rivers, are occasionally present in large numbers in
woodland pools, are frequently taken from springs, seepage areas, and oc¬
casionally from the faster flowing waters of small streams. Several species
( oblitus group) have been taken from wells and caves.
We believe that the species allied with pulcher form a morphologically
and ecologically related group which is sufficiently distinct to warrant subge¬
neric status. Wolfe and Matta (1981) have reviewed the generic and subge¬
neric synonomies within Hydroporus (with the emphasis on names appli¬
cable to Fall’s (1923) pulcher-undulatus group). In that paper Strand’s
subgenus Heterosternuta is recognized for those species which have been
known as the pulcher group ( sensu Fall). Here the subgenus and its species
are redescribed and a key is provided. Figures of adult color patterns, gen¬
italia and scanning electron micrographs are provided for each species.
Materials and Methods
Extensive collecting for specimens in this subgenus was conducted in the
eastern United States and the mid-south to add to the museum material
available and to determine habitat preferences. Specimens were collected
along margins of streams with a sturdy round or triangular framed dip net.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
177
The most productive areas were gravelly stream margins and isolated gravel
bottomed pools of water in drying stream beds. Specimens were found in
streams with a substrate of bedrock in the fissures and cracks where gravel
and algae accumulated. They are extremely abundant in suitable habitats
and occasionally we have collected hundreds of specimens along a few feet
of stream margin. Repeated vigorous scraping was often necessary and
frequently more specimens were collected after the area had been thor¬
oughly disturbed than in the initial stages of collecting.
Specimens were preserved in 80% alcohol which was changed after sev¬
eral hours. Dissection of genitalia was performed under a binocular micro¬
scope with jewelers forceps or a slightly hooked minutin. All drawings were
done with an ocular grid and camera lucida.
It is important to observe the structure of the genitalia in alcohol as well
as after they are dried and mounted on points. This is expecially true for
Hydroporus laetus Leech and H. ouachitus Matta and Wolfe. When wet
the thin bifid tips of the aedeagus bend gently inward; however, when dry
the tips flex out (Figs. 36c, 36e). All drawings in this paper are from wet
specimens unless otherwise indicated. The cleft bisecting the tip of the ae¬
deagus is often obscured in dorsal view and is best observed ventrally.
Specimens were borrowed from several individuals and museums and we
would like to thank the following people for aid in obtaining specimens: Dr.
G. A. Schuster (State Biological Survey of Kansas), Dr. L. L. Pechuman
(Cornell University), Dr. David Larson (Memorial University of Newfound¬
land), Dr. Ales Smetana (Biosystematics Research Institute, Canadian Na¬
tional Collection), Dr. K. C. Kim (Forest Entomological Museum, Penn
State University), Dr. William Hilsenhoff (University of Wisconsin), Mr. P.
Severance (University of Connecticut), Dr. Paul Spangler (National Mu¬
seum of Natural History), Dr. Frank Young (Indiana University), Dr. W.
Brigham (Illinois Natural History Survey) and Dr. L. Herman (American
Museum of Natural History). Type material from the H. C. Fall collection
was generously loaned from the Museum of Comparative Zoology (Harvard
University) and we thank Ms. M. M. Pearce for her assistance. We also
wish to thank Mr. Nicholas Stone (Museum of Comparative Zoology) for
searching through the LeConte collection for specimens of H. oppositus.
We especially appreciate Mr. R. E. Roughley’s critical review of the
manuscript. His suggestions for change and addition have increased the
usefulness of this work.
Technical work involving specimen preparation and scanning electron
microscope use was provided by Ms. Mary Jacque Mann and Mrs. Susan
Braden.
Subgenus Heterosternuta Strand
Diagnosis. — The species of Heterosternuta are narrow, elongate oval,
brightly maculate species and all possess a distinctly apically bifid aedeagus.
178
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
All but two species ( wickhami and oppositus ) have at least a portion of the
dorsal surface of the aedeagus sclerotized.
Redescription. — Form elongate-oval (almost always twice as long as
broad); pronotum and elytra continuous in outline; shining, usually brightly
maculate. Head broadest at posterior edge of eye. Front and back margin
of eye very shallowly emarginate. A series of coarser punctures by anterior
medial edge of eye. Clypeus not thickened; labrum distinctly emarginate,
emargination with dense golden cilia. Maxilla four segmented; ultimate seg¬
ment apically emarginate and approximately equal in length to basal three
segments. Labial palpus four segmented; ultimate segment about equal to
the combined lengths of second and third segments. Ligula roughly trian¬
gular, with a row of short spines along the anterior edge; mentum strongly
lobed anteriorly on each side, produced between the labial palps. Antennae
usually filiform (median segments expanded in diversicornis).
Pronotum broadest at base; basal width a little more than two times the
midlength. Lateral bead distinct, approximately equal to width of second
antennal segment. Posterolateral pronotal stria not present. Anterolateral
corners of pronotum produced, bluntly pointed, posterolateral angles sharp.
Prosternum distinctly declivitous (Figs. 41-45); declivity transversely ridged
or rugose (Figs. 46, 47); anterior portion sometimes with dense stiff setae.
Prosternal process lanceolate; strongly margined laterally; with definite me¬
dial ridge; bluntly pointed, apex extending between mesocoxae and touching
metasternum.
Elytra widest in basal third or at middle, gradually tapered posteriorly;
occasionally basal margins subparallel. In lateral view side margin straight,
not ascending at base. Epipleura gradually narrowing, but more strongly,
evenly constricted at level of second sternite.
Metasternum sulcate, shallowly in some species. Anterior and posterior
edges of metacoxal plates subparallel. Metacoxal lines extending anteriorly
to metasternum as thin carinate lines; lines a little divergent anteriorly.
Metacoxal process laterally produced, covering base of hind trochanters;
medially produced and sinuate on each side, apex recessed.
Metafemora shining, with definite medial line of setatious punctures. An¬
terior protarsi of male broadened; anterior protarsal claws modified. Usually
more strongly bent basally and more sinuate on the inner edge than the
posterior claw.
Genitalia symmetrical with parameres broadest at base; tapered poste¬
riorly; aedeagus always deeply bifid.
Type-species. — Hydroporus wickhami Zaitzev ( =H . concinnus LeConte)
(Guignot, 1942).
Distribution. — The subgenus, as now defined, is restricted to North
America, with most species found east of 97 degrees west longitude.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
179
Taxonomic notes. — There are many species of Hydroporus in addition to
the members of Heterosternuta which are found at the margins of streams;
however, none has the aedeagus split dorsoventrally. In our experience
species most frequently collected at stream margins and easily confused
with the Heterosternuta are H. stratiopunctatus , H. vitiosus and H. blan-
chardi. Dark specimens of H. blanchardi are easily confused with the dark
forms of H. oppositus but may be distinguished by the absence of prosternal
bristles. H. vitiosus was originally grouped with the pulcher-wickhami
group by Fall (1923) but Leech (1949) pointed out the aedeagus is not bifid
and vitiosus is not a member of this group. H. vitiosus may be separated
from the Heterosternuta on the basis of external characters by the combi¬
nation of the dark ventral surface and the lack of modified prosternal setae.
H. stratiopunctatus may be easily separated from all other species by the
alternating of deeply impressed elytral punctures and rather fine punctures.
Diagnostic characters. — A brief consolidated overview of diagnostic
characters is presented to facilitate use of the key, especially for the non-
taxonomic specialist.
Coloration. — The color of the head ranges from yellowish to orangish.
Head color differences have only been used to help separate ohionis Fall
(orangish) from jenniferae Wolfe and Matta (yellowish).
The most common pronotal color pattern in Heterosternuta consists of
an anterior infuscation (usually evenly extended along the entire anterior
edge) and a separate, more restricted and variable posterior infuscation.
The anterior infuscation is somewhat reduced in cocheconis Fall and div-
ersicornis Sharp and most reduced in ouachitus Matta and Wolfe. In three
species ( jeanneae Wolf and Matta, sulphurius Matta and Wolfe and laetus
Leech) the pronotum is uniformly reddish-brown.
Elytral coloration may only be used to conclusively identify one species,
jeanneae. In that species there is a large dark sub-medial elytral fascia (Fig.
8). Most other species possess two dark and three light fascia; however,
interconnections between dark fascia sometimes obscure the distinctly fas-
ciate appearance (e.g. compare Figs. 17-19).
Metasterna, metacoxa and abdominal sterna are usually orangish or yel¬
lowish. However, in oppositus and wickhami ventral coloration tends to be
dark blackish-red with medial portions of metacoxae and abdominal sterna
usually reddish. The degree of infuscation is more pronounced in wickhami
than oppositus.
Microsculpture . — The reticulation pattern is very conservative, usually
appearing as a pentagonal mesh. However, punctation can be a valuable
supplement in identification. In Heterosternuta, elytral and metacoxal punc¬
tures vary from fine and dense (Figs. 48, 61 pule her) to very coarse and
sparse (Figs. 59, 70 folkertsi). The differences between some species are
180
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
subtle while differences between others are so extreme that knowledge of
that difference can completely eliminate confusion. For example, the meta-
coxal punctation of pulcher is so fine it should not be confused with coarsely
punctate species like cocheconis, folkertsi, or ouachitus (Figs. 52, 59, 50).
Differences in elytral punctation are usually similarly useful.
Head. — There are few morphological head characters important in
species identification. The clypeus is not thickened and there is a series of
coarse punctures at the anterior corner of each eye in all Heterosternuta.
Antennae are always filiform; however, the broadened medial antennal seg¬
ments (5 through 8, segment 6 twice as broad as 11) of male H. diversicornis
(Fig. 25) affords ready identification of that species.
Pronotum. — Pronotal morphology and shape is not generally useful. The
pronotal margin is distinctive in H. oppositus specimens from the southern
portion of its range (southern Virginia and Tennessee), because it is subtly
sinuate anteriolaterally.
Prosternum. — The prostemum is always angularly declivitous (Figs. 42-
45). The declivity is less pronounced in some species but this variation is
too subtle to be useful.
The declivitous portion of the prosternum is ridged (Figs. 46, 47). In most
species the ridges are irregular (rugose) (Fig. 46) but in four species ( wick -
hami, oppositus, diversicornis, and jeanneae ) the ridges are transverse and
regularly placed (Fig. 47). The characters associated with the declivitous
area are consistent but minute.
The most useful, readily observable prostemal character involves the de¬
gree of modification of setae on the base of the prosternum, just anterior to
the procoxae. In some species prosternal setae are sparse and slender (Fig.
42); in other species prostemal setae are elongate, stiff and thickened (Figs.
43-45). Modified setae are present in diversicornis, jeanneae, wickhami,
oppositus, jenniferae and ohionis', however, the modified setae are less
developed in the last two species.
Elytra. — In a few species {ouachitus, alleghenianus Matta and Wolfe and
cocheconis ) the basal, lateral, outer edge of each elytron is very slightly
concave for about Vs its length.
Metacoxae. — Metacoxal characters are not of use in most species; how¬
ever, there is a distinct pubescence (Figs. 40-41) restricted to the internal
lamina on one species, diversicornis.
Figs. 1-13. Figs. 1, 2. H. folkertsi, Jefferson Co., AL. Figs. 3, 4. H. jenniferae, Trousdale
Co., TN. 5. H. sulphurius, Benton Co., AR. Fig. 6. H. ohionis, Clarke Co., KY. Fig. 7. H.
ohionis, Dearbome Co., IN. Fig. 8. H. jeanneae, Trousdale Co., TN. Fig. 9. H. allegheni¬
anus, Morgan Co., TN. Figs. 10, 11. H. alleghenianus, Stewart Co., TN. Fig. 12. H. ouach¬
itus, Polk Co., AR. Fig. 13. H. diversicornis, Blanco Co., TX.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
181
182
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
183
Legs. — Leg morphology is very uniform and not of use in species iden¬
tification. Secondary sexual characteristics of the pro tarsus and protarsal
claw are discussed below.
Genitalia. — The aedeagus apex is always deeply bifid and this is especially
evident in ventral view (Figs. 26-38). In some species there is a distinct
subapical ventral projection evident in lateral view (Figs. 30-33, 35); in other
species this projection is reduced and appears more as an angular promi¬
nence (Figs. 34, 36-38). The subapical ventral projection is absent in four
species (Figs. 26-29).
The dorsal aedeagal surface is completely membranous only in oppositus
and wickhami. In all other species at least a portion of the dorsal surface
is sclerotized. In most species there is a small sclerotized cross bridge in
the posterior dorsal portion of the aedeagus (Figs. 28, 30-37) but in diver-
sicornis the entire dorsal surface is sclerotized (Fig. 29).
Length. — Total length is so variable that it is only helpful in separating
the smallest species, alleghenianus, from other Heterosternuta.
Secondary sexual characters. — In some species males are shinier than
females. In most Heterosternuta the protarsi are broadened and the anterior
protarsal claw is more strongly bent basally and at least vaguely sinuate on
the inner side. Protarsal modifications are least pronounced in folkertsi and
cocheconis and most pronounced in jeanneae (Fig. 39f) and some oppositus
(from southern Virginia and Tennessee).
The modified antennal segments in diver sicornis were discussed above.
Additionally, the pubescence of the metacoxae of diver sicornis is denser in
males (Fig. 40) than in females (Fig. 41).
A Key to the Species of Subgenus Heterosternuta Strand
1 . Pro sternum with dense tufts of thickened setae anterior to the cox¬
ae (Figs. 43-44) . 2
Without modified prosternal setae (Fig. 42) . 7
2. With the area between the coxal lines densely pubescent (Figs. 40-
41); male with middle antennal segments (5-8) broadened and
flattened, 6th segment twice as broad as 11th) (Fig.
24) . diversicornis
Figs. 14-25. Fig. 14. H. cocheconis, Cambria Co., TN. Fig. 15. H. cocheconis, Tolland
Co., CT. Fig. 16. H. wickhami, Bledsoe Co., TN. Fig. 17. H. oppositus Grundy Co., TN.
Fig. 18. H. oppositus, Frederick Co., VA. Fig. 19. H. oppositus, Benton Co., VT. Fig. 20.
H. laetus, Trimble Co., KY; Fig. 21. H. laetus, Macon Co., TN; Fig. 22. H. pulcher, Ross
Co., OH. Fig. 23. H. pulcher, DeKalb Co., TN. Fig. 24. H. pulcher, E. Varick, NY. Fig.
25. H. diversicornis, antennae (male right, female left).
184
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 26, 27. Fig. 26. H. oppositus. Fig. 27. H. wickhami. a, aedeagus, lateral view; b,
posterodorsal view (note absence of sclerotized cross bridge, see Fig. 28); c, ventral apex; d,
dorsal view; e, paramere, lateral view.
Figs. 28-29. Fig. 28. H. jeanneae ; a, lateral view of aedeagus (arrow indicates postero¬
lateral pustules); b, posterodorsal view (arrow indicates sclerotized cross bridge); c, ventral
apical view of aedeagus; d, dorsal view of aedeagus; e, paramere, lateral view. Fig. 29. H.
diversicornis; a, aedeagus, lateral view; b, aedeagus, ventral apical view; c, aedeagus, dorsal
view; d, paramere, lateral view.
186
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
The area between the coxal lines not pubescent; male with middle
antennal segments (5-8) not broadened (6th segment equal or
slightly wider than 11th) . 3
3. Pronotum uniformly reddish-brown; elytron with a pale basal fascia
and a long posterior dark brown fascia (Fig. 8). Aedeagus pos-
terolaterally with minute denticles (Fig. 28a); apex elongate,
gently tapering . jeanneae
Pronotum with some pale fascia; elytron not as above, usually with
2 dark and 3 light fascia . 4
4. Aedeagus with a posterior sclerotized bridge (Fig. 28b); metacoxal
punctation coarse (Figs. 57-58); ventral surface yellowish or
orangish . 5
Aedeagus without a posterior sclerotized bridge (Figs. 26-27);
metacoxal punctation finer (Figs. 54-55); usually with extensive
darkening of the ventral surface, at least laterally . 6
5. Length 3.3 mm or less; head more orangish or reddish; aedeagus
as in Fig. 32 . ohionis
Length usually greater than 3.3 mm; head rather yellowish; ade-
agus as in Fig. 31 . jenniferae
6. Ventrally more blackish, elytral (Fig. 62) and metacoxal (Fig. 54)
punctation just perceptibly finer. Best separated from oppositus
by the shape of the aedeagus (Fig. 27a) which is more distinctly
deflected ventrally at the apex . wickhami
Ventral surface reddish, at least medially; elytral (Fig. 63) and
metacoxal (Fig. 55) punctation a little coarser; aedeagus (Fig.
26a) more elongate, not as distinctly deflected at apex . . oppositus
7. Length less than 3.1 mm, usually less than 3.0 mm; aedeagus with
a distinct ventral projection (Fig. 30a) . alleghenianus
Length usually greater than 3.1 mm, if less than 3.1 mm and aede¬
agus with a ventral projection then pronotum completely
infuscate . 8
8. Pronotum uniformly reddish brown (Figs. 5, 20-21) or with yellow
markings reduced to very small spots . 9
Pronotum with transverse anterior and posterior infuscation, disc
yellow (Figs. 9-13) . 10
9. Aedeagus apex extremely acute in dorsal view, with a distinct ven¬
tral projection (Fig. 30) . sulphurius
Aedeagus apex not very acute in dorsal view, without a ventral
projection (Fig. 36) . laetus
10. Metacoxal punctation very distinctly fine and dense (Fig. 48); ae¬
deagus broadly flattened at apex (Fig. 38) . pulcher
Metacoxa more coarsely punctate (Figs. 50, 52, 59), not appearing
smooth . 11
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
187
Figs. 30, 31. Fig. 30. H. sulphurius . Fig. 31. H.jenniferae. a, aedeagus, lateral view (arrow
indicates ventral subapical prong); b, aedeagus, posterodorsal view; c, aedeagus, ventral apical
view; d, aedeagus, dorsal view; e, paramere, lateral view.
188
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 32, 33. Fig. 32. H. ohionis. Fig. 33. H. folkertsi. a, aedeagus, lateral view; b, ae-
deagus, posterodorsal view; c, aedeagus, ventral apical view; d, aedeagus, dorsal view; e,
paramere, lateral view.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
189
Figs. 34-35. Fig. 34. H. cocheconis', a, aedeagus, lateral; b, aedeagus, posterodorsal; c, d,
aedeagus, ventral apical (bifurcate tips showing variation); e, aedeagus, dorsal; f, paramere,
lateral. Fig. 35. H. alleghenianus ; a, aedeagus, lateral (arrow indicates ventral subapical
prong); b, aedeagus, posterodorsal; c, aedeagus, ventral apical; d, aedeagus, dorsal; e, para¬
mere, lateral.
190
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
11. Aedeagus as in Fig. 34; size variable but usually greater than 3.3
mm; northeastern U.S. and Canada . cocheconis
Aedeagus not as above; size usually less than 3.3 mm; not in north¬
eastern U.S . 12
12. Aedeagus as in Fig. 33; presently known from Alabama
. folkertsi
Aedeagus as in Fig. 37; presently known from the Ozark
province . ouachitus
Hydroporus alleghenianus Matta and Wolfe
Hydroporus alleghenianus Matta and Wolfe 1979:291.
This is the smallest species in the pulcher group with an average size of
less than 3 mm. Small specimens of several species approach this size, but
may always be separated on the basis of the male genitalia. The species is
quite uniform in size throughout its range; however, some specimens from
the western portions of its range have the medial and apical fascia broadly
coalesced.
Description. — Length 2.6 to 3.1 mm; width 1.2 to 1.5 mm. Form elongate
oval, sides of elytra subparallel, widest at middle, elytra and pronotum
almost continuous in outline, however basal lateral elytral edges very slight¬
ly concave. Lateral margins of pronotum evenly rounded inward toward the
anterior angles, lateral bead distinct, gradually broader anteriorly, at max¬
imum width a little less than the width of the second antennal segment.
Prosternal prominence angular, not protuberant, file area rugose, prosternal
process lanceolate, bluntly pointed, modified prosternal setae absent.
Rather shining dorsally, a little alutaceous. Head pale yellow; pronotum
with broad blackish band along anterior margin, basal infuscation very nar¬
row, sometimes scarcely evident, discal and lateral areas pale yellow. Elytra
with yellow and brownish-black fascia (Figs. 9-11). Sutural stripe usually
distinct and extending narrowly laterally up to one half the basal width.
Medial fascia broad, undulating, sometimes isolated from the sutural stripe;
basal and medial fascia not connected. Apical fascia smaller, also occasion¬
ally isolated from the sutural stripe, apical and medial fascia usually sepa¬
rate; however, some specimens have broadly coalesced apical and medial
fascia, usually isolated from the sutural stripe.
Dorsal surface with evident microreticulation. Head randomly, finely
punctate, punctures usually separated by 1 to 3 times puncture width; finer
anteriorly, densest in shallow depressions. Pronotal punctures a little
coarser, usually separated by 1 to 2 times puncture width, somewhat denser
paralleling the anterior margin. Elytral punctation fine, somewhat sparse,
punctures separated by about 2 puncture widths (Fig. 65). Ventrally meta-
coxal punctures coarse, somewhat sparse (Fig. 49). Metasternal punctures
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
191
Figs. 36, 37. Fig. 36. H. laetus. Fig. 37. H. ouachitus. a, aedeagus, lateral; b, aedeagus,
posterodorsal; c, aedeagus, ventral apical; d, aedeagus, dorsal (wet); e, aedeagus, dorsal apex
(dry); f, paramere, lateral.
192
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 38-39. Fig. 38. H. pulcher; a, aedeagus, lateral view; b, aedeagus, posterodorsal; c,
aedeagus, ventral apical; d, aedeagus, dorsal; e, paramere, lateral. Fig. 39. a-e, H. oppositus;
anterior protarsal claw of male; a, Grundy Co., TN; b, Grainger Co., TN; c, Frederick Co.,
YA; d, Belfrage, PA; e, Benton Co., VT; f, H. jeanneae, Trousdale Co., TN.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
193
Figs. 40, 41. H. diversicornis metacoxae (96x). Fig. 40. Male; Fig. 41. Female.
a little coarser, finer medially. Abdominal sternum 1 and anterior half on
sternum 2 coarser, rest of abdomen finer.
Male protarsi and anterior protarsal claw scarcely modified. Aedeagus
with subapical ventral projection peg-like (Fig. 34).
Females are similar to males. No external sexual characters are evident.
Larvae. — U nkno wn .
Type data. — The holotype and allotype are from Bath Co., VA, collected
by J. F. Matta on VIII-9-73. They are deposited in the collection of J. F.
Matta but have NMNH type number 75967.
Range. — Indiana, Ohio, Illinois, Virginia, Kentucky, North Carolina,
Tennessee (Fig. 74).
Natural history. — Teneral specimens were collected in August. This
species is found in marginal pools of streams with pebble substrate and leaf
litter. Large collections have been obtained from very small (possibly in¬
termittent) streams. While some specimens have been collected from the
stream itself most were found in small coves or isolated pockets of water
less than 0.5 meters wide.
Hydroporus cocheconis Fall
Hydroporus cocheconis Fall 1917:171.
This species may be separated from other Heterosternuta by the absence
of prosternal setae, the coarse punctation of the ventral surface (Fig. 52)
and the distribution (northeastern U.S. and Canada).
Description. — Length 3.0 to 3.7 mm; width 1.4 to 1.8 mm. Form elongate
oval, widest at middle; elytra almost parallel sided for the basal half, very
194
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 42-45. Prostemum and prostemal process, legs and head removed. Fig. 42. H.
pulcher (180x). Fig. 43. H. ohionis (114x). Fig. 44. H. jenniferae (123x) (arrow points to
prosternal bristles). Fig. 45. H. wickhami (132x).
slightly concave in basal third; edges of elytron and pronotum continuous in
outline. Lateral margins of pronotum evenly rounded toward anterior angle
and with well defined lateral bead which widens anteriorly; at widest point
about the width of fourth antennal segment. Prosternal prominence angular
but not distinctly protuberant, file not pronounced; modified prosternal setae
absent; prosternal process broadly lanceolate, blunt at tip.
Strongly shining dorsally, head pale yellow with light brown mottling
which is darkest posterior to eyes. Antennae brown with the last segment
infuscate. Pronotum with an even broad dark band on the anterior margin
which does not extend to the side margins. Elytra (Figs. 14, 15) with sutural
stripe distinct. Middle and apical spots narrowly connected to each other
and broadly connected to the sutural stripe. Ventral surface yellow-brown,
legs slightly darker.
Dorsal surface with reticulation fine and weak, especially on the elytra.
Punctation of head very fine; pronotal and elytral (Fig. 64) punctation larger,
punctures separated by as much as a puncture width (Fig. 64). Ventral
punctation coarser; metastemal and metacoxal punctures quite large and
separated by less than Vi a puncture width (Fig. 52). Abdominal sternum 1
and anterior portion of 2 coarsely punctate; rest of abdomen finely punctate.
Male protarsi slightly broader than female, with anterior protarsal claw
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
195
Figs. 46-49. Fig. 46. H. ouachitus, rugose prosternal declivity (400x). Fig. 47. H.jean-
neae, transversely ridged prosternal declivity (384x). Fig. 48. H. pulcher, metacoxal punc-
tation (150x). Fig. 49. H. alleghenianus, metacoxal punctation.
bent at base and slightly broadened on inner margin. Aedeagus and para-
meres as in Fig. 34.
Variation. — Specimens from Connecticut are smaller than average and
are strongly marked with the darker markings appearing almost black.
Larvae. — Unknown.
Type data. — Fall (1917) never designated a holotype but stated that he
had a series of specimens from the Cocheco River at Farmington, New
196
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hampshire, which were taken in July and August. The type series is in the
MCZ and there are 8 specimens collected in July and August 1900 and 1
specimen collected in August 1902.
One male bears a type label with the number 23919; however, the genitalia
of this specimen are apparently lost. Since there has never been a published
type designation we have designated another male specimen as the lectotype
and all other syntypes as paralectotypes.
Range. — The northeast; Quebec, New Hampshire, Vermont, New York
and Connecticut (Fig. 75).
Natural history. — This species is typically found at gravelly margins of
smaller streams in areas protected from the current, or in overhanging vege¬
tation.
Hydroporus diversicornis Sharp
Hydroporus diversicornis Sharp 1882:437.
This is the most easily recognized of all of Heterosternuta because of the
densely pubescent area (Figs. 40, 41) between the coxal lines in both sexes
and the modified male antennae (Fig. 25). It also has dense, modified pro-
sternal setae. This species has not previously been included in the pulcher
group but is included in the subgenus on the basis of the following charac¬
teristics: 1; the length to width ratio is 2.0 in most specimens; 2; the un¬
modified clypeus; 3; the aedeagus is highly modified and atypical of the
subgenus but is split at the tip; 4; finally prostemal bristles are present and
this character has been found only within this subgenus.
Description. — Length 4.2 to 4.6 mm; width 2.15 to 2.3 mm. Form elongate
oval, elytra parallel sided in basal half; elytra and pronotum continuous in
outline, pronotal margin evenly curved towards anterior angles; with a flat¬
tened lateral bead which gradually widens anteriorly; at widest point about
equal to width of last antennal segment. Modified pro sternal setae distinct;
prostemal process protuberant; with a distinct anterior file; process lanceo¬
late posterior to procoxae.
Strongly shining dorsally. Head, including antennae, and pronotum ru-
fotestaceous; pronotum with an infuscation on the anterior margin which
extends no more than Vi of the distance to the lateral margin. Posterior
margin with a narrow brown border. Elytra flavotestaceous with brown
markings. Sutural stripe reduced to a narrow dark line bordering the suture.
Dark markings consisting of a strongly undulating medial fascia which reach¬
es the suture, a postmedain spot and postapical fascia which is usually
connected along the suture to the medial fascia. Ventral surface rufotesta-
ceous, somewhat lighter on the abdominal sterna.
Dorsal surface finely alutaceous, markedly so on the pronotum. Punctures
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
197
Figs. 50-55. Metacoxal punctation. Fig. 50. H. ouachitus (150 x). Fig. 51. H. laetus
(150x). Fig. 52. H. cocheconis (150x). Fig. 53. H. diversicornis (150x). Fig. 54. H. wickhami
(150x). Fig. 55. H. oppositus (123x).
of head fine and sparse; pronotal punctation coarser and denser, punctures
separated by up to 1 puncture width. Punctation of elytra (Fig. 72) about
the same size as pronotal punctation but more densely applied; separated
by Vi a puncture width or less. Ventral surface with punctures of metaster-
198
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 56-61. Metacoxal punctation. Fig. 56. H. sulphurius (150x). Fig. 57. H. jenniferae
(150x). Fig. 58. H. ohionis (150x). Fig. 59. H. folkertsi (150x). Fig. 60. H. jeanneae (150x).
Fig. 61. Elytral punctation, H. pulcher (350x).
num and metacoxae (Fig. 53) about the size of pronotal punctures; separated
by 114 to 2 puncture widths. Abdominal punctures finer. The space between
the coxal lines is covered with a dense pile of white hairs.
Male protarsi broadened; anterior pro tarsal claw shorter and slightly
thicker than posterior claw. Male with middle antennal segments (Fig. 25)
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
199
Figs. 62-67. Elytral punctation. Fig. 62. H. wickhami (308x). Fig. 63. H. oppositus
(308x). Fig. 64. H. cocheconis (350x). Fig. 65. H. alleghenianus (350x). Fig. 66. H. ouach-
itus (350x). Fig. 67. H. laetus (350x).
broadened and flattened. Aedeagus decidedly aberrant; fully sclerotized dor-
sally and ventrally (Fig. 29).
Female similar to male except there is no protarsal or antennal modifi¬
cation and the pubescent area between the coxal lines is less dense.
Larvae. — Unknown.
200
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 68-73. Elytral punctation. Fig. 68. H. jenniferae (400x). Fig. 69. H. ohionis (400x).
Fig. 70. H. folkertsi (350x). Fig. 71. H. sulphurius (350x). Fig. 72. H. diversicornis (350x).
Fig. 73. H. jeanneae (350x).
Type data. — The specimens on which Sharp based his description are
presumably deposited at the British Museum of Natural History; however,
we have not examined them.
Range. — Texas, Oklahoma and Kansas (Fig. 76).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
201
Natural history. — We have collected this species from overhanging grassy
banks beside flowing portions of streams in Texas. Occasional specimens
have been reported from temporary ponds in Kansas.
Hydroporus folkertsi Wolfe and Matta
Hydroporus folkertsi Wolfe and Matta 1979:175.
The unusually elongate narrow form and very coarse punctation (Figs.
59, 69) distinguish this species. The aedeagus is similar to that of ohionis
but that species has modified prosternal setae.
Description. — Length 3.0 to 3.4 mm; width 1.4 to 1.7 mm. Form quite
elongate oval, very narrow, widest at middle. Lateral edges of pronotum
evenly rounded toward the anterior angles, lateral bead distinct. Modified
prosternal setae not present; prosternal prominence angulate but reduced;
prosternal process lanceolate posterior to procoxae.
Rather strongly shining dorsally; head entirely pale yellow. Antennae pale
yellow with articles 8 to 11 becoming gradually infuscate. Pronotum with
even broad brownish infuscation along the anterior margin, posterior infus-
cation restricted to the middle third with the anterior edge undulating; discal
and lateral areas yellow. Elytra (Figs. 1, 2) with sutural stripe distinct and
extending one third of the length of the elytral base. Middle and apical fascia
not connected, usually connected to the sutural stripe. Ventral surface en¬
tirely yellowish.
Dorsal surface with perceptible reticulation, somewhat effaced on elytra.
Punctation of head sparse and fine, denser on vertex between eyes, sparser
anteriorly, densest in shallow depressions at antero-lateral corners of eyes.
Pronotum with narrow area of denser punctures parallel to anterior margin,
discal punctures slightly coarser, coarsest punctures along posterior edge
in infuscation. Elytra (Fig. 69) with coarse and sparse punctures, somewhat
less coarse laterally and apically; a vague lengthwise series of finer punc¬
tures evident in discal area and adjacent to suture. Ventrally metacoxae
very coarsely and sparsely punctured (Fig. 59), metasternal punctures finer
medially. Abdominal sterna finely punctate except sternum 1 and the an¬
terior portion of 2.
Male protarsi scarcely broadened; anterior protarsal claw strongly bent
at base, otherwise scarcely modified. Aedeagus with distinct narrow sub-
apical projection located ventrally (Fig. 33).
Female with anterior protarsal claw gradually and evenly tapered and
curved; female not otherwise discernible from male on the basis of external
characters.
Larvae. -Unknown.
Type data. — The holotype and allotype are from a woodland stream 1.5
mi. N. of Praco on Co. Rd. 81, 18 Dec. 1977, collected by Jennifer, Jeanne
202
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
and G. W. Wolfe. The primary types are in the NMNH with type number
75500.
Range. — Known only from the type locality in Jefferson Co., Alabama
(Fig. 74).
Natural history. — The type locality is a small woodland stream (3 to 8
feet wide) with a gravel rock and rubble bottom. All specimens were taken
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
203
along the margin in overhanging grass and leaves. Both of the existing col¬
lections were made in January.
Hydroporus jeanneae Wolfe and Matta
Hydroporus jeanneae Wolfe and Matta 1979:174.
This species is quite easily distinguished by its unique elytral pattern
which consists of a pale basal fascia and a large submedial dark brown fascia
(Fig. 8). The combination of a uniformly reddish brown pronotum (Fig. 8)
and the presence of prostemal setae is also a distinctive combination. The
only other species which have a concolorous pronotum, H. laetus and H.
sulphurius , lack prostemal setae and are also easily separated by aedeagus
morphology.
Description. — Length 3.1 to 3.5 mm; width 1.6 to 1.8 mm; form evenly
elongate oval, widest at middle, pronotum and elytra continuous in outline.
Lateral margins of pronotum evenly rounded toward the anterior angles,
lateral bead distinct and at maximum width about equal to the width of the
second antennal segment. Modified prostemal setae distinct and dense;
prostemal prominence distinctly angulate and somewhat produced; file com¬
posed of regularly placed transverse ridges (Fig. 47). Prostemal process
lanceolate posterior to procoxae.
Not strongly shining dorsally; head light brownish yellow and vaguely
infuscate on each side of head between eyes and at occiput. Antennae light
reddish yellow with eleventh segment infuscate. Pronotum entirely dark
reddish-brown, slightly darker anteriorly. Elytra (Fig. 8) with one large dark
fascia in posterior half, pale yellow band across basal third and apical sixth;
pale markings also evident in lateral areas of the discal fascia. Dark brown¬
ish sutural stripe extending from apex to base of elytra then laterally along
the base to two thirds the width, expanding at middle of base. Ventral
surface orange.
Dorsal surface with perceptible micro reticulation. Punctation on head
sparse and fine, denser on vertex between eyes, finer anteriorly, densest in
shallow depressions at antero-lateral corners of eyes. Pronotal punctation
finer medially, elytral punctation coarser (Fig. 73), with a vague lengthwise
series of discal punctures on elytra. Ventral punctation (Fig. 60) coarser
than dorsal punctation, rather dense; punctation of abdominal sternum 1
and anterior portion of sternum 2 very coarse, posterior portion of 2 and 3
through 5 finer.
Protarsi broadened; anterior protarsal claw strongly sinuate internally.
The aedeagus is distinct (Fig. 28); it possesses posterolateral denticles and
is deeply cleft.
Female similar to the male but slightly more alutaceous. Anterior tarsi
204
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 75. H. cocheconis •; H. laetus ■.
narrower and anterior protarsal claw evenly curved and tapering. The ab¬
dominal sterna are more infuscate.
Larvae . — Unknown.
Type data. — The holotype and allotype are from Trousdale Co., TN, 1
mi. N. Barthelia on Hwy 231-10, 20 June 1977, and were collected by G. W.
Wolfe and Jennifer and Jeanne Wolfe. The primary types are deposited in
the NMNH with type number 75499.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
205
Fig. 76. H. diversicornis ■; H. ohionis •.
Range. — This species has been collected only in central Tennessee (Fig.
74).
Natural history. — Hydroporus jeanneae prefers gravelly margins of
streams and the fissures in large barely submerged slabs of bedrock. Leaves
and algae were usually present.
Hydroporus jenniferae Wolfe and Matta
Hydroporus jenniferae Wolfe and Matta 1979:171.
This species is most closely related to H. folkertsi and H. ohionis but
averages slightly larger and has a paler head than ohionis and is not as
coarsely punctate as folkertsi. The apex of the aedeagus of jenniferae is
ventrally deflected; appearing hook-shaped in lateral view.
Description. — Length 3.0 to 3.7 mm; width 1.4 to 1.7 mm; form evenly
oval, widest at middle; pronotum and elytra continuous in outline. Lateral
margins of pronotum evenly rounded toward the anterior angles; lateral
bead distinct and at maximum width about equal to the width of the second
antennal segment. Modified prosternal setae present but sparse. Prostemal
prominence evidently angulate but not distinctly protuberant, prostemal file
present rugose; prostemal process lanceolate posterior to procoxae, tip
bluntly pointed.
Not strongly shining dorsally. Head pale yellow; vaguely infuscate at
206
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
vertex, antennae pale yellowish with 1 1th segment infuscate. Pronotum with
an evenly broad black band along anterior edge. Posterior margin of prono¬
tum with a black band of variable width, narrower on each side, expanding
in undulating fashion and often coalescing with the anterior band. Paler
isolated areas of the pronotum reddish yellow. Elytra (Figs. 3, 4) with dis¬
tinct brownish black and yellow fascia. Sutural stripe distinct and extending
along half the elytral base. Middle fascia large, indented in an undulating
fashion; variable in extent. The middle fascia may be reduced and isolated
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
207
Fig. 78. H. oppositus •; H. sulphurius T; H. ouachitus ■.
from the sutural stripe and the smaller apical fascia or it may be broadly
connected to both. Ventral surface primarily reddish-yellow with mesoster-
num, lateral edges of metasternum, metacoxae and abdominal sterna vari¬
ably infuscate.
Dorsal surface perceptibly reticulate; punctation of head fine and sparse,
densest on vertex between eyes, sparser and finer anteriorly, densest in
shallow depressions at antero-medial corners of eyes. Pronotum with a line
of coarser and denser punctures parallel to anterior margin, discally punc¬
tures sparser and finer. The posterior prototal areas with punctures coarser
and more or less restricted to the posterior infuscations.
Elytral punctation fine and sparse (Fig. 68), coarsest discally and finer
laterally and apically. A very poorly defined lengthwise series of denser
punctures is discernible in the discal area of each elytron. Ventrally meta¬
coxa rather coarsely punctate (Fig. 57), metastemum even more so; medial
punctures finer on both metacoxa and metasternum. Abdominal punctures
coarser on sternum 1 and anterior portion of 2; posteriorly finer.
Pro tarsi of male relatively short and broad, anterior claw strongly bent at
base and slightly sinuate internally. Aedeagus ventrally deflected at apex;
appearing hook-shaped, with thin subapical ventral projection (Fig. 31).
Female similar to the male but slightly longer and broader. The anterior
protarsal claw evenly curved and tapering. Abdominal sterna usually more
infuscate.
208
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 79. H. pulcher •.
Larvae. — Unknown.
Type data. — The holotype and allotype are from Trousdale Co., TN, 1
mi. N. Barthelia on Hwy 231-10, 20 June 1977 and were collected by G. W.
Wolfe and Jennifer and Jeanne Wolfe. The primary types are deposited in
the NMNH with type number 75498.
Range. — Known only from central Tennessee but its presence in central
Kentucky is probable (Fig. 77).
Natural history. — This species prefers gravelly stream margins. Many
specimens were taken from a section of stream with extensive slabs of
bedrock. The beetles were found among algae and leaves in fissures and
depressions containing one to several inches of water.
Hydroporus laetus Leech
Hydroporus laetus Leech 1948:90.
This species is characterized by its uniformly dark reddish or brown
pronotum and the absence of prosternal setae. The only other species in
this subgenus with this combination of characters, H. sulphurius, has a
distinct subapical ventral projection on the aedeagus and is so far known
only from northwestern Arkansas.
Description. — Length 3.15 to 3.30 mm; width 2.0 to 2.15 mm; form elon-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
209
Fig. 80. H. wickhami •.
gate oval, sides subparallel basally, widest at middle; pronotum and elytra
continuous in outline. Lateral margins of pronotum evenly and gradually
rounded towards the anterior angles; lateral bead distinct, gradually wid¬
ening anteriorly, at maximum width about equal to the width of the second
antennal segment. Prostemal prominence declivitous, somewhat protuber¬
ant. File area rugose, process lanceolate posterior to procoxae and bluntly
pointed. Modified prostemal setae absent.
Shining dorsally, a little alutaceous. Head reddish or orange brown; clyp-
eus lighter yellow. Pronotum reddish to reddish-brown. Elytra (Figs. 20, 21)
with variable yellowish and brownish to blackish fascia which are usually
as follows: sutural stripe distinct and extending about half the length of the
elytral base, occasionally extending back. Middle and apical fascia con¬
nected to sutural stripe, separated from each other and not connected to the
basal fascia. An infuscate area present in the anterior light fascia.
Microreticulation evident; head randomly and finely punctate, punctures
separated by 1 to 2 puncture widths; sometimes more coarsely punctate on
vertex between eyes. Punctures finer anteriorly, densest in shallow depres¬
sion at antero-medial comer of eye. Pronotal discal punctation sparse, fine,
separated by the width of 2 to 3 punctures; somewhat coarser and denser
parallel to the anterior margin. Elytral punctures fine and sparse (Fig. 67);
separated by as much as 3 puncture widths. Ventrally metacoxal punctures
210
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
(Fig. 51) coarser than above, metasternal punctures coarser than those on
the metacoxae; both becoming finer medially. Abdominal sternum 1 and
anterior portion of 2 coarsely punctate, posteriorly finer.
Male pro tarsi scarcely modified; protarsi with anterior claw strongly bent
basally, sinuate internally. Aedeagus and parameres as in Fig. 36. Female
identical to the male except that the anterior protarsal claw is evenly and
gradually tapered and curved.
Larvae . — Unknown.
Type data. — The holotype and allotype are from a stream adjacent to
Lake Hope, Vinton Co., Ohio. They are deposited in the California Acad¬
emy of Science. We have examined paratypes loaned by F. N. Young and
from the Canadian National Collection.
Range. — The Great Lakes states to Pennsylvania, south to northern Ten¬
nessee (Fig. 75).
Natural history. — Teneral specimens were collected by Dr. F. N. Young
on 22 September 1968. This species prefers the margins of streams.
Hydroporus ohionis Fall
Hydroporus ohionis Fall 1917:172.
This species is similar to H. folkertsi, H. jenniferae and H. sulphurius.
H. ohionis is usually smaller, the head is more reddish and the aedeagus is
unique. H. sulphurius has a uniformly dark pronotum and is known only
from the northwestern portion of Arkansas. Furthermore, H. sulphurius
and H. folkertsi lack prostemal setae.
Description. — Length 3.1 to 3.4 mm; width 1.4 to 1.5 mm; form elongate
oval, widest at middle with pronotum and elytra continuous in outline. Lat¬
eral margins of pronotum gradually evenly curved toward the anterior an¬
gles. Lateral pronotal bead distinct, gradually broadening anteriorly; at wid¬
est point about equal to the width of the second antennal segment.
Prostemum with stiff antecoxal setae; file area rugose; prostemal process
lanceolate posterior to procoxae, bluntly pointed.
Shining but evidently alutaceous dorsally. Head orange, a little darker
between the eyes. Pronotum orange to reddish discally, with broad dark
bands along the anterior and posterior edges; the posterior band not ex¬
tending as far laterally. These bands are sometimes sufficiently broad that
the paler central band is narrow but the dark bands are rarely connected.
Elytra with brown and yellowish fascia (Figs. 6, 7). Sutural stripe extending
along basal edge for about half the width. Basal dark fascia narrow; middle
fascia with uneven anterior and posterior margins; usually connected to the
sutural stripe and rarely connected to the apical fascia; the apical fascia
smaller. Ventrally dark orange, variably infuscate on the abdominal sterna,
especially laterally.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
211
Microreticulation evident dorsally and ventrally. Head with fine sparse
punctation, punctures separated by 1 to 2 puncture widths; finer on clypeus,
densest in shallow depression at antero-medial corners of eyes. Pronotum
sparse, finer discally, punctures separated by up to 4 puncture widths; dens¬
er and coarser along anterior and posterior edges. Elytra rather finely and
sparsely punctate, punctures separated by 2 to 3 puncture widths (Fig. 69).
Ventral punctation distinctly coarser; a little coarser on the metastemum
than metacoxae (Fig. 58); both finer medially. Abdominal sternum 1 and
anterior portion of 2 coarser, posterior portion of 2 and 3 to 5 finer.
Male with anterior tarsi scarcely modified, anterior claw bent basally but
only feebly sinuate. Aedeagus with a thin subapical ventral projection (Fig.
32).
Female very similar to the male. Anterior protarsal claw gradually taper¬
ing and curved.
Larvae . — U nkno wn .
Type data. — Fall’s description of this species is based on three males
from Cincinnati, Ohio, but he did not designate a type specimen. We have
designated as the lectotype of Hydroporus ohionis Fall the male specimen
from Fall’s type series which we have dissected. The specimen bears the
following label information: Cincin. Ohio; a small label with the male sex
symbol and a label bearing the words H. C. Fall Collection. We have placed
a yellow lectotype label on this specimen with the following information:
Lectotype, Hydroporus ohionis. This specimen has been returned to the
Museum of Comparative Zoology, Harvard.
Range. — The Great Lakes states to Pennsylvania and south through Ken¬
tucky and Virginia (Fig. 76).
Natural history. — This species seems to prefer the margins of small
streams with sand or fine gravel substrates and overhanging vegetation. It
is frequently collected in the submerged roots of grass clumps at the stream
margin and is occasionally taken from small backwaters.
Hydroporus oppositus Say
Hydroporus oppositus Say 1823:289.
Diagnosis. — This species is most easily separated from the closely related
H. wickhami by the apex of the aedeagus which is more prolonged (Figs.
26, 27) in lateral view; however, it also averages larger and is somewhat less
infuscated and more coarsely punctate ventrally. In the southeastern por¬
tions of its range H. oppositus is distinctly fasciate with blackish and yellow
fascia. In the northeast the darker elytral fascia are reddish and expanded,
almost obliterating the yellow fascia. In the south the anterolateral angles
of the pronotum are sinuate and the anterior protarsal claw of the male is
markedly sinuate (Fig. 39).
212
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Description. — Length 3.4 to 4.1 mm; width 1.7 to 2.1 mm. Form elongate
oval, widest at middle with pronotum and elytra continuous in outline. Lat¬
eral edges of pronotum gradually curved inward but sometimes slightly sin¬
uate at the antero-lateral comers. Lateral pronotal bead distinct, about as
wide as the second antennal segment; gradually broadening anteriorly. Dis¬
tinct stiff prostemal setae present. Prostemal prominence angularly declivi¬
tous, file composed of regularly placed transverse ridges. Prostemal process
lanceolate posterior to the procoxae, bluntly pointed.
Dorsally shining. Head flavotestaceous, infuscate in back of the eyes
across vertex. Pronotum with even broad dark band along anterior edge;
infuscate along the posterior edge but this infuscation not as dark or as
broad; discal area rufotestaceous. Elytra with yellow and brownish black
fascia (Figs. 17-19). Sutural stripe distinct and extending laterally along the
basal edge up to two thirds of the elytral width; then extending posteriorly.
This posterior extension is often isolated, forming a discreet spot and is
seldom connected to the middle fascia. Middle dark fascia large, undulating,
occasionally deeply indented, connected to the sutural stripe; variably con¬
nected with the posterior dark fascia. Posterior dark fascia smaller, usually
not deeply indented. Ventral coloration variable, usually darkly infuscate,
medial areas of metacoxae, metasternum and abdominal sterna often rufo¬
testaceous.
Microreticulation evident dorsally and ventrally. Punctation of head fine,
usually denser on vertex, punctures separated by one half to one puncture
width, becoming finer anteriorly; densest in shallow depressions at antero¬
lateral corners of eyes. Pronotal punctation coarse; separation variable but
up to 2 puncture widths; often finer and sparser medially; a line of coarser
punctures parallel to anterior edge. Elytral punctation a little coarser (Fig.
63), separated by 1 to 1 and one half puncture widths. Ventral punctation
coarser than above; metacoxae (Fig. 55) and metastemum finer medially.
Punctures of abdominal sternum 1 and anterior portion of 2 coarser, pos¬
teriorly finer.
Anterior protarsi of male broadened, pro tarsal claw sinuate, usually lobed
(Fig. 39). Aedeagus as in Fig. 26. Female similar to male; more alutaceous;
anterior protarsal claw evenly tapered and curved.
Larvae. — Described in Barman (1972).
Type data. — Say’s types are generally considered to be lost. Since no
material suitable for designation as a neotype was available from the Le-
Conte collection (a usual source for specimens representative of Say’s
species) a male specimen from Pendleton County, West Virginia is desig¬
nated as a neotype of Hydroporus oppo situs Say. This specimen is typical
of northeastern specimens of oppo situs and fits Fall’s interpretation of H.
oppositus Say. The specimen bears the following labels; 1, Pendleton Co.,
W. Va., V-3-74, Matta; 2, Hydroporus oppositus Say, Det. J. F. Matta; 3,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
213
Neotype Hydroporus oppositus Say. des. 1980 JFM. This specimen has
been deposited in the Museum of Comparative Zoology, Cambridge, MA.
Range. — Hydroporus oppositus extends from eastern Canada and New
England south to North Carolina and Tennessee (Fig. 78).
Variation. — This species exhibits interesting variation in a north-south
direction throughout its range and Fall’s (1923) analysis, which is based on
northeastern specimens, can be misleading if applied to southern material.
In the south this species closely approaches H. wickhami in coloration; the
ventral infuscation is reduced and the dorsum is distinctly fasciate. Speci¬
mens with this coloration possess a distinctly sinuate and lobed anterior
pro tarsal claw and the anterior pronotal margin is sinuate. Specimens from
more northern areas have the dark fascia expanded and in New England
specimens the dark fascia are usually broadly connected and the light yellow
fascia reduced to isolated spots. As the coloration becomes progressively
more infuscate (nonfasciate) the pronotal sinuation disappears (it is rare in
Virginia specimens and absent in material from Pennsylvania and New
York) and the anterior protarsal claw becomes less sinuate (the sinuation
is scarcely detectable in northern material). In addition H. oppositus be¬
comes gradually smaller in the northern part of its range.
Natural history. — This species is usually taken at the margins of streams
with gravel margins. It is commonest in smaller and intermittent streams.
Hydroporus ouachitus Matta and Wolfe
Hydroporus ouachitus Matta and Wolfe 1979:289.
Diagnosis. — This species is best identified by the shape of the male gen¬
italia. It is similar to H. pulcher but may be separated from that species by
the coarser ventral punctation, smaller size and reduction of the anterior
pronotal dark spot and distinctly different aedeagus (Fig. 37). The aedeagus
is similar to that of H. laetus but that species has a uniformly reddish
pronotum. The punctation (Fig. 64) is finer than in H. cocheconis (Fig. 66)
and the presently recorded ranges are allopatric.
Description. — Length 2.80 to 3.20 mm; width 1.35 to 1.45 mm. Form
elongate oval, widest at middle; pronotum and elytra continuous in outline
with the sides of the elytra very slightly concave basally. Lateral pronotal
bead distinct, slightly widened anteriorly. Modified prosternal setae absent
although a few short stiff hairs may be present on the prostemum at the
base of the coxae. Prosternal process distinctly angulate, prosternal file
present but poorly developed. Posterior half of the prosternal process broad¬
ly lanceolate with the medial portion slightly rounded and lateral edges
margined; the tip bluntly pointed.
Head reddish brown, antennae with last segment infuscate. Pronotum
reddish brown with a diffuse dark spot at the anterior margin which reaches
214
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
from the central line to approximately half the distance to the margin on
each side. Posterior margin of pronotum with a thin dark band which nar¬
rows laterally. Elytra (Fig. 12) dark brown with subbasal, postmedial and
apical pale areas which are separated from the sutures and the lateral mar¬
gins by thin dark bands. Ventral surface yellow-brown, the legs, prostemum
and head reddish brown.
Dorsal surface finely and densely microreticulate; punctation of head fine;
punctures separated by 3-4 times the width of a puncture. Pronotum with
discal punctures similar to those of the head; with a band of coarser punc¬
tures near the anterior margin and with a few coarse punctures scattered
along the posterior margin. Elytra rather evenly punctured (Fig. 66), the
punctures separated by 1 to 1 Vi a puncture width. Ventral punctation
coarser; the metacoxae (Fig. 50) and metasternum with the punctures sep¬
arated by less than Vi a puncture width. The abdominal punctures fine,
slightly coarser basally.
Male with pro- and mesotarsi short and thickened; the anterior pro tarsal
claw not modified; aedeagus as in Fig. 37. Female similar to the male but
averages 0.1 mm longer. There is some minor variation in color pattern but
all extant specimens are quite similar.
Larvae. — Unknown.
Type data. — The holotype, allotype and 11 paratypes are from a small
stream 2 mi. s of Mena, Arkansas, 19 July 1978, collected by J. F. Matta. The
primary types are in the collection of J. F. Matta but have NMNH type
number 75966.
Range. — Texas, Arkansas and Oklahoma (Fig. 78).
Natural history. — The type series was collected from the margins of a
pool in the bedrock of a small temporary stream. Most specimens were
washed out of the roots and sand near grass and bushes which extended
partly into the pool.
Hydroporus pulcher LeConte
Hydroporus pulcher LeConte 1855:298.
This is one of the most widely distributed species in the subgenus. It may
be easily recognized by the extremely fine ventral punctation (Fig. 61) and
by the form of the aedeagus (Fig. 38).
Description. — Length 3.1 to 3.6 mm; width 1.6 to 1.8 mm. Form elongate
oval, widest at middle; length to width ratio usually greater than or equal
to 2, however occasional specimens are slightly broader; pronotum and
elytra continuous in outline. Lateral margins of pronotum evenly rounded
toward anterior angles, lateral bead distinct, widening slightly anteriorly; at
maximum width about equal to the width of second antennal segment. Mod¬
ified prosternal setae absent. Prosternal prominence declivitous, not dis-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
215
tinctly protuberant, prostemal file quite rugose, prostemal process broadly
lanceolate posterior to procoxae, bluntly pointed.
Shining dorsally. Head uniformly pale yellow; antennae yellow with ter¬
minal segment vaguely and variably infuscate. Pronotum with even black
band along entire anterior edge; posterior margin with narrow medial black
band extending across 2A of the edge. Disc and lateral margins yellow. Elytra
(Figs. 22-24) with distinct undulating yellow and black fascia. Sutural stripe
distinct and extending along basal edge Vi to % of the width to form a basal
fascia. Basal fascia extending posteriorly in some specimens occasionally
coalescing with middle fascia, sometimes this posterior extension isolated
as an anterolateral spot. Middle dark fascia large, usually coalescing with
sutural stripe, at maximum extent coalesced with basal and apical fascia;
sometimes isolated from all three. Apical fascia smaller than middle, show¬
ing same variation as middle fascia. Venter yellow, metacoxae usually light¬
est, sutural and lateral areas and abdominal sterna sometimes lightly infus¬
cate; mesosternal area darkest.
Microreticulation evident on head and pronotum, reduced on elytra and
ventrally. Punctation of head fine, randomly punctate; usually coarser and
denser on vertex between the eyes; finer and sparser anteriorly, densest in
shallow depressions at anteriomedial corners of eyes. Pronotal punctation
fine; punctures separated by 1 to 2 puncture widths; a line of coarser punc¬
tures parallel to anterior margin. Elytral punctation (Fig. 61) finer than
pronotum except at extreme base; punctures separated by about 2 puncture
widths. Punctation of metacoxae (Fig. 48) and abdominal sterna fine, dense;
separated by less than 1 puncture width on metacoxae. Metasterna with
punctures a little coarser and sparser laterally.
Protarsi of male slightly modified; anterior protarsal claw slightly sinuate
on inner margin; strongly bent basally. Apical portion of aedeagus broadly
dorsoventrally flattened, with minute subapical ventral projection (Fig. 38).
Female identical to male except that the anterior protarsal claw is evenly
curved and tapered.
Larvae. — U nkno wn .
Type data. — The type specimen is in the MCZ and bears type number
6004. It is from Alabama and was collected by Mr. Hentz.
Variation. — This species is rather uniform throughout its range except
that some northern specimens have the darker elytral fascia broadly co¬
alesced and appear almost completely dark.
Range. — Southern Canada south to Virginia; west to Wisconsin and Ar¬
kansas. The Minnehaha, Arizona, specimen mentioned by Fall probably
represents a mislabeled specimen from Minnehaha, West Virginia (Fig. 79).
Natural history. — Teneral specimens were taken in June and August. This
species is found in a wide variety of stream habitats but is most frequently
collected from gravel margins of smaller streams.
216
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hydroporus sulphurius Matta and Wolfe
Hydroporus sulphurius Matta and Wolfe 1979:287.
The unicolorous (infuscate) pro no turn and lack of pro sternal setae sepa¬
rate this species from all others in the subgenus except H. laetus. The
punctures of H. sulphurius are slightly smaller and sparser than laetus and
the elytral markings are darker. In addition the ranges of the two species
are allopatric. The aedeagus of H. sulphurius is distinct (Fig. 30) and may
be used to separate it from all species in the genus.
Description. — Length 2.9 to 3.5 mm; width 1.4 to 1.7 mm. Form elongate
oval; widest at middle; pronotum and elytra continuous in outline with the
lateral margins of the pronotum evenly rounded towards the anterior angles.
Margin of pronotum with a distinct lateral bead which appears flattened on
top and which is about Vi as wide as the last antennal segment. Modified
prostemal setae absent; prostemal process with an angulate protuberance
and a poorly defined anterior file. Prostemal process lanceolate posterior to
the procoxae and with a bluntly rounded tip.
Head pale brown; antennae concolorous with head, vaguely infuscate on
last segment. Pronotum uniformly reddish brown; lateral margins lighter.
Each elytron (Fig. 5) reddish brown with anterior, postmedial and posterior
light brown pale patches which extend across the width of the elytron and
terminate against the sutural stripe. The postmedial spot is interrupted by
a narrow dark band cutting across its middle and the apical spot extends
anteriorly as a vague narrow streak but does not reach the postmedial spot.
Ventral surface light brown with the metacoxal plates, metastemum and
prostemal process slightly darker.
Finely and distinctly alutaceous dorsally. Head sparsely and finely punc¬
tured. Pronotum with disc finely punctured; with a narrow band of coarse
punctures near the anterior margin and a broader band of coarse punctures
on the posterior margin. Elytral punctures (Fig. 71) fine and sparsely dis¬
tributed; separated by at least the width of 1 puncture, usually by the width
of several punctures. Ventral surface finely punctured except for the
metacoxal plates (Fig. 56) and metasternum where the punctures are 4-5
times larger than normal.
Protarsal claw and protarsi of male unmodified. Aedeagus as in Fig. 30;
with a thin subapical ventral projection. Female similar to the male in ex¬
ternal characters.
Larvae. — U nkno wn .
Type data. — The holotype, allotype and all paratypes are from Sulphur
Springs, Arkansas, VII-20-1955, collected by P. J. Spangler. The holotype
and allotype are in the NMNH and have type number 75967.
Variation. — In the small series available there is little variation. A few
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
217
specimens have a small vague paler area on the disc, there may be a dark
spot at the anterior edge of the anterior elytral spot and the postmedial pale
spot may be reduced or split by a dark streak. The dark areas on the ventral
surface vary from the typical reduced dark area to large infuscate patches
on the abdominal sterna.
Range. — Known only from Sulphur Springs, Arkansas (Fig. 78).
Natural history. — This species has been collected from only one site on
the Ozark plateau in an area of numerous springs and small sand bottom
streams. No specific habitat data is available for this species however it is
probably found at the margins of the smaller streams.
Hydroporus wickhami Zaitzev
Hydroporus wickhami Zaitzev 1907:114.
This species can be separated from most other species in the subgenus
by the presence of dense prosternal setae and a blackish venter. It is difficult
to separate from H. oppositus and the discussion of that species should be
referred to for distinguishing characters.
Description. — Length 3.3 to 3.7 mm; width 1.5 to 1.9 mm. Form elongate
oval, widest at middle; with pronotum and elytra in continuous outline.
Lateral margins of pronotum gradually and evenly curved toward anterior
angles. Lateral margins of pronotum with a distinct bead which gradually
broadens anteriorly; at its greatest width approximately as wide as the sec¬
ond antennal segment. Distinct stiff prosternal setae present. Prosternal
process with angular prominence, file composed of regularly placed trans¬
verse ridges; process lanceolate posterior to the procoxae; apex bluntly
rounded.
Dorsally shining, occasionally somewhat alutaceous. Head yellowish or¬
ange; vaguely infuscate across vertex behind eyes. Pronotum with even
broad dark band on anterior margin; posterior margin with a narrower dark
band. Elytra markings (Fig. 16) yellow and brown to black. Sutural stripe
extending length of suture and 2A of way along elytral base, then backward
toward medial dark fascia. Medial fascia large, deeply indented and con¬
nected to sutural stripe; sometimes barely connected to apical dark fascia.
Apical dark fascia smaller, usually connected to sutural stripe. Venter dark;
black to reddish black; area between metacoxal lines and abdominal sterna
often more reddish. Legs, prosternum and ventral side of head rufotesta-
ceous.
Microreticulation evident dorsally and ventrally. Punctation of head fine,
punctures separated by 1 to 2 puncture widths; denser on vertex between
eyes, finer anteriorly and coarsest and densest in shallow depressions at
anteromedial corners of eyes. Pronotal punctation fine and dense; punctures
218
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
separated by 1 to 2 puncture widths; a line of coarse punctures parallel to
anterior margin. Elytral punctation fine (Fig. 62); punctures separated by 2
to 3 puncture widths; a discal longitudinal line of coarse punctures evident.
Metacoxae (Fig. 54) and metasternum more coarsely punctate. Punctures
on abdominal sternum 1 and posterior region of 2 coarser; those on the rest
of 2 and 3-5 finer.
Anterior protarsi of male broadened; anterior protarsal claws feebly sin¬
uate. Aedeagus distinct (Fig. 27). Female identical to male except that the
protarsi are narrower and the anterior protarsal claws are gradually and
evenly curved.
Larvae. — Described in Barman (1972).
Type data. — There are two specimens in the type series, a male and a
female. The female bears a type label with the type number 6007; however
a type designation has never been published and we are designating the male
(which we have dissected) as the lectotype and the female as the paralec-
totype. The type locality is given as Fort Laramie, Nebraska; however, this
is now Wyoming (Fall, 1923).
Range. — Southeastern Canada south to north Georgia, west to Kansas and
Wisconsin (Fig. 80). The type is recorded from Wyoming; however, we
have not seen other specimens from this far west.
Natural history. — This species is found in many stream habitats but is
most common at the margins of medium to small streams.
Discussion
The subgenus Heterosternuta, as here redefined, is composed of a mono-
phyletic group of species. These species are characteristically found along
the margins of piedmont or mountain streams and all but two species are
found east of the 100th meridian. The subgenus presents some interesting
problems and areas for future work. Barman (1972) has described the larvae
and biology of H. oppositus and H. wickhami ; however, the larval and
pupal stages of all other species are undescribed and the life history of most
species are unknown. The role of the subgenus in the stream community
also needs study. They frequently occur in large numbers — particularly in
temporary streams — and may have a significant impact on the small inver¬
tebrates which presumably make up the major portion of their diet. They
are rarely reported in stream surveys however since most stream sampling
proceedures neglect the stream margins.
A particularly interesting problem is presented by the prostemal setae
which are present in several species. These bristles do not appear in any
other North American Hydroporus and vary in size and number between
the species of Heterosternuta. Their function is unknown and it would be
interesting to know their biological function.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
219
Literature Cited
Barman, Jr., E. H. 1972. The biology and immature stages of selected species of Dytiscidae
(Coleoptera) of central New York State. Dissertation. Cornell University, 207 pp.
Fall, H. C. 1917. New Dytiscidae. J. N.Y. Entomol. Soc., 25:163-182.
Fall, H. C. 1923. A revision of the North American species of Hydroporus and Agaporus.
Mt. Vernon, N.Y., 129 pp.
Guignot, F. 1942. Dix-septieme note sur les Hydrocantheres. Soc. D’Etud. Sci. Nat. Vau-
cluse, 16-21.
Gordon, R., and R. L. Post. 1965. North Dakota water beetles. North Dakota Insects —
Publication No. 5. Department of Entomology, North Dakota State University, 53 pp.
Gordon, R. 1969. A revision of the niger-tenebrosus group of Hydroporus (Coleoptera: Dy¬
tiscidae) in North America. Dissertation, North Dakota State University, 311 pp.
Larson, D. 1975. The predaceous water beetles (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) of Alberta: System-
atics, natural history and distribution. Quaest. Entomol., 11:245-498.
LeConte, J. 1855. Analytical table of the species of Hydroporus found in the United States
with descriptions of new species. Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci. Phila., 7:290-299.
Leech, H. B. 1949(1948). Some nearctic species of hydradephagid water beetles, new and old.
(Coleoptera). Can. Entomol., 80:89-96.
Leech, H. B. 1950. Addendum: Some nearctic species of hydradephagid water beetles, new
and old. (Coleoptera). Can. Entomol., 81:233.
Leech, H. B., and H. P. Chandler. 1955. Aquatic Coleoptera in Usinger, Aquatic insects of
California. University of California Press. Berkeley + Los Angeles, 508 pp.
Matta, J. F., and G. W. Wolfe. 1979. New species of nearctic Hydroporus (Coleoptera:
Dytiscidae). Proc. Biol. Soc. Wash., 92:287-293.
Say, T. 1823. Descriptions of insects of the families Carabici and Hydrocantheri of Latreille
inhabiting North America. Trans. Amer. Philos. Soc., 2:1-108.
Sharp, D. 1882. On aquatic carnivorous Coleoptera or Dytiscidae. Trans. Roy. Dublin Soc.
2, ser. 2:179-1003.
Wolfe, G. W., and J. F. Matta. 1979. Three new species of Hydroporus (Coleoptera: Dytis¬
cidae) from the southeastern United States. Proc. Entomol. Soc. Wash., 81:171-177.
Wolfe, G. W., and J. F. Matta. 1981. Notes on nomenclature and classification of Hydroporus
subgenera with the description of a new genus of Hydroporini (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae).
Pan-Pacific Entomol., 57(1): 149-175.
Young, F. N. 1954. The water beetles of Florida. Univ. Florida Studies. Biol. Sci. Series,
V. 5; ix + 238 pp.
Zaitzev, Ph. 1907. Berichtigungen und Zusatze su den Haliplidae, Dytiscidae und Gyrinidae
in den neuesten Katalogen der Coleopteran. Rev. Russ. d’Entomol., 7:114-124.
Footnote
1 Parts of this work were also completed during graduate study at the University of Tennessee
and during a postdoctoral fellowship at the Smithsonian Institution.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 220-226
A NEW GENUS AND SPECIES OF WATER SCAVENGER BEETLE FROM
AFRICA (COLEOPTERA: H YDROPHILID AE : SPHAERIDIINAE)
Paul J. Spangler and Philip D. Perkins
Smithsonian Institution, Washington, D.C. 20560
The distinctive hydrophilid beetle described herein was found in the Na¬
tional Museum of Natural History collections during routine identifications
of miscellaneous beetles for curatorial purposes. The single specimen has
been residing in the collections since it was collected by Dr. W. M. Mann
40 years ago. Although we would prefer more specimens for the description,
the specimen is a male, which should be easily recognized by the descrip¬
tions and illustrations provided here.
Nothing is known about the habits and habitat of this new beetle except
that it belongs to the subfamily composed of taxa which are terrestrial rather
than aquatic in their habits. Members of this subfamily occur in wet or moist
rotting vegetation such as palm logs, fruits, coconut hulls, banana stalks,
cactus, etc.; others live in dung. The taxa living in rotting vegetation usually
have dense pads of long hairlike pubescence on the ventral surfaces of their
tarsi. In contrast, those which live in dung usually lack this pubescence.
Therefore, the dense pubescence on the tarsi of this new taxon suggests
that it occurs in rotting vegetation.
Sphaeridiini
Kruia, new genus
Body form (Fig. 1) broadly rounded, moderately convex; strongly, coarse¬
ly, and irregularly punctate dorsally. Head with anterior margin of clypeus
broadly subtruncate and distinctly upturned, expanded shelflike in front of
eyes and extending as a canthus to midlength of eye. Labrum short and
mostly obscured beneath clypeus. Eyes viewed from above ovoid. Antenna
8 segmented; 2 basal, 2 intermediate, 1 cupule, and 3 club segments; only
club segments pubescent. Maxillary palpus 4 segmented; shorter than an¬
tennae; basal segment very short; second (pseudobasal) segment inflated,
about two-thirds as long as maxillary stipes and shorter than either penul¬
timate or ultimate segment; penultimate segment slightly longer than ulti¬
mate segment. Prosternum moderately long in front of procoxal cavities;
longitudinally carinate medially; terminating posteromedially in an acute
apex between procoxae. Mesosternal process (Fig. 2) a large pentagonal
process but appearing triangular with anterior and lateral angles acute; mid-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
221
die tectiform. Metasternum (Fig. 2) apically with an inclined lanceolate pro¬
cess extending between middle coxae; metasternum bearing two large pos¬
teromedial mammilliform processes, one on each side of midline in front of
metacoxae; each metacoxal process surmounted with a short tuft of setae.
Pronotum strongly broadly swollen on discal area and explanate, especially
anterolaterally. Elytron with strongly raised sutural margin; humeral areas
tumid; base with vestiges of three costiform intervals between humerus and
sutural margins; punctures very coarse, confused basally but in rows api¬
cally; lateral margins broadly explanate. Epipleura wide and strongly
oblique basally and becoming almost horizontal opposite margin of first
abdominal sternum. Scutellum a rather large equilateral triangle. All tarsi
covered on ventral surfaces with dense golden setae. Middle and hind tibiae
arcuate. Inner apical angle of middle tibia bearing a large dense tuft of
golden setae. Ventral surface of middle and hind tibiae with long slender
rows of golden setae and other golden setae scattered irregularly between
rows. Tarsal claws small, equal, strongly curved. Tarsal formula 5-5-5; basal
segments longest. First abdominal sternum with low longitudinal carina on
midline; carina extending about five-sixths the length of sternum.
Type-species. — Kruia chrysopelma, new species.
Etymology. — Kruia from Kru, a tribe of Liberian natives and a major
language in that country. Gender: feminine.
This new genus has the basal segment of the hind tarsus longer than the
second segment; antenna longer than the maxillary palpus; last glabrous
antennal segment cuplike and snugly embracing triarticulate pubescent
club; second segment of maxillary palpus distinctly thicker than third or
fourth segments. Therefore, the genus belongs to the subfamily Sphaeridi-
inae. Furthermore, the head is not narrowed in front of the eyes and the
anterior margin is broadly expanded and hides the bases of the antennae.
Consequently this new genus is assigned to the tribe Sphaeridiini.
In d’Orchymont’s (1937) key to sphaeridiine genera, Kruia runs to couplet
12 on the basis of the prosternum being long in front of the procoxal cavities
and to Dactylo sternum in couplet 13 because the mesosternum bears a large
pentagonal process with narrow base, therefore, appearing triangular or
sagittate, and the eyes are deeply emarginate by intrusion of a strong can-
thus. However, the facies as well as the morphology of Kruia is quite dif¬
ferent from the genus Dactylosternum. For example, Kruia is brown; mod¬
erately convex, with extremely coarse punctures; punctures confused
basally, in rows apically; elytral margins and anterolateral half of pronotum
strongly explanate; eyes deeply emarginate; antenna 8 segmented; edge of
broad, truncate clypeus narrowly but distinctly upturned; base of meso-
sternal process narrowly separated from metasternum; tibiae of middle legs
each bearing a tuft of golden setae on inner apical angle; and metasternum
222
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Kruia chrysopelma, n. gen., n. sp., holotype, habitus view.
bearing two large posteromedial mammilliform processes in front of meta¬
coxae. In contrast, Dactylo sternum is black or black and red; usually
strongly convex; elytra distinctly striate or with rows of punctures; punc¬
tures small; or moderate in width; elytral and pronotal margins not expla-
nate, eyes may be moderately emarginate; antenna 9 segmented; edge of
clypeus not exceptionally broad and not upturned anteriorly; base of me-
sosternal process broadly separated from metasternum; tibia of middle legs
lacking tuft of golden setae; metasternum without large posteromedial pro¬
cesses.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
223
Fig. 2. Kruia chrysopelma, n. gen., n. sp., holotype, mesosternum and metasternum.
This new genus may be interpolated into d’Orchymont’s key by referring
to the following modified couplets.
12. Prosternum long in front of procoxal cavities; elytra striate or punc¬
tures in rows at least on apex . 13
Prosternum short in front of procoxal cavities; elytra without striae
or rows of punctures . Dactylostethus d’Orchymont
13. Eyes without canthus; mesosternum not sagittate . 14
Eyes sometimes with canthus; mesosternum sagittate . 13a
13a. Antenna 8 segmented; elytral margins strongly explanate; clypeal
margin upturned; base of mesosternal process narrowly articulates
with metasternum . Kruia, n. gen.
Antenna 9 segmented; elytral margins not explanate; clypeal margin
not upturned; base of mesosternal process broadly articulated with
metasternum . Dactylo sternum Wollaston
Kruia chrysopelma, new species
(Figs. 1-4)
Body form (Fig. 1) broadly rounded; apicolateral halves of margins of
pronotum and entire elytral margins broadly explanate. Length 6.8 mm;
greatest width 5.5 mm slightly behind midlength. Color of dorsum dark
reddish brown except head and pronotum almost piceous and explanate mar¬
gins of elytra lighter reddish brown. Venter dark reddish brown with labrum,
labium, and maxillae lighter reddish brown; antennae and maxillary and
labial palpi testaceous.
224
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 3-4. Kruia chrysopelma, n. gen., n. sp., holotype, male genitalia. Fig. 3, Ventral view.
Fig. 4, Lateral view.
Head very coarsely, densely punctate; punctures as wide or slightly wider
than basal width of ultimate segment of maxillary palpus and separated by
about one-third width of a puncture. Clypeus greatly expanded shelflike in
front of eyes, expanded laterally as a canthus extending to midlength of eye;
anterior margin subtrunctate , slightly arcuate laterally; covering all except
anterior margin of lab rum. Lab rum truncate, setose apically, and finely
densely punctate. Ventral surface of head with genae microalutaceous; men-
tum and stipes coarsely, densely punctate and bearing dense, long, golden
setae. Antenna and maxillary palpus as described for genus. Labial palpus
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
225
3 segmented; basal segment small, about one-fourth length of second seg¬
ment; second segment broader than basal segment and bearing a dense tuft
of golden setae encircling apex; third segment about half as long as second
segment and bearing a tuft of golden setae on apex.
Pronotum slightly narrower at base than base of elytra; about three times
wider than long at middle of disc; strongly arcuate laterally; sides narrowly
margined; discal area strongly swollen and shallowly broadly longitudinally
grooved on midline; punctures larger than those on head and those on disc
slightly more widely separated; with a few fine sparse punctures on intervals
between coarse punctures. Anterolateral and posterolateral angles obtuse;
hypopleura broad, almost vertical, and microreticulate.
Scutellum a moderately large isosceles triangle with base wider than
length of sides; bearing two moderately coarse punctures.
Elytron broad, moderately convex, strongly explanate laterally; shining;
with broad sutural stria; bearing 10 or 11 rows of very coarse punctures,
confused on base and only slightly more distinct apically; humerus swollen;
with indications of 3 subcostate intervals on base between humerus and
suture. Epipleuron wide; with dense transverse striolae; almost vertical op¬
posite mesosternum and metasternum then becoming almost horizontal to
apex.
Prosternum, mesosternum, and metasternum as described for genus.
Front, middle, and hind legs with femora microalutaceous; with coarse,
sparse punctures; each puncture bearing a short golden seta. Middle and
hind tibiae arcuate, narrow at base and diverging strongly to apex; ventral
surface with several rows of golden setae along margins and other golden
setae scattered between rows. Tarsi with long, dense, golden setae ven-
trally; basal metatarsal segment longest, about twice as long as second seg¬
ment; second segment slightly less than third and fourth segments com¬
bined; fourth segment shortest; fifth segment as long as third and fourth
combined; tarsal claws small, equal in length, and rather strongly curved.
Abdominal sterna with very short dense golden setae; except sparse on
middle of second through fifth sterna. First sternum with low, distinct carina
on basal five-sixths. Last sternum rounded.
Genitalia as illustrated (Figs. 3 and 4).
Female. — Unknown.
Etymology . — chrysopelma, from chrysos, G. — gold, plus pelma from pel-
ma, G. — sole of the foot; in reference to the long, dense, golden setae on
the ventral surface of the tarsi.
Type-data. — Holotype male. — LIBERIA, Bendija, Smithsonian Firestone
Exp. 1940, W. M. Mann; USNM Type No. 75668, deposited in the National
Museum of Natural History, Smithsonian Institution.
226
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Acknowledgments
We are indebted to Mrs. Elaine R. Hodges, Smithsonian Institution staff
artist, for preparing the carbon dust and line drawings included herein.
Literature Cited
d’Orchymont, A. 1937. Sphaeridiini: bromeliadicoles nouveaux (Coleoptera: Hydrophilidae,
Sphaeridiinae). Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist. ser. 10, 20:127-140, 2 figures.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 226-227
SCIENTIFIC NOTE
NOTES ON NEARCTIC HELICHUS (COLEOPTERA: DRYOPIDAE)
The genus Helichus Erichson was established for the nearctic species
lithophilus (Dryops) Germar in 1847. Since that time almost sixty names
and descriptions have appeared for species from nearly all continents, which
have been assigned to that genus. In the Nearctic Region alone approxi¬
mately twenty names have been proposed.
Revisionary studies of the nearctic forms are still incomplete; neverthe¬
less, some facts may be securely presented at this time.
A small complex of species exists within the “lithophilus group” of Hin¬
ton (1935, Pan-Pac. Entomol., 11:71), consisting of striatus LeConte, fo-
veatus LeConte, and columbianus W. J. Brown. For almost half a century
all three names have been considered as applying to a single species pop¬
ulation occurring transcontinentally in North America (cf. Brown, H. P.,
1972, USEPA Water Poll. Control Res. Ser. 18050ELD04/72:l-82).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
227
It is now possible to state that H. columbianus Brown is a distinct species.
Its range extends from central California at least into southern Oregon, all
across southern British Columbia, and into western Montana.
Helichus striatus LeConte occurs from southeastern British Columbia
(apparently in the same streams as H. columbianus) completely across
southern Canada, including western Newfoundland (reported here for the
first time), as well as adjacent parts of the United States. This species is
unknown from the west coast of the U.S. In the East I have seen specimens
only from as far south as Connecticut, southern New York, Indiana, Illinois,
and Iowa. Except for a record in extreme southern Indiana given by Finni
and Skinner (1975, J. Kans. Entomol. Soc., 48:388-395), all eastern locali¬
ties appear to be in recently glaciated country.
It is not yet possible to certainly settle the status of populations ranging
from northern Mexico to Utah and Nevada. LeConte described H. foveatus
from New Mexico, which may be, at most, a subspecies of striatus. In any
event, foveatus is not the same as columbianus.
Differences between columbianus and striatus will be presented in detail
in a future publication. Here it may simply be noted that columbianus is a
larger more robust form that has a noticeable inflation of the elytra at the
apical two-fifths (absent in striatus Ifoveatus). Males of the two species are
readily distinguishable by examining the lateral aspect of the genitalia. Thus,
in columbianus the lateral lobes are gradually acuminate to the tip; in stria¬
tus /foveatus the lateral lobes are continuously smoothly rounded, being
blunt at the extreme tip. Holotypes of these species have been studied.
In Musgrave’s synopsis of the genus (1935, Proc. Ent. Soc. Wash.,
37:137-145) a geographical record for H. confluentus Hinton has been a
puzzle, and has been repeated in the literature. It requires correction.
Musgrave reported H. confluentus as occurring in Georgia at Rabun Bald,
as well as in the southwestern United States, where it undoubtedly lives.
Examination of collections of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Phila¬
delphia disclosed a series of nine specimens studied by Musgrave, which
evidently led to the error. (Another specimen from this series is present in
the Musgrave Collection at the Illinois Natural History Survey.) All bear
the same Georgia locality data, and were in extremely dirty condition. After
cleaning it was discovered that three species were included in the series, all
of which are common in the southwestern U.S., and all otherwise unknown
from the southeastern states. It seems clear enough that the set of specimens
simply received an incorrect label during preparation, and that Musgrave
was misled. The Georgia record for confluentus should be removed from
future catalogs.
Harry G. Nelson, Roosevelt Univ. and Field Museum of Natural History,
Chicago, Illinois 60605.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 228-244
HULEECHIUS, A NEW GENUS OF RIFFLE BEETLES
FROM MEXICO AND ARIZONA
(COLEOPTERA, DRY OPOIDE A , ELMIDAE)
Harley P. Brown
Dept, of Zoology, and Stovall Museum of Science and History,
University of Oklahoma, Norman 73019
The southern portion of the Mexican state of Baja California is quite arid,
as is most of the peninsula. Something of an oasis amid the typical thorn
and cactus scrub of the area is the small village of Caduano, which is located
some 30 km from San Jose del Cabo and 15 km below the Tropic of Cancer.
Caduano boasts several modest springs, only one of which produces more
than a mere trickle of water. At least, such was the case during my visits
to the site in the summers of 1973 and 1974. The largest spring (or cluster
of springs) gave rise to a stream about 30-50 cm wide, 2-5 cm deep, and
less than 30 m in length, ending in a small impoundment. The substrate was
sand and fine gravel, with an occasional larger pebble. In 1973 the stream
was completely overgrown, chiefly by bamboo or “river grass,” which, in
turn, was overhung by palms and other trees. Access to the stream was at
an inconspicuous watering place just above the impounded pool, shared by
people and cattle. To collect in the stream I had to stoop — almost to crawl —
in the tunnel of vegetation.
The water was crystal clear and cool, and swarmed with amphipods. The
only dryopoid beetles I found were blackish elmids ranging from 2.25 to
2.75 mm in length and their larvae, which were yellowish brown, subcylin-
drical, and about 6 mm in maximum length — very much like tiny elaterid
wire worms. The larvae caught my attention. I thought them to be those of
Cylloepus, and was delighted to find them relatively abundant, for in my 10
years of tropical collecting I had gotten Cylloepus larvae only once (in
Bolivia) despite the numbers of assorted adults from scores of localities
(Brown, 1977).
Later, when I had time and facilities to examine my preserved material,
I was not disappointed. But the larvae were not those of Cylloepus, though
they bear a close superficial resemblance, as do the adults. The combination
of larval and adult features indicated that this population represented a
genus not previously described.
In June of 1974 I returned to Caduano with the hope of obtaining pupae
of the new genus and of gaining more information concerning the ecology
and life history of this population. To my dismay, the habitat had been
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
229
Figs. 1-5. Fig. 1. Cylloepus parked Sanderson, ventral aspect of larva. On the prothorax,
the pleurites meet midventrally both behind and in front of the coxae. There are no perceptible
meso- or metathoracic pleurites. On the abdomen, sterno pleural sutures extend even onto the
last segment. Tergopleural sutures are lateral and cannot be seen from this view, but they also
extend onto the last segment. Anal gill filaments extended. Fig. 2. Cylloepus parked, dia¬
grammatic cross-section of larva. Fig. 3. Huleechius marroni, n. sp., diagrammatic cross-
section of larva. Fig. 4. Huleechius marroni, n. sp., ventral aspect of larva. On the prothorax,
note median posterior sternite. Each thoracic segment has distinct pleurites and tergo-pleural
sutures. On the abdomen, pleural sutures occur only on segments 1-7. Fig. 5. Huleechius
marroni, n. sp., dorsal aspect of larva.
230
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
greatly altered. Gone was all the overhanging vegetation. The entire stream
course was open and sunlit — and had been thoroughly cleaned out. An hour
or two spent examining every little stone in the brook revealed not a single
dryopoid, though a number of other groups of aquatic invertebrates were
now thriving. Since I have not found specimens of this genus in any other
streams of Baja California (though some harbor a reasonable assortment of
elmids), it is possible that the genus has been extirpated from the peninsula.
For this reason, it seems wise not to designate this local species as type for
the genus, but to select one that presumably occupies a less tenuous posi¬
tion. Hinton described such a species in 1934, elaborating upon it in 1940,
when he also described what must have been the larvae of his Cylloepus
spinipes. He had no basis for associating adult with larva, and, quite ap¬
propriately, referred to the larva as representing “ Elsianus (?) sp. ?” In my
own collection I find adults of the new genus among unidentified specimens
of Cylloepus, and larvae among those classified as Elsianus or “near Elsi¬
anus."
As in the case of Neocylloepus (Brown, 1970), I should stress the point
that it is the almost certain association of larval type with adult which forces
me to conclude that the adults cannot belong to the genus Cylloepus. The
larva of Cylloepus (Fig. 1), first described by Hinton (1940), is unique among
elmids in several respects: (1) it lacks tergopleural thoracic sutures; (2)
pro thoracic pleurites meet in the mid ventral line posterior to the procoxal
cavities as well as anterior to them; (3) mesothoracic and metathoracic pleu¬
rites are absent; (4) the first abdominal segment has only sternopleural su¬
tures, but all the remaining abdominal segments have both tergopleural and
sternopleural sutures which even extend onto the basal half of the ninth
segment, never converging. The larva of the new genus exhibits none of
these rather basic features, being quite conventional and resembling very
much the larvae of such major genera as Elsianus and Stenelmis. Prodded
by such convincing evidence from the larvae, I have simply had to seek
valid characters for separating the adults from those of bona fide Cylloepus.
Huleechius, new genus
(Figs. 3-34)
Description. — Body elongate, subparallel. Dorsal surface clothed with
short, recumbent hairs. Tomentum on genae, epipleura, sides of thoracic
and abdominal sternites (none on hypomera), and legs (except tarsi). Head
retractile almost to antennal base. Antenna 11-segmented, filiform (Fig. 9).
Mandible (Fig. 15) with 3 chisel-like apical teeth; prostheca large, membra¬
nous, with spinose apex. Maxilla (Fig. 16) with rather small, 4-segmented
palp; stipes with well-developed palpifer; galea and lacinia separate and
apex of each spinose. Labium (Fig. 17) with palp 3-segmented; prementum
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
231
Figs. 6-13. Fig. 6. Huleechius marroni, n. sp., adult male, dorsal aspect. Figs. 7-13.
Huleechius spinipes (Hinton). 7, Male genitalia, dorsal aspect; 8, same, lateral aspect; 9,
antenna; 10, front leg, tibia; 11, middle tibia; 12, hind tibia, inner aspect; 13, same, lateral
aspect (all from Hinton, '1940).
with palpiger; mentum and submentum transverse. Gula rectangular, con¬
spicuously narrower than mentum or submentum. Pro not urn on each side
with a sublateral longitudinal carina extending from base to apex; with a
median longitudinal impression on disk. Elytra striate and punctate; without
accessory striae; with 2 sublateral carinae. Hind wing (Fig. 19) without
radial cross-vein or closed anal cell; cubito-anal cross-vein complete, joining
cubitus to remnant of first anal; branches of second anal apparently fused;
third anal without a second branch. Prosternum (Fig. 18) very long in front
of procoxae; prosternal process rather long, with posterior margin rounded.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
232
Figs. 14-17. Huleechius marroni, n. sp., adult male. Fig. 14. Labrum. Fig. 15. Mandible.
Fig. 16. Maxilla. Fig. 17. Labium and gula.
Mesosternum with a rather deep median groove for the reception of the
prostemal process, followed by an impressed line to posterior margin. Meta¬
sternum with a median longitudinal impressed line. Abdomen slightly longer
than broad, with segments 1 and 5 longest; segment 5 on each side with
apicolateral margin curled upward and inward to clasp invaginated epipleu-
ral margin of elytron. Legs with visible portions of coxae rounded and
trochantin concealed by hypomera; tibiae of male with pronounced second¬
ary sexual characters (Figs. 10-13, 20-22); claws without teeth. Alimentary
canal with 8 caeca on anterior margin of midgut; hind gut with 6 Malpighian
tubules. Male genitalia (Figs. 7, 8, 23-25) with basal piece well developed;
both penis and parameres long and acute at apex. Female genitalia (Fig.
26) with both coxites and styli relatively elongate.
Type-species. — Cylloepus spinipes Hinton (1934).
Etymology. — Huleechius is named in honor of Hugh Leech; gender mas¬
culine.
Comparative notes. — Huleechius is close to such genera as Stenelmis,
Ordobrevia, Cylloepus, Hexacylloepus , and Elsianus. In the keys of Hinton
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
233
(1940), Leech and Chandler (1956), Leech and Sanderson (1959), Arnett
(1963), and Brown (1976), adults of the new genus key out to Cylloepus,
from which they differ in having the gula distinctly narrower than the sub-
mentum or mentum, in lacking vein 3A2 in the hind wing, in the structure
of the male genitalia, and in the nature of the secondary sexual characters
of the tibiae of males. Huleechius differs from Stenelmis and Ordobrevia
in having hairy tomentum on the anterior tibiae, from Ordobrevia and El-
sianus in lacking an accessory elytral stria between the sutural and second
striae, from Elsianus in having a median longitudinal impression on the
pronotum, and from Hexacylloepus in lacking a belt of tomentum across
the pronotal hypomeron, in having 8 rather than 6 caeca at the anterior end
of the midgut, and in having 6 rather than 4 Malpighian tubules. As men¬
tioned earlier, the larvae of Huleechius resemble those of Cylloepus only
in such superficial features as their very slender, parallel- sided form. They
differ from larvae of Cylloepus in possessing tergopleural thoracic sutures,
a median posterior prosternum, mesothoracic and metathoracic pleurites,
and pleural sutures that end on the 7th segment of the abdomen rather than
extending all the way to the middle of the 9th segment. The larvae of Hu¬
leechius are fundamentally very similar to those of Stenelmis and Elsianus
in all the features listed above, as will be discussed in the section dealing
with larvae.
Key to the Species of Huleechius
1. Pronotum with disk distinctly granulate; elytra with intervals vir¬
tually flat; size larger (at least 2.8 mm) . H. spinipes (Hinton)
Pronotal disk not noticeably granulate; elytral intervals moderately
convex; size smaller (less than 2.8 mm) . 2
2. Uniformly very dark brown to black, or elytra with sutural intervals
and sublateral carinae somewhat lighter in color, giving the
impression of faint vittae . H. marroni Brown, n. sp.
Pronotum darker than elytra, color ranging from light to moderately
dark brown; sutural intervals may be darker than rest of elytral
disk . H. marroni carolus Brown, n. subsp.
Huleechius spinipes (Hinton), NEW COMBINATION
(Figs. 7-13)
Cylloepus spinipes Hinton 1934. Rev. Ent., Rio de J., 4(2): 192.
The following description of this, the type-species of the new genus, is
taken from Hinton’s (1940) redescription of the species, together with the
figures he provided.
Male. — Length, 3. 0-3. 4 mm; breadth, 1.1-1. 3 mm. Clothed with fine,
234
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
short (about 0.038 mm long), recumbent, brownish-testaceous hairs which
arise mostly at intervals equal to slightly less than their lengths; antennae
similarly but more sparsely clothed; apical half of labrum clothed with equal¬
ly fine but much longer (as long as 0.087 mm at sides) and paler hairs which
are more erect and much denser. Cuticle shining and for the most part
densely alutaceous; piceous to dark rufopiceous; antennae, mouth-parts,
and legs paler rufopiceous. Tomentum cinerous with moderate golden reflec¬
tions. Head with a scarcely noticable, broad, feebly oblique impression
which extends shortly on each side near anterior half of eyes. Clypeal suture
strongly impressed and feebly arcuate; anterior margin of clypeus very
broadly and feebly arcuately emarginate, with the angle on each side ob¬
tusely rounded and sides moderately arcuate. Labrum broadly and feebly
rounded in front, with the angle on each side broadly rounded. Surface with
the alutaceous micro sculpture appearing somewhat granulate; with granules
which are usually round, slightly coarser than facets of eyes, and usually
separated by less than to once their diameters; granules on clypeus similar;
labium without granules, apical half punctate with very fine punctures which
are usually separated by once to twice their diameters. Pronotum at broad¬
est point, which is at basal half, broader than long (1.05:0.97 mm) and base
broader than apex (0.96:0.72 mm). Apical margin as seen from above mod¬
erately feebly arcuate at middle and deeply sinuate on each side behind eye
before apical angle; apical angles acute and strongly produced forwards and
very slightly inwards; sides feebly arcuate, more strongly so at basal half,
nearly straight at apical fourth and scarcely noticeably sinuate just before
basal angles; lateral margins feebly crenate; basal angles feebly acute, nearly
rectangular and scarcely produced; base trisinuate, broadly and moderately
strongly sinuate on each side and shortly and very shallowly sinuate in front
of scutellum. Pronotum with the sublateral carinae prominent, very slightly
converging towards apex, moderately sinuate at basal two-fifths, and ex¬
tending to apical margin, while the broadest portion of the carinae is from
basal fifth to apical fourth. Pronotum also as follows: a very broad and
feebly raised portion extends from base to base of disk; on each side of this
raised area with a feeble, moderately broad, feebly curved and oblique
impression extending to broad, moderately shallow, indefinite impression
near sinuation of sublateral carina which when viewed from a nearly lateral
position seems to very shallowly extend across sublateral carinae at about
middle; median longitudinal impression in some specimens extending from
base to basal third as a very shallowly impressed line and in others beginning
only at basal third, but in all extending from basal third to about apical third
as a navicular, moderately deep impression which is broadest at middle
where it is not quite as broad as scutellum. Surface with the alutaceous
micro sculpture similar but not as evident as that of head; set with round to
feebly obovate granules which are nearly twice as coarse as facets of eyes,
Figs. 18-22. Huleechius marroni, n. sp., adult male. Fig. 18. Prothorax, ventral aspect.
Fig. 19. Hind wing, with venation after Forbes. Fig. 20. Front tibia and tarsus. Fig. 21. Middle
tibia and tarsus. Fig. 22. Hind tibia and tarsus.
low (only feebly convex), and are usually separated by slightly less than
their own diameters; granules on sublateral carinae coarser and denser;
granules anteriorly on disk slightly finer and sparser. Elytra more than twice
as long as pronotum (2.30:0.97 mm) and feebly broadening to broadest point,
which is at apical third, and is here broader than base of pronotum (1 .32:0.96
mm). Apices broadly and moderately feebly produced and conjointly broad¬
ly rounded. Lateral margins feebly but regularly crenate. Surface striate
with the discal striae moderately coarse at base, becoming finer towards
apex, and beyond apical fourth obsolete except for sutural; discal strial
punctures round to subquadrate and at basal third a third to two-thirds as
broad as intervals, separated longitudinally by once to twice their diameters;
these punctures are narrower basally and towards apex rapidly become fine
and sparse so that at apical eighth they are about a fourth as coarse as those
at basal third. Discal intervals nearly flat and subequal in breadth, at base
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
236
0.25mm
0.5mm
Figs. 23-26. Huleechius marroni, n. sp., adult. Fig. 23. Male genitalia, ventral aspect. Fig.
24. Same, but more flattened beneath cover glass. Fig. 25. Same, but lateral aspect. Fig. 26.
Female genitalia.
all except sutural are slightly convex, and of the convex intervals the third
is only slightly more so than the others; surface of intervals at base aluta-
ceous somewhat as pronotum, elsewhere much more sparsely and differ¬
ently alutaceous; on basal fourth set with granules which are similar in size
to those of pronotum and similarly distributed; these granules rapidly be¬
come sparser so that beyond basal half the disk is free of granules; granules
of carinate intervals equal in size and density to those of elytral base. Scu-
tellum flat, subovate, broader than sutural interval (0.14:0.10 mm), longer
than broad (0.15: 0.14 mm), very feebly and broadly rounded basally, nearly
truncate, and at apex narrowly rounded; surface nearly free of granules.
Prosternum with the process rounded at apex; prosternum and process
evenly and moderately depressed, with the anterior two-thirds (not including
prostemal process) strongly and abruptly lobed; surface granulate as that
of elytral base; hypopleura slightly more sparsely granulate. Mesostemum
nearly entirely depressed for the reception of the prosternal process; sides
near middle coxae very strongly and broadly raised and at apex with a dozen
or less slender, long (about 0.075 mm), erect, brownish-testaceous hairs;
surface similar to prosternum but more sparsely granulate. Metastemum
with nearly the entire discal region occupied by a deep, transverse, oval
depression; posterior margin on edge of each side of middle with a moder¬
ately deep and large subtriangular impression; with a broad (0.375 mm broad
in specimen 3.0 mm long) and shallow median longitudinal impression which
ends rather abruptly at apical fifth and basal seventh; discal surface gran-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
237
ulate similarly to pronotum; sides similarly sculptured but with the granules
sparser and extreme sides with the granules very flat. Middle basal portion
of first abdominal stemite strongly depressed and sculptured similarly to
metastemal disk; ventral stemites elsewhere more sparsely granulate than
disk of metastemum and especially sparsely so at middle. Front tibiae with
three toothlike structures as figured (Fig. 10). Middle tibiae with a ventral
row of teeth (Fig. 1 1). Hind tibiae with a large, flat, knife-like tooth on inner
ventral side at basal two-fifths (Figs. 12, 13). Surface of femora and tibiae
granulate similarly to ventral abdominal segments. Genitalia as figured
(Figs. 7, 8).
Female. — Externally similar to male except as follows: (1) sides of meso-
sternum only moderately convex and without the group of long hairs; (2)
disk of metasternum not as broadly nor as strongly depressed; and (3) front
and hind tibiae without the toothlike structures and middle tibiae without
the row of teeth.
Type. — Male in the U.S. National Museum. MEXICO: Dist. de Temas-
caltepec, Real de Arriba, alt. 6000-7000 ft, May-July 1933 (H. E. Hinton
and R. L. U singer).
Specimens examined. — 68, with same data as type but a few of these also
collected at Temascaltepec, alt. about 5000 ft; 25, as above but collected in
June and July, 1934 (H. E. Hinton).
Variations. — The only notable variation is that in some specimens the
median longitudinal line on the pronotum extends from base to basal third
as a very shallowly impressed line, while in others it is absent on basal third
and only present from basal third to apical third.
Although the description above is adapted from Hinton (1940), I might
add that I have collected a few additional specimens from other localities
in Mexico, as follows: also in the state of Mexico, 2 adults from near Ixtapan
de la Sal 19/XI/64, and 1 from Cieneguillas 13/VIII/70; 1 from Coahuila near
Bella Union 16/VIII/70; 1 from Jalisco s. of Mazamitla 23/XI/64; 1 from
Nuevo Leon in the Rio Ramos n. of Linares 8/X/64. The latter two are only
2.8 mm in length, and may actually represent another closely-related
species.
Huleechius marroni, new species
(Figs. 3-6, 14-34)
Holotype. — Male. Like H. spinipes (Hinton) except as follows: length 2.5
mm, width 0.95 mm; pronotum 0.8 mm in length and width, broadest at
basal third; elytra 1.85 mm in length, 0.95 mm in width, broadest at or just
posterior to middle; antenna 0.7 mm in length, slightly greater than width
of head across eyes. Antenna testaceous rather than rufopiceous. Labrum
238
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
(Fig. 14) not granulate, with long, pale hairs mostly curved rather than
straight. Mandible as figured (Fig. 15). Maxilla (Fig. 16) with galea and
lacinia spinose laterally as well as apically; palp small, with apical segment
not enlarged. Labium (Fig. 17) with apical segment of palp less flattened
and pubescent than in male of H. spinipes. Gula square, about half as broad
as submentum. Pronotum with granulation inconspicuous. Elytral intervals
moderately convex. Hind wings reduced (Fig. 19), proportionately much
smaller than in H. spinipes. Prosternum (Fig. 18) medially less depressed
and less coarsely granulate than in H. spinipes. Mesosternum with pale
hairs on lateral prominences less conspicuous than in H. spinipes. On the
tibia of the front leg (Fig. 20), of the inner subapical spines, the first or
proximal one differs from that of H. spinipes in being less apically directed,
but the features of all 3 tibiae (Figs. 20-22) are remarkably similar to the
corresponding ones of H. spinipes (Figs. 10-13). The male genitalia (Figs.
23-25) are also strikingly similar to those of H. spinipes.
Variations. — Other males range from 2. 15 to 2.65 mm in length and 0.85 to
1.0 mm in width. In some, the sutural intervals and sublateral carinae are
slightly paler in color than the rest of the elytra, giving an appearance of
faint vittae.
Females. — Slightly larger than males (length 2.4-2.75 mm, width 0.9-1. 1
mm) and externally similar to males except as in H. spinipes. Female gen¬
italia are shown in Fig. 26.
Types. — Holotype male: MEXICO: Baja California Sur: spring at Ca-
duano, Trapiche de Marron, 28/VII/73, H. P. Brown, deposited in the
National Museum of Natural History, Smithsonian Institution. Allotype:
same data as holotype, deposited with holotype. Paratypes: 32 with same
data as holotype, some deposited in the collection of the California Academy
of Sciences, but most in the Stovall Museum of Science and History, Nor¬
man Oklahoma.
Etymology . — The species is named in honor of Sr. Anselmo Ciro Marron
Alvarez, on whose property the specimens were collected and who gra¬
ciously conducted me to the site and gave me permission to collect.
Habitat. — All specimens were taken from a small, clear, spring-fed brook
less than 1 m in width and no more than a few cm in depth, completely
shaded by overhanging vegetation. The substrate was sand and rather fine
gravel. The surrounding region is quite arid. Caduano is south of the Tropic
of Cancer, just a few miles north of San Jose del Cabo. No other dryopoid
beetles were seen in the stream.
Comparative notes. — Members of this species are smaller and less no¬
ticeably granulate than those of H. spinipes. From specimens of H. marroni
carolus they differ most conspicuously in their much darker and essentially
uniform coloration.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
239
Huleechius marroni carolus, new subspecies
Holotype. — Male. Length 2.35 mm, width 0.9 mm. Like H. marroni ex¬
cept as follows: pronotum smooth, darker than elytra. Labrum with pale
hairs reduced to stubble.
Variations. — Other male 2.5 mm in length, 0.95 mm in width.
Females. — Slightly larger than males (length 2. 6-2. 7 mm, width 0.97-1.0
mm) and externally similar to males except as in H. spinipes.
Types. — Holotype male: ARIZONA: Gila Co. border with Graham Co.,
in San Carlos River ca. 30 km e San Carlos, 3/VIII/73, H. P. Brown,
deposited in Stovall Museum of Science and History, Norman Oklahoma.
Allotype: same data as holotype, deposited with holotype. Paratypes: 1 male
with same data as holotype, deposited in the National Museum of Natural
History, Smithsonian Institution, and 1 female with same data except col¬
lected 20/VI/74, deposited in the entomological collection of the University
of Arizona, Tucson.
Etymology. — The subspecific epithet is derived from the collection site,
the San Carlos River, on the San Carlos Indian Reservation.
Habitat. — All specimens were taken from stream rapids below a ford,
less than 100 m downstream from several large warm springs. The substrate
consists of sand, gravel, and rocks of considerable size. Other dryopoid
beetles found in the same portion of the stream included representatives of
the following genera: the dryopid Helichus, the psephenid Psephenus, and
the elmids Elsianus, Hexacylloepus, and Neoelmis.
Comparative notes. — Although members of this subspecies are about the
same size as those of Huleechius marroni, they exhibit a distinctively dif¬
ferent appearance, with elytra conspicuously lighter in color than the prono¬
tum. The cuticle is translucent and reminiscent of caramel, but the speci¬
mens are not teneral. From H. spinipes, which is opaque, they also differ
in being smaller, with little trace of the conspicuous labial moustache, and
without the granules studding the pronotum.
Larvae
The larvae of Huleechius have been determined not by rearing, which
would be desirable, but by elimination and by association with adults under
circumstances that preclude any other interpretation: 74 larvae of appro¬
priate dimensions in a small permanent, isolated stream from which I also
collected 34 adults of Huleechius marroni but no other larval or adult el¬
mids. Other larvae with the same facies have also been taken from localities
in which H. spinipes (Hinton) is relatively common, although they were
mistakenly identified as probably larvae of Elsianus (Hinton, 1940).
240
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 27-34. Huleechius marroni, n. sp., mature larva. Fig. 27. Antenna. Fig. 28. Labrum.
Fig. 29. Mandible. Fig. 30. Labium. Fig. 31. Maxilla. Fig. 32. Setiferous tubercle from pos¬
terior margin of pronotum. Fig. 33. Setiferous tubercle from posterior margin of 4th abdominal
sternite. Fig. 34. Setiferous tubercle from posterior margin of 4th abdominal tergite.
Generic Characters of Larvae of Huleechius
(Figs. 3-5, 27-34)
Body parallel, subcylindrical, elateriform (Figs. 3-5).
Head very large, exposed; anterior margin with a conspicuous tooth on
each side between clypeus and base of antenna. With one ocellus on each
side. Antenna (Fig. 27) 3-segmented and partially retractile; last segment
setiform and small, bearing a minute terminal seta, and side by side with
apical seta of second segment. Clypeus short and broad. Labrum (Fig. 28)
broader than long. Mandible (Fig. 29) with 3 subacute or obtuse apical teeth;
prostheca long, slender, and densely spinose. Maxilla (Fig. 31) with palp 4-
segmented; stipes without palpifer; galea and lacinia separate, each with
apex spinose. Labium (Fig. 30) with mentum rather elongate and broadening
apically; labial palp 2-segmented; prementum with a well-developed palpi-
ger. Gula well-developed.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
241
Prothorax with anterior sternite reduced to a small intercoxal sclerite
which is easily overlooked; pleura obscurely divided into 2 parts, the pre-
pleurites (anterior pleurites) meeting in midventral line; posterior sternite
pentagonal, with anterior apex projecting acutely between procoxae; coxal
cavities closed behind.
Me so- and metathorax each with pleura divided into 2 parts.
Abdomen without carinae; segments 1-7 with pleura bounded by tergo-
and stemopleural sutures; segments 1-8 bordered posteriorly by tubercles
bearing flat, branched setae; segment 8 forming a complete sclerotized ring;
apex of segment 9 emarginate; operculum with 2 strongly sclerotized claws
attached to its dorsal membrane. Anal tufts of gill filaments well-developed.
Spiracles present on mesothorax and abdominal segments 1-8.
Description of Mature Larva of Huleechius marroni
(Figs. 3-5, 27-34)
Length 6.0 mm; breadth 0.75 mm. Elongate, subparallel, cylindrical to
hemicylindrical. Cuticle testaceous and feebly shining.
Head slightly broader than long (0.63:0.55 mm); posterior margin broadly
and feebly emarginate; epicranial suture 0.08 mm long; frontal suture ex¬
tending on each side in a subsinuate line to anterior margin above medial
base of antenna; anterior margin on each side between base of clypeus and
antenna with a prominent tooth subequal in length to first antennal segment.
Cuticle sparsely pubescent with short, decumbent hairs arising chiefly from
flattened granules; a few long, recurved hairs arise from the lateral portions
of the head and longer, erect hairs (0.2 mm) are conspicuous on the ventral
portion; vertex devoid of granules and setae; basal portion at level of epi¬
cranial suture rather densely covered with very small scales; anterior to
level of epicranial suture the small scales are interspersed by large setiferous
tubercles; toward base of antenna and marginal tooth only the larger tuber¬
cles are present. Antenna (Fig. 27) with first segment constricted laterally
so that second segment articulates at a 45-degree angle; second segment
subequal in length to first. Labrum (Fig. 28) with anterior margin sub trun¬
cate and bordered by recurved setae resembling curled eyelashes; angles
broadly rounded; anterior angle on each side with 1 or 2 very short, toothlike
setae or spines; upper surface on each side with numerous small hairs di¬
rected medially or, toward midline, posteromedially. Mandible (Fig. 29) with
a single, large, recurved seta arising below middle of outer margin. Both
maxilla and labium virtually devoid of hairs except near apex. Maxilla (Fig.
31) with a short, toothlike spine at lateral base of galea and another at base
of lacinia. Labium (Fig. 30) with apex mammiform.
Pronotum with anterior angles rounded, not produced. Cuticle devoid of
tubercles except near lateral margins and in a small band 2-4 tubercles in
242
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
width that extends dorsally from near anterior margin of procoxal cavity;
bordered posteriorly by a row of flattened scales bearing furcate, flattened
setae (Fig. 32). Meso- and metanotum rather generally covered with tuber¬
cles except in several bilaterally symmetrical patches and in a narrow band
near posterior margin; bordered posteriorly by a row of flattened tubercles
or scales bearing furcate, flattened setae.
Abdomen with tergites 1-8 even more uniformly tuberculate except for
small dorsolateral and lateral bare patches symmetrically located on each
segment and bordered posteriorly by flattened tubercles bearing flattened
setae that are usually symmetrically branched (Fig. 34); these marginal tu¬
bercles are darker than the rest of the cuticle, forming a brownish band at
the posterior margin-of each segment; the projecting flat setae form a sort
of collar around the intersegmental membrane and anterior portion of the
succeeding segment. Segment 9 circular in cross-section; cuticle rather uni¬
formly tuberculate except near apex; posterior margin deeply and broadly
emarginate with apices acute and produced.
Ventrally, prosternite of prothorax reduced to a small, fusiform sclerite
between procoxae; poststemite with apex acute and heavily sclerotized;
lateral margin of coxal cavity close to lateral margin of segment; division
between pre- and post-pleurite difficult to observe. Meso- and metastemum
with posterior margins medially acute; cuticle uniformly tuberculate; pre-
pleurites smaller than post-pleurites. Abdomen with tergopleural and ster-
nopleural sutures convergent on each side of segment 7; sternites and pleu-
rites uniformly tuberculate. On segment 9, operculum lacks tubercles, and
is about one-third the length of the segment. All but last segment bordered
posteriorly by a row of flattened tubercles bearing flat, furcate setae which
are more asymmetrical toward the lateral margins (Fig. 33).
Specimens examined. — 74 from MEXICO: Baja California Sur, Caduano,
28/VII/73, H. P. Brown, deposited in Stovall Museum of Science and His¬
tory. Some of these specimens are of earlier instars.
Comparative notes. — The larva of Huleechius marroni is very similar to
that described by Hinton (1940:284) as “ Elsianus (?) sp. ?” Since Hin¬
ton’s 3 specimens upon which he based his description were collected at
Temascaltepec, in the state of Mexico, where he also took adults of Hu¬
leechius spinipes (Hinton), it is reasonable to assume that his description
pertains to the larva of H. spinipes. The larva of H. marroni differs from
that of H. spinipes in being smaller (6.0 mm as compared with 8.5 mm),
lighter in color, with the pronotal transverse belt of tubercles broader (2-4
tubercles in width rather than about 2 tubercles), and in having the meso-
notum, metanotum, and abdominal tergites rather uniformly covered with
tubercles. There are also other minor differences in setal and tubercular
details.
Two larvae I collected 17/VIII/70 at Rancho de Carrales, about 20 km e
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
243
Cuatro Cienegas, Coahuila, presumably represent another species. One is
ca. 5, the other, ca. 6 mm in length. Both are pale, with large bare patches
(free of tubercles) on the mesonotum, metanotum, and posterior medial
portion of abdominal tergite 1. At least the smaller, if not both larvae, would
probably be immature.
I also have two larvae from South America which apparently represent
species of Huleechius. Each is about 7 mm in length. They differ from the
larva of H. marroni in having a greater portion of the mesonotum and
metanotum devoid of tubercles and in having on each side above the spi¬
racles on abdominal segments 1-7 a diagonal patch devoid of tubercles. One
is from the Rio Piray near Santa Cruz, Bolivia, 8/XI/71 (H. P. Brown). The
other is from the Rio Chanchan, Bucay, Prov. Guay as, Ecuador, 13/XI/71
(H. P. Brown). The latter specimen is much darker than the larvae of H.
marroni. As yet, I have not detected adults of Huleechius from South
America.
Although the larva of Huleechius was first described by Hinton (1940) as
“ Elsianus (?),” it is actually closer in appearance to larvae of Stenelmis.
Fortunately, the distributional ranges of the two genera do not quite overlap.
If it should turn out that they do overlap, it will probably be difficult to
separate the larvae. All the true Elsianus larvae studied by Hinton (about
14 species by 1940) exhibit on each side of abdominal segments 2-7 an
accessory longitudinal suture above what appears to be the normal tergo-
pleural suture. Huleechius larvae lack such sutures; they are apparently
unique to Elsianus, though in some species they occur only on segments
2-6. Huleechius larvae differ from those of Stenelmis in having the pro¬
thorax on each side with the pleuron divided into pre- and post-pleurites,
though this division is difficult to see, and in possessing a vestige of the
prosternite in the form of a fusiform intercoxal sclerite.
Acknowledgments
I wish to express my appreciation to the University of Oklahoma Faculty
Research Committee for Polaroid film used in recording dissections and
other microscopic features, and to Ms. Karen Herbst for photographing my
drawings.
Literature Cited
Arnett, R. H., Jr. 1963. The Beetles of the United States. Catholic University of America
Press, Washington, D.C., 1112 pp.
Brown, H. P. 1970. Neocylloepus, a new genus from Texas and Central America (Coleoptera:
Dryopoidea: Elmidae). Coleop. Bull., 24(1): 1-28.
Brown, H. P. 1976. Aquatic Dryopoid Beetles (Coleoptera) of the United States. Biota of
Freshwater Ecosystems, Identification Manual No. 6. U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency, Cincinnati, Ohio, 82 pp.
244
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Brown, H. P. 1977. Tell-tale larvae. Trans. Amer. Microsc. Soc., 96(2): 165-170.
Hinton, H. E. 1934. Miscellaneous studies in the Helminae (Dryopidae, Coleoptera). Rev.
Entomol., Rio d® Janeiro, 4:192-201.
Hinton, H. E. 1940. iji monographic revision of the Mexican water beetles of the family
Elmidae. Novit. Zool., 42:217-396.
Leech, H. B., and H. P. Chandler. 1956. Aquatic Coleoptera, Chapter 13, pp. 293-371. In R.
L. Usinger, Aquatic Insects of California. Univ. of California Press, Berkeley, 508 pp.
Leech, H. B., and M. W. Sanderson. 1959. Coleoptera. Chapter 38, pp. 981-1023. In W. T.
Edmondson, Fresh-Water Biology, 2nd ed. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York,
1248 pp.
NOTICE
This is the last issue to be edited by T. D. Eichlin and A. R. Hardy. The
new editor of The Pan-Pacific Entomologist will be Dr. Gordon Marsh.
Manuscripts and other items of an editorial nature should be sent to the new
editor:
Dr. Gordon Marsh
Museum of Systematic Biology
University of California
Irvine, CA 92717
It has been a rewarding experience serving as your editors, but all must
realize that no editor can function without a great deal of help. Over the
years we have had the aid of several editorial assistants, who have lightened
the load. We have had an excellent working relationship with the always
professional and responsive staff at Allen Press.
In our approximately four and one-half year tenure, we have processed
nearly 500 manuscripts, all requiring critical review. To all of those dedi¬
cated scientists, who were willing to lend their expertise to review papers,
we owe a very special debt of gratitude, because they, in large part, insure
a high quality of our publication.
Finally, we want to thank the Pacific Coast Entomological Society for
giving us the opportunity to serve the Society and our profession.
T. D. Eichlin, A. R. Hardy, Co-editors
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 245-250
A DURABLE, LIGHTWEIGHT NET AND A MANUAL ASPIRATOR FOR
COLLECTING AQUATIC ORGANISMS
Paul J. Spangler
Department of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution,
Washington, D.C. 20560
The net and aspirator described herein were designed for use in collecting
aquatic Coleoptera. However, the net has been used for collecting a wide
variety of aquatic invertebrate and vertebrate organisms, and the aspirator
works just as well on terrestrial insects.
When I first started collecting aquatic insects about 30 years ago I tried
using one of the lightweight aquatic dip nets sold for student use by some
biological supply companies. Although these nets are satisfactory for dip¬
ping up surface inhabiting taxa, the circular net frame invariably bent when
the net bag became laden with aquatic vegetation or when it was pushed
through dense growths of aquatic plants. The heavy accumulation of vege¬
tation in the net occurs frequently when one collects in grassy margins of
aquatic habitats where some of the most interesting aquatic forms are found.
After I had straightened the net frame several times, the frame would in¬
variably break. Therefore, a sturdy net was necessary for this type of col¬
lecting.
I next tried using a sturdy dip net with a triangular frame, the base of
which was imbedded in a lead-filled ferrule attached to a heavy wooden
handle. However, the net was very heavy when the additional weight of
wet vegetation was added to it or when the net was used in streams with
rapid current. The net proved to be very fatiguing after only a few hours’
use; in time, the wooden net handles rotted and broke and had to be
replaced.
Consequently, I constructed an inexpensive, sturdy, lightweight net (Figs.
1-3) that has proved to be very satisfactory. The net may be constructed
with a single piece handle or with one that can be dismantled (Figs. 2, 3) so
it will fit into a suitcase for travel. The items used in constructing the net
are as follows.
1 — Aluminum tubing, 8' long, 1" in outside diameter
1 — Net bag, purchased from biological supply company
1 — Copper or brass wire, about 90"
1 — Metal rod, W diameter and 42" long — for net frame
1 — Crutch tip, 1" inside diameter
4 — Screws, roundhead, brass, no. 7, W long
246
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
I
\
Fig. 1. Aquatic net, complete.
1 — Wooden dowel, %" diameter and 8" long
1 — Copper or brass tubing, %" outside diameter, 8" long
2 — Hose clamps
The aluminum tubing for the handle is usually available in two standard
lengths of 6 or 8 feet and with a smooth or knurled surface. I purchase the
8-foot length and make two 4-foot handles from it; the overall length of the
net is then about 5 feet. If a longer net handle is necessary, the 6- or 8-foot
length can be used as purchased or shortened as desired. I prefer the tubing
with the knurled surface because it provides a firmer grip and holds paint
better than the smooth surface. The iron rod used for the net frame does
not need to be rust resistant if the net bag is dried before storing, but a
rustless metal rod at a slightly higher cost may be desired. So that com-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
247
Figs. 2, 3. Aquatic net. Fig. 2, Dismantled. Fig. 3, Crimped end of handle for attachment
of net frame (upper), copper/wood plug in net handle (middle), brass screws and hose clamps
(lower).
248
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
mercially available net bags could be used, the dimensions of the net frame
are the same as those of the bag. The rod can be bent in a sturdy vise in a
home workshop to form the triangular net frame; the leading edge of the
frame is 1314" wide, the sides are 11" long and the basal pieces that are
clamped to the handle are 314" long on one side and 214" long on the oppo¬
site side (Fig. 2). The shape of the new frame may be circular, rectangular,
or triangular depending on personal preference. I have tried all three forms
and have found that the triangular frame is most satisfactory because it
offers a straight edge and the acute angles can be worked more easily
through thick vegetation and into small spaces that would be inaccessible
with other types. The crutch tip on the end of the net handle is used only
to prevent the handle from scratching the palms of one’s hands or the paint
of car interiors, etc., and to keep mud out of the end of the handle.
In order to adapt the net handle so that it can be carried in luggage I find
the following method works well. (1) The aluminum handle is cut in half,
i.e., cut into two 2-foot lengths. (2) An 8" piece of copper tubing that fits
snugly inside the aluminum handle is cut. (3) An 8" wooden dowel that fits
snugly inside the copper tubing is cut. (4) Then the copper tubing filled with
the wooden plug is inserted 4" into the end of one section of the aluminum
handle; two holes are tapped through the aluminum and the copper tubing;
and brass, round-headed screws are inserted into the holes. (5) The other
half of the aluminum handle is then slipped over the still exposed 4" piece
of copper tubing and two screws installed as mentioned above. Placing wax,
soap, or oil on the screws before inserting them will ease their removal. The
inner copper tubing prevents the wooden dowel from swelling and the han¬
dle will slip apart easily. Thus the dismantled parts of the handle can be
reduced to pieces not more than 24" long and these can be packed in luggage.
The hollow aluminum tubing has two minor disadvantages. It can be dent¬
ed or bent if subjected to an unusually severe blow; and in some waters a
chemical reaction occurs that causes a temporary dark stain on the hands.
This stain can be washed away easily with soap, but staining can be pre¬
vented altogether by painting the handle with a metal paint.
The new frame is fastened to the handle in a manner similar to an ordinary
aerial insect net (Figs. 1-3). However, the end of the handle is partially
flattened to receive the ends of the net frame and two hose clamps replace
the metal sleeve of ordinary nets. With hose clamps as illustrated (Fig. 3)
and sufficiently large slots in the heads of the brass screws, a coin may be
used to dismantle the net; otherwise a screwdriver is needed.
The net bag may be purchased or constructed, if satisfactory sewing
equipment is available. The bag may be made of any satisfactorily strong
netting of desired mesh. The upper edge of the bag should include a stout
lA" diameter cord in the hem to prevent the bag from tearing away after it
is wired to the net frame. The entire net bag should be inside a stout,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
249
©
Fig. 4. Aspirator and ground cloth.
Photographs by Victor Krantz, Smithsonian Institution staff photographer.
lightweight canvas sleeve to prevent snagging the netting on limbs, thorns,
etc. The sleeve slightly impedes drainage of the water from the net but this
slight disadvantage is far outweighed by the prolonged “life” of the bag.
The net bag is wired to the frame so that the leading edge of the net is the
iron rod and not the net bag itself. This too decreases damage to the net
bag and prolongs its “life.” I have used copper wire to fasten the bag to
the frame because of the ease of bending it around the frame and because
it does not rust and thereby weaken the bag as some other wire might do.
I have used the type of aquatic net described above for 20 years and it
has been used by students in my aquatic entomology class at the University
of Maryland for 14 years. Only once, after 4 months of daily use, did a
handle break. The break occurred at a stress point at the end of the copper/
wood plug closest to the net frame. The 4" piece of aluminum tubing that
broke loose was removed and the remaining piece of the handle was slipped
over the copper/wood plug, new holes were punched with a nail, the screws
secured, and the net, although 4 inches shorter, was as good as new.
Most individuals who have used oral aspirators for collecting insects prob¬
ably have had the unpleasant experience of aspirating fine dust, tiny spec-
250
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
imens, or acrid defensive insect gases into their mouths; and many have
experienced a dry throat reaction from these aspirators. Luckily, few have
gotten myiasis of the sinuses as reported by Hurd (1954). Because I was
preparing to collect in the Neotropics and did not want to experience the
same problems Hurd had, I purchased a mechanical aspirator. However,
this aspirator was very large and awkward; it promptly rusted from water
sucked into it with the aquatic beetles and it soon ceased to function. I then
constructed an aspirator (Fig. 4) with a rubber pressure/suction bulb which
is available from scientific supply dealers. The bulb is small, has no metallic
parts to rust, and is durable. With this bulb, one must squeeze the air from
it and suction occurs when the bulb is released. The amount of pressure put
on the bulb combined with the speed by which the bulb is released regulates
the force exerted on the insects being aspirated. The aspirator may be used
with a plastic or glass vial which is dry or contains alcohol.
This device seems slightly awkward when first used because one expects
the squeezing action to aspirate and this is not true with this device. How¬
ever, the user becomes a believer after using this aspirator for only a short
time. When small beetles are abundant in a net or on a ground cloth, several
are often aspirated with one release of the bulb and all specimens are col¬
lected much more rapidly and with less damage than when collected with
forceps or fingers. Where schistosomiasis organisms may be present this
aspirator is useful in reducing exposure to them and provides greater peace
of mind. I have used the type of aspirator described above for 17 years and
would not want to be in the field without one. Eventually the multiple
squeezing of the bulb causes it to weaken and break, but replacement bulbs
are inexpensive.
The aspirator works well when aquatic plants and specimens are dumped
onto a nylon ground cloth. The ground cloth, 2 Vi feet square, drains rapidly;
the insects, free of mud, crawl out of the drying plants and are easy to see
and collect with the aspirator. Triangular pockets may be sewn in the cor¬
ners of the ground cloth, and when sticks are placed in diagonal corners the
cloth will serve as a beating cloth.
Literature Cited
Hurd, P. D., Jr. 1954. “Myiasis” resulting from the use of the aspirator method in the col¬
lection of insects. Science, 1 19(3 101):8 14.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 251-259
A NEW GENUS AND A NEW SPECIES OF LACCOPHILINE WATER
BEETLE FROM ECUADOR (COLEOPTERA: DYTISCIDAE)
Warren E. Steiner, Jr.
% Department of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution,
Washington, D.C. 20560
The predaceous diving beetles (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) of the subfamily
Laccophilinae are a large and widespread group with 9 genera presently
recognized. Most of the species belong to the cosmopolitan genus Lacco-
philus Leach (1817). Species of Neptosternus Sharp (1882) are known from
the Old World tropics. The other genera have a more limited distribution
and are represented by few species: Laccodytes Regimbart (1895) is neo¬
tropical, Philaccolus Guignot (1937), Philodytes J. Balfour-Browne (1939b),
and Africophilus Guignot (1947) are African, Laccoporus J. Balfour-Browne
(1939a) is known only from Tibet, and Australphilus Watts (1978) is found
in Australia and Tasmania. The new genus described in this paper is rep¬
resented by a single new species from the eastern foothills of the Andes
Mountains in Ecuador.
Napodytes, new genus
Form oval, somewhat flattened, more convex dorsally than ventrally;
outer margin of head, pronotum and elytra forming a continuous smooth
outline; surfaces smooth and polished (Fig. 1).
Head broad, evenly rounded dorsally; eyes rounded except for straight
posterior side, not protuberant. Clypeus broadly, shallowly emarginate.
Lab rum broad, evenly rounded on each side of a deep, rounded, median
emargination. Antennae with segments 1 and 2 not much thicker than seg¬
ments 3 and 4, cylindrical; segments 5-10 enlarged and flattened in male,
smaller, cylindrical in female. Segment 11 elongate, pointed, with anterior
side nearly straight, posterior side curved. Maxillary and labial palpi similar
in form, with apical segments shaped like those of antennae.
Pronotum broad, 2.5 times as wide as long, widest at base, narrowing to
width of head anteriorly; anterior margin straight, with a rounded emargi¬
nation behind eyes; posterior margin obtusely angulate at middle, narrowly
arcuate to sides; lateral margins finely beaded. Prosternum sharply carinate
from base to apex of prosternal process; process narrowed between front
coxae, abruptly widening to a rhomboid apex, with pointed tip fitting into
a V-shaped notch in metasternum (Fig. 2A). Scutellum hidden.
252
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Napodytes boki, male, dorsal habitus. Total length 1.8 mm.
Elytra widest at basal V3, more than twice as long as wide, narrowly and
obliquely truncate at apex; lateral margins finely beaded, with an irregular
row of long, fine setae along apical V3 of elytra; epipleura gradually tapering
from base, extending nearly to outer corner of truncation. Episterna of
metathorax not reaching mesocoxae (separated by mesepimera). Metaster¬
num with a small, polished, median elevation at posterior apex. Metacoxal
lines widely separated, gradually diverging posteriorly to metacoxal pro-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
253
Fig. 2. Napodytes boki. A, Area of sternum showing prosternal process, metasternum, and
metacoxal lobes. B, Antenna, male. C, Antenna, female. D, Apex of abdomen, male. E, Apex
of abdomen, female.
cesses. Metacoxal processes rounded, separated by a narrow V-shaped cleft
(Fig. 2A). Metasternal side wings strongly arcuate, evenly, narrowly tapered
to a point. Abdominal sterna each with a transverse row of setigerous punc¬
tures; apex of last visible sternum entire and evenly rounded in male, emar-
ginate in female.
Front and middle femora somewhat flattened, not setose. Front femora
with a comb of stiff, posteriorly curved setae along apical Vs of front ventral
margin (well-developed in male, less so in female). Front and middle tarsi
long, slender; segments 1-3 short, roughly equal in size, as long as wide;
4th segment longer; 5th segment very long, as long as the 2 preceding seg¬
ments combined; segments 1-3 ventrally with narrow pads of adhesive hairs
in male, a few short, stout setae in female; segments not dilated or thicker
in male; claws equal, slender. Hind femora oblong, flattened. Hind tibiae
short, robust, with a single, large, sharply pointed apical spur (Figs. 3A, B).
Hind tarsal segments 1-4 with prominent ventrolateral lobes roughly Vs as
254
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 3. Napodytes boki (allotype, $), right hind tibia, apex. A, Oblique view of apical spur.
B, Direct view of apical spur. x400.
long as the segments; outer edge of each segment and lobe armed with a
long ventral spur and an outer row of 7-10 stout spines; natatory hairs long
and fine. Apical segment small, narrow, prolonged apically to a sharp spine;
lateral lobe and spines reduced; a single, inconspicuous, flattened claw pres¬
ent between apical spine and lobe, lying along inner side of spine, about Vi
as long as spine.
Male genitalia with median lobe asymmetrical, bladelike; parameres
asymmetrical, thin, leaflike, nearly straight on ventral side, widely rounded
dorsally; left paramere with a single apical seta; right paramere with 2 apical
setae. Female genitalia knifelike, with fused second valvulae (ovipositor)
serrated ventrally, resting between long, curved, laterally flattened first val¬
vulae.
Type species. — Napodytes boki, new species.
Etymology. — The name of the genus is derived from Napo, the name of
the major river in eastern Ecuador and the province where the type-species
was collected, and dytes (Greek), “diver,” a component of many of the
generic names in the family. The gender is masculine.
Napodytes boki, new species
Length 1.8 mm; greatest width 1.0 mm; greatest thickness 0.6 mm. Head
light brownish yellow; dorsal surface shining, polished, with a small, faintly
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
255
punctate area above each eye. Eyes narrowly ringed with black. Pronotum
mostly yellow, brownish yellow anteriorly, with dark brown to black col¬
oration along posterior margin; surface polished, with a narrow band of very
fine, inconspicuous punctures behind anterior margin. Elytra black with
undulate yellow patches, as illustrated (Fig. 1); surfaces shining, very finely,
faintly reticulate, with a row of small punctures down basal V3 of disc.
Appendages, epipleura, and ventral surfaces of head, prothorax, and ab¬
domen yellowish; metathorax and metacoxal plates darker, brownish.
Antennae of male (Fig. 2B) with segments 5-10 flattened, more rounded
and expanded anteriorly than posteriorly, convex dorsally, slightly concave
ventrally; segment 7 widest, nearly as wide as long; segments 8-11 succes¬
sively narrower and longer; segment 11 nearly 4 times as long as wide.
Antennae of female (Fig. 2C) not modified, with most segments roughly
twice as long as wide, only slightly flattened; segments 3-10 successively
widening gradually (10th segment widest); segment 11 like that of male, but
smaller.
Ventral surfaces of body shining, very finely reticulate. Abdominal sterna
not as smoothly polished as metasternal and metacoxal plates. Last visible
abdominal sternum (Figs. 2D, E) in female with emargination small, semi¬
circular, with apical corners narrowly rounded.
In male profemoral comb of 4 enlarged, rigid setae proximally, several
very small, fine setae distally; first (proximal) seta largest; comb reduced in
female, with only 3 small setae visible.
Male genitalia (Figs. 4A-D) with median lobe slender, arched dorsally,
with apex flattened and knifelike, twisted from axis of base like a blade of
a propeller; left side of blade with edge thin and sharp, with a very thin
flange expanded outward at base (midlength of median lobe); right side thick
and rounded in cross section, narrowly sinuate along length of median lobe
in dorsal view, angled to form a broadly, obliquely truncate apex; tip nar¬
rowly rounded. Left paramere twisted, narrower than right paramere, with
a single, long, stiff, apical seta. Right paramere broad, cupped around base
of median lobe, with 2 long apical setae.
Female genitalia (Figs. 4E, F) with ovipositor long and slender, heavily
sclerotized, with a row of fine, closely spaced teeth along each side of a
median ventral groove from base to apical Vs, where rows merge into a
single row of 4 very large, flattened, triangular teeth. Outer (1st) valvulae
long and gradually curved upward to a sharp apex, with a second subapical
point on dorsal edge; valvulae connected at a small dorsal swelling just
beyond midlength.
Types. — Holotype S , and allotype: ECUADOR: Napo, 17 km. SW Tena,
28 May 1977 (W. E. Steiner). The types are deposited in the U.S. National
Museum of Natural History, Smithsonian Institution, Washington, D.C.;
USNM type no. 76602.
256
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 4. Napodytes boki, male and female genitalia. A, Median lobe, lateral view. B, Median
lobe, dorsal view. C, Right paramere, lateral view. D, Left paramere, lateral view. E, Ovi¬
positor, lateral view. F, First valvula, lateral view.
Etymology. — It gives me great pleasure to name this species in honor of
Gordon Bok, folklore artist from Maine, who has given us many inspiring
songs and stories of the water and the life so dependent on it.
Known distribution. — The species is known only from the 2 specimens
from the type-locality.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
257
Biotope at the type-locality. — The specimens of Napodytes boki were
collected at a blacklight shortly after dark during a light rain. The light was
operated in an open roadside clearing near a swift, rocky creek. Steep hills
of montane rain forest surrounded the site. Elevation approximately 660 m;
temperature about 23°C.
The specific microhabitat of Napodytes boki cannot be determined; in
addition to the stream, other nearby aquatic habitats included shaded seep¬
ages, small creeks, roadside puddles, and water in epiphytic plants. Mem¬
bers of other laccophiline genera are known to be associated with a variety
of temporary lentic habitats and margins of small streams.
Behavior. — When collected from the sheet beneath the blacklight, the bee¬
tles were observed jumping actively in various unexpected directions. This
evasive behavior is seen in other laccophilines when out of water and dis¬
turbed, and seems to be characteristic of the group. It has been described
as a method of escape in Africophilus species (Omer-Cooper, 1965).
Discussion
The genus Napodytes is placed in the subfamily Laccophilinae because
of the separation between the metepisterna and mesocoxae, hidden scutel-
lum, single hind tarsal claws, smoothly oval body outline, and serrate ovi¬
positor. The small size, form of the prosternal process, and emarginate
abdominal apex in the female are characters shared by the members of the
genus Laccodytes. These apotypic features are not seen in the other known
laccophiline genera, suggesting that Napodytes and Laccodytes are closely
related sister groups.
The single apical spur of the hind tibia in Napodytes boki is, however, a
unique and unusual character among the Dytiscidae. Members of other
known laccophiline genera have two large spurs arising from the excavated
apex of the tibia: a longer dorsal (posterior) spur and a shorter but equally
strong ventral (anterior) spur, with bases contiguous. In Napodytes boki
the single spur arises medially, and no trace of a second spur is evident, as
illustrated by the scanning electron micrographs (Figs. 3 A, B). The setae
and small, peglike spurs surrounding the smooth apical excavation are not
homologous with the second large spur; these small ones are also present
and arranged similarly in other laccophilines with two normal spurs. The
single spur in Napodytes is probably the result of an evolutionary loss of
one of the spurs, or a fusion of the two.
The modified antenna in the male of Napodytes boki is also an unusual
feature not previously known in the Laccophilinae. Regimbart’s (1895) two
species of Laccodytes (including the type-species, phalacroides ) were de¬
scribed from females only, but both sexes of Laccodytes americanus Pes-
chet (1919) are known and have antennae simple, not sexually dimorphic.
258
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
The following key will serve to identify the genera recognized at present.
Key characters were taken from the descriptions and other keys in regional
studies (Balfour-Browne, 1939; Omer-Cooper, 1965). I have not seen ex¬
amples of all of the genera.
Key to the Known Genera of Laccophilinae of the World
1. Hind tibiae with a single large apical spur; antennal segments en¬
larged and flattened in male . Napodytes
Hind tibiae with 2 large subequal apical spurs; antennae not notice¬
ably different between sexes, filiform . 2
2. Prosternal process trifurcate, with 3 long sharply pointed spines di¬
rected posteriorly; hind angles of pronotum spiniform Neptosternus
Prosternal process variably lanceolate, with a single pointed apex;
hind angles of pronotum squared or narrowly rounded, not
spiniform . 3
3. Hind tibial spurs bifurcate at apex . Laccophilus
Hind tibial spurs with a simple sharp apex . 4
4. Size small, under 2.5 mm long; prosternal process widely broadened
and angulate at sides behind front coxae, forming a diamond¬
shaped apex . Laccodytes
Size larger, over 2.5 mm long; prosternal process more narrowly
lanceolate, not angulate behind front coxae . 5
5. Base of pronotum angulate at middle, sinuate to sides . 6
Base of pronotum straight or broadly rounded across middle . 7
6. Surfaces of legs densely punctate; prosternal process distinctly
carinate . Laccoporus
Surfaces of legs smooth; prosternal process not strongly cari¬
nate . Philodytes
7. Elytral reticulation irregular; metacoxal lines parallel ante¬
riorly . Africophilus
Elytral reticulation transverse; metacoxal lines divergent ante¬
riorly . 8
8. Hind coxal processes bilobed; reticulation of metacoxal plate
rounded . Australphilus
Hind coxal processes simple, rounded; reticulation of metacoxal
plate transverse . Philaccolus
The curious single spur of the hind tibia and obvious sexual dimorphism
in the antennae of Napodytes boki are unique apotypic features among the
Laccophilinae, and are the key characters separating Napodytes from the
other genera in the group. The adaptive advantages of these modifications
are uncertain; the presence of these characters and the relatively flattened
body form suggests that the species may have an unusual aquatic niche and
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
259
microhabitat. These questions and the relationships among the genera may
be worked out when the Neotropical fauna can be more thoroughly studied,
and the larval stages and biologies are discovered.
Acknowledgments
Thanks are due to Philip D. Perkins, Paul J. Spangler, and G. William
Wolfe for their helpful comments concerning this study, and assistance in
searching the literature. I am especially indebted to Paul J. Spangler for his
generous help while collecting in Ecuador. I also thank Donald R. Givens,
Lawrence J. Pinto, and David L. Vincent for their company and assistance
in the field.
Literature Cited
Balfour-Browne, J. 1939a. A contribution to the study of the Dytiscidae. — I. (Coleoptera,
Adephaga). Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist., 1 1(3):97-1 14.
Balfour-Browne, J. 1939b. Scientific results of the Cambridge expedition to the East African
Lakes 1930-1. No. 19. Coleoptera of the families Dytiscidae and Gyrinidae. Linnean
Soc. J.-Zool., 11:475-485.
Guignot, F. 1937. Contribution a F etude des Laccophilinae (Col. Dytiscidae). Bull. Soc. Ento-
mol. Fr., 42(9): 137-143.
Guignot, F. 1947. Vingt-quatrieme note sur les Hydrocanthares. Dytiscides et Gyrinides nou-
veaux ou peu connus de FAfrique Occidentale. Bull. Soc. Entomol. Fr., 10:162-165.
Leach, W. E. 1817. Synopsis of the stirpes and genera of the family Dytiscidea. Zool. Miscell.,
3:68-73.
Omer-Cooper, J. 1965. Coleoptera: Dytiscidae. S. Afr. Animal Life, 11:59-214.
Peschet, R. 1919. Description d’un Dytiscidae nouveau de FAmerique du Sud. Bull. Soc.
Entomol. Fr., 8:145-147.
Regimbart, M. 1895. Dytiscides trouves dans les tabacs. Ann. Soc. Entomol. Fr., 64:321-348.
Sharp, D. 1882. On carnivorous aquatic Coleoptera or Dytiscidae. Sci. Trans. Roy. Dublin
Soc. 2(2): 179-1003.
Watts, C. H. S. 1978. A revision of the Australian Dytiscidae (Coleoptera). Austr. J. Zool.,
Suppl. no. 57. 166 pp.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 260-268
SOME OMICRINI FROM THE ORIENTAL AND PACIFIC REGIONS
(COLEOPTERA: HYDROPHILIDAE: SPHAERIDIINAE)
Stanley E. Malcolm
Biol. Sciences Group, The Univ. of Connecticut, Storrs 06268
Smetana’s (1975) recognition and erection of the tribe Omicrini have been
catalytic to my study of sphaeridiine phylogeny. I have elaborated on his
tribal description and emended his list of included genera (Malcolm, 1980).
The following new species were discovered in the course of identifying
material for the Bernice P. Bishop Museum and British Museum (Natural
History). The description of the aedeagus of Omicrus brevipes Sharp comes
about as the result of my wish to compare the Marquesan specimens with
O. brevipes, the only Omicrus previously known from the Pacific Region.
Fifteen other species are known from the neotropics (Smetana, 1975). That
new species of Omicrus should be found on Pacific islands is not surprising;
their occurrence in rotting wood and other decaying plant material would
seem to make them excellent candidates for dispersal by rafting. The same
might be said for many other taxa of Sphaeridiinae, particularly some other
Omicrini, which appear to have radiated widely throughout Indonesia and
other Pacific island groups. It is in the Pacific and Oriental Regions that one
must look for insight into the evolutionary history of Omicrini.
Omicrus brevipes Sharp, 1879
Smetana (1975) based his redescription of Omicrus brevipes Sharp on two
of the three specimens in the original series. He did not figure the male
genitalia, as one specimen appeared to be a female and he preferred not to
dissect the lectotype. I was able to examine the third specimen of O. brev¬
ipes through the courtesy of the British Museum (Natural History). Imagine
my surprise to find it a male, with the aedeagus already dissected out and
preserved in glycerin. The specimen is labeled: “d ’’/‘‘Hawaiian Is. Rev. T.
Blackburn. 1888-30’ 7“ Omicrus brevipes.” Although partly dissected, its
length is about 1.45 mm, its width is 0.98 mm. In external characters the
specimen agrees with Smetana’s redescription. I do not doubt that it is
conspecific with the two specimens examined by Smetana. The aedeagus
(Fig. 1A) is 0.67 mm long, the basal piece proportionally much longer than
in any other known Omicrus, and the parameres strongly curved ventrally
at their tips.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
261
Fig. 1. Male genitalia of Omicrus : A, O. brevipes Sharp; B. O. smetanai new species; C,
O. milleri new species.
Omicrus smetanai, new species
Holotype. — Male; Marquesas Islands, Temetiv Ridge, Hivaoa, 3900 ft,
14-1-1932, Le Bronnec Coll., Pacific Entom. Survey (Bernice P. Bishop
Museum).
Length 1.97 mm; width 1.41 mm; head rufobrunneus, slightly lighter an¬
teriorly, sparsely finely punctate, without trace of microsculpture; antennae,
maxillary palps, and labrum testaceous; pronotum rufobrunneus, with few
widely separated fine punctures, micro sculpture barely visible as fine waves
laterally; scutellum with a few very fine punctures; elytra rufobrunneus
except lighter at extreme apex, punctation slightly coarser and more dense
than on pronotum, especially laterally, micro sculpture virtually obsolete as
on pronotum; thoracic sterna dark rufobrunneus, mesosternal elevation
262
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
rather narrow basally, elevated middle portion of metasternum sparsely
punctate, each moderate-sized puncture bearing a long golden seta, meta-
stemum microreticulate laterally; legs rufotestaceous, tarsi fringed with long
golden setae below, first hind tarsal segment about equal to second; abdo¬
men rufobrunneus, microreticulate; aedeagus as in Fig. IB.
Paratypes. — 4 specimens (one 6 , the others not dissected), same data as
holotype (Bernice P. Bishop Museum); 1 specimen (sex not determined),
same data as holotype, (retained by the author).
This is the largest Omicrus species yet described, averaging 2.10 mm long
(range 1.97-2.25 mm) and 1.46 mm wide (range 1.39-1.52 mm). Of the neo¬
tropical species it most nearly resembles O. laevis (Sharp), from which it
can be distinguished by its larger size and aedeagus with shorter basal piece.
The wings are reduced to functionless slips. Paratype labels include habitat
as “in rotting leaves.” The species is named for Dr. Ales Smetana in rec¬
ognition of his contributions to the knowledge of Hydrophilidae, especially
Omicrini.
Omicrus milleri, new species
Holotype. — Male; Marquesas Islands, Temetiv Ridge, Hivaoa, 3900 ft,
14-1-1932, Le Bronnec Coll., Pacific Entom. Survey, in rotting leaves (Ber¬
nice P. Bishop Museum).
Length 1.56 mm; width 1.07 mm; head rufopiceous, punctures of mod¬
erate size separated by spaces 2 or 3 times their diameter, micro sculpture
of irregular waves visible on clypeus, obsolete on vertex; antennae, max¬
illary palps, and labrum testaceous; pronotum rufobrunneus, appearing al¬
most impunctate, punctures very sparse and fine, micro sculpture barely
visible as rudimentary irregular waves; scutellum with a few punctures
slightly coarser than those on pronotum; elytra rufobrunneus, diffusely light¬
er posterolaterally, punctures uniformly moderately coarse, tending to be
arranged in distinct rows laterally, punctation of intervals equally coarse
but less regular in pattern, micro sculpture lacking; thoracic sterna rufo¬
brunneus, mesosternal elevation rather narrow, distinctly lanceolate raised
along midline, elevated middle portion of metastemum sparsely finely punc¬
tate except at base, each puncture bearing a long golden seta, metastemum
microreticulate laterally; legs fuscotestaceous, tarsi fringed with long golden
setae below, first hind tarsal segment about equal to second; abdomen ru¬
fotestaceous, microreticulate; aedeagus as in Fig. 1C.
Paratypes. — 8 specimens (sex not determined), same data as holotype
(Bernice P. Bishop Museum); 2 specimens (sex not determined), same data
as holotype (retained by the author).
Average length is 1.67 mm (range 1.56-1.85 mm), average width 1.09 mm
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
263
(range 0.98-1.23 mm). This species superficially resembles O. brevipes,
particularly in the coarseness of elytral punctation, but differs in the lack
of strong pronotal microsculpture and in the form of the male genitalia. The
wings are reduced to functionless slips. The species is named for Dr. David
C. Miller, who introduced me to the study of Hydrophilidae and who pointed
out the series of the Bishop Museum collection on which this and the pre¬
vious species are based.
Peratogonus grandis, new species
Holotype. — Sex not determined; Sikkim: Gopaldhara, Rungbong Vail.,
H. Stevens (British Museum (Natural History)).
Length 2.21 mm; width 1.64 mm; head piceous, finely microreticulate,
finely densely punctate; labrum rufo testaceous; antennae and maxillary
palps testaceous; pronotum rufopiceous, microreticulate as head, punctures
slightly coarser, more widely separated than on head; elytra rufopiceous,
10-striate, striae deeply impressed except on disc, intervals shining, very
sparsely, minutely punctate; ventral surface rufobrunneus, microreticulate;
mesosternal elevation very broadly pentagonal, anterior margin raised, dis¬
tance between mesocoxae equal to width of coxa; metasternum excavated
laterally for reception of mesotibiae, medially finely, densely punctate,
punctures becoming less dense and much coarser laterally; 1st abdominal
sternum longitudinally carinate; legs rufobrunneus; profemora microretic¬
ulate, angulate at apex of trochanter, grooved anteriorly for reception of
tibiae, slightly concavely bowed posteriorly; protibiae grooved externally
for reception of tarsi; meso- and metafemora having micro sculpture con¬
sisting of short lines parallel to the length of the femur; tarsi short, not very
hairy, first segment about equal to second.
I have before me one specimen of P. reversus Sharp, lent me by the
Institut royal des Sciences naturelles de Belgique, determined by Armand
d’Orchymont. In comparison, P. grandis is much larger (the specimen of
P. reversus measures 1.72 mm long and 1.31 mm wide) and has more and
finer punctures laterally on the metasternum (the punctures of P. reversus
are exceptionally large and deep).
Peratogonus and the closely related genus Noteropagus were placed in
Megasternini by d’Orchymont (1919), primarily on characters of sternal
morphology. I find Noteropagus and Peratogonus (hereafter abbreviated
N & P) to belong to Omicrini for the following reasons:
1. N & P possess the depressed explanate clypeus of Omicrini, although
this condition is partly masked by the development in most species of a
false clypeal margin. The explanate clypeus is a key synapomorphy defining
Omicrini.
264
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
2. N & P share with Omicrini the possession of a bifurcate vein Cu 2 in
the flight wing. They, and all Omicrini, lack the pre-apical spur on the M-
Cu loop found in Cercyonini and Megastemini.
3 . N & P have distinct elytral epipleura in the basal half, a plesiomorphic
condition. Megasternini are apomorphic for the loss of epipleura.
4. N & P have elytral punctation of a derived omicrine type, that is, all
series follow the curve of the elytral convexity. Thus lateral striae end
progressively further anterior of the elytral tip. In Megasternini the lateral
series are parallel to the elytral margin.
5. N & P have the profemoral base angulate in common with Omicrini,
but not Megasternini.
6. N & P lack the secondarily derived suture between frons and clypeus
common to all Megastemini except Megasternum.
7. N & P lack the femoral lines of all Megastemini except Megasternum
and Emmidolium (which appear to have lost them secondarily).
8. The pentagonal mesostemum and elevated prostemum by which N &
P were placed in Megastemini are found also in some Omicrini, and ap¬
proximated in some Cercyonini and Sphaeridiini.
d’Orchymont (1919) separated Noteropagus from Peratogonus, stating
that the former were smaller, with body form more oblong, more depressed,
and less globose, without a series of larger punctures against the posterior
margin of the pronotum, with the elytra finely seriatopunctate (rather than
distinctly striate), and with epipleura more visible up to the sutural angle.
While the described species of Noteropagus are all smaller than those of
Peratogonus, and while the other characters hold in most cases, it is not
apparent that these features warrant generic status for Noteropagus. I pro¬
pose that Noteropagus be retained pending further study of the hydrophilid
fauna of the Pacific and Oriental Regions, where I have no doubt more
species await description.
Ischyromicrus, new genus
Etymology. — “Stubborn Omicrus combining reference to the difficulty
in determining the relationships of the genus (Ischyros = stubborn Gr ) and
the type-genus of Omicrini. Gender: Masculine.
Type-species. — I. julieae new species
Form oval, moderately convex; antennae 9 segmented (6 + 3), first seg¬
ment elongate, segments 3-5 minute, club moderately compact, pubescent;
clypeus strongly depressed and explanate immediately anterior to antennal
bases; maxillary palpi shorter than antennae, 2nd (pseudobasal) segment
slightly swollen, 3rd and 4th segments about equal, shorter than 2nd; eyes
located on lateral angular prominences of head, not emarginate anteriorly;
lab rum visible, emarginate medially, fringed with setae; labium and maxillae
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
265
Fig. 2. Ischyromicrus julieae new species, Holotype, Ventral View.
separated from posterior head region by a transverse groove, submentum
obliquely sloping, entire labium slightly concave below for reception of me¬
dian prostemal projection; labial palps of moderate length; maxillae, labium,
and labial palps fringed with setae; pronotum convex to margin, not ex-
planate, deeply emarginate anteriorly for reception of head; prosternum
very short, almost vertical anterior to coxae, raised strongly towards medial
rounded prominence, median projection with a short spine anteriorly, nar¬
rowly carinate raised between coxae, carina split posteriorly; mesostemum
elevated medially in the form of a flat plate, grooved longitudinally, con-
vexly narrowed to a point anteriorly, broadly contacting metasternal pro¬
jection posteriorly; metastemum linearly raised medially, projecting be¬
tween mesocoxae, mesocoxae appearing moderately widely separated,
actually close together under metasternal projection, metepistema not nar-
266
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
B
E
E
n
o
Fig. 3. A-C, Ischyromicrus julieae new species: A, wing venation; B, male genitalia; C,
labrum. D, I. cognitus new species: labrum.
rowed; elytra with sutural stria in apical half, otherwise not striate but with
10 rows of punctures, epipleura broad from base to apex, broadest in basal
third; wing venation as in Fig. 3A, two closed cells in cubito-anal region,
jugal lobe weakly defined but present; tarsi long, hind tarsi as long as tibiae,
1st hind tarsal segment about equal to 2, 3, and 4 together; 1st abdominal
sternum not longitudinally carinate.
Ischyromicrus presents a suite of characters, some quite generalized, oth¬
ers autapomorphic, which at first obscured the affinities of the genus. Never¬
theless I am convinced that the genus is omicrine, resembling most closely
the genera Heteryon Sharp and Oreomicrus Malcolm. Ischyromicrus is
placed in Omicrini based on its possession of an explanate clypeus, its eyes
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
267
on lateral angular prominences of the head, and its metasternum prolonged
between the mesocoxae. Like Heteryon and Oreomicrus the 1st abdominal
sternum is not longitudinally carinate, the pro sternal projection is split be¬
hind the coxae, the profemora are not angulate at their base, the submentum
is not perpendicular, and, like Heteryon, the elytral punctation pattern is
simple. Although the antennae are 9 segmented, segments 3-5 are minute,
perhaps a precursor to the loss of one segment as in Heteryon and Oreo¬
micrus. The antennal clubs are similarly shaped in all three genera. The long
1st hind tarsal segment is an apomorphic condition found in no other omi-
crine genus, where the rule is short tarsi with the first segment about equal
to the second. The flight wing has two closed cells in the cubito-anal region,
a plesiomorphic condition. In Sphaeridiinae, exclusive of Rygmodini, I have
found two closed cells only in Omicrus sp. and in Andotypus ashworthi
Spangler (1979) of the Sphaeridiini. Ischyromicrus possesses autapomorphi-
cally derived pro- and mesosterna. The mesostemal projection is reminis¬
cent of that found in Cercyonini, yet differs by being longitudinally grooved
and closely joined to the metasternum between rather than behind the me¬
socoxae.
Ischyromicrus julieae, new species
(Fig. 2)
Holotype. — Male; North Borneo (SE), Forest Camp, 9.8 km SW of Ten-
om, 19. XII. 1962, Y. Hirashima Collector, Bishop (Bernice P. Bishop Mu¬
seum).
Length 2.95 mm; width 1.80 mm; head brunneus, moderately, finely punc¬
tate, each slit-like puncture with a minute hair-like projection; labrum, max¬
illary palps, and antennae testaceous, except antennal club fuscous, labrum
with single emargination (Fig. 3C); pronotum light brunneus, punctures as
on head; scutellum impunctate; elytra light brunneus, puncture rows very
fine, intervals with still finer punctures irregularly placed; ventral surface
light brunneus, microreticulate, me so sternal elevation about twice as long
as wide, metasternal projection slightly narrowed anteriorly; legs brunneus;
aedeagus as in Fig. 3B.
Paratype. — 1 female; length 3.03 mm, width 1.97 mm, same data as ho¬
lotype, Bernice P. Bishop Museum.
The species is named for Ms. Julie Ramsey, who has been a constant
source of encouragement to me over the last two years.
Ischyromicrus cognitus, new species
Holotype. — Female; Haut Mekong, Muong Sing (North Vietnam),
18. IV. 1918, R. V. de Salvaza, Brit. Mus. 1921-89 (British Museum (Natural
History)).
268
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Length 3.44 mm; width 2.05 mm; head rufopiceous, moderately, finely
punctate, punctures round, not slit-like; labrum, maxillary palpi, and anten¬
nae rufobrunneus, except antennal club fuscous, labral emargination deeper
on each side of midline (Fig. 3D); pronotum rufopiceous, punctures as on
head; scutellum impunctate; elytra rufopiceous, fading to rufobrunneus pos¬
teriorly, puncture rows fine on disc, becoming larger laterally and poste¬
riorly, intervals with much finer punctures irregularly placed, elytra slightly
explanate posterolaterally; ventral surface rufopiceous, microreticulate,
mesostemal projection about three times as long as wide, narrowed slightly
posteriorly, metastemal projection fairly narrow, only barely overlapping
coxae; legs rufopiceous.
This species is easily separated from /. julieae by its narrower mesoster-
nal projection, coarser elytral punctation, and doubly emarginate labrum.
Acknowledgments
I am indebted to Dr. G. A. Samuelson of the Bernice P. Bishop Museum,
Honolulu, Mr. M. E. Bacchus of the British Museum (Natural History),
London, and Mr. L. Baert of the Institut royal des Sciences naturelles de
Belgique, Bruxelles, for the loan of specimens used in this study. I also wish
to thank Dr. Carl Schaefer for helpful criticism of this manuscript. To Ms.
Julie Ramsey I extend special thanks for her encouragement and insightful
comments.
Literature Cited
d’Orchymont, A. 1919. Contribution a l’etude des sous-familles des Sphaeridiinae et les Hy-
drophilinae (Col., Hydrophilidae). Ann. Soc. entomol. France, 88:105-168.
Malcolm, S. 1980. Oreomicrus new genus, and elaboration of the tribe Omicrini (Coleoptera:
Hydrophilidae: Sphaeridiinae). Ann. Entomol. Soc. Amer., 73:185-188.
Sharp, D. 1879. On some Coleoptera from the Hawaiian Islands. Trans. Entomol. Soc. Lon¬
don. :77-105.
Smetana, A. 1975. Revision of the New World genera of the tribe Omicrini trib. nov. of the
hydrophilid subfamily Sphaeridiinae (Coleoptera). Stud. Neotr. Fauna, 10:153-182.
Spangler, P. 1979. A new genus of water scavenger beetle from Chile (Coleoptera: Hydro¬
philidae: Sphaeridiini). Coleop. Bull., 33:303-308.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 269-272
ON THE IDENTITY OF AMPHIZOA KASHMIRENSIS VAZIRANI
(COLEOPTERA: AMPHIZOIDAE)
David H. Kavanaugh
Department of Entomology, California Academy of Sciences,
Golden Gate Park, San Francisco 94118
and
Robert E. Roughley
Department of Entomology, University of Alberta,
Edmonton T6G 2E3, Canada
Since its discovery and original description (LeConte, 1853), the genus
Amphizoa has been the focus of considerable interest and study (Edwards,
1951) in spite of its low diversity (only six species described). Members of
this genus, considered by most workers since Horn (1881) as representing
a distinct, monobasic, phyletically relict family, demonstrate a combination
of structural characters which appears to be intermediate between those of
the Caraboidea and the Dytiscoidea of Adephaga. Amphizoa is thus a crucial
group for understanding adephagan phylogeny in general and relationships
among terrestrial and aquatic representatitves of the suborder in particular.
Amphizoids are also of interest for their presumed geographical distri¬
bution — four species restricted to western North America and two species
described from the Himalayan region. This particular disjunction pattern,
seen in at least a few other groups (e.g. in Opisthiini, another relict adepha¬
gan (Carabidae) group), has been interpreted as a remnant of a formerly
more continuous distribution pattern. Undoubtedly some groups are pres¬
ently distributed in this pattern, but we are uncertain that it actually rep¬
resents the distribution of Amphizoidae. Our doubts, and this report, center
on the identity of the Palaearctic components of this pattern.
Palaearctic Amphizoidae
Past efforts by North American workers (e.g. Edwards, 1951; Kavanaugh,
1980) to study or even locate identified material representing these presumed
Palaearctic amphizoid taxa have failed. The location of type specimens or
any other representatives of Amphizoa davidi Lucas (1882:157) is unknown
at present. Regimbart (1899:192) indicated that at least one specimen was
to be found in Museum d’Historie Naturelle de Paris (MHNP); but recent
searches in that collection have uncovered nothing referable to this taxon.
270
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Similarly, identified specimens of Amphizoa kashmirensis Vazirani
(1964:145) have not been available for study, and structures illustrated in
the original description of this taxon are unlike those of Nearctic Amphizoa
members. This led Kavanaugh (1980) to question the familial relationships
of these Palaearctic ‘amphizoids’ and, hence, occurrence of the genus Am¬
phizoa in the Palaearctic region. However, in the absence of material rep¬
resenting these taxa, the problem has remained unsolved.
“ Amphizoa kashmirensis ”
Fortunately, and through the kind assistance of Dr. K. Rai, Director of
the Zoological Survey of India (ZSI), Calcutta, Kavanaugh recently ob¬
tained two female paratypes of A. kashmirensis on loan from that institution.
An initial examination of these specimens revealed that they share charac¬
teristics (in structure and form of pro- and metasterna, coxal cavities, pro-
and metacoxae, and hind legs [fringed with natatorial setae]) typical of dy-)
tiscids rather than of amphizoids. Kavanaugh then asked Hugh B. Leech to
review the specimens and venture an opinion on their familial affinities.
Leech agreed that the specimens are dytiscids and suggested further that
they belong to the genus Gaurodytes, subgenus Hydronehrius (sensu Zait¬
sev, 1953), which included a single species, G. cordaticollis (Reitter, 1896),
known from the U.S.S.R. (Uzbekistan and Tadzhikistan).
Independently and somewhat earlier, Roughly had obtained unidentified
material from the Canadian National Collection (CNC), Ottawa, which he
subsequently identified as representative of the genus Hydronehrius Jakov¬
lev (1897) (Dytiscidae), perhaps of H. cordaticollis (Reitter). It occurred to
him at that time that these beetles could easily be mistaken for amphizoids
and, further, that Palaearctic records for the latter family could actually be
based on specimens of this dytiscid taxon.
We became aware of our parellel studies in early 1980 and immediately
began collaborative work. We first obtained material identified as Hydro¬
nehrius cordaticollis (Reitter) from the British Museum (Natural History)
(BMNH), London, compared same with the A. kashmirensis paratypes, and
found all to be similar in almost every detail. A key character in recognition
of Hydronehrius members is the absence of the short row of setae found on
the ventral posteroapical angle of the hind femur in Agabini (Brinck, 1948);
A. kashmirensis paratypes also lack this setal row.
At that point, the identify of A. kashmirensis appeared to be established
(pending review of H. cordaticollis type material). However, two important
papers have subsequently come to our attention which confound the issue
at present. Vazirani (1970) described a second species of Hydronehrius, H.
guignoti (from Kashmir), and illustrated pronotal silhouettes and aedeagi
for members of both this species and H. cordaticollis. A third species,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
271
Hydronebrius mattheyi (from Pakistan) was described by Brancucci (1980)
whose illustrations of pronota and aedeagi for all three Hydronebrius
species agree well with those of Vazirani (1970). Our comparisons of ma¬
terial at hand with these illustrations of pronota and original descriptions
suggest the following: (1) Amphizoa kashmirensis Vazirani (1964) and Hy¬
dronebrius guignoti Vazirani (1970) appear to be synonymous, in which
event the former name has priority and the valid name for the taxon would
be Hydronebrius kashmirensis (Vazirani). (2) Specimens from CNC appear
to be members of H. guignoti rather than H. cordaticollis . (3) Specimens
from BMNH identified as H. cordaticollis appear to be members of H.
mattheyi. (4) We have not yet seen specimens of H. cordaticollis.
We admit that our comparisons have been severely limited because we
have not yet studied males of A. kashmirensis nor type specimens of any
of the three Hydronebrius taxa. Present ambiguities are no doubt due, at
least in part, to a willingness among past workers to describe new taxa
based on too few specimens and/or without reference to type specimens of
previously describe taxa. We therefore refrain from making any formal iden¬
tifications or designations of synonymy at this time, pending a more com¬
plete review of genus Hydronebrius, especially type material. We have no
doubt, however, that A. kashmirensis is a dytiscid rather than amphizoid
and, further, that it belongs in genus Hydronebrius Jakovlev.
Our findings certainly weaken the case for occurrence of Amphizoidae in
the Himalayan region; but in the absence of type material for Amphizoa
davidi and, hence, certainty as to its identity, the question can not yet be
resolved.
Acknowledgments
We thank M. E. Bacchus (BMNH), K. Rai (ZSI), and A. Smetana (CNC)
for the loan of critical material in their care, H. B. Leech for his review of
the material and helpful comments, and G. E. Ball for his efforts to locate
the type specimen(s) of Amphizoa davidi in MHNP.
Literature Cited
Brancucci, M. 1980 (1979). Espece et sous-espece nouvelles du genre Hydronebrius Jakovlev
1897 de l’Himalaya (Insecta: Coleoptera: Dystiscidae). Senckenbergiana Biol., 60:171-
174.
Brinck, P. 1948. Coleoptera of Tristan da Cunha. Results of the Norwegian Scientific Expe¬
dition to Tristan da Cunha 1937-1938, No. 17. A. W. Brpggers, Oslo, 121 pp.
Edwards, J. G. 1951 (1950). Amphizoidae (Coleoptera) of the World. Wasmann J. Biol., 8:
303-332.
Horn, G. H. 1881. On the genera of Carabidae with special reference to the fauna of Boreal
America. Trans. Amer. Entomol. Soc., 10:91-196.
Jakovlev, A. 1897. Dytiscidarum novorum diagnoses. L’Abeille, 29:37-41.
272
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Kavanaugh, D. H. 1980. On type specimens of Amphizoa LeConte (Coleoptera: Amphizoidae).
Pan-Pacific Entomol., 56:289-292.
LeConte, J. L. 1853. Descriptions of twenty new species of Coleoptera inhabiting the United
States. Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci. Philadelphia, 6:226-235.
Lucas, H. 1882. Description d’une espece nouvelle du genre Amphizoa. Bull. Soc. Entomol.
France, Series 2, 21:157-158.
Regimbart, M. 1899. Revision des Dytiscidae de la region indo-sino-malaise. Ann. Soc. Ento¬
mol. France, 68:186-367.
Reitter, E. 1896. Abbildungen mit Beschreibungen zehn neuer Coleopteren aus der palaearc-
tischen Fauna. Weiner Entomol. Zeit., 15:233-240, PI. III.
Vazirani, T. G. 1964. On a new species of aquatic beetle of the genus Amphizoa LeConte,
1853 [Insecta: Coleoptera: Amphizoidae] from Kashmir, India. Proc. Zool. Soc., Cal¬
cutta, 17:145-147.
Vazirani, T. G. 1970. Contributions to the study of aquatic beetles (Coleoptera) VII. A revision
of Indian Colymbetinae (Dytiscidae). Oriental Insects, 4:303-362.
Zaitsev, F. A. 1953. Fauna of the U.S.S.R. Coleoptera, Volume 4. Families Amphizoidae,
Hygrobiidae, Haliplidae, Dytiscidae, Gyrinidae. English Translation (1972), Israel Pro¬
gram for Scientific Translations, Jerusalem, iii + 401 pp.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 273-285
TRACHYPACHIDAE AND HYDRADEPHAGA (COLEOPTERA):
A MONOPHYLETIC UNIT?1
Robert E. Roughley
Dept. Entomology, Univ. Alberta, Edmonton, Alberta T6G 2E3, Canada
Members of Trachypachus represent an extremely interesting phyloge¬
netic relic taxon, probably derived from near the branching point of Cara-
boidea and Dytiscoidea (Bell, 1966; Evans, 1977). Most investigations of
the phylogenetic position of Trachypachus have been done by morpholo¬
gists and/or carabidologists. The purposes of this paper are to: 1. bring this
taxn to the attention of hydradephagan workers and to call for their views,
2. summarize the contributions of these workers, 3. point out some of the
problem areas in hydradephagan phylogeny, 4. test the presumption that
Trachypachidae belongs with Hydradephaga, and 5. re-evaluate the mono-
phyly of Hydradephaga itself.
My working hypothesis is that the suborder Adephaga comprises two
monophyletic lineages: Caraboidea and Dytiscoidea, the latter including
Trachypachidae and Hydradephaga. Trachypachids have traditionally been
placed within Carabidae, at the tribal level, on the basis of possession of
tibial antennal cleaner, carabiform adult and larval habitus and terrestrial
life style. Trachypachidae contains two genera: Trachypachus and Systo-
losomus, together including six extant species. Trachypachidae were first
recognized to be of importance to discussions of hydradephagan evolution
by Crowson (1955) who elevated the tribe to family status. Specimens of
Systolosomus are not common in collections and none were examined dur¬
ing this study. Sharp (1882) and Hammond (1979) described structural de¬
tails of Systolosomus and concurred with other authors that these two gen¬
era are closely related. Hydradephaga presently includes Amphizoidae,
Hygrobiidae, Haliplidae, Noteridae, Dytiscidae and Gyrinidae.
Cladistic methods were used. For an explanation of this technique see
Hennig (1966) and Kavanaugh (1972, 1978) and the references cited therein.
Polarity of characters was determined by comparison to character states
found in presumed sister groups. Dytiscoidea and Caraboidea are almost
certainly sister groups with Dytiscoidea being derived from an ancestor
which probably would be placed within the division Isochaeta of Carabidae
(Bell, 1966). For Dytiscoidea, characters are polarized from plesiotypic
states exhibited by members of Caraboidea.
This analysis would be strengthened if character states for the primitive
sister group of Adephaga could be determined. Unfortunately this taxon is
274
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
probably something other than an extant member of Coleoptera and perhaps
is best represented by members of the extinct suborder Protocoleoptera
{sensu Crowson, 1975), known only from fossils of Lower Permian age.
Crowson (1975) listed the character states known for this group. The extant
group nearest to the ancestor of Adephaga are probably Megaloptera (Crow¬
son, 1975).
Discussion of Characters
The best treatment of imaginal structure of Hydradephaga remains
Sharp’s (1882, pp. 190-257) analysis of “Dytiscidae.” Sharp’s concept of
Dytiscidae includes the currently accepted families Amphizoidae, Hygro-
biidae, Noteridae and Dytiscidae s. str. Throughout his discussion Sharp
compared dytiscids to carabids and haliplids in sufficient detail to provide
good structural knowledge of most of Dytiscoidea. This account should be
supplemented by Hatch’s (1926) work on gyrinid structure. Sharp (1882, pp.
967-972) also analyzed similarities and differences in character states be¬
tween Carabidae and Dytiscidae sensu Sharp, some of which were missed
by later authors.
The following discussion is restricted to those characters in which the
majority of Dytiscoidea exhibit the apotypic states. Distribution of character
states among various groups of Adephaga is shown in Table 1.
Character 1. Antennal pubescence. Antennae of all adult hydradephagans
are glabrous or almost glabrous. The apex of each antennomere of adult
Trachypachus does have setae, but antennomeres I-X lack the close set
pubescence common in adult Caraboidea (Bell, 1966; Hammond, 1979;
Sharp, 1882). However, antennomere XI does have a small area of pubes¬
cence. A similar condition was found in adult members of some Pseudo-
morphini and Scaritini (Sharp, 1882) and in Gehrinigiini (Bell, 1966) of Ca¬
rabidae. This is a weak synapomorphy because it is a loss state (Hecht and
Edwards, 1976).
Character 2. Prostemal process. Characteristic of adults of Dytiscoidea
is an elongate, well-developed prosternal process (Sharp, 1882), although it
is somewhat less well-developed in gyrinids (Hatch, 1926). Members of
Protocoleoptera and most Caraboidea do not have the prosternal process as
well-developed as in Dytiscoidea (Crowson, 1975; Sharp, 1882). Possible
reasons for increased importance of the prostemal process may be inferred
from an ecological and structural perspective. Concomitant with an increase
in body streamlining is a decrease in size of the prosternum (Nachtigall,
1974). This has resulted in a decrease in ventral contact of procoxae with
the prosternum but is compensated for by an increase in dorsal contact to
produce articulation around a wheel-like rim (Evans, 1977). The prosternal
process forms a strong union between the prothorax and the remainder of
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
275
the sternum. The benefits of such a union are a major increase in structural
integrity and protection of this major and potentially vulnerable body joint
by thick cuticle (Hlavac, 1972). The latter would be very important to hy-
dradephagan beetles which respire at the water surface and thereby expose
their venters to attack by predators. A well-developed prostemal process
is also found in adults of the carabid genera Omophron (Omophronini) and
Cyclosomus (Masoreini) (Sharp, 1882).
Character 3. Open procoxal cavities with post-coxal bridge. All adult
Dytiscoidea, in which this character has been investigated possess open
procoxal cavities and a post-coxal bridge formed by extension of the pro¬
sternum and proepimeron (Bell, 1965, 1966, 1967; Baehr 1979). This con¬
dition is distinct from closed procoxal cavities in which a coxal bar is present
(Bell, 1966, 1967). It is also found in adult members of Carabus (Carabini),
Hiletus (Hiletini) and Leistus (Nebriini) of Carabidae (Hlavac, 1975).
Characters 2 and 3 could form a functional complex in that a change in
the prosternal process could be correlated with a change in the type of
procoxal cavity. If this can be demonstrated then Characters 2 and 3 should
be treated as a single character.
Character 4. Prostemal-metastemal contact. Contact of the prostemal
process with the metastemum is common to most Hydradephaga and there
is no such contact in adult Protocoleoptera and most Caraboidea (Crowson,
1975; Sharp, 1882). Prostemal-metasternal contact is possible because the
mesostemum is shortened and occupies an almost vertical rather than a
horizontal plane. The cavity thus formed conceals the pro thoracic legs of
larger dytiscids during swimming — a hydrodynamic co-adaptation (Nachti-
gall, 1974). Smaller dytiscids use all three pairs of legs for locomotion (Nach-
tigall, 1974), and in some groups ( i.e . some Bidessini and Vatellini of Hy-
droporinae) prosternal-metasternal contact appears to be secondarily lost.
Adult Trachypachus also have shortened mesosterna, but they are not as
vertical as in most Hydradephaga. Actual contact of the prostemal process
with the metasternum can be attained only by maximum deflection of head
and prothorax. The question is whether this is due to resumption of a more
typically caraboid (i.e. terrestrial) life style or whether it represents a truly
primitive step in the evolution of the character. Within Carabidae, only adult
Cyclosomus (Masoreini) have prosternal-metasternal contact.
Adult member of Gyrinidae have the prosternum contacting the meso-
sternum (Sharp, 1882; Hatch, 1926). In gyrinids, the mesosternum is hori¬
zontal rather than vertical. Therefore, streamlining has taken a different
form in response to life on the water surface habitats rather than the sub¬
surface habitats of other Hydradephaga. Flexibility of the prostemal joint
would be important to life on the water surface. As well, a near vertical
mesosternum in gyrinids would represent an extreme, antistreamlined con-
276
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
dition (Nachtigall, 1974). Possession of the plesiotypic state by adult hali-
plids remains unexplained.
Character 5. Metacoxal cavities of interrupted type. All adult dytiscoids
have metacoxae which are extended laterally to reach the elytral epipleura,
i.e. metacoxal cavities of the interrupted type (Bell, 1965, 1966, 1967). Mem¬
bers of Gehringiini and Rhysodini of Carabidae also possess this character
state, although they are believed to have achieved it independently (Bell,
1967). Most adult Caraboidea and Protocoleoptera have uninterrupted coxal
cavities (Bell, 1967; Crowson, 1975).
Character 6. Metacoxal fusion. In trachypachids and hydradephaga the
metacoxae are fused medially, the fusion being marked by a single internal
intercoxal septum continuous with the metafurca and the median sternal
ridge (Evans, 1977). This metacoxal immobilization of Dytiscoidea is un¬
doubtedly related to their aquatic existence. The metasternum and meta¬
coxae function as a single sclerite and great expansion of the metacoxae is
coincident with expansion of coxal swimming muscles (Evans, 1977). Ad¬
aptation to aquatic existence has allowed a change in function of metacoxae
from femoral counter-rotation in the wedge-pushing movement of Caraboi¬
dea to the propulsion movement of Dytiscoidea (Evans, 1977). It is inter¬
esting to note that Evans (1977) believes that metacoxal immobilization has
been achieved in a different manner among members of Haliplidae than by
other members of Dytiscoidea.
Character 7. Setal patch of flight wings. Micro trichia of the metathoracic
wings of some Dytiscoidea are organized into a distinct setal patch just
posterior to vein C112 near the wing margin (Ward, 1979). This setal patch
acts as a mechanism for binding the flight wings against a roughened area
on the underside of the elytra and together they function in wing-folding
(Hammond, 1979). Among adult Adephaga the setal patch is found in tra¬
chypachids, amphizoids, most dytiscids and most noterids (Hammond,
1979; Ward, 1979). It has presumably been secondarily lost in certain genera
among Bidessini, Hydrovatini and Hyphydrini (Hydroporinae: Dytiscidae),
whose adults are quite small, and within some members of Notomicrini and
Noterini of Noteridae (Hammond, 1979).
Character 8. Giardina body. Within the ovaries of some female dytiscoid
beetles, development of oogonia is similar to that of most insects having
polytrophic ovarioles up until the preoocyte stage of oogenesis. At this stage
an extrachromosomal Giardina body appears. The accepted role for the
Giardina body is that the extrachromosomal DNA which it contains is the
nucleolus organizing region of the genome responsible for synthesis of ri-
bosomal RNA (Urbani, 1969).
In insects, Giardina bodies are known only in females of Acheta (Gryl-
lidae: Orthoptera), Tipula (Tipulidae: Diptera) and Dytiscoidea (Urbani
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
277
1969). The Giardina bodies appear to be of a different type in Dytiscoidea
than in other insects. Too little study has been devoted to the distribution
of this character within Dytiscoidea and closely related groups for its real
value as a synapomorphy to be ascertained. It is known from representatives
of Gyrinidae, Hygrobiidae, Colymbetinae and Laccophilinae (Dytiscidae).
Among investigated Dytiscinae (Dytiscidae) it is absent in members of Er-
etes (Eretini) and Cybister (Cybistrini) but present in members of Hydaticus
(Hydaticini), Acilius (Thermonectini) and Dytiscus (Dytiscini). It was not
found in the single member of Hydroporinae studied (Urbani, 1969), and
there is no information about Trachypachidae, Amphizoidae, Haliplidae and
Noteridae.
Character 9. Size and armature of internal sac. The great majority of
male caraboids have, within the median lobe of the aedeagus, a well-devel¬
oped internal sac equipped with setae and spines known as armature (Jean-
nel, 1955). Male dytiscoids have the internal sac greatly reduced or absent
and I have not seen any published reports of armature within the internal
sac. The character states of members of Protocoleoptera is unknown, but
I have interpreted the dytiscoid state as apomorphic. The problems of in¬
terpreting this character have to do with reduction and character polarity.
Character states exhibited by dytiscoids could be: derived once and indicate
monophyly; achieved independently through reduction from the caraboid
state and give a false impression of monophyly; or, they could be the prim¬
itive form of the character with the caraboid type being derived, in which
case, it would be invalid to use for monophyly.
Character 10. Dilator muscle of vagina. Adult female Dytiscoidea possess
a muscle which originates on the upper surface of the vulvar sclerite and
inserts dorsolaterally on the vagina, termed dilator of the vagina by Bur-
meister (1976). This muscle was absent from all caraboids examined by
Burmeister and appears to have been secondarily lost from some members
of Bidessini and Hydroporini (Hydroporinae: Dytiscidae).
Analysis of Distribution of Characters
Trachypachids possess nine of 10 synapomorphies with Hydradephaga,
and the tenth has not been investigated within this group. Amphizoids,
hygrobiids, noterids, gyrinids and the dytiscid subfamilies Laccophilinae,
Colymbetinae and Dytiscinae each have a majority of apomorphic states.
One difficulty affecting deduction of relationships among Adephaga is the
age of the groups. Division into Caraboidea and Dytiscoidea (Geadephaga
and Hydradephaga) was probably complete by the end of the Triassic period
and most extant families were present before the end of the Jurassic (Crow-
son, 1975). The great age of these two superfamilies greatly increases the
chances of evolutionary change, specialization and modification which could
Table 1. Characters, character states and their distribution among family-level taxa of Adephaga. Only those used in phylogenetic analysis
of the monophyly of Dytiscoidea are included. Character polarity is based on ex-group comparison to Protocoleoptera and Caraboidea.
Dytiscoidea
Hydradephaga
278 PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 1. Continued.
Dytiscoidea
Hydradephaga
<D
Total
+9 +9 +10 +9 +8 +8 +6 (+) 12
-0 -0 -4 -1 -1 -2 -2 (-) 12
to
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
280
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
obscure phyletic relationship. Therefore, it is not surprising that carabids
have gained some apotypic states similar to those of Dytiscoidea. The im¬
portant aspect is that no group of carabids has gained more than two apo¬
typic states of the characters included in Table 1.
Dytiscoidea and Caraboidea have undergone different rates of adaptive
radiation as indicated by their diversity. Trachypachidae, Amphizoidae and
Hygrobiidae are groups with less than 10 described, extant species. Gy-
rinidae ( ca . 700 spp.), Noteridae (ca. 150 spp.), Haliplidae ( ca . 200 spp.)
and Dytiscidae ( ca . 4,000 spp.) (Britton, 1970) are much more diverse but
are still quite a bit less than Carabidae with about 40,000 species (Thiele,
1977). Species diversity is derived by periodic radiation of species known
as taxon pulses (Erwin, 1979). Caraboidea have undergone taxon pulses as
recently as the Quaternary (Erwin, 1979). In Dytiscoidea, while we lack
overall resolution of similar scale, there is no evidence to suggest the action
of recent taxon pulses except among a few, widely separated tribes and
genera. Presumably extensive, older radiations have taken place such that,
with subsequent extinctions, Dytiscoidea is presently comprised of evolu-
tionarily disjunct sets of taxa. This can also obscure phyletic relationship.
At this point we need to examine the classification of Adephaga. Gener¬
ally, land-dwelling Adaphaga were placed in Caraboidea and aquatic Ade¬
phaga were assigned to Dytiscoidea. Therefore, until recently, higher taxa
were based on features concerned with way of life. Groups were assigned
to families on the basis of similarity of phenotype and assignment of family
rank was based on ‘appropriate’ amounts of dissimilarity (see Ball, 1979 for
a general history of classification of caraboids). This same pattern runs
throughout the classification of Dytiscoidea. This system may have led to
formation of polyphyletic groups. The first major attempt to demonstrate
the naturalness of Hydradephaga (as Dytiscidae and excluding Gyrinidae
and Haliplidae) is that of Sharp (1882) and his conclusions were that:
“. . . although several pecularities may be pointed out as being especially
characteristic of the Dytiscidae, yet all of them when taken seriatim dis¬
appear within the bounds of the family or are found in one or more mem¬
bers of the Carabidae.” (Sharp, 1882, p. 967).
Probably the single greatest difficulty in any attempt to establish mono-
phyly is to separate characters which have evolved in parallel as a result of
adaptation to aquatic habitats (Bell, 1966) — phenetic similarity — from those
which show evolutionary relationship. There are at least two methods by
which this distinction can be made. First, is the demonstration of a few,
well-founded and well-understood synapomorphies not related to aquatic
existence. This would seem to be the preferred method (Hecht and Ed¬
wards, 1976). However, this is not yet possible because we lack knowledge
of the functional importance of characters in relation to aquatic habitats. A
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
281
second tactic is to tabulate a number of characters which, in total, are highly
suggestive of monophyly. The supposition of this approach is that the
chances of 10 different characters attaining the exact same state in different
groups are very low.
It must be understood that the 10 characters in Table 1 are not of equal
value. For instance, fusion of the metacoxae (character 6) is probably the
best character. Other characters are of lesser value for different reasons,
for example, the distribution of the Giardina bodies (character 8) among
Coleoptera is too poorly known. Also, characters 1 to 5 are related to an
aquatic mode of life (see Discussion of Characters). One way to establish
their use as synapomorphies is to examine the character states found in
other groups of aquatic beetles outside the Hydradephaga. This analogy will
establish whether or not the character states of Dytiscoidea are common
aquatic adaptations of beetles, or, whether they may be used as phylogenetic
indicators.
The group of beetles best suited for comparison with dytiscoids are aquat¬
ic members of the superfamily Hydrophiloidea because of their occurrence
in similar habitats to, and their general behavioral similarity to Hydrade¬
phaga. Members of the superfamily Dryopoidea and the suborder Myxo-
phaga can also be used, but only to a limited extent because the adaptive
zone of these groups is quite different (mainly bottom dwellers with plastron
respiration). For Character 1, the majority of adults of all three groups have
at least some antennomeres with close set pubescence (Britton, 1970; Rei-
chardt, 1973). As well, a few carabids such as Carabus clathratus L. have
attained an aquatic lifestyle (Thiele, 1977) yet the antennomeres are pubes¬
cent. Therefore, a complete lack of antennal pubescence is not necessarily
correlated with aquatic life. Different strategies are employed by these three
analogous groups (Hydrophiloidea, Dryopoidea, and Myxophaga) with re¬
spect to each of characters 2 to 5. While each of these character states
shown by dytiscoids is an aquatic adaptation, they are not the only character
states which could be derived in conjunction with aquatic life. Each group
has responded to the same situation in a different manner. Therefore, I think
they can be used as a basis for inferring monophyly, providing that they are
found to be achieved in the identical manner.
Analysis of Table 1 reveals that trachypachids are more similar to Hy¬
dradephaga, in the apomorphic states of the characters used, than they are
to Carabidae, where they have been placed traditionally. Trachypachids
possess nine of a possible 10 derived states and the tenth has not been
investigated within the group. They show a striking affinity to a group of
families including Amphizoidae, Dytiscidae, Noteridae and Hygrobiidae
(Fig. 1). Therefore, the original question is only partly answered — Trachy-
pachidae and at least part of Hydradephaga form a natural evolutionary
282
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Trachypachidae
Amphizoidae
Dytiscidae
Hygrobiidae
CARABOIDEA
Noteridae
Gyrinidae
Fig. 1. Schematic representation of the proposed relationships of Adephaga.
unit. This qualified statement, however, leads to another question — are the
Hydradephaga monophyletic?
The characters presented here are insufficient to arrive at a definitive
conclusion but they are suggestive of areas where intensive investigation
will be helpful. For instance, eight of 12 supposedly independent character
losses within family-level taxa of Dytiscoidea occur in a single subfamily
(Hydroporinae) of Dytiscidae. Some of these exceptions are probably ex¬
plained by the small physical size of these beetles (less than 6 mm, Sharp,
1882), but members of Notomicrini and particularly members of Notomicrus
(1.0 to 1.6 mm, Young, 1978) are among the smallest of Dytiscoidea and yet
they are not nearly (one of 12) as autapomorphic. Thus Hydroporinae may
not belong with the remainder of dytiscids. If the present classification is to
be retained, they must be demonstrated to be closer to other subfamilies of
Dytiscidae than to any other group of Dytiscoidea. It is important to note
that Burmeister (1976) could find no synapomorphies between female Hy¬
droporinae and the remainder of Dytiscidae, in his study of ovipositor mus¬
culature. In addition, Burmeister (1976) could not define a systematic po¬
sition for Notomicrus even though he was convinced that it was not a
member of Noteridae.
Haliplidae have only six of 10 synapomorphies with other Dytiscoidea
(Table 1) and all but two (Character 1, 2, 3 and 6) are possibly associated
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
283
with adaptation to aquatic life. Further, Evans (1977) demonstrated that the
metacoxal plates (Character 6) were derived in a manner quite unlike that
of other members of Dytiscoidea (see also Sharp, 1882, p. 972). Adults of
Omophron (Omophronini: Carabidae) have a resemblance in the type of peg
and socket mesocoxal articulation (Evans, 1977). However, Burmeister
(1976) indicated three synapomorphies between female haliplids, gyrinids
and Noterus and another six between haliplids and Noterus. The position
of Gyrinidae must be similarly re-analyzed. The relationships of Dytiscoidea
inferred from the characters used in this analysis are shown in Fig. 1 .
It should be clear from these few examples that we need more characters,
as well as a greater understanding of their functional significance before we
can test our existing schemes of classification within Dytiscoidea. This
search should be carried out at all levels within the hierarchies of Adephaga.
After all, the positioning and rearrangement of higher taxa is only an exten¬
sion of a systematises desire to classify species. From an optimistic view¬
point, the beetles have the characters and now all we have to do is go and
find them.
One critical question concerning trachypachids remains to be answered.
If they are indeed related to Hydradephaga then why do the extant members
live in xeric terrestrial habitats (Evans, 1977)? My evolutionary hypothesis
is similar to that of Evans (1977), and would have primitive trachypachids
in aquatic situations analogous to those in which Carabus clathratus occurs
(see Thiele, 1977). Subsequent taxon pulses of trachypachids could have
given rise to some terrestrial members. As Hydradephaga arose and diver¬
sified they replaced the aquatic or semi-aquatic trachypachids, and the ter¬
restrial Trachypachidae are all that remain.
Acknowledgments
My colleagues at the University of Alberta have provided constant sup¬
port and encouragement. I would like to thank J. S. Ashe, J. M. Cumming,
G. A. P. Gibson, E. Maw and Drs. B. S. Hemming and G. E. Ball as well
as Dr. R. T. Bell, Univ. of Vermont, for their helpful comments on earlier
drafts of this paper. Drs. G. E. Ball, Univ. of Alberta and F. N. Young,
Univ. of Indiana, Bloomington loaned or made a gift of specimens used to
confirm characters used in this study. Dr. G. W. Wolfe of Rutgers Univer¬
sity provided part of the inspiration and encouragement needed to complete
this paper. Financial support was provided by an NSERC Grant (#A1399)
held by G. E. Ball.
Literature Cited
Baehr, M. 1979. Vergleichends Untersuchungen am Skelett und an der Coxalmuskulatur des
Prothorax der Coleoptera. Ein Beitrag zur Klarung der phylogenetischen Beziehungen
der Adephaga (Coleoptera, Insecta). Zoologica, 44:1-76.
284
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Balfour-Browne, F. 1940. British water beetles. Vol. I. Ray Society, London, xx + 375 pp.
Ball, G. E. 1979. Conspectus of carabid classification: History, holomorphology, and higher
taxa. pp. 63-111. In: Erwin, T. L., G. E. Ball, D. R. Whitehead and A. L. Halpem.
Eds. Carabid beetles: their evolution, natural history, and classification. Dr. W. Junk,
The Hague, 635 pp.
Bell, R. T. 1965. Coxal cavities and the phylogeny of the Adephaga. Proc. XII Int. Congr.
Entomol., 80-81.
Bell, R. T. 1966. Trachypachus and the origin of the Hydradephaga (Coleoptera). Coleop.
Bull., 20:107-112.
Bell, R. T. 1967. Coxal cavities and the classification of the Adephaga (Coleoptera). Ann.
Entomol. Soc. Amer., 60:101-107.
Britton, E. B. 1970. Ch. 30. Coleoptera (Beetles), pp. 495-621. In: The insects of Australia.
Univ. of Melbourne Press, xiii + 1029 pp.
Burmeister, E-G. 1976. Der ovipositor der Hydradephaga (Coleoptera) und seine phyloge-
netische Bedeutung unter besonderer Beriicksichtung der Dytiscidae. Zoomorph.,
85:165-257.
Crowson, R. A. 1955. The natural classification of the families of Coleoptera. Nathaniel Lloyd
& Co., London, 187 pp.
Crowson, R. A. 1975. The evolutionary history of Coleoptera, as documented by fossil and
comparative evidence. Atti X Congr. Naz. Ital. Entomol., 47-90.
Erwin, T. L. 1979. Thoughts on the evolutionary history of Ground Beetles: hypotheses
generated from comparative faunal analysis of lowland forest sites in temperate and
tropical regions, pp. 539-592. In: Erwin, T. L., G. E. Ball, D. R. Whitehead and A. L.
Halpem. Eds. Carabid beetles: their evolution, natural history, and classification. Dr.
W. Junk, The Hague, 635 pp.
Evans, M. E. G. 1977. Locomotion in the Coleoptera Adephaga, especially Carabidae. J.
Zool., London, 181:189-226.
Hammond, P. M. 1979. Wing-folding mechanisms of beetles, with special reference to Ade-
phagan phylogeny. pp. 113-180. In: Erwin, T. L., G. E. Ball, D. R. Whitehead and A.
L. Halpem. Eds. Carabid beetles: their evolution, natural history, and classification.
Dr. W. Junk, The Hague, 635 pp.
Hatch, M. H. 1926. The morphology of Gyrinidae. Pap. Mich. Acad. Sci. Arts Lett., 7:311—
350.
Hecht, M. K., and J. L. Edwards. 1976. The methodology of phylogenetic inference above
the species level, pp. 3-51. In: Hecht, M. K., P. C. Goody and B. M. Hecht. Eds.
Major patterns in Vertebrate evolution. NATO Advanced Study Institute Series. Series
A, Life Sciences, 14; ix + 908 pp. Plenum Press, New York.
Hennig, W. 1966. Phylogenetic systematics. Univ. of Illinois Press, Urbana. 263 pp.
Hlavac, T. F. 1972. The prothorax of Coleoptera: origin, major features of variation. Psyche,
79:123-149.
Hlavac, T. F. 1975. The prothorax of Coleoptera (Except Bostrychiformia-Cucujiformia).
Bull. Mus. Comp. Zool., 147:137-183.
Jeannel, R. 1955. L’edeage, initiation aux recherches sur la systematique des Coleopteres.
Publ. Mus. Natl. Hist. Nat., 16:155 pp.
Kavanaugh, D. H. 1972. Hennig’s principles and methods of phylogenetic systematics. The
Biologist, 54:115-127.
Kavanaugh, D. H. 1978. Ch. 8. Hennigian phylogenetics in contemporary systematics: prin¬
ciples, methods, and uses. pp. 139-150. In: Beltsville symposia in agricultural research,
2. Biosystematics in Agriculture. Halstead Press, New York, xii + 340 pp.
Nachtigall, W. 1974. Mechanics and hydrodynamics of swimming in aquatic insects, pp. 381—
432. In: Rockstein, M. Ed. The physiology of Insecta, 2nd ed., xviii + 517 pp. Academic
Press, New York.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
285
Reichardt, H. 1973. A critical study of the suborder Myxophaga, with a taxonomic revision
of the Brazilian Torridincolidae and Hydroscaphidae (Coleoptera). Arq. Zool., Sao Pau¬
lo, 24:73-162.
Sharp, D. 1882. On aquatic carnivorous Coleoptera or Dytiscidae. Scient. Trans. R. Dublin
Soc., Ser. II, 2:179-1003.
Thiele, H-U. 1977. Carabid beetles in their environments. A study on habitat selection by
adaptations in physiology and behaviour. Zoophsiology and Ecology, vol. 10, xviii +
372. Springer- Verlag, New York.
Urbani, E. 1969. Cytochemical and ultrastructural studies of oogenesis in the Dytiscidae.
Monitore Zool. Ital., 3:55-87.
Ward, R. D. 1979. Metathoracic wing structures as phylogenetic indicators in the Adephaga
(Coleoptera). pp. 181-192. In: Erwin, T. L., G. E. Ball, D. R. Whitehead and A. L.
Halpem. Eds. Carabid beetles: their evolution, natural history, and classification. Dr.
W. Junk, The Hague, 635 pp.
Young, F. N. 1978. The New World species of the water-beetle genus Notomicrus (Noteri-
dae). Syst. Entomol., 3:285-293.
Footnote
1 Part 1 of A Phylogenetic Classification of Dytiscoidea (Coleoptera).
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 286-294
PAGELMIS AMAZONICA , A NEW GENUS AND SPECIES OF
WATER BEETLE FROM ECUADOR
(COLEOPTERA: ELMIDAE)
Paul J. Spangler
Dept, of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution,
Washington, D. C. 20560
The new genus of riffle beetle described here was found among the very
rich and interesting collections of aquatic insects made during the Ecuador-
Peace Corps-Smithsonian Institution Aquatic Insect Survey of Ecuador that
was conducted from 1975 through 1979. Specimens of this new genus were
very abundant in catches in blacklight traps. The large number of specimens
(6,000+) and the unusual and extensive plastron drew attention to this beetle
and resulted in its description here. All specimens I have seen of this
species — except for parts of the legs, head and its appendages, and a narrow
area on the pronotum and on the elytra — are covered with a plastron. Other
elmids, with few exceptions, have a plastron restricted to the ventral sur¬
faces. Scanning electron micrographs provided visual evidence of the struc¬
ture of the plastron of this new taxon and suggested a possible manner by
which the plastron may be formed; following the descriptions of the new
taxa, the plastron and other features of the cuticular ultrasculpture are dis¬
cussed.
Pagelmis, new genus
Body elongate, subparallel, and moderately convex (Fig. 1). Integument
with an opaque plastron which apparently covers body except head, eyes,
antennae, mouthparts, middle of me so sternum, metasternum between mid¬
dle coxae, a narrow medial area on basal two-thirds (Fig. 2) of pronotum,
scutellum, and a band four times wider at base than at apex and paral¬
leling elytral suture (Fig. 1).
Head when seen from below partly retracted into pronotum; dorsal sur¬
face partially hidden by anterior prolongation of pronotum. Mouthparts vis¬
ible. Maxillary palpus 4 segmented. Labial palpus 3 segmented. Antenna 11
segmented, arising beside inner edge of eye and separated from clypeus by
a deep transverse groove. Labrum rather broad and transversely rectan¬
gular.
Pronotum (Fig. 2) widest at basal one-third then narrowing anteriorly,
becoming evenly arcuate over head, rimmed apicomedially, also narrow-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
287
ingly slightly posterolaterally; posterolateral angles moderately acute; pos¬
terior margin bisinuate; carinae absent. Elytra with first row of punctures
distinct, laterally other rows become increasingly effaced; carinae absent;
humeri slightly swollen. Prosternum long in front of forecoxae; prostemal
process slender, moderately elongate (Fig. 5), parallel sided and bordered
by a distinct rim, apex bluntly rounded. Mesostemum deeply depressed on
midline in front of and between anterior half of mesocoxae for reception of
prostemal process. Metastemum between mesocoxae without opaque plas¬
tron, remainder with opaque plastron; disc with narrow, longitudinal, shal¬
low, posterior depression on midline. Legs with visible portion of front
coxae rounded and trochantin concealed by hypomera. Protibiae, mesoti-
biae, and metatibiae without cleaning fringes. Hind trochanters of male each
with a strong tubercle apicoventrally (Fig. 7). Claws small, slender, without
teeth.
Abdominal sterna 1-5 normally convex and not lobed laterally.
Type-species of the genus. — Pagelmis amazonica, new species.
Etymology. — Pagelmis from pago, G. — frost, in reference to the opaque,
frostlike appearance of the plastron covering much of the pronotum, elytra,
and venter; plus elmis from the nominate genus of the family, Elmis. Gen¬
der: feminine.
Comparative notes. — This new genus, because the dorsal surface of the
integument is mostly opaque as described above, resembles a miniature
Stenhelmoides but may be distinguished by the following combination of
characters: prostemal process parallel sided and narrow, about a third as
wide as long (Fig. 5); hind trochanter of males each with an apicoventral
tubercle (Fig. 7); all tibiae without cleaning fringes (Figs. 7, 8).
Pagelmis amazonica, new species
(Figs. 1-17)
Holotype male. — Form and size. — Body form elongate, subparallel, and
moderately convex (Fig. 1); length 2.2 mm; width 0.8 mm.
Coloration. — Plastron covers integument except those areas listed under
generic description. Also, dorsum with contrasting, shiny, narrow, sinuous,
microalutaceous, longitudinal area on midline of posterior half of pronotum
and a similarly shiny contrasting area on each elytron. Shiny area of elytron
a narrow band across base and a wider band along suture; shiny band nar¬
rows at apical fourth of elytron. Head and pronotum reddish brown but
color obscured by opaque plastron. Pronotum with short, sparse, golden
setae. Elytra reddish brown except each elytron with 1 basal and 1 subapical
dark brown macula; maculae joined by a dark, poorly defined, subsutural
stripe; coloration obscured by plastron. Elytra with short, sparse, golden
setae on indistinct intervals.
288
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 1-6. Pagelmis amazonica, n. gen., n. sp.: Fig. 1, habitus view, 44x. Fig. 2, prono-
tum, 140x. Fig. 3, base of elytron, 220x. Fig. 4, plastron on base of elytron, llOOx. Fig. 5,
prosternum, lOOx. Fig. 6, head, ventral surface, 230x. Photographs reduced Va.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
289
Figs. 7-8. Pagelmis amazonica, n. gen., n. sp.: Fig. 7, hind leg, male, 160x. Fig. 8, hind
leg, female, 160x. Photographs reduced V6.
Head. — Partly retracted into pronotum (Figs. 5, 6). Mouthparts visible.
Maxillary palpus 4 segmented (Fig. 6). Labial palpus 3 segmented. Antenna
11 segmented, arising beside inner edge of eye and separated from clypeus
by a deep transverse groove. Labrum rather broad, transversely rectangu¬
lar, and coarsely punctate.
Thorax. — Pronotum widest at basal third, converging anteriorly and ex¬
tending apicomedially over base of head; narrowing slightly posterolaterally;
sides strongly, evenly arcuate; base shallowly bisinuate; posterolateral an¬
gles moderately acute; integument impunctate but small sparse granules
basally and numerous coarser granules on anterior third; apicomedial margin
arcuate and distinctly rimmed on medial third; carinae absent. Prostemum
with coarse granules; long in front of forecoxae; prostemal process slender,
moderately elongate (Fig. 5), about 3 times as long as wide, parallel sided
and bordered by a distinct rim, apex bluntly rounded. Mesostemum deeply
depressed on midline in front of and between anterior halves of mesocoxae
for reception of prosternal process. Metastemum with opaque plastron ex¬
cept area between mesocoxae without plastron; disc with narrow, longitu¬
dinal, shallow depression posteriorly on midline. Elytron with first (sutural)
row of punctures coarse, punctures separated by 1 to 2 times their width;
other rows of elytral punctures indicated but indistinct, becoming increas¬
ingly effaced laterally. Legs with visible portion of front coxae rounded and
trochantin concealed by hypomera. Protibiae, mesotibiae, and metatibiae
290
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 9-11. Pagelmis amazonia, n. gen., n. sp.: Fig. 9, male genitalia, ventral view. Fig.
10, median lobe, lateral view. Fig. 11, paramere, lateral view.
without cleaning fringes (Figs. 7, 8). Hind trochanter with a strong tubercle
apicoventrally (Fig. 7). Claws small, slender, without teeth (Fig. 7).
Abdomen. — Abdominal sterna 1-5 normally convex and not lobed later¬
ally.
Male genitalia. — As illustrated (Figs. 9-11).
Female. — Similar to male except the tubercles on the hind trochanters
are much smaller than those on the male (Fig. 8).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
291
Variations. — The type-material was obtained from blacklight traps which
typically contain many teneral specimens; many of these specimens are
lightly pigmented and the elytral maculae are indistinct. In the more darkly
pigmented specimens, the prosternum, mesosternum, and metastemum
instead of being uniformly reddish brown, have the discal areas darker
reddish brown. These color differences are more obvious on specimens in
liquid preservatives.
Type-data. — Holotype male and allotype: ECUADOR: Pastaza Province,
Tzapino (1°1TS, 77°14'W) (Tigueno, 32 km northeast), 400 m elev., 22 May
1976, Jeffrey Cohen, Ecuador, Peace Corps, Smithsonian Institution Aquat¬
ic Insect Survey. USNM Type No. 75669, deposited in the National Mu¬
seum of Natural History, Smithsonian Institution. Paratypes: Same data as
holotype, 6,000 specimens; same data as holotype except 24 May 1976, 19
specimens and 25 May 1976, 10 specimens. Napo Province: Limoncocha,
3 June 1977, W. E. Steiner, 24 specimens; Limoncocha, 8 June 1977, W. E.
Steiner, 8 specimens; Limoncocha, 5 June 1977, P. J. Spangler and D. R.
Givens, 11 specimens; Limoncocha, 15 June 1977, P. J. Spangler and D. R.
Givens, 26 specimens; Limoncocha, 16 June 1977, P. J. Spangler and D. R.
Givens, 49 specimens; Puerto Montufar, 26 April 1976, J. Cohen, 6 speci¬
mens.
Paratypes will be deposited in the American Museum of Natural History,
New York; British Museum (Natural History), London; California Academy
of Sciences, San Francisco; Canadian National Collection, Ottawa; Instituto
Lillo, Tucuman; Institut Royal de Histoire Naturelle de Belgique, Bruxelles;
Museum of Comparative Zoology, Cambridge; Museum Nacional de His-
toria Natural de Chile, Santiago; Museum National de Histoire Naturelle,
Paris; Museo Argentina de Ciencias Naturales, Buenos Aires; Zoologische
Sammlung Bayerischen Staates, Miinchen; and the Stovall Museum of Sci¬
ence and History, University of Oklahoma, Norman.
Etymology. — amazonica, in reference to the occurrence of this taxon in
the Amazon River Basin.
Habitat. — Unknown; all material was collected in blacklight traps.
Plastron
Elmid beetles that live in aquatic habitats with a high calcium content
often are found to be heavily coated with calcium carbonate; however, those
coatings occur irregularly on many areas of the body. The glazed, frosted,
or opague areas covering most of the integument of Pagelmis, when ex¬
amined under a stereoscopic microscope, resembled the calcareous coat¬
ings. However, these opaque areas were consistently present in a symmet¬
rical pattern and suggested a non-calcareous cuticular sculpture which
probably was produced when the pupa changed into the adult form. Never-
292
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 12-17. Pagelmis amazonica, n. gen., n. sp.: Fig. 12, plastron (scraped loose) of
abdominal sterna, 600x. Fig. 13, plastron showing plugs from pores in cuticle, 1500x. Fig.
14, plug and plastron texture, 12,500x. Fig. 15, pore, cuticular micro tubercles, and porous
plastron, 6000 x. Fig. 16, cuticular surface of prosternum with broken plastron, 1625 x. Fig.
17, pore and cuticle, enlarged, seen (arrow) in Figure 16, ll,500x. Photographs reduced V6.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
293
theless, I placed some beetles in acetic acid and in a sonic cleaner in an
effort to remove the opaque areas, but neither treatment altered the surface
sculpture. Subsequently, I scratched the opaque area on the abdomen of a
specimen with a pin and then examined the beetle with the scanning electron
microscope.
Instead of a plastron made up of a dense layer of often overlapping scale¬
like setae that I expected to find, and as illustrated for some species in the
elmid genera Austrolimnius , Cylloepus, Elmis, Elsianus, Hexacylloepus,
Limnius, Pilielmis, Portelmis, Stegoelmis, and Tyletelmis by Hinton (1976),
it appeared that the plastron of Pagelmis is similar to the plastron of mem¬
bers of the aquatic weevil genus Neochetina as illustrated and discussed by
Hinton (1976). However, the plastron of Neochetina is divided into porous
scale-like plates supported on microtubercles and the plastron of Pagelmis
is a porous sheetlike layer supported by microtubercles.
By good fortune, pieces of the plastron that I disrupted with the pin were
turned upside down but remained on the specimen examined under the
SEM. From this specimen it is evident that in Pagelmis the true cuticle
(Figs. 3, 12, 13) is relatively smooth and apparently well sclerotized. How¬
ever, pore-like openings (Figs. 12, 13, 15-17) in the cuticle and cast-like
impressions on the lower side of the plastron (Figs. 12-14) suggest that
the plastron (Figs. 13-17) probably resulted from secretions exuded from
the pores; the micrographs also show that the plastron is porous (Figs.
15, 17). The micrographs show that the plastron rests on microtubercles
on the true cuticle and this presumably leaves a thin air space under
the plastron and this air space extends into the porous areas in the
plastron. In addition, the microcarinae (Fig. 17) radiating from the pores
also would support the plastron above the air space.
Because the plastron is distributed more extensively over the ingement,
specimens of Pagelmis presumably have a larger supply of air available for
respiration than do elmids with a reduced plastron. This seems to be an
unusual condition because most elmids of the same small size as Pagelmis
have only a ventral plastron. These small elmids with the smaller, ventral
plastron are known to occur in streams and brooks with high to moderate
oxygen content; but, unfortunately, the habitat of Pagelmis is unknown
because all available specimens came from lighttrap collections. It is pos¬
sible that specimens of Pagelmis occur in slow-moving streams or similar
habitats which may be low in dissolved oxygen. This suggestion is further
supported by the topography and low elevation of the areas from which the
type-material was collected. The meandering streams in those areas gen¬
erally have a low gradient, are more sluggish, and, consequently, contain
less oxygen. Under these conditions it seems reasonable that a more exten¬
sive plastron would be advantageous and may have evolved in Pagelmis.
Specimens described in the genus Stenhelmoides have a similar glazed,
294
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
frosty, or opaque appearance on the venter and extensively on the elytra as
well. Unfortunately the habitat of members of this genus also are unknown,
but they have been collected in the same localities as the type-material of
Pagelmis. The plastron on Stenhelmoides as seen under the SEM after it
has been scraped loose is similar to that illustrated here for Pagelmis ; the
plastron on Stenhelmoides will be discussed in greater detail in a revision
of Stenhelmoides that is in progress.
Acknowledgments
The new taxon described above is one of many new taxa collected during
an aquatic insect survey of Ecuador. The survey was financed, in part, by
the Ecuadorian Ministry of Agriculture, the United States Peace Corps, the
Smithsonian Institution, and the National Geographic Society and I extend
my deep appreciation to them for their assistance.
I thank Andrea Langley- Armstrong, Jeffrey Cohen and Joseph Anderson,
former Peace Corps volunteers, and Warren Steiner and Donald Givens,
Museum Technicians, for their efforts in collecting specimens of this new
taxon and many other insects from Ecuador.
I also thank the following individuals for counsel and logistical support
in Ecuador: Ing. Julio Molineros and Ing. Tomas Guerrero in Quito, Mr.
Joseph Brenner in Puyo, and the staff of the Summer Institute of Linguistics
at Limoncocha.
In addition, I thank Mrs. Elaine Hodges, Smithsonian Institution staff
artist, for preparing the line drawings; and I thank Mrs. Susann Braden,
Smithsonian Institution scanning electron microscopist, for taking the mi¬
crographs for this article.
Literature Cited
Hinton, H. E. 1976. Plastron respiration in bugs and beetles. J. Insect Physiol., 22:1529-1550,
13 figs.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 295-302
HUGHLEECH1A GIULIANII, A NEW GENUS AND NEW SPECIES
OF INTERTIDAL BEETLE FROM AUSTRALIA
(COLEOPTERA: HYDRAENIDAE)
Philip D. Perkins
% Department of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution,
Washington, D.C. 20560
As part of ongoing studies of the Hydraenidae of Australasia, I have
received specimens from the Commonwealth Scientific and Industrial Re¬
search Organization (Canberra) and the Western Australian Museum (Perth)
which represent an interesting new genus and new species of flightless,
intertidal hydraenid, which is herein described as Hughleechia giulianii. All
specimens were collected by Derham D. Giuliani along the south and west
coasts of Australia. Mr. Giuliani comments thusly (in litt.) concerning the
habitats of these beetles: “They occurred in rock crevices covered by high
tides, dry rock crevices in the high tide splash zone, and usually most nu¬
merously in rock pools a few feet above the water line (created by splash
and spray but seldom or never reached by waves). In this latter case they
were found walking around the edge of the pools on the rock just below the
surface, never more than an inch down, often including apparently mating
pairs.” Some were collected near Albany, “in rock pools on cliffs up to at
least 50 feet above the high tide level. Whether these pools were created by
seeps or rain or storm-driven spray I do not know.”
Two other genera of flightless Hydraenidae are specially adapted for
coastal or intertidal existence, Meropathus Enderlein and Neochthebius
d’Orchymont, both of which are members of the subfamily Ochthebiinae
Perkins (1980). Neochthebius includes two species, one inhabits the pacific
coast of North America, the other lives in Japan (Sato, 1963; Perkins, 1980).
These two species are truly intertidal, living in rock crevices below high
tide line. Eight species are currently included in Meropathus : one on the
subantarctic islands of Prince Edward, Kerguelen and Heard (Enderlein,
1901; d’Orchymont, 1938; Jeannel, 1940; Janssens, 1967), three on islands
of the New Zealand subregion (Ordish, 1971), three inland species in eastern
Australia (Janssens, 1967), and one species on the Falkland Islands and Isla
de los Estados at the southern end of South America (Perkins, 1980). Mer¬
opathus species are terrestrial or semi-aquatic, the insular species being
found in bird nests and among stones and grass tussocks in coastal areas
(Ordish, 1971).
296
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Hughleechia giulianii n. g., n. sp.: (a) dorsal view, 45x; (b) head, male, dorsal
view, 185x; (c) head, male, oblique view, 175x; (d) lateral view, 45x; (e) meso- and meta-
stemum, 140x.
Phylogenetic relationships of Hughleechia
In addition to similarities in habitat, the phylogenetic relationship of this
new genus to Meropathus and Neochthebius is clearly indicated by the
fused elytra, reduced metasternum, body form, antennal configuration and
by the short, stiff recumbent elytral setae. It is immediately differentiated
from Meropathus and Neochthebius by the widely spaced meso- and me-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
297
Fig. 2. Hughleechia giulianii n. g., n. sp.: (a) head, ventral aspect, 150x; (b) mentum,
400x; (c) antenna, 250x; (d) basal antennal segments, 950x.
tacoxae (Fig. le) and the unusual aedeagus. In Meropathus and Neochthe-
bius the meso- and metacoxae are nearly contiguous, separated by only a
lamina.
In Meropathus the aedeagus lacks parameres, whereas Neochthebius has
fully developed parameres which originate at the base of the main-piece.
The aedeagus of Hughleechia is a morphocline intermediate, having the
parameres originating at mid-length of the main-piece (Fig. 4c). Elsewhere
(Perkins, 1980) I have discussed possible mechanisms of paramere loss in
the family Hydraenidae, a process which occurs in all major lineages. It
appears that Hughleechia represents an intermediate stage in paramere loss
for the Neochthebius-Hughleechia-Meropathus lineage, and suggests that
loss in this lineage is accomplished by fusion of parameres to the main-
piece, although it is possible that the location of the parameres is a result
298
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 3. Hughleechia giulianii n. g., n. sp.: (a) head, male, anterior view, 165x; (b) clypeus
and labrum, male, 340x; (c) mesotarsus, 240x; (d) metatarsus, 240x; (e) meso-, metasternum
and abdomen, 50x.
of elongation of the main-piece (for a discussion of terminology and other
possible processes in paramere reduction and loss, see Perkins, 1980).
In addition to the widely spaced meso- and metacoxae, Hughleechia dif¬
fers externally from Meropathus and Neochthebius by lacking hydrofuge
pubescence on major portions of the metasternum and abdominal segments
(Figs, le, 3e), and having more elongate tarsi (Figs. 3c, d). The eyes of
Meropathus and Neochthebius are relatively small and separated from the
ocelli. The eyes of Hughleechia are larger and the ocelli are adjacent to the
eyes (Fig. lb).
Hughleechia differs further from certain Meropathus species by lacking
a median sulcus of the metasternum, having elytra devoid of ridges, and
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
299
Fig. 4. Hughleechia giulianii n. g., n. sp.: (a) known geographical distribution; (b) sper-
matheca; (c) aedeagus, dorsal and lateral views.
possessing a well developed antennal fossula of the hypomeron. Males of
Hughleechia giulianii have the labral lobes produced as small, acute, up¬
turned processes and also have an apicomedian upturned process of the
clypeus which is slightly larger than the labral processes (Figs, lb, c, 3b).
Males of some Meropathus species have the labral lobes rather remarkably
produced, but neither Meropathus nor Neochthebius males have a clypeal
process.
Hughleechia, new genus
Type-species. — Hughleechia giulianii, new species.
Gender. — Feminine.
Body form elongate oval, depressed. Head with distinct ocelli next to
protuberant eyes; dorsum of head flat, frons and clypeus in same plane.
Maxillary palpus short, 4-segmented, segment 1 very small, segment 2 sub¬
equal in length to segment 3, segment 3 broader than other segments, seg¬
ment 4 slightly shorter than segment 3. Antenna (Figs. 2c, d) 9-segmented;
2 basal, 1 small intermediate, 1 small cupule, and 5 pubescent segments
300
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
which form a compact club. Pronotum with anterior margin weakly rounded
in middle, posterior margin much more strongly rounded; anterior and pos¬
terior margins with narrow hyaline border, sides lacking hyaline border;
disc with shallow median longitudinal depression which is slightly constrict¬
ed at midlength; lateral fossulae well developed; pronotal surface with mod¬
erately dense and moderately long hairs, except hairs absent in median
depression and in lateral fossulae. Elytra ovoid, fused together at suture
which is weakly elevated; each elytron with 8 rows of punctures, each
puncture with a short, stiff, recumbent seta; rows 6-8 much less distinct
than discal rows, sometimes random. Flight wings absent. Hypomeron with
well developed fossula. Prosternum slightly and evenly elevated in midline,
not carinate; procoxae contiguous. Mesosternum (Fig. le) broad between
mesocoxae, lacking carinae, with hydrofuge pubescence. Metasternum (Fig.
le) reduced, length in midline approximately equal to that of mesosternum;
intercoxal process broad, equal in size to intercoxal process of mesoster¬
num; metacoxae widely separated; hydrofuge pubescence restricted to lat¬
eral areas and narrow band along edge of mesocoxal cavities. Abdomen
(Fig. 3e) 7-segmented; intercoxal sclerite broader than long; segments 1-4
with hydrofuge pubescence restricted to sides; segment 5 totally hydrofuge
pubescent; segments 6 and 7 with a few sparse hairs. Legs rather long. Tarsi
long, slender for most of length, but distinctly broadened apically; tarsal
formula 5-5-5; segments 1-3 very small, combined length subequal to length
of segment 4; segment 5 slightly longer than other segments combined.
Etymology. — It is with pleasure that I dedicate this new genus to Hugh
B. Leech, a small gesture in recognition of his aid to the advancement of
Coleopterology in general, and specifically in appreciation for his many and
lasting contributions to the knowledge of aquatic beetles.
Hughleechia giulianii, new species
Type-data. — Holotype male and allotype. Western Australia, Fisherman’s
Island, 28-IV-1969, D. D. Giuliani. Deposited in the Western Australian
Museum, Perth.
Paratypes (80 specimens; all collected by D. D. Giuliani). — Western Aus¬
tralia: Little Anchorage, 24-IV-1969. Small island just offshore of Little
Anchorage, 25-IV-1969. Fisherman’s Island, 28-IV-1969. Beaches and
points of Rottnest Island, 3-V-1969. Bald Head, Albany, 10-V-1969. 50 miles
S Dongara, 4-IV-1969 (all above in WAM). Peron Point nr. Rockingham,
28-IX-1969. Cape Naturalist (33.32s 115. Ole), 30-X-1969 (this and previous
in CSIRO). New South Wales: Green Cape, 8-VIII-1968 (WAM).
Description. — Holotype male 1.80 mm long, 0.84 mm wide. Color black
dorsally, infrequently with faint metallic blue reflections; venter and legs
dark brown.
Head. — Length 0.36 mm, width 0.46 mm. Frons strongly granulose,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
301
sparsely pubescent at sides; interocular foveae oblique impressed lines, area
between foveae flat; interocular tuberculi well developed, adjacent to pos¬
teromedian margin of eyes, sparsely setose. Frontoclypeal suture very shal¬
lowly bisinuate. Clypeus length Vi width, less strongly granulose and hence
more reflective than frons, sparsely punctate; apicomedian margin upturned
to form a blunt tooth. Labroclypeal suture weakly arcuate. Lab rum length
Vi width; apicomedian emargination well developed, hemispherical, at each
side of which is a distinctive tooth; surface of labrum smooth and shiny.
Maxillary palpus with penultimate segment moderately wide; ultimate seg¬
ment tapering to apex, % length of penultimate. Mentum produced at sides
(Figs. 2a, b), shiny, very sparsely punctate. Submentum shiny. Genae swol¬
len in midregion, shiny, finely sparsely punctulate. Postgena pubescent,
punctulate.
Thorax. — Pronotum length at midline 0.46 mm; maximum width (slightly
before midlength) 0.60 mm; sparsely pubescent on reliefs; depressions gran¬
ulose, reliefs punctate and less strongly granulose, hence more reflective
than depressions; anterior margin weakly arcuate, with narrow hyaline bor¬
der; sides rather strongly convergent from midlength; posterior margin with
narrow hyaline border which is overlaid with a row of setae; median depres¬
sion without setae, slightly constricted in midlength, anterior Vi more strong¬
ly granulose than posterior Vi\ a shallow depression on each side at base
which connects to base of median depression, these oblique depressions
with pubescence like that on reliefs; lateral fossulae well developed. Pro¬
sternum evenly rounded in midregion, antennal fossulae well developed;
coxae contiguous. Mesosternum pubescent, with broad intercoxal process
whose width at apex is about equal to length of last segment of maxillary
palpus; carinae totally lacking, not even with remnants anteriorly. Meta¬
sternum hydrofuge pubescent except for shiny triangular area in midregion
which has only a few setae; intercoxal process broad, about equal in length
and width to mesosternal intercoxal process, but with apex on a plane slight¬
ly higher than that of latter; posteromedian area between metacoxae broadly
emarginate to receive intercoxal sclerite.
Elytra. — Length 1.08 mm; maximum width (near midlength) 0.84 mm.
Wings absent, elytra interlocked. Each elytron with 5 distinct discal rows
of punctures, and 3 semi-serial rows laterally, each puncture with a short,
stiff recumbent seta, some punctures confluent in basal Vs; suture very
slightly raised. Explanate margin moderately developed. Elytron distinctly
declivous in apical Vx.
Abdomen. — Intercoxal sclerite broader than long. Sterna 1-4 hydrofuge
pubescent laterally; shiny, non-hydrofuge pubescent median area of sternum
1 forming equilateral triangle, similar areas of sterna 2-4 forming broad
triangles (Figs, le, 3e). Flydrofuge pubescence completely covering sternum
5, absent from sterna 6 and 7, the latter two with sparse hairs.
Legs. — All legs moderately long and slender. Tarsi broadened apically,
302
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
claws large. Segment 5 (last) of all tarsi longer than respective basal seg¬
ments combined. Segment 4 of meso- and metatarsi equal to combined
lengths of segments 1-3. Protarsi with segment 4 slightly shorter than com¬
bined lengths of segments 1-3.
Genitalia. — Aedeagus with parameres originating near midlength of main-
piece (Fig. 4c). Spermatheca as illustrated (Fig. 4b).
Variation. — Females average slightly larger than males, some individuals
attaining 2.00 mm in length. Females lack clypeal and labral processes seen
in males.
Distribution. — Currently known from the south and west coasts of Aus¬
tralia (Fig. 4a).
Etymology. — I am pleased to dedicate this new species to Derham D.
Giuliani, who collected all known specimens.
Acknowledgments
I am grateful to Terry Houston of the Western Australian Museum
(WAM) and to John F. Lawrence of the Commonwealth Scientific and In¬
dustrial Research Organization (CSIRO) for making specimens in their care
available for study. Thanks are also extended to Susann Braden and Mary
Jacque Mann of the Smithsonian Institution for taking the micrographs in¬
cluded herein. Finally, sincere appreciation is expressed to Derham D. Giu¬
liani, whose careful fieldwork made this study possible.
Literature Cited
Enderlein, G. 1901. Meropathus chuni nov. gen., nov. spec. Eine neue Helephorinen — gattung
von der Kerguelen Insel. Zool. Anzeiger, 24:121-124.
Janssens, E. 1967. Sur quelques Hydraenidae de la faune Australe. Bull. Ins. Roy. Sci. Nat.
Belg., 43(11): 1-13.
Jeannel, D. R. 1940. Croisiere du Bougainville auxiles Australes Frangaises. Mem. Mus. Nat.
Hist. Nat. Paris, 2(14): 1-325.
Orchymont, A. d’. 1938. Voyage de M. E. Aubert de la Rue aux iles Kerguelen: Palpicornia.
Rev. Franc. Entomol., 5:78-91.
Ordish, R. G. 1971. Entomology of the Aucklands and other islands south of New Zealand:
Coleoptera: Hydraenidae. Pac. Ins. Monog., 27:185-192.
Perkins, P. D. 1980. Aquatic beetles of the family Hydraenidae in the Western Hemisphere:
classification, biogeography and inferred phylogeny (Insecta: Coleoptera). Quaest. Ento¬
mol. (in press).
Sato, M. 1963. A new inter-tidal species of the genus Ochthebius Leach from Japan (Coleop¬
tera: Hydraenidae). Trans. Shik. Entomol. Soc., 7(4): 129-132.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 303-305
A CLARIFICATION OF THE AUTHORSHIP OF SOME NAMES IN
LACCOBIUS ERICHSON (COLEOPTERA: HYDROPHILIDAE)
Alan R. Hardy
Insect Taxonomy Laboratory, California Department of Food and
Agriculture, 1220 N Street, Sacramento 95814
Brian S. Cheary
Union Carbide Company, 7825 Baymeadows Way,
Jacksonville, FL 32216
AND
Stanley E. Malcolm
Biological Sciences Group, Box U-43,
The University of Connecticut, Storrs 06268
In 1971, B. S. Cheary completed his studies and received the Ph.D. degree
for a revision of the genus Laccobius Erichson of the New World. At ap¬
proximately this same time (1970), R. B. Willson was completing a master’s
thesis on the Hydrophilidae of Michigan, which included a draft of two new
species of Laccobius. At about this same time (1971), S. E. Malcolm was
completing a paper on the Water Beetles of Maine. Both Cheary’s and
Malcolm’s papers included Willson’s species (Cheary 2 sp., Malcolm 1 sp.),
and Malcolm’s paper included a species of Cheary’s.
Both Cheary and Malcolm assumed that Willson’s paper would appear
first, Cheary’s second, and then Malcolm’s. Cheary’s paper was submitted
to the University of California Press, where delays, including the death of
Editor D. D. Jensen and subsequent editor changes, have contributed to a
situation where the paper was never published in this series. Willson’s paper
has likewise never appeared. Malcolm’s paper appeared in late 1971 (Sept.-
Nov.). In 1979 Malcolm published a paper which attempted to clarify the
status of the authorship of L. reflexipenis (originally Cheary) and L. span-
gleri (originally Willson). His assessment, after discussion with Cheary and
others, was that both species should be credited to Malcolm. Accordingly,
the 1979 paper contained type designations and amplified descriptions. At
about this time, Cheary approached Hardy for assistance with the publi¬
cation of his (Cheary’s) thesis. It was Hardy’s assumption that the form of
Cheary’s thesis at the time the degree was awarded constituted valid sci¬
entific publication. Under Section III, Article 8 of the International Code of
Zoological Nomenclature, a publication to be regarded as valid must:
304
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
“(1) be reproduced in ink on paper by some method that assures numer¬
ous identical copies;
(2) be issued for the purpose of scientific, public, permanent record;
(3) be obtainable by purchase or free distribution; and
(4) not be reproduced or distributed by a forbidden method [Art. 9].”
At the completion of the degree work, Cheary had 50 copies of his thesis
reproduced by offset press and bound in a formal soft-cover binding, by a
local print-shop. They appeared, and are dated, June 1971. These copies
were sent free to cooperators and others. Some were sent upon request. At
present only 3-4 copies remain.
Cheary’s thesis, then, meets all criteria for publication, as outlined above.
This opinion has been concurred in by C. Sabrosky, who has had informal
discussions with other members of the International Commission of Zoo¬
logical Nomenclature on Cheary’s paper. This then means that the author
of reflexipenis is indeed Cheary, and Malcolm’s reflexipenis should be con¬
sidered a homonymous synonym. Likewise, Malcolm’s (originally Will¬
son’s) spangleri should be credited to Cheary. Cheary had examined Will¬
son’s type series in their entirety, and the types, deposited in the Michigan
State University Collection, should stand as the types of Cheary’s species.
The synonymies should stand as follows:
Laccobius arenarius Cheary 1971
( Laccobius arenarius Willson 1970:45, ms. name.)
“ Laccobius arenarius Willson,” Cheary 1971:93.
Laccobius spangleri Cheary 1971
(. Laccobius spangleri Willson 1970:40, ms. name.)
“ Laccobius spangleri Willson” Cheary 1971:93; Malcolm 1971:40.
Laccobius spangleri Malcolm 1979:62. NEW SYNONYM.
Laccobius reflexipenis Cheary 1971
Laccobius reflexipenis Cheary 1971:101.
“ Laccobius reflexipenis Cheary” Malcolm 1971:40.
Laccobius reflexipenis Malcolm 1979:59. NEW SYNONYM.
In the paper by Cheary, then, these names were described, and should be
considered valid as of 1971:
Laccobius carri pallidus n. ssp. Cheary 1971:90
L. arenarius Cheary 1971:93.
L. spangleri Cheary 1971:93
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
305
L. piceus australis n. ssp. Cheary 1971:98.
L. tridentipenis Cheary 1971:99.
L. bruesi Cheary 1971:100.
L. reflexipenis Cheary 1971:101.
L. oregonensis Cheary 1971:102.
L. leechi Cheary 1971:104.
L. hardyi Cheary 1971:105.
L. teneralis Cheary 1971:107.
L. borealis Cheary 1971:110.
L. magnus Cheary 1971:114.
L. occidentalis Cheary 1971:116.
L. chandleri Cheary 1971:119.
Acknowledgments
The authors would like to thank Drs. C. Sabrosky and R. Hodges, both
associated with the United States National Museum of Natural History, for
their opinions and discussions of this problem, especially during the Denver
Meetings (1979) of the Entomological Society of America.
Literature Cited
Cheary, Brian S. 1971. The Biology, Ecology and Systematics of the Genus Laccobius (Lac-
cobius) (Coleoptera: Hydrophilidae) of the New World. Publ. at Riverside, 1971, 178
pp.
International Commission of Zoological Nomenclature. 1964. International Code of Zoological
Nomenclature. London, 176 pp.
Malcolm, Stanley E. 1971. The Water Beetles of Maine: Including the Families Gyrinidae,
Haliplidae, Dytiscidae, Noteridae, and Hydrophilidae. Univ. Maine Agric. Exp. Stn.
Tech. Bull. 48, 40 pp.
Malcolm, Stanley E. 1979. Two new species of Laccobius from Eastern North America
(Coleoptera: Hydrophilidae). J. New York Entomol. Soc., 87(1):59— 65.
Willson, Ronald B. 1970. Hydrophilidae of Michigan. Unpubl. Master’s Thesis, Mich. State
Univ., pp. 35-48, 83.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 306-312
TWO NEW PERUVIAN SPECIES OF THE RIFFLE BEETLE GENUS
XENELMIS (COLEOPTERA: ELMIDAE)
Philip D. Perkins and Warren E. Steiner, Jr.
% Department of Entomology, Smithsonian Institution,
Washington, D.C. 20560
The riffle beetle genus Xenelmis Hinton is comprised of minute elmids,
the adults of which are less than 2 mm in length and have robust body form.
Nine species have been previously described; these are known from Central
America (1 species), Brazil (7), Paraguay (1), northern Argentina (2) and
Ecuador (1). Five of the Brazilian species are apparently restricted to that
country, the other two species range into Paraguay and northern Argentina.
With the exception of the Central American species, X. bufo (Sharp), adults
of this genus are very rarely collected; the combined total of known spec¬
imens for the other eight species being less than 50 specimens (Hinton, 1946;
Deleve, 1968; Brown, 1970).
Described below are two new species of Xenelmis collected by W. E.
Steiner in Peru. Both species are presently known only from holotype males.
These specimens were collected from an open, sunlit section of a fairly
rapid stream, about 2 m wide and 15-20 cm deep, on submerged, moss-
covered rocks. The surrounding vegetation was dense, secondary-growth,
montane rain forest. This stream, a tributary of the Rio Marcapata, is about
one km north of the town of Quince Mil, at an elevation of about 900 m. A
number of other elmid species representing several genera were also taken
at this site; individuals of these species were much more abundant than
those of Xenelmis.
Xenelmis leechi, new species
(Figs. 1, 3)
Type-data. — Holotype male. Peru, Department of Cuzco, Quince Mil, 26-
1-1979, W. E. Steiner, Jr. Deposited in the National Museum of Natural
History, Smithsonian Institution; type no. 76696.
Description. — Holotype male 1.52 mm long, 0.92 mm wide. Body broadly
obovate and strongly convex (Fig. 1). Cuticle feebly shining, dorsum and
venter nearly black; pronotum with bronze cast; legs dark brown; antennae
and palpi brown.
Head on each side with a row of low granules extending forward from
near mid-dorsal line on vertex and terminating between upper margins of
eyes; frons microreticulate and granulate, granules smaller than facets of
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
307
eyes, separated by 2-4 times granule diameter. Lab rum with sculpture sim¬
ilar to frons.
Pronotum 0.56 mm long, 0.72 mm wide at base; disc rather evenly convex,
sparsely, randomly granulate, granules smaller than facets of eyes, sepa¬
rated by about 4 times diameter of a granule; each granule with a small seta;
lateral margins strongly granulate, granules contiguous or nearly so, sub¬
serial, twice size of those on remainder of pronotum; base trisinuate. Dull
lustre of pronotum especially well developed in basal half; a fine pin will
make a scratch line in this surface.
Elytra 1.04 mm long, 0.92 mm wide (slightly before midlength); non-
striate; serial punctures small, especially those of sutural row which are
smaller than facets of eyes, separated by about 5 times diameter of a punc¬
ture; serial punctures becoming increasingly larger and more deeply im¬
pressed from suture toward lateral margin, punctures of row 4 slightly larger
than facets of eyes; rows of punctures separated by about 5 times diameter
of a puncture; intervals 5 and 7 each with a row of closely spaced granules
which are distinctly larger than other granules on elytra; remaining intervals
with small, random granules about equal in size to those on pronotal disc,
but slightly denser; lateral margins granulate, forming a bead which is 3
times width of sublateral rows of granules; epipleura with sparse, random
granules. Anterior margin of elytra very finely crenulate.
Prosternum 0.32 mm long; prosternal process 0.16 mm long, 0.30 mm
wide; a low, indistinct ridge extending anteriorly from mesial margin of
procoxa for half distance to anterior margin of prosternum, area between
ridge and anterior margin rugulose, remainder of disc and process finely,
irregularly punctate, with very short, sparse setae directed anteriorly, each
seta arising from base of very small, nearly imperceptible granule; margins
of prosternal process raised slightly. Mesosternum finely microreticulate,
raised slightly behind prosternal process. Metasternum with a finely im¬
pressed median longitudinal line in posterior anterior with a distinc¬
tive transverse depression, middle Vs of which has a transverse groove; disc
with shallow setiferous punctures equal in size to facets of eyes, separated
by 1-4 times their diameter; sides of metasternum with dull lustre and small
granules as on pronotum, dull lustre ending midway between middle of coxal
cavities and median longitudinal line. Abdomen extremely finely microre¬
ticulate and with a dull lustre in all areas except intercoxal process of first
sternum; sparsely granulate, granules similar to those of pronotal disc; gran¬
ules of last sternum denser than those on other sterna; intercoxal process
with anterior margin shallowly trisinuate.
Legs without apparent modification. Cleaning fringes on the following
surfaces: protibiae — anteromedial, occupying distal Vi\ mesotibiae — antero-
and posteromedial, occupying distal Vs and V2 respectively; metatibiae —
posteromedial, occupying distal Vs.
Genitalia. — Aedeagus as illustrated (Fig. 3).
308
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Xenelmis leechi holotype, habitus (body length 1.52 mm).
Distribution. — Currently known only from the type-locality near Quince
Mil, Department of Cuzco, Peru.
Etymology. — We are pleased to dedicate this new species to Hugh B.
Leech, who has so greatly influenced the study of Coleoptera.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
309
Fig. 2. Xenelmis marcapata holotype, habitus (body length 1.36 mm).
Xenelmis marcapata, new species
(Figs. 2, 4)
Type-data. — Holotype male. Peru, Department of Cuzco, Quince Mil, 26-
1-1979, W. E. Steiner, Jr. Deposited in the National Museum of Natural
History, Smithsonian Institution; type no. 76697.
Description: Holotype male 1.36 mm long, 0.84 mm wide. Body broadly
obovate and strongly convex (Fig. 2). Cuticle feebly shining, pronotum with
310
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
slight bronze cast, dorsum and venter brown to rufopiceous; legs brown;
antennae and palpi testaceous.
Head on each side with a row of low granules extending forward from
near mid-dorsal line on vertex and terminating between upper margins of
eyes; frons microreticulate and granulate, granules about equal in size to
facets of eyes, separated by 1-2 times their diameter. Labrum with sculpture
similar to frons.
Pronotum 0.50 mm long, 0.62 mm wide at base; disc rather evenly convex,
with random, rather evenly spaced granules which are smaller than facets
of eyes and separated by about 3 times the diameter of a granule; a distinc¬
tive, golden adpressed seta emerging from mesial margin of each granule;
seta length equal to distance separating granules; in general, setae form a
pattern as each is directed toward most elevated region of pronotum, which
is median basal Vs. Lateral margins granulate but not strongly so, each
granule about equal in size to eye facet, usually contiguous. Dull lustre of
pronotum weakly developed.
Elytra 0.98 mm long, 0.84 mm wide (slightly before midlength); non-
striate; serial punctures small, especially those of sutural row which are
smaller than eye facets, separated by about 5 times diameter of a puncture;
serial punctures becoming increasingly larger and more deeply impressed
from suture toward lateral margin; punctures of row 4 about size of eye
facets; rows of punctures separated by about 5 times diameter of a puncture;
intervals 5 and 7 each with a row of closely spaced granules which are about
twice as large as other granules on elytron; remaining intervals extremely
finely microreticulate (much less so than head) and with small, random
granules about equal in size to those on pronotal disc, but slightly sparser;
lateral margins granulate, forming a bead which is only very slightly wider
than width of sublateral rows of granules; epipleura with a distinct row of
elongate granules along ventral edge adjacent to metasternum, granules sim¬
ilar in size to those of sublateral rows, separated by their lengths, remainder
of epipleura with random, sparse granules. Anterior margin of elytra very
finely crenulate.
Prosternum 0.28 mm long; prosternal process 0.12 mm long, 0.30 mm
wide, margins slightly raised; a low, indistinct ridge extending anteriorly
from mesial margin of procoxa for half distance to anterior margin of pro¬
sternum; area between ridge and anterior margin, and remainder of disc,
smooth, with small, sparse setae arising from tiny granules. Mesosternum
finely microreticulate, raised slightly behind prosternal process. Metaster¬
num with a finely impressed, median longitudinal line in posterior Vs\ a
distinct transverse depression occupying anterior Vs, middle V3 of which
has a transverse groove; disc with shallow setiferous punctures equal in size
to facets of eyes, separated by 1-3 times their diameters; dull lustre on sides
of metasternum, disc without dull lustre. Abdomen extremely finely micro-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
311
Figs. 3, 4. Aedeagi of Xenelmis. Holotypes, dorsal and lateral aspects. Fig. 3, X. leechi,
new species. Fig. 4, X. marcapata new species.
reticulate and with a dull lustre in all areas except intercoxal process of first
sternum; granules small, size equal to meshes of microreticulation, sparse
on middle 3/s of sterna 1-4, lacking, or nearly so, on lateral Vs; granules of
sternum 5 twice as dense as those on other segments.
Legs without apparent modification. Cleaning fringes on the following
surfaces: protibiae — anteromedial, occupying distal Vi; mesotibiae — antero-
(less distinct) and posteromedial, occupying distal Vi and Vi respectively;
metatibiae — posteromedial, occupying distal Vi.
Genitalia. — Aedeagus as illustrated (Fig. 4).
Distribution. — Currently known only from the type-locality near Quince
Mil, Department of Cuzco, Peru.
Etymology. — marcapata, a noun in apposition, refers to the Rio Marca¬
pata. The stream at the type-locality is a tributary of this river.
Hinton (1946) published a key to the species of Xenelmis known at that
time. This key was modified by Brown (1970) for inclusion of his new
species, X. laura from Brazil, but X. rufipes Deleve 1968 from Ecuador
was not included in that key. The two new species from Peru described
herein, plus X. rufipes Deleve, may be distinguished by replacing couplet
4 of Brown’s (1970) key with the following couplets:
312
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
1. Elytra with a conspicuous row of coarse granules on basal three-
fifths of third interval . 2
Elytra without a row of coarse granules on third interval . 3
2. Male with last metatarsomere broadly dilated and densely pubescent
beneath; aedeagus as illustrated (Fig. 1 in Hinton, 1940); Mato
Grosso, Brazil . X. tarsalis Hinton
Male with last metatarsomere not dilated nor densely pubescent be¬
neath; aedeagus as illustrated (Fig. 19 in Deleve, 1968); Ecuador
. X. rufipes Deleve
3. Head on each side with a row of granules extending forward from
near mid-dorsal line on vertex and terminating near base of an¬
tenna; aedeagus as illustrated (Figs. 193, 194 in Hinton, 1940);
Central America . X. bufo (Sharp)
Head with rows of granules short, not reaching bases of antennae,
terminating between upper margins of eyes; Peru . 4
4. Larger (1.56 mm), broader, more markedly sculptured species (Fig.
1) ; integument rugulose between anterior margin of prosternum
and mesial margin of procoxae; metasternum with dull lustre ex¬
cept on median longitudinal Vi of disc; abdominal sterna 1-4 with
well-developed granules laterally; aedeagus as illustrated
(Fig. 3) . Xenelmis leechi new species
Smaller (1.36 mm), narrower, less markedly sculptured species (Fig.
2) ; integument smooth between anterior margin of prosternum and
mesial margin of procoxae; metasternal disc lacking dull lustre as
seen laterally; abdominal sterna 1-4 agranulate laterally; aedeagus
as illustrated (Fig. 4) . Xenelmis marcapata new species
Literature Cited
Hinton, H. E. 1946. A key to the species of Xenelmis Hinton, with descriptions of three new
species (Col., Elmidae). Entomol. Mon. Mag., 82:237-241.
Deleve, J. 1968. IV. — Coleoptera Elminthidae. Mission zoologique beige aux lies Galapagos
et en Ecuador (N. et J. Leleup, 1964-1965), 1:211-272.
Brown, H. P. 1970. Neotropical dryopoids I. Xenelmis laura, a new species from Brazil
(Coleoptera: Elmidae). Coleop. Bull., 24(3):61-65.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
January 1981, Vol. 57, No. 1, pp. 313-320
ECTOPRIA LEECHI, A NEW FALSE WATER PENNY FROM THE
UNITED STATES (COLEOPTERA: EUBRIIDAE)
Warren U. Brigham
Illinois Natural History Survey, Urbana, Illinois 61801
The family name Eubriidae, representing the false water penny beetles,
is probably unfamiliar to most coleopterists. The genera included here have
been placed with the Dascillidae (Leng, 1920; Arnett, 1968) or, especially,
the Psephenidae (Leech and Chandler, 1956; Leech and Sanderson, 1959;
Brown, 1972; Doyen and Ulrich, 1978). Bertrand (1972) points out that a
number of earlier investigators established Ectopria LeConte and related
genera {Acneus Horn and, presumably, Alabameubria Brown and Dicranop-
selaphus Guerin-Meneville in North America) as a distinct family. Ectopria
is included in the Eubriidae by Bertrand (1972) and Brigham (1981).
Ectopria has long been considered monospecific in the United States,
with Ectopria thoracica (Ziegler, 1844), Ectopria tarsalis LeConte 1853,
and Ectopria tibialis LeConte 1853 being considered synonymous with Ec¬
topria nervosa (Melsheimer, 1844). The genus currently is under revision by
this author. Preliminary observations indicate that both Ectopria nervosa
and Ectopria thoracica are valid species and that one new species, de¬
scribed below, occurs in the United States.
Ectopria leechi, new species
Holotype male. — Pear-shaped, widest approximately % distance from hu¬
meral region of elytra to apex (Fig. 1). Greatest width 2.01 mm; greatest
length 3.30 mm. Head: Maximum width through eyes 0.72 mm, minimum
width between eyes 0.33 mm; surface of vertex and frons granular, purplish-
black, darker around eye; ventral projection between bases of antennae
excavated between and especially below antennae, with a distinct margin,
purplish-black anteriorly, margin darker, light brown laterally and ventrally;
mouthparts testaceous. Antenna: Serrate (Fig. 4); basal segment trapezoi¬
dal, glabrous; segment 2 cylindrical, glabrous; segments 3 through 10 tri¬
angular, dull, with numerous short setae and a few long hairs ventrally;
segment 11 elongate-oval, dull, with numerous short setae and longer hairs;
lengths of segments (from basal segment) 0.24 mm, 0.05 mm, 0.21 mm, 0.24
mm, 0.24 mm, 0.24 mm, 0.24 mm, 0.24 mm, 0.23 mm, 0.21 mm, 0.30 mm;
color light brown, darker dorsally, the basal segment darker brown. Prono-
tum: Width at apex 0.90 mm, width at base 1.59 mm, length along midline
0.81 mm; surface granular, densely covered with appressed silvery hairs
314
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Ectopria leechi, holotype male, habitus.
except along anterior margin; distinctly margined laterally, finely margined
anteriorly, posterior margin crenulate; disc strongly inflated above plane of
anterior and posterior margins, somewhat inflated posterolaterally; a pair of
shallow foveae near basal margin, each fovea located just laterad of lateral
margin of scutellum; color light brown with margins, disc, and a spot laterad
from each fovea darker brown, clouded with darker brown from disc to
lateral margin. Scutellum: Obtusely triangular; width at base 0.36 mm, width
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
315
along midline 0.24 mm; surface shining, densely covered with appressed
silvery hairs; basal margin straight, crenulate; lateral margins curved, con¬
verging to form obtuse angle; color light brown, darker along lateral mar¬
gins, basal margin dark brown. Elytron: Surface, in part, coarsely granulate,
the coarse granules confined to slightly impressed vermiculations, remainder
of elytral surface finely granulate, densely covered with appressed silvery
hairs; anterior margin crenulate from suture to humeral region; distinctly
margined in humeral region, laterally, and apically; faintly margined sutur-
ally; lateral margin reflected, more strongly so anteriorly; color very light
brown, becoming darker basally where it matches light brown of pronotum,
margins very dark brown, vermiculations dark brown, elytron with four
longitudinal dark brown lines extending toward, but not reaching, apex,
sutural line arising from scutellum, discal lines arising from near base of
elytron, humeral line arising from base of elytron, lines anastomosing pos¬
teriorly as in Figure 1. Venter: Densely covered with appressed silvery
hairs; prosternum with surface finely granulate, margin beaded except along
prosternal process, prosternal process parallel-sided, extending posteriorly
to base of fore trochanter, slightly concave ventrally, truncate apically,
coloration light brown, darker posteriorly, margin and prosternal process
dark brown; mesosternal process trapezoidal, deeply concave, truncate api¬
cally, with a few coarse granulations, extending posteriorly to base of middle
trochanter, coloration light brown with lateral margin darker, mesepister-
num dark brown; metasternum transversely excavated at base, below plane
of apex of mesosternal process, color light brown, except metepisternum
dark brown, elongate glabrous area posteriorly along midline; abdomen light
brown, darker laterally, apical sternite with a pair of foveae laterally along
basal margin. Legs: Testaceous, densely covered with appressed silvery
hairs, hairs thinning along dorsal surfaces of femora; fore coxa ovate, middle
coxa conical, hind coxa transverse, remaining leg-segment measurements
as follows (in mm)
leg
Genitalia: Trilobed (Figs. 2, 3); maximum length of sclerotized parts 723 /x,
maximum width 289 /z; aedeagus complex, with two parts, dorsal piece V-
316
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 2-5. Ectopria leechi: Fig. 2, holotype male, genitalia, dorsal aspect. Fig. 3, holotype
male, genitalia (from below). Fig. 4, holotype male, antenna. Fig. 5, allotype female, antenna.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
317
shaped, length 553 /jl, width at base 182 /jl, apparently articulating anteriorly
with parameres, apex bluntly rounded, with coarse punctures, concave ven-
trally and receiving apex of ventral piece, extending 31 p beyond apices of
parameres, ventral piece V-shaped, length 201 p, width at base 132 p, ap¬
parently articulating anteriorly with midpoint of dorsal piece, apex sharply
rounded, curving ventrally and received by concave ventral surface of apex
of dorsal piece, terminating 54 p proximal to apices of parameres; parameres
with membranous dorsal and ventral margins forming sheath around aedea-
gus, apices closely applied to lateral margins of dorsal piece of aedeagus.
Allotype female. — Similar to holotype except antenna less serrate, espe¬
cially basally (Fig. 5). Greatest length 4.4 mm, greatest width 2.5 mm.
Variation. — Gross variation within the type series of Ectopria leechi is
limited to the longitudinal anastomosing lines on the elytra, being less dis¬
tinct in older specimens; the coloration of the antennae and legs, varying
from testaceous to light brown; and the body measurements. Twenty-nine
males ranged in length from 2.8 mm to 3.6 mm (mean length 3.15 mm ±
0.21 mm) and in width from 1.7 mm to 2.0 mm (mean width 1.87 mm ± 0.12
mm). Twenty-one females ranged in length from 3.6 mm to 4.9 mm (mean
length 4.08 mm ±0.34 mm) and in width from 2.5 mm to 2.9 mm (mean
width 2.57 mm ± 0.13 mm). Body proportions were roughly similar between
males and females, though the females were distinctly larger. The width of
20 males averaged 0.602 ± 0.022 times the length. The width of 10 females
averaged 0.615 ± 0.033 times the length.
Diagnosis. — Pear-shaped medium-sized Ectopria which keys to Ectopria
nervosa in Brown (1972) and keys to Ectopria and most closely fits Ectopria
nervosa in Brigham (1981). It is distinct from other Ectopria in coloration
(Fig. 1) and in the distinctive type of male genitalia (Figs. 2, 3). Legs and
antennae testaceous or light brown, pronotum light brown with margins,
disc, and a spot laterad from each basal fovea darker brown, clouded with
darker brown from disc to lateral margin; elytron light brown with distinct
dark brown vermiculations and four longitudinal dark brown anastomosing
lines extending toward apex; male genitalia broad, 0.4 times as wide as long,
parameres nearly straight apically, smooth, without subapical callosities.
The following modifications of Brigham’s (1981) key are necessary to in¬
clude the new species.
1. Elytron light brown with distinct dark brown vermiculations and
four dark brown anastomosing lines extending toward apex (Fig.
1); legs and antennae testaceous or light brown; aedeagus broad,
0.4 times as wide as long, without subapical callosities (Figs. 2,
3) . Ectopria leechi Brigham, new species
Elytron uniformly brownish-black or black or dull dusky reddish-
brown with faint dark vermiculations, without longitudinal dark
318
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
anastomosing lines; legs and antennae brown or black, although
tarsi may be lighter; aedeagus elongate, 0.26 times as wide as long
or 0.32 times as wide as long with distinct subapical callosities on
parameres . 2
2. Pronotum bicolored, yellow or gold laterally, dusky or black medi¬
ally; elytron uniformly brownish-black or black; aedeagus very
elongate, 0.26 times as wide as long .... Ectopria thoracica (Ziegler)
Pronotum uniformly black or brown; elytron dull dusky reddish-
brown with faint dark vermiculations; aedeagus elongate, 0.32
times as wide as long, parameres with distinct subapical callosi¬
ties . Ectopria nervosa (Melsheimer)
Distribution. — Holotype 3 ILLINOIS, Ogle Co., White Pines St. Pk.,
Trib. of Pine Cr. in youth campground, 27 June 1972 #35, W. U. Brigham
& M. W. Sanderson; Allotype 9 ILLINOIS, Boone Co., North Kinnikin-
nick Cr. at Boone Co. Conserv. area, 26 June 1972 # 22, W. U. Brigham
6 M. W. Sanderson; Paratypes 1 6 ARKANSAS, Washington Co., 2 July
1939, M. W. Sanderson; CONNECTICUT, 1 <J [Litchfield Co.], Cornwall,
7 June 1925, sweeping field, L. B. Woodruff Coll. Acc. 26824; ILLINOIS,
1 3 , 2 9 9 same data as holotype; 1 9 same data as allotype; 1 9 Winnebago
Co., Trib. of North Branch Otter Cr. 2 km NE of Durand, 26 June 1972
#23, W. U. Brigham & M. W. Sanderson; INDIANA, 1 <J , 1 $ [Floyd Co.],
Edwardsville; 3 S3 Chas. Palm Coll. Acc. 5409; KENTUCKY, 3 3 3, 4
9 9 [Jefferson Co.], Louisville, 3 June, H. Soltau Coll.; 1 9 [Jefferson Co.],
Louisville, 22 June, H. Soltau Coll.; 1 3 , 1933, H. F. Wickham Coll.; MICH¬
IGAN, 1 (3 Midland Co., 1 July 1936, R. R. Dreisbach; PENNSYLVANIA,
1 3, 1 9 [Lehigh Co.], Bethlehem, 20 June 1933, H. F. Wickham; NO
LOCALITY, 15 3 3,9 99 #3995.
Distribution of other specimens of Ectopria leechi, but not designated as
paratypes. — CONNECTICUT, 1 9 [Litchfield Co.], Goshen, 5 July 1925,
Chamberlain; KENTUCKY, 3 9 9 [Franklin Co.], Frankfort, 9 June, H.
Soltau Coll.; NEW YORK, 1 9 [Erie Co.], Lancaster, 4 June 1911, M. C.
Van Duzee, C. A. Frost Coll.; OKLAHOMA, 1 9 [Ottawa Co.], Wyandotte,
19 June 1939, Kaiser-Nailon; VIRGINIA 4 9 9 Liebeck Coll. A single fe¬
male bore no label other than a small blue-grey disc. LeConte used identical
discs to designate specimens collected from the north shore of Lake Su¬
perior during his visit to the lake with Agassiz during the early 1840’s. If
this specimen is from LeConte material, it represents the northernmost rec¬
ord for Ectopria leechi. Figure 6 shows the distribution of Ectopria leechi
based upon the type series and other known specimens listed above. No
Virginia records have been plotted because the specimens labelled “VA”
lacked more specific locality information.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 1
319
Fig. 6. Distribution of Ectopria leechi (also known from Virginia, but without specific
locality).
The holotype and allotype are in the collection of the Illinois Natural
History Survey. Paratypes are in the collections of or have been distributed
to the American Museum of Natural History, California Academy of Sci¬
ence, Field Museum of Natural History, Museum of Comparative Zoology,
National Museum of Natural History, and Stovall Museum of Science and
History.
Etymology. — The epithet leechi honors Hugh B. Leech for his many con¬
tributions to the study of aquatic Coleoptera.
Habitat. — All Illinois specimens of Ectopria leechi came from small,
swift-flowing streams. Stream width ranged from 1 m to 2 m and depth ranged
up to 10 cm. Water temperatures were cool for the localities and time of
year ranging from 15°C to 17°C. Substrate composition ranged from mud-sand
to cobble riffles. Surrounding countryside was predominantly gently rolling
agricultural land with a narrow belt of young trees along the streams. The
type-locality, however, was open woodland. One stream bank here was a
sheer rock bluff approximately 10 m high.
Adults from the type-locality were taken by sweeping insects from the
320
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
moist undersurfaces of a log and rocks closely overhanging the stream.
Adults from other localities presumably were taken from streamside grasses
growing down into the water.
Ectopria larvae believed to be Ectopria leechi were taken from the un¬
dersurfaces of cobble-sized rocks in riffles. They appeared to be gregarious
in that a few rocks yielded most of the specimens. These larvae were taken
in association with the dryopoid genera Dubiraphia, Helichus, Optioservus,
and Stenelmis.
The illustrations were prepared by Ms. Aleta A. Holt of the Illinois
Natural History Survey.
Literature Cited
Arnett, R. H. 1968. The beetles of the United States (a manual for identification). Amer.
Entomol. Inst., Ann Arbor, Michigan, xii +1112 pp.
Bertrand, H. P. I. 1972. Larves et nymphes des Coleopteres aquatiques du globe avec tableaux
de determination des generes. F. Paillart, Paris. 804 pp.
Brigham, W. U. 1981. Aquatic Coleoptera, pp. 10.1-10.136. In A. R. Brigham, W. U. Brig¬
ham, and A. Gnilka, eds. Aquatic insects and oligochaetes of North and South Carolina.
Midwest Aquatic Enterprises, Mahomet, Illinois.
Brown, H. P. 1972. Aquatic dryopoid beetles (Coleoptera) of the United States. Biota of
freshwater ecosystems identification manual no. 6. U.S. Environ. Protection Agency,
Washington, D.C. ix + 82 pp.
Doyen, J. T., and G. Ulrich. 1978. Aquatic Coleoptera, pp. 203-231. In R. W. Merritt and
K. W. Cummins, eds. An introduction to the aquatic insects of North America. Kendall/
Hunt Publ. Co., Dubuque, Iowa.
LeConte, J. L. 1853. Synopsis of the Atopidae, Rhipiceridae and Cyphonidae of the United
States. Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci. Philadelphia, 6:350-357.
Leech, H. B., and H. P. Chandler. 1956. Aquatic Coleoptera, pp. 293-371. In R. L. Usinger,
ed. Aquatic insects of California. Univ. California Press, Berkeley.
Leech, H. B., and M. W. Sanderson. 1959. Coleoptera, pp. 981-1023. In W. T. Edmondson,
ed. Fresh-water biology, 2nd ed. John Wiley and Sons, Inc., New York.
Leng, C. W. 1920. Catalogue of the Coleoptera of America, north of Mexico. John D. Sher¬
man, Jr., Mount Vernon, New York, x + 470 pp.
Melsheimer, F. E. 1844. Descriptions of new species of Coleoptera of the United States. Proc.
Acad. Nat. Sci. Philadelphia, 2:26-43, 98-118, 134-160, 213-223, 302-318.
Ziegler, D. 1844. Descriptions of new North American Coleoptera. Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci.
Philadelphia, 2:43-47, 266-272.
PUBLICATIONS
OF THE
PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
PROCEEDINGS OF THE PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL
SOCIETY.
Vol. 1 (16 numbers, 179 pages) and Vol. 2 (9 numbers, 131
pages). 1901-1930. Price $5.00 per volume.
THE PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST.
Vol. 1 (1924) to Vol. 51 (1975), price $10.00 per volume of 4
numbers, or $2.50 per single issue. Vol. 52 (1976) and subse¬
quent issues, $15.00 per volume or $3.75 per single issue.
MEMOIR SERIES.
Volume 1. The Sucking Lice by G. F. Ferris. 320 pages. Pub¬
lished October 1951. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.00 postage and han¬
dling.)*
Volume 2. The Spider Mite Family Tetranychidae by A. Earl
Pritchard and Edward W. Baker. 472 pages. Published July
1955. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 3. Revisionary Studies in the Nearctic Decticinae by
David C. Rentz and James D. Birchim. 173 pages. Published
July 1968. Price $4.00 (Plus $.75 postage and handling.)*
Volume 4. Autobiography of an Entomologist by Robert L.
Usinger. 343 pages. Published August 1972. Price $15.00. (Plus
$1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 5. Revision of the Millipede Family Andrognathidae
in the Nearctic Region by Michael R. Gardner. 61 pages. Pub¬
lished January 21, 1975. Price $3.00 (Plus $.75 postage and
handling.)*
*(Add 6% sales tax on all California orders (resident of Alameda, Contra
Costa, San Francisco, Santa Clara and Santa Cruz counties add 6 Vi%).
Members of the Society will receive a 20% discount.)
Send orders to:
Pacific Coast Entomological Society
c/o California Academy of Sciences
Golden Gate Park
San Francisco, California 94118
(' Continued from front cover )
SPANGLER and PERKINS — A New Genus and Species of Water Scavenger Beetle
from Africa (Coleoptera: Hydrophilidae: Sphaeridiinae) _ 220
BROWN — Huleechius , A New Genus of Riffle Beetles from Mexico and Arizona (Cole¬
optera, Dryopoidea, Elmidae) _ 228
SPANGLER — A Durable, Lightweight Net and a Manual Aspirator for Collecting
Aquatic Organisms _ 245
STEINER — A New Genus and a New Species of Laccophiline Water Beetle from
Ecuador (Coleoptera: Dytiscidae) _ 251
MALCOLM — Some Omicrini from the Oriental and Pacific Regions (Coleoptera:
Hydrophilidae: Sphaeridiinae) _ 260
KAVANAUGH and ROUGHLEY — On the Identity of Amphizoa kashmirensis Vazirani
(Coleoptera: Amphizoidae) _ 269
ROUGHLEY — Trachypachidae and Hydradephaga (Coleoptera): A Monophyletic
Unit? _ 273
SPANGLER — Pagelmis amazonica, a New Genus and Species of Water Beetle from
Ecuador (Coleoptera: Elmidae) _ 286
PERKINS — Hughleechia giulianii, a New Genus and New Species of Intertidal Beetle
from Australia (Coleoptera: Hydraenidae) _ 295
HARDY, CHE ARY and MALCOLM — A Clarification of the Authorship of Some
Names in Laccobius Erichson (Coleoptera: Hydrophilidae) _ 303
PERKINS and STEINER — Two New Peruvian Species of the Riffle Beetle Genus
Xenelmis (Coleoptera: Elmidae) _ 306
BRIGHAM — Ectopria leechi, a New False Water Penny from the United States (Cole¬
optera: Eubriidae) _ 313
SCIENTIFIC NOTE
Nelson — Notes on Nearctic Helichus (Coleoptera: Cryopidae) _ 226
NOTICES _ 148, 244
Vol. 57
APRIL 1981
No. 2
THE
Pan-Pacific Entomologist
LINDSKOG — On the Identity of Saldula laticollis (Reuter) (Heteroptera: Saldidae) _ 321
DAIGLE and HADDOCK — The Larval Description and Ecological Notes of a Caddis-
fly, Nectopsyche tavara (Ross) from the Central Florida Refugium (Trichop-
tera: Leptoceridae) _ 327
COVILLE — Biological Observations on Three Trypoxylon Wasps in the Subgenus Tryp-
argilum from Costa Rica: T. nitidum schulthessi, T. saussurei, and T. lactitarse
(Hymenoptera: Sphecidae) _ 332
CANNINGS — The Larva of Sympetrum mcididum (Hagen) (Odonata: Libellulidae) _ 341
LEVINE and CLEMENT — A Laboratory Method for Rearing Bonnetia comta Fallen
(Diptera: Tachinidae) _ 347
KIMSEY — A New North American Chrysidid Genus and Redescription of the Genus
Pseudolopyga Krombein (Elampinae, Hymenoptera) _ 351
SHOOK — The Status of the Columbia Tiger Beetle ( Cicindela columbica Hatch) in
Idaho (Coleoptera: Cicindelidae) _ 359
GILBERT — A New Species of Coscinopterci Lacordaire from California (Coleop¬
tera: Chrysomelidae) _ 364
FRANCKE and MERICKEL — Two New Species of Pogonomyrmex Harvester Ants
from Texas (Hymenoptera: Formicidae) _ 371
SHELLY and WEINBERGER — Courtship and Diet of the Neotropical Robber Fly
Mallophora schwarzi Curran (Diptera: Asilidae) _ 380
SAN FRANCISCO, CALIFORNIA • 1981
Published by the PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
in cooperation with THE CALIFORNIA ACADEMY OF SCIENCES
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist
EDITORIAL BOARD
G. A. Marsh, Editor
C. Pleines, Editorial Asst.
P. H. Amaud, Jr., Treasurer
R. M. Bohart E. S. Ross
H. B. Leech
J. A. Chemsak
Published quarterly in January, April, July and October with Society Proceedings
appearing in the October number. All communications regarding nonreceipt of num¬
bers, requests for sample copies, and financial communications should be addressed
to the Treasurer, Dr. Paul H. Amaud, Jr., California Academy of Sciences, Golden
Gate Park, San Francisco, California 94118.
Application for membership in the Society and changes of address should be ad¬
dressed to the Secretary, Ronald E. Somerby, Insect Taxonomy Laboratory, California
Department of Food and Agriculture, 1220 “N” St., Sacramento, CA 95814.
Manuscripts, proofs and all correspondence concerning editorial matters should be
addressed to Gordon A. Marsh, Museum of Systematic Biology, University of Cal¬
ifornia, Irvine, 92717.
The annual dues, paid in advance, are $12.00 for regular members of the Society,
$7.00 for student members, or $15.00 for subscription only. Members of the society
receive The Pan-Pacific Entomologist. Single copies of recent numbers are $3.75 each
or $15.00 a volume. Write to the treasurer for prices of earlier back numbers. Make
all checks payable to The Pacific Coast Entomological Society.
The Pacific Coast Entomological Society
OFFICERS FOR 1981
D. Kavanaugh, President P. H. Amaud, Jr., Treasurer
J. E. Hafemik, Jr., President-Elect R. E. Somerby, Secretary
Statement of Ownership
Title of Publication: The Pan-Pacific Entomologist.
Frequency of Issue: Quarterly (January, April, July, October).
Location of Office of Publication, Business Office of Publisher and Owner: Pacific Coast Entomological Society,
California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, California 94118.
Editor: G. A. Marsh, Museum of Systematic Biology, University of California, Irvine, 92717
Managing Editor and Known Bondholders or other Security Holders: None.
This issue mailed 15 March 1982
Second Class Postage Paid at San Francisco, California and Additional offices.
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist (ISSN 0031-0603)
PRINTED BY THE ALLEN PRESS, INC., LAWRENCE, KANSAS 66044, U.S.A.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 321-326
ON THE IDENTITY OF SALDULA LATICOLLIS (REUTER)
(HETEROPTERA: SALDIDAE)
Per Lindskog
Section of Entomology, Swedish Museum of Natural History,
P.O. Box 50007, S-104 05 Stockholm, Sweden
Polhemus (1977) concluded that the American forms of shore bugs cur¬
rently referred to as Saldula palustris (Douglas) are specifically differen¬
tiated from the true S. palustris, a species originally described from England
and widely distributed in the Palaearctic region. According to that author,
the valid name of one of the American forms is Saldula fernaldi Drake.
This is a predominantly coastal species which is commonly distributed in
salt marsh habitats along the Pacific coast from Alaska to Baja California
and on the Atlantic coast from New England northwards (Polhemus and
Chapman, 1979). Independent studies by the present author fully confirm
the conclusions reached by Polhemus as to the specific separation of S.
palustris and the allied New World forms. However, my studies also show
that S. fernaldi is a synonym of Saldula laticollis (Reuter, 1875). As S.
laticollis has priority by age, this name must replace S. fernaldi as the valid
name of this form. This conclusion was reached after a revision of the type
material of S. laticollis and studies of the North American forms involved.
S. laticollis is listed by Polhemus (op. cit.) as a synonym of Saldula
pallipes (F.), therein following the view of Reuter (1890) and reiterated by
subsequent authors (Oshanin, 1908; Drake and Hoberlandt, 1951). Further,
“Siberia” is quoted as the terra typica of S. laticollis. However, as already
explained by Reuter (1912), the assignment of Siberia as the terra typica in
the original description of S. laticollis, as well as the more specific indication
“Ad Irkutsk habitans” given under the redescription of this form in Reuter
(1879) was based upon a misinterpretation. The type material of S. laticollis
had in fact been collected at Sitka on the Baranof Island, Alaska, by the
well-known Finnish entomologist and explorer, Reinhold Ferdinand Sahl-
berg, during his stay there in 1840-1841 (cf. Saalas, 1958), i.e. at a time when
the Alaskan Peninsula still was a Russian colony.
A revised synonymy and nomenclature of S. laticollis and included nom¬
inal forms is given below, together with supplementary taxonomic data on
this and allied species of the Holarctic S. pallipes-palustris complex. The
figures and descriptions of male genital structures are based upon dry
mounts prepared from fully sclerotized specimens, according to Lindskog
(1974).
322
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
NRS = Naturhistoriska Riksmuseet, Stockholm (the Swedish Museum of
Natural History).
Saldula laticollis (Reuter)
Acanthia (= Saida) laticollis Reuter, 1875: 544. LECTOTYPE male, ALAS¬
KA: Sitka (NRS), here designated. Reuter, 1879: 32 (redescription (as
Saida)). Reuter, 1890: 251 ( laticollis reduced to a variety of Acanthia
pallipes Fabricius, 1794). Reuter, 1912: 71 (discussion of taxonomic sta¬
tus, earlier statements of type locality of laticollis corrected). Drake and
Hoberlandt, 1951 (catalog; laticollis listed as synonym of Saldula pallipes
(F.)).
Saldula fernaldi Drake, 1949: 191. Drake, 1962: 116 (fernaldi synonymized
with Saldula palustris (Douglas, 1874)). Polhemus, 1977 (unpublished dis¬
sertation; fernaldi restored to specific status, separated from palustris).
Saldula notalis Drake, 1950: 4. Polhemus, 1977 (unpublished dissertation;
notalis synonymized with fernaldi).
Saldula notabilis Drake, 1950: 5 (alternate spelling for notalis Drake, 1950
in the same work). Drake and Hoberlandt, 1951 (catalog; adoption of
notabilis as the correct name).
Saldula palustris of authors (nec Douglas).
Type material. — The original description of S. laticollis was based upon
material deposited in Coll. NRS (“Mus. Holm.”). The number of specimens
was not stated by the author. Two specimens of the same species are present
under laticollis in Coll. NRS. They have no type label or any other deter¬
mination labels attached to them. However, they clearly represent the au¬
thentic material of this form, as evidenced by the locality and collector data
and their diagnostic features.
Lectotype male, labelled: “Sitka,” “Stal” /= Coll. Stal/, “Lectotypus
Acanthia laticollis Reuter, P. Lindskog.” Female, labelled: “Sitka,” “F.
Sahlberg/= collector/, “Paralectotypus Acanthia laticollis Reuter, P. Lind¬
skog.” Both specimens are pinned and in a fairly good state of preservation.
The primary diagnostic features (dorsal pilosity, hemelytral coloration) are
clearly observable. Total body length, male (lectotype) = 4.86 mm, female =
5.38 mm.
Taxonomic remarks. — The intricate problem of the taxonomic relation¬
ships of the Old and New World forms of the S. pallipes -palustris complex
has been a subject of much discussion and confusion (Cobben, 1960a;
Schuh, 1967; Stock, 1972; Polhemus, 1977). This confusion stems from the
fact that European populations of S. pallipes and palustris have served as
the basis of comparison when discussing the identity and status of the
American forms. Accordingly, the standard concept of these two species is
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
323
Fig. 1. Right paramere in front and inner view (A-G) and parandria, hind views (H-K) —
A + B, Saldula laticollis (orig. Oregon: Toledo) — C, idem (orig. California: Tomales Bay) —
D + E, S. pallipes (orig. Siberia: Abakan) — F + G, S. palustris (orig. Kamchatka) — H, S.
laticollis (orig. as in A) — J, S. pallipes (orig. as in D) — K, S. palustris (orig. as in F). ca =
carina.
based upon the differential diagnostic characters of the orderly or eunomic
patterns of sequential variation of the dark and light coloration of the hem-
elytra and in the length of the hairs of the processus sensualis of the male
parameres, as first elaborated in more detail by Wagner (1951) and Cobben
(1960b) and then primarily with regard to (West) European populations.
Both species have very wide trans-Palaearctic ranges, however, and pat¬
terns of geographic variation must be accounted for. In fact, a geographic
324
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
variation in hemelytral color eunomies between several Central European
populations of S. pallipes and palustris has recently been described (Kar-
necka, 1978). Moreover, populations from North America, notably the
northwestern regions (Alaska, etc.), should primarily be compared with pop¬
ulations from East Eurasia, viz. NE Siberia and Kamchatka, where the
presence of both species recently has been confirmed. I have had the op¬
portunity to study material of S. pallipes and palustris from their entire
Palaearctic range, including a very large material from the U.S.S.R. and
adjacent Asiatic regions in the collections of the Zoological Institute of the
Academy of Sciences of the U.S.S.R., Leningrad. When considering the
total spectrum of variability of S. pallipes and palustris, a complete inter¬
gradation and overlap in hemelytral color patterns, shape and proportions
of the body and body parts and features of the dorsal pilosity between these
species can be established. Thus none of these external features can be
employed as a universally valid character for identifying and separating
these geographically broadly overlapping species. However, when each re¬
gional situation in the phenetic interrelationships of these two species is
studied and treated separately, a more or less reliable separation by means
of various combinations of these characters is generally possible. A similar
situation is likely to exist among the American species of this complex.
The basic diagnostic characters differentiating S. pallipes and palustris
concern the structure and shape of the male parameres (Fig. 1D-G). S.
pallipes is primarily distinguished by the very long hairs of the processus
sensualis (Fig. ID) and by the shape of the inner side of the paramere body
(corpus parameri) which is produced as a sharp edge at the level of the
processus sensualis (Fig. IE) instead of being smooth as in palustris (Fig.
1G). Further, the parameres of S. pallipes are markedly longer and less
curved and the ventral carina (cf. Fig. 1A-B) proximal to the processus
sensualis is more strongly developed and prominent compared with palustris
(Fig. IE, G). The distinctive features of S. pallipes and palustris in the
structure and the overall shape and size of the parameres illustrated in Fig.
1 on the basis of specimens from Western Siberia and Kamchatka, respec¬
tively, are seen to agree quite closely with the situation previously described
for populations from Finland (Lindskog, 1974, Fig. 1), and have further been
verified in material from many other regions (e.g. North Africa, Middle and
Central Asia). In addition to the type material, specimens of S. laticollis
were studied from Alaska: Valdez Bay, Oregon: Yaquina River estuary, and
California: Tomales Bay and San Diego, which form part of the material of
Bahr and Schulte (1976), and which were determined by J. T. Polhemus (in
1973) as S. palustris and S. notalis. As stated by Polhemus (1977), S. la¬
ticollis (=S. fernaldi ) is distinguished by the constant presence of long,
curved, semi-recumbent or suberect setae on the head. The dorsal pilosity
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
325
is rather variable, sometimes markedly coarse and shaggy with several long¬
er, erect or suberect setae on pronotum ( =S . notalis). In S. palustris and
S. pallipes (Old World populations) the pubescence of the head and dorsum
is uniformly short and recumbent. The parameres of S. laticollis are rather
variable in shape and size, as partly shown by Fig. 1 and also noticed and
illustrated by Polhemus (1977). All specimens studied by me clearly differ
from S. palustris as well as S. pallipes by the ventrally more strongly car¬
inate paramere body (Fig. 1A-C) and the generally longer and more strongly
acuminate processus hamatus. S. laticollis further differs from S. pallipes
by the shorter hairs of the processus sensualis and through the lack of any
similarly marked edge-like structure on the inner side of the paramere body.
The male parandrial lobes of S. laticollis are separated by a moderately
wide notch and their inner membranous margins are only slightly converging
distad (Fig. 1H). In S. pallipes and palustris the parandria are distally more
broadly and evenly rounded and their inner margins more or less strongly
converging distad (Fig. 1J-K). Generally the parandria of S. pallipes are
more narrowly separated and often less extensively sclerotized compared
with S. palustris, as shown by the figures. These latter differences are es¬
sentially of a statistical nature only and cannot be used for a critical species
identification.
I have not been able to study authentic material of S. pallipes from the
New World. A few specimens in the aforementioned material from San
Diego determined as S. pallipes were found to be light color forms of S.
laticollis. Some specimens in NRS labelled “Colorado” (Morrison lgt.) have
been determined as “5. pallipes var.” by C. J. Drake. With respect to the
hemelytral color pattern they agree with S. pallipes as well as with S.
palustris, notably with some forms of the latter species occurring in the arid
zones of southern Russia and Middle Asia (relatively small size, pronotum
with a relatively dense and moderately long, fine, appressed, silvery or
golden pubescence). The parameres are also closely similar to S. palustris,
but the parandria are of a quite different shape, size, and configuration
compared with this and the other species above. This form probably rep¬
resents an undescribed species. The male genital structures of S. pallipes
from America figured by Polhemus (1977) well agree with the Old World
form, except for the apparently short hairs of the processus sensualis. More
studies are clearly needed in order to clarify the phenetic and taxonomic
relationships between the Old and New World forms of this taxon.
Acknowledgment
I am indebted to Dr H.-H. Weber, Kiel, GFR, for the loan of S. laticollis
from his collection.
326
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Literature Cited
Bahr, A., and G. Schulte. 1976. Die Verbreitung der Uferwanzen (Heteroptera: Saldidae) im
brackigen und marinen Litoral der Nordamerikanischen Pazifikkiiste. Mar. Biol., 36:37-
46.
Cobben, R. H. 1960a. The Heteroptera of the Netherlands Antilles. — III. Saldidae (Shore
bugs). In: Studies on the Fauna of Curasao and other Caribbean Islands (P. W. Hum-
melinck edit.), 11:44-61.
Cobben, R. H. 1960b. Die Uferwanzen Europas. Hemiptera Heteroptera. Saldidae. In: Sti-
chel, W. Illustrierte Bestimmungstabellen der Wanzen II. Europa, 3:209-263.
Douglas, J. W. 1874. British Heteroptera — additional species. Entomol. Mon. Mag., 11:9-12,
142-144.
Drake, C. J. 1949. Some American Saldidae (Hemiptera). Psyche (Camb.) 56:187-193.
Drake, C. J. 1950. Concerning North American Saldidae (Hemiptera). Bull. Brooklyn Ento¬
mol. Soc., 45:1-7.
Drake, C. J. 1962. Synonymic data and two new genera of shore-bugs (Hemiptera: Saldidae).
Proc. Biol. Soc. Wash., 75:115-124.
Drake, C. J., and L. Hoberlandt. 1951. Catalogue of genera and species of Saldidae. Acta
Entomol. Mus. Natur. Prag., 26 (376): 1-12.
Fabricius, J. C. 1794. Entomologia systematica emendata et aucta. Vol. 4. Hafniae.
Karnecka, H. 1978. A study of some characters in four species of Saldidae with special regard
to eunomies (Heteroptera). Acta Univ. Carol. (Biologica), 1975-1976:151-165.
Lindskog, P. 1974. Distributional and systematic notes on Saldula fucicolci (J. Sahib.) and
some other shore bugs of Eastern Fennoscandia (Heteroptera, Saldidae). Notul. Ento¬
mol., 54:33-56.
Oshanin, B. 1908. Verzeichnis der Palaearktischen Hemipteren mit besonderer Beriicksich-
tigung ihrer Verteilung im Russischen Reiche. I. Band Heteroptera. II. Lieferung Tin-
gidae — Acanthiidae. St. Petersburg.
Polhemus, J. T. 1977. The biology and systematics of the Saldidae of Mexico and Middle
America. Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Colorado at Boulder, 606 pp.
Polhemus, J. T., and H. C. Chapman. 1979. Family Saldidae. In: The Semiaquatic and Aquatic
Hemiptera of California (Heteroptera: Hemiptera) (A. S. Menke edit.). Bull. Calif. Insect
Surv., 21:16-33.
Reuter, O. M. 1875. Hemipteres nouveaux. Petite Nouv. Entomol., 7 (136): 544-545.
Reuter, O. M. 1879. De Hemipteris e Sibiria orientali nonnullis adnotationes criticae. Ofvers.
Finska VetenskSoc. Forh., 21:42-63.
Reuter, O. M. 1890. Adnotationes Hemipterologicae. Rev. Entomol., 9:248-254.
Reuter, O. M. 1912. Hemipterologische Miscellen. Ofvers. Finska VetenskSoc. Forh. 54, A
(7): 1-76.
Saalas, U. 1958. Reinhold Ferdinand Sahlberg. Forschungsreisender, Naturwissenschaftler,
Arzt und Gutbesitzer 1811-1874. Acta Entomol. Fenn., 14:1-255. (In Finnish with a
summary in German.)
Schuh, T. 1967. The shore bugs (Hemiptera: Saldidae) of the Great Lakes region. Contrib.
Amer. Entomol. Inst., 2 (2): 1-35.
Stock, M. W. 1972. Biological studies on Saldula palustris (Douglas) with emphasis on factors
influencing wing pigmentation (Heteroptera: Saldidae). Ph.D. Dissertation, Oregon State
University, 172 pp.
Wagner, E. 1951. Notes on Saldidae. Acta Entomol. Mus. Natur. Prag., 26 (371): 1-4.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 327-331
THE LARVAL DESCRIPTION AND ECOLOGICAL NOTES OF A
CADDISFLY, NECTOPSYCHE TAVARA (ROSS) FROM
THE CENTRAL FLORIDA REFUGIUM
(TRICHOPTERA: LEPTOCERIDAE)
Jerrell J. Daigle
Orange County Pollution Control Dept., 2008 E. Michigan Avenue,
Orlando, Florida 32806
AND
James D. Haddock
Department of Biological Sciences, Indiana University-Purdue
University at Fort Wayne, Fort Wayne 46805
The genus Nectopsyche (formerly Leptocella ) in North America was re¬
vised by Haddock (1977) and at that time the larval stage of N. tavara was
unknown. This paper provides a description of the larvae and notes on their
bionomics.
Nectopsyche tavara (Ross) appears to be restricted to the lakes of the
central Florida highlands region. Adults have been recorded from Lake,
Levy and Orange counties (Ross, 1944) and have also been collected from
Lake Placid in Highlands County and Prairie Lake in Seminole County. The
hypothesis of a Florida refugium has had considerable support by zoogeog¬
raphers working with a variety of organisms. Clench and Turner (1956)
showed that the antiquity and distinctiveness of the freshwater molluscan
fauna offer evidence that the central Florida region was an island during the
Pliocene and Pleistocene eras. They also found that a considerable number
of species of freshwater molluscs did not range east or south of the Suwan¬
nee River in northcentral Florida and that the fauna indicated that the head¬
waters of the Chattahoochee and Flint Rivers have persisted since mid-
Tertiary time. They termed the Florida refugium area “Orange Island,” a
modification of the “island of Florida,” coined by Dali (1903). Howden
(1969) also cites several additional examples of well-studied groups such as
some meloids, scarabs, the genus Melanoplus and certain lycosid spiders
that show evidence of having survived the Pleistocene in several parts of
peninsular Florida.
Recently, a series of adults and the previously unknown larvae of N.
tavara were collected from Lake Conway and nearby Lake Fredrica. These
lakes may be characterized as unpolluted, good- water quality lakes falling
in the mesotrophic range of eutrophication. Utilizing the limnological lake
328
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
1
Fig. 1. Nectopsyche tavara head capsule, pro and mesothorax, dorsal view, x80
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
329
Fig. 2. Nectopsyche tavara swimming brush on metathoracic leg, lateral view, x50.
classification scheme of Shannon and Brezonik (1972) the two lakes would
be considered mesotrophic in three categories. Water analyses revealed that
chlorophyll a readings for Lakes Conway and Fredrica were 6.5 and 5.0 mg/
1 respectively. Total phosphates were 0.025 and 0.026 mg/1 with total organic
nitrogen 0.60 and 0.50 mg/1.
The larvae are phytophagous, feeding on submerged aquatic macrophytes
such as southern naiad (Najas guadalupensis (Spreng.) Magnus), fan wort
0 Cabomba caroliniana Grey), Illinois pondweed {Potamogeton illinoensis
Morong), stonewort ( Nitella megacarpa L.), and hydrilla ( Hydrilla verticil-
lata Royle). Adult associations were made from larvae reared in the labo¬
ratory on these plants with various size groups observed in daytime feeding.
No attempt was made to establish a chronological life-history with detailed
instar classification data. Both early and late instar larvae swim utilizing the
swimming brush on the metathoracic leg. The larval case is elongate-linear,
composed primarily of sand grains and typically with a plant stem attached
to the antero-dorsal side (Fig. 3). The length of the case averages about 18
mm. Prior to pupation the larvae affix themselves to suitable sites on food
plant leaves and stems by means of an anterior and a posterior secreted
holdfast. The larvae modify their pupal chamber by sectioning off part of
the posterior case and any inherent plant matter. Pupal duration averages
about 20 days except for the overwintering generation.
Adults can be collected from March to October on vegetation, grasses
and trees along the shoreline. They appear to be multivoltive as many size
classes of larvae can be collected. An emergence period occurs in late March
330
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 3. Nectopsyche tavara larval case, lateral view, xl6.
followed by the peak summer emergence in early July. A smaller fall emer¬
gence follows in late September.
Description. — Larval characters for N. tavara are consistent with the
generic diagnosis of Nectopsyche larvae provided by Wiggins (1977). A
ventral band of tiny spines lateral to the anal opening, characteristic of some
mature Nectopsyche larvae, is absent in this species.
Diagnosis. — Larvae of N. tavara can be distinguished from other Nearc-
tic species of Nectopsyche on the basis of the following combination of
characters: anterior half of fronto-clypeus with medial, longitudinal, brown
stripe dividing four oval, luteous spots that appear as “figures 8’s”; an
inconspicuous gill found in the posterolateral region of the metanotum; a
well-developed swimming brush on the metathoracic leg and the absence of
gills on the first abdominal segment.
Mature larvae are very similar to those of N. spiloma but can be distin¬
guished by the presence of numerous luteous spots surrounded by brown
pigmentation in the posterior half of the gena in addition to the coloration
of the fronto-clypeus as mentioned above. N. spiloma is allopatric from N.
tavara and is common in the large rivers of the Mississippi River drainage,
in the Edwards plateau of Texas as well as extending into Central America.
Larvae of N. tavara also bear a superficial resemblance to a western
species, N. gracilis (senior synonym of N. intervena Banks in Wiggins,
1977) but shows consistent difference in head and pronotal color patterning.
In addition, N. gracilis larvae have no metanotal gills.
Mature larva. — Maximum body length 13 mm. Head (Fig. 1). — Anterior
margin of lab rum with narrow transverse brown band; mandible with basal
two-thirds luteous, distal portion black; anterolateral margins of fronto-clyp¬
eus luteous; anterior region of fronto-clypeus with two pairs of luteous
spots, in some larvae separation of spots indistinct; posterior half of fronto-
clypeus with four luteous markings of unequal size; entire dorsum of head
with luteous oval to oblong-shaped spots separated by dark brown irregu¬
larly-shaped reticulations; subocular line of weakness present, bisecting
gena; posterior portion of gena with many luteous spots similar to those on
fronto-clypeus; vertical area of gena luteous with light brown border along
medial margin; black spot present anterior to base of antenna; ventral apo-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
331
tome triangular, pale. Thorax. — Pronotum with area medial to lines of weak¬
ness ranging from light to dark brown posteromedial portion luteous; lateral
areas of pronotum with marbled blotching as seen on dorsum of head; scler-
otized portion of mesonotum predominantly brown with luteous indistinct
stripe in central area; posterolateral corner of metanotum with dark brown
sclerotized stripes running posteriorly; inconspicuous gill present in pos¬
terolateral area of metonotum. Legs. — Legs luteous to light brown in color;
tarsus of pro thoracic leg with 3 or 4 bristles on ventral margin; prothoracic
tibia with two stout spines on ventral margin near apex and two bristles
lying slightly mesad; prothoracic femur with many bristles on ventral mar¬
gin; mesothoracic tibial spines on ventral margin shorter than maximum
width of tibia; well-developed swimming brush on metathoracic leg (Fig. 2)
consisting of double fringe of setae on femur and tibia and single row of
setae on tarsus. Abdomen. — Tracheal gill formula on abdominal segments:
1-0; II-3; III- 1 ; IV- 1; V-l; VI-1; VII-0,1; abdominal segment I with sclero¬
tized bar and circular roughened area on each lateral hump characteristic
for genus; ventral band of tiny spines absent from area lateral to anal open¬
ing.
Literature Cited
Clench, W. J., and R. D. Turner. 1956. Freshwater Molluscs of Alabama, Georgia and Florida
from the Escambia to the Suwannee River. Fla. State Mus. Biol. Sci. Bull., 1:97-239.
Dali, W. H. 1890-1903. Tertiary Molluscs of Florida. Trans. Wagner Free Inst. Sci. Phila.,
(1-6) 1654 p. 60 pis.
Haddock, J. D. 1977. The Biosystematics of the Caddis Fly Genus Nectopsyche in North
America with Emphasis on the Aquatic stages. Amer. Midi. Natur., 98:382-421.
Howden, H. F. 1969. Effects of the Pleistocene on North American Insects. Ann. Rev.
Entomol., 14:39-56.
Ross, H. H. 1944. The Caddis Flies or Trichoptera of Illinois. Bull. Ill. Nat. Hist. Surv.,
23(1):326 p.
Shannon, E. E., and P. L. Brezonik. 1972. Limnological Characteristics of North and Central
Florida Lakes. Limnol. Oceanog., 17:97-100.
Wiggins, G. B. 1977. Larvae of the North American Caddisfly Genera (Trichoptera). Univer¬
sity of Toronto Press. Toronto and Buffalo, 401 p.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 332-340
BIOLOGICAL OBSERVATIONS ON THREE TRYPOXYLON WASPS IN
THE SUBGENUS TRYPARGILUM 1 FROM COSTA RICA:
T. NITIDUM SCHULTHESSI, T. SAUSSUREI, AND
T. LACTITARSE (HYMENOPTERA: SPHECIDAE)
Rollin E. Coville
Division of Entomology and Parasitology, 201 Wellman Hall,
University of California, Berkeley 94720
The genus Trypoxylon subgenus Trypargilum occur in temperate and
tropical regions of the Western Hemisphere (Bohart and Menke, 1976).
These solitary spider wasps are either mud daubers or they nest in pre¬
existing cavities. They are unusual among all wasps in that males normally
remain in nests as guards while females forage (Peckham and Peckham,
1895; Rau, 1928; Fattig, 1936; Paetzel, 1973; Coville and Coville, 1980). In
addition, many species groups and complexes of Trypargilum appear to
have distinctive nest architecture, cocoon morphology, and prey prefer¬
ences (Krombein, 1967; Matthews and Matthews, 1968; Lin, 1969; Coville,
1979). The last three traits may become useful taxonomic characters when
information becomes available on more species, especially in the Neotrop¬
ics. Coville and Coville (1980) recently reported on the biology of Trypox¬
ylon ( Trypargilum ) tenoctitlan Richards in Costa Rica. The purpose of this
paper is to present biological data obtained from nests of three other Costa
Rican Trypargilum during that study: T. nitidum schulthessi Richards, T.
lactitarse Saussure, and T. saussurei Rohwer.
Methods
Trap-nests with borings of 4.8, 6.4, and 9.5 mm drilled to a depth of 152
mm were used to obtain wasp nests. Coville (1979) and Coville and Coville
(1980) describe the technique in detail.
The study was conducted in 1975 in Guanacaste Province, Costa Rica.
One study site was 25 km SW of Bagaces at the Organization for Tropical
Studies Field Station at Palo Verde on the Comelco Property. Two other
sites were 4 km NW Canas at La Pacifica 1) in the riverine forest along the
Rio Corobici and 2) on the porch of a cabin.
Trypoxylon {Trypargilum) nitidum schulthessi Richards
Richards (1934) placed T. nitidum Smith in the subgroup of T. nitidum
{=nitidum complex) of the nitidum group. This polytypic species is found
1 The author prefers to treat Trypargilum as a subgenus until its relationship to the diverse
species groups of subgenus Trypoxylon is carefully studied.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
333
Table 1. Contents of 6 Trypoxylon nitidum schulthessi nests from La Pacifica, Costa Rica.
Rio Corobici Cabin Porch
Bore Diameter (mm)
throughout the tropics. Trypoxylon nitidum schulthessi, previously known
only from the original description of Richards (1936), occurs in Costa Rica.
This species occupied 6 trap-nests at La Pacifica, Costa Rica. Three traps
were from one bundle set out in the narrow forest along the Rio Corobici.
The other three were from bundles attached to a chair on the cabin porch.
One nest from the Rio Corobici was in a 6.4 mm boring; the other 5 were
in 4.8 mm borings. Contents of these nests are summarized in Table 1.
Adult behavior. — On February 7, each of two pairs of T. nitidum schul¬
thessi entered trap-nests on the cabin porch. The males followed the females
that were searching for nests. Thereafter, the males remained in the nests
as guards with their heads facing outwards at the nest entrance. Three
marked males and two marked females of T. tenoctitlan, a larger species,
were observed trying to enter the nests of T. nitidum schulthessi. The guard
(presumably the male) successfully defended his nest except for one ex¬
tremely aggressive female that had to be repeatedly driven away (see Coville
and Coville, 1980).
One of the wasps in each of the nests on the porch regularly spent the
night away from the nest and returned at 0647-0732 AM CST, a time which
was 7-29 minutes before the males of T. tenoctitlan returned to their nests.
At that time air temperature was about 25°C.
When the female returned to the nest with prey, she alighted at the en¬
trance. The male guard then left the tunnel, mounted the female’s back, and
attempted to copulate as the female entered the nest head first.
334
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
i _ i
Figs. 1-6. Cocoons of Trypargilum (anterior on the left). Fig. 1. T. nitidum schulthessi.
Fig. 2. T. tridentatum. Fig. 3. T. orizabense. Fig. 4. T. tenoctitlan from trap-nest with 9.5
mm diameter tube. Fig. 5. Same from 6.4 mm trap-nest. Fig. 6. T. clavatum. Scale equals
5 mm.
One of the 2 nests started on February 7 was completed on February 16
and contained 8 provisioned cells; the other nest was completed on February
18 and contained 6 provisioned cells.
Nest architecture. — Nests consisted of a linear series of provisioned cells
separated by mud partitions, followed by one or more vestibular cells, and
a mud closure plug. A preliminary mud plug was always present at or near
the inner end of the trap-nest boring. The 6.4 mm nest contained 8 provi¬
sioned cells and one vestibular cell. The 4.8 mm nests contained 2 to 8
provisioned cells and 2 or 3 vestibular cells. Closing plugs consisted of 2
elements resembling 2 thickened, closely spaced cell partitions. Closing
plugs were at the entrance in 4 nests but were recessed 12 mm in the 6.4
mm nest and 18 mm in one of the 4.8 mm nests. The last nest contained
only 2 provisioned cells. Nest dimensions are shown in Table 2.
Prey. — Cells were provisioned with 7 to 17 spiders ( x — 10.9, N = 7).
Identifications of 52 spider prey are as follows:
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
335
ARANEIDAE: 2 S 6 Eustala sp.; 4 imm., 2 9 2,5 6 6 Metazygici sp.; 2
6 6 Metepeira sp.; 34 imm. undetermined Araneidae.
THERIDIIDAE: 3 9 9 Theridion sp.
Life history. — The egg, about 2 mm long, is attached to the abdomen of
one of the last spiders stored. Eclosion of the larva takes place about 1-1.5
days after the egg is laid. One larva completed feeding on 12 spider prey in
about 2 days, spent 2 days spinning its cocoon, and then pupated 7 days
later. The imaginal molt occurred after 20 days, but the adult waited 4 more
days before attempting to chew through the gelatin capsule in which it was
confined for observation.
The time interval from nest completion to emergence of the adult from
the cocoon is 34 to 49 days. No diapause or quiescent stage was noted. The
distribution of the sexes in the nest appears to be random.
The cocoon is dark brown, varnished in appearance, and brittle. It is
cylindrical with the posterior end rounded; the anterior end is truncate with
a median nipple, which is gray and more coarsely granular than the rest of
the cocoon (Fig. 1). Two male cocoons were 8.7 and 9.5 mm long and 2.9
mm wide. Six female cocoons ranged 9.7-11.0 mm long (x = 10.2) and 3.0-
3.6 mm wide (x = 3.3).
Natural enemies. — Four females of Neochrysis lecointei (Ducke) were
reared from the 6.4 mm nest (Table 1). The chrysidids emerged from March
25 to 31, whereas 3 females of T. nitidum schulthessi reared from the same
nest emerged on March 15 and 16. This late emergence of the parasite is
unusual [and perhaps indicates poor adaptation of N . lecointei to T. nitidum
schulthessi .] The innermost cell in one of the 4.8 mm borings was infested
by Py emotes mites.
Trypoxylon ( Trypargilum ) lactitarse Saussure
This species occurs from Canada to Argentina. Richards (1934) placed T.
lactitarse (under the name cinereum ) in the punctulatum group. Its biology
(under the names striatum and albopilosum) is well known in North Amer¬
ica (Peckham and Peckham, 1895; Rau, 1928; Krombein, 1967; Medler,
1967).
Trypoxylon lactitarse occupied 2 trap-nests in Costa Rica. A 9.5 mm nest
was from a bundle set out on January 12 at the Rio Corobici site at La
Pacifica. The nest was collected on January 31 along with the female wasp
that was constructing the closing plug. No male wasp was observed at the
nest. A 6.4 mm nest set out on January 14 at Palo Verde was collected on
February 25 and had a chrysidid emergence hole in the closing plug.
Nest architecture. — Nest structure was similar to that of T. nitidum schul¬
thessi. Both lactitarse nests had preliminary mud plugs deposited at the
inner end of the tunnels. The 9.5 mm nest had 7 provisioned cells and 1
336
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 2. Nest dimensions of Trypoxylon subgenus Trypargilum from trap-nests in Costa
Rica.
1 Female cells are significantly longer than male cells (t = 2.95, df = 15, p < 0.05).
vestibular cell. The 6.4 mm nest contained 3 provisioned cells and 2 vesti¬
bular cells. Nest dimensions are shown in Table 2. All cell partitions in the
6.4 mm nest and most partitions in the 9.5 mm nest had a globule of mud
at the center of the outer surface. The globules of mud were probably de¬
posited by the female wasps after they detected a chrysidid oviposition hole
in a partition. The nests were heavily parasitized by chrysidids.
Prey. — Two cells from the 9.5 mm nest each had 7 spider prey. Identifi¬
cations of 13 of these spiders are as follows:
ARANEIDAE: 3 $ 2 , 1 8 Araneus pegnia (Walckenaer); 6imm. Eriophora
sp.
THERIDIIDAE: 1 imm. Argyrodes sp.
SALTICIDAE: 1 $ Pseudicius sp.
THOMISIDAE: 1 $ Misumenops sp.
Life history and natural enemies. — The first 5 cells in the 9.5 mm nest
contained developing larvae on January 31. Female T. lactitarse emerged
on May 23 and 28 from cocoons taken from the first and second cells. A
male from the fourth cell emerged on May 22. Male Neochtysis lecointei
emerged from the third (date undetermined) and fifth cell on March 19. On
January 31 the sixth cell contained a first instar chrysidid larva devouring
a wasp egg attached to the abdomen of a spider, and the seventh cell con-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
337
tained a chrysidid egg near the inner end and a wasp egg on a spider ab¬
domen near the outer end. Both cell contents were preserved.
The first two cells in the 6.4 mm nest contained wasp cocoons on February
25. Male T. lactitarse emerged on May 13 and 14. A chrysidid had presum¬
ably emerged from the third cell before the nest was collected, since the cell
contained remnants of a chrysidid cocoon.
The cocoon of T. lactitarse has been described by Krombein (1956, 1967),
Balduf (1961), and Medler (1967) from nests collected in the United States.
Cocoons are similar in Costa Rica. The brittle, dark brown cocoons are
cylindrical with the posterior end rounded, and the anterior end usually
flared outwardly to the walls of the boring, the amount of flare being de¬
pendent on the tunnel diameter. Two cocoons from the 9.5 mm nest had the
anterior end bluntly rounded. Krombein (1967) reported similar occurrences
in large diameter tubes. The anterior face of the cocoon is convex, gray,
and more coarsely granular than the rest of the cocoon. In the 9.5 mm nest
one cocoon was 15.8 mm long, 5 mm wide at the middle, and 9.0 mm wide
at the anterior end. Another cocoon with the anterior end bluntly rounded
was 16.4 mm long and 5.2 mm wide.
Tiypoxylon ( Trypargilum ) saussurei Rohwer
Tiypoxylon saussurei, a member of the spinosum group of Richards
(1934), has been confused with the similar T. salti Richards, but the male
genitalia are quite different. T. saussurei is found in Central America and
southern Mexico.
This species occupied a 4.8 mm trap-nest at the cabin porch site at La
Pacifica. The nest was indirectly determined to be that of T. saussurei, since
no adults were reared. Nevertheless, I was able to identify 1 female that
died shortly before emerging from the pupa as either T. salti Richards or T.
saussurei. Since numerous males that I have seen from Guanacaste Province
have all been T. saussurei, I assume that the female is also of that species.
Adult behavior. — On February 7 two wasps slowly flew and hovered
around the cabin door. One of them, presumably the female, was examining
dark knots and beetle holes and entered a 4.8 mm trap-nest that I held up
to her. The nest was attached to the arm of a chair, and the wasp completed
it on February 16.
When the female returned to the nest with spider prey, the male left the
boring and mounted the female’s back as she entered head first. On Feb¬
ruary 12 and 13 a marked T. tenoctitlan female harassed the wasps and once
succeeded in entering the nest and chasing the male out. The marked female
was forcibly removed with a pair of forceps. The male reentered shortly,
followed by the resident female who returned with a spider.
Nest architecture. — The nest contained a preliminary plug at the inner
338
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
end of the tube followed by 3 provisioned cells and 2 vestibular cells. The
closing plug consisted of a single mass of mud. Nest dimensions are shown
in Table 2.
Prey. — The second and third cells contained 12 and 17 spider prey, re¬
spectively. Identifications of 28 spiders are as follows:
ARANEIDAE: 1 imm. Acanthepeira sp.; 2 imm., 1 8 Araneus pegnia
(Walckenaer); 2 imm. Larinia directa (Hentz); 1 imm., 1 8 Metepeira
sp.; 1 imm., 1 8 undetermined Araneidae.
PHOLCIDAE: 7 imm. Physocyclus globosus (Taczanowski).
OXYOPIDAE: 1 imm. Oxyopes sp.
SALTICIDAE: 1 imm. Bryantella sp.; 1 imm., 1 9 Corythalia sp.; 2 88
Hentzia sp.; 2 imm. Lyssomanes sp.; 1 8 Rudra sp.; 1 imm. Thiodina
sylvana (Hentz).
THOMISIDAE: 1 imm. Imams sp.
Life histoiy. — An egg attached to the side of the abdomen of a pholcid
spider was in the third cell. The cocoon is brittle, dark brown and varnished
in appearance. It is cylindrical with the posterior end rounded and with a
gray collar extending beyond the anterior end.
Discussion
Richards (1934) divided Tiypargilum into five species groups: superbum,
albitarse, punctulatum, nitidum, and spinosum groups. He also recognized
several species complexes within the nitidum group: aureovestitum, exca-
vatum, fugax, nitidum, and vagum complexes. This discussion pertains to
the punctulatum, nitidum, and spinosum groups.
In the spinosum group, besides T. saussurei, prey and cocoons are known
of T. clavatum clavatum Say (Krombein, 1967), T. clavatum johannis (Rich¬
ards) (Krombein, 1967), T. californicum ( =arizonense , Matthews and Mat¬
thews, 1968), and T. texense (Kurczewski, 1963; Lin, 1969; personal obs.
of cocoons). Lin (1969) also reported on prey of another species, T. spi¬
nosum Cameron. As pointed out by Matthews and Matthews (1968) the prey
of the spinosum group include a wide variety of spider families with as many
wandering spiders (those that pursue or ambush prey, e.g., Oxyopidae,
Salticidae, and Thomisidae), as snarebuilders (those that entangle their prey
in webs, e.g., Araneidae, Pholcidae, and Theridiidae). The general pattern
of prey preferences in Tiypargilum are often still evident when sample sizes
are small, as in T. saussurei (N = 28). Cocoons of all spinosum group
species have a gray collar that extends beyond the anterior end (Fig. 6).
Within the nitidum group biological data exist only for representatives of
the nitidum complex, fugax complex, and a species of uncertain placement,
T. tridentatum Packard (Krombein, 1967). In the nitidum complex, besides
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
339
T. nitidum schulthessi, prey and cocoons are also known of T. collinum
collinum Smith (Krombein, 1967), T. collinum rubrocinctum (Packard)
(Krombein, 1967), and T. orizabense Richards (Coville, 1979). Their prey
include primarily snarebuilding spiders, and their cocoons have a truncate
anterior end that bears a small median nipple (Figs. 1 and 3). Cocoons of
T. nitidum schulthessi and T. collinum are virtually indistinguishable (Fig.
1), but those of T. orizabense are relatively more elongate (Fig. 3). Prey of
T. tridentatum are similar to the nitidum complex. However, cocoons of T.
tridentatum have a more rounded anterior end, and often have a weak nipple
(Fig. 2).
Cocoons of T. tenoctitlan Richards {nitidum group, fugax complex, Figs.
4 and 5) described by Coville and Coville (1980) are indistinguishable from
those of T. lactitarse (punctulatum group). Cocoons of both species have
the anterior end flaring outwardly to the walls of the nesting tube. This
suggests that the punctulatum group and the fugax complex are closely
related. In fact, Bohart and Menke (1976) have suggested combining the
punctulatum, nitidum, and spinosum groups on the basis of adult mor¬
phology. Cocoon characteristics of the punctulatum and spinosum groups
are no more distinctive than those of species complexes of the nitidum
group .
Acknowledgments
I thank Dr. H. V. Daly, Dr. J. A. Powell, and Dr. J. A. Chemsak for
reviewing the manuscript. I am grateful to the following individuals who
kindly provided taxonomic determinations: Dr. R. M. Bohart (Chrysididae);
Dr. H. W. Levi, Dr. W. J. Gertsch, and Mr. C. Griswold (Aranaea). Pamela
L. Coville assisted in the field study. I am indebted to Dr. G. W. Frankie
for the opportunity to work in Costa Rica.
Literature Cited
Balduf, W. V. 1961. Insects from the tunnels of Xylocopa virginica (Linn.) (Col., Lep., Dipt.,
Hym.). Bull. Brooklyn Entomol. Soc., 56:81-85.
Bohart, R. M., and A. S. Menke. 1976. Sphecid wasps of the world. Univ. Calif. Press,
Berkeley, 695 pp.
Coville, R. E. 1979. Biological observations of Trypoxylon ( Trypargilum ) orizabense Rich¬
ards in Arizona (Hymenoptera: Sphecidae). J. Kansas Entomol. Soc., 52:613-620.
Coville, R. E., and P. L. Coville. 1980. Nesting biology and male behavior of Trypoxylon
(' Trypargilum ) tenoctitlan in Costa Rica (Hymenoptera: Sphecidae). Ann. Entomol. Soc.
Am., 73:110-119.
Fattig, P. W. 1936. Nest building of Trypoxylon politifonne Roh. Can. Entomol., 68:44-45.
Krombein, K. V. 1956. Biological and taxonomic notes on the wasps of Lost River State
Park, West Virginia, with additions to the faunal list (Hymenoptera, Aculeata). Proc.
Entomol. Soc. Washington, 58:153-161.
340
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Krombein, K. V. 1967. Trap-nesting wasps and bees; life histories, nests, and associates.
Smithsonian Press, Washington, D.C., 570 pp.
Kurczewski, F. E. 1963. A first Florida record and note on the nesting of Trypoxylon ( Try -
pargilum) texense Saussure (Hymenoptera: Sphecidae). Fla. Entomol., 46:243-245.
Lin, C. S. 1969. Biology of Trypargilum spinosum , with notes on T. texense and T. politum
at Lake Texoma (Hymenoptera: Sphecidae: Trypoxyloninae). Wasmann J. Biol.,
27:125-133.
Matthews, R. W., and J. R. Matthews. 1968. A note on Trypargilum arizonense in trap nests
from Arizona, with a review of prey preferences and cocoon structure in the genus
(Hymenoptera: Sphecidae). Psyche (Cambr., Mass.), 75:285-293.
Medler, J. T. 1967. Biology of Trypoxylon in trap nests in Wisconsin (Hymenoptera: Spheci¬
dae). Am. Midi. Nat., 78:344-358.
Paetzel, M. M. 1973. Behavior of the male Trypoxylon rubrocinctum (Hymenoptera: Spheci¬
dae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 49:26-30.
Peckham, G. W., and E. G. Peckham. 1895. Notes on the habits of Trypoxyllon rubrocinctum
and Trypoxyllon albopilosum. Psyche (Cambr., Mass.), 7:303-306.
Rau, P. 1928. Field studies in the behavior of the non-social wasps. Trans. Acad. Sci. St.
Louis, 25:325-489.
Richards, O. W. 1934. The American species of the genus Trypoxylon. Trans. R. Entomol.
Soc. Lond., 82:173-362.
Richards, O. W. 1936. On American species of Trypoxylon. Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist., 18:457-
463.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 341-346
THE LARVA OF SYMPETRUM MADIDUM (HAGEN)
(ODONATA: LIBELLULIDAE)
Robert A. Cannings
Entomology Division, British Columbia Provincial Museum,
Victoria, B.C., V8V 1X4, Canada
Sympetrum madidum (Hagen) is a dragonfly widely distributed through
much of western North America, ranging from the Northwest Territories
south through British Columbia to California and east to Manitoba and Mis¬
souri (Walker and Corbet, 1975).
In 1904 J. G. Needham published a description of a single Sympetrum
larva that he attributed by supposition to S. madidum (Needham, 1904).
The characteristics of this larva subsequently were treated as those of S.
madidum in other works (Byers, 1927; Needham and Westfall, 1955).
Recently, Walker and Corbet (1975) recognized that the S. madidum adult
was similar to those of S. corruptum and S. illotum which were considered
by Needham and Fisher (1936) and Needham and Westfall (1955) and others
to belong to a separate genus, Tarnetrum. Consequently, Walker and Corbet
(1975) placed S. madidum in a subgenus Tarnetrum within Sympetrum,
agreeing with Gloyd and Wright (1959) and Kormondy (1958, 1960) in not
giving Tarnetrum full generic rank.
The larvae of the subgenus Tarnetrum are different from those of other
Sympetrum species: they are larger, have reduced lateral spines and lack
dorsal hooks on the abdomen. Needham’s larva was considerably smaller
than the expected size of the larva of S. madidum, and moreover, had dorsal
hooks and long lateral spines. This, as well as Needham’s professed doubts
as to the identity of the larva he described, led Walker and Corbet (1975)
to disregard the 1904 description and consider the larva of S. madidum to
be unknown.
On 19 June 1978 at Riske Creek, British Columbia (51°58', 122°30') I found
a teneral S. madidum female with an exuvia about one m away. The as¬
sociation of adult and exuvia was not conclusive, however, and despite the
fact that the exuvia fitted all the requirements for a larva of S. madidum
(the other species in the subgenus are not known to occur anywhere near
this region), no definite claim for the discovery of the larva could be made.
Similar larvae were collected from a pond in Langford, ten km west of
Victoria, British Columbia (48°28', 123°30') on 3 June 1979. On 10 June an
adult male and female S. madidum emerged from these larvae in the labo¬
ratory and another female did so on 11 June. A second collection of larvae
from the same pond on 16 June produced ten more adults.
342
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Sympetrum madidum, final-instar larva, dorsal view. Scale line = 2 mm.
Sympetrum madidum (Hagen), final instar of larva
(Fig. 1)
Description. — Male and female similar except in minor aspects of devel¬
oping genitalia. Coloration described from living specimens. Those pre¬
served in 70-80 percent ethanol lose all green color and light areas become
yellow-brown; darker areas become medium to red-brown. Fresh exuviae
are ash-brown. Total length 17.8-20.3 mm (19.0 ± 0.26 mm) (range with
mean and standard error in parentheses; n = 10).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
343
Head with dorsum brown; eyes brown with black stripes across omma-
tidia and bordered posteriorly by white bar (Fig. 6). Antennae with socket
and segments 1 and 2 white, 3 brown, 4-6 brown with apices white, 7 white
with apex black. Prementum and labial palps light brown, with scattered
dark spots especially on the palps. Head 5. 2-5. 5 mm (5.3 ± 0.03 mm) across
eyes, 2. 7-2. 8 mm (2.7 ± 0.02 mm) long at midline. Antennae with segments
(from base) having mean lengths of 0.20, 0.33, 0.43, 0.22, 0.35, 0.59 and
0.49 mm. Division between segments 3 and 4 less distinct than between
others; one exuvia from Riske Creek with segments 3 and 4 fused, giving
6 segments in total, the third segment measuring 0.53 mm. Labium as in
Fig. 5 (terminology as in Corbet, 1953); venter of folded prementum (ex¬
cluding hinge) 4. 2-4. 5 mm (4.3 ± 0.02 mm) long, 4. 3-4. 6 mm (4.4 ± 0.03
mm) at widest point and 1.0-1. 2 mm (1.1 ± 0.02 mm) at base. Ratio of
length to greatest width 0.95-1.0 (0.98 ± 0.01). Folded prementum extending
posteriorly to middle of mesocoxae. Premental setae 13-18 (15.3 ± 0.30) on
each side, the inner 2 or 3 usually minute; 8-10 very short setae on each
side of non-crenulate distal margin of median lobe of prementum. Labial
palps with 10-13 (11.4 ± 0.23) palpal setae; 12-15 shallow, rounded cren-
ulations on distal margin of palp, each crenulation with 2-4 short spiniform
setae diminishing in size dorsally (Fig. 4).
Thorax and wing sheaths brown with dark brown markings on dorsal
midline of pro thorax and laterally on thorax dorsal to coxae. Legs yellow-
brown, coxae and trochanters margined with dark brown. Femora with
brown bands, one at apex, a wider one at middle of distal half and one at
middle of proximal half; distal bands on metafemora fused in some speci¬
mens. Tibiae with dark bands at base and apex, tarsal segments with dark
apices. Setae on legs pale, those on tibiae up to 2.0 mm long. Hindwing
sheath 5. 3-6. 6 mm (5.7 ± 0.07 mm) long, extending to anterior margin of
abdominal segment 6. Metafemur 5. 3-5. 7 mm (5.5 ± 0.05 mm), metatibia
6. 6-7. 3 mm (6.9 ± 0.08 mm) and metatarsus 2. 5-2. 9 mm (2.7 ± 0.04 mm)
long.
Abdomen green-brown with brown punctae; setal bases on posterior mar¬
gin of segments black. Setae on segment 10 pale, up to 1.7 mm long. Ab¬
domen widest at segment 6, 5. 0-5. 9 mm (5.5 ± 0.09 mm). Epiproct (Figs.
2 & 3) 1.3-1. 4 mm (1.3 ± 0.02 mm) long and 1.0-1. 1 mm (1.1 ± 0.01 mm)
wide at base; paraprocts 1.6- 1.9 mm (1.8 ± 0.03 mm) long; cerci 0.6-0. 8
mm (0.7 ± 0.02 mm) long. No dorsal hooks present. Lateral spines short,
those on segment eight 0.17-0.26 mm (0.23 ± 0.01 mm) long, or 0.13-0.18
(0.17 ± 0.01) the length of the lateral margin of the segment including the
spine; spine on segment nine 0.40-0.50 mm (0.43 ± 0.01 mm) long, 0.23-
0.28 (0.25 ± 0.01) the length of the lateral margin of the segment.
Color pattern variable from a light green venter with light green-brown or
344
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 2-6. Sympetrum madidum, final-instar larva. Fig. 2, apex of abdomen, dorsal view;
Fig. 3, apex of abdomen, lateral view; Fig. 4, distal margin of labial palp, dorsal view; Fig.
5, left half of prementum and left labial palp, dorsal view; Fig. 6, head, lateral view. Scale
lines = 1 mm.
yellow-brown dorsally, to dark brown over most of the body. Lighter larvae
may be those which have most recently molted.
Material examined. BRITISH COLUMBIA. Spencer School Pond, Lang¬
ford, 4 larvae, 4 exuviae (3 reared), 3. VI. 1979 (R. A. Cannings); 12 larvae,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
345
9 exuviae (reared), 16. VI. 1979 (R. A. Cannings); 4 larvae, 23. VI. 1979 (R.
A. Cannings). Riske Creek, 1 exuvia 19. VI. 1978 (R. A. Cannings). All above
specimens located in the Spencer Entomological Museum, University of
British Columbia. Measurements and counts are based on ten final instar
larvae. Measurements made of all exuviae show no significant differences
between them and preserved larvae except in the dimensions of the head
which in the exuviae are distorted during emergence.
Diagnosis and remarks. Walker and Corbet (1975) added Sympetrum
madidum to the subgenus Tarnetrum, containing S. corruptum and S. il-
lotum, on the basis of similar wing venation and genitalia characters. Fur¬
ther, they noted that adult S. madidum seemed intermediate between the
subgenera Sympetrum and Tarnetrum (e.g. lack of an accessory transverse
carina on abdominal tergite 4). Concerning the reflection of these relation¬
ships in larval structures, Walker and Corbet state that the larvae of S.
corruptum and S. illotum “stand apart from other North American Sym¬
petrum in lacking dorsal hooks on the abdomen, and in the extreme reduc¬
tion or absence of lateral spines on abdominal segment 8.” The newly dis¬
covered larva of S. madidum also fits this description, justifying the
placement of this species in the subgenus Tarnetrum. Like the adult, the
larva is a link between the Tarnetrum and Sympetrum subgenera: the lateral
abdominal spines are small, but are not as rudimentary as those of S. cor¬
ruptum or S. illotum. They are never absent as is often the case in the latter
two species.
Spines on segment 8 average 0.17 the length of the segment (including the
spine) compared to 0.10 or less in S. corruptum and S. illotum. Spines on
segment 9 average 0.25 the length of the segment whereas they are less than
0.13 the length in the other two species (Walker and Corbet, 1975; Musser,
1962).
S. madidum is as large (total length 17.8-20.3 mm) as S. corruptum (17-
19 mm) and S. illotum (18 mm). Most other Sympetrum larvae measure
under 18 mm (Walker and Corbet, 1975).
The number of premental setae ranges from 13-18 but is usually 14-16
while in S. corruptum there are 14-18 (usually 16-17) and in S. illotum
about 13 (Walker and Corbet, 1975). The number of palpal setae in S. mad¬
idum (10-13, usually 11) also falls between the counts in S. illotum (9) and
S. corruptum (13-15). Several other measurements show the same relation¬
ship. The head width is 5. 2-5. 5 mm compared to 5.0 mm in S. illotum and
5.8 mm in S. corruptum ; the metafemur is 5. 3-5. 7 mm long in S. madidum
while in S. illotum it is 5.0 mm and in S. corruptum 6.5 mm. The cerci in
S. madidum are always less than 0.45 (0.37-0.44) the length of the para-
procts while in S. corruptum they are “about one-half” the length and in
S. illotum “about two-thirds” the length of the paraprocts (Walker and
346
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Corbet, 1975). A more detailed description of S. illotum than is available
would enable these three similar larvae to be distinguished more reliably.
Key to the Final Instar Larvae of Sympetrum ( Tarnetrum ) Species
1. Dorsal hooks present on abdomen . Sympetrum ( Sympetrum )
Dorsal hooks absent Sympetrum ( Tarnetrum ) . 2
2. Cerci 0.67 the length of paraprocts; palpal setae 9 . illotum
Cerci 0.50 or less the length of paraprocts; palpal setae 10 or more 3
3. Lateral spines on abdominal segment eight 0.13 or more the length
of segment including spine; those on segment nine 0.23 or more
the lateral length of segment; metafemur less than 6.0 mm long;
palpal setae (on each palp) 10-13, usually 11 or 12 . madidum
3. Lateral spines on segment eight, if present, about 0.10 or less the
length of the segment including the spine; those on segment nine
less than 0. 13 the lateral length of the segment; metafemur 6.0 mm
or longer; palpal setae 13-15 . corruptum
Acknowledgments
I thank Dr. G. G. E. Scudder, Dr. P. S. Corbet and Dr. R. W. Garrison
for criticizing the manuscript and Mr. E. Mansfield for help with the col¬
lections.
Literature Cited
Byers, C. F. 1927. Notes on some American dragonfly nymphs (Odonata, Anisoptera). J. N.
Y. Ent. Soc., 35:65-74.
Corbet, P. S. 1953. A terminology for the labium of larval Odonata. Entomol., 86:191-196.
Gloyd, L. K., and M. Wright. 1959. Odonata. In: Freshwater Biology, H. B. Ward and G. C.
Whipple (ed. W. T. Edmondson). Wiley, New York.
Kormondy, E. J. 1958. Catalogue of the Odonata of Michigan. Misc. Publ. Mus. Zool. Univ.
Michigan 104. Ann Arbor.
Kormondy, E. J. 1960. New North American nymphs of anisopterous Odonata. Entomol.
News, 71:121-130.
Musser, J. R. 1962. Dragonfly nymphs of Utah (Odonata: Anisoptera). Univ. of Utah Biol.
Series, 12:1-71.
Needham, J. G. 1904. New dragonfly nymphs in the United States National Museum. Proc.
U.S. Nat. Mus., 27:685-720.
Needham, J. G., and E. Fisher. 1936. The nymphs of North American libelluline dragonflies
(Odonata). Trans. Entomol. Soc. Amer., 62:107-116.
Needham, J. G., and M. J. Westfall. 1955. A manual of the dragonflies of North America
(Anisoptera). Univ. of California Press, Berkeley.
Walker, E. M., and P. S. Corbet. 1975. The Odonata of Canada and Alaska. Volume III.
Univ. of Toronto Press, Toronto.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 347-350
A LABORATORY METHOD FOR REARING BONNETIA COMTA
FALLEN (DIPTERA: TACHINIDAE)1
Eli Levine2 and Stephen L. Clement
Department of Entomology, Ohio Agricultural Research and Development
Center, Wooster 44691
Bonnetia comta Fallen (Diptera: Tachinidae) is a parasite of several noc-
tuid larvae, including the black cutworm, Agrotis ipsilon (Hufnagel) (Ar-
naud, 1978). B. comta is among the most frequently reared parasites of the
black cutworm in Ohio (Levine and Clement, unpub. data). Because A.
ipsilon is an important pest of corn in the Corn Belt, we wished to conduct
laboratory studies to determine the effect of parasitism by B. comta on
larval longevity and damage potential of black cutworms.
Although Strickland (1923), Allen (1926), and Wen et al. (1965) studied
the relationship of B. comta with lepidopterous hosts, they did not describe
methods for rearing this parasitic fly. In this paper we describe methods for
rearing sufficient numbers of B. comta to conduct small-scale laboratory
studies involving this parasite and the black cutworm. We also provide new
information on developmental interactions between B. comta and A. ipsi¬
lon.
Rearing Methods
Flies were obtained in June 1978 from a large number of 4th-6th instar
black cutworms collected in a Wayne County, Ohio cornfield. These host
larvae were reared individually in 35 ml capped plastic cups on a pinto bean
diet (Nielsen et al., 1979) at 27 ± 1°C, 60 ± 10% RH, and 16 hr photoperiod.
Flies that emerged from these larvae were transferred to 38 x 39 x 39-cm
plexiglass and plastic mesh cages, 10-20 flies per cage. The sex ratio of
these flies was not determined; however, the 9 \ S sex ratio of 148 flies from
several cages was 1.1:1. The cages were provided with two 60 ml cups, one
containing cotton soaked with water, the other containing cotton soaked
with 25% honey solution. Female flies were induced to larviposit by pro¬
viding each cage with fresh (<24 hr old) black cutworm fecal pellets in open
petri dishes lined with filter paper. Feces (provided daily) were obtained
from 5th— 6th instars fed pinto bean diet. We observed females larviposit on
or within 5 mm of a fecal pellet.
We were able to establish a laboratory colony of the fly once larviposition
had begun. Parasitization of black cutworms (5th-6th instars) was accom¬
plished by transferring maggots (=planidia) with a dissecting probe (one per
348
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 1. Larviposition response of Bonnetia comta to feces and vomitus from the black
cutworm.
1 Values based on 4 replicates/treatment/cage.
2 Numbers in each column followed by the same letter are not significantly different (P <
0.05) (DNMRT).
host) to the upper abdominal surface of larvae. With this technique it was
not necessary to remove larvae from their 35 ml diet cups. Parasitized larvae
were reared under the aforementioned conditions. Host larvae and feces
were obtained from a black cutworm colony maintained at the Ohio Agri¬
cultural Research and Development Center.
Although the above rearing method proved to be satisfactory we did mod¬
ify it in January 1980 by reducing the number of flies per larviposition cage
to 2 or 4 (1: 1 sex ratio). Males can be sexed by their pulvilli which are more
elongate than females. Flies were observed to mate freely in cages contain¬
ing either 10-20 or 2-4 flies.
To determine if larviposition is triggered by a substance produced by
black cutworm larvae, a laboratory bioassay was conducted as follows. We
placed a male and female fly in each of 3 cages shortly after their emergence
from puparia. Then each cage was supplied with water and honey solution
as previously described and placed in a rearing room (24 ± 1°C, 80 ± 5%
RH, and a 16 hr photoperiod). Test materials on filter paper in petri dishes
were introduced into each cage 7 days after fly eclosion since females started
to larviposit about that time. The petri dishes (4 replicates/treatment) were
arranged in a randomized complete block design. Larviposition was record¬
ed, test materials were replaced, and petri dishes were re-randomized 2-3
times per cage during the length of the test period (48-96 hr). Test materials,
which were obtained from 6th instars fed pinto bean diet, included fresh
fecal pellets (one pellet/petri dish) and vomitus (one small drop/petri dish).
Controls consisted of empty petri dishes.
Table 1 shows that significantly more ( P < 0.05) planidia were deposited
in petri dishes with feces. Vomitus elicited a statistically stronger ( P < 0.05)
larviposition response than did empty petri dishes in 2 cages. These results
suggest that a substance (kairomone) in the feces, and perhaps in the vom¬
itus, stimulates B. comta to larviposit.
Interestingly, Wen et al. (1965) stated that B. comta larviposited on soil
surfaces over which A. ipsilon moved, as well as on plant surfaces where
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
349
this host fed. In contrast, Strickland (1923) and Allen (1926) reported that
B. comta larviposited freely on foliage in the absence of host caterpillars
but these observations are not surprising since some tachinids may larviposit
in the absence of a larvipositional stimulant, apparently because of the pres¬
sure of eggs in the uterus (see Clausen, 1940). In fact, we observed a few
females larvipositing in cages lacking the larvipositional stimulant. How¬
ever, it is clear that knowledge of the stimulus influencing the ovipositional
behavior of B. comta has been important in maintaining our laboratory
colony of this parasite.
We have maintained a laboratory colony of B. comta since June 1978.
Feral flies were introduced into the colony in July 1979.
Parasite Development
Planidia entered hosts by boring through segmental membranes, ac¬
tivity which usually took <5 min. Duration of the endoparasitic period var¬
ied significantly with the host’s stage of development at which parasitization
occurred. The average duration of this period within hosts parasitized as
3rd, 4th, 5th, and 6th instars was 14.2a (n = 18), 10.9b (n = 18), 8.8c (n =
12), and 9.7c (n = 9) days, respectively (means followed by the same letter
are not significantly different, P < 0.05). Thus, maggot development was
generally accelerated with advance in host larval stage parasitized.
Parasite pupation occurred within 6 hr after fully developed maggots
emerged from host larvae. The pupal period was significantly (P < 0.01)
longer for parasites reared from larvae parasitized as 6th instars (11.2 ± 0.2
days, n = 9, x ± SE) than for those reared from larvae parasitized as 3rd
instars (10.5 ± 0.1 days, n = 14). Pupae that developed from planidia placed
on 5th and 6th instars weighed 128.3 ± 7.4 mg (n — 12) and 125.6 ±3.4 mg
(n = 9), respectively. These values are significantly (P < 0.01) greater than
an average weight of 104.8 ± 3.7 mg (n = 18) for pupae from planidia placed
on 4th instars.
Female flies lived 18.1 ± 1.7 (n = 17) days while males lived 13.1 ± 1.5
(n = 19) days (sig. diff. , P 0.05). These females began to larviposit 8 13
days after eclosion. Of 133 planidia deposited during a 24 hr period, 85.7%,
64.7%, 25.6%, and 2.3% were alive 1, 2, 3, and 4 days after deposition,
respectively.
All developmental tests were conducted at 27 ± 1°C and 60 ± 10% RH
with a 16 hr photoperiod.
Acknowledgments
We thank D. McCartney and M. Casey for technical assistance and Dr.
C. W. Sabrosky, USDA Systematic Entomology Laboratory, Washington,
D. C., for identification of B. comta.
350
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Literature Cited
Allen, H. W. 1926. Observations upon the early maggot stage of Linnaemyia comta Fall.
(Diptera: Tachinidae). Entomol. News, 37:283-286.
Arnaud, P. H., Jr. 1978. A host-parasite catalog of North American Tachinidae (Diptera).
Misc. Pub., No. 1319, SEA, USDA, 860 pp.
Clausen, C. P. 1940. Entomophagous Insects. McGraw-Hill, New York, 680 pp.
Nielsen, D. G., F. F. Purrington, G. F. Shambaugh, and G. J. Musick. 1979. Rearing Po-
dosesia larvae on a meridic diet. J. Georgia Entomol. Soc. 15:37 — 41 .
Strickland, E. H. 1923. Biological notes on parasites of prairie cutworms. Canada Dept. Agr.
Bull., No. 26, 40 pp.
Wen, Y., K. Ching-Yang, and Y. Tseng-Fang. 1965. Biological studies on Linnaemyia compta
Fallen (Diptera: Larvae voridae) . Acta Entomologica Sinica, 14:159.
Footnotes
1 Approved for publication as Journal Article No. 138-79 of the Ohio Agricultural Research
and Development Center, Wooster 44691. Research supported by USEPA Grant R805429.
2 Present address: Section of Economic Entomology, Illinois Natural History Survey, 163
Natural Resources Building, Champaign 61820.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 351-358
A NEW NORTH AMERICAN CHRYSIDID GENUS AND
REDESCRIPTION OF THE GENUS PSEUDOLOPYGA
KROMBEIN (ELAMPINAE, HYMENOPTERA)
Lynn Siri Kimsey
Department of Entomology, University of California, Davis 95616
The genera Minymischa and Pseudolopyga are tiny desert dwelling chry-
sidids. They are typical members of the Elampinae based on the three ex¬
posed terga; reduced wing venation, with a short radial sector and absent
cubital and discoidal cells, and tarsal claws with one or more subsidiary
teeth. Both genera are closely related to Holopyga having similar tarsal
claw dentition and facial sculpture. Females can be recognized by the apical
v-shaped swelling of sternum III. In males sternum III is flat. The structure
of the female tarsomeres of Minymischa superficially resemble those of
Muesebeckidium (also a close relative of Holopyga ). Abbreviations used
are: RS for radial sector, and F-I, II and X for flagellomeres.
Minymischa can be identified using the key to the North American chry-
sidid genera (Bohart and Kimsey, 1980). Material that runs out to Pseu¬
dolopyga in that key should then be run through the first couplet in the
following key.
I would like to thank Drs. R. M. Bohart and K. V. Krombein for their
help and F. D. Parker for providing specimens and host records. Specimens
were seen from the following institutions: U.S. National Museum (USNM),
University of California at Davis (UCD) and Berkeley (UCB), California
Department of Food and Agriculture and Utah State University at Logan.
Key to the Species of Pseudolopyga and Minymischa
1. RS stub about half as long as medial vein (Fig. 3); female fore and
midtarsi not laterally expanded and flattened (Figs. 10, 11); male
hindtarsal claws apically tridentate (Fig. 9) .
. Pseudolopyga Krombein 2
RS stub one-fifth or less as long as medial vein (Fig. 4); female fore
and midtarsi laterally expanded and flattened, appearing prehen¬
sile (Figs. 6, 7); male hindtarsal claws apically bidentate (Fig. 5)
. Minymischa Kimsey 3
2. Clypeal apex strongly emarginate (Fig. 1); mesopleural face with
large circular punctures, little or no microstriae .
. P. carrilloi (Bohart & Brumley)
352
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
3 Pseudolopyga
4 Minymischa
Figs. 1—12. Figs. 1-2. Front view of face of male Pseudolopyga. Figs. 3-4. Forewings.
Figs. 5-12. Tarsi. 5-8. Minymischa. 9-12. Pseudolopyga.
Clypeal apex not emarginate (Fig. 2); mesopleural face without dis¬
crete large circular punctures, covered with microstriae .
. P. taylori (Bodenstein)
3. F-II longer than wide and terga brassy to bright green, in strong con¬
trast with rest of body . M. deserticola Kimsey
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
353
F-II about as long as wide or wider and terga black, dark blue or
purple not contrasting with rest of body . 4
4. F-X as long as wide or wider; forewing without brown stained vein
remnants . M. arenicola Kimsey
F-X longer than wide; forewing with brown stained vein remnants
. M. ventura Kimsey
Minymischa, new genus
Type-species. — Minymischa arenicola new species.
Generic diagnosis. — Forewing with RS stub one-fifth or less as long as
medial vein (Fig. 4); female fore and midtarsi laterally expanded and flat¬
tened (Figs. 6, 7); hindtarsal claws bidentate (Figs. 5, 8); volsella undi¬
vided into digitus and cuspis, less than five times as long as broad and
with stout spine-like setae (Figs. 15-17).
Both Minymischa and Pseudolopyga are sympatric through the drier
parts of the western United States. In a cursory examination they are
easily confused, but can be immediately separated by the very short RS
stub of Minymischa. No host is known for Minymischa. The name Min¬
ymischa refers to the “short stub” of the radial sector of the forewing.
Minymischa arenicola, new species
(Fig. 15)
Holotype male. — Length 3 mm; entire head, thorax and abdomen dark
metallic green; rest of body black; wings slightly brown tinted; pubescence
sparse and pale; head and thorax with large shallow punctures becoming
deeper and closer on propodeum and mesopleuron; tergal punctures much
smaller, separated by one puncture diameter or less; malar space as long as
pedicel; clypeal margin subtruncate; F-I and II very slightly longer than
broad and little more than half as long as pedicel; F-X as broad as long;
volsella 5.4 times as long as broad and 0.7 as long as paramere (Fig. 15).
Female. — Same as male except F-I length 0.6 pedicel length; F-II length
0.8 times width and 0.8 F-I length; F-X 1.2 times as broad as long.
Holotype male (UCD), 5 mi N Barstow, San Bernardino Co., California,
May 13, 1979 (R. M. Bohart). Paratypes, 15 males and 38 females, from
CALIFORNIA, San Diego Co.: Borrego Springs, Campo; Inyo Co.: Death
Valley, Eureka Valley, Deep Springs, Darwin Falls; Riverside Co.: Thou¬
sand Palms, Gavilan; Napa Co.: Monticello Dam; Monterey Co.: Arroyo
Seco; Imperial Co.: Glamis; San Bernardino Co.: Kelso, 5 mi N Barstow,
Cronise Wash, Cajon Pass; Contra Costa Co.: Antioch; Los Angeles Co.:
Claremont; NEVADA, Churchill Co.: 12 mi NE Stillwater; White Pine Co.:
Dolly Varden Valley; Washoe Co.: Wadsworth; Lyon Co.: Fernley; Clark
354
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Co.: 10 mi N Las Vegas; ARIZONA, Pima Co.: Sahuarita, 10 mi N Tucson;
Cochise Co.: 7 mi SE Pierce. Additional specimens have been seen from
Lynndyl and Hurricane, Utah; Mt. Milton, Lincoln Co., Oregon; 20 mi N
Eltopia, Washington; 23 mi N Van Horn, and El Paso, Texas; Hollister and
McCall, Idaho; and Green Mountain Reservoir, Summit Co., Colorado.
Specimens were collected from March to July.
Systematics. — Found throughout the drier parts of the western United
States, arenicola is the commonest species in Minymischa. Distinguishing
characters are the dark color, weakly stained wings and F-II and X as broad
or broader than long.
Minymischa deserticola, new species
(Figs. 5-8, 16)
Holotype male. — Length 3 mm; head, pronotum and thoracic pleura
greenish blue, black on scutum, scutellum, propodeum and sterna I— III;
terga dark with strong bronze to brass reflections; wings water clear; pu¬
bescence pale and sparse; head and thorax with medium, shallow punctures
becoming larger and deeper on propodeum and mesopleuron; tergal punc¬
tures small and deep, separated by one or two puncture diameters; malar
space subequal to pedicel length; clypeal margin subtruncate; F-I slightly
longer than wide; F-II length 1.4 times width; F-X somewhat longer than
wide; volsella 4.6 times as long as broad and 0.6 times as long as paramere
(Fig. 16).
Female. — Same as male, except F-X as long as broad.
Holotype male (UCD), Borrego Springs, San Diego Co., California,
March 30, 1960 (M. Wasbauer). Paratypes, 2 males and 12 females, from
CALIFORNIA, Riverside Co.: Thousand Palms, 18 mi W Blythe; San Ber¬
nardino Co.: Kramer Junction; San Diego Co.: Borrego Springs, Split
Mountain, N end Borrego Clark Lake; Imperial Co.: Fish Creek; ARIZO¬
NA, Yuma Co.: 5 mi W Dateland, McVay; NEVADA, Clark Co.: 10 mi N
Las Vegas. Specimens were collected in March and April.
Systematics . — Minymischa deserticola is the most distinctive of these
three species because of the highly colored terga that contrast with the
thoracic color. Other distinguishing characteristics are F-II longer than
wide, and F-I slightly longer than wide.
Minymischa ventura, new species
(Fig. 17)
Holotype male. — Length 3.5 mm; head, thorax and terga, black with some
greenish reflections and sterna dark brown; wings brown stained with darkly
stained vein remnants; pubescence pale and scattered; head and thorax with
irregular large to small punctures becoming deeper on propodeum; tergal
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
355
Figs. 13-17. Genital capsule, ventral view: aedeagus (a), cuspis (c), digitus length (dl),
paramere (p), paramere length (pi), volsella (v). Figs. 13-14. Pseudolopyga. Figs. 15-17. Min-
ymischa.
punctures small, deep and 0.5 to 1.0 puncture diameter apart; malar space
0.8 length of pedicel; clypeal margin subtruncate; F-I slightly longer than
broad and 0.5 times as long as pedicel; F-II as long as broad, slightly shorter
than F-I; F-X length 1.6 times width; volsella 3.5 times as long as broad and
0.5 times as long as paramere (Fig. 17).
Female. — Unknown.
356
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Holotype male (UCD), Quatal Canyon, Ventura Co., California, April 29,
1968 (D. Veirs). Paratype male: Bend, Oregon, May 27, 1964 (K. Goeden).
Systematics. — Minymischa ventura can be distinguished by the dark col¬
or, stained vein remnants, F-II as long as broad and F-X longer than broad.
Pseudolopyga Krombein
Type-species. — Pseudolopyga taylori (Bodenstein).
Generic diagnosis. — Forewing RS stub one-half or more as long as medial
vein (Fig. 3); female fore and midtarsi not laterally expanded and flattened
(Figs. 10, 11); hindtarsal claws apically tridentate (males) or medially bi-
dentate (females) (Figs. 9, 12); volsella divided into digitus and cuspis, cus-
pis length nine or more times breadth, with sparse hairlike setae apically
(Figs. 13, 14).
Systematics . — Pseudolopyga Krombein (1969) contains two species,
found only in the Nearctic region. Both species are small, less than 3 mm,
dark and easily confused. P. carrilloi was synonymized with taylori by
Krombein (1969). When I examined the holotypes, I found carrilloi to be
a distinct species based on clypeal and integumental sculpture and male
genitalia. The Pseudolopyga reported by Carrillo and Caltagirone (1970) as
a parasite of Solierella is carrilloi and not taylori.
Pseudolopyga carrilloi (Bohart and Brumley)
(Figs. 1, 9-13)
Hedychridium carrilloi Bohart and Brumley 1967:232. Male holotype, Ar-
buckle, Colusa Co., California, UCD.
Male holotype. — Length 2-3 mm. Head, thorax and abdomen black; teg-
ula brown; wings brown-tinted; pubescence on body sparse and pale; punc¬
tures on head, pronotum, scutum and scutellum shallow and weakly defined
with polished interspaces becoming larger, denser and well-defined on pro-
podeum and mesopleuron, tergal punctures small, shallow and dense; malar
space as long as pedicel; clypeal margin deeply notched apically (Fig. 1); F-I
twice as long as broad and as long as pedicel; F-II shorter than F-I and
1.3 times as long as broad; F-X length 1.8 times breadth; volsella 0.6 times
as long as paramere (Fig. 13).
Female. — As in male, except pedicel 1.4 times as long as F-I, F-I length
1.6 times breadth and F-X length subequal to breadth.
Distribution. — CALIFORNIA: Yolo, San Diego, Riverside, Colusa, Im¬
perial, Inyo, San Luis Obispo, Kern, Contra Costa and San Bernardino
counties; ARIZONA: Cochise, Maricopa, Pima, Pinal, Yavapai, Graham,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
357
Gila and Coconino counties; IDAHO: Cassia County; TEXAS: Brewster
County; NEVADA: Storey, Elko, Churchill and Washoe counties, and
UTAH: Cache County. Specimens were collected from March through Oc¬
tober. A total of 70 males and 49 females were seen.
Discussion. — Pseudolopyga carrilloi is found in dry areas west of the
100th meridian. It is reared in large numbers from twig nesting Solierella
(Carrillo and Caltigirone, 1970 and Parker, pers. comm.). Superficially car¬
rilloi resembles taylori but it can be immediately distinguished by the strong¬
ly notched clypeus and almost complete lack of microstriae on the gena and
thorax. Specimens vary in color from brown (old specimens), to blackish,
dark purple or blue-black, with slight bronze reflections in some.
Pseudolopyga taylori (Bodenstein)
(Figs. 2, 14)
Holopyga taylori Bodenstein 1939:11. Male holotype, Hollister, Idaho,
USNM.
Holotype male. — Length 2.3 mm; head, thorax and abdomen dark brown
with greenish highlights; tegula brown; wings brown tinted; pubescence on
body sparse and pale; punctures shallow and dense on head becoming sparse
on pronotum, scutum and scutellum, deeper and more well-defined on pro-
podeum and anterior half of mesopleuron; gena, propleuron, posterior half
of mesopleuron, metapleuron and lateral wall of propodeum microridged;
tergal punctures small and shallow; malar space slightly shorter than pedi¬
cel; clypeal margin subtruncate apically (Fig. 2); F-I twice as long as broad
and as long as pedicel; F-II shorter than F-I and length 1.3 times breadth;
F-X 1.8 times as long as broad; digitus length 0.8 times length of paramere
(Fig. 14).
Female. — As in male, except F-II length 1.4 times breadth and F-X length
1.4 times breadth.
Distribution. — CALIFORNIA: San Bernardino, Sierra, Yolo, San Diego,
Inyo, Riverside and Contra Costa counties; IDAHO: Cassia County; ARI¬
ZONA: Yavapai and Cochise counties; NEVADA: Washoe County; col¬
lected in the months of March through August; 13 males and 11 females
were seen.
Discussion. — Although not as common as P. carrilloi, taylori is found
throughout the West in desert areas. It can be distinguished from carrilloi
by the relatively straight apical margin of the clypeus and extensive micro¬
ridges on the gena, mesopleuron and metapleuron. The host of taylori is
unknown. Coloration is variable, from all black to dark purple or blackish
with strong purple highlights, or even brown (old specimens).
358
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Literature Cited
Bodenstein, W. G. 1939. A new Holopyga from the Western United States. Entomol. News,
50:19-21.
Bohart, R. M., and R. L. Brumley. 1967. Two new species of Hedychridium from California
(Hymenoptera: Chrysididae). Pan-Pac. Entomol., 43:232-235.
Bohart, R. M., and L. S. Kimsey. 1980. A generic synopsis of the Chrysididae of America
north of Mexico. J. Kansas Ent. Soc., 53:137-148.
Carrillo, J. L., and L. E. Caltagirone. 1970. Observations on the biology of Solierella peck-
hami, S. blaisdelli and two species of Chrysididae. Ann. Ent. Soc. Amer., 63:673-681.
Krombein, K. V. 1969. The generic placement of two Nearctic Holopyga with biological
notes. Proc. Ent. Soc. Wash., 71:351-361.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 359-363
THE STATUS OF THE COLUMBIA TIGER BEETLE
( CICINDELA COLUMBICA HATCH) IN IDAHO
(COLEOPTERA: CICINDELIDAE)
Gary Shook
Department of Environmental Health, University of Washington,
Seattle 98195
Frank M. Beer (1971) reported the apparent extermination of the Colum¬
bia Tiger Beetle ( Cicindela columbica Hatch) from a rather large segment,
if not all, of its habitat due to dam construction on the Columbia and Snake
Rivers in Oregon, Washington and Idaho. Originally described by Melville
Hatch (1938), this species was reported to be locally abundant on sandbars
of those rivers from The Dalles, Oregon eastward to just west of Lewiston,
Idaho. Beers found no evidence of the beetles after flooding of the habitats
by dam backwaters. However, he did find all of the Tiger Beetles that had
been associated with the Columbia Tiger Beetle prior to flooding. Those
species found to have re-established themselves on the shores of the new
reservoirs were Cicindela oregona LeConte, repanda Dejean, hirticollis
Say, tranquebarica Herbst, and cinctipennis LeConte.
Vernon Clifford (1979), a well-known Tiger Beetle collector from Wash¬
ington, reported that he was not aware of any existing populations of C.
columbica as all former sites to his knowledge had been flooded by back¬
waters. Leffler and Pearson (1976) reported the species in their work on the
Tiger Beetles of Washington. However, they made citations from the lit¬
erature and made no observations of living populations. They noted, “Dr.
L. Rogers reported no populations (of C. columbica ) in the Columbia on
river islands above Pasco. Construction of dams along the Columbia and
Snake Rivers appears to be having an adverse effect on the species.”
The first known literature citation of the Columbia Tiger Beetle in Idaho
was by Norman L. Rumpp (1967), who found the beetle on August 10, 1962
at two locations along the Salmon River. The first site was 2 miles south of
Whitebird, Idaho County, and the second site was 1 mile southwest of Slate
Creek (8.4 mi N Lucile), also in Idaho County.
It was feared that subsequent construction on realignment of U.S. High¬
way 95 near the sandbars on which C. columbica had been found may have
harmed those populations. During August 1977, Gary Shook visited all ma¬
jor sandbars on the easterly side of the Salmon River from Riggins north to
Whitebird. C. columbica was found at two locations: 1 mi SW Slate Creek,
360
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Idaho County and 2.4 mi SW Slate Creek, Idaho County. Thus the presence
of the Columbia Tiger Beetle in Idaho was confirmed.
No investigation for C. columbica had been made between the Salmon
River locations in Idaho downriver to the former locations near Clarkston,
Washington. Much of the approximately 161 km (95 mi) of intervening river
is generally inaccessible except by raft or kayak.
During the last two days of July and the first two days of August, 1979,
a raft trip was made down the Lower Salmon River and the Snake River.
The trip started just below the Rice Creek bridge in Idaho County, Idaho,
and ended at Heller’s Bar near Rogersburg, Washington, a distance of 95
km (56 mi) by river.
The Trip
On July 30, 1979, the trip down the two rivers began with the launching
of two inflated rafts and an aluminum dory. During the next four days forty-
nine (49) sandbars were inspected for Tiger Beetles. Figure 1 grapically
illustrates the collection site locations.
Sandbars inspected were at least 30 m in length. Many smaller bars were
noted, but were recently emerged due to the natural seasonal drop in the
rivers’ flows or were otherwise deemed inappropriate to inspect. Not all
bars 30 m or over were investigated, but the 49 observed represented at
least 40% of the larger sandbars seen.
Inspection generally consisted of a boundary or perimeter transect: walk¬
ing the shoreline at the moist sand water interface, then up and around the
dry outer boundary inshore. Extensive grid transects were made at the
White House Bar (Site No. Ill) and Maloney Creek Bar (Site No. 117) in
an effort to estimate the rather large populations of C. columbica found
there.
After tentative identification, random specimens were netted for in-hand
verification. Two hundred and four specimens of all species were collected
and retained as vouchers. They were represented by 80 C. oregona, 51 C.
repanda, 31 C. hirticollis, and 42 C. columbica. All voucher specimens
were retained in the author’s collection or were deposited in the entomo¬
logical collection of the California Academy of Science, Golden Gate Park,
San Francisco, California.
The elevation near the Rice Creek Bridge was 4251 m (1296 feet) above
sea level. The Rogersburg, Washington, elevation was 2706 m (825 feet)
above sea level. That represented a drop of 1545 m (471 feet) in the total
trip length.
The Salmon River canyon has slopes generally in excess of 30%, with
many areas, especially the Blue Canyon, of vertical walls. Hackberry,
Mountain Mahogany, with some Ponderosa and Jack Pine and Doulgas Fir
represented the major trees.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
361
Fig. 1.
The Hells Canyon of the Snake River had similar slope configurations,
although the river bed was considerably wider than that of the Salmon River.
Trees and vegetation in general were much less than that noted on the
Lower Salmon River, decreasing downstream.
Observations
Periodically, the air, water and sand surface temperatures were recorded
with the following observed results (in degrees Celsius, °C): All tempera¬
tures were taken with a dial-type metal thermometer that had been previ¬
ously calibrated between 4° and 60°C. The sand temperatures were of dry
sand and were taken 6 to 18 mm below the actual sand surface. Moist sand
near the waterline tended to follow the air temperature and did not exceed
26° to 27°C.
Although C. hirticollis and C. repanda were observed on sand with sur¬
face temperatures of 44° to 47°C, they would occasionally fly onto the hotter
60°C sand. There they would remain but a second or two in one place,
making short hops until cooler sand was attained.
C. columbica was commonly found seeking food on sands ranging in
temperature from 26° to 42°C. They were not seen to fly onto the hotter
sands as did the other species. When disturbed, the Columbia Tiger Beetle
often flew out over the river or up or down the moist area of the sandbar.
One interesting note was the extended period of activity observed of C.
362
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
columbica and C. repanda after sandbars had been completely shaded and
after sunset. At Collection Site No. 110 near Mile 10, the sandbar was
completely shaded by 7:30 PM MDST as the sun had dropped below the
surrounding mountain tops at that time. C. repanda persisted in activity on
the sand until after 9:00 PM when seeing was becoming difficult. On the
Maloney Creek Bar (Site No. 117), complete shading occurred at 7:30 PM.
C. columbica was observed still active until 8:45 PM.
The largest significant populations of C. columbica occurred at White
House Bar (Site No. Ill) and at Maloney Creek Bar (Site No. 117). These
bars were quite extensive, being approximately 400 m long and extending
back from the river over 100 m. They were generally not entirely flooded
during the spring run-off in May, June and early July. However, it was felt
by the boatmen that the sandbars may receive periodic total inundation
during those infrequent years of very high run-off, such as 1974.
The population of C. columbica at White House Bar was estimated at
greater than 200 beetles. The population at Maloney Creek Bar was esti¬
mated at greater than 400 beetles. Estimates were based on observing four
grid transect areas equal to V10 the total estimated sandbar area. The great
difficulty in population estimates of this very active, winged beetle can be
appreciated by anyone who has collected it. The degree of confidence, there¬
fore, has been placed with the lowest observation numbers.
Ten (10) of the forty-two (42) C. columbica collected from all sites were
obviously teneral.
Where C. columbica was found it was generally gregarious within the
species and, although mixing with the other tiger beetle species did occur,
it tended to be more isolated from those other beetles.
C. tranquebarica was observed at only three sites, but this wide-ranging
species is often found more abundantly earlier in the season. The specimens
found may have represented the last of the spring populations which had
moved onto the cooler, moister sandbars from the surrounding area.
The Oregon Tiger Beetle ( Cicindela oregona LeConte) was by far the
most abundant species observed, being found on 94% of the sites inspected.
Conclusion
The Columbia Tiger Beetle, Cicindela columbica Hatch, is generally
found in large, viable populations in Idaho within the Lower Salmon River
canyon from near Slate Creek to Eagle Creek. It was not found below Eagle
Creek on the Salmon River and was found nowhere on the Snake River to
Heller’s Bar. It generally occupies older, well-established bars that extend
back from the river sufficiently to generally not be inundated by spring run¬
off waters. Although the beetle is generally intraspecifically gregarious, it
does share its area with four other species of Tiger Beetles: Cicindela or¬
egona, C. repanda, C. hirticollis and C. tranquebarica.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
363
Literature Cited
Beers, Frank M. 1971. Note on Cicindela columbica Hatch. Cicindela, 3(2):32, June.
Clifford, Vernon. 1979. pers. com. Aug. 10.
Hatch, M. H. 1938. The Coleoptera of Washington: Carabidae: Cicindelinae. University of
Washington Biol., 1:225-240.
Leffler, S. R., and D. L. Pearson. 1976. Tiger Beetles of Washington. Cicindela, 8(2/3):21-60.
Rumpp, N. L. 1967. A New Species of Cicindela from Idaho (Coleoptera: Cicindelidae).
Proc. Cal. Acad, of Sciences, 35(7): 129-140.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 364-370
A NEW SPECIES OF COSCINOPTERA LACORDAIRE FROM
CALIFORNIA (COLEOPTERA: CHRY SOMELID AE)
Arthur J. Gilbert
California Department of Food and Agriculture,
Exclusion and Detection, 2550 Mariposa Street,
Room 3083, Fresno 93721
In California, the State and County departments of agriculture annually
perform various surveys aimed at detecting new plant pest introductions,
the primary goal being early detection and possible eradication. Entry way
surveys covering the routes of transportation, i.e. roads, canals, railroads,
etc., are generally for detection of introduced plant species. However, in
June of 1977, two Fresno County Department of Agriculture inspectors
performing an entryway survey in the area along Panoche Road near the
Fresno-San Benito County line collected a pair of chrysomelids from Ephed¬
ra calif ornica Wats. Knowing my interest in this group, the beetles
were submitted to me for identification. These were recognized as an un¬
described Clytrinae and recollection the following year yielded numerous
additional specimens and biological data.
The genus Coscinoptera, to which this new species belongs, is repre¬
sented in North America by seven species and fourteen subspecies (Mol-
denke, 1970). Only one of these can be found in California, north of the
Tehachapi Mountains of southern California and west of the Sierra Nevada
Mountains. For a North American representative, this new species is one
of the largest to be found.
Coscinoptera panochensis, new species
(Figs. 1, 2, 4)
Holotype male. — Length 7.10 mm, width 3.45 mm. Head shiny black,
punctation of vertex and frontal area obscured by thick, white pubescence.
Eyes black, oval and entire. Antennae not attaining hind margin of prono-
tum; basal segment black, globose and thickly pubescent; segments 2-4
testaceous, clavate and sparsely pubescent, becoming darkened towards
apex. Clypeus broadly emarginate and black, narrow lateral and anterior
margins lacking pubescence. Labrum alutaceous with scattered setigerous
punctures along anterior margin, lateral margins rufo-testaceous graduating
to black in center and lacking pubescence. Mandibles black and enlarged;
pubescent basally. Pronotum widest basally, transverse (approx. 1.5 x wid-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
365
Figs. 1-3. Fig. 1. C. panochensis mating pair in situ on leaf of E. californica. Fig. 2. C.
panochensis male with clearly defined glabrous humeral area. Fig. 3. Ephedra californica (large
plants) at type locality.
er than long), black, thickly pubescent except for a median, smooth, lon¬
gitudinal impunctate area which on the anterior half is narrow and obscured
by the pubescence, the posterior half is wider and exposed; hind angles
distinctly angulate, nearly 90°. Elytra black, covered with thick, white, ap-
pressed pubescence except humeral callus; widest anteriorly; tapering
slightly posteriorly. Scutellum black and pubescent. Venter and pygidium
black, copiously pubescent, much more so than the dorsum or the legs.
Legs black, coxae pubescent only distally, remaining segments intermediate
in pubescence between elytra and venter; tarsal claws widened basally form¬
ing a very indistinct obtuse tooth.
366
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 4. SEM of C. panochensis viewed dorsally with five clearly defined black, glabrous
areas (eyes, pronotum and humeri) in contrast to overall grayish appearance.
Males range in size from 6.25-7.50 mm in length and from 3.05-3.65 mm
in width.
The female differs from the male in the following characters: size larger,
6.55-7.95 mm in length and 3.20-4.00 mm in width. Mandibles not enlarged,
not extending laterally much beyond the anterior corners of the clypeus
when closed. Venter with an oval, median, glabrous depression on the
fourth and fifth segments, which is punctured on the periphery and termi¬
nates midway on the fourth segment. Antennae shorter reaching posteriorly
to about middle of pronotum.
Holotype. — Male (CAS #13400): California, San Benito Co., 8.2 mi on Pa-
noche Rd. W from 1-5 (Interstate Highway), V-2 1-1978, collected from
Ephedra californica Wats., A. J. Gilbert, F. G. Andrews, S. Kuba.
Paratypes. — 15 males, 18 females same data as holotype. All other spec¬
imens are from the type locality and host, only the dates and collectors vary
as noted. 1 male, 1 female, VI-19-1977, W. Peregrin, D. Haines; 4 males,
4 females, V-13-1978, A. J. Gilbert, D. A. Burdick, G. Caseri, W. Peregrin;
10 males, 5 females, V-21-1978, S. Kuba, F. Andrews; 41 males, 42 females,
V-30-1978, A. J. Gilbert, D. A. Griffin; 1 female, V-14-1979, A. J. Gilbert,
D. A. Griffin; 9 males, 10 females, V-19-1979, A. J. Gilbert, D. A. Griffin;
8 males, 5 females, V-23-1979, A. J. Gilbert, D. A. Griffin. Specimens are
deposited in USNM, CAS, Calif. Dept. Food and Agric., Brit. Mus. Nat.
Hist., MCZ, Univ. Calif., Davis, Fresno Co. Dept. Agric. and A. J. Gilbert.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
367
Figs. 5-6. Fig. 5. SEM of hatched egg minus the stalk. First instar larva partially exposed
at top. Fig. 6. SEM of angulate posterior corner of pronotum.
Additional specimens. — 1 male, V-21-1978, A. J. Gilbert, S. Kuba, F.
Andrews; 1 male, V-21-1978, S. Kuba, F. Andrews; 1 female, V-30-1978,
A. J. Gilbert, D. A. Griffin; 1 male, V-30-1978, A. J. Gilbert, D. A. Griffin.
The last specimen cited possesses an aberrant left antenna with an enlarged
sixth segment from which emanates two four-segmented continuations.
Distribution. — Efforts to collect C. panochensis at other Ephedra sites
in Fresno and San Luis Obispo counties were unproductive. Flowever, as
this paper was being submitted for publication, two specimens (1 male, 1
female), were discovered in a drawer of unsorted material in the collection
of the California Department of Food and Agriculture. The data are as fol¬
lows: California, Riverside County, Whitewater Canyon, 26 May 1976, on
Ephedra, Larry Bezark collector. They agree in all respects with the Pa-
noche specimens. The determined and unsorted material in the collection
at the University of California, Riverside has been examined. There were
no specimens of C. panochensis in the material, including that from the
Boyd-Deep Canyon Research Station, an area which has received a great
deal of attention and is very near Whitewater Canyon. Apparently the range
of this beetle is not restricted to the Panoche area.
Of the six species groups in the genus Coscinoptera mentioned by Mol-
denke (1970), C. panochensis would be best placed in the dominicana
group. Except for the distinctly angulate posterior pronotal corner (Fig. 6),
morphological features and geographical distribution align closely with other
members of this group. The adult host Ephedra californica Wats. (Gym-
nospermae: Gnetaceae) is an unusual host for members of the genus, which
368
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 7-9. Fig. 7. Dorsal aspect of the aedeagus. 40x . Fig. 8. Lateral aspect of the aedeagus.
40x. Fig. 9. Spermatheca. lOOx. The spermathecal pump has a lateral twist and does not lie
in the same plane as the rest of the structure.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
369
are usually associated with various flowering plants (Angiospermae) includ¬
ing the Mimosaceae, Polygonaceae, Leguminosae and Anacardiaceae (Mol-
denke, 1970).
Moldenke (1970) presents a key to the Coscinoptera of North America.
Coscinoptera panochensis would run to couplet 9A, as C. mucorea inornata
Fall. However, C. panochensis can be easily differentiated from this species
(which belongs to the axillaris /mucorea group) by panochensis ’ larger size,
enlarged mandibles in the male, glabrous humeral and pronotal areas, denser
pubescence, nearly parallel sides, by distinct black coloration and the bi¬
colored antennal segments 5-11 which are entirely black in C. m. inornata.
Most of these features will also readily separate C. panochensis from other
members of the dominicana group.
Biology. — The following subjective observations should be noted. Adult
beetles are active fliers not showing preference for any time of day. Most
specimens were found clinging to the outer extremities of the host. When
approached they would attempt to hide by circling the stem (leaf), or take
flight. Mating was observed on the host, with the male mounting the female
from the rear and assuming an almost perpendicular orientation to the fe¬
male (Fig. 1). Mating pairs were docile and were not as readily disturbed as
were individuals. Eggs were laid individually on a stalk of approximately 5
mm in length. The female would orient in a head to the ground position
while laying and the rear legs were active tools in the egg laying process,
apparently guiding, pulling or supporting the stalk as it emerged from the
abdomen. As many as 13 eggs were found on a single branch (a hatched egg
without the stalk is pictured in Fig. 5). Eggs collected V-21-1978 and held
at room temperature hatched in about 7 days. First instar larvae emerged
from one of the long ends of the ovate egg and used the remainder of the
egg as living quarters. When in motion the larvae would extend far enough
out of the case for the legs to be used. When disturbed they would retract
completely within the case. Larvae that emerged lived only a few days and
none developed beyond the first instar.
Attempts were made to collect the larval stage by sweeping the host plant
throughout the summer of 1978, by taking berlese samples under Ephedra
periodically and by deploying anti-freeze pit traps near the plants. The pit
traps were serviced monthly and inspected for larvae. All efforts were neg¬
ative.
Acknowledgments
I would like to thank Wayne Peregrin and Dennis Haines for bringing the
original specimens to my attention and for guiding me to the exact locality.
Appreciation is also extended to Dennis Haines for the determination of the
host plant. I am also indebted to Denis Griffin for field assistance in re-col¬
lections and in taking pit trap and berlese samples in search of larval spec-
370
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
imens. I would also like to thank Alan Hardy, Paul Tuskes, and Terry Seeno
for their constructive reviews and Rose Niino and Joanne Shimada for typ¬
ing the paper.
Special appreciation is extended to Fred Andrews for untiring guidance
in insect systematics and for many helpful suggestions and review of this
paper.
The drawings of the male and female genitalia were prepared and drawn
by Iris Savage for which I am grateful.
Literature Cited
Horn, G. H. 1892. Studies in Chrysomelidae. Trans. Amer. Entomol. Soc., 19:1-18.
Moldenke, A. R. 1970. A Revision of the Clytrinae of North America North of the Isthmus
of Panama (Coleoptera: Chrysomelidae). Stanford Univ. Press, Stanford, CA.
Wilcox, J. A. 1975. Checklist of the Chrysomelidae of Canada, the United States, Mexico,
Central America and the West Indies. Vol. 1, Pt. 7 (Red Version). Biol. Res. Inst.
Amer., Inc., Latham, NY.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 371-379
TWO NEW SPECIES OF POGONOMYRMEX HARVESTER ANTS
FROM TEXAS (HYMENOPTERA: FORMICID AE) 1
Oscar F. Francke and Frank W. Merickel2
Department of Entomology and The Museum, Texas Tech University,
Lubbock 79409
Harvester ants of the genus Pogonomyrmex Mayr are among the most
conspicuous members of the formicid fauna of the arid and semiarid regions
of the southwestern United States. In the most recent revision of the North
American harvester ants, Cole (1968) recognized 23 species grouped in two
subgenera; two species occurring only in Mexico, and 21 present in the
United States, nine of which occur in Texas. A faunistic survey of the ants
of Texas west of the 100th meridian was initiated in 1978 by several members
of the Department of Entomology, Texas Tech University. We have acces¬
sioned slightly over 8000 nest series representing about 40 genera and 140
species. Harvester ants represent approximately 17.5% of the samples in
our collection (n = 1400 nest series), and all the species reported from Texas
by Cole (1968) are adequately represented. In addition, however, we have
identified two new species, whose descriptions follow. For the sake of con¬
tinuity, and ease of identification, the terminology used and the measure¬
ments provided follow Cole (1968).
Pogonomyrmex (Pogonomyrmex) bigbendensis, new species
(Figs. 1, 2, 9, 12, 15)
Worker. — Measurements of holotype followed, in parenthesis, by the
ranges observed in paratypes: Head length 1.75 mm (1.49-1.75 mm), head
width 1.85 mm (1.61-1.87 mm), cephalic index 105.7 (105.2-108.7), scape
length 1.20 mm (1.08-1.22 mm), scape index 71.35 (71.35-73.78), maximum
eye length 0.40 mm (0.34-0.41 mm), maximum eye width 0.28 mm (0.26-
0.30 mm), ocular index 22.86 (22.82-23.26), Weber’s length 1.82 mm (1.56-
1.85 mm), petiolar node length 0.48 mm (0.44-0.49 mm), maximum width
of petiolar node 0.36 mm (0.30-0.40 mm), postpetiolar length 0.39 mm (0.35-
0.40 mm), postpetiole width 0.51 mm (0.45-0.54 mm).
Head slightly broader than long; eye small, weakly convex, not extending
beyond lateral margin of head. Mandible with five or six teeth (Figs. 1-2):
ultimate basal tooth distinctly offset from basal mandibular margin, forming
a rounded angle; penultimate basal tooth greatly reduced or aborted; third
basal tooth very broad basally, somewhat pointed apically, with lateral mar¬
gins deeply excised; second basal tooth apparently aborted; first basal, sub-
372
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 1-16. North American Pogonomyrmex : Figs. 1-3, right mandible of worker; 1, P.
bigbendensis, n. sp., with five teeth, 2, P. bigbendensis with six teeth, 3, P. anzensis Cole with
six teeth (redrawn from Cole, 1968): Figs. 4-6, right mandible of male; 4, P. texanus, n. sp., 5,
P. desertorum Wheeler, 6, P. apache Wheeler: Figs. 7-9, lateral profile of thorax, petiole, and
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
373
apical, and apical teeth broad basally, blunt apically. Apical margin of man¬
dible broadly convex, basal margin somewhat sinuous. Antennal scape
moderately curved on basal one-half, area of bend compressed. Base of
antennal scape (Fig. 12) similar to that of P. bicolor Cole: with very narrow
basal flange; superior and inferior lobes subequal; impression on lateral
surface of basal enlargement small and shallow, the longitudinal peripheral
carina very narrow and not ending in a distinct point. Lateral lobes of clyp-
eus produced in front of antennal insertions, projecting anteriorly beyond
level of median clypeal lobe; frontal lobes ascending moderately steeply
from clypeal lobe, not forming a deep impression for median clypeal lobe
and adjoining frontal triangle. Median cephalic rugae longitudinal, widely
spaced, extremely fine; interrugal spaces strongly shiny; in lateral view ru¬
gae reduced to very indistinct striae, either parallel or somewhat concentric
behind eyes. Posterior comer of head smooth and shiny.
Contour of thorax, petiole, and postpetiole, in lateral view, as in Fig. 9.
Dorsum of thorax flat, epinotal declivity short and distinct, epinotal arma¬
ture absent. Thoracic rugae coarse, transverse and widely spaced on ante¬
rior of pronotum, transverse to longitudinal on posterior of pronotum; trans¬
verse and more closely set on mesonotum and epinotum; intermgal spaces
strongly shiny on all segments. Dorsal portions of metasternal flanges fused,
forming a single arcuate carina across posterior declivity of epinotum. Con¬
tours of petiolar and postpetiolar nodes, in dorsal view, as in Fig. 15. Ventral
peduncular process of petiole distinct, thick, rounded, with 0-5 erect hairs.
Petiolar and postpetiolar nodes shagreened, rugae when present confined to
posterior half; anterior declivity of petiolar node short, meeting peduncle in
broad, well rounded angle. First gastric segment slightly broader than long.
Body color medium to dark ferrugineous red.
Male. — Unknown.
Female . — U nkno wn .
Type data. — Type nest series (workers only) from Rio Grande Village
(565 m), Big Bend National Park, Brewster Co., Texas, 30 July 1978 (J. V.
Moody, O. F. Francke). Holotype worker deposited at the California Acad¬
emy of Sciences, San Francisco.
Distribution. — Known only from Big Bend National Park, Brewster Co.,
Texas.
Comparisons. — Pogonomyrmex bigbendensis belongs in the barbatus
postpetiole; 7, P. texanus worker, 8, P. texanus male, 9, P. bigbendensis worker: Fig. 10,
frontal view of P. texanus male head: Figs. 11-12, base of antennal scape; 11, P. texanus
worker, 12, P. bigbendensis worker: Figs. 13-15, dorsal profile of petiolar and postpetiolar
nodes; 13, P. texanus worker, 14, P. texanus male, 15, P. bigbendensis worker: Fig. 16, dorsal
view of parameres of P. texanus male.
374
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
complex as defined by Cole (1968). The following characters, diagnostic of
the barbatus complex, are also present in P. bigbendensis : (1) not poly¬
morphic, (2) lateral lobes of clypeus projecting anteriorly beyond the level
of the median clypeal lobe, (3) head broader than long, (4) eye small and
weakly convex, not extending beyond sides of head with head in full-face
view, (5) longitudinal cephalic rugae nearly straight and parallel, (6) venter
of petiolar peduncle with a few, long, erect hairs extending downward from
the peduncular process, and (7) first gastric segment broader than long. P.
bigbendensis differs from all other species in the barbatus complex in man¬
dibular dentition: the seven species known from workers have seven teeth
on the mandible, and the ultimate basal tooth is not offset from the basal
mandibular margin; whereas in P. bigbendensis the mandible bears 5-6
teeth, and the ultimate basal tooth is distinctly offset from the basal man¬
dibular margin.
The mandibular dentition of P. bigbendensis appears to be unique among
the North American species in the subgenus Pogonomyrmex, and thus can
be used to identify this species readily. The only other North American
species known to have six mandibular teeth is P. anzensis Cole (Fig. 3), a
member of the occidentalis complex, but in this taxon the ultimate basal
tooth is not offset from the basal mandibular margin. On the other hand, P.
occidentalis (Cresson) which has the ultimate basal mandibular tooth dis¬
tinctly offset from the basal margin, as occurs in P. bigbendensis, has seven
mandibular teeth and can thus be readily separated.
Within the barbatus complex, P. bigbendensis will key out to P. apache
Wheeler in Cole’s (1968) key, the species to which it also appears to be
most closely related. P. bigbendensis shares with P. apache the following
characters: (1) cephalic rugae extremely fine and closely set, (2) posterior
corner of head without rugae, smooth and strongly shiny, (3) epinotum
generally unarmed, and (4) dorsal portions of metasternal flanges fused so
as to form a single arcuate carina across posterior declivity of epinotum.
These two species differ as follows: (1) base of antennal scape, as in Fig.
11 for P. bigbendensis, and very similar to Fig. 12 in P. apache (see Cole,
1968, p. 190, fig. 18); (2) mandibular dentition, with 5-6 teeth in P. bigben¬
densis and with ultimate basal tooth offset from margin, and with seven
teeth in P. apache with ultimate basal tooth not offset from margin; (3)
clypeal excision, with anterior margin of clypeal lobe straight or only broad¬
ly and shallowly excised in P. bigbendensis, and with the clypeal lobe deep¬
ly excised, often to the level of the frontal lobes, in P. apache; and (4) size,
with a Weber’s length range of 1.56-1.85 mm in P. bigbendensis, versus a
range of 1.90-2.51 mm in P. apache (after Cole, 1968).
The base of the antennal scape in P. bigbendensis is very similar to that
of P. bicolor Cole, another species in the barbatus complex. These two
taxa differ significantly in a number of characters, among which the presence
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
375
of: (1) epinotal armature, (2) seven mandibular teeth with ultimate basal
tooth not offset from margin, and (3) bicolored body with head and thorax
red, and gaster black, in P. bicolor readily separate it from P. bigbendensis.
Specimens examined. — All specimens examined are from Big Bend Na¬
tional Park, Brewster Co., Texas, as follows: Rio Grande Village (565 m,
level terrain, nest under rock), 30 July 1978 (J. V. Moody, O. F. Francke;
type nest series, 16 workers); Burro Mesa Pouroff (1076 m, 2° SW slope,
nest with 10 x 13 cm pebble tumulus), 9 August 1979 (J. V. Moody, O. F.
Francke, F. W. Merickel; 9 workers). Paratypes deposited in the following
collections: California Academy of Sciences, American Museum of Natural
History, Museum of Comparative Zoology, Los Angeles County Museum,
and Texas Tech University.
Pogonomyrmex (Pogonomyrmex) texanus, new species
(Figs. 4, 7, 8, 11, 13, 14, 16)
Worker. — Measurements of holotype followed, in parenthesis, by the
ranges observed in paratypes: Head length 2.15 mm (2.05-2.35 mm), head
width 2.45 mm (2.15-2.56 mm), cephalic index 113.95 (104.88-113.95), scape
length 1.65 mm (1.45-1.75 mm), scape index 74.08 (74.08-75.49), maximum
eye length 0.45 mm (0.40-0.48 mm), maximum eye width 0.35 mm (0.32-
0.38 mm), ocular index 20.93 (19.51-20.93), Weber’s length 2.65 mm (2.30-
2.75 mm), petiolar node length 0.75 mm (0.65-0.80 mm), maximum width
of petiolar node 0.60 mm (0.49-0.60 mm), postpetiolar length 0.65 mm (0.60-
0.68 mm), postpetiole width 0.80 mm (0.65-0.80 mm).
Head broader than long; eye small and weakly convex, not extending
beyond lateral margin of head. Mandible with seven subequal, blunt teeth.
Apical margin of mandible broadly convex, basal margin straight. Base of
antennal scape (Fig. 11) similar to P. apache Wheeler: with superior lobe
considerably stronger than inferior lobe ; basal flange very weak on superior
lobe, developed as a strongly recurved lip on inferior lobe; longitudinal
peripheral carina very strong, point absent. Lateral lobes of clypeus pro¬
duced in front of antennal insertions, margin of clypeal lobe broadly and
shallowly excised; frontal triangle deeply impressed. Median cephalic rugae
longitudinal, parallel; extremely fine and closely set, producing a silky lus¬
ter; interrugal spaces shiny; in lateral view rugae not forming whorls behind
eye; posterior corner of head without rugae, smooth, strongly shiny.
Contour of thorax, petiole, and postpetiole, in lateral view, as in Fig. 7.
Thoracic rugae dense, fine, and shiny; transverse throughout. Epinotum
unarmed; posterior epinotal declivity short, smooth. Dorsal portions of
metasternal flanges fused, forming a single arcuate carina across posterior
declivity of epinotum. Venter of petiolar peduncle with a few long, erect
hairs in vicinity of peduncular process. Petiolar node flattened dorsally; with
376
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
faint, transverse striae. Postpetiolar node dorsally with faint, transverse
striae. Contour of petiolar and postpetiolar nodes, in dorsal view, as in Fig.
13. First gastric segment broader than long. Body color uniformly reddish
brown.
Male. — The two known males are of similar size, the measurements for
one of them are as follows: Head length 1.62 mm, head width 1.95 mm,
cephalic index 120.00, scape length 0.75 mm, scape index 42.31, maximum
eye length 0.54 mm, maximum eye width 0.36 mm, ocular index 33.84,
Weber’s length 2.70 mm, petiolar node length 0.70 mm, maximum width of
petiolar node 0.75, postpetiolar length 0.70 mm, postpetiole width 0.82 mm.
Head with lateral outline between eye and occipital corner evenly, rather
strongly convex; eye not strongly convex, not strongly protruding from
lateral margin of head (Fig. 10). Basal margin of mandible strongly concave,
apical margin broadly convex; both margins subparallel to each other; with
four teeth, broad, blunt and robust (Fig. 4). Antennal scape with outer
surface of base evenly convex; antennal scape longer than combined lengths
of first two segments of flagellum, shorter than combined lengths of first
three segments of flagellum; apical segment of flagellum less than twice
length of subapical segment, which is distinctly longer than wide. Anterior
margin of median clypeal lobe broadly, very shallowly excised. Upper sur¬
face of head unstriated, smooth and shiny. Interocellar area with very faint
longitudinal, parallel striae. Posterior corner of head smooth, shiny. Clypeus
vestigially striate. Mandibles feebly rugose, shiny. Entire head with mod¬
erately dense, long, white, very fine erect hairs.
Contour of thorax, petiole, and postpetiole, in lateral view, as in Fig. 8.
Epinotum unarmed. Entire thorax shiny; scutum, scutellum, and basal face
of epinotum very shiny. Nota smooth; pleura vestigially striate to smooth,
shiny. Fore wing with one cubital cell. Petiolar and postpetiolar nodes, in
dorsal view, as in Fig. 14; smooth and shiny throughout. Venter of petiolar
peduncle with poorly developed, blunt tooth, bearing numerous erect hairs.
Paramere as in Fig. 16. Head and thorax black, gaster reddish brown; body
hairs fine and silky, mostly pure white.
Female. — Unknown.
Type data. — Type nest series (workers, males, brood) from Lubbock
(Farm Road 2641 at Blackwater Draw, 990 m), Lubbock Co., Texas, 2 July
1973 (J. V. Moody). Holotype worker and paratype male deposited at the
California Academy of Sciences, San Francisco.
Distribution. — Known from 13 counties in western Texas.
Comparisons. — Pogonomyrmex t exanus belongs to the barbatus complex
of Cole (1968). Workers of P. texanus share with other members of this
complex the seven characters listed above in the comparisons of P. big-
bendensis. The following characters of males, diagnostic of the barbatus
complex, are also present in males of P. texanus ; (1) head with the lateral
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
377
outline between the eye and the occipital corner evenly and rather strongly
convex, (2) eye not strongly convex, not protruding from side of head, (3)
mandible with teeth broad, blunt, and robust, (4) forewing generally with
one cubital cell, and (5) venter of petiolar peduncle with numerous long,
erect, ventrally directed hairs.
Within the barbatus complex, P. texanus appears to be most closely
related to P. apache and P. bigbendensis, and workers of these three
species share the four characters listed above under comparisons between
P. apache and P. bigbendensis. Workers of P. texanus differ from those
of P. bigbendensis as follows: (1) mandibular dentition, with seven teeth in
P. texanus and with the ultimate basal tooth not offset from margin, but
with 5-6 teeth in P. bigbendensis and with the ultimate basal tooth distinctly
offset from margin; (2) base of antennal scape, as Fig. 1 1 in P. texanus, and
as Fig. 12 in P. bigbendensis ; (3) shape of petiolar and postpetiolar nodes,
in dorsal view, as Fig. 13 in P. texanus, and as Fig. 15 in P. bigbendensis ;
and (4) size, with a Weber’s length of 2.30-2.75 mm in P. texanus versus
1.56-1.85 mm in P. bigbendensis. Workers of P. texanus differ from those
of P. apache as follows: (1) clypeal excision, with anterior margin of clypeal
lobe broadly and shallowly excised in P. texanus, but with the clypeal lobe
deeply excised, often to the level of the frontal lobes, in P. apache ; (2)
posterior epinotal declivity, smooth in P. texanus, and transversely rugose
in P. apache ; (3) ventral process of postpetiole, very weakly developed in
P. texanus, moderately developed in P. apache’, and (4) size, with a We¬
ber’s length range of 2.30-2.75 mm in P. texanus versus a range of 1.9-2.51
in P. apache.
The males of P. texanus differ from those of P. apache as follows: (1)
clypeal excision, with anterior margin of clypeal lobe broadly and shallowly
excised in P. texanus, and rather deeply and broadly excised in P. apache;
(2) shape of mandible, as Fig. 4 in P. texanus, as Fig. 6 in P. apache; (3)
proportions of the last two segments of antennal flagellum, in P. texanus
the apical segment is distinctly less than twice the length of the subapical
segment, whereas in P. apache the apical segment is about twice the length
of the subapical segment; (4) paramere morphology, as Fig. 16 in P. texanus,
whereas in P. apache the terminal lobe is proportionately shorter, more
angular and with a deeper excision on the inner margin (see Cole 1968, pi.
X, fig. 12); and (5) color, P. texanus is distinctly bicolored with the head
and thorax black and the gaster reddish brown, whereas P. apache is con-
colorous shiny black.
In Cole’s (1968) key to males of the barbatus complex, P. texanus will
key out to P. desertorum Wheeler because of its bicolored nature. The
males of these two species, however, can be easily separated by the follow¬
ing characters: (1) mandibles, as Fig. 4 in P. texanus, and as Fig. 5 in P.
desertorum; (2) epinotal armature, absent in P. texanus, but with two weak
378
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
tubercles in P. desertorum, and (3) parameres, as Fig. 16 in P. texanus,
whereas in P. desertorum the terminal lobe is proportionately shorter and
almost semicircular in outline (see Cole, 1968, pi. X, fig. 13). Workers of
these two species are only superficially similar because of the fineness of the
cephalic rugae and the broadly, shallowly emarginate clypeal lobe. They
can be separated as follows: (1) epinotal armature, absent in P. texanus,
and present as two long, sharp spines in P. desertorum ; (2) base of antennal
scape, as Fig. 11 in P. texanus, and more like Fig. 12 in P. desertorum,
with the superior and inferior lobes subequal; (3) metasternal flanges, with
dorsal portions fused in P. texanus, forming a single arcuate carina across
posterior declivity of epinotum, whereas the dorsal portions are not fused
in P. desertorum, and thus do not form an arcuate carina across the epinotal
declivity; and (4) size, with a Weber’s length range of 2.30-2.75 mm in P.
texanus versus 1.60-2.28 mm in P. desertorum.
Remarks. — We have collected and studied 21 nest series of P. texanus.
All the nests were found in open situations, mostly in level terrain (16 of
21; greatest slope exposure noted 20°). The altitudinal range is 580-1645 m
(1900-5400 ft), with most (n = 15) coming from 610-915 m (2000-3000 ft).
Soil characterization of the nests is as follows: clay 8, sandy clay loam 4,
clay loam 3, silty clay loam, sandy, and sandy clay 1 each. Conical craters
with a central depression, ranging from 5 cm diameter and 2.5 cm high to
25 cm x 10 cm (predominantly about 10 cm x 6 cm), were present on 16
nests; relatively flat discs were present on two (30 cm and 12 cm diameter,
respectively); and on three occasions no excavated material about the nest
entrance was observed.
The workers move slowly and at a steady gait, in contrast to the erratic,
hesitant gait of P. apache (see Cole, 1954, 1968; pers. obs.). The gaster is
usually held parallel to the substrate, in contrast to P. desertorum which
frequently forages with the gaster turned downward (Cole, 1968; pers. obs.).
Colonies are usually small (less than 100 workers), and there is no aggressive
response when the nest is disturbed.
To crudely determine the relative potency of the venom of P. texanus,
the senior author allowed one worker to sting him on the forearm. The
symptoms experienced are very similar to those resulting from envenoma-
tion by P. barbatus or Pogonomyrmex rugosus Emery.
Specimens examined. — In addition to the type nest series we have ex¬
amined workers (designated paratypes) from the following localities in Tex¬
as: Brewster Co., 29.2 km NE Marathon (1265 m), 27 July 1978 (T. B. Hall,
J. V. Moody, O. F. Francke); 6.5 km W Marathon (1250 m), 27 July 1978
(T. B. Hall, J. V. Moody, O. F. Francke: two nest series). Coke Co., 22.7
km NW Robert Lee (610 m), 25 July 1978 (T. B. Hall, J. V. Moody, O. F.
Francke). Crane Co., 8.1 km W Crane (750 m), 5 June 1979 (J. V. Moody,
O. F. Francke, F. W. Merickel). Crosby Co., 17.6 km N Crosbyton (880
m), 15 June 1978 (D. P. Bartell, R. Beckham, G. Henderson, K. Neece).
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
379
Culberson Co., Guadalupe Mountains National Park, mouth of McKittrick
Canyon (1540 m), 14 June 1978 (J. V. Moody, O. F. Francke). Dickens Co.,
21.9 km N Dickens (790 m), 11 June 1979 (W. D. Sissom, J. V. Moody, O.
F. Francke). Hall Co., 24 km S Estelline (580 m), 8 June 1978 (D. P. Bartell,
R. Beckham, G. Henderson, K. Neece). Midland Co., 48.6 km SW Midland
(880 m), 5 June 1979 (J. V. Moody, O. F. Francke, F. W. Merickel: two
nest series); 27.5 km S Midland (820 m), 12 August 1979 (J. V. Moody, O.
F. Francke. F. W. Merickel). Pecos Co., 6.5 km SE Sheffield (670 m), 10
August 1978 (T. B. Hall, J. V. Moody, W. D. Sissom, O. F. Francke).
Presidio Co., 34.7 km SW Marfa (1645 m), 8 August 1979 (J. V. Moody, O.
F. Francke, F. W. Merickel). Reagan Co., 21 km W Big Lake (850 m), 10
August 1978 (T. B. Hall, J. V. Moody, W. D. Sissom, O. F. Francke: two
nest series). Terrell Co., 53 km N Dryden (655 m), 21 October 1978 (E. L.
Meeks, J. V. Moody). Upton Co., 11 km N Rankin (670 m), 11 August 1978
(T. B. Hall, J. V. Moody, W. D. Sissom, O. F. Francke: two nest series);
37.3 km NW Rankin (870 m), 5 June 1979 (J. V. Moody, O. F. Francke, F.
W. Merickel). Paratypes deposited in the following collections: California
Academy of Sciences, American Museum of Natural History, Museum of
Comparative Zoology, Los Angeles County Museum, and Texas Tech Uni¬
versity.
Acknowledgments
We are grateful to the National Park Service for permission to collect in
Big Bend National Park and Guadalupe Mountains National Park; and to
Dr. Mont A. Cazier, Arizona State University, for the loan of comparative
material. Mr. James V. Moody helped considerably with both the field and
laboratory work; and made valuable suggestions on the manuscript, as did
the following: Dr. D. P. Bartell, Dr. W. F. Buren, Dr. R. E. Gregg, Dr. W.
P. Morrison, Dr. J. K. Wangberg, and one anonymous reviewer, all of whom
we thank.
Literature Cited
Cole, A. C. 1954. Studies of New Mexico Ants. IX. Pogonomyrmex apache Wheeler a
synonym of Pogonomyrmex sancti-hyacinthi Wheeler (Hymenoptera: Formicidae). J.
Tennessee Acad. Sci., 29(4) : 266-27 1 .
Cole, A. C. 1968. Pogonomyrmex harvester ants: A study of the genus in North America.
Univ. Tennessee Press, Knoxville, 222 pp.
Footnotes
1 Supported by Texas Department of Agriculture Interagency Contract No. IAC (78-79) 0744.
Contribution No. T-10-124, College of Agricultural Sciences, Texas Tech University.
2 Present address: Department of Entomology, University of Idaho, Moscow 83843.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
April 1981, Vol. 57, No. 2, pp. 380-384
COURTSHIP AND DIET OF THE NEOTROPICAL ROBBER FLY
MALLOPHORA SCHWARZI CURRAN
(DIPTERA: ASILIDAE)1
Todd E. Shelly and Dorothy A. Weinberger2
Department of Biology, University of California, Los Angeles 90024
Except for Curran’s (1934) original description of the species based on
specimens from Barro Colorado Island in the Panama Canal, and reports of
individuals from Cerro Campana, Panama, and Madden Forest, former Ca¬
nal Zone (E. Fisher, pers. comm.) there are no published accounts on the
biology of Mallophora schwarzi. The present observations were made 3 km
northwest of Gamboa, former Canal Zone, on a hillside that had been largely
cleared by the U.S. Army. Although occasionally seen on tall grass blades,
individuals of M. schwarzi were most regularly seen on branch tips of shrubs
and trees that bordered the cleared space.
All observations were made between February 20 and April 21, 1979. No
M. schwarzi were seen prior to February 20 during weekly visits to the site
conducted since October 1978 (M. Greenfield, pers. comm.). Peak abun¬
dance was noted on March 1 1 when 20-25 mating pairs and numerous sol¬
itary individuals were observed in a 2 hr period. Following this mid-March
peak, numbers declined steadily. On April 21 we saw only 1 individual, and
on June 18 no M. schwarzi were seen. Thus the flight period of M. schwarzi
appears limited to the 2 months from mid-February to mid- April.
Mallophora schwarzi is a robust species whose members resemble certain
euglossine bees of the genus Eulaema (E. Fisher, pers. comm.). Individuals
vary from 20 to 23 mm in length. Dense, orange pile on abdominal segments
2-7 contrasts sharply with the shiny, black face and black pile of the
thorax, the first abdominal segment, and the anterior pair of legs. The sexes
exhibit dimorphism in that the hind legs of the female are totally black¬
haired, whereas in the male the venter of the apical half of the hind femora
and the venter and side of the basal % of the hind tibiae are covered with
relatively long, white hairs.
Males of Curran’s type series (from Barro Colorado) also possessed abun¬
dant white hairs on the metatarsi and males observed near Gamboa, al¬
though similar to the type series, lacked such white hairs. In addition, a
male recently captured on Barro Colorado (March 1980) also lacked these
white, metatarsal hairs. Consequently, M. schwarzi males are here consid¬
ered to be polymorphic with respect to the presence or absence of white,
metatarsal hairs.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
381
Courtship
Courtship and mating occurred with greatest frequency between approx¬
imately 0900 hr and 1200 hr. Individuals were seldom active before 0800
hr at which time they were first seen perching on branches exposed to full
sunlight. Individuals rarely exhibited mating behavior in the afternoon but
during this time appeared to be primarily engaged in foraging activity.
Courtship proceeded as follows. A flying male approached a perching
female and hovered approximately 7 to 15 cm above and behind her. From
this position the male made repeated approaches to and withdrawals from
the stationary female. Thus, the male appeared to be bobbing up and down
slightly above and behind the female. Throughout this movement, the male’s
anterior pair of legs were held against the thorax, while the hindlegs were
widespread. In the majority of the male’s approaches no contact was made
with the female. However, in some approaches the male contacted the fe¬
male’s wings (which were resting directly over her abdomen) with a forward
movement of his hindlegs, flicking her wings away from her body into a
spread position. This wing flick was extremely rapid, since the male with¬
drew immediately and continued the bobbing behavior. Sometimes, before
approaching the female, the male hovered and rubbed his hindlegs over its
posterior abdominal segments. Following 2-4 such grooming actions, the
male resumed approach-withdrawal activity. This bobbing behavior with
occasional wing flicking lasted 3-4 minutes at the longest and was inter¬
rupted only by the male grooming behavior. All observed courtship behavior
ended with the female suddenly flying away and the male following. Thus,
although copulating pairs were observed, not one observed courtship dis¬
play was seen to result directly in copulation.
Diet
Mallophora schwarzi are sit and wait predators that attempt aerial capture
of passing, flying insect prey. Individuals perch in open, conspicuous sites
on grass blades and woody branch tips at heights of 50-310 cm. Although
most foraging flights were less than 1.0-1. 5 m long, several flights of 2-3 m
were observed.
M. schwarzi is a dietary specialist on Apidae, Vespidae, and Sphecidae
(Table 1). These 3 families alone comprised 90% of the recorded diet. Apidae
constituted the major prey taxon (49%), and within the family 53% were
members of the genus Trigona. The remaining prey included 2 ants, 1 re-
duviid, and 1 stratiomyid.
Mean length and wet weight values for all prey were 9.94 mm and 24.6
mg, respectively. Individual prey lengths varied 3.5 fold (17.6/5.0), and in¬
dividual wet weights varied 1 19 fold (178.2/1 .5). Distribution of prey lengths
was not significantly skewed ( t = 1.74; P < .1) but was highly leptokurtotic
382
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 1. Prey of Mallophora schwarzi, February 20-April 21, 1979, near Gamboa, former
Canal Zone.
(t = 9.18; P < .001). Conversely, distribution of prey wet weights was sig¬
nificantly skewed to the right ( t = 2.9; P < .01) but did not differ signifi¬
cantly from normality with respect to kurtosis (/ = 0.13; P < .9).
Discussion
The importance of courtship behavior in robber fly reproductive behavior
varies greatly among species; for details of particular species see Lavigne
and Holland (1969), Rogers and Lavigne (1972), Dennis and Lavigne (1975)
and references therein. Certain species exhibit no recognizable courtship
behavior. Males simply overtake females in the air, and the grappling pair
falls to the ground and mates. In other species courtship may only involve
male searching flights for females. More complex behavior may involve
either (1) males hovering above females, (2) males hovering above females
and making contact with them, (3) males palpating their fore legs on the
substrate directly before the female, or (4) males performing intricate
“dances” involving leg, wing, and abdominal movement.
In the 2 previous accounts of courtship in Mallophora, both Alcock (1974)
and Copello (1922) described hovering, back-and-forth movement of males
behind perched females for M. fautrix Osten Sacken and M. ruficauda
(Wiedemann), respectively. In addition, Copello (1922) noted a movement
(no further description is provided) of the female’s wings in synchrony with
a forward movement of the bobbing male’s hind legs. Copello (1922) pro¬
posed that the female moved its wings as an annoyance signal to discourage
the male. In observing M. schwarzi, however, we clearly saw that female
wing movement was actually induced by the forward movement of the
male’s hind legs. Given our observations and the observed synchrony in
female wing movement and male leg movement in M. ruficauda, we suggest
that male wing flicking behavior occurs in M. ruficauda as well.
Male contact with the female during courtship has been noted for only a
few asilid species. In these previous accounts, males were always noted to
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 2
383
make contact by touching their fore legs to either the female’s eyes, Stich-
opogon trifasciatus (Say) (Lavigne and Holland, 1969), wings, Heteropogon
wilcoxi James (Lavigne and Holland, 1969) or head and thorax, Cyrtopogon
auratus Cole (Wilcox and Martin, 1936). The wing flicking action described
here for M. schwarzi males (and presumably for M. ruficauda males) is the
first account of such courtship behavior in the Asilidae.
As E. Fisher (pers. comm.) has noted, unlike most asilid species, M.
schwarzi (and all other Mallophora species) possess wings which are sig¬
nificantly longer than the abdomen. Access to a perching M. schwarzi fe¬
male may thus require that the wings be spread. Wing flicking behavior
could serve to provide the male with access to the female.
The tendency for Mallophora species to feed primarily (if not exclusively)
upon bees and wasps has been observed in a variety of species (Bromley,
1930, 1946, 1950; Carrera, 1945, 1947; Carrera and Vulcano, 1961; Alex,
1947; Linsley, 1960; Clements and Bennett, 1969). With bees and wasps
constituting 90% of its recorded diet, M. schwarzi clearly conforms to this
generic pattern. Although no data were collected regarding available prey,
the leptokurtotic distribution of prey lengths further reveals that M. schwar¬
zi feeds upon a relatively narrow length range (62% of recorded prey were
between 7-11 mm). In part, this result reflects the relatively high proportion
(26%) of Trigona spp. in the diet. Trigona are slow-flying bees, and M.
schwarzi may have relatively little difficulty capturing them. Trigona prey
were all between 7-11 mm. The skewed distribution of prey wet weights,
however, indicates that within this narrow length range, prey varied con¬
siderably in weight and that M. schwarzi was capable of capturing the heavi¬
er items. These comments upon prey selection are preliminary, however,
and a detailed analysis obviously requires monitoring of available prey.
Acknowledgments
We thank Eric Fisher for taxonomic assistance and for many helpful com¬
ments on an earlier draft. M. Greenfield provided initial encouragement to
observe the species.
Literature Cited
Alcock, J. 1974. Observations on the behavior of Mallophora fautrix Osten Sacken (Dip-
tera: Asilidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol., 50:68-72.
Alex, A. H. 1947. Notes on robber flies (Asilidae) preying on honey bees in the San Antonio
area during 1946. Bull. Brooklyn Entomol. Soc., 42:170-172.
Bromley, S. W. 1930. Bee-killing robber flies. J. New York Entomol. Soc., 38:159-177.
Bromley, S. W. 1946. Bee-killing Asilidae of the southeastern United States (Diptera). Proc.
Entomol. Soc. Wash., 48:16-17.
Bromley, S. W. 1950. Florida Asilidae (Diptera) with description of one new species. Ann.
Entomol. Soc. Am., 43:227-239.
384
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Carrera, M. 1945. Relacao de alguns Asilidae (Diptera) com suas pressas. Papeis Avulsos
Dep. Zool., Sao Paulo, 5:159-166.
Carrera, M. 1947. Segunda relacao de alguns Asilidae (Diptera) e suas presas, com a descricao
previa de nuas novas especies. Papeis Avulsos Dep. Zool., Sao Paulo, 8:265-271.
Carrera, M., and M. A. Vulcano. 1961. Relacao de alguns Asilidae (Diptera) e suas presas
(IV). Rev. Brazil. Ent., 10:67-80.
Clements, A. N., and F. D. Bennett. 1969. The structure and biology of a new species of
Mallophora Macq. (Diptera, Asilidae) from Trinidad, W. I. Bull. Entomol. Res., 58:455-
463.
Copello, A. 1922. Biologia de Mallophora ruficauda Wied. Physis, 6:30-42.
Curran, C. H. 1934. New American Asilidae (Diptera). III. Am. Mus. Novitates, No. 752.
18 pp.
Dennis, D. S., and R. J. Lavigne. 1975. Comparative behavior of Wyoming robber flies. II
(Diptera: Asilidae). Univ. Wyo. Agric. Exp. Sta. Sci. Monogr., 30:1-68.
Lavigne, R. J., and F. R. Holland. 1969. Comparative behavior of eleven species of Wyoming
robber flies (Diptera: Asilidae). Univ. Wyo. Agr. Exp. Sta. Sci. Monogr., 18:1-61.
Linsley, E. G. 1960. Ethology of some bee- and wasp-killing robber flies of southeastern
Arizona and western New Mexico (Diptera: Asilidae). Univ. Calif. Publ. Entomol.,
16:357-392.
Rogers, L. E., and R. J. Lavigne. 1972. Asilidae of the Pawnee National Grasslands, in
northeastern Colorado. Univ. Wyo. Agr. Exp. Sta. Sci. Monogr., 25:1-35.
Wilcox, J., and C. H. Martin. 1936. A review of the genus Cyrtopogon in North America
(Diptera: Asilidae). Entomol. Americana, 16:1-94.
Footnotes
1 This research was supported by a Regent’s Fellowship, University of California, to Shelly.
2 Present address: 3326 Sawtelle Ave., Los Angeles, California.
PUBLICATIONS
OF THE
PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
PROCEEDINGS OF THE PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL
SOCIETY.
Vol. 1 (16 numbers, 179 pages) and Vol. 2 (9 numbers, 131
pages). 1901-1930. Price $5.00 per volume.
THE PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST.
Vol. 1 (1924) to Vol. 51 (1975), price $10.00 per volume of 4
numbers, or $2.50 per single issue. Vol. 52 (1976) and subse¬
quent issues, $15.00 per volume or $3.75 per single issue.
MEMOIR SERIES.
Volume 1. The Sucking Lice by G. F. Ferris. 320 pages. Pub¬
lished October 1951. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.00 postage and han¬
dling.)*
Volume 2. The Spider Mite Family Tetranychidae by A. Earl
Pritchard and Edward W. Baker. 472 pages. Published July
1955. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 3. Revisionary Studies in the Nearctic Decticinae by
David C. Rentz and James D. Birchim. 173 pages. Published
July 1968. Price $4.00 (Plus $.75 postage and handling.)*
Volume 4. Autobiography of an Entomologist by Robert L.
Usinger. 343 pages. Published August 1972. Price $15.00. (Plus
$1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 5. Revision of the Millipede Family Andrognathidae
in the Nearctic Region by Michael R. Gardner. 61 pages. Pub¬
lished January 21, 1975. Price $3.00 (Plus $.75 postage and
handling.)*
*(Add 6% sales tax on all California orders (resident of Alameda, Contra
Costa, San Francisco, Santa Clara and Santa Cruz counties add 61/2%) .
Members of the Society will receive a 20% discount.)
Send orders to:
Pacific Coast Entomological Society
c/o California Academy of Sciences
Golden Gate Park
San Francisco, California 94118
Vol. 57
JULY 1981
No. 3
THE
Pan-Pacific Entomologist
VILLEGAS and BYERS — Orobittacus obscurus, a New Genus and Species of Bittaci-
dae (Mecoptera) from California _ 385
POLHEMUS and POLHEMUS — Three New Species of Ambrysus from Mexico (He-
miptera: Naucoridae) _ 397
GOEDEN and RICKER — Life History of the Gall-forming Moth, Carolella beevorana
Comstock, on the Ragweed, Ambrosia dumosa (Gray) Payne, in Southern Cali¬
fornia (Lepidoptera: Cochylidae) _ 402
BALSBAUGH — Nonarthra cyaneum Baly (Coleoptera: Chrysomelidae: Alticinae), a
Pan-Pacific Flea Beetle _ 41 1
WILDER — A Review of the Genus Roederoides Coquillett with the Description of a
New Species (Diptera: Empididae) _ 415
WILDER — A Revision of the Genus Niphogenia Melander (Diptera: Empididae) _ 422
REIMER and GOEDEN — Descriptions of the Immature Stages of Stobaera tricarinata
(Say) (Hemiptera-Homoptera: Delphacidae) _ 429
ELLIOTT — Records of Plecoptera (Insecta) from Southeastern Alaska _ 434
PETERS — The Effects of an Outbreak of Tridepia nova (Smith) (Lepidoptera: Noctuidae)
on Four-wing Saltbush, Atriplex canescens (Pursh) Nutt. _ 443
SCIENTIFIC NOTE
Hartman and Zahary — Aggregation in Two Sympatric Species of Crane Fly (Dip¬
tera: Tipulidae) _ 447
SAN FRANCISCO, CALIFORNIA • 1981
Published by the PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
in cooperation with THE CALIFORNIA ACADEMY OF SCIENCES
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist
EDITORIAL BOARD
G. A. Marsh, Editor
C. Pleines, Editorial Asst.
P. H. Amaud, Jr., Treasurer H. B. Leech
R. M. Bohart E. S. Ross J. A. Chemsak
Published quarterly in January, April, July and October with Society Proceedings
appearing in the October number. All communications regarding nonreceipt of num¬
bers, requests for sample copies, and financial communications should be addressed
to the Treasurer, Dr. Paul H. Amaud, Jr., California Academy of Sciences, Golden
Gate Park, San Francisco, California 94118.
Application for membership in the Society and changes of address should be ad¬
dressed to the Secretary, Ronald E. Somerby, Insect Taxonomy Laboratory, California
Department of Food and Agriculture, 1220 “N” St., Sacramento, CA 95814.
Manuscripts, proofs and all correspondence concerning editorial matters should be
addressed to Gordon A. Marsh, Museum of Systematic Biology, University of Cal¬
ifornia, Irvine, 92717.
The annual dues, paid in advance, are $12.00 for regular members of the Society,
$7.00 for student members, or $15.00 for subscription only. Members of the society
receive The Pan-Pacific Entomologist. Single copies of recent numbers are $3.75 each
or $15.00 a volume. Write to the treasurer for prices of earlier back numbers. Make
all checks payable to The Pacific Coast Entomological Society.
The Pacific Coast Entomological Society
OFFICERS FOR 1981
D. Kavanaugh, President P. H. Amaud, Jr., Treasurer
J. E. Hafemik, Jr., President-Elect R. E. Somerby, Secretary
Statement of Ownership
Title of Publication: The Pan-Pacific Entomologist.
Frequency of Issue: Quarterly (January. April, July, October).
Location of Office of Publication, Business Office of Publisher and Owner: Pacific Coast Entomological Society,
California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, California 94118.
Editor: G. A. Marsh, Museum of Systematic Biology, University of California, Irvine, 92717
Managing Editor and Known Bondholders or other Security Holders: None.
This issue mailed 1 April 1982
Second Class Postage Paid at San Francisco, California and Additional offices.
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist (ISSN 0031-0603)
PRINTED BY THE ALLEN PRESS, INC., LAWRENCE, KANSAS 66044, U.S.A.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 385-396
OROBITTACUS OBSCURUS, A NEW GENUS AND SPECIES OF
BITTACIDAE (MECOPTERA) FROM CALIFORNIA
Baldomero Villegas1 and George W. Byers2
Genera in the Bittacidae have traditionally been differentiated primarily
on the basis of wing characters — fusion of veins, number of costal cross¬
veins, reduction or loss of wings, etc. Descriptions of most genera have
included little about other structural details. Probably this has been due
largely to the fact that most genera, when described, were monotypic so
that the difference between generic and specific significance of taxonomic
characters was not yet clear. Their authors observed greater differences in
characters of antennae, legs and genital structures within the large genus
Bittacus Latreille than between Bittacus and the new genera. Rarely, there
has been an exception, for example, Pazius Navas, distinguished by large,
contiguous compound eyes. Byers (1972) discussed this problem in relation
to Kalobittacus Esben-Petersen, Nannobittacus Esben-Petersen and Issi-
kiella Byers.
Accordingly, Smithers’ (1973) discovery of the remarkable Australian
Tytthobittacus macalpinei, which differed from other Bittacidae more in
male genitalia than in venation, came as a surprise. Two characteristics of
this species are striking: the cerci are greatly enlarged, extending beyond
the apices of the basistyles, and the ninth abdominal tergum is a medially
notched, horizontally-oriented plate (rather than two vertically-aligned
lobes, as in all other bittacids).
An even more surprising species, recently discovered in central Califor¬
nia, also has greatly lengthened and widened cerci in the male. Its ninth
abdominal tergum is more modified than that of Tytthobittacus , being pro¬
duced backward as a single median lobe with terminal, claw-like spines, and
solidly fused to the ninth sternum at the sides. The dististyles in this species
are not small and simple, as in Bittacidae generally, but large, bilobed and
of complex structure. In both sexes the antennae are conspicuously long,
and the wings have no pterostigmal cross-veins.
Except for the cerci, these characteristics recalled Anabittacus iridipennis
Kimmins of southern Chile. This led to a re-examination of males of that
species, dissection revealing that the supposed lobes of the ninth tergum are
in fact enlarged cerci, arising close beneath the inconspicuous, downturned
tergum (cf. Byers, 1965:136, figs. 1, 5). Anabittacus turns out to be, in
several respects, intermediate between Tytthobittacus of eastern Australia
and the new genus from California, a circumstance that agrees well with our
current concept of continental drift as a factor in zoogeography of Mecop-
tera.
386
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Orobittacus, new genus
This genus includes bittacids in the wings of which vein is un¬
branched, pterostigmal cross-veins are absent but a single cross-vein con¬
nects Rj and R2+3 far before the stigma, and M4 branches from M3 beyond
the m-cu cross-vein; in which the antennae are nearly as long as the body
or slightly longer and have 34 or more flagellomeres; and in males of which
the ninth abdominal segment is a continuously sclerotized ring with a single,
median, dorsal projection, the cerci are longer than the basistyles and broad¬
ly spatulate, and the dististyles are large, complex and two-branched.
Type species. — Orobittacus ob scums, new species.
The generic name is derived in part from both Greek and Spanish (Greek
or os = mountain, Spanish oro = gold, + Bittacus ), referring to the occur¬
rence of the type species in the Sierra Nevada, particularly in the region
where gold was discovered in 1848 on the American River, not far below
the type locality.
Orobittacus can be differentiated from other genera of Bittacidae in the
Western Hemisphere by the following key:
Key to Genera of Bittacidae of the Western Hemisphere
1. Antennae nearly as long as body or slightly longer; cross-vein be¬
tween Rx and R2+3 far before pterostigma, approximately opposite
level of tip of Cu4; ninth abdominal tergum and sternum of male
fused into continuous ring; cerci of male projecting farther caudad
than any part of ninth tergum . 2
Antennae less than half as long as body; one or two cross-veins
between Rx and R2+3 behind pterostigma (or wings absent); ninth
abdominal tergum and sternum of male separated laterally by
membranous pleura; cerci of male usually much shorter than cau¬
dal prolongations of ninth tergum . 3
2. Vein M trifurcate at first fork (M1+2 , M3 and M4 having single origin);
R2 and R3 separated before wing margin, Rs thus with four branch¬
es; in male, ninth abdominal tergum with two short, downtumed
submedian lobes, ninth sternum with narrowly triangular median
projection (southern Chile and Argentina) .
. Anabittacus Kimmins
Vein M bifurcate at first fork (M4 originating from M3 well beyond
first fork of M); R2 and R3 coalesced to wing margin, so Rs has
only three branches; in male, ninth abdominal tergum with one
median projection directed caudad, posterior margin of ninth ster¬
num entire, without median projection (California) .
. . . . Orobittacus , new genus
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
387
3. Wings absent (California) . Apterobittacus, MacLachlan
Wings present . 4
4. In front wing, vein 1 A short, extending at most to level of origin of
M, often only slightly beyond level of humeral cross- vein . 5
In front wing, vein 1A extending approximately to level of first fork
of M, i.e., far beyond origin of M . 8
5. Vein 1A in front wing extending approximately to level of origin of
M; two pterostigmal cross-veins (Pcv) (Mexico and Central Amer¬
ica) . Kalobittacus Esben-Petersen
Vein 1A in front wing extending only slightly past level of humeral
cross-vein; only one Pcv . 6
6. Compound eyes enlarged, touching on front of head beneath anten¬
nae; abdomen extremely long and slender, extending far beyond
tips of wings (Central America and northern South America) . . .
. Pazius Navas
Compound eyes not touching on front of head; abdomen not ex¬
tending beyond wing tips, or only slightly beyond them . 7
7. Subcosta ending in costa (C) before level of first fork of radial sector
(FRs); subcostal cross- vein (Scv) near level of origin of Rs; vein
Cu2 in front wing ending opposite first fork of M (Brasil and Bo¬
livia) . Issikiella Byers
Subcosta ending in C well beyond FRs; Scv well beyond origin of
Rs; in front wing, Cu2 ending well beyond level of first fork of M
(Panama, Colombia, Venezuela, Brasil) .
. Nannobittacus Esben-Petersen
8. Costal cell with 4 or 5 cross-veins beyond humeral cross-vein (h);
wings broadly banded and spotted with brown (Brasil) .
. Neobittacus Esben-Petersen
Costal cell with 0 to 3 cross-veins, usually 0 or 1, beyond h; wings
not extensively banded but may be spotted or have narrow dark¬
ened zones along some cross-veins or veins . 9
9. Wings hyaline with smoky gray or black spot at apex; only one Pcv
(eastern United States, possibly Mexico) .
. Hylobittacus Byers
Wings usually tinged with yellow or yellowish brown, without dark¬
ened apex; usually two Pcv (one in some South American species)
(United States, southeastern Canada, Mexico, Central America,
South America) . Bittacus Latreille
Orobittacus obscurus, new species
Description based on 191 8 8 , 122 9 9 pinned and 86 8 8, 76 9 9 pre¬
served in alcohol.
388
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Head. — Dorsal occiput, vertex and frons above antennal bases shining
black, grading into blackish brown on occipital-postgenal surfaces behind
eyes and on small median swelling immediately below and between antennal
sockets. Rostrum and palps generally dark yellowish brown, labrum slightly
darker. Eyes dark plum colored, slightly convergent below antennal bases.
All three ocelli of approximately same diameter, on prominent elevation.
Anterior tentorial pits conspicuous but epistomal suture otherwise obliter¬
ated. Rostrum slender but short; labrum only a little more than twice as
long as width at base. Mandible with a single subterminal tooth; maxillary
lacinia bearing brush of hairs at apex, fifth segment of maxillary palp shorter
than fourth, without hairs. Antennae long (about 16 mm in both sexes), if
drawn out along costal wing margin extending to mid-length of pterostigma,
comprising thick subcylindrical scape, pedicel, and 38-39 distinct flagello-
meres in male, 34-37 in female.
Thorax. — Pronotum shining black with thin, pale hairs along anterior mar¬
gin, hairs increasing in length from mid-line toward sides. Mesonotum and
metanotum shining black to brownish black with sparse, fine hairs; two
longer, thicker hairs on each scutellum. Pleural surfaces unevenly blackish
brown to brown, glossy, with few scattered, very thin, pale hairs; coxae
yellowish brown ventrally, grading into brown dorsally, front and middle
coxae bearing long, pale hairs on anterior surfaces; mera brown. Femora
not noticeably enlarged in either sex, yellowish brown, covered with
closely-set rings of tiny setae but without spines. Tibiae dark yellowish
brown basally, darkening to brown at apex, with rings of tiny setae through¬
out; no spines on fore tibia, 4-6 on middle tibia, and several on hind tibia,
particularly on apical half; tibial spurs long, slender. Tarsi brown at base
grading to dark brown distally, narrowly paler at joints; tarsomere 4 with
0-2 pairs of lateral spines; tarsomere 5 without spines; basitarsus of front
leg about 7 times length of fifth tarsomere (more than twice as long as hind
basitarsus) in both males and females; basitarsus of hind leg only about 3
times as long as fifth tarsomere in male, 4 times as long in female. Tarso-
meres 3, 4 and 5 finely toothed along their opposing edges; pretarsal claws
slender, nearly straight in basal three-fourths, gently curved near tip.
Wings (Figs. 1, 7) moderately iridescent, evenly darkened with smoky
yellowish brown, stigma only slightly darker; diffuse gray clouding along
cross-veins in radial and medial fields. Subcosta in fore wing ending in costa
slightly beyond first fork of radial sector (FRs), subcostal cross- vein (Scv)
opposite FRs. No pterostigmal cross- veins, but a single cross-vein between
Rj and R2+3 about half-way between Scv and proximal end of stigma. Vein
Rj with short transverse branch to C near base of stigma, in many individ¬
uals an indication (concentrated row of setae) of diagonal second branch
near mid-length of stigma. Vein R2,3 unbranched; Rs, R4, 5 and R5 nearly in
alignment; usually only one cross-vein between R2+3 and R4 but two or
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
389
Fig. 1. Orobittacus obscurus, new genus and species, dorsolateral aspect of individual
suspended from spiderweb in typical resting posture. Photograph by B. Villegas.
rarely three present in one or more wings of some individuals; R4 rarely
forked. Conspicuous thyridium at first fork of media; only one cross-vein
between M, and M2, none between M3 and M4; vein M3+4 branching well
beyond m-cu cross-vein. Small thyridium at junction of M3+4 and m-cu,
another on short cross- vein between Cu2 and 1A near base of wing. Vein
1A extends to level of origin of Rs; 2A extends almost to level of origin of
390
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 2-6. Orobittacus obscurus, n. sp., details of terminal abdominal segments of male
paratype. Fig. 2, terminal abdominal segments, left lateral aspect. Fig. 3, basistyle, dististyle,
aedeagus and associated structures, posteroventral aspect; most of right side omitted. Fig. 4,
ninth abdominal tergum and epiproct, left lateral aspect. Fig. 5, posterior process of ninth
abdominal tergum, dorsal aspect. Fig. 6, left dististyle, left lateral aspect. Scale a. Figs. 2-3;
scale b, Figs. 4-6.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
391
M; 3 A short, inconspicuous. In hindwing, Sc ends in C well before FRs,
Scv opposite mid-length of Rs or slightly more proximal; veins 2 A and 3 A
fused with 1A except for short terminal segments.
Abdomen of male. — Terga 2-5 dark brown, 6-8 shining black; corre¬
sponding sterna similarly colored. Segment 9 a continuously sclerotized
ring, abruptly paler than 8, brown dorsomedially paling to sordid yellowish
brown at sides, dark yellowish brown ventrally. Basistyles, most of disti-
styles, and cerci pale yellowish brown. Slender, wedge-shaped laterosternite
at each side of sterna 2-7, attached very narrowly to anterolateral corner
of sternum on segments 3-7 (attachment usually concealed by fold of pleural
membrane), attached more broadly to separate anterior portion of sternum
2. No spines on sides of anterior terga. Tergum 9 totally lacking epiandrial
lobes, produced caudad as a complex median lobe (Figs. 2, 4, 5) with dark¬
ened, dorsal, setiferous prominence and more ventral, slender process
abruptly widened at apex and bearing about 12 thick, downcurved, black
spines. Proctiger not conspicuous, but cerci arising from its sides (Fig. 2)
greatly enlarged, flattened (compressed), gradually expanded toward diag¬
onally truncate apex, slightly bent and constricted near mid-length, with
subapical hairs on mesal surface directed cephalad. Basistyles deeply sep¬
arated, connected ventrally by membranous cuticle, each with submedian
ventral protuberance, acute, blade-like point just above base of dististyle
and slender, setiferous projection directed mesad below base of dististyle
(Fig. 3). Conspicuous membranous structure, appearing as inflated, four-
chambered pouch in specimens preserved in fluid (Fig. 3), adjacent to inner
surface of each basistyle (may be homolog of pheromone sac of Panorpidae;
tergal pheromone sacs not evident). Dististyles (Figs. 3, 6) large and com¬
plex (as compared to those of Bittacidae in general), deeply divided, com¬
prising a stout anterodorsal arm with shallow mesal concavity at apex and
a more slender, curved, posteroventral arm with pale basal portion bearing
numerous dark setae, and darkly sclerotized, mostly glabrous distal portion
with small tuft of setae at apex. Aedeagus (Fig, 3) a slender filament with
basal membranous pouch at each side, median dorsal sclerotized band above
pouches, and pair of flattened, sclerotized ventrolateral appendages (pos¬
sibly homologs of ventral parameres of Panorpidae) each with broad, round¬
ed subterminal lobe and sharp, curved tip.
Abdomen of female. — All terga and sterna unevenly brown to dark brown,
terga 2 and 3 somewhat darker than others. Laterosternites on segments 2-
7, shaped and attached as in male. Segment 8 continuously sclerotized ex¬
cept along ventral mid-line (Figs. 8,9); hypovalves subtriangular, hinged to
each other and to basal eighth sternum by lightly sclerotized cuticle. Ninth
tergum saddle-like, sternum 9 lightly sclerotized, pale except for slender
dark ring around aperture of bursa (spermathecal duct). Tenth segment
392
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 7-10. Orobittacus obscurus, n. sp., wing of male and details of abdomen of female
paratype. Fig. 7, right front wing of male paratype; A — anal vein. M — media, R — radius. Fig.
8, terminal abdominal segments of female, left lateral aspect; hv — hypo valve of ovipositor, It —
laterosternite, t — tergum. Fig. 9, terminal abdominal segments of female, ventral aspect; hv —
hypovalve, s — sternum. Fig. 10, spermatheca and portion of spermathecal duct. Scale a, Fig.
7; scale b, Figs. 8-10.
mostly membranous ventrally but caudal margin sclerotized, forming con¬
tinuous ring with tergum; tergum and sternum of segment 11 moderately
sclerotized; cerci pale at base, darkened toward acute apex. Spermatheca
(Fig. 10) darkly sclerotized except around attachment of short, thick sper¬
mathecal duct. Nearly mature eggs oval in outline, ends equally rounded;
chorion dark yellowish brown.
Body length, male, about 14.5-16.8 mm (M = 15.7; holotype 16.0 mm);
female, 14.0-15.7 mm (M = 15.0; allotype 14.0 mm). Length of front wing,
male, 16.2-17.9 mm (M = 16.9; holotype 17.9 mm); female, 16.5-17.0 mm
(M = 16.8; allotype 16.6 mm).
Types. — Holotype, male, labelled “California, El Dorado Co. #3, Amer¬
ican Riv., 11.4 mi. W. of Kyburz, 6 June 1976, 3040 ft., G. W. Byers, B.
Villegas.” Allotype, female, and 15 6 , 8 9 paratypes, same label data as
for holotype. Additional paratopotypes, 211 c3, 156 9, various dates from
10 May to 4 July, most early June 1976-1979. Additional paratypes, 50 <3,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
393
33 $ , Shirttail Creek, 6.4 km northeast of Foresthill, Tahoe National Forest,
Placer Co., California, 27 May and 7 June 1976. The type locality is the
vicinity of a U.S. Forest Service picnic area near Bridal Veil Falls, El
Dorado National Forest, between U.S. Highway 50 and the South Fork of
the American River, about 18 miles east of Placerville. Holotype, allotype
and initially 331 paratypes in the Snow Entomological Museum, University
of Kansas, Lawrence, Kansas; 142 paratypes in the collection of the Uni¬
versity of California at Davis. Paratypes will be distributed from the Snow
Museum to other entomological collections, including the California Acad¬
emy of Sciences, the Los Angeles County Museum, the California Insect
Survey, the U.S. National Museum of Natural History, the Museum of
Comparative Zoology at Harvard University, the Illinois Natural History
Survey, Cornell University, the University of Michigan, the Florida State
Collection of Arthropods, the British Museum (Natural History), and the
Australian Museum.
Habitat
At the type locality, the American River flows generally westward be¬
tween steep (50-60°), rocky but largely forested slopes. The river flows
among huge boulders (Fig. 11), and the lower slopes are strewn with boul¬
ders and rocks of all sizes broken from the outcrops above. Soil trapped on
the slopes and forming the short, narrow floodplain at this site is sandy but
humous. The forest is dominated by three conifers, Ponderosa Pine ( Pinus
ponder osa ), Incense Cedar ( Calocedrus decurrens ) and Douglas-Fir ( Psen -
dotsuga menziesii ). It also includes Big-leaf Maple ( Acer macrophyllum) ,
dogwood ( Cornus sessilis), hazelnut ( Corylus cornuta ), occasional oaks,
and, along the stream, White Alder ( Alnus rhombifolia ) and willow ( Salix
sp.). Particularly on the north-facing slope, a variety of mosses are common
on outcropping rocks, boulders, fallen logs and soil, where these substrates
are more or less continuously moist and shaded. The herb-grass-fern stratum
is generally well developed. Elevation at the floodplain is approximately 935
meters, or 3040 feet.
The habitat at the Shirttail Creek site is much the same, differing chiefly
in the much narrower stream, the somewhat steeper slopes along it, and
generally slightly drier conditions. In addition to the three dominant coni¬
fers, Jeffrey Pine ( Pinus jeffreyi), California Black Oak ( Quercus kelloggii)
and Canyon Live Oak ( Q . chrysolepis) are common on the slopes. Dog¬
woods, hazelnuts, alders and willows are common nearer the stream. Ele¬
vation is approximately 1060 meters, or 3440 feet. Shirttail Creek flows
generally southwestward to join the North Fork of the American River.
During the day, Orobittacus usually seeks darkly shaded crannies in
which the humidity is high. Often, such resting places are beneath tree roots
Fig. 1
River, 1
Ponderc
tacus obscurus , n. sp.,
/burz, El Dorado Cou
ar and Douglas Fir. PI
: bank of I
California,
aph by B
Fork of the Ameri
inant forest trees
igas.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
395
in overhanging banks, below rock outcrops and in deep shade beneath fallen
logs, and along streams beneath large boulders even near the water’s edge.
Habits
In their day-time hiding places, individuals of Orobittacus will be found
ordinarily hanging by their more or less outspread front and middle legs,
with the hind legs held close together along the ventral side of the abdomen,
the tarsi curving dorsad around the tips of the folded wings (Fig. 1). Because
of their dark color, they are not easily seen when thus suspended motionless
in darkened crannies; hence their specific name, obscurus.
Places where Orobittacus hides by day are often inhabited by spiders,
and it is common for the hanging-flies to suspend themselves from spider¬
webs when at rest. Occasionally they become entangled, however, and are
preyed upon by the spiders. Fungus gnats (Mycetophilidae) abound in many
of the niches occupied by Orobittacus and constitute the main prey of the
bittacids; they are also frequently trapped in the spiderwebs. Male and
female Orobittacus captured with prey were carrying fungus gnats; one was
also seen feeding on a small crane fly (Tipulidae).
Courtship and mating have not been observed, either in natural surround¬
ings or when the insects were caged. This behavior is presumed to occur at
night, when Orobittacus has been seen leaving its day-time retreats.
Geographical and Seasonal Distribution
Orobittacus obscurus is known from only the two localities mentioned
above, both on the western slopes of the central Sierra Nevada and only
about 50 km apart. The abruptly increasing elevation of the mountains to
the east and the relatively dry, hot and treeless central valley to the west
would seem to be natural barriers to the spread of the species. We have
sought O. obscurus in apparently suitable habitats both to the north and
south of El Dorado and Placer counties but without success.
Since the earliest and latest collections of Orobittacus (10 May and 4
July) yielded only small numbers of individuals while those made near the
middle of this period (29 May to 9 June) were most productive, we judge
that the type series more or less correctly indicates the seasonal distribution
of the species.
Acknowledgments
We are indebted to the administrative officers of the El Dorado National
Forest, Placerville, California, for permission to collect specimens and for
other assistance. R. F. Denno and W. C. Fields, Jr., respectively, provided
us with ecological information on the type locality near Bridal Veil Falls
396
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
and on the Shirttail Creek localities. Chen-Wen Young, N. J. Smith and R.
W. Brooks assisted in the collection of specimens.
The junior author’s studies of Mecoptera have been generously supported
by the National Science Foundation, during the period of this study by grant
GB-30837.
Literature Cited
Byers, G. W. 1965. New and uncommon neotropical Mecoptera. J. Kansas Entomol. Soc.,
38:135-144.
Byers, G. W. 1972. A new genus of Mecoptera from Brazil. J. Kansas Entomol. Soc., 45:340-
346.
Smithers, C. N. 1973. New species and records of Australian Bittacidae (Mecoptera). J.
Australian Entomol. Soc., 12:296-300.
Footnotes
1 Biological Control Services Project, California Department of Food and Agriculture, 3288
Meadowview Road, Sacramento 95832.
2 Department of Entomology, University of Kansas, Lawrence 66045.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 397-401
THREE NEW SPECIES OF AMBRYSUS FROM MEXICO
(HEMIPTERA: NAUCORIDAE)
John T. Polhemus and Dan A. Polhemus1
3115 S. York, Englewood, Colorado 80110
The following new species of Naucoridae, along with others, have been
in manuscript for some time. This publication is one result of a long term
study on centers of speciation of Nepomorpha in America north of the
Isthmus of Panama. During our many expeditions to Mexico and Middle
America we have studied and collected most of the naucorids known from
the region and a number of undescribed taxa. The late Ira LaRivers regularly
described species from this area but did not utilize our extensive material.
The authors would welcome naucorid material from the Americas for study
and determination.
Most material reported here is in the J. T. Polhemus Collection (JTP);
additional material from the California Academy of Sciences (CAS) has been
made available for study through the kindness of Dr. Paul Arnaud. For all
measurements, 40 units = 1 mm unless otherwise noted.
Ambrysus colimanus, new species
(Figs. 1, 4, 7)
General appearance. — Of moderate size, ovate, shape as in Fig. 1.
Ground color yellowish, dorsum with strongly contrasting dark markings
similar to Ambrysus lunatus Usinger; faintly shining; head and pronotum
shallowly rugose and punctate; scutellum finely rugulose. Venter and legs
yellow brown to luteus, spines on legs golden brown.
Structure. — Head with eyes not raised above surface dorsally; vertex
moderately produced behind eyes; labrum shallowly triangular in shape,
width/length = 23/13, bluntly rounded apically; eyes convergent anteriorly,
posterior/anterior interocular space = 54/41. Pronotum with lateral margins
slightly convex, smooth; posterolateral angles rounded; width/length (mid¬
line) = 167/57. Scutellum wider than long, width/length = 130/50; sinuate
along lateral margins. Hemelytra fully developed; embolium weakly ex¬
panded, not sinuate posteriorly; entire surface set with minute white nod¬
ules, denser and more obvious on darkened portions. Connexival margins
weakly serrate; posterolateral angles weakly spinose. Foreleg femur length/
width = 73/43; tarsi slightly exceeding adjacent proximal part of femur.
Middle and posterior femora with a close-set row of small spines postero-
dorsally; middle and posterior tibia set with numerous stout spines; distally
398
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 1-9. Ambrysus n. spp. Figs. 1-3. Dorsal view of body, legs not shown. 1. A. coli-
manus n. sp. 2. A. baeus n. sp. 3. A. spiculus n. sp. Figs. 4-6. Dorsal view of male abdominal
tergites V-VII showing male genital process (arrow) on right side (left in figures) of tergite V.
4. A. colimanus n. sp. 5. A. baeus n. sp. 6. A. spiculus n. sp. Figs. 7-9. Ventral view of
female subgenital plate, hairy vestiture not shown. 7. A. colimanus n. sp. 8. A. baeus n. sp.
9. A. spiculus n. sp.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
399
with two transverse rows of small spines. Propleura not contiguous with
prosternum; propleura separated slightly medially, widely separated there
from mesosternum.
Male genital process as in Fig. 4; female subgenital plate shape as shown
in Fig. 7.
Length 7.8 mm, width 5.0 mm (male holotype).
Material. — Holotype, male, and allotype, female, MEXICO, Colima,
Ameria (River), CL 1229, XI-26-68, J. T. Polhemus (JTP). Paratypes, 6
6 S , 3 $ 9 , same data as holotype (JTP).
Etymology. — The name colimanus is derived from Colima, the Mexican
state of origin. Masculine.
Discussion
The male genitalia of Ambrysus colimanus are very similar to Ambrysus
signoreti Stal; the female subgenital plate is also similar to signoreti, but
not flared laterally as in the latter. A. colimanus differs from signoreti in
having a different coloration, eyes more convergent anteriorly over all their
length, and body length only about half that of signoreti. The coloration of
colimanus is quite similar to that of Ambrysus lunatus Usinger, but the
latter has a more rugose dorsum and different genital structures.
Ambrysus baeus, new species
(Figs. 2, 5, 8)
General appearance. — Small, ovate, shape as in Fig. 2. Ground color
yellowish to yellow brown; dorsal markings not strongly contrasting, scu-
tellum and hemelytra marked with dark brown, similar to Ambrysus pyg-
maeus LaRivers; faintly shining, many specimens encrusted and dull; head
and pronotum shallowly punctate and shallowly rugose; scutellum and hem-
elytra finely rugulose. Venter and legs yellow to yellow brown, spines on
legs golden brown.
Structure. — Head with eyes moderately raised above surface dorsally;
lateral margin narrow, not reflexed; vertex strongly produced behind eyes
(see Fig. 2); labrum not produced anteriorly, broadly rounded apically, twice
as broad as long, width/length = 16/8; eyes convergent anteriorly over all
their length, posterior/anterior interocular space = 37/27. Pronotum with
lateral angles convex, smooth, straight or faintly sinuate just anterad of
posterolateral angles; latter sharply rounded; width/length (on mid-line) =
120/39. Scutellum wider than long, width/length = 80/36; sinuate along lat¬
eral margins. Hemelytra fully developed; membrane not clearly differen¬
tiated, coriaceous; embolium weakly expanded; entire surface thickly set
with tiny round pits appearing white against dark background. Connexival
angles not serrate; posterolateral angles forming a right angle, not spinose.
400
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Foreleg femur length/width = 57/39; tarsi clearly reaching beyond adjacent
proximal part of femur. Middle and posterior femora each with a close-set
row of tiny almost invisible spines posterodorsally. Middle and posterior
tibia with numerous short spines; distally set with two transverse rows of
close-set spines. Propleura contiguous with prostemum, both on same
plane; propleura contiguous medially, contiguous there with mesosternum.
Male genital segments as in Fig. 5; female genital segments as in Fig. 8.
Length 5.75 mm; width 3.65 mm (male holotype).
Material . — Holotype, male, and allotype, female, MEXICO, Nayarit,
Aticama, CL727A, VI-7-1975, J. T. Polhemus (JTP). Paratypes: 19 S 6 , 19
9 9 , 12 nymphs, same data as holotype (JTP); 2 66, 5 9 9, 1 nymph,
MEXICO, Nayarit, 15 mi E San Bias, CL1026, J. T. & M. S. Polhemus
(JTP); 2 6 6, 5 9 9, MEXICO, Colima, Ameria (River), CL1229, XI-26-
1968, J. T. Polhemus (JTP); 3 66, 1 9, MEXICO, Jalisco, 300 ft (91 m),
Rio Tomatlan, CL736, VI-9-1975, J. T. Polhemus (JTP).
Etymology. — The name baeus is derived from the Greek baios, meaning
small. Masculine.
Discussion
Ambrysus baeus belongs to the same group as Ambrysus circumcinctus
Montandon and Ambrysus pygmaeus LaRivers. A. baeus is similar to the
latter in appearance and coloration but is much smaller than either circum¬
cinctus or pygmaeus and has very different male and female pregenital
structures. The male process of pygmaeus is greatly expanded distally,
spatulate, and almost straight; the male process of circumcinctus is slender
as in baeus, but curved only at the base and straight distally; the process
in baeus is strongly curved over the entire length as shown in Fig. 5. The
female subgenital plates of pygmaeus and circumcinctus are truncate cau-
dad or slightly excavate, but without the strong lateral angulate projections
seen in baeus (Fig. 8).
Ambrysus spiculus, new species
(Figs. 3, 6, 9)
General appearance. — Of moderate size, ovate, shape as shown in Fig.
3. Ground color brownish yellow, dorsum with extensive dark markings,
especially on hemelytra, moderately contrasting; markings similar to those
of dark specimens of Ambrysus vanduzeei Usinger; faintly shining; head,
pronotum and scutellum shallowly punctate; pronotum faintly rugose, scu-
tellum rugulose. Venter brown, abdominal venter thickly clothed with very
fine appressed golden pubescence obscuring venter to certain light angles;
legs luteus to yellow brown.
Structure. — Head with eyes barely raised above dorsal surface, lateral
edge reflexed, carinate; vertex produced behind eyes (see Fig. 3); labrum
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
401
broadly rounded apically, twice as broad as long, width/length = 20/10; eyes
convergent anteriorly over all their length, posterior/anterior interocular
space = 56/40. Pronotum with lateral margins slightly convex, smooth, pos¬
terolateral angles rounded; width; length (mid-line) = 178/60. Scutellum
wider than long, width/length = 120/50, sinuate along lateral margins. Hem-
elytra fully developed; embolium weakly expanded, not sinuate poste¬
riorly, rugose; entire surface with tiny round pits, appearing white, thicker
and most obvious on darker portions. Connexival margins weakly serrate;
posterolateral angles sharply angulate, not spinose. Foreleg femur length/
width = 80/48; tarsi just reaching adjacent proximal part of femur. Middle
and posterior femora each with a close-set row of small spines posteroven-
trally and a close-set row of stouter spines posterodorsally. Middle and
posterior tibia with numerous stout spines; distally with two transverse rows
of close-set spines. Propleura not contiguous with prosternum; propleura
contiguous medially, not contiguous there with mesosternum.
Male genital process as in Fig. 6; female subgenital plate as in Fig. 9.
Length 8.2 mm, width 5.4 mm (male holotype).
Material. — Holotype, male, and allotype, female, MEXICO, Durango, La
Palmita, CL1018, 20 April 1964, J. T. & M. S. Polhemus (JTP). Paratypes;
8 6 6 , 7 9 9, 10 nymphs, same data as holotype (JTP); 1 6 , 1 9 , MEXICO,
Zacatecas, 61 mi W of Fresnillo, Alt. 8100 ft (2469 m), pool, stream bed, 25
June 1954, R. H. Brewer (CAS); 5 66, 7 9 9, MEXICO, Durango, La
Palmita, CL721, VI-6-1975, J. T. Polhemus (JTP); 1 9, MEXICO, Sonora,
Rancho Los Banos, CL709, El. 3400 ft (1036 m), VI-3-1975, J. T. Polhemus
(JTP).
Etymology. — The Latin name spiculus pointed, refers to the shape of the
female subgenital plate. Masculine.
Discussion
Ambrysus spiculus is closely related and similar in appearance to Am¬
bry sus tridentata LaRivers from Puebla, Mexico. A. spiculus differs from
the latter in the more convergent eyes, less explanate lateral margins and
less rugose dorsum of the pronotum, thinner process on the male fifth ter-
gum, and very different female subgenital plate. The male process in tri¬
dentata has the shank erect compared to the sloping shank of spiculus seen
in Fig. 6. The female subgenital plate of tridentata has a blunt median
projection flanked by two acute shorter angulate projections, whereas spic¬
ulus has only one thin median projection caudad as shown in Fig. 9.
Footnote
1 Contribution from the University of Colorado Museum, Boulder 80309 and Martin Marietta
Corp., Denver 80201.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 402-410
LIFE HISTORY OF THE GALL-FORMING MOTH, CAROLELLA
BEEVORANA COMSTOCK, ON THE RAGWEED, AMBROSIA
DUMOSA (GRAY) PAYNE, IN SOUTHERN CALIFORNIA
(LEPIDOPTERA: COCHYLIDAE)
R. D. Goeden and D. W. Ricker
Department of Entomology, University of California, Riverside 92521
Native, southern California ragweed insects include a diversity of non¬
economic, little- studied, stenophagous species. We herein describe field,
laboratory, and insectary studies on a heretofore little-known, gallicolous
moth. Insectory conditions were 27 ± 1°C, 40-70% relative humidity, and
a 12/12-hr (light/dark) photoperiod.
Taxonomy. — Carolella beevorana adults first were described and the fe¬
male moth pictured by Comstock (1939b). The larva was described from
Ambrosia dumosa by Comstock (1939b) as being similar to, but darker than
that of C. busckana Comstock, which forms galls on the stems of the com¬
posite shrub, Encelia calif ornica Nuttall (Comstock, 1939a). A brief com¬
parison of the pupae of C. beevorana and C. busckana and photographs of
the former pupa also were provided by Comstock (1939b).
Distribution and host plant. — Carolella beevorana apparently occurs in
small demes discontinuously distributed throughout the range of its sole
host plant, A. dumosa, in southeastern California (Goeden and Ricker, 1976)
and, probably, adjacent parts of Arizona, Nevada, and Mexico. Comstock
(1939b) described this moth from specimens collected at Ludlow and Yer-
mo, San Bernardino County, in the high elevation Mojave Desert. Our study
site was located in a Creosote Bush Scrub-type community (Munz, 1974) in
the low elevation Sonoran Desert, ca. 3 km southeast of Niland, Imperial
County. The only other record for C. beevorana from our faunistic survey
of A. dumosa (Goeden and Ricker, 1976) involved a single plant bearing
old, empty galls observed on the east shore of the Salton Sea, ca. 3 km
south of the Riverside/Imperial County line.
Biology. — Egg. — The egg (Fig. 1A, B) is lustrous, translucent, ivory col¬
ored, sub-ovoid, but flattened and smooth-surfaced along one side where
loosely glued to the plant surface. The chorion is transversely, irregularly,
but smoothly ridged or wrinkled. This type of sculpturing also was reported
for eggs of Carolella sartana (Hubner) by Peterson (1967). Ten, newly de¬
posited, infertile eggs averaged (±S.D.) 0.72 ± 0.043 mm, 0.48 ± 0.036 mm,
and 0.32 ± 0.036 mm in length, width, and greatest thickness, respectively.
In insectary cagings on potted A. dumosa, most eggs (ca. 80%) were
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
403
Fig. 1. Egg and mature larva of Carolella beevorana. A. egg, top view, B. egg, side view,
C. larva, lateral view, D. right mandible, enlarged (semidiagrammatic), E. prothoracic spiracle,
enlarged, F. proleg, ventral lateral view (semidiagrammatic), G. larva, dorsal view.
attached singly to the undersides of leaf laminae along the midribs and veins;
the remainder, to leaf petioles, branches near axils, or cage surfaces. No
eggs of E. beevorana were observed in nature, but such individual egg
placement on foliage agrees with observed post-eclosion larval behavior
described below, as well as with ovipositional behavior described for C.
sartana by Peterson (1967).
Larva. — The first instar (Fig. 2A) differs markedly from the last instar
(Figs. 1C, 1G, 2B) in gross appearance. The heart-shaped head capsule of
the first instar is black, the prothoracic shield is prominent and dark brown,
and the cylindrical body is a translucent, dirty pale yellow-green color prin¬
cipally derived from the chlorenchyma in its gut. The mature larva, in con¬
trast, has a light reddish-brown head capsule, a much less sclerotized and
prominent prothoracic shield, a dorsoventrally flattened body, and a soiled
whitish-yellow color derived from the copious fatty tissue accumulated in¬
ternally.
The number of larval instars was not determined with certainty because
of their endophytic habit and the broad variation encountered in widths of
head capsules sampled, which included those of starved larvae held for
emergence in excised galls. Six instars were indicated.
The newly hatched larva crawled to and entered a herbaceous, photosyn-
—
Fig. 2. Life stages of Carolella beevorana. A. first instar, 20x, B. mature larva, 5.3x, C.
young larva tunneling near apical meristem, 7x, D. young gall in cross-section, 1.5 x, E. inner,
pitted surface of mature gall, 3x, F. pupa in cocoon, 5x, G. pupal exuvium projecting from
exit hole in gall, 2.5x, H. adult at rest, 3.7x.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
405
Fig. 3. Dorsal view of head of Carolella beevorana last instar (semidiagrammatic). No¬
menclature and abbreviations after Hinton (1946) and format after Common (1970).
thetic, terminal branch basally, usually tunneling into the smooth epidermis
just distal to a petiole base. A transverse, 2-lipped, entrance hole (0.4 to
0.8-mm wide), usually plugged with feces, marked this point of entry. The
larva tunneled directly into the central pith, and then within the pith towards
the branch apex (Fig. 2C). The open lumens of 10 young galls, initially
comprised of excavated pith (Fig. 2D), began 10 ± 2.8 (range: 6-15) mm
distal to the entrance holes. External recognition characters for these incip¬
ient galls were chlorotic and slightly swollen apical branches that bore fully
expanded leaves along their entire lengths, reflecting slowed branch elon¬
gation resulting from reduced apical meristem activity. Although the infest¬
ed terminal branches usually remained alive, the apical meristems occa¬
sionally were killed by the young larvae (Fig. 2C). This prematurely halted
the elongation of the infested branch and led to the formation of subspherical
galls. Of the first 100, fully formed galls containing larvae collected for
laboratory measurement on March 9-17, 1976, at Niland, 21 were subspher¬
ical; the remainder, the more typical, fusiform shape (Figs. 2E, 2G).
The young larvae defended their galls against intruding, younger larvae
of their own species. Combat usually resulted in the death of the younger
406
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
MESO-
Fig. 4. Setal map of Carolella beevorana last instar. Nomenclature and abbreviations after
Hinton (1946) and format after Common (1970).
invader and the ejection of its corpse, as with feces and exuviae, through
one of up to 3, 0.3 to 0.5-ram diameter, frass ejection holes chewed in the
gall walls. These holes usually were located in the basal half of the gall in
expanded ray tissue. The larvae pick up and thrust fecal pellets through
these ejection holes by means of their mouthparts. The lumens of galls that
contained developing larvae were kept free of debris in this manner. Ejec¬
tion holes in disuse were covered with a silken web sealed by impregnation
with an oral secretion that dried hard and black. The covered holes provide
translucent windows to the outside through which the larvae apparently
perceive photoperiodic stimuli. Small, externally caused breaks in the gall
walls were repaired in the same manner.
Only 1 larva developed per gall. The gall expanded in width mainly
through the proliferation of parenchyma comprising the longitudinally di¬
rected rays, a wound reaction by the host plant to the constant erosion of
the inner gall wall by the feeding larva. The inner surface was pitted with
concave feeding scars (Fig. 2E) in the expanded rays located between lon¬
gitudinally directed fibrous ribs. The larva left a silken trail as it moved
about and fed within the gall, and completely covered the inner surface with
a thin layer of silk as a measure of its activity. The gall thus provided a
humid, protected, nutritionally fully supportive microhabitat in an otherwise
harsh, arid environment.
The mature larva expanded the gall lumen to its ultimate dimensions and
partly filled this space with its coarse feces. It then spun a fusiform, thin-
walled, white, silken, centrally located cocoon surrounded by loose fecal
pellets (Fig. 2F). The cocoon extended distally as a short, tubular “exit
channel” (terminology of Comstock, 1939a) that ended in an exit hole cut
laterally in the apical third of the gall wall. The exit hole remained covered
by a thin remnant of bark. A few exit channels were directed proximally,
Fig. 5. Pupa of Carolella beevorana. A. lateral view, B. ventral view.
and the exit holes thus were located basally. Carolella busckana showed
similar prepupal behavior (Comstock, 1939a).
The mature larva, which measured 9-12 mm in length, is illustrated in
Figs. 1C-G, 2B, 3, and 4. The setal maps (Figs. 3 and 4) employ the no¬
menclature and abbreviations of Hinton (1946) and the format used to illus¬
trate Epiphyas sp. (Lepidoptera: Tortricidae) in Common (1970, pp. 774 and
776).
Mean dimensions of 79 mature fusiform galls were: external length, 29.8 ±
6.29 (range: 18-45) mm; external maximum width, 9.4 ± 2.47 (range: 5-
18) mm; and lumen length, 24.5 ± 6.08 (range: 11-38 mm). Sixteen of the
100 fully developed galls containing larvae, noted above, bore no live ter¬
minal or lateral branches, 29 bore live lateral branches only, 3 bore live
terminal branches only, and 52 bore live terminal and lateral branches. Exit
408
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 6. Map of locations of 20 Ambrosia dumosa that bore galls of Carole lla beevorana
(black dots) at the Niland, California, study site in 1976. The numbers of gall-free A. dumosa
located between selected gall-bearing plants are encircled.
channels in cross-section approximated the shape and diameter of the exit
holes, 35 of which ranged from circular to elliptical and measured 3. 3-3. 8
mm across. The long axes of 24 galls measured on 2 plants in nature pointed
to all quarters of the compass. Only 3 of 24 (12.5%) galls formed descending
angles of 20° and 30° with the horizon; the remainder formed ascending
angles that averaged ca. 14° and ranged from 0° to 80°.
Pupa. — Forty-four pupae averaged 9.2 ± 1.18 (range: 6.5-11.6) mm in
length, apparently slightly larger than pupae of C. busckana, as well as
darker and more cylindrical, according to Comstock (1939a, 1939b). The
pupa is illustrated in Fig. 5.
Pupation occurred in the central cocoon (Fig. 2F), with the head directed
towards the exit hole. The abdomen moved freely. The emerging pupa
worked its way out of the cocoon and through the exit channel using the 2
rows of short, serrate, posteriorly-directed spines on the dorsum of each
abdominal segment for traction (Fig. 5 A). With the aid of the sclerotized,
2-pronged process on its vertex (Fig. 5), it broke through the bark window
and projected from the exit hole, with its head, thorax, and upper abdomen
free, anchored by the cremasteric hooklets at the tip of the abdomen (Fig. 5).
Adult . — Adults (Fig. 2H) were not observed in nature. The fragile pupal
exuviae remained projecting for a few days from the exit holes as evidence
of adult field emergence (Fig. 2G).
In the insectary, the preovipositional periods of 8 females caged on potted
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
409
A. dumosa averaged 4.4 ± 1.65 (range: 2. 0-6. 5) days. These females laid
an average of 54 ± 29.9 (range: 7-106) eggs during an average ovipositional
period of 5.5 ± 3.26 (range: 1.5-10.5) days and lived an average of 11.6 ±
1.6 (range: 9-13.5) days. A single female laid as many as 29 eggs and an
average of ca. 10 eggs during a 12-hr photoperiod. Three non-ovipositing
females and 5 males also lived ca. 12 days in the same cagings.
Host-plant relations. — The 20 plants attacked by C. beevorana repre¬
sented only ca. 0.5% of the potential host individuals contained in the part
of the study area mapped in Fig. 6. Five gall-bearing plants were located
along an unpaved access road. No obvious differences were noted in the
location, crown size, and vigor of these plants compared to uninfested A.
dumosa.
When surveyed during March 9-16, 1976, the 20 galled plants averaged
62 ± 8.8 (range: 50-80) cm in height and ca. 134 ± 19.4 (range: 100-175)
cm in diameter. They bore an average total of 80 ± 96.6 (range: 1-357) galls,
of which an average of 7 ± 11 (range: 0-45) were nearly fully formed, intact,
and contained mid-instar larvae. Of the 1603 galls excised from these 20
plants, 1463 (91.3%) were old and empty. Galls were distributed throughout
the crowns, with 22%, 28%, 27%, and 23% found in the north, east, south,
and west quadrants, respectively. More galls occurred in the lower (52%)
and middle (41%) thirds of the crowns.
Seasonal history . — Only 11 of the 20 (55%) gall-bearing plants (Fig. 6)
bore current generation galls, indicating that not all plants were re-attacked
during successive years. Carolella beevorana usually is a univoltine species,
with overlapping generations that principally result from a protracted, win¬
ter, emergence period. Comstock (1939b) reported the occurrence of mature
galls along with immature galls, containing very young larvae. This, he
suggested, indicated a 2-year period of development or a protracted emer¬
gence period. Both interpretations were correct. Field observations and
insectary cagings of excised galls indicated that most adult emergence at
Niland occurred in mid-December 1976 and 1977, following pupation in late
November and early December that apparently coincided with the first win¬
ter rainfall, which also re-initiated host-plant growth. A smaller segment of
this population pupated, emerged, and oviposited during January and Feb¬
ruary. A still smaller segment, i.e., 3 individuals in labelled galls, took 2
years to emerge as adults. Comstock (1939a) reported adult emergence dur¬
ing December 4-3 1 from excised galls collected at Ludlow and the trapping
of 2 adults near Yermo on January 28.
Natural enemies. — Intraspecific, internecine combat accounted for some
early-instar, larval mortality, as noted above. Spilochalcis sp., nr. marine
(Riley) and Spilochalcis sp., nr. flavopicta (Cresson) (Hymenoptera: Chal-
cididae) were reared as solitary, larval-pupal endoparasites from galls col-
410
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
lected at Niland during November 1976- January 1977. Larvae and pupae of
C. beevorana were preyed upon by larvae of Cymatodera fuchsii Schaeffer
(Coleoptera: Cleridae).
Acknowledgments
Carolella beevorana was identified by Dr. D. C. Ferguson, Systematic
Entomology Laboratory, IIBII, USDA, %U.S. National Museum of Nat¬
ural History, Washington, D.C. Mr. R. J. LaSalle, Division of Biological
Control, Department of Entomology, University of California, Riverside,
identified the chalcidids.
Literature Cited
Common, I. F. B. 1970. Lepidoptera (moths and butterflies). Pp. 765-866 In: The Insects of
Australia. Melbourne Univ. Press, 1029 pp.
Comstock, J. A. 1939a. The fauna and flora of the El Segundo Sand Dunes. 7. Two new
phaloniid moths. Bull. S. California Acad. Sci., 38:112-119.
Comstock, J. A. 1939b. Four new California moths with notes on early stages. Bull. S.
California Acad. Sci., 38:172-182.
Goeden, R. D., and D. W. Ricker. 1976. The phytophagous insect fauna of the ragweed,
Ambrosia dumosa, in southern California. Environ. Entomol., 5:45-50.
Elinton, H. E. 1946. On the homology and nomenclature of the setae of Lepidoptera larvae,
with some notes on the phylogeny of the Lepidoptera. Trans. Royal Entomol. Soc.
London, 97:1-37.
Munz, P. A. 1974. A Flora of Southern California. Univ. of California Press, Berkelely, Los
Angeles, London, 1086 pp.
Peterson, A. 1967. Some eggs of moths from several families of Microlepidoptera. The Florida
Entomol., 50:125-132.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 411-414
NONARTHRA CYANEUM BALY (COLEOPTERA: CHRYSOMELIDAE:
ALTICINAE), A PAN-PACIFIC FLEA BEETLE1
Edward U. Balsbaugh, Jr.
Entomology Department, North Dakota State University, Fargo 58105
A gift of insects in December 1978, to the North Dakota State Insect
Reference Collection by Captain Mike Knutson, U.S. Army, included 9
specimens of an unusual species of flea beetle (Fig. 1) having only 9 antennal
segments (Fig. 2). Collection data are: “Ft. Sherman, Panama C.Z. Feb.
1976”, “Mike Knutson Collector”.
No alticines previously known from the western hemisphere have such
reduced antennae — the majority of genera have 1 1 segments and a few gen¬
era have 10 (Arnett, 1962; Scherer, 1962). Dr. G. Scherer,2 a world authority
on the Alticinae, informed me that to his knowledge, only the genus Non-
arthra Baly, known from the Orient, contains species with 9 segments per
antenna. I therefore compared our specimens with the literature describing
this genus and was convinced that the beetles from Panama were a Non¬
art hr a species.
Heikertinger and Csiki (1940) listed 29 species of Nonart hra valid at that
time which are distributed from Australia (Queensland) and the Celebes [the
Australian Faunal Zone], Borneo, Viet Nam, India, Burma, the Philippine
Islands, Southern China [the Oriental Faunal Zone] to China, Korea, and
Japan [the Palearctic Faunal Zone]. Maulik (1926) included 8 species in his
keys to the species of India, Ceylon and Burma; and Scherer (1969), who
later revised Maulik's treatment, reduced this number through synonymy
to 4. Gressitt and Kimoto (1963) listed 7 species for China and Korea, also
further reducing through synonymy the earlier list of Heikertinger and Csiki
(1940). Kimoto (1965) included 5 species for Japan and Samuelson (1973)
listed one species, N. cyaneum Baly, for Oceania.
In attempting to identify the Panamanian specimens to species I used the
papers of Maulik (1926), Scherer (1969), Gressitt and Kimoto (1963) and
Kimoto (1965), The beetles keyed to N. cyaneum Baly (1874) in the publi¬
cations of the latter two authors. Through the kindness of Dr. Richard E.
White3 1 obtained the loan of 3 specimens of this species, collected in Sze¬
chuan Province, China, and which now belong to the U.S. National Mu¬
seum. I also compared the Panama specimens with one labeled “Suhara
[Japan] Gifu Prcf. 13-5- 1951” and one labeled “Erzendjanzcy Mai 1938
Mandschurei” [Manchuria], both determined as N. cyaneum Baly by Dr.
G. Scherer, to whom I am grateful for the gift of these two specimens. I
412
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 1. Nonarthra cyaneum Baly.
believe that the recent specimens from Panama are representatives of N.
cyaneum Baly. They agree very closely with the determined specimens I
have seen but differ slightly in that 2 of the 3 China specimens of the USNM
are slightly more brownish on the dorsum, rather than the normal blackish
blue. I suspect that these 2 brownish specimens were teneral when collect¬
ed — which is also indicated by their soft, distorted shapes. They differ from
N. tibiale Jacoby, which is similar in appearance. N. cyaneum has the
fourth antennal segment triangular (Fig. 2), rather than elongate (Kimoto,
1965). The aedeagus, however, compares favorably with that of N. cyaneum
as illustrated by Samuelson (1973).
The previously known distribution for N. cyaneum Baly, 1874 (type-lo-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
413
Figs. 2-3. Fig. 2. Right antenna of N. cyaneum Baly. Fig. 3. Right hind tibia and tarsus
of N. cyaneum Baly.
cality Nagasaka — type depository BMNH, London) includes Japan, China
(Hopei, Szechuan, Sikang, Hupeh, Anhwei, Chekiang, Kweichow, Kiangsi,
Kwangtung, Fukien), Taiwan (Gressitt and Kimoto, 1963), and Bonin Is¬
lands, Micronesia (Samuelson, 1973). The specimen from Manchuria listed
in this paper represents a new regional record for China. The specific Old
World source for the Panamanian beetles is not known.
The 9 flea beetles from Panama therefore represent a New World record,
both for genus and species and are now even more truly pan-Pacific in
distribution. They also have possible economic significance. Gressitt and
Kimoto (1963) recorded beets, Beta vulgaris L. var. altissima Rossig, and
a rose, Rosa Wichuraiana Crep. as host plants. I reconfirmed the accuracy
of the collection data for the Panama specimens from Captain Knutson, the
collector. He does not recall specific host plants but commented that his
collection efforts while in the Canal Zone included gardens. In as much as
the Panama Canal serves as a major highway for commerce, it is not sur¬
prising to learn of new introductions for that territory which may have been
imported via ships.
Because these beetles are new immigrants, a reiteration of how they can
be distinguished from other New World fauna would be of some value. An
additional, new initial couplet can be amended to the key to “Groups” of
Scherer (1962), which would distinguish this unique new “Group” having
only 9 antennal segments. A brief description of the species N. cyaneum
Baly, follows:
414
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Ovate, convex, dark metallic blue; ventrally the pro-, meso-, and meta¬
thorax pitchy black — abdominal sternites vary from all black to all yellowish
brown — the yellowish brown occurring on apical segments in specimens
having both colors. Antennae pubescent, pitchy black on segments 4-9,
basal 3 segments shining black on ectal surface and yellowish brown on
ental surface. Head smooth, shining; sparsely, very finely punctate. Frontal
calli contiguous, a slight transverse depression immediately dorsad of the
calli. Prothoracic coxal cavities closed behind. Hind femora broad — width
Vi- the length. Apex of hind tibia rounded and edged with a row of short
teeth (Fig. 3). Hind tarsus inserted in tibia on dorsal side before apex.
Length of Panamanian specimens 3. 3-3. 9 mm. Mean 3.6 mm [3. 5-4. 5 mm
for Oriental specimens (Gressitt and Kimoto, 1963)].
Literature Cited
Arnett, R. H., Jr. 1962. The beetles of the United States (A manual for identification). Part
VI. Suborder Polyphaga (Concl.) Series Cucujiformia (Concl.) Chrysomeloidea Curcu-
lioidea. The Catholic University of America Press, Washington, D.C., 851-1 1 12 pp.
Baly, J. S. 1874. The phytophagous Coleoptera of Japan. Trans. Royal Entomol. Soc. London,
1874, pp. 210-211.
Gressitt, J. L., and S. Kimoto. 1963. The Chrysomelidae (Coleopt.) of China and Korea, Part
2. Pacific Insects Monograph 1B:301— 1026.
Heikertinger, F., and E, Csiki. 1940. Coleopterorum catalogus, pars 169, Chrysomelidae:
Halticinae, II, pp. 337-635. (Vol. XXV.)
Kimoto, S. 1965. The Chrysomelidae of Japan and the Ryukyu Islands. VIII. Subfamily
Alticinae I. Jour. Faculty of Agric. Kyushu Univ. 13(3): 40 1-429.
Maulik, S. 1926. The fauna of British India, including Ceylon and Burma. Taylor and Francis,
London. 442 pp. + map.
Samuelson, G. A. 1973. Alticinae of Oceania (Coleoptera: Chrysomelidae). Pacific Insects
Monograph, 30:1-165
Scherer, G. 1962. Bestimmungsschussel der neotropischen Alticinen-Genera (Col. Chrysom.).
Entomol. Arbeiten Mus. G. Frey, 13(2): 497-607.
Scherer, G. 1969. Die Alticinae des indischen Subkontinentes (Coleoptera-Chrysomelidae).
Pacific Insects Monograph, 22:1-251.
Footnotes
1 Approved by the Director of the North Dakota Agricultural Experiment Station as
Journal Series No. 1128.
2 Zoologische Staatssammlung, Munich, Federal Republic of Germany.
3 Systematic Entomology Laboratory, United States Department of Agriculture, Washing¬
ton, D.C.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 415^121
A REVIEW OF THE GENUS ROEDERIODES COQUILLETT
WITH THE DESCRIPTION OF A NEW SPECIES
(DIPTERA: EMPIDIDAE)
D. Dee Wilder1
California Academy of Sciences, San Francisco 94118
J. G. Chillcott revised the genus Roederiodes in 1961, describing five new
species. Since that time, more material has been collected and now some
of the species can be better defined. The purpose of this paper, the first of
a series seeking to revise all the clinocerine empidid genera, is to review
the genus Roederiodes and update Chillcott’ s 1961 paper.
Adults of Roederiodes junctus Coquillett have been observed capturing
and feeding on adult blackflies. Peterson and Davies (1960) reported adult
R. junctus feeding on adults of Simulium venustum Say in Algonquin Park,
Ontario. The blackflies were captured from swarms by flying R. junctus
individuals, and from the water surface by females skimming on the surface
film. Needham (1901) reported larvae and pupae of the same species asso¬
ciated with simuliid pupae and empty pupal cases, the Roederiodes pupae
being found in empty simuliid pupal cases.
Large numbers of R. junctus adults have been found beneath pieces of
board which were positioned just above the water surface (Needham, 1901).
I have observed R. wirthi adults resting in a similar manner on the lower
surfaces of rocks which closely overhang clear, fast-flowing streams. Mating
was observed to take place in these assemblages.
The sharp, piercing mouthparts of Roederiodes adults differ from those
of most other clinocerines, which are short and relatively haustellate. Adults
of such genera as Clinocera and Wiedemannia feed on small, soft-bodied
insects which they capture from thin water films flowing over rocks. It is
possible that the more robust mouthparts of the Roederiodes adults are
adapted for feeding on heavier bodied insects like blackflies. Careful obser¬
vation is necessary in areas of abundance of these flies to elucidate their
feeding habits and prey preferences.
Representatives of the genus occur throughout North America. Frey
(1940) described a species from Madeira Island and herein one is described
from Cocos Island. This peculiar distribution almost certainly reflects a lack
of collecting. Clinocerine empidids in general are not commonly collected
because of their tendency to stay close to the substrate and to make only
short, low flights along the water surface when they are disturbed. Collecting
416
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
on emergent rocks with an aspirator while wading streams is the only ef¬
fective way to capture most species. Roederiodes adults are even more
secretive than typical clinocerines, resting beneath overhanging surfaces
where they are constantly moistened by water spray. Only an occasional
specimen can be collected with a net or flight trap. For this reason, I believe
that the genus probably has a much wider distribution than present material
indicates.
The name Roederiodes was chosen for the genus because of the supposed
similarity of its members to the European Roederia, now considered to be
a subgenus of Wiedemannia. The specific epithet of the type species, junc-
ta, had the feminine ending. The name was used in that form until Melan-
der’s 1927 revision, when it was spelled, without explanation, Roederioides.
Curran (1934) also adopted this spelling, and it was generally used in that
form, even by Chillcott in 1961 , until Melander (1965) again used the original
spelling, Roederiodes. At that time the endings on the specific epithets were
changed to the masculine. This is in accordance with the ICZN Article
30(a). (ii).
Key to the Species of Roederiodes Coquillett
(Modified from Chillcott, 1961)
1 . Proboscis longer than head height . longirostris Frey
Proboscis at least slightly shorter than head height . 2
2. Doroscentrals 5, strong; ocellar and vertical bristles strong . 3
Dorsocentrals 7-8, weak; ocellar and vertical bristles weak; small
median ocellar bristle present . wirthi Chillcott
3. Acrostichals present and well-developed, numerous; me crossvein
present and distinct . distinctus Chillcott
Acrostichals, if present, not occurring posterior to second dorso-
central; me crossvein absent or very short . 4
4. Antennal style twice as long as third antennal segment; basal costal
bristle subequal in length to second basal cell . wigginsi n. sp.
Antennal style less than twice as long as third antennal segment;
basal costal bristle much shorter than second basal cell . 5
5. Hind tibia with distinct median ventral bristles; hypopygium with
surstylus long, slender and curved anterad .... recurvatus Chillcott
Hind tibia without distinct median ventral bristles; hypopygium with
surstylus short and broad . 6
6. Dorsal lobe of hypopygium broad and truncate at apex; tip of ae-
deagus with truncated lateral arms . junctus Coquillett
Dorsal lobe of hypopygium more slender, not distinctly truncate; tip
of aedeagus with pointed lateral arms . vockerothi Chillcott
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
417
Fig. 1. Wing of Roederiodes wigginsi, holotype.
Roederiodes wigginsi, new species
(Figs. 1-2)
Description. — Small body size, 1.8 mm in length; with brown coloration.
Head (Fig. 2). — In profile widest at lower eye margin, strongly receding
to oral margin. One pair of strong vertical bristles present; no setulae present
on lower two-thirds of head between eye and postoccipital bristles; one pair
of weak genal bristles present. Third antennal segment short ovate, style
twice as long as third segment. Proboscis .70 of head height.
Thorax . — Acrostichals absent; dorsocentrals five, strong; two small an¬
terior notopleural setulae. Mesonotal depression concolorous with rest of
thorax.
Wing (Fig. 1). — Length 2.3 mm, slightly infuscated. Basal bristle longer
than second basal cell. Humeral crossvein not visible, costal cell distinctly
darkened. Second submarginal cell four times as long as broad. Medial and
cubital veins distinctly coalesced for a distance one eighth the length of the
second submarginal cell. Anal vein indicated by a short spur; dorsal half of
anal cell infuscated.
Legs. — Uniform brown, slightly paler than thorax. Anterior femora slen¬
der; tibiae without distinct median ventral hairs.
Hypopygium. — Male unknown.
418
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 2-4. Fig. 2. Head of Roederiodes wigginsi, holotype. Fig. 3. Hypopygium of R.
distinctus. Fig. 4. Hypopgium of R. wirthi.
Type material. — Holotype $ , “COSTA RICA: ISLA DEL COCO, Bahia
de Chatham, 22-1-1967. Ira L. Wiggins” “California Academy Sciences
Type No. 13622.” “Holotype Roederiodes wigginsi Wilder 1980.”
Discussion. — This species may be distinguished from other known
species of Roederiodes by the small size, long proboscis, long antennal
arista, and the long basal costal bristle. Roederiodes wigginsi is named in
honor of the distinguished botanist, Ira L. Wiggins, who collected the unique
specimen.
The holotype was collected in a flight trap, but despite subsequent flight
trap collections, no additional specimens have been found. No blackflies
are recorded from Cocos Island, but numerous ceratopogonid midges live
in the streams and could serve as a food source for these tiny flies (C. L.
Hogue, in litt.).
Roederiodes junctus Coquillett
Roederiodes juncta Coquillett, 1901:585. Holotype $, USNM Type No.
5345. Type locality: Saranac Inn, Adirondack Forest Preserve, New
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
419
York. Needham (1901:581, figs. 5-8); Melander (1902:239); Coquillett
(1903:257); Coquillett (1910:601); Engel (1918:264); Johannsen (1935:20);
Peterson and Davies (1960:9, 10, 12).
Roederioid.es juncta: Melander (1927:225, pi. 2, fig. 9); Chillcott (1961:422,
figs. 1, 5, 13, 16, 21, 26).
Roederiodes junctus: Melander (1965:467).
Roederoides juncta: Knutson and Flint (1971:316). (lapsus calami).
Discussion. — Adults vary in length from 2.0 to 3.3 mm; there is little
additional intraspecific variation. Members of R. junctus are easily distin¬
guished from those of R. recurvatus by the structure of the hypopygium
(Chillcott, 1961:421), the silvery mesonotal depression, a more rounded
head profile, longer antennal style, and the absence of tibial bristles. Chill¬
cott stated that adults of this species differ from those of R. vockerothi
Chillcott (1961:424) only in minor genitalic characters. The characters used
in this comparison are not consistent within other species, however. More
material of R. vockerothi must be examined before a decision on its status
can be made.
Roederiodes junctus occurs in the northeastern U.S. and southeastern
Canada. Roederiodes vockerothi is represented by one specimen taken in
Gainesville, Florida (Type 6 , CNC No. 7185).
Roederiodes recurvatus Chillcott
Roederioides recurvata Chillcott, 1961:424, figs. 3, 6, 12, 14, 17, 22, 25.
Holotype 6 , CNC Type No. 7186. Type locality: Old Chelsea, Quebec.
Roederioides juncta: Vaillant (1960:117, figs, la-b) (misidentification).
Roederiodes recurvatus: Melander (1965:468).
Discussion. — Adults vary in body length from 2.0 to 3.25 mm; the leg
color varies from yellow to dark brown. Roederiodes recurvatus adults are
generally smaller than those of R. junctus, and can be distinguished from
them by the distinctive genitalia (Chillcott, 1961:421; Vaillant, 1960:119),
the mesonotal depression concolorous with the rest of the mesonotum, the
elongate head profile, the shorter antennal style and the presence of ventral
bristles on the hind tibia. Examination of new material indicates that the
dorsal lobe of the hypopygium is “elbowed” in macerated specimens, but
appears to be uniformly curved anterad in dried, unprepared material.
This species occurs throughout eastern North America from Quebec to
Virginia and Tennessee.
Roederiodes distinctus Chillcott
(Fig. 3)
Roederioides distincta Chillcott, 1961:425, figs. 4, 8, 23. Holotype $,
USNM Type No. 65091. Type locality: South Vrain Creek, Boulder Co.,
Colorado.
420
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Roederiodes distinctus: Melander (1965:468).
Discussion. — Adults vary in length from 2.7 to 3.0 mm; leg color varies
from brown to black. Members of this species can be separated from other
Roederiodes by the distinct mediocubital crossvein, the tuberculate facial
prohle, the anteriorly inclined eye, and the presence of well-developed ae¬
ro stichal setae.
Type material did not include males. Subsequent collections have pro¬
duced a male from Trail River, Northwest Territories (CNC). It conforms
exceptionally well with Chillcott’s description of the female. The hypopyg-
ium (Fig. 3) has the surstylus long, narrow, evenly tapering to a pointed,
mesally inclined tip, the inner surface with numerous spines.
At present, this species is known from only the two above-mentioned
localities.
Roederiodes wirthi Chillcott
(Fig. 4)
Roederioides wirthi Chillcott, 1961:426, figs. 2, 9, 11, 15, 19, 24, 28. Holo-
type S , USNM Type No. 65092. Type locality: Catron Co., 5 mi E of
Glenwood, New Mexico.
Roederioides retroversa Chillcott, 1961:427, figs. 10, 20, 29. Holotype 6,
USNM Type No. 65093. Type locality: St. Helena Creek, Lake Co.,
California. NEW SYNONYMY.
Roederiodes retroversus: Melander (1965:467).
Roederiodes wirthi: Melander (1965:467).
Discussion. — Chillcott’s concept of this species was based on a few spec¬
imens from widely separated areas. Currently available material from inter¬
mediate areas gives a clearer idea of the intraspecific variation.
Roederiodes wirthi adults are easily separated from those of other species
by the weak head bristles, the presence of a weak median ocellar hair and
the weak and more numerous dorsocentrals.
The head profile of these flies varies considerably, from smooth to tuber¬
culate among individuals of the same series. This was one of the principal
characters originally used to separate wirthi from retroversus. The other
significant character used to distinguish the two was the structure of the
hypopygium. There is remarkably little variation in the terminalia. The dif¬
ferences which Chillcott mentioned were due to differences in the degree
of maceration of the genitalic structures of the specimens. The hypopygium
has the surstylus strongly tapering on the basal half, then parallel sided to
a rounded-truncate, mesally directed apex (Fig. 4).
The length of the proboscis rarely varies from two thirds (.63-.70) the
head height. The number of genal hairs varies from 0-3. The distance for
which the medial and cubital veins are coalesced varies considerably from
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
421
not at all to distances up to three times the length of the radiomedial cross¬
vein. Leg color varies from yellow to black, the usual color being brown.
Additional material shows that this species ranges from New Mexico into
California from San Diego to Lake County. Adults are found associated
with small, clear fast-flowing streams.
Acknowledgments
I would like to thank the following individuals for making specimens under
their care available to me: Dr. P. Arnaud, California Academy of Sciences;
Dr. L. Knutson, National Museum of Natural History; Dr. L. Pechuman,
Cornell University; and Dr. H. Teskey, Canadian National Museum.
I gratefully acknowledge the facilities made available to me by Dr. D.
Kavanaugh, and the help given by Mr. George Steyskal.
Literature Cited
Chillcott, J. G. 1961. A revision of the genus Roederioides Coquillett (Diptera: Empididae).
Can. Entomol., 93:419-428.
Coquillett, D. W. 1901. Original descriptions of new Diptera. pp. 585-586, in Needham and
Betten, Aquatic insects in the Adirondacks. N.Y. State Mus. Bull. 47.
Coquillett, D. W. 1903. The genera of the dipterous family Empididae, with notes and new
species. Proc. Entomol. Soc. Wash., 5:245-272.
Coquillett, D. W. 1910. The type species of North American genera of Diptera. Proc. U.S.
Natl. Mus., 37:499-647.
Curran, C. H. 1934. The families and genera of North American Diptera. New York, 512 pp.
Engel, E. O. 1918. Das Dipterengenus Atalanta Mg. ( Clinocera ol.). Deut. Ent. Ztschr.,
1918:1-80, 197-268.
Frey, R. 1940. Die Arthropodenfauna von Madeira nach den Ergebnissen der Reise von Prof.
Dr. O. Lundblad Juli-August 1935. XIX. Diptera Brachycera. Ark. Zool., 3 1 A(20): 1—
18(1939).
Johannsen, O. A. 1935. Aquatic Diptera. Part II. Orthorrhapha- Brachycera and Cyclorrhapha.
Cornell Univ. Agric. Exp. Stn. Mem. 177.
Knutson, L. V,, and O. S. Flint. 1971. Pupae of Empididae in pupal cocoons of Rhyacophilidae
and Glossosomatidae. Proc. Entomol. Soc. Wash., 73(3):3 14—320.
Melander, A. L. 1902. A monograph of the North American Empididae, Part 1. Trans. Am.
Entomol. Soc. (Phila.), 28:195-368.
Melander, A. L. 1927. Diptera, Family Empididae, in Wytsman, P. Genera Insectorum, 185: 1-
434. Brussels.
Melander, A. L. 1965. Family Empididae. Pages 446-481 in Stone, A., C. W. Sabrosky, W.
W. Wirth, R. H. Foote, and J. R. Coulson, Catalogue of the Diptera of America North
of Mexico. U.S. Dep. Agric. Agric. Res. Serv. Agric. Handb. 276.
Needham, J. G., and C. Betten. 1901. Aquatic Insects in the Adirondacks. N.Y. State Mus.
Bull. 47, 612 pp.
Peterson, B. V., and D. M. Davies. 1960. Observations on some insect predators of blackflies
(Diptera: Simuliidae) of Algonquin Park, Ontario. Can. J. Zool., 38:9-18.
Vaillant, F. 1960. Quelques Empididae Atalantinae des monts des Appalaches (Dipt.). Bull.
Entomol. Soc. Fr., 65:117-123.
Footnote
1 Present address: U.S. National Museum, Washington, D.C. 20560.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 422-428
A REVISION OF THE GENUS NIPHOGENIA MELANDER
(DIPTERA: EMPIDIDAE)
D. Dee Wilder1
California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park,
San Francisco 94118
A. L. Melander erected the genus Niphogenia for the single species,
eucera, in 1927. Since that time, nothing has been written about these un¬
usual flies, and until recent years very few have been collected. The purpose
of this paper is to better define the genus, to make available some behavioral
observations, and to describe one new species.
Niphogenia adults are readily distinguished from other empidids belong¬
ing to the subfamily Clinocerinae by the remarkably lengthened third an¬
tennal segment (Fig. 1). Ceratempis longicornis adults also have the third
antennal segment elongate, but they lack an antennal style and acrostichal
setae.
Most clinocerines are associated with water, the larvae being aquatic and
the adults occurring on rocks in or at the edge of streams. In these genera,
prey is taken from the water in some way. Niphogenia, a primitive clino-
cerine, is not aquatic.
I have observed N. eucera adults on various occasions at elevations from
1150 to 1830 m on alpine meadows in the Cascades. These flies are often
abundant, but not easily collected with a sweep net because they rest, feed,
and mate on the surface of the soil or on very low-growing vegetation. Only
in areas of extreme abundance are specimens seen on taller vegetation.
They are found on moist soil, sometimes associated with small streams from
melting snow, but are not as intimately associated with the water as are
most other clinocerines.
Individuals of N. eucera feed on insect larvae (and perhaps other soft-
bodied arthropods) which they unearth from the soil. They move the loose
soil with their tarsi until an individual unearths a larva. Other adults im¬
mediately converge on the prey, pull it from the ground, and tear it to
pieces, each individual eventually devouring its own small portion (Fig. 2).
I have observed feeding behavior only in localities where the flies were
present in large numbers, and it is likely that such dividing of food does not
take place where the density of individuals is not as great.
Despite the large number of females I have collected and observed, the
males are represented by only a few specimens. The males may emerge
earlier and mate with the females when they are still teneral, passing their
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
423
Figs. 1-2. Fig. 1. Niphogenia eucera, female, habitus. Fig. 2. N. eucera females feeding.
peak density at a time earlier than the dates of collection. Mating behavior
in this species was observed only once, the coupling taking place on a low-
growing leaf in a locality where many N. eucera were present. The female
was teneral.
The following generic description is an expansion of Melander’ s (1927)
original description of the genus.
Niphogenia Melander
Niphogenia Melander, 1927:217. Type-species, eucera Melander (by origi¬
nal designation).
Description. — Delicate empidids with lengthened antennae (Fig. 1). Head
round; eyes round, bare, facets uniform. Face wide, convex, protruding in
424
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
female, continuous with the small genae, its lower edge straight; front broad,
more so in female, diverging from antennae to ocellar triangle, a small ex¬
cision in the eyes at antennae, a few small setae on front above excision.
Ocellar triangle slightly elevated with one pair of strong ocellar and several
small post-ocellar bristles. Two to three poorly defined rows of strong oc¬
cipital bristles, one row of strong setae ringing occipital foramen laterally
and ventrally. First antennal segment cylindrical, more than twice as long
as the globose second segment, both with a few small setae; third segment
more than twice as long as the first two, slightly tapering, shorter and strong¬
ly tapering in female, loosely pubescent, tipped with a small bristle. Pro¬
boscis short, sharp, with fleshy labella, palpi elongate oval, with a few setae;
oral opening ringed with hairs laterally and ventrally. Thorax: Pronotum
with a row of short, stiff bristles; mesonotum with two rows of dorsocentrals
and a single median row of acrostichals, 2-3 humerals, 1-2 posthumerals,
2-3 notopleurals, one each prealar, supraalar, postalar, two scutellars;
metapleuron with a cluster of hairs; proepisternum with bristles above coxal
bases. Legs slender, not bristly, coxae setose; tarsi longer than their tibiae,
puJ villi small, empodium microscopic. Hind tibia with dorsal bristles; middle
tibia of males with small, thorn-like flexor spines on apical portion. Wings
with anal angle projecting only slightly, costa encompassing wing, costal
bristle present, small; subcosta weak, complete; R^5 forked, discal cell
complete, emitting three veins; the first basal cell considerably longer than
the second; anal crossvein curving into lower side of anal cell, no anal vein,
anal cell subequal to second basal cell. Calypters with a nearly straight edge
and weak fringe. Abdomen cylindrical, segments loosely setose with small
pittings along base of second segment and with two visible (three total)
laterally on segments 3-7. Pygidium with lateral valves elongate, but usually
folded mesally and ventrally, appearing globular; dorsal process of lateral
valve long, slender and pointed; aedeagus erect with a long, slender basal
appendage; cerci large and erect. Female with seventh sternite polished
apically.
Key to the Species of Niphogenia Melander
1. General body color brown, legs fight brown to yellow; males with
comb on apical half of middle tibia strongly differentiated (Fig. 6);
hypopygium with dorsal process of lateral lobe not reaching apex
of lateral lobe (Fig. 10), not crossing or crossing only at tips in
folded hypopygium (Fig. 8); females with proboscis a broad tri¬
angle, setose, narrowed to a rounded apex (Fig. 13) .
. eucera Melander
General body color black, legs brown to dark brown; males with
comb on apical third of middle tibia weakly differentiated (Fig. 5);
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
425
Figs. 3^1. Fig. 3. Wing of N. eucera male. Fig. 4. Wing of N. turneri holotype.
hypopygium with dorsal process of lateral lobe surpassing apex
of lateral lobe (Fig. 7), crossing at bases in folded hypopygium;
females with proboscis a narrow triangle with a sharp, pointed
apex (Fig. 12) . turneri, new species
Niphogenia eucera Melander
(Figs. 1-3, 6, 8-10, 13)
Description. — Body length 2.5 to 4.0 mm, females usually larger than
males; coloration brown to dark brown, covered with brownish grey to-
mentum. Head: One pair of ocellar bristles subequal in length to first an¬
tennal segment. Antennae brown, with first two segments often lighter than
third; third with loose, pale pubescence; ratio of segments 2:1:10. Oral mar¬
gin ringed laterally and posteriorly with stiff hairs. Thorax: One long post-
humeral bristle, two or three notopleurals; pleural suture and halteres pale.
A clump of setae on proepisternum above front coxa, setae stronger than
those of front coxae. Coxae yellow; legs concolorous light brown or yellow,
426
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 5-13. Fig. 5. Middle tibia of N. turned. Fig. 6. Middle tibia of N. eucera. Fig. 7.
Hypopygium of N. turned holotype. Fig. 8. Folded hypopygium of N. eucera. Fig. 9. Female
genitalia of N. eucera. Fig. 10. Hypopygium of N. eucera. Fig. 11. Female genitalia of N.
turned allotype. Fig. 12. Proboscis of N. turned female. Fig. 13. Proboscis of N. eucera
female.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
427
tarsi sometimes darker. Middle tibia slightly swollen apically; a row of 14-
17 short setae on anteroventral surface of apical half; a few thorns present
on ventral surface. Wings brown, yellowish at base, venation as in Fig. 3.
Abdomen brown, lightly tomentose, shining. Terminalia with pointed dorsal
processes of lateral lobe not reaching apex of lateral lobe, not crossing at
all or crossing only at tips in folded hypopygium. Female: Generally the
same as male. Proboscis wide, spade-shaped, setose, narrowed to a rounded
apex. Genitalia as figured (Fig. 9).
Type material. — Holotype male, Paradise Park, Mt. Rainier National
Park, Washington, August 1917, A. L. Melander. Allotype female with the
same data. These specimens are deposited in NMNH.
Diagnosis. — Members of this species can be distinguished from those of
N. turned by the following combination of character states: Color light
brown, tomentum weak, legs and coxae distinctly lighter than rest of body;
comb of middle tibia strongly differentiated, male and female genitalia dis¬
tinctive (Figs. 8-10).
Specimens examined. — (DDWC indicates specimens in my personal col¬
lection, other acronyms are listed in acknowledgments.) Total number of
specimens examined was 362. CALIFORNIA: Plumas Co., 8 mi. [12.8 km]
S.E. Mt. Lassen, 8 July (WSUC). OREGON: Clackamas Co., Mt. Hood,
Lost Lake, 3000 ft. [ca. 910 m], 10 July; Still Creek Campground, 1150 m,
23 June, 27 June (CASC, CNCI, DDWC, NMNH, WSUC). Hood River
Co., Mitchell Creek near Sahalie Falls, 1400 m, 27 June; Mt. Hood Mead¬
ows, 1350 m, 27 June (DDWC). WASHINGTON: Clallam Co., Olympic
Nat. Park, Hurricane Ridge, 21 July; nr. Hurricane Ridge Lodge, 4 August;
Meadow below Sunrise Ridge, Mt. Angeles, 1550 m, 22, 23, 24 July (CASC,
CNCI, DDWC, WSUC). Mt. Rainier Nat. Park, along creek draining E end
Yakima Park, 1830 m, 3 August; Eagle Peak, 19 July; Edith Creek at Par¬
adise Park, 1650 m, 2 August; Frog Pond, Paradise Valley, 20 July; Paradise
Park, August; Van Trump Creek, 1 September (CASC, DDWC, NMNH,
WSUC).
Remarks. — This species is found in moist areas in the Cascades at ele¬
vations from 1150 to 1830 m. Adults occur on the surface of the soil or on
low-growing vegetation and may be quite abundant at times.
Niphogenia turneri, new species
(Figs. 4, 5, 7, 11, 12)
Description. — Body length 2.5 to 4.0 mm, females usually larger than
males; coloration dark brown to black covered with heavy grey tomentum.
Head: One pair of ocellar setae slightly shorter than first antennal segment.
Antennae with all segments concolorous dark brown to black; third with
loose grey pubescence; ratio of segments 2:1:9. Oral margin ringed laterally
428
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
and posteriorly with a few fine hairs. Thorax: One posthumeral, two noto-
pleural bristles; pleural suture concolorous with rest of thorax. A clump of
setae on proepisternum above front coxae, setae about as strong as those
of front coxae. Coxae light to dark brown, sometimes darker dorsally; legs
brown to black. Middle tibia with a row of 8 to 10 weakly-differentiated
setae on the anteroventral surface of the apical third; a few small setae on
ventral surface. Wings brown, yellowish at base, venation as in Fig. 4.
Abdomen dark brown to black with heavy greyish or greenish tomentum,
shining. Terminalia (Fig. 7) with pointed dorsal processes of lateral lobes
surpassing apex of lateral lobe, crossing at bases in folded hypopygium.
Female: Generally the same as the male, proboscis an elongate triangle,
narrowed to a sharp, pointed apex (Fig. 12). Genitalia as figured (Fig. 11).
Type material. — Holotype male, IDAHO: Idaho Co., South Lone Lake,
13.5 airline miles NNE of Selway Falls. R10E/T33N/Sec. 11. 6480 ft. [ca.
1975 m]. 17 July 1979. Sweep. W. J. Turner. Allotype, a female with the
same data. The holotype and allotype are deposited in the California Acad¬
emy of Sciences (Type No. 13638).
Diagnosis. — Members of this species can be distinguished from those of
N. eucera by the following combination of character states: Body color
dark, legs and coxae dark; comb on middle tibia weak, male and female
genitalia distinctive; females have a narrowly triangular, sharp proboscis.
Specimens examined. — (23.) 3 male, 14 female paratypes from the same
locality and date as the holotype. 6 female from IDAHO: Idaho Co., East
Peak Lake, 12.7 airline mi. NNE Selway Falls R10E/T33N/Sec. 14, 6360 ft.
16 July 1979, W. J. Turner (WSUC, NMNH).
Remarks. — Nothing is known of the habits of this species. Niphogenia
turned is named in honor of its collector, Dr. William J. Turner.
Acknowledgments
The following institutions and curators kindly loaned the specimens upon
which this study was based: L. V. Knutson, National Museum of Natural
History (NMNH), H. J. Teskey, Canadian National Collection (CNCI), and
William J. Turner, Washington State University (WSUC). I am indebted to
Dr. D. H. Kavanaugh, California Academy of Sciences, for providing space,
facilities, and encouragement.
Literature Cited
Melander, A. L. 1927. Diptera. Family Empididae. Fasc. 185, 434 pp., 8 pis. In P. Wytsman,
ed., Genera insectorum. Bruxelles.
Footnote
1 Present address: Systematic Entomology Laboratory, IIBIII, Agricultural Research Service,
U.S.D.A. % U.S. National Museum, Washington, D.C. 20560.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 429^133
DESCRIPTIONS OF THE IMMATURE STAGES OF
STOBAERA TRICARINATA (SAY)
(HEMIPTERA-HOMOPTERA: DELPHACIDAE)
Neil J. Reimer and Richard D. Goeden1
Department of Entomology, University of California, Riverside 92521
Kramer (1973) revised the genus Stobaera based in part on specimens of
4 species, including S. tricarinata, collected from southern California rag¬
weeds by Goeden and Ricker (1974a, 1974b, 1975, 1976a, 1976b, 1976c). No
immature stages of Nearctic Delphacidae apparently heretofore have been
described. The eggs and nymphs of S. tricarinata, the most widely encoun¬
tered member of this genus in North America (Kramer, 1973), collected
from western ragweed, Ambrosia psilostachya Decandolle (Compositae),
herein are described using terminology from Hassen (1939) and Vilbaste
(1968).
Egg (Fig. 1A). — Smooth, fusiform-ellipsoidal, slightly curved along its
long axis, initially white, becoming hyaline with age. Mean lengths and
widths (±S.D.) of 32 eggs were 0.80 ± 0.03 mm and 0.21 ± 0.02 mm, re¬
spectively.
Nymphs (Fig. 1). — Measurements of 11, 12, 12, 17, and 14 first-fifth in¬
stars, respectively, yielded the following averages: body length (excluding
appendages), 0.80 ± 0.10 mm, 0.98 ± 0.14 mm, 1.25 ± 0.19 mm, 1.64 ±
0.17 mm, and 2.44 ± 0.24 mm, respectively; antenna length (including apical
seta), 0.33 ± 0.03 mm, 0.35 ± 0.08 mm, 0.44 ± 0.06 mm, 0.61 ± 0.07 mm,
and 0.86 ± 0.05 mm, respectively; and maximum head width, 0.22 ± 0.04
mm, 0.26 ± 0.03 mm, 0.36 ± 0.05 mm, 0.49 ± 0.03 mm, and 0.67 ± 0.04
mm, respectively.
First instar (Fig. IB). — Opaque white, with beige mottling on abdominal
segments 2 and 5; eyes red; tarsal claws black; abdominal segments 6, 7,
and 8, light orange.
Antenna with small, plate-like scape rising in genal region; pedicel cylin¬
drical, comprising most of antenna; flagellum hemispherical, ca. half pedicel
length and with a long, setaceous bristle extending from apex.
Vertex and frons with carinae; median carinae parallel from vertex to
frons, gradually diverging laterally to post-clypeus; thus, interfrons narrow¬
er than laterofrons.
Wing pads and thorax without carinae; hind tibia without teeth or spur.
Second instar (Fig. 1C). — Nearly all white, with beige mottling on ab¬
dominal segments 3, 4, and 5. Antenna with flagellum and pedicel light
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
431
brown; flagellum reduced to small knob at pedicel apex. Compound eyes
with dark red facets; each facet ringed with white, imparting a pinkish eye
color.
Hind tibia with distal spur on calcar; calcar smooth, pointed distally, and
0.04 ± 0.01 mm (N = 12) long. Wing pads present, 0.16 ± 0.02 mm long.
Third instar (Fig. ID). — Body mostly white, with light brown, slightly
more pronounced, medial and lateral carinae on head. Mesonotal wing pad
0.33 ± 0.04 mm long, smooth, with light brown distal third; metanotal pad,
with light brown, rectangular marking on mesal half.
Hind tibia with 2 small teeth, 1 each on mid-anterior and distal end; calcar
0.10 ± 0.01 mm long, with 2 distinct teeth on inner margin; tibia with light
brown, annular markings at 16 and 36 its length.
Fourth instar (Fig. IE). — Body coloration like third instar, but with white
compound eyes surrounded by membranous areas. Antenna in groove on
ventral part of eye; scape enlarged and cylindrical; flagellum very much
reduced, but still with long, setaceous bristle.
Mesonotal wing pads 0.60 ± 0.05 (N = 17) mm long; metanotal pads,
only slightly elongated. Mesonotum and metanotum with pair of longitudinal
carinae lateral to meson; longitudinal carina also laterad on pronotum.
Calcar 0.15 ± 0.01 mm long (N = 17), with row of teeth along inner edge.
Fifth instar. — Sensory pits present on many parts of the body were only
studied in fifth instar S. tricarinata (Figs. IF, 2) but also occur in the other
instars. Vilbaste (1968) stated that the number and arrangement of these pits
in delphacid nymphs is constant in all but the first instar. On the head of S.
tricarinata, these pits are limited to the lateral frons and vertex, 9 pits to
each side of the median carinae (Fig. 2A). The European delphacids that
Vilbaste (1968) studied also had 9 pits to each side of the median carinae,
but these were arranged in 3 pairs on the laterofrons, 1 pit near the lateral
keel and vertex, and another pair on the vertex near the medial keel. In S.
tricarinata, the pits are unpaired and alternately placed along the length of
the lateral and medial cariane from the vertex to the anteclypeus (Fig. 2A).
The upper pit is always located nearest the lateral carina of the vertex. The
remaining 8 pits are located on the laterofrons. Another pair of pits lie dorsal
to the anteclypeus and lateral to the medial carina.
Pronotum with 2 lateral carinae, each carina with 3 pits, 2 medial to keel,
and a caudal pit laterad to keel; pronotum with 2 additional pits at posterior
base of each eye (Fig. 2B).
Mesonotal wing pads, 1.09 ± 0.10 mm (N = 17) long, covering metanotal
pads; wing pads with carinae well developed, a pair of pits on opposite sides
of carinae, 1 mesal, 1 lateral, and 3 more pits laterad to these: 1 near outer
edge of mesonotal pad, the other 2 pits in center of pad ca. 36 distance from
pronotum to distal end of pad (Fig. 2B).
432
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
1 1mm
Fig. 2. A. location of sensory pits on the head of a fifth instar Stobaera tricarinata. B.
location of sensory pits on the dorsum of this instar.
Metanotal wing pads reach abdominal segment 3; marginal slit present
just behind medial ridge; sensory pit laterad to medial ridge (Fig. 2B).
Legs mostly white, with 3 dark brown annular markings on each tibia;
calcar 0.27 ± 0.03 ram (N = 14) long, with row of teeth on inner edge (Fig.
2E).
Abdomen with 9 apparent segments; sensory pits on terga 4-9 (Fig. 2B):
terga 4 and 9 with 0+1 pits (number of medial pits + number of lateral
pits; after Vilbaste, 1968) laterally, terga 5 and 7 with 0 + 2 pits, terga 6 and
8 with 1 + 2 pits; ridge on dorsum along meson. Abdomen, like rest of
body, mottled dark brown and white.
Literature Cited
Goeden, R. D., and D. W. Ricker. 1974a. The phytophagous insect fauna of the ragweed,
Ambrosia acanthicarpa, in southern California. Environ. Entomol., 3:827-834.
Goeden, R. D., and D. W. Ricker. 1974b. The phytophagous insect fauna of the ragweed,
Ambrosia chamissonis , in southern California. Environ. Entomol., 3:835-839.
Goeden, R. D., and D. W. Ricker. 1975, The phytophagous insect fauna of the ragweed,
Ambrosia confertiflora, in southern California. Environ. Entomol., 4:301-306.
Goeden, R. D., and D. W. Ricker. 1976a. The phytophagous insect fauna of the ragweed,
Ambrosia dumosa, in southern California. Environ. Entomol., 5:45-50.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
433
Goeden, R. D., and D. W. Ricker. 1976b. The phytophagous insect fauna of the ragweeds,
Ambrosia chenopodiifolia, A. eriocentra, and A. ilicifolia, in southern California. En¬
viron. Entomol., 5:923-930.
Goeden, R. D., and D. W. Ricker. 1976c. The phytophagous insect fauna of the ragweed,
Ambrosia psilostachya, in southern California. Environ. Entomol., 5:1169-1177.
Hassen, A. I. 1939. The biology of some British Delphacidae (Homoptera) and their parasites
with special reference to the Strepsiptera. Trans. R. Entomol. Soc. Lond., 89:345-383.
Kramer, J. P. 1973. Revision of the American planthoppers of the genus Stobaera (Homop¬
tera: Delphacidae) with new distributional data and host plant records. Proc. Entomol.
Soc. Wash., 75:379^102.
Vilbaste, J. 1968. Preliminary key for the identification of the nymphs of North European
Homoptera Cicadina. Ann. Entomol. Fenn., 34:65-74.
Footnote
1 Research Assistant and Professor, respectively. From a thesis submitted in partial satis¬
faction of the requirements for a M.S. degree in Entomology, University of California, Riv¬
erside.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 434-442
RECORDS OF PLECOPTERA (INSECTA) FROM
SOUTHEASTERN ALASKA
S. T. Elliott
Alaska Department of Fish and Game, Sport Fish Division,
230 S. Franklin Street, Juneau 99801
Southeastern Alaska is that portion of the state extending from Dixon
Entrance near the City of Ketchikan to Cape Yakutaga near the village of
Yakutat and bounded by the Gulf of Alaska on the west and the glaciated
coast range on the east. The region is heavily forested with Sitka Spruce
and Western Hemlock and has a maritime climate with some areas receiving
over two meters of precipitation annually. The region contains over 10,000
stream and lake systems and four main rivers that originate in British Co¬
lumbia and Yukon Provinces of Canada. Streams and lakes are generally
low in productivity due to low mineral content (Schmidt, 1979).
Plecoptera were first recorded in Southeastern Alaska by Nathan Banks
during the Harriman-Alaska Expedition (Banks, 1900). Since then, records
of stoneflies have been infrequent except for those found in Jewett (1959)
in his treatment of the Pacific Northwest fauna, Bauman and Gaufin (1970),
and Ellis (1975).
Knowledge of stonefly distribution in the Pacific Northwest was enhanced
when Ricker and Scudder (1975) published a checklist of stoneflies of British
Columbia. This paper presents collection records from Southeastern Alaska
gathered since 1968 and should serve to further extend the northern range
of many species discussed by Ricker and Scudder.
Materials and Methods
Specimens were captured with aerial nets, stream drift nets, or obtained
from fish stomachs. Specimens were stored in 70% ethanol and are main¬
tained in a reference collection located at the Alaska Department of Fish
and Game in Juneau, Alaska.
Nomenclature and arrangement follows Zwrick (1973).
Family Perlodidae
Isogenoides colubrinus (Hagen)
Alaska (Ricker, 1952).
Taku River, 2 mi. S. of Canyon Island, VII-15-72, 1 <3.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
435
Kogotus nonus (Needham and Claassen)
Hood Bay Creek, 6 mi. S. of Angoon, Admiralty Island, VIII-21-69, 1
3 ; Blossom River, near North Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, D. Hubartt,
1 3.
Megarcys signata (Hagen)
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Davidoff Lake, Baranof Island, 50 mi. S. of Sitka, VII-26-77, A. Schmidt,
1 3, 2 9; Falls Creek, South Arm of Hood Bay, 6 mi. S. of Angoon,
Admiralty Island, VII-1-70, 1 9; North inlet stream, Turner Lake, Taku
Inlet, VIII-5-70, 2 9 ; Turner Lake, North inlet stream, Taku Inlet, VII- 1 1-
77, A. Schmidt, 1 3 (dissected from nymph).
Isoperla petersoni Needham and Christenson
Reitze’s Pond, Chilkat River, near Haines, VI-10-77, J. Koerner, 2 3.
Isoperla sordida Banks
Swan Lake, Cascade Creek Inlet, 15 mi. N.E. of Petersburg, VIII-28-74,
A. Schmidt, 1 3 .
Family Perlidae
Hesperoperla pacifica (Banks)
Ella Lake, inlet stream, 50 mi. E. of Ketchikan, VI-8-77, A. Schmidt, 1
nymph; Lake Kathleen, Admiralty Island, 30 mi. S. Juneau, VIII-28-79, R.
Vineyard, 3 nymphs; Inlet stream, Patching Lake, Naha River, 15 mi. N.E.
of Ketchikan, VI-19-75, A. Schmidt, 2 nymphs; V1I-29-75, 1 nymph; Sarkar
Lake system, Prince of Wales Island, 8 mi. N. of Tuxekan, VII-9-76, A.
Schmidt, 1 nymph; Ward Cove Creek, 7 mi. N. of Ketchikan, IV-21-78, D.
Hubartt, 3 nymphs.
Family Chloroperlidae
Kathroperla perdita Banks
Sitcha [sic] (Needham and Claassen, 1925).
Inlet Stream, DeBoer Lake, 15 mi. N.E. of Petersburg, IX-4-74, A.
Schmidt, 2 nymphs; Haska Creek, 6 mi. W. of Haines, VII- 1 1-72, 1 nymph;
Keta River, near Hill Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, VI-4-78, 2 <3; VII-
24-78, M. Anderson, 1 9; Kook Lake, Chichagof Island, VI-6-72, 1 9;
Sheep Creek, 5 mi. S. of Juneau, VII-2-72, 3 3,3 9 .
436
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Alloperla serrata Needham and Claassen
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975); Alaska (Zwick,
1973).
Osprey Lake, Little Port Walter, Baranof Island, VIII-7-74, A. Schmidt,
1 3.
Hastaperla brevis (Banks)
Sitka, as Isopteryx cydippe (Banks, 1900).
Neaviperla forcipata (Neave)
Alaska (Jewett, 1959).
Eagle River, head of estuary, 28 mi. N. of Juneau, IX-9-72, 1 9 ; IX-11-
72, 1 3, 1 9; Kadashan River, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VIII-25-
72, 2 $ ; VIII-8-72, 3 3 , 1 9 ; VIII-22-72, 1 3 ; Keta River, near Hill Creek,
Boca de Quadra, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, IX-2-77, D. Magnus, 1 <3, 3
9 ; VII-22-78, M. Anderson, 3 9 ; VII-29-78, 13.
Suwallia pallidula (Banks)
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975); Alaska (Jewett,
1959).
Dog Salmon Creek, Skowl Arm, Prince of Wales Island, VIII- 18-71, 10
(3,3 9; inlet stream, Jordan Lake, Naha River, 15 mi. N.E. of Ketchikan,
VII- 16-75, A. Schmidt, 1 S; Kadashan Creek, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof
Island, VIII-8-72, 2 3, 5 9 ; Mile 28 Creek, Petersburg road system, Mitkof
Island, VII-27-71, 1 <3,3 9 ; Osprey Lake inlet, Little Port Walter, Baranof
Island, IX-5-74, A. Schmidt, 1 6; Saginaw Creek, Saginaw Bay, Kuiu Is¬
land, VIII-3-71, 1 9; Sheep Creek, 5 mi. S. of Juneau, IX-19-72, 1 9;
Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, VIII-7-73, 1 3; VIII-9-73, 2 3,4 9;
VIII- 24-73, 2 9; VIII-2-73, 13,1 9 ; St. Johns Harbor, Zarembo Island,
VII-28-71, 1 3,3 9.
Sweltza borealis (Banks)
Sitka (Banks, 1900); Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis
1970; Ellis, 1975).
Redoubt Lake, Baranof Island, VIII-29-74, A. Schmidt, 1 3,2 9.
Sweltza coloradensis (Banks)
Fish Bay, Peril Straits, Baranof Island, VII-7-71, 4 9.
Sweltza exquisita (Frison)
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
437
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Fick Cove, South Arm Hoonah Sound, Chichagof Is., VI-25-71, 1 9 ; Fish
Bay Creek, Peril Straits, Baranof Island, VII-17-71, 1 9; Kadashan River,
Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VI-25-72, 7 6; VI-22-72, 1 6,3 9; 2 mi.
S. of Little Basket Bay, Chichagof Island, VII-7-72, 1 6, 1 9; Klawock
Lake outlet, Prince of Wales Island, VII-13-73, A. Schmidt, 1 6 ; Whiterock
Creek, Chichagof Island, VII-6-72, 2 6,2 9; Whitewater Bay Creek, Ad¬
miralty Island, VI-29-71, 1 6.
Sweltza fidelis (Banks)
Alaska (Jewett, 1959).
Sheep Creek, 5 mi. S. of Juneau, at tidewater, VII-3-74, D. Kirchhofer,
1 6.
Sweltza oregonensis (Frison)
Auke Cr., 12 mi. Glacier Highway, Juneau (Ellis, 1970); Harris River, 35
mi. E. of Ketchikan (Ellis, 1970); Traitors River, 20 mi. N. of Ketchikan
(Ellis, 1970); Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1970; 1975).
Corner Bay Creek, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VI-9-72, 8 6 ; inlet
stream, Heckman Lake, Naha River, 15 mi. N.E. of Ketchikan, VI-12-75,
A. Schmidt, 4 6: inlet stream, Jordan Lake, Naha River, 15 mi. N.E. of
Ketchikan, VH-15-75, A. Schmidt, 4 cJ; Kadashan River, Tenakee Inlet,
Chichagof Island, VI-20-72, 10 6, 9 9; VI-22-72, 10 6, 8 9; Keta River,
near Hill Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, VI-9-78, 1 6,2 9; VI-22-78, M.
Anderson, 1 6,4 9; VII-29-78, 1 9; King Salmon River, Seymour Canal,
Admiralty Island, VII-28-72, 4 9 ; inlet stream. Patching Lake, Naha River,
15 mi. N.E. of Ketchikan, VI- 18-75, A. Schmidt, 4 6 ; VH-9-75, 4 d; Star-
rigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, VI-13-74, 2 9 ; Whiterock River, Chichagof
Island, VII-6-72, 4 6, 6 9.
Sweltza pacifica (Banks)
Sitka and Juneau as Chloroperla pacifica (Banks, 1900).
Sweltza revelstoka (Jewett)
Corner Bay Creek, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VI-9-72, 1 6 nymph;
Kook Lake, Basket Bay, Chichagof Island, VI-8-72, 4 6 ; Rodman Creek,
Peril Straits, Baranof Island, VII-22-71, 1 6 ; Seal Bay, Peril Straits, Baranof
Island, VII-23-71, 1 9; Switzer Creek, 5 mi. N. of Juneau, IV-25-78, D.
Hubartt, 1 9 .
Triznaka diversa (Frison)
438
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Alaska (Jewett, 1959).
Fick Cove, Peril Straits, Baranof Island, VI-25-71, 1 <J; Kadashan River,
Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VI-22-72, 1 <5; Porcupine Creek, 13 mi. E.
of Klukwan, on Haines Highway, VII-24-73, 1 8 ; Turner Lake, Taku Inlet,
from kokanee stomach sample taken near cabin inlet, VII 11-77, D. Hu-
bartt, 1 8 (dissected from nymph).
Family Taeniopterygidae
Doddsia occidentalis (Banks)
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975); Alaska (Jewett,
1959).
Gold Creek, Juneau, IV-5-73, 4 8 ; 11-23-73, 1 nymph; Keta River, 50 mi.
S.E. of Ketchikan, IV-13-78, 21 8, 11 9 ; Switzer Creek, 5 mi. N. of Juneau,
VI-2-72, 1 9 .
Taenionema pacificum (Banks)
Stikine River, near Kakwon Point, V-5-78, J. Koerner, 5 8, 1 9.
Taenionema pallidum (Banks)
Sheep Creek, 5 mi. S. of Juneau, VII-3-74, D. Kirchhofer, 1 8 .
Family Nemouridae
Podmosta decepta (Frison)
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Kook Lake, main inlet stream, Chichagof Island, VI-8-72, 2 8 ; Menden¬
hall River, Brotherhood Bridge, Juneau, V-30-72, 5 8', VI-1-74, 2 8\ VI-13-
74, 6 8, 1 9; Seal Bay, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VII-23-71, 1 9;
Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, VI-13-73, 1 9.
Podmosta delicatula (Claassen)
Mendenhall River, Brotherhood Bridge, Juneau, V-30-74, 1 8 .
Visoka cataractae (Neave)
Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, IV-19-73, 1 8, 1 9; West fork of
Bear Creek, Mitkof Island, IV-23-73, 1 9; West Mendenhall Glacier Trail,
Juneau, IV-20-75, D. Kirchhofer, 1 8; Spurt Lake, Thomas Bay, 20 mi.
N.E. of Petersburg, IX-8-74, A. Schmidt, 1 8, (dissected from nymph).
Zapada cinctipes (Banks)
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
439
Sitka and Yakutat (Banks, 1900); Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof
Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Fish Bay Creek, Peril Straits, Baranof Island, VII-7-71, 2 9 ; Fod Creek,
tributary to Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, 1-22-74, 1 8 ; Herbert
River, 29 mi. N. of Juneau, V- 16-74, 10 8 ; Jordan Lake, Naha River system,
15 mi. N.E. of Ketchikan, specimen obtained from cutthroat trout stomach
sample, VII- 15-75, A. Schmidt, 1 9 ; Mendenhall Lake, on West Glacier Trail,
10 mi. N. of Juneau, IV-20-75, D. Kirchhofer, 1 9; Osprey Lake, Little
Port Walter, Baranof Island, V-31-74, A. Schmidt, 1 8', Patching Lake,
Naha River system, 15 mi. N.E. of Ketchikan, obtained from cutthroat trout
stomach sample, VI-19-75, A. Schmidt, 3 9; Seal Bay, Tenakee Inlet,
Chichagof Island, V1I-23-71, 3 9; Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka,
Baranof Island, IV-23-72, 4 (5; IV-18-73, 3 <J, 6 9; IV-18-74, 2 9; Switzer
Creek, 5 mi. N.W. of Juneau, III-23-72, \ 8,2 9 ; III-24-72, 6 d, 6 9; IV-
23-72, 4 8 ; West Fork of Bear Creek, Mitkof Highway, Mitkof Island, IV-
23-73, 5 8 .
Zapada Columbiana (Claassen)
Southern Alaska (Ricker, 1952).
Gold Creek, near Juneau, IV-5-74, 2 8,2 9; VI-27-74, 1 9; Starrigavan
Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, III-19-74, 1 8\ Switzer Creek, 5 mi. N. of Juneau,
III-24-72, 1 d; West Glacier Trail, Mendenhall Lake, 8 mi. N. of Juneau,
III-23-75, 1 9; III-31-75, 2 8, \ 9.
Zapada frigida (Claassen)
Sitka (Claassen, 1923); Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis,
1975).
Fish Bay, Peril Straits, Baranof Island, VII-7-71, 1 8 .
Zapada haysi (Ricker)
Herbert River, 29 mi. N. of Juneau, V-16-74, 19,1 nymph; Gold Creek,
near Juneau, VI-27-74, 1 9 ; Keta River, near Hill Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of
Ketchikan, IV-29-79, L. McVey, 1 8 ; Manzanita Lake inlet, 25 mi. E. of
Ketchikan, V-25-77, A. Schmidt, 1 <3; Sheep Creek, 5 mi. S. of Juneau,
VII-2-72, 2 9; IV-5-73, 2 9, reared material; Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N.
of Sitka, IV- 19-73, 1 9.
Zapada oregonensis (Claassen)
Sashin Creek, Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975); Alaska (Jewett,
1959).
Corner Bay Creek, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VI-9-72, 16 8, 6
440
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
9; Eagle River, 28 mi. N. of Juneau, near tidewater, V-17-74, 1 9; IX-17-
74, 1 9 ; Keta River, Hill Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, VI-4-78, 1 9;
Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, VI-3-73, 1 9 ; Stikine River, Kakwon
Point, V-15-78, J. Koerner, 1 9 ; Switzer Creek, 5 mi. N. of Juneau, IV-22-
72, 1 9.
Family Capniidae
Capnia confusa Claassen
Eagle River, 28 mi. N.W. of Juneau, V-17-74, 3 3; Gold Creek, near
Juneau, VI-27-74, 1 3, 2 9; Herbert River, 29 mi. N.W. of Juneau, V-16-
74, 2 3, 1 9 ; Keta River, near Hill Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, VI-6-
78, 1 3 , 2 9 ; VT-16-78, M. Anderson, 1 3 ; Lisianski River, North Chichagof
Island, V-18-73, A. Schmidt, 1 <3; Mendenhall River, Juneau, V-17-73, 14
(3; V-16-74, 2 <3, 1 9; IX-17-74, 13 3; Redoubt Lake, 10 mi. S. of Sitka,
Baranof Island, VI-19-74, A. Schmidt, 1 mature nymph; Sister Lake, Chich¬
agof Island, VI-9-73, A. Schmidt, 1 3; Sheep Creek, 5 mi. S. of Juneau,
VI-13-74, 10 3,5 9; V-30-74, 2 3,2 9; Stikine River, Kakwon Point, V-16-
78, J. Koerner, 4 3,8 9; Switzer Creek, 5 mi. N. of Juneau, VI-2-72, 1
3,4 9.
Capnia excavata Claassen
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Kadashan Creek, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Island, VI-22-72, 1 3,3 9 ;
VI-25-72, 1 3; Keta River, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, IV-13-78, 9 3,2 9;
VI-10-78, 2 3,2 9; Kook Lake, south inlet stream, Chichagof Island, VI-
6-72, 13,19; Mendenhall River, Brotherhood Bridge, near Juneau, IV-
II- 73, 14 3, 4 9; V-17-73, 6 3; V-30-73, 5 3; IX-17-74, 6 3; Steep Creek,
16 mi. N. of Juneau, VI- 13-73, D. Kirchhofer, 1 3 ; Whiterock Creek, Chich¬
agof Island, VII-6-72, 1 3.
Capnia melia Frison
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, Baranof Island, 1-22-74, 1 3 ; Switzer
Creek, 5 mi. N. of Juneau, III-7-73, 1 3,2 9.
Capnia nana Claassen
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka, IV-18-73, 2 3; III-19-74, 13,3
9; Steep Creek, 16 mi. N. of Juneau, III-27-72, D. Kirchhofer, 6 3, 6 9;
III- 24-75, 3 3,2 9 ; West Mendenhall Glacier Trail, 8 mi. N. of Juneau, III-
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
441
23-75, D. Kirchhofer, 1 d; III-24-75, 3 d, 2 9; III-31-75, 2 d, 2 9 ; IV-20-
75, 1 d, 1 9; Windfall Lake Inlet, 28 mi. N. of Juneau, III-25-72, D.
Kirchhofer, 1 6 , 3 9 .
Isocapnia agassizi Ricker
Keta River, near Hill Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, R. Vineyard, V-4-
79, 1 6, 1 9.
Isocapnia spenceri Ricker
Keta River, near Hill Creek, 50 mi. S.E. of Ketchikan, IV-29-79, R. Vine¬
yard, 1 6, 1 9.
Mesocapnia autumna (Bauman and Gaufin)
Ideal Cove, Mitkof Is. (Bauman and Gaufin, 1970); Ohmers Slough, Ku-
preanof Is. (Bauman and Gaufin, 1970).
Lower Situk River, 12 mi. S.E. of Yakutat, X-21-72, 2 3,3 9.
Family Leuctridae
Despaxia augusta (Banks)
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975); Alaska (Jewett,
1959).
Dog Salmon Creek, Prince of Wales Is., VIII-5-71, 1 d; Kadashan Cr.,
Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Is., VIII-8-72, 1 6 ; Osprey Lake, Little Port Wal¬
ter, Baranof Is., VIII-24-75, A. Schmidt, 2 d; IX-16-75, 4 d, 4 9; Pat’s
Creek, 12 mi. N. of Wrangell, VIII-28-71, 1 d; Sarkar Lake inlet, 10 mi. N.
of Tuxekan, Prince of Wales Island, VII-16-76, A. Schmidt, 1 d; St. Johns
Harbor, Zarembo Is., VIII-3-71, 1 d; Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka,
VIII-7-73, 1 d; VIII-24-73, 1 d; Spurt Lake, inlet stream, Thomas Bay, 20
mi. N. of Petersburg, IX-8-74, A. Schmidt, 1 d.
Paraleuctra forcipata (Frison)
Alaska (Zwick, 1973).
Corner Bay Creek, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Is., VI-9-72, 1 9 ; Exchange
Cove Cr., Prince of Wales Is., VII-12-72, R. Reed, 1 9; Kadashan Cr.,
Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Is., VI-20-72, 11 d, 6 9 ; Kook Lake, inlet stream,
Chichagof Is., VI-22-72, 4 d, 2 9 ; Osprey Lake, Little Port Walter, Baranof
Is., V-29-74, A. Schmidt, 1 d.
Paraleuctra occidentalis (Banks)
442
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is. (Ellis, 1975).
Kook Lake, inlet stream, Chichagof Is., VI-6-72, 1 8 ; Sheep Creek, 5 mi.
S. of Juneau, VII-2-72, 1 8, 1 9; Starrigavan Creek, 8 mi. N. of Sitka,
Baranof Is., V- 10-73, 1 9 ; West fork of Bear Creek, near Petersburg, Mitkof
Is., IV-23-73, 1 9.
Paraleuctra vershina Gaufin and Ricker
Sashin Cr., Little Port Walter, Baranof Is., as Paraleuctra sara (Ellis,
1975).
Corner Bay Creek, Tenakee Inlet, Chichagof Is., VI-9-72, 1 9 ; Patching
Lake, Naha River, 15 mi. N. of Ketchikan, VI-18-75, A. Schmidt, 3 8 , 1
9.
Acknowledgments
This investigation was conducted with U.S. Federal Aid in Fish Resto¬
ration Funds. Appreciation is extended to Kim Lonberg for typing the manu¬
script.
Literature Cited
Banks, N. 1900. Papers from the Harriman Alaska Expedition. X. Entomological Results (4):
Neuropteroid Insects. Washington Acad. Sci. Proc., 2:465-476.
Bauman, R. W., and A. R. Gaufin. 1970. The Capnia projecta complex of Western North
American (Plecoptera: Capniidae). Trans. Amer. Ent. Soc., 96:435-468.
Ellis, R. J. 1970. Alloperla stonefiy nymphs: Predators or scavengers on salmon eggs and
alevins? Trans. Amer. Fish. Soc., 99(4): 677-683.
Ellis, R. J. 1975. Seasonal abundance and distribution of adult stoneflies of Sashin Creek,
Baranof Island, Southeast Alaska. Pan-Pacific Entomol., 51(1):23— 30.
Jewett, S. G., Jr. 1959. The stoneflies (Plecoptera) of the Pacific Northwest. Oregon St.
Monogr. Stud. Ent. Corvallis, 3:1-92.
Needham, J. G,, and P. W. Claassen. 1925. A monograph of the Plecoptera or Stoneflies of
America north of Mexico. Thomas Say Foundation, 2:1-397.
Ricker, W. E. 1952. Systematic studies in Plecoptera. Indiana Univ. Publ. (Sci.), 18:1-200.
Ricker, W. E. , and G. G E. Scudder. 1975, An annotated checklist of the Plecoptera (Insecta)
of British Columbia. Syesis, 8:333-348.
Schmidt, A. E. 1979. Inventory and cataloging of sport fish and sport fish waters in Southeast
Alaska. Alaska Dept, of Fish and Game. Fed. Aid in Fish Rest., Annu. Rept. of Per¬
formance, 1978-1979, Proj. F-9-11, 20(G-I-R), 131 pp.
Zwick, P. 1973. Ordo Plecoptera: Phylogenetisches System und Katalog. Das Tierreich Berlin,
Lieferung 94, 32:1-465.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 443-446
THE EFFECTS OF AN OUTBREAK OF TRIDEPIA NOVA (SMITH)
(LEPIDOPTERA: NOCTUIDAE) ON FOUR- WING SALTBUSH,
ATRIPLEX CANESCENS (PURSH) NUTT.
Jon F. Peters1
Department of Biological Sciences, Northern Arizona University,
Flagstaff 860 1 1
From 24 August 1977 to 30 August 1977 large numbers of Tridepia nova
(Smith) larvae were observed on Wupatki National Monument in northern
Arizona. The monument is located 42 km north of Flagstaff, Arizona at an
elevation of 1432 m. During the outbreak, the moth larvae were observed
feeding only on Four-wing saltbush, Atriplex canescens (Pursh) Nutt.,
which is abundant throughout the Cold Desert Shrub community of the
monument. Comstock (1929) and Tietz (1972) have reported that a related
species, Trichoclea antic a, feeds solely on A. canescens. Although weekly
sampling indicated that the outbreak apparently lasted only six to nine days,
damage to many of the plants in certain areas of the monument was exten¬
sive. Damages included almost complete defoliation of the shrubs and con¬
siderable damage to many of the saltbush seeds.
Tridepia nova was first described as Trichoclea nova (Smith, 1903). Later,
McDunnough (1938) placed it in Tridepia. Smith (1903) described adults as
having a pale grayish ground color due to the mixing of white and smoky
scales. The last instar larvae are light green to pale yellow in color and about
20 mm in length. These features resemble other closely related species
(Comstock, 1929; Benjamin, 1932).
Observations
There is some uncertainty as to the area covered and exact time span of
the outbreak, but the larvae were seen consuming Four-wing saltbush on
24 August 1977. Observations after 30 August 1977 indicated that few, if
any, larvae remained on the saltbush. Several park rangers noticed the out¬
break on 25 and 26 August, but none reported seeing T. nova larvae before
24 August 1977. Thus, the outbreak probably lasted from six to nine days.
The range of the outbreak probably included Antelope Mesa as the west¬
ern boundary because of the scarcity of saltbush west of the mesa. Due to
the brevity of the outbreak and sampling restrictions, the exact boundaries
of the outbreak were not determined. However, observations near the Wu¬
patki visitor center indicated that the area immediately around the visitor
444
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
center could have been the eastern limit of the outbreak. The northern and
southern limits of the outbreak were not determined.
During the outbreak, T. nova larvae were observed feeding not only on
Four- wing saltbush leaves, but also on the four enlarged bracts that consti¬
tute the wings of the saltbush seeds. Interestingly, some saltbush plants
were left relatively untouched by the moth larvae during the 1977 outbreak.
Larvae collected from saltbush plants pupated in soil in the laboratory
and commenced emergence several weeks later on 13 September 1977. The
emergence of adult moths in the lab corresponded to the few black-light
captures in the field. Although T. nova individuals were collected by sweep¬
ing, pitfall trapping, and by a black- fight trap in 1977, not one individual was
captured in 1978 using the same methods in the same area.
The larvae expressed several possible defense mechanisms although no
predation by vertebrates or arachnids was observed. First, the larvae re¬
sembled the leaf color of the Four-wing saltbush. Behaviorally, the larvae
moved little while on the saltbush, presumably to enhance concealment.
Secondly, when the larvae were touched they quickly dropped to the ground
under the dense growth of the shrub, where they were extremely difficult
to locate. Third, when handled the larvae secreted a brown substance that
was probably repugnatorial.
Discussion
Four-wing saltbush is named for the four enlarged bracts that surround
the saltbush seeds. Since the wings on these seeds aid in seed dispersal, any
factor that would remove the bracts would tend to reduce seed dispersal.
As mentioned, the larvae attacked not only the saltbush leaves but also the
wings of the saltbush seeds. Thus, it is possible that the 1977 T. nova
outbreak may have reduced the seed dispersal and slowed the growth of
existing saltbush plants in succeeding years. During the summer of 1978,
much less rain fell than during the summer of 1977. The resulting xeric
conditions of 1978 suppressed much of the saltbush growth. Therefore, it
was impossible to conclude what effect the 1977 outbreak of T. nova had
on the saltbush in succeeding years, if any, since the dry 1978 spring and
summer obscured any effects of the 1977 larval feeding damage.
Some saltbush plants were not fed upon by T. nova larvae in 1977, and
it is possible that these plants were missed due to chance. However, the
high larval densities throughout the outbreak area probably precludes this
as an explanation. More likely, chemical differences between plants may
have accounted for the absence of T. nova larvae on certain saltbush plants.
Sharma et al. (1972) have found that sodium and chloride concentrations
increase progressively with corresponding decreases in rainfall. If certain
plants were located in soil with relatively low moisture retention, they may
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 3
445
have had electrolyte concentrations above the tolerance levels of the larvae,
and the plants would not have been palatable to the moths.
The appearance of T. nova larvae in late August may be an adaptation to
low electrolyte levels in the Atriplex. The Cold Desert Shrub community of
Wupatki National Monument usually receives heavy rainfall in the form of
summer thunderstorms from mid-July to late August. Upon hatching in late
August, the larvae would find both adequate moisture and the lowest elec¬
trolyte concentrations, resulting from the summer rains.
Although the 1977 outbreak area was sampled in 1978 using the same
collecting methods that had detected T. nova individuals in 1977, no adults
or larvae were seen. Possibly, intense predation or disease reduced the
population dramatically. The larvae did apparently possess defense mea¬
sures, such as cryptic coloration, avoidance behaviors, and the secretion of
a probable repellent.
Summary
An outbreak of Tridepia nova was observed on Wupatki National Mon¬
ument, Arizona, during the last week of August 1977. The moth larvae fed
exclusively on Four-wing saltbush ( Atriplex canescens ) within part of the
Cold Desert Shrub community of the monument. Both saltbush leaves and
seed bracts were consumed. With many plants, almost complete defoliation
occurred. The removal of the seed wings by the larvae probably decreased
overall seed dispersal in 1977. Some saltbush plants were not fed upon by
these larvae in 1977, and it is speculated that higher sodium and chloride
concentrations in spared plants may have deterred the larvae from feeding
on them. The T. nova larvae possessed several defenses, which included
cryptic coloration, various behavioral adaptations for concealment, and the
secretion of a brown substance that probably served as a predator repellent.
Acknowledgments
I especially wish to thank Dr. C. D. Johnson of Northern Arizona Uni¬
versity for his encouragement and guidance. Moth larvae and adults were
identified by Don Weismann, and Dr. James Rominger contributed infor¬
mation about the Four-wing saltbush on the monument. Funds that were
provided to Northern Arizona University as grants 950189 and 950236 by
the National Park Service to help in this study are gratefully acknowledged.
Literature Cited
Benjamin, F. H. 1932. New Phalaenidae from the southwestern part of the United States
(Lepidoptera). Bull. S. Calif. Acad. Sci., 31:29-32.
Comstock, J. A. 1929. Studies in Pacific coast Lepidoptera. Bull. S. Calif. Acad. Sci., 28:22-
58.
446
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
McDunnough, J. 1938. Check list of the Lepidoptera of Canada and the United States of
America. Memoirs of the Southern California Academy of Sciences, vol. 1, pp. 1-275.
Sharma, M. L., J. Tunny, and D. J. Tongway. 1972. Seasonal changes in sodium and chloride
concentration of saltbush ( Atriplex spp.) leaves as related to soil and plant water po¬
tential. Aust. J. Agric. Res., 23:1007-1019.
Smith, J. B. 1903. New noctuids for 1903, No. 4, with notes on certain described species.
Trans. Am. Ent. Soc., 29:191-224.
Tietz, H. M. 1972. An index to the described life histories, early stages, and hosts of the
macrolepidoptera of the continental United States and Canada. A. C. Allyn, Sarasota,
Florida, vol. 2, pp. 537-1041.
Footnote
1 Present address: Department of Biology, Laredo Junior College, Laredo, Texas 78040.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
July 1981, Vol. 57, No. 3, pp. 447-448
SCIENTIFIC NOTE
AGGREGATION IN TWO SYMPATRIC SPECIES OF CRANE FLY
(DIPTERA: TIPULIDAE)
Tipula acuta Doane and Tipula simplex Doane are two sympatric species
of crane fly, the larvae of both inhabiting the soil of unirrigated pastures in
Tulare County, California during the winter months, often aggregated under
the same cowpads. Previous investigations (Hartman & Hynes, 1977, Pan-
Pac. EntomoJ., 53:118-123; Hartman, Surfleet & Hynes, 1978, Pan-Pac.
Entomol., 54:305-310) have shown that T. simplex larvae release a fecal
pheromone that acts as a locomotory inhibitor, hence aiding aggregation.
The purpose of this research is to determine if T. acuta also produces a
fecal pheromone or if it aggregates in response to the pheromone produced
by T. simplex.
The apparatus used was modified from the one reported by Reeve and
Berry (1976, Environ. Entomol., 5:961-963). Two 9 cm petri dishes were
cut and joined together to make a choice-cage with a 4.5 cm opening be¬
tween the two sections. Filter paper was placed in each side, and one side
was moistened with 1.1 ml of an extract made by grinding the inestinal tract
of one crane fly and diluting with 2.0 ml of distilled water, while the other
was moistened with 1.1 ml of distilled water. Five larvae were placed in
each side of the cage. The position of each larva was recorded after 24
hours.
Each species was tested for reaction to its own extract, and for reaction
to the extract of the other, and each test was replicated six times. The data
were analyzed using Chi Square.
Results are shown in Table 1. T. simplex shows a definite aggregation to
extract of its own intestinal tract, confirming the presence of the aggregation
pheromone previously detected by Hartman & Hynes (1977) and Hartman,
Surfleet & Hynes (1978). However, T. simplex does not respond to the feces
of T. acuta. T. acuta does not appear to have a fecal aggregating phero¬
mone, nor does it respond to the one produced by T. simplex.
Table 1.
* Not significant at P = 0.05.
448
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
The aggregation of T. simplex is due not only to chemical communication,
but also to its response to light and moisture as demonstrated by Hartman
& Hynes (1977). The limited data we have gathered suggest that the re¬
sponses to light and moisture in T. acuta are similar to the responses of T.
simplex . The aggregation of T. acuta under cowpads, therefore, probably
is due to the darker, moister environment found there, rather than to chem¬
ical communication among individuals in the population.
We would like to thank the Tulare County Agricultural Commission for
their continued assistance and the J. G. Boswell Company for their mone¬
tary support.
Margaret J. Hartman, Department of Biology, California State Uni¬
versity, Los Angeles 90032 ; and Robert G. Zahary, Allan Hancock Foun¬
dation, University of Southern California, Los Angeles 90007.
PUBLICATIONS
OF THE
PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
PROCEEDINGS OF THE PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL
SOCIETY.
Vol. 1 (16 numbers, 179 pages) and Vol. 2 (9 numbers, 131
pages). 1901-1930. Price $5.00 per volume.
THE PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST.
Vol. 1 (1924) to Vol. 51 (1975), price $10.00 per volume of 4
numbers, or $2.50 per single issue. Vol. 52 (1976) and subse¬
quent issues, $15.00 per volume or $3.75 per single issue.
MEMOIR SERIES.
Volume 1. The Sucking Lice by G. F. Ferris. 320 pages. Pub¬
lished October 1951. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.00 postage and han¬
dling.)*
Volume 2. The Spider Mite Family Tetranychidae by A. Earl
Pritchard and Edward W. Baker. 472 pages. Published July
1955. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 3. Revisionary Studies in the Nearctic Decticinae by
David C. Rentz and James D. Birchim. 173 pages. Published
July 1968. Price $4.00 (Plus $.75 postage and handling.)*
Volume 4. Autobiography of an Entomologist by Robert L.
Usinger. 343 pages. Published August 1972. Price $15.00. (Plus
$1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 5. Revision of the Millipede Family Andrognathidae
in the Nearctic Region by Michael R. Gardner. 61 pages. Pub¬
lished January 21, 1975. Price $3.00 (Plus $.75 postage and
handling.)*
*(Add 6% sales tax on all California orders (resident of Alameda, Contra
Costa, San Francisco, Santa Clara and Santa Cruz counties add 6'/i%).
Members of the Society will receive a 20% discount.)
Send orders to:
Pacific Coast Entomological Society
c/o California Academy of Sciences
Golden Gate Park
San Francisco, California 94118
Vol. 57
OCTOBER 1981
No. 4
THE
Pan-Pacific Entomologist
ALLEN and CHAO — Mayflies of the Southwest: New Records and Notes of Siphlo-
nuridae (Ephemeroptera) _ 449
KIRKBRIDE — A New Species of Ammophila from North America (Hymenoptera:
Sphecidae) _ 457
FELLIN — Pleocoma spp. in Western Oregon Coniferous Forests: Observations on
Adult Flight Habits and on Egg and Larval Biology (Coleoptera: Scarabaeidae) _ 461
CHEMSAK and LINSLEY — Additions to the Known Species of Pseudotypocems and
Strangalia (Coleoptera: Cerambycidae) _ 485
MARI MUTT — Two New Dicranocentrus from Nepal and a Key to the Indian and
Nepalese Species (Collembola: Entomobryidae) _ 493
FIELDS — New Species of Rhyacophila from California (Trichoptera: Rhyacophilidae) 500
SCIENTIFIC NOTES
Tyson — Artemisia californica Less., A New Host for Perarthrus vittatus Le-
Conte (Coleoptera: Cerambycidae) _ 492
Hajek and Dahlsten — First California Record for Dendrosoter protuberans
(Nees) (Hymenoptera: Braconidae) _ 504
PROCEEDINGS OF THE PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY _ 506
INDEX TO VOLUME 57 _ 509
SAN FRANCISCO, CALIFORNIA • 1981
Published by the PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
in cooperation with THE CALIFORNIA ACADEMY OF SCIENCES
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist
EDITORIAL BOARD
G. A. Marsh, Editor
C. Pleines, Editorial Asst.
P. H. Amaud, Jr., Treasurer
R. M. Bohart E. S. Ross
H. B. Leech
J. A. Chemsak
Published quarterly in January, April, July and October with Society Proceedings
appearing in the October number. All communications regarding nonreceipt of num¬
bers, requests for sample copies, and financial communications should be addressed
to the Treasurer, Dr. Paul H. Amaud, Jr., California Academy of Sciences, Golden
Gate Park, San Francisco, California 941 18.
Application for membership in the Society and changes of address should be ad¬
dressed to the Secretary, Ronald E. Somerby, Insect Taxonomy Laboratory, California
Department of Food and Agriculture, 1220 “N” St., Sacramento, CA 95814.
Manuscripts, proofs and all correspondence concerning editorial matters should be
addressed to Gordon A. Marsh, Museum of Systematic Biology, University of Cal¬
ifornia, Irvine, 92717.
The annual dues, paid in advance, are $12.00 for regular members of the Society,
$7.00 for student members, or $15.00 for subscription only. Members of the society
receive The Pan-Pacific Entomologist. Single copies of recent numbers are $3.75 each
or $1 5.00 a volume. Write to the treasurer for prices of earlier back numbers. Make
all checks payable to The Pacific Coast Entomological Society.
The Pacific Coast Entomological Society
OFFICERS FOR 1981
D. Kavanaugh, President P. H. Amaud, Jr., Treasurer
J. E. Hafemik, Jr., President-Elect R. E. Somerby, Secretary
Statement of Ownership
Title of Publication: The Pan-Pacific Entomologist.
Frequency of Issue: Quarterly (January, April, July, October).
Location of Office of Publication, Business Office of Publisher and Owner: Pacific Coast Entomological Society,
California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, California 94118.
Editor: G. A. Marsh, Museum of Systematic Biology, University of California, Irvine, 92717
Managing Editor and Known Bondholders or other Security Holders: None.
This issue mailed 24 May 1982
Second Class Postage Paid at San Francisco, California and Additional offices.
The Pan-Pacific Entomologist (ISSN 0031-0603)
PRINTED BY THE ALLEN PRESS, INC., LAWRENCE, KANSAS 66044. U.S.A.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 449-456
MAYFLIES OF THE SOUTHWEST: NEW RECORDS AND NOTES OF
SIPHLONURIDAE (EPHEMEROPTERA)
Richard K. Allen1 and Esther S. M. Chao2
A recent study of mayfly collections from Arizona and New Mexico has
revealed undescribed nymphs, and new distributional records of the family
Siphlonuridae. In the accounts dealing with the species, collections made
by the senior author are indicated by the initials RKA, and all specimens
are deposited in the California Academy of Sciences, San Francisco.
Genus Ameletus Eaton
Ameletus is composed of 31 described species in North America, 25 from
western North America and 6 from eastern North America. Western North
America is defined as all land area west of the eastern edge of the Rocky
Mountains. The distributional range of the genus in western North America
is from southern Arizona (32°40' north latitude) in the MIDDLE NORTH
TEMPERATE ZONE to central Alberta (53°3T north latitude) in the UP¬
PER NORTH TEMPERATE ZONE. In eastern North America the range
is from northern Alabama (33°45' north latitude) in the MIDDLE NORTH
TEMPERATE ZONE to southern Quebec (50° 19' north latitude) in the UP¬
PER NORTH TEMPERATE ZONE. Ameletus falsus McDunnough, 1938,
A. velox Dodds, 1923, and three undescribed nymphs are the only Ameletus
presently known to occur in the Southwest. The nymphs herein treated as
Ameletus sp. “A,” “B,” and “C” have not been reared and cannot be
associated with described male imagoes and hence the use of informal ep¬
ithets.
Ameletus falsus McDunnough
Ameletus falsus McDunnough 1938:30.
This species was described from a male imago collected in Arizona.
Type locality. — Greer, Arizona.
Type deposition. — No. 4293, Canadian National Collection, Ottawa, On¬
tario.
Distribution. — This species is known only from the type locality.
Remarks. — It is probable that one of the unnamed nymphs described be¬
low will eventually be found to be the immature stage of this species. All
three nymphs have been collected near the type locality of A. falsus.
450
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Ameletus velox Dodds
Ameletus velox Dodds 1923:105; Dodds and Hisaw 1924:139; Needham and
Christenson 1927:11; Seemann 1927:47, McDunnough 1928:9; Mc-
Dunnough 1929:174; McDunnough 1934:163; Traver 1935:459; Edmunds
1954:64.
Dodds (1923) described this species from adults and nymphs collected in
Colorado. Seemann (1927) reported specimens from southern California,
and Needham and Christenson (1927) collected it in Utah. McDunnough
(1928) reported it from Alberta, and Edmunds (1954) reported additional
specimens from Utah. The nymphal stage is redescribed below.
Nymph. — Length: body 12.0-13.0 mm; caudal filaments 6.0-7. 0 mm.
General color brown with dark brown markings. Head dark brown, light
brown at sutures. Thoracic nota brown with light brown markings; prono-
tum brown, with light brown midline and sublateral markings; pronotum
dark brown anteriorly; mesonotum brown with light brown midline, dark
brown anteromedian triangular-shaped macula, and light brown posterior
and sublateral markings; metanotum brown with light brown midline; tho¬
racic sterna pale; legs brown. Abdominal terga brown to dark brown with
light brown sublateral maculae on terga 1-2; terga 3-8 brown with light
brown median diamond-shaped and sublateral markings on each tergum;
tergum 9 dark brown with elongate median light brown macula; tergum 10
light brown; abdominal terga with smoky web-like tracheations ; abdominal
gills pale with numerous dark tracheations; gills 1-7 with subdorsal band
one-third from dorsal margin; gills with distinct band on ventral margin;
ventral margin gill 4 with 8-9 spines (Fig. 1); abdominal sterna brown, pos¬
terior sterna darker; sterna 4-8 with dark brown median macula. Caudal
filaments dark brown, light brown basally, without distinct transverse band
(Fig. 5).
Remarks. — The numph of A. velox can be distinguished from all others
by the following combination of characters: (1) abdominal gills with distinct
dorsal and ventral bands; (2) gills with numerous, dark tracheations (Fig.
1); (3) caudal filaments without a wide transverse band (Fig. 5); (4) ventral
margin of gill 4 with 8-9 spines (Fig. 1); (5) abdominal terga with numerous
smoky web-like tracheations; and (6) abdominal sterna 4-8 with a median
brown macula.
Type locality. — Tolland, Colorado.
Type deposition. — Unknown.
Distribution. — This species has been reported previously from Colorado,
Utah, Alberta, and southern California, and this study extends the known
range into southern Arizona.
New records. — ARIZONA: Apache Co. Stream at Greer, 27-VI-66,
451
;s. 1-4. Nymphs
B”; Fig. 4. Arm
6. Ameletus sp
B”; Fig. 8. Ame
sp. “A”; Fig. 3
I filaments. Fig. 5
•rsal view. Fig. 7
452
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
RKA. Graham Co. Moonshine Cr. on Hwy. 366, Pinaleno Mtns., 20- VII-
70, RKA; Wet Cr., Wet Cr. Canyon Camp, Pinaleno Mtns., 20-VII-70,
RKA.
Biology. — Nymphs were collected during June and July from streams be¬
tween 5900-8500 feet elevation, and with a water temperature range be¬
tween 58°-66°F.
Ameletus sp. “A”
Nymph. — Length: body 12.0-13.0 mm; caudal filaments 5. 0-6.0 mm.
General color brown to dark brown with light brown markings. Head dark
brown, light brown at sutures. Thoracic nota brown with light brown mark¬
ings; pronotum brown with light brown midline and sublateral markings;
mesonotum brown with light brown midline, submedian and sublateral
markings; legs brown. Abdominal terga brown with light brown markings;
terga 1-3 with light brown median oval-shaped macula; terga 4-5 brown;
terga 6-7 with light brown diamond-shaped macula; terga 8-10 with light
brown elongate macula; terga with paired submedian light brown spots;
abdominal terga with few smoky web-like tracheations; abdominal gills with
wide ventral band (Fig. 2); ventral margin gill 4 with 15-16 spines (Fig. 2);
abdominal sterna pale, sterna 3-8 with purplish median macula. Caudal
filaments pale with distinct dark brown transverse band (Fig. 6).
Remarks. — Ameletus sp. “A” nymph can be distinguished from all others
by the following combination of characters; (1) abdominal gills with distinct
subdorsal and ventral bands (Fig. 2); (2) gills with numerous dark trachea¬
tions; (3) caudal filaments with distinct wide, dark, transverse band (Fig. 6);
(4) ventral margin gill 4 with 15-16 spines (Fig. 2); (5) abdominal terga with
sparse smoky web-like tracheations; and (6) abdominal sterna 3-8 with me¬
dian purplish macula.
Distribution. — This species is known only from Arizona.
Records. — ARIZONA: Apache Co. Stream at Greer, 27-VI-66, RKA.
Graham Co. Grant Cr. on Hwy. 366, Pinaleno Mtns., 20-VII-70, RKA; Wet
Cr., Wet Cr. Canyon Camp, Pinaleno Mtns., 20-VII-70, RKA.
Biology. — Nymphs were collected during the months of June and July
from streams between 5900-8500 feet elevation, and in water with a tem¬
perature range between 56°-66°F.
Ameletus sp. “B”
Nymph. — Length: body 10.0-11.0 mm; caudal filaments 3. 0^1.0 mm.
General color brown with light brown markings. Head brown, light brown
at sutures. Thoracic nota brown with indistinct light brown markings; legs
brown. Abdominal terga brown; terga 2-8 with light brown median diamond¬
shaped macula; terga 1-9 with paired light brown sublateral markings (Fig.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
453
7); tergum 10 light brown; abdominal gills with faint ventral band; ventral
margin gill 4 with 14-15 spines (Fig. 3); gills with pale tracheations; abdom¬
inal sterna 2-8 brown with paired light brown sublateral markings. Caudal
filaments pale with distinct wide, dark, transverse band.
Remarks . — Ameletus sp. “B” can be distinguished from all others by the
following combination of characters: (1) abdominal gills with a faint ventral
band; (2) gills with sparse, pale tracheations; (3) ventral margin of gill 4 with
14-15 spines (Fig. 3); (4) caudal filaments with a distinct, wide, dark trans¬
verse band; abdominal terga without smoky web-like tracheations (Fig. 7).
Distribution. — This species is known only from New Mexico.
Record. — NEW MEXICO: Rio Arriba Co. Canjilon Cr. on Hwy. 110,
Carson Nat. For., 29- VI-64, RKA.
Biology. — Nymphs were collected during June from a stream with a water
temperature of 66°F.
Ameletus sp. “C”
Nymph. — Length: body 10.0-11.0 mm; caudal filaments 3. 0-4.0 mm.
General color brown to dark brown with pale markings. Head dark brown,
pale at sutures. Thoracic nota pale with brown markings; pronotum pale
with pale midline, dark brown sublateral markings, and dark brown at an¬
terior margin; mesonotum brown with pale midline, submedian, and sub¬
lateral markings; metanotum brown with pale midline; thoracic sterna pale;
legs pale with brown markings. Abdominal tergum 1 brown with paired pale
sublateral spots; tergum 2 pale with paired, brown, submedian, oblique
markings and brown posterolateral markings; terga 3-6 brown with median
pale elongate to diamond-shaped macula and paired pale sublateral and sub¬
median markings; tergum 7 pale with paired brown submedian markings;
terga 8-10 brown with pale median markings; tergum 10 usually pale, often
with submedian macula (Fig. 8); abdominal gills pale with sparse, pale tra¬
cheations; gills with subdorsal band, without ventral band (Fig. 4); ventral
margin gill 4 with 11-12 spines; abdominal sterna pale with paired brown
anterolateral spots; sterna 7-9 or 8-9 with paired brown, sublateral bands,
sternum 9 often with brown inverted U-shaped macula. Caudal filaments
pale with distinct, wide, dark brown transverse band.
Remarks. — Ameletus sp. “C” can be distinguished from all other nymphs
by the following combination of characters: (1) abdominal gills with a sub¬
dorsal band only; (2) gills with sparse, pale tracheations; (3) ventral margin
gill 4 with 1 1—12 spines (Fig. 4); (4) caudal filaments with a distinct wide,
dark transverse band; and (5) abdominal terga without smoky web-like tra¬
cheations (Fig. 8).
Distribution. — This species is known only from Arizona.
Records. — ARIZONA: Apache Co. E. Fk. Little Colorado Riv., E. Fk.
454
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Campground, Apache Nat. For., 3-VII-64, RKA; Stream at Greer, 27-VII-
66, RKA.
Biology. — Nymphs were collected during June and July from streams be¬
tween 8500-8700 feet elevation with a water temperature range between
62°-66°F.
Genus Siphlonurus Eaton
Siphlonurus is composed of 17 North American species, five of which are
found in western North America. The distributional range in western North
America is from southern Arizona (31°70' north latitude) in the MIDDLE
NORTH TEMPERATE ZONE to central Alberta (53°3F north latitude) in
the UPPER NORTH TEMPERATE ZONE. In eastern North America the
range is from northern Georgia (33°29' north latitude) in the MIDDLE
NORTH TEMPERATE ZONE to northern Ontario (52°15' north latitude)
in the UPPER NORTH TEMPERATE ZONE. Siphlonurus occidentalis
Eaton, 1885, is the only species in the genus known from the Southwest.
Siphlonurus occidentalis Eaton
Heptagenia brunnea (in part) Hagen 1875:581.
Siphlurus occidentalis Eaton 1885:218 ( =H . brunnea, in part); Dodds
1923:104; Dodds and Hisaw 1924:138.
Siphlonurus occidentalis, Clemens 1915:248; Ulmer 1920:135; Needham and
Christenson 1927:12; McDunnough 1928:9; Traver 1935:473; Spieth
1941:92; Edmunds 1954:64; Allen and Edmunds 1956:85; Edmunds
1960:73; Edmunds and Musser 1960:114; Peters and Edmunds 1961:108;
Argyle and Edmunds 1962:181; Edmunds 1962: vii ( =inflatus ).
Siphlurella occidentalis, Bengtsson 1930:10.
Siphlonurus inflatus McDunnough 1931:90; Traver 1935:470.
Hagen (1875) proposed the name Heptagenia brunnea based on a male
and a female imago from California. Eaton (1885) examined the type material
and discovered that the female imago represented a separate species and
named it Siphlurus occidentalis. Needham and Christenson (1927) reported
specimens from Utah, and McDunnough (1928) reported it from Alberta.
Bengtsson (1930) discussed the species under the name Siphlurella occi¬
dentalis. McDunnough (1931) described S. inflatus from Alberta and British
Columbia, and Edmunds (1962) synonymized it with S. occidentalis. Traver
(1935) published records from Montana, Washington, Utah, Colorado, Wy¬
oming, Oregon, and New Mexico. Edmunds (1954) reported the species
from Utah, and Allen and Edmunds (1956) collected it in Oregon. Edmunds
and Musser (1960) cited records from Wyoming and Utah, Peters and Ed¬
munds (1961) from New Mexico, and Argyle and Edmunds (1962) from
Colorado.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
455
Spieth (1941) stated that Eaton, in 1885, had other individuals from Wash¬
ington, Nevada, and “Mt. Hood,” he designated a Colorado male imago as
the lectotype, and labeled all the other specimens, except the “Mt. Hood”
females, as syntypes.
Type locality. — “Colorado.”
Type deposition. — McLachlan Museum, British Museum (Natural His¬
tory), London.
Distribution. — Siphlonurus occidentals is widely distributed in western
North America and it is known from every western state in the United
States and British Columbia and Alberta in Canada.
New records. — ARIZONA: Apache Co. N. Fk. White Riv., Hawley Lake
Rd., 27-VI-66, RKA; Stream at Greer, 27-VI-66, RKA. Coconino Co. Pond
ca. 8 mi. S. Flagstaff. Cochise Co. Herb Martyr Lake, Chiricahua Mtns.,
28- VI-66, RKA; E. Fk. Turkey Cr., Chiricahua Mtns. 28- VI-66, RKA.
Biology. — Nymphs were collected during June and July from streams and
ponds between 5530-8500 feet elevation and a water temperature between
64°-66°F.
Literature Cited
Allen, R. K., and G. F. Edmunds, Jr. 1956. A list of the mayflies of Oregon. Proc. Utah Acad.
Sci., Arts, Letters, 33:85-87.
Argyle, D. W., and G. F. Edmunds, Jr. 1962. Mayflies (Ephemeroptera) of the Curecanti
Reservoir Basins. Univ. Utah Anthro. Pap., 59:179-189.
Bengtsson, S. 1930. Kritische Bemerkungen iiber einige nordische Ephemeriden, nebst bes-
chreibung neuer larven. Lunds Univ. Arssk. N. F. Afd. 2, Bd., 26:1-27.
Clemens, W. A. 1915. Mayflies of the Siphlonurus group. Canad. Ent., 47:245-260.
Dodds, G. S. 1923. Mayflies from Colorado, descriptions of certain species and notes on
others. Trans. Amer. Ent. Soc., 49:93-114.
Dodds, G. S., and F. L. Hisaw. 1924. Ecological studies of aquatic insects, I. Adaptations of
mayfly nymphs to swift streams. Ecology, 5:137-148.
Eaton, A. E. 1885. A revisional monograph of recent Ephemeridae or mayflies. Trans. Linn.
Soc. London, Sec. Ser. Zool., 3:1-353.
Edmunds, G. F., Jr. 1954. The mayflies of Utah. Proc. Utah Acad. Sci., Arts, Letters, 31:64-
66.
Edmunds, G. F., Jr. 1960. The food habits of the nymph of the mayfly Siphlonurus occiden¬
tals . Proc. Utah Acad. Sci., Arts, Letters, 37:73-74.
Edmunds, G. F., Jr. 1962. The type localities of the Ephemeroptera of North America north
of Mexico. Univ. Utah Biol. Ser., 12:i— viii, 1-39.
Edmunds, G. F., Jr., and G. G. Musser. 1960. The mayfly fauna of Green River in the Flaming
Gorge Reservoir Basin, Wyoming and Utah. Univ. Utah Anthro. Pap. 48, Upper Colo.
Ser., 3:112-123.
Hagen, H. A. 1875. Report on the Pseudo-Neuroptera and Neuroptera collected by Lieut. W.
L. Carpenter in 1873, in Colorado. Ann. Rep. U.S. Geol. and Geog. Surv. Terr., 1873,
Pt. 3, Zool., 571-606.
McDunnough, J. 1928. The Ephemeroptera of Jasper Park, Alberta. Canad. Ent., 60:8-10.
McDunnough, J. 1929. Notes on North American Ephemeroptera with descriptions of new
species, 11. Canad. Ent., 61:169-180.
456
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
McDunnough, J. 1931. New species of North American Ephemeroptera. Canad. Ent., 63:82—
93.
McDunnough, J. 1934. New species of North American Ephemeroptera, IV. Canad. Ent.,
66:154-164, 181-188.
McDunnough J. 1938. New species of North American Ephemeroptera with critical notes.
Canad. Ent., 70:23-34.
Needham, J. G., and R. O. Christenson. 1927. Economic insects in some streams of northern
Utah. Utah Agri. Exp. Sta. Bull., 201:1-36.
Peters, W. L., and G. F. Edmunds, Jr. 1961. The mayflies (Ephemeroptera) of the Navajo
Reservoir Basin, New Mexico and Colorado. Univ. Utah Anthro. Pap. 55, Upper Colo.
Ser., 5:107-111.
Seemann, T. M. 1927. Dragonflies, mayflies and stoneflies of southern California. Jour. Ent.
Zool., 19:40-51.
Spieth, H. T. 1941. The North American Ephemeropteran types of the Rev. A. E. Eaton.
Ann. Ent. Soc. Amer., 34:87-98.
Traver, J. R. 1935. Systematic, Part II, pp. 237-739. In: J. G. Needham, J. R. Traver & Y.-
C. Hsu. The Biology of Mayflies. Comstock Publ. Co., Ithaca, N.Y., pp. 1-739.
Ulmer, G. 1920. Ubersicht iiber die Gattungen der Ephemeropteren nebst Bermerkungen iiber
einzelne Arten. Steit. Ent. Zeit., 81:97-144.
Footnotes
1 22021 Jonesport Lane, Huntington Beach, California 92646.
2 1420 Lightview Avenue, Monterey Park, California 91754.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 457-460
A NEW SPECIES OF AMMOPHILA FROM NORTH AMERICA
(HYMENOPTERA: SPHECIDAE)
Dale M. Kirkbride1
Department of Entomology, University of Idaho, Moscow 83843
A recent study of the subfamily Sphecinae has revealed the presence of
a new species in the genus Ammophila W. Kirby from the coniferous wood¬
land areas of the western United States. The name for this new species is
being proposed to make it available for use in a forthcoming faunistic work
on the sphecine wasps of Idaho.
Ammophila silvestris Kirkbride, new species
Holotype male. — Length 17 mm.
Color. — Black; tegula brown, red posteriorly; petiole tergum and gastral
terga I and II red laterally, gastral sterna I and II entirely red; wing veins
dark brown.
Vestiture. — Head with erect white hairs; mesopleura with faintly indicat¬
ed band of appressed silver hairs ventrally along mesopleural suture (Fig.
1); metapleura with evenly distributed appressed silver hairs in area below
transmetapleural line, and without such hairs in area above transmetapleural
line; propodeal enclosure without erect hairs, but with sparsely placed ap¬
pressed hairs.
Structure. — Clypeus with free margin arcuate, moderately emarginate
medially; pronotal collar rounded longitudinally, smooth; scutum slightly
rugose, with weakly developed irregular transverse ridges; epistemal sulcus
long; metapleural flange not lamellate (Fig. 2); propodeal enclosure with
closely spaced transverse ridges laterally, interspaces smooth; penis valve
with long basal spine.
Allotype female . — Length 18 mm.
Color. — Black; tegula dark brown, red posteriorly; petiole tergum and
gastral tergum and sternum I entirely red, tergum II red laterally; wing veins
dark brown.
Vestiture. — Similar to holotype.
Structure. — Clypeus with disc moderately bulging, median free margin
vaguely distinct, bounded laterally by a tooth; scutum with weakly devel¬
oped, irregular transverse ridges; pronotal collar, episternal sulcus, meta¬
pleural flange, and propodeal enclosure similar to holotype.
Types. — Holotype from: 21 mi. W. Lolo Pass, Idaho Co., Idaho, VII-28-
458
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 1-3. Ammophila silvestris Kirkbride, new species. Fig. 1. Male, lateral view. Fig. 2.
Metapleural flange. Fig. 3. Female abdomen, lateral view.
1976, D. M. Kirkbride. Allotype from: 0.2 mi. S. Plummer, Benewah Co.,
Idaho, VIM 6-1976, D. M. Kirkbride.
Paratypes (33 males and 23 females) from the following localities: IDA¬
HO: BEAR LAKE CO., 1 mi. N. Emigration Campgmd., VIII-4-1976, D.
M. Kirkbride. BLAINE CO., 15 mi. NW. Ketchum, VII-22-1961, A. R.
Gittins. BONNER CO., 2 mi. SW. Granite, VII-21-1977, D. M. Kirkbride;
Granite Lk., VII-4-1977, D. M. Kirkbride. BOUNDARY CO., 0.5 mi. W.
MacArthur Reservoir, VIII-31-1976, D. M. Kirkbride. CAMAS CO., 13.3
mi. N. Fairfield, VI-18-1966, A. R. Gittins. CARIBOU CO., 1 mi. N. Gravel
Crk. Campgrnd. , VII-1-1976, D. M. Kirkbride. CLEARWATER CO., Elk
River, VII-9-1962, A. R. Gittins; 3.5 mi. upstrm. frm. Washington Crk., N.
Fork Clearwater Riv., VII-1 1-1977, D. M. Kirkbride; Skull Crk., N. Fork
Clearwater Riv., VII-1 1-1977, D. M. Kirkbride; Elk River Reservoir, VII-
9-1963, G. B. Hewitt. CUSTER CO., Redfish Lk., VII-21-1964, A. R. Git¬
tins; 3 mi. E. Trail Crk. Summit, Pioneer Mts., VIII- 17- 1977, D. M. Kirk¬
bride; Bonanza, VII-22-1965, W. F. Barr. FRANKLIN CO., 1 mi. SW.
Emigration Campgrnd., VIII-2-1976, D. M. Kirkbride; 1.6 mi. SW. Emigra¬
tion Campgrnd., VIU-2-1976, D. M. Kirkbride. IDAHO CO., 21 mi. W.
Lolo Pass, VII-28-1976, D. M. Kirkbride; 25 mi. E. Lowell, VII-19-1964,
A. R. Gittins. KOOTENAI CO., Cottonwood Crk., VII-21-1976, D. M.
Kirkbride; Lane, VI-27-1962, A. R. Gittins. LATAH CO., Moscow, VII-20-
1928. LEMHI CO., Meadow Lk., VIII-15-1977, D. M. Kirkbride. SHO¬
SHONE CO., 7 mi. E. Clarkia, VII-18-1962, A. R. Gittins; Freeze Out Hill,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
459
Figs. 4-6. Ammophila azteca Cameron. Fig. 4. Male, lateral view. Fig. 5. Metapleural
flange. Fig. 6. Female abdomen, lateral view.
VII- 18- 1962, A. R. Gittins; 8 mi. N. Avery, VII-20-1969, D. S. Horning; 5
mi. W. Avery, VII-13-1958, A. R. Gittins; Roundtop, St. Joe Nat. For.,
VII- 7-1960, A. R. Gittins; Wallace, VI-27-1918, O. Huelleman. TETON
CO., 3.4 mi. SE. Victor, VIII-7-1976, D. M. Kirkbride; 3.2 mi. SE. Victor,
VIII- 6-1976, D. M. Kirkbride; 2.9 mi. SE. Victor, VIII-6-1976, D. M. Kirk¬
bride. VALLEY CO., Boulder Mt., VIII-21 -1952, S. E. Knapp; Yellow
Pine, VIII-22-1955, H. C. Manis. MONTANA: MISSOULA CO., Lolo Hot
Sprgs., VII- 19- 1963, W. F. Barr. WYOMING: TETON CO., Teton Cyn.,
West Side, Teton Range, VII-19-1964, R. L. Westcott. Holotype, allotype,
and paratypes are deposited in the collection at the University of Idaho,
Moscow.
Discussion. — An examination of the paratypes listed above has shown
that gastral segment II is sometimes entirely black in males, while in fe¬
males, the sternum of this segment may infrequently be entirely red. Fur¬
thermore, in both sexes, the band of appressed silver hairs along the me-
sopleural suture is not always visible, and the metapleural flange is rarely
narrowly lamellate.
An initial examination of specimens in the U.S. National Museum of
Natural History, and consultation with A. S. Menke clearly placed Am¬
mophila silvestris in the complex of species associated with Ammophila
azteca Cameron. The specific status of silvestris was subsequently deter¬
mined by an examination of types, paratypes, and descriptions of the species
in this complex.
460
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Ammophila silvestris is most similar to Ammophila azteca Cameron, to
which it is probably very closely related. In fact, in the revision of the North
American Ammophila by Menke (1965), silvestris keys out to azteca. The
absence of erect hairs on the propodeal enclosure of silvestris, along with
the generally non-lamellate condition of the metapleural flange (Fig. 2) will
usually, however, distinguish it from azteca, which has erect hairs on the
propodeal enclosure and a broadly lamellate metapleural flange (Fig. 5). In
addition, the band of appressed silver hairs along the mesopleural suture is
either absent or only faintly visible on silvestris (Fig. 1), but is usually
distinct on azteca (Fig. 4). These two species can also be separated by
differences in gastral coloration. Males of silvestris usually have the first
and second gastral terga red laterally and black dorsally, while in males of
azteca these terga are usually entirely red. Females of silvestris, on the
other hand, generally have the second gastral tergum black dorsally, where¬
as in azteca females this tergum is entirely red.
Habitat preferences are different between these two species. While sil¬
vestris has only been collected from habitats associated with coniferous
forests, azteca is abundant in both the coniferous forest and desert habitats
alike. The possible sympatric occurrence of these two species in forested
areas has been verified by collections made from a number of localities in
Idaho. Although the similarity in gross anatomy might imply that silvestris
is simply a subspecies of azteca, their sympatric occurrence in forested
areas indicates that these are in fact separate species.
Acknowledgments
My thanks to Dr. C. D. Johnson of Northern Arizona University for his
advice in the preparation of this description.
Literature Cited
Menke, A. S. 1965. A revision of the North American Ammophila (Hymenoptera: Sphecidae).
University Microfilms, Ann Arbor, Michigan, 247 pp.
Footnote
1 Current address: School of Forestry, Northern Arizona University, Flagstaff 86011.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 461-484
PLEOCOMA SPP. IN WESTERN OREGON CONIFEROUS FORESTS:
OBSERVATIONS ON ADULT FLIGHT HABITS AND ON EGG
AND LARVAL BIOLOGY1 (COLEOPTERA: SCARAB AEIDAE)
David G. Fellin
Intermountain Forest and Range Experiment Station, Forest Service,
U.S. Department of Agriculture , Ogden, Utah 84401,
Forestry Sciences Laboratory, Missoula, Montana 59801
In the early 1960’s, I studied the feeding habits of Pleocoma larvae in
some old-growth coniferous forests in western Oregon (Fellin, 1975). The
study began shortly after Stein (1963) confirmed that Pleocoma larvae feed
on the roots of forest trees. Five species of Pleocoma were studied — pri¬
marily P. dubitabilis dubitabilis Davis2 (hereafter referred to merely as P.
dubitabilis), P . carinata Linsley, P. simi Davis, and to a lesser extent P.
minor Linsley, and P. crinita Linsley.
Incidental to that study, other studies were conducted and/or observations
made on the biology, ecology, behavior, and distribution of Oregon Pleo¬
coma spp. Many new localities were recorded and described. Based on
these and other locality descriptions, the geographic distribution of all
species of Pleocoma in Oregon was summarized and the habitats for P.
simi and P. carinata were described (Fellin and Ritcher, 1967). Observa¬
tions also were made on trapping male Pleocoma with female-baited traps
(Fellin, 1968). Results of studies on the movement and distribution of Pleo¬
coma larvae will be presented elsewhere.
Adult Flight
Since the earliest published record on the flight habits of Pleocoma males
(Ricksecker 1887, 1888), entomologists have observed the flight habits of
many species of Pleocoma, oftentimes incidental to collecting specimens
for taxonomic study. Many observations have been made of environmental
conditions or circumstances existing during male flight, especially with the
species occurring in California.
These observations frequently have been interpreted as reflecting patterns
of behavior of a particular species associated with a particular environmen¬
tal condition, when, in fact, they may have been merely artifacts of col¬
lecting. For example, under certain circumstances, individual males or
groups of males of some species may behave in a particular manner, while
under another set of circumstances, they might behave altogether differ-
462
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
ently. One entomologist, who has observed and collected all known (and
some “unknown”) species and subspecies in California has concluded, in
concert with two of his colleagues, that, . thus far, the only real piece
of information to emerge is that Pleocoma males will fly (or can fly but
might not) at any time of day, during every conceivable climatic condition
(appropriate to the season), and will exhibit nearly every form of behavior
physically feasible in the process.” (F. T. Hovore, personal communica¬
tion.)
Concerning the Oregon species, Ellertson and Ritcher (1959) observed
the flights of P. crinita, P. minor, and P. oregonensis Leach, and Ritcher
and Beer (1956) published a few notes on the adult activity of P. dubitabilis.
Nothing has been published until now concerning the flight of the two south¬
western Oregon species, P. simi and P. carinata. The only known reference
to P. carinata flight is a statement of Linsley’s (1941) that three P. carinata
“were captured in a rainstorm.”
The observations presented in this paper on the flights and the factors
associated with flights of some Oregon species, are not to be interpreted as
an indication of a species-specific response to some environmental condi¬
tion. Rather, they are presented merely to document the conditions that
existed while I or others observed flights of P. dubitabilis, P. simi or P.
carinata.
Flight Habits
Description of flight. — The most detailed observation of the flight of an
Oregon species was made 11 October 1960 on the Umpqua National Forest,
about 28 km northwest of Union Creek in Douglas County, at an elevation
of approximately 850 m. W. I. Stein (personal communication) describes
the flight of a series of P. simi as follows:
“Beetles were flying in the timber at the same time as in the open. When
flights were at a maximum, several beetles could be seen at once within
sight in any direction. Flights were both low among the weeds and over
head high, or a combination thereof. Some beetles circled, others flew in
relatively straight flights either up or down hill. Beetles did not fly too
fast, but it took a good trot to keep up with them when they made straight
flights.”
Many species of Pleocoma males differ greatly in their flight behavior
(Davis, 1934a); this variability in flight behavior is often explained by wheth¬
er males are “tracking” a pheromone or merely “dispersing,” not yet hav¬
ing picked up the female scent (F. T. Hovore, personal communication).
Males of P. hirsuta have been observed to fly stronger, swifter, or more
“purposefully” when (a) disturbed or frightened by collectors or predators
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
463
Table 1. Date, time of day and weather conditions for flights of Pleocoma dubitabilis, P.
simi, and P. carinata in western Oregon coniferous forests in 1960 and 1961. 1
464
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 1. Continued.
1 All flights of Pleocoma dubitabilis were observed by the author in a Douglas-fir stand at
McDonald Forest, 8 km north of Corvallis, Oregon, Benton County. Flights of Pleocoma simi
and Pleocoma carinata were seen by various people in mixed coniferous forests primarily on
the Umpqua and Rogue River National Forests in Douglas, Jackson, and Josephine Counties
in southwestern Oregon.
2 The subjectivity of such terms as “drizzle, light rain, drizzling, rain” etc., is recognized.
Although each can mean different intensities of precipitation to different people, the terms are
presented in the words of the individuals making the observations.
and (b) near the end of a given activity period (F. T. Hovore, personal
communication) .
Time of day of flight. — Males of P. dubitabilis, P. simi, and P. carinata
were observed flying from predawn until late afternoon and early evening
(Table 1). The earliest flights observed were those of P. simi at 0300 14
October 1960 and P. carinata, IV2 hours before daylight 15 October 1960.
The latest flights were about 1745-1800 11 October 1960 and 14 October
1961 for P. carinata and P. simi, respectively. Though the data in Table 1
indicate periods during the day when beetles were observed flying, they do
not preclude the possibilities of flights occurring from late evening until
early morning when observers were not likely to be in the forest.
An unconfirmed, but reliable, report of an adult male Pleocoma ( cari -
natal) captured in flight at 2330 is substantiated by reports that males of
other species of Pleocoma fly at night. In November 1949, males of P.
conjungens were taken almost continually from 2200 to 0600 hrs, during a
steady light rain and a nearly full moon (Hazeltine, 1950). Pleocoma fim-
briata males are reported to fly at dusk (Hopping, 1920), and P. marquai
males will fly throughout the night while rain or snow is falling and at dusk
for several days thereafter (Hovore, 1972). F. T. Hovore (personal com¬
munication) also reports that an increase in rain intensity initiated small
flights of P. conjungens lucia and P. blaisdelli at 2330 and 0200 hrs., re¬
spectively.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
465
Time of year of flight. — In 1960 and 1961, males of all three species, P.
dubitahilis, P. carinata, and P. simi, flew for the first time on 11-12 Oc¬
tober. The last P. dubitabilis flight was observed on 19 November 1960 and
most major flights of P. simi and P. carinata were last observed between
17-20 November. However, some P. carinata males were still flying as late
as 1 and 16 December 1960 and a P. simi flight was reported by Bureau of
Land Management foresters near Myrtle Creek in Douglas County on 13
December 1961.
As far as P. dubitabilis is concerned, observations presented in Table 1
generally support earlier ones. In 1954, Ritcher and Beer (1956) report P.
dubitabilis began flying on 16 October (at Forest Grove) and continued,
when conditions were favorable, through the second week in November. In
1955, males first flew on 3 October (at McMinnville). That year, at the
McDonald Forest study area, flight began shortly before 8 October and
continued until 4 November (Ritcher and Beer, 1956).
The peak of male activity for P. oregonensis occurs in October and No¬
vember (Ellertson, 1956).
Other species of Pleocoma are known to fly late into the winter. Pleo-
coma crinita is reported to have sporadic flights as late as March (Ellertson
and Ritcher, 1959). Pleocoma hoppingi males have been collected in flight
as late as 5 February (Linsley, 1941) and 16 March (F. T. Hovore, personal
communication) in Yosemite National Park in California. Flight of P. mar-
quai males usually begins in early October and can continue until early
December in years of relatively low rainfall (Hovore, 1972). Two males of
this species were taken in flight on 6 January 1979 (F. T. Hovore, personal
communication). Specimens of P. rubiginosa Hovore have been collected
in blacklight traps from January to April, and P. reflexa males are known
to fly from late November to mid- January (Hovore, 1972).
I have an additional unconfirmed report of Pleocoma males flying as early
as late August. On 8 November 1961, 1 received a letter from Gordon Walker
(personal communication) describing several collections he had made of
Pleocoma males that fall. The letter read, in part, as follows:
“Also around the week of the 24th of August, I caught one about 11:30
one night while on a fire in the Neil Creek area. The exact location is
T40S, R1E, SEl^NE^ section 12. 1 didn’t have any place to put the thing
so I took the head off a flashlight and put it in behind the reflector. It
would have worked fine, but I put the flashlight with several others and
couldn’t locate it after that.’’
Although I did not see the specimen for positive identification (which could
make this record somewhat suspect), I consider this a reliable report since
Walker had forwarded specimens from several collections to me in the fall
of 1960 and 1961. He reportedly caught the beetle 9 km south-southeast of
466
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Ashland (Jackson County) and a similar distance from the California border,
at a site between the known distributions for P. carinata and P. simi. It
could have been either one of these species or P. shastensis or one of the
other northern California species.
The time of year of flight may also be influenced by certain weather
conditions, particularly fall rains. Hovore (personal communication) indi¬
cates that in the mid- 1970’s when fall rains were late, he observed species
(P. australis, P. marquai, and P. tularensis ), which normally fly from late
September to early November, flying from January to March. The following
year was characterized by unusually early heavy rains, and he took the
same species in flight in mid-September. He concludes that . . under
‘normal’ circumstances, one can safely ‘predict’ the approximate flight sea¬
sons of various species according to their usual levels of responsiveness to
precipitation . . . ,” but in years of very early, very late, or particularly
cold seasons, flight times can often be off as much as 2 or 3 months.
Environmental Factors Associated with Flights
Moisture. — Probably the greatest single factor affecting flight of adult
male Pleocoma is rainfall. As noted by Ellertson and Ritcher (1959), “The
autumn and winter seasons with their rain and saturated atmosphere have
long been associated with flight of Pleocoma males.” However, as Hovore
observed (personal communication), “The actual presence of falling rain
though ‘preferred’ by certain species (such as puncticollis, australis, mar¬
quai) is not entirely necessary.”
The first flights of the year seem to follow general fall rains and subsequent
flights are often, but not always, associated with day to day precipitation.
At a study site at McDonald Forest, 8 km north of Corvallis (Benton County)
the first P. dubitabilis flights were observed in 1960 on 12 October; two
flights were observed, one between 0600-0700 and another between 1400-
1600 hrs. Although 4 cm of rain had fallen at that site between 1 September
and 12 October, these and subsequent flights probably were triggered by the
3.60 cm of rain that fell between 6 and 12 October, as shown below:
Ellertson and Ritcher (1959) note that at least 2.5 cm of rain falls between
1 September and first flights of P. crinita males at Hood River.
Adult males of P. simi and P. carinata flew for the first time in 1960 on
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
467
11 October when flights at five localities were documented by as many
observers on the Umpqua and Rogue River National Forests in Jackson and
Douglas Counties. The distance between the two furthermost observed
flights was about 112 km.
These five flights occurred after the third general rain in western Oregon.
A general rain fell in western Oregon between 1-4 September (U.S. Weather
Bureau, 1960a). The next general rain fell 6 October and lasted for 3 days
(U.S. Weather Bureau, 1960b). On 9 October, rain was scattered and, on
10 October, no rain or a trace was reported. On 11-12 October, a general
rain fell again. Two factors were common to all five flights: (1) each flight
was observed at some period between 1200 hrs. and dark and (2) rain was
falling at the time each flight was observed.
Observations by four individuals who observed and collected P. simi in
flight show how closely — after the first general fall flights — male flights ap¬
pear to be related to precipitation. (1) A collector at a site 29 km northwest
of Union Creek (Douglas County) reported that rain began falling at 1300
2 November 1960 and beetles became abundant locally; none had been seen
earlier in the day. (2) In October, another collector (D. J. Tandy, personal
communication) reported that, at a site 26 km west- north west of Diamond
Lake (Douglas County), when a sprinkling rain began falling at 1500, beetles
came out and many were in flight almost immediately. (3) On 11 October
1960 a third collector (Jerry Conner, personal communication) working on
the Rogue River National Forest 11 km north of Prospect (Jackson County)
reported that a few beetles were seen shortly after noon and that the number
increased the longer it rained. (4) The fourth flight was described (W. I.
Stein, personal communication) as follows:
“Arrived at Falls Unit (27 km northwest of Union Creek, Douglas Coun¬
ty) shortly before 12 o’clock (noon, 11 October) weather first was calm,
chilly and overcast with brief interludes of diluted sunshine. Then breeze
came up which made it colder and more uncomfortable. Shortly after
12:30 p.m. overcast became complete rapidly. Some wind developed, and
a few drops of rain started falling. Simultaneously beetle ( P . simi) activity
became evident. The first one was sighted and captured at 12:50 p.m.
Captures averaged nearly one a minute for the next half hour, then flights
waned as did the rain. Within another half hour rain began again but
beetle flights did not increase. Occasional beetle flights were seen until
about 4:00 p.m. when heavy rain began.”
The fall flights of these three Oregon species following the onset of fall
precipitation are similar to those reported for many California species. Adult
males of P. linsleyi, at least at the type locality, appear to begin flight only
after the area has received over 7.5 cm of rain (Hovore, 1971). Hazeltine
468
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
(1952) reported that P. puncticollis males usually fly during the second or
third general rain and that P. fimbriata males begin flying after the first few
soaking rains (Hopping, 1920). Recently, Page and Fisher (1976) caught four
males of P. hirticollis vandykei one day after the second rain of the season
south of San Jose, California. According to Hovore (1972), adult activity of
P. marquai in the vicinity of the type locality begins during or shortly after
the first precipitation of the fall season, usually in early October. Males of
P. reflexa have been collected only after an area has received several cm
of precipitation (Hovore, 1972).
Although the above reports document the close association of beetle
flights with rain, males of some Oregon species have been observed to fly
in clear weather. On 29 October 1960, I observed about Vi dozen P. dubi-
tabilis males flying between 1300-1500. It was a perfectly clear, cloudless
day with air temperature 12°C. In the preceding 2 days, however, more than
2 cm of rain had fallen at that study site. On another clear day, 1 1 November
1960, no beetles were observed flying although rain had fallen all day on the
10th. On 14 October 1960, another collector observed P. sirni males flying
between 0300-0600 in clear weather in a forested area 8 km south of Eugene
in Lane County.
Similarly, many of the California species are also known to fly in clear
weather. A male P. sonomae was observed flying at sunset in clear cool
weather in Marin County, California (Hazeltine, 1952). Smith and Potts
(1945) reported P. hirticollis vandykei flying in late afternoon sunshine.
Rivers (1889) mentions that it is the habit of Pleocoma to travel both by
day and night, in sunshine or rain. Hovore (1971) reports that P . nitida
Linsley does not require immediate precipitation for flight activity. He col¬
lected specimens, “. . . approximately 4 hours after rain had ceased and
under clearing sky conditions.” Hovore (1972) also reports that P. marquai
will fly at dusk (for several days after a rain or snow) during weather con¬
ditions varying from heavy overcast to bright afternoon sunlight. He also
collected a male P. reflexa shortly after dusk following a day of clear cold
weather.
Male adult Pleocoma are also reported to be attracted to pools of water
(Davis, 1934a), small streams and water-filled ditches or puddles (Ellertson,
1958; Linsley, 1957). Light reflected from the surface of the water apparently
attracts the beetles. On 14 October 1961, Frank Wilson (personal commu¬
nication) wrote that he “creamed” 37 P. simi males from the surface of
puddles of water in the center of a clearcut on the Umpqua Forest east of
Idleyld Park. Hovore (personal communication) has taken males of at least
seven species from the surface of puddles, pools, and forebays in California.
Temperature. — I observed flights of P. dubitabilis when temperatures
were as low as 6°C and as high as 15°C. On 5 November 1954, Ritcher and
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
469
Fig. 1. Pleocoma female with some of her eggs showing how they were laid in spiral fashion
as she moved upward through the soil. (The eggs fell from their niches when collected and had
to be replaced for the photograph.) (actual size)
Beer (1956) observed P. dubitabilis males flying when air temperatures were
10.5°C. One P. simi flight was observed in clear weather when the air tem¬
perature was 5°C.
On at least three occasions, adult males of Oregon species have been
collected in areas where forest residue (slash) was being burned or where
natural forest fires were being controlled. On 14 October 1961, P. simi males
were flying in a clearcut area, 35 km east of Idleyld Park, Douglas County,
where burning forest residue was accompanied by considerable smoke. It
was not raining at the time. Later, on 23 October, P. simi males were flying
470
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 2. Portion of vertical core of packed and pulverized soil. Burrows in the soil were
made by second stage Pleocoma dubitabilis larvae moving outward from egg niches. Larvae
were still in the burrows when the core was collected on 12 November 1960 (2x).
in another clearcut area, 14 km northeast of Tiller, Doulgas County, where
slash had recently been burned. During this flight there was heavy shifting
fog with rain. I have already mentioned the adult male reportedly caught by
an individual fighting a forest fire on 24 August 1961. Whether increased air
or soil temperatures during these fires had any relationship to the respective
beetle flights is not known. It is possible that heat produced by the fires
could have stimulated adult male beetles to emerge and fly, particularly if
flights have already occurred and/or if males were in the litter close to the
soil surface.
Egg and Larval Biology
With the exception of the studies of Ellertson (Ellertson and Ritcher,
1959) of P. crinita, P. minor, and P. oregonensis in Hood River and Wasco
County orchards, little ecological information exists or has been published
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
471
concerning the soil-inhabiting stages, particularly for P. simi, P. carinata,
or P. dubitabilis in the coniferous forest environment. My observations,
though fragmentary, on the egg and larval biology for these three species
are presented here.
In the laboratory, all eggs and larvae collected in the field and larvae
developing from eggs laid in the laboratory were reared in small salve tins
lightly packed with sifted soil. The tins were kept in a temperature cabinet
equipped with a fan and heating unit to maintain constant temperature.
Cabinet temperature was periodically adjusted to conform to soil tempera¬
ture 75 cm deep at a study site at McDonald Forest, 8 km north of Corvallis.
Egg Biology
Eggs of P. simi and P. carinata are dull white in color and ellipsoidal in
shape similar to eggs of P. dubitabilis (Ritcher and Beer, 1956), but they do
not have the yellowish tinge characteristic of eggs of P. crinita, P. minor,
and P . oregonensis (Ellertson, 1958).
Manner of deposition. — Other biologists have described how Pleocoma
females deposit their eggs. Eggs are deposited individually beginning at the
bottom of a burrow and moving upward in a spiral fashion within a vertical
core of pulverized soil (Ritcher and Beer, 1956; Ellertson, 1958; Ellertson
and Ritcher, 1959). The process has never been illustrated, however. Figure
1 shows an expired female with a portion of the clutch of eggs she has laid.
The core of soil within which eggs are laid is often so tightly packed that it
can be removed from the ground intact (Fig. 2).
Size of eggs. — All field-collected and laboratory-reared eggs were mea¬
sured to the nearest 0.15 mm with a stereo microscope, one ocular of which
was equipped with a calibrated micrometer. Laboratory-reared eggs of both
P. simi and P. carinata are larger than those of P. dubitabilis, and 1-week-
old P. simi eggs seem to be a bit longer than those of P. carinata, but about
the same width (Table 2).
As with other insects (Counce, 1961), Pleocoma eggs enlarge during de¬
velopment. Eight-week-old eggs of both P. carinata and P. dubitabilis were
both longer and wider than they were when they were 1 week old.
It appears that laboratory-deposited eggs are generally smaller than those
laid under natural conditions in the field. This is due, no doubt, to the
artificial conditions of the laboratory and the periodic handling of the fe¬
males. Ninety field-collected P. dubitabilis eggs of unknown age averaged
5.33 and 4.31 mm in length and width, respectively. These field-collected
eggs are larger than 8- week-old eggs laid in the laboratory (Table 2).
Number of eggs laid. — The total number of eggs deposited by single P.
dubitabilis females in the field and in the laboratory was as follows:
472
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 2. Size of laboratory-reared Pleocoma eggs shortly after oviposition (1 week) and
just before producing larvae (8 weeks).
One week old Eight weeks old
In the laboratory, two P. carinata females laid 34 and 33 eggs, respectively,
and two P. simi females deposited 45 and 42 eggs, respectively. Two P.
oregonensis females deposited 35 and 48 eggs, respectively, in the labora¬
tory (Ellertson, 1956); however, Ellertson (1958) found considerable varia¬
tion in the number of eggs deposited by P. crinita , P. minor, and P. ore¬
gonensis . Ritcher and Beer (1956) found that the total egg capacity of five
P. dubitabilis females was 61, 59, 53, 51, and 33 eggs, respectively.
Depth of oviposition. — Six egg clutches of P. dubitabilis females exhumed
from the soil indicate the depth at which oviposition took place as follows:
Depth of eggs or small larvae3
Uppermost Lowermost
Date observed (cm) (cm)
Three more females collected on 3 1 March and 13 and 14 April at depths of
25, 34.5, and 17.5 cm, respectively, later oviposited in jars in the laboratory.
Whether oviposition would have occurred at the depths at which the females
were collected is unknown. On 23 July 1954, Ritcher and Beer (1956) found
a single P . dubitabilis female that had deposited 50 eggs at a depth between
30 and 49 cm in the soil.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
473
Table 3. Date and depth that dead adult Pleocoma females were collected in the soil in
1960 and 1961.
Dead P. dubitabilis, P. simi, and P. carinata females were often collected
in the soil. These females could have failed to emerge from the pupal cell
and died there, or could have emerged from the pupal cell but died before
reaching the soil surface. More likely, however, these females died after
having spent themselves in oviposition, so the depth at which they were
collected probably represents the depth of the uppermost egg laid. The
date and depths at which these dead females were collected are shown in
Table 3.
Time and rate of oviposition. — Two P. carinata females collected in the
field on 3 January 1961 and two P. simi females collected on 26 May 1961
were removed to the laboratory, placed on packed, sifted soil in Mason jars,
and examined periodically after 30 April. They began laying eggs soon after
30 May and continued until about 21 June. Between 14 and 21 June, the two
P. simi females laid 4.6 and 4.7 eggs per day, respectively, and the two P.
carinata females laid 3.3 and 4.7 eggs per day, respectively.
474
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 4. Earliest and latest dates at which larvae hatch from eggs, for the Oregon species
of Pleocoma.1
1 Data for P. crinita, P. minor, and P. oregonensis from Ellertson (1956) and Ellertson and
Ritcher (1959).
Three P. dubitabilis females began ovipositing in the laboratory just prior
to 9 June 1961 and the last eggs were laid between 26 June and 2 July. From
10 to 25 June, these P. dubitabilis females laid an average of 1.3 eggs per
day per female, considerably less than the number observed for P. carinata
and P. sirni. In 1955, Ritcher and Beer (1956) observed P. dubitabilis fe¬
males laying eggs in late May and still in the process on 18 June.
Most adult females die shortly after depositing their last egg. Six females
(two each of P. dubitabilis , P. simi, and P. carinata ) deposited their last
eggs between 21 June and 2 July in 1961 and died between 2 and 9 days
later; however, a third P. dubitabilis female lived for 45 days after laying
her last egg.
Duration of egg stage. — Laboratory-reared P. dubitabilis, P. simi, and
P. carinata remained in the egg stage for 91, 89, and 81 days, respectively.
This compares to 69 and 62 days in the egg stage for P. crinita and P. minor
(Ellertson and Ritcher, 1959).
Larval Biology
Hatching from eggs. — Larvae of the three species studied began hatching
from eggs in late August and continued until late September. For compar¬
ative purposes, the earliest and latest dates of larval hatch are presented in
Table 4 for all six Oregon species of Pleocoma. From the table, it appears
that: (1) larvae of P. crinita, P. minor, and P. oregonensis begin hatching
more than a month before the other three species; (2) P. minor and P.
oregonensis larvae complete hatching earlier than the other four species;
(3) the length of time between earliest and latest larval hatch is considerably
less for P. dubitabilis , P. simi, and P. carinata than for the other three
species.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
475
Ritcher and Beer (1956) reported field-collected P. dubitabilis eggs pro¬
duced larvae between 28 August and 8 September in 1954 and between 1
and 24 September in 1955.
Moulting. — In the soil, Pleocoma larvae prepare a cell in which to moult.
The cell is usually cylindrical, rounded on the ends, and often horizontally
oriented; if sloped at all, larvae usually lie with their heads at the upper end.
Larvae almost always lie on their dorsa while moulting, often assuming this
position a day or two before the moult and remaining on their dorsa for as
long as 2 days afterwards.
First stage Pleocoma larvae moult about 1 month after hatching. Twenty-
three first instar P. carinata, hatched in the laboratory from eggs deposited
by two field-collected females, moulted for the first time between 5 and 12
October, approximately 33.5 days after hatching. Seventy first-instar P.
dubitabilis (35 hatching from field-deposited eggs and 35 from laboratory-
deposited eggs) moulted approximately 31 days after hatching. Larvae from
field-collected eggs moulted between 21 September and 20 October, while
those from laboratory-deposited eggs moulted between 30 September and
17 October.
Other than first instars, P . dubitabilis usually moult annually shortly be¬
fore first instars leave the eggs. Of 55 P. dubitabilis larvae, field-collected
between 24 July and 22 August 1961, the first moulted on 19 August and the
last on 25 September. Eighty-four percent moulted between 26 August and
17 September.
Younger larvae seem to be the first to moult. Of 16 larvae that moulted
prior to 1 September, 94 percent were fifth instars or younger and 69 percent
were fourth instars or younger.
Some Pleocoma larvae, particularly first instars and those beyond their
seventh year, may not moult each year. Out of 60 P. dubitabilis larvae
collected between 24 July and 22 August 1961, 14 (23 percent) did not moult
between the time they were collected and the time observations were dis¬
continued in the laboratory on 15 October. All but one of these nonmoulting
larvae were seventh instars or older, and all were males. First instar P.
dubitabilis and P. carinata were observed daily from eclosion until 30 Oc¬
tober and 6 November, 10 and 25 days, respectively, after the last larva of
each species moulted. Of 80 first instar P. dubitabilis reared in the labora¬
tory, five, or 6.3 percent, failed to moult. Twenty-one of 46, or 45.6 percent,
first instar P. carinata failed to moult.
Sex ratio. — All larvae were sexed according to techniques described for
some Scarabaeid larvae by Menees (1957) and Hurpin (1953). The applica¬
bility of their methods with Pleocoma larvae was confirmed when sexed
larvae pupated, in which stage sex was readily determined (Ellertson and
Ritcher, 1959).
476
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 5. Sex ratio of three species of field-collected Pleocoma larvae.
Of all larvae collected in the field, males of all three species, P. dubita-
bilis, P. simi, and P. carinata, outnumbered females by 31, 28, and 26
percent, respectively (Table 5).
Six groups of first stage larvae, each group representing portions of larger
egg clutches of six different females, were sexed to compute the larval sex
ratio for progeny of individual females. Male to female sex ratios for first
instars of P. dubitabilis and P. carinata range from a high of 2:22 to 1:00
to a low of 1:09 to 1:00 (Table 6).
Number of instars. — Head capsules of all larvae were measured at the
widest portion of the dorsum to the nearest 0.15 mm. All head capsules of
preserved specimens were dry when measured; no measurements were
made with specimens submerged in preserving medium. Living larvae were
anesthetized with a small amount of carbon dioxide while being measured.
The range of head capsule width for first and second instar P. dubitabilis,
P. simi, and P. carinata was established in a manner similar to that used
by Ellertson and Ritcher (1959). That is, several larvae were preserved
shortly after hatching and measured to establish a range for the first instar.
Other larvae were allowed to moult after which they were preserved and
the head capsules measured.
Table 6. Larval sex ratio for progeny of individual females of Pleocoma dubitabilis and P.
carinata.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
477
The range in measurements of head capsule width for first and second
stage larvae of three species is shown in the following tabulation:
Range in measurements (mm)
Species First instar Second instar No. of larvae
P. dubitabilis 1.95-2.55 2.25-2.55 118 and 92
P. carinata 2.25-2.55 2.55-2.85 44 and 23
P. simi 2.25 — 2.60 — 7 and 13
The range of measurements for P. dubitabilis and, to a lesser extent, P.
carinata so overlap that there is no distinct difference in size of head cap¬
sules between the first two instars. The same is probably true for P. simi.
Frequency histograms for larval head capsule widths for all instars of all
three species are shown in Fig. 3. The peaks for first and second instar P.
dubitabilis and P. carinata are rather obvious; however, other than those
peaks, an interpretation from the histogram of the range of any given instar
for any of the species, especially P. carinata and P. simi, would be very
subjective. Peaks may characterize some instars, at least with P. dubitabilis,
but extremes of the range for each instar tend to merge.
With P. dubitabilis, it was possible by rearing larvae through a moult, to
get two head capsule measurements on individual larvae, one prior to and
one after the moult. Following this procedure and using the known range
of second instars as a starting point, head capsule measurements have been
arranged into reasonably discrete groups for the first eight instars (Table 7).
From the data in Table 7 and the frequency histogram (Fig. 3A), minimum
and maximum head capsule widths for the first eight instars are suggested
as follows:
Tentative
Head capsule width (mm)
instars Minimum Maximum
Although the ranges are given here for eight instars, it is obvious from Fig.
3A that P. dubitabilis larvae pass through more than eight stages. Moreover,
the wide range of head capsule measurements for P. carinata and P. simi
478
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
O'
UJ
(C) Pleocoma simi
i — 5 c\i ro cri 'T uS md -o’ i — ! oo o’ O' d o ^
HEAD CAPSULE W IDTHS (MILLIMETERS)
Fig. 3. Frequency histograms of larval head capsule widths for three species of Pleocoma.
Portions of histograms to left of arrows represent both male and female larvae, portions to
right represent females only.
(Fig. 3B, C) indicate that both of these species pass through as many instars
as does P. dubitabilis .
There appear to be some sexual differences in the number of instars of
P. dubitabilis, P. carinata, and P. simi. All larvae were sexed at the time
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
479
head capsules were measured and there appeared to be no difference in
head capsule widths between sexes through about the eighth instar; how¬
ever, with P. dubitabilis, all larvae with head capsules measuring more than
7.80 mm were females (Fig. 3A). The same phenomenon was observed with
P. carinata and P. simi larvae; larvae of these two species with head cap¬
sules larger than about 8.70 mm were all females (Fig. 3B, C). Ellertson and
Ritcher (1959) found that the largest P. crinita and P. minor larvae were all
females. They found that three P. crinita larvae larger than 7.65 mm (9th
or 10th instars) were females and the three largest P. minor larvae collected,
all with head capsules greater than 7.95 mm, were all females.
Since there appears to be no difference in larval head capsule widths
between sexes in the earlier instars, these observations indicate that in at
least five species of Oregon Pleocoma, female larvae develop through more
stages than males before pupating.
Pupation. — Pleocoma dubitabilis larvae appear to pass through at least
seven instars before pupating. Six larvae that pupated had head capsules
ranging from 6.45 to 8.25 mm as follows:
P. dubitabilis larvae pupate toward the end of July, becoming inactive
several weeks prior to the transformation. In 1961, larvae pupated between
20 and 31 July. Two larvae became completely inactive 41 and 72 days,
respectively, before pupating. There are indications that some larvae be¬
come inactive as much as 6 months prior to pupating. At the McDonald
Forest study area, most P. dubitabilis larvae pupated at relatively shallow
depths in the soil, as shown in the tabulation:
Date of collection Depth of pupae (cm)
480
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Table 7. Head capsule measurements of Pleocoma dubitabilis larvae made before and after
moulting.
At McDonald Forest, on 22 July 1954, Ritcher and Beer (1956) found three
P. dubitabilis pupae at depths of 17.5, 18.5, and 24 cm. Generally, the depth
of pupation is shallower in the soil than depths at which most larvae are
found.
Natural control factors. — At the time of this study, no parasites or in¬
vertebrate predators had been reported from any species of Pleocoma ,4
Observations made during the study indicate that a fungus disease and a
larval predator account for some larval mortality.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
481
Fig. 4. Second stage Pleocoma dubitabilis larva killed by a fungus disease, Beauveria sp.
(3x).
Five to 22 percent of the P. dubitabilis larvae collected in 1961 at the
McDonald Forest study site had been killed by a fungus identified5 as either
Beauveria gtobulifera (Spegazzini) Picard or B. bassiana (Balsamo) Vuil-
lemin. Infected larvae were collected in their soil burrows throughout the
year and at depths ranging from 15 to 95 cm. All instars appeared to be
susceptible. It is of interest that no diseased P. simi or P. carinata larvae
were collected.
Observations made during laboratory rearings indicate that the fungus
may develop quite rapidly in Pleocoma larvae even in relatively cool forest
soil. In the laboratory, it took from 3 to 7 days at 9-1 1°C, for the Beauveria
infection to progress from a state of apparent noninfection to a condition
such as that shown by the larva in Fig. 4. Davis (1934b) reports having
collected a number of P. behrensii pupae that had been attacked and killed
by fungi.
Asilid larvae also kill some Pleocoma larvae. Occasionally, P. dubitabilis
larvae were collected bearing discolored or blackened areas on one or more
portions of the abdomen. On two occasions, dead or dying Pleocoma larvae
were found with an asilid6 larva in the burrow immediately adjacent to the
grub; one grub had a hole in its thorax where the predator had been feeding.
In both instances, the Pleocoma larva appeared similar to that shown in
Fig. 5. Though only two Pleocoma larvae were collected that had been
killed by asilids, these predators were frequently collected from sample
482
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Fig. 5. A seventh instar Pleocoma dubitabilis showing discoloration in the abdominal mid¬
section and several blackened areas caused by feeding of a predaceous asilid larva (5x).
holes in the soil in the same general strata where Pleocoma larvae were
found.
Hovore (1971) reports that P. linsleyi is . . preyed upon in the larval
and pupal stages by a large dipteran larva . He and his colleagues
have tentatively identified the predator as belonging to the family Asilidae,
possibly in the genus Stenopogon (subfamily Dasypogoninae). He reports
(1971) that he has collected these dipteran larvae from grubs and pupae of
both sexes of P. linsleyi and has taken similar dipteran larvae from the
immature stages of P. badia, and P. venturae. Hovore (personal commu¬
nication) also reports having taken this asilid “parasitising” P. fimbriata,
P. marquai , and P. bicolor. Asilids are known to be a natural enemy of
other white grubs in the genus Phyllophaga (Davis, 1919) and, in one case,
are reported to have controlled an infestation of Phyllophaga koehleriana
(Saylor) in the Texas Panhandle (Daniels, 1966).
During this study, both ants and centipedes killed Pleocoma larvae that
had been placed in the soil for experimentation; however, whether they kill
larvae in the soil under natural conditions is not known. Ants do feed on
other species of white grubs in the southeast (Anonymous, 1957).
Acknowledgments
Professors Paul O. Ritcher (retired) and Julius A. Rudinsky (deceased)
provided funds for this work, and suggestions and criticisms during the
study.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
483
I would like to thank Frank T. Hovore of the Placerita Canyon Nature
Center, Newhall, Calif., Richard L. Westcott, and Richard L. Penrose of
the State Department of Agriculture, Salem, Oreg., for valuable technical
assistance. I am deeply appreciative of Dr. Hovore’ s permission to cite
many of his unpublished observations that contributed to the interpretation
of adult beetle flight habits.
I am deeply grateful to the many resource management personnel of the
Forest Service and the Bureau of Land Management in western Oregon who
took an interest in this study and provided many specimens and observa¬
tions. Among them are: William I. Stein, Gordon Walker, D. J. Tandy,
Jerry Connor, and Frank Wilson.
Literature Cited
Anonymous. 1957. U.S. Department of Agric., Forest Serv., Southeastern Forest Exper. Sta.
Annu. Rep. 1956. Asheville, N.C., 84 p.
Counce, S. J. 1961. The analysis of insect embryogenesis. Annu. Rev. Entomol., 6:295-312.
Daniels, N. E. 1966. The association of a Rangeland Grub, Phyllophaga koehleriana (Co-
leoptera:Scarabaeidae), with Asilid larvae and mites. Annu. Entomol. Soc. Amer.,
59(5): 1021.
Davis, A. C. 1934a. A revision of the genus Pleocoma. Bull. So. Calif. Acad. Sci., 34(1):4-
36.
Davis, A. C. 1934b. A revision of the genus Pleocoma. Bull. So. Calif. Acad. Sci., 33(3): 1 23—
130.
Davis, J. J. 1919. Contributions to a knowledge of the natural enemies of Phyllophaga. Bull.
Ill. State Lab. of Natur. Hist., 13(5):51-138.
Ellertson, F. E. 1956. Pleocoma oregonensis Leach as a pest in sweet cherry orchards. J.
Econ. Entomol., 49(3):431.
Ellertson, F. E. 1958. Biology of some Oregon rain beetles, Pleocoma spp. associated with
fruit trees in Wasco and Hood River Counties. Ph. D. Thesis. Corvallis, Oreg. State
Univ., 129 p.
Ellertson, F. E., and P. O. Ritcher. 1959. Biology of rain beetles, Pleocoma spp. associated
with fruit trees in Wasco and Hood River Counties. Oreg. Agric. Exper. Sta. Tech.
Bull. No. 44, 42 p. illus.
Fellin, D. G., and P. O. Ritcher. 1967. Distribution of Pleocoma species in Oregon with notes
on the habitat of P. simi and P . carinata (Coleoptera:Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Ento¬
mol., 43 (4): 25 1-263.
Fellin, D. G. 1968. Further observations on trapping male Pleocoma with female-baited traps
(Coleoptera:Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol., 44(l):69-70.
Fellin, D. G. 1975. Feeding habits of Pleocoma larvae in coniferous forests of western Oregon.
Northwest Sci., 49(2):71-86.
Hazeltine, William. 1950. Observations on flights of Pleocoma conjugens (Coleoptera:
Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol., 26(4): 188-190.
Hazeltine, William. 1952. Notes on flight and food plants of Pleocoma (Coleoptera:
Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol., 28(4):202.
Hopping, R. 1920. Popular and practical entomology. Some winter insect life. Can. Entomol.,
52(8):217— 218.
Hovore, F. T. 1971. A new Pleocoma from southern California with notes on additional
species (Coleoptera: Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol., 47(3): 193-201.
484
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hovore, F. T. 1972. Three new sympatric Pleocoma from the southern Sierra Nevada Moun¬
tains of California (Coleoptera:Scarabaeidae). Bull. So. Calif. Acad. Sci., 71(2):69-80.
Hurpin, B. 1953. Reconnaissance des sexes chez les larves de Coleopteres, Scarabaeidae.
Bull. Entomol. Soc. France, 58(7): 104-107.
Linsley, E. G. 1941. Additional observations and descriptions of some species of Pleocoma
(Coleoptera:Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol., 17(4): 145-152.
Linsley, E. G. 1957. Distributional records for some species of Pleocoma. Pan-Pacific Ento¬
mol., 33(2): 102-104.
Menees, J. H. 1957. Sex identification in some larvae of Scarabaeoidea. Bull. Brooklyn Ento¬
mol. Soc., 52(4):97-100.
Page, R. E., and J. W. Fisher. 1976. Observations of Pleocoma hirticollis vandykei Linsley
in Santa Clara County, California (Coleoptera: Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol.,
52(1) :95.
Ricksecker, L. E. 1887. Pleocoma fimbriata Lee. Entomol. Amer., 2(10):201-202.
Ricksecker, L. E. 1888. Pleocoma fimbriata Lee. Entomol. Amer., 3(11):212.
Ritcher, P. O., and F. M. Beer. 1956. Notes on the biology of Pleocoma dubitalis dubitalis
Davis. Pan-Pacific Entomol., 32(4): 181-184.
Rivers, J. J. 1889. Notes upon the habit of Pleocoma. Entomol. Amer., 5:17.
Smith, R. F., and W. L. Potts. 1945. Biological notes on Pleocoma hirticollis vandykei Linsley
(Coleoptera: Scarabaeidae). Pan-Pacific Entomol., 21(3): 115-1 18.
Stein, W. I. 1963. Pleocoma larvae, root feeders in western forests. Northwest Sci., 37(4):126-
143.
U.S. Weather Bureau. 1960a. Climatol. data. Oreg., 66(9): 148-162.
U.S. Weather Bureau. 1960b. Climatol. data. Oreg., 66(10): 163-178.
Footnotes
1 This investigation was supported chiefly by the Oregon Agricultural Experiment Station
and National Science Foundation Grants Nos. G- 14296 and G- 17935, and partially by the
USDA Forest Service, Intermountain Forest and Range Experiment Station, Ogden, Utah.
2 According to Hovore (personal communication), the variety dubitabilis Davis was de¬
scribed in 1934 as a new variety of Pleocoma staff Schaufuss. Later, it was considered by
Linsley (1938) to be a distinct species but inadvertently misspelled as P. dubitalis. This error
has persisted since that time.
3 The three observations on 12 November 1960 were made after larvae had hatched; however,
the larvae had not dispersed from the niches in which the eggs had been laid.
4 Collembola and mites have been reported to be associated with dead and living Pleocoma
larvae in the vicinity of Hood River, Oregon, but whether either have acted antagonistically
toward the grubs is not known (Ellertson, 1958).
5 Identified by Clarence A. Thompson, insect pathologist, Forestry Sciences Laboratory,
USDA Forest Service, Corvallis, Oregon.
6 Identification of this asilid larva was confirmed by P. O. Ritcher, former Head, Department
of Entomology, Oregon State University, Corvallis, Oregon.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 485-491
ADDITIONS TO THE KNOWN SPECIES OF PSEUDOTYPOCERUS
AND STRANGAL1A (COLEOPTERA: CERAMBY CIDAE)
John A. Chemsak and E. G. Linsley
University of California, Berkeley 94720
The lepturine genera Pseudotypocerus Linsley and Chemsak and Stran-
galia Audinet-Serville have been treated recently by Chemsak and Linsley
(1976a, 1976b). In their summary, Pseudotypocerus, which was formerly
monotypic, was increased to five species, all occurring in Mexico and/or
Central America. Although the genus Strangalia then consisted of 21
species in these regions, an additional species has since been described from
Honduras (Chemsak and Linsley, 1979). Recent collections have now turned
up further undescribed species in these genera, some of which are described
below.
This study was supported by the National Science Foundation (Grant GB-
BM574) for a monograph of North American Cerambycidae. H. F. Howden
and R. D. Cave are acknowledged for making specimens available for study,
as did the Essig Museum of Entomology, University of California, Berkeley,
and the Ohio State University, Columbus.
Key to the Species of Pseudotypocerus
1. Pronotum rather coarsely, separately punctate, punctures dense
or very sparse . 2
Pronotum finely, very densely punctate, punctures confluent ... 5
2(1). Pronotum densely punctate, punctures larger than those at base
of elytra . 3
Pronotum very sparsely punctate and pubescent, punctures sub¬
equal to those at base of elytra; abdomen sparsely punctate,
pubescence short, sparse. Length, 12-14 mm. El Salvador
. nitidicollis Chemsak and Linsley
3(2). Elytra with pubescence black under oblique light; head with front
broader across genae than length from bases of genae to base
of labrum . 4
Elytra with pubescence appearing golden in oblique light; head
with front measured from bases of genae to base of labrum as
long as width across genae. Length, 10-13 mm. Mexico to Nic¬
aragua . rufiventris (Bates)
4(3). Antennae with segments from fifth clothed with golden appressed
pubescence. Abdomen black, with last sternite in males im-
486
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
pressed over the apical Vs. Integument with strong metallic
overtones. Length, 14 mm. Panama .
. virescens Chemsak and Linsley
Antennae with outer segments densely clothed with very fine,
short, whitish pubescence. Abdomen reddish, with last sternite
in males barely impressed at apex. Integument vaguely metallic.
Length, 13-16 mm. Costa Rica . citer, new species
5(1). Antennae with outer segments finely black pubescent . 6
Antennae with outer segments densely golden pubescent . 7
6(5). Elytra more than 2Vi times as long as broad, punctures behind
scutellum finely granulate, contiguous, apices black. Length,
13-16 mm. Costa Rica and Panama .
. canthandis Chemsak and Linsley
Elytra less than 2 V2 times as long as broad, punctures behind
scutellum not granulate, separated, disk with two broad, lon¬
gitudinal, yellowish vittae. Length, 12 mm. Panama .
. vittatus, new species
7(5). Abdomen finely, densely punctate and pubescent . 8
Abdomen glabrous, almost impunctate; integument yellow and
black, elytra with broad black bands over humeri to basal Vx
and less than apical Vi black. -Length, 12 mm. Panama .
. dimidiatus, new species
8(7). Elytra densely, confluently punctate; pronotum inflated, abruptly
narrowed at apex; neck, pronotum and scutellum orange.
Length, 11-15 mm. Panama .
. inflaticollis Chemsak and Linsley
Elytra with punctures separated by more than their diameters;
pronotum moderately convex, gradually narrowing to apex;
pronotum, scutellum and two narrow, longitudinal vittae of
elytra orange. Length, 14 mm. Panama .
. auricornis, new species
Pseudotypocerus ater, new species
Male. — Form strongly tapering; color black, most shining black parts with
faint greenish to bluish metallic overtones, abdomen reddish. Head with
front measured from bases of genae to base of labrum wider across genae
than long; vertex opaque, finely, confluently punctate; antennae with porif¬
erous areas from segment five, segments from seventh with a double set.
Pronotum moderately strongly convex, apex narrowly impressed; disk fine¬
ly densely punctate, middle with a glabrous longitudinal fine; pubescence
dark golden and black, depressed; prosternum minutely punctate, finely
golden pubescent; meso- and metasternum very finely, densely punctate,
densely clothed with golden depressed pubescence. Elytra more than 2Vi
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
487
times as long as broad, strongly tapering; punctures fine, separated; pubes¬
cence short, dark, depressed; apices obliquely, shallowly emarginate trun¬
cate, outer angle dentate. Legs slender, black and golden pubescent. Ab¬
domen with stemites minutely punctate at bases and middle; last sternite
elongate, shallowly impressed at apex. Length, 13-15 mm.
Female. — Form more robust. Antennae extending to second abdominal
segment. Abdomen with last sternite dentate at angles; last tergite emargin¬
ate at apex. Length, 15-16 mm.
Holotype male, allotype (Canadian National Collection) and 6 paratypes
(5 males, 1 female) from 6 km S. Santa Elena, Puntarenas, Costa Rica, 30
May 1979, 2 June 1979, on flowers of Croton (H. and A. Howden); one
additional female paratype from Turrialba, Costa Rica (E. A. Bottcher).
This species is closely related to P. virescens but differs by the reddish
abdomen, lack of golden pubescence on the antennae and barely impressed
last abdominal sternite. The golden pubescence on the elytra of P. rufiven-
tris will separate that species from P. ater.
Pseudotypocerus vittatus, new species
Female. — Form moderate-sized, rather short; integument black, protho¬
rax, mesosternum, front tibiae except apically, orange, elytra with two
broad, yellowish longitudinal vittae. Head with front from bases of genae
to base of labrum longer than width across genae; vertex finely, densely
punctate with larger punctures interspersed; pubescence sparse, short; an¬
tennae extending to about third abdominal segment, outer segments clothed
with fine dark pubescence, segments from fifth with double rows of porif¬
erous areas. Pronotum moderately convex, apex moderately strongly im¬
pressed; disk finely, confluently punctate, median line narrow; pubescence
depressed, orange; prosternum glabrous, minutely punctate between coxae;
meso- and metasternum minutely, densely punctate, densely clothed with
short, depressed, golden pubescence. Elytra less than 2Vz times as long as
broad; basal punctures fine, separated, dense; pubescence short, depressed,
mostly golden; apices obliquely emarginate. Legs slender, black and golden
pubescent. Abdomen minutely, very densely punctate, densely clothed with
appressed golden pubescence; last sternite impressed at apex; last tergite
subtruncate at apex. Length, 12 mm.
Holotype female (Ohio State University) from Santa Fe, Darien Province,
Panama, 29 May 1967 (D. M. DeLong and C. Triplehorn).
The coloration, black pubescent antennae, and punctation of the elytra
will separate this species from other Pseudotypocerus.
Pseudotypocerus dimidiatus, new species
Female. — Form moderate-sized, moderately tapering posteriorly; integ¬
ument yellow-orange, head, neck, antennae, legs except spots at bases of
488
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
front and middle femora, sides of mesostemum, metasternum, last two ab¬
dominal segments, scutellum, apices of elytra and humeri broadly, black.
Head with front across genae as broad as length from bases of genae to base
of labrum; vertex finely, densely punctate with some larger contiguous punc¬
tures present; pubescence fine, pale; antennae extending to second abdom¬
inal segment, segments from apex of fifth densely clothed with appressed
pubescence which appears golden in oblique light, poriferous areas small.
Pronotum moderately convex, gradually narrowing to apex; disk finely con-
fluently punctate, median line vague, pubescence fine, orange, depressed;
prosternum subglabrous, meso- and metastemum finely, densely punctate,
moderately densely clothed with short, depressed pubescence. Elytra less
than 2Vi times as long as broad; punctures very fine, dense, lightly granulate;
pubescence short, depressed, orange on pale areas, black on dark areas;
apices obliquely emarginate. Legs slender, gold and dark pubescent. Ab¬
domen glabrous, almost impunctate; last sternite impressed over apical Vi\
last tergite emarginate at apex. Length, 12 mm.
Holotype female (California Academy of Sciences) from Cerro Azul, 700
m, Panama Province, Panama, 20 May 1972 (D. Ingleman).
The distinctive coloration and glabrous abdomen make this species readily
recognizable. The color pattern of the elytra will probably prove to be vari¬
able when more material becomes available.
Pseudotypocerus auricornis, new species
Female. — Form moderate-sized, strongly tapering posteriorly; integu¬
ment black with vague metallic overtones, prothorax and sides of meso-
sternum orange, elytra with longitudinal, yellowish vittae at middle extend¬
ing from behind scutellum to beyond middle. Head broader across genae
than length from bases of genae to base of labrum; vertex finely, densely
punctate with larger punctures interspersed; pubescence fine, sparse; an¬
tennae extending to second abdominal segment, segments from third dense¬
ly golden pubescent; poriferous areas small. Pronotum moderately convex,
rather abruptly impressed at apex; disk very finely, confluently punctate;
pubescence orange, depressed; prosternum sparsely pubescent; meso- and
metasternum finely, densely punctate, densely clothed with depressed, gold¬
en pubescence. Elytra slightly more than 2Vi times as long as broad; punc¬
tures fine, well separated; pubescence short, dark, depressed; apices
obliquely truncate. Abdomen minutely, densely punctate, apical margins of
sternites not punctate, pubescence fine, depressed, silvery; last sternite im¬
pressed at apex; last tergite notched at apex. Length, 14 mm.
Holotype female (California Academy of Sciences) from Barro Colorado
Island, Canal Zone, Panama, 25 May 1972 (J. Irwin).
This species is distinctive by the golden pubescent antennae and well
separated punctures of the elytra.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
489
Strangalia cavei, new species
Male. — Form slender, elongate, strongly tapering posteriorly; integument
black, part of head, front coxae and femora, midfemora and basal Vi of hind
femora yellowish, elytra testaceous, broadly black along lateral margins,
narrowly black along suture, apices black. Head with front moderately long,
irregularly, sparsely punctate, finely sparsely pubescent; vertex finely,
densely punctate, finely pubescent; palpi very unequal, apical segments of
maxillary pair large, elliptical ; antennae slender, extending to apices of ely¬
tra, segments from fifth with poriferous areas, areas very large on segments
seven to eleven, segments from apex of fifth opaque. Pronotum with sides
slightly sinuous, apex narrowly impressed, disk moderately convex with a
rather vague median fine; punctures larger than those at base of elytra,
subcontiguous; pubescence short, depressed, black at middle, golden at
sides; prosternum glabrous at middle; meso- and metasternum finely, dense¬
ly punctate, densely clothed with short, depressed, golden and grayish pu¬
bescence. Elytra more than three times as long as broad, strongly atten¬
uated, moderately dehiscent; punctures fine, separated by at least a
puncture diameter; pubescence short, depressed, black and golden; apices
obliquely, shallowly emarginate. Legs slender; front tibiae arcuate, hind tib¬
iae noncarinate, tarsi elongate. Abdomen extending two segments beyond
elytra; first four segments minutely, densely punctate at bases, punctures
becoming larger and sparser toward apex, apical margins glabrous; pubes¬
cence fine, depressed; last sternite excavated for its length, glabrous inter¬
nally, carinate medially at base, sides moderately produced, apices rounded.
Length, 18-20 mm.
Holotype male (California Academy of Sciences) and three male para-
types from Bosque El Imposible, Depto. Ahuachapan, 745 meters, El Sal¬
vador, 18 June 1979, on flowers of Croton (R. D. Cave). One male paratype,
Puerta Mayor, 600 meters, Bosque El Imposible, 17 June 1979 (R. D. Cave).
The type series shows little variation in coloration with only the apices
of the elytra varying in the extent of black.
In the key to Strangalia (Chemsak and Linsley, 1976b) this species will
come out in couplet 4 with gracilis and lachrymans . S. cavei differs from
gracilis by its larger, more robust form, shorter face, larger apical segments
of the maxillary palpi and thicker distal antennal segments. From lachry¬
mans , it may be separated by the depressed pubescence of the pronotum,
more densely punctate elytra, and less strongly inflated sides of the last
sternite of the abdomen.
This species is named for R. D. Cave who collected and made the type
series available for study.
Since the name, Strangalia gracilis Chemsak, 1969, is preoccupied by
490
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Strangalia ( Strangalina ) gracilis Gressitt, 1934 from the Loochoo Islands,
we here propose Strangalia sinaloae, new name for gracilis Chemsak.
Strangalia anneae, new species
Male. — Form slender, elongate, strongly tapering posteriorly; integument
black, mouthparts, front coxae, femora and undersides of tibiae, middle
femora and undersides of tibiae and hind femora brownish orange, elytra
dark testaceous, lateral margins narrowly dark at basal V2 and more broadly
over apical Vi, suture very narrowly dark. Head with front moderately elon¬
gate, irregularly, sparsely punctate, very finely, sparsely pubescent; vertex
finely, confluently punctate, very sparsely pubescent; palpi very unequal,
apical segments of maxillary pair long, shallowly excavated beneath; anten¬
nae as long as elytra, segments from sixth moderately enlarged, segments
from fifth with large poriferous areas. Pronotum narrow, sides barely sin¬
uate, apex narrowly impressed; punctures larger than those at base of elytra,
dense except for glabrous median spot near basal margin; pubescence short,
depressed, golden in oblique fight; prosternum broadly glabrous at middle;
meso- and metasternum finely, densely punctate, densely clothed with
short, depressed, golden pubescence, metasternum with a small tubercle on
each side of middle. Elytra more than three times as long as broad, strongly
attenuated, moderately dehiscent; punctures fine, separated by at least a
puncture diameter; pubescence short, depressed, dark and golden; apices
obliquely emarginate. Legs slender; front tibiae arcuate; hind tibiae non-
carinate; tarsi elongate. Abdomen extending two segments beyond elytra;
stemites minutely, densely punctate at bases, punctures becoming larger
and sparser toward apices, first two segments glabrous along apical margins,
pubescence fine, short; last sternite excavated for most of its length, gla¬
brous at middle, sides moderately produced, apices subacute. Length, 17-
20 mm.
Female. — Form more robust, elytra less attenuated. Antennae shorter
than elytra, poriferous areas small. Maxillary palpi with apical segments not
excavated beneath. Pronotum orange except at apex, shining, very sparsely,
irregularly punctate and pubescent; metasternum non-tuberculate. Under¬
side orange, legs black. Abdomen subglabrous; last sternite black, shallowly
impressed at apex, sides dentate; last tergite medially impressed, narrowly
emarginate, apex bidentate. Length, 16 mm.
Holotype male, allotype (Canadian National Collection) and two male
paratypes from 6 km S. Santa Elena, Puntarenas, Costa Rica, 1100 m, 2
June 1979 on flowers of Croton (H. and A. Howden).
This species varies in coloration with the elytra often all black except for
a broad basal testaceous area. It will also key to couplet 4 ( gracilis and
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
491
lachrymans ) in Chemsak and Linsley’s 1976 key. S. anneae differs from
both of those species by the poriferous areas of the antennae, size and shape
of the excavation of the last abdominal sternite and by the presence of
metasternal tubercles in the males. From cavei, anneae differs by the more
slender pronotum and maxillary palpi and by having the last abdominal
sternite not excavated for its entire length.
We are pleased to dedicate this species to Anne T. Howden.
Literature Cited
Chemsak, John A. 1969. New Mexican and Central American species of Strangalia Audinet-
Serville. Jour. New York Entomol. Soc., 77:2-9, 7 figs.
Chemsak, John A., and E. G. Linsley. 1976a. The lepturine genus Pseudotypocerus. Coleop.
Bull., 30:171-175.
Chemsak, John A., and E. G. Linsley. 1976b. A review of the Mexican and Central American
species of Strangalia Audinet-Serville. Jour. New York Entomol. Soc., 84:216-232, 2
figs.
Chemsak, John A., and E. G. Linsley. 1979. New Cerambycidae from Honduras. Pan-Pacific
Entomol., 55:267-272.
Gressitt, J. L. 1934. New Longicorn beetles from the Japanese Empire, II. Philippine Jour.
Sci., 55:379-386.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, p. 492
SCIENTIFIC NOTE
ARTEMISIA CALIFORNICA LESS., A NEW HOST FOR PERARTHRUS
VITTATUS LeCONTE (COLEOPTERA: CERAMBYCIDAE)
Several dead or partially dead shrubs of California Sagebrush, Artemisia
calif arnica Less., were found in March 1979 in the Telegraph Canyon area
of San Diego County, California. While attempting to pull up the shrubs to
determine cause of death, several limbs, 5-12 mm in diameter broke 30-50
cm above the ground. The breakage was because of cerambycid larval work
within the limbs. Four of the seven shrubs examined had larval work in
approximately the same sized limbs and at the same height above the
ground. The larvae initiated boring in the upper third of the plant in small
twigs, the probable oviposition site. They bored down the twigs into larger
limbs and remained within the heartwood beneath the thin bark. Several
small, oval holes, 1-2 mm in diameter, were cut through the bark by each
larva and used to expel excess frass. Each hole was filled with a tight plug
of coarse frass when not in use. Gallery walls were coarsely striated, re¬
sembling buprestid larval work. Pupal chambers parallel to the grain of the
wood were formed within galleries beneath the bark and a thin layer of
heartwood. Infested limbs were placed in rearing containers, and a total of
4 male and 7 female Perarthrus vittatus adults emerged between 17 and 30
July. No parasitism or predation was noted.
Linsley (1962, Univ. Calif. Publ. Entomol., 20:93) records Haplopappus
venetus vernonioides (Nutt.) Munz as a host with the emergence period as
September and October. The adult emergence in July, an early record, may
be a response to more arid rearing conditions in Fresno than found at the
collection site. It is likely that Linsleys’ host data is based on a “collected
from” label rather than an actual rearing. Thus, A. calif ornica is probably
the first confirmed host association for this cerambycid. That only 60% of
the examined shrubs were infested suggests that the cerambycid was not
the primary cause of the shrubs condition. Most of the affected 1 meter tall
shrubs were either completely dead or appeared dead with a few new basal
shoots. The roots and root crowns displayed no evidence of borer or termite
damage. Drought conditions which occurred throughout California in 1977—
78 may have contributed to the decline and death of the shrubs.
W. H. Tyson, Calif. Dept, of Food and Ag., Suite A, 2895 N. Larkin,
Fresno 93727.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 493-499
TWO NEW DICRANOCENTRUS FROM NEPAL AND A KEY TO
THE INDIAN AND NEPALESE SPECIES
(COLLEMBOLA: ENTOMOBRYIDAE)
Jose A. Mari Mutt
Department of Biology, University of Puerto Rico, Mayaguez 00708
Through the courtesy of Dr. L. Deharveng of the Laboratoire de Zoologie,
Universite Paul Sabatier, Toulouse, France, I have received part of the
Orchesellinae collected by him during a 1977 expedition to Central Nepal.
The specimens, which are from an area some 33 km west of the Annapurna
Himal and south of Mustang mountain ranges, represent two new species
of Dicranocentrus closely related to the six species of this genus known
from Nepal and Northeast India.
Dicranocentrus deharvengi, new species
Habitus and distribution of violet pigment as in Fig. 2. Length up to 3.0
mm. First 4 antennal segments (Ant. 1-4), head, body, all segments of legs,
collophore, and dorsal and ventral sides of manubrium covered by brown,
strongly striated oval scales. Ant. 6 missing in all specimens. Pin seta seen
on apex of regenerated Ant. 5. Head macrochaetotaxy as in Fig. 1 (note
absence of S2). Eyes 8 + 8 on dark patches, g and h reduced in diameter.
Labral papillae (Fig. 8) of type I, rounded with spinelike processes. Chae-
totaxy of labial triangle as in Fig. 10; 9—11 setae on posterior row. Some
individuals with unequal number of setae on the two triangles; one specimen
(Fig. 10) with a smooth seta on left posterior row but all setae ciliated in
other specimens and in right triangle of same specimen. Maxillary palp as
in Fig. 5. Differentiated seta of outer labial papilla as in Fig. 4, placed far
back on its papilla. All setae of venter of head ciliated. Tibiotarsi without
smooth setae. Metathoracic claws as in Fig. 9; inner margin of ungues with
a pair of well developed teeth and 2 very small unpaired teeth (drawn larger).
Unguiculus with a very small basal tooth. Tenent hair long, apically clavate.
Body macrochaetotaxy as in Fig. 3, setae indicated by arrows missing in
one specimen. No smooth setae on dorsum of manubrium (but most setae
have fallen off). Each dental lobe with a long macrochaetalike plumose seta.
Dental spines absent. Mucro with 2 teeth and a basal spine.
Diagnosis. — The species is close to the Nepalese D. janetscheki (Yosii,
1971) and to D. fraternus (Mari Mutt and Bhattachaijee, 1980), a species
from the vicinity of Shillong, Northeast India. It may be separated from the
494
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Figs. 1-7. D. deharvengi n. sp. Fig. 1. Dorsal head macrochaetotaxy, each dot represents
a seta. Fig. 2. Habitus and distribution of violet pigment. Fig. 3. Dorsal body macrochaetotaxy;
setae indicated by arrows are missing in one specimen. Fig. 4. Outer labial papilla. Fig. 5.
Maxillary palp. Fig. 6. Th. 2-macrochaetotaxy of left side. Fig. 7. Th. 3-macrochaetotaxy of
left side.
496
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
former by the chaetotaxy of Th. 3 and Abd. 1 (see Mari Mutt, 1979:47, Fig.
47) and by the color pattern (compare Fig. 2 with Yosii, 1971:128, Fig. A
or Mari Mutt, 1979:29, Fig. 20). From the latter it may be distinguished only
by the chaetotaxy of Th. 3, Abd. 1 and Abd. 4.
Comments . — Figures 6 and 7 detail the macrochaetotaxy of the left half
of Th. 2 and Th. 3 of a smaller specimen. The sockets left by some of the
macrochaetae are distinctly smaller than those left by other macrochaetae.
If only the larger sockets are considered, the resulting pattern is very similar
or even identical to that of other species. For an example, compare Fig. 7
with the chaetotaxy of Th. 3 of D. marias, a Central American and Carib¬
bean species (Mari Mutt, 1979:45, Fig. 77c). The same pattern of Th. 3 is
found in the Indian D. singularis Mari Mutt and Bhattacharjee (1980).
Material examined. — Just beyond Gorges Kali Gandaki, 1900 m, Sept.
27, holotype and 16 paratypes. As preceding but under Cannabis, 1 para-
type. Tukuche, 2600 m, Sept. 28, 4 paratypes. As preceding but 2500 m, 1
paratype. Kalopani, 2500 m, Sept. 27, under Cupressus, 2 paratypes. Tir-
kedunje, 1500 m. Sept. 24, 4 paratypes.
The holotype and five paratypes are deposited at the British Museum
(Natural History). Other paratypes are in the author’s collection.
Dicranocentrus violaceus, new species
Habitus and distribution of violet pigment as in Fig. 17. Length up to 1.5
mm. Scales distributed as in preceding species (except impossible to deter¬
mine presence on dorsum of manubrium). Ant. 5 and Ant. 6 missing. Ar¬
rangement of eyes, head macrochaetotaxy, and labral papillae as in D. de-
harvengi. Chaetotaxy of labial base as in Fig. 16, posterior row of triangle
with 1 smooth and up to 4 ciliated setae. Maxillary palp as in Fig. 18.
Differentiated seta of outer labial papilla (Fig. 13) not placed as far back on
its papilla (compare with Fig. 4). Setae of postlabial quadrangle smooth but
a ciliated seta located between them; rest of venter of head mostly with
ciliated setae. Tibiotarsi without smooth setae. Claws as in Fig. 14, inner
margin of ungues with a basal pair and a distal unpaired tooth. Unguiculus
with a small outer tooth not placed as proximally as in D. deharvengi.
Tenent hair clavate. Body macrochaetotaxy as in Fig. 12. No smooth setae
seen on dorsum of manubrium but many setae have fallen off. Dental lobe
with a long maorochaetalike plumose seta. Dental spines absent. Mucro
with 2 teeth and a basal spine.
Diagnosis . — The species comes closest to the micronesian D. inermo-
dentes (Uchida) (Uchida, 1944) and to D. indicus (Bonet, 1930), sensu Yosii
(1966): a widely distributed oriental species occurring in Nepal. From the
first it may be readily separated by the color pattern, presence of only
smooth setae on venter of the head, and by the chaetotaxy of Th. 3, Abd.
1 and Abd. 4 (see Mari Mutt, 1979:47, Fig. 92). From the latter it may be
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
497
by arrows are of smaller diameter and length than other setae. Fig. 13. Outer labial papilla.
Fig. 14. Metathoracic claws. Fig. 15. Left mandible (see text for comments). Fig. 16. Base of
labium; setae named according to Gisin’s system. Fig. 17. Habitus and distribution of violet
pigment. Fig. 18. Maxillary palp.
498
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
distinguished only by the chaetotaxy of Th. 3 and Abd. 1 (see Yosii,
1966:372, Fig. C or Mari Mutt, 1979:47, Fig. 91) and some aspects of the
color pattern (compare Fig. 17 with Fig. A in Yosii, 1966:372).
Comments . — Two very unusual mandibles (e.g. Fig. 15) were found while
studying a dissected head that had been mounted in Marc Andre II over a
year earlier. The head of these mandibles is greatly expanded and the teeth
are facing the molar area. Two additional specimens were dissected recently
and these possessed normal mandibles like those of D. deharvengi (Fig. 11).
With so few specimens at hand it was not advisable to continue dissections;
I could not determine whether this type of mandible is common, teratolog-
ical, or caused by preservation in this medium, which tends to deteriorate
rapidly in atmospheres with high humidity.
Material examined. — Birethanti, 1000 m, Sept. 23, holotype and 4 para-
types. Tirkedunje, 1500 m, 2 paratypes ( D . deharvengi was also collected
at this locality).
The holotype and 2 paratypes are at the British Museum (Natural His¬
tory). Other paratypes are in the author’s collection.
Key to the Indian and Nepalese Dicranocentrus
1. Dental spines present . 2
Dental spines absent . 3
2. Spines along inner margin of dentes; Abd. 6 of adults greatly pro¬
longed posteriorly (see Mari Mutt, 1979:27, Fig. 8); Ant. 5 about
1.5 x length of Ant. 6 . . cercifer (Imms)
Spines along inner and outer margin of dentes; Abd. 6 not prolonged
posteriorly; Ant. 5 slightly shorter than Ant. 6 ... spinosus Prabhoo
3. Abd. 1 with 2 or 3 macrochaetae per side . 4
Abd. 1 with 4 or 6 macrochaetae per side . 6
4. Abd. 1 and Th. 2 with 2 and 5 macrochaetae respectively; dental
lobe without plumose seta (with a smooth erect seta) .
. singularis Mari Mutt and Bhattacharjee
Abd. 1 and Th. 2 with 3 and 9 macrochaetae respectively; dental
lobe with an erect plumose seta . 5
5. Posterior half of Th. 2 with 7 macrochaetae; body segments with
blue band near posterior margins; unguis with an unpaired tooth
. indicus Bonet
Posterior half of Th. 2 with 6 macrochaetae; body unpigmented;
unguis with 2 unpaired teeth . nepalensis Mari Mutt
6. Abd. 1 with 4 macrochaetae . 7
Abd. 1 with 6 macrochaetae . 9
7. Th. 3 (Fig. 12) with 9 macrochaetae, innermost posterior seta miss¬
ing (compare with Fig. 3); posterior labial row with up to 4 ciliated
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
499
and 1 smooth seta; pigmentation as in Fig. 17 .
. violaceus, new species
Th. 3 with 10 macrochaetae (e.g. Fig. 3); posterior labial row with
more setae (7-9), all of which are ciliated; pigmentation not as
above . 8
8. Th. 2 and Abd. 2 with 9 and 2 macrochaetae respectively; posterior
half of Th. 3 and all of Abd. 1 intensely pigmented while rest of
body is practically devoid of pigment resulting in a striking banded
pattern (see Yosii, 1971:128, Fig. A or Mari Mutt, 1979:29, Fig.
20) . janetscheki Yosii
Th. 2 and Abd. 2 with 6-7 and 3 macrochaetae respectively; body
either thoroughly pigmented or unpigmented .
. fraternus Mari Mutt and Bhattachaijee
9. Unguis without inner teeth; tenent hair lanceolate, very short (see
Mari Mutt and Bhattacharjee, 1980, Fig. 25); head and body with
numerous macrochaetae (27 and 65 setae respectively on each
side, see Mari Mutt and Bhattacharjee, 1980, Fig. 26, 34) .
. pilosus Mari Mutt
Unguis (Fig. 9) with a pair of basal and 2 distal unpaired teeth along
inner margin; tenent hair clavate, long; head and body with fewer
macrochaetae (24 and 45 respectively per side; see Fig. 3)
. deharvengi, new species
Acknowledgment
I wish to thank Dr. Angel Berrios, Department of Biology, University of
Puerto Rico at Mayaguez, for preparing Figures 2 and 17.
Literature Cited
Bonet, F. 1930. Sur quelques Collemboles de Flnde. Eos, 6(3):249-273.
Mari Mutt, J. A. 1979. A revision of the genus Dicranocentrus Schott (Insecta: Collembola:
Entomobryidae). Agr. Exp. Stn. Univ. P.R. Bull., 259, 79 p.
Mari Mutt, J. A., and R. K. Bhattacharjee. 1980. Four new species of Dicranocentrus from
Northeast India and Nepal (Collembola: Entomobryidae: Orchesellinae). Pacif. Insects,
22(1-2): 162-170.
Uchida, H. 1944. Collembola von Mikronesien. Bull. Tokyo Mus., 17:1-23.
Yosii, R. 1 966. On some Collembola of Afghanistan, India and Ceylon collected by the Kuphe-
Expedition, 1960. Results Kyoto Univ. Sci. Exped. Karakoram and Hindukush, 1955,
8:333^105.
Yosii, R. 1971. Collembola of Khumbu Himal. Ergeb. Forsch. Nepal, Himalaya, 4:80-130.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 500-503
NEW SPECIES OF RHYACOPHILA FROM CALIFORNIA
(TRICHOPTERA: RH Y ACOPHILID AE)
Wayne C. Fields, Jr.
10325 Indian Hill Road, Newcastle, California 95658
In this paper two new species of Rhyacophila and the female of Rhyaco-
phila spinata Denning are described. All were collected from the western
half of the Foresthili Divide in Placer County, California. The types are in
the author’s collection and will eventually be deposited in the Entomology
collection of the California Academy of Science, Golden Gate Park, San
Francisco.
Rhyacophila darbyi, new species
(Figs, la-d)
The species is tentatively placed in the ecosa group although there is a
resemblance to R. lineata Denning in the viquaea group. Until the female
and additional specimens are collected this placement will remain tentative.
Diagnostic differences from described species are the emarginated margin
of the ninth tergite, the subquadrate second clasper segment, and the pe¬
culiar phallus complex.
Male. — Length to apex of folded wings 10.3 mm. General color fuscous
but darker dorsally, especially on head. Sternum 7 with minute mesal pro¬
cess. Genitalia as illustrated (Fig. 1). Segment 9, lateral aspect, widest me¬
dially, anterior margin arcuate; from dorsal aspect distally emarginate (Fig.
lb). Preanal plates large, posterolateral margin emarginated (Fig. la); dorsal
margin acuminate from lateral or dorsal aspect (Fig. lc). Tergum 10 partially
obscured by preanal plates; heavily sclerotized, from lateral aspect apical
margin obliquely truncate, black pigmented. Anal sclerite, lateral aspect
(Fig. la) heavily sclerotized and elongate, apex black pigmented dorsally.
Clasper basal segment short, rhomboid, the semi-quadrate distal segment
densely covered mesally with short pubescence. Phallus structure (Fig. Id):
basal capsule elongated into lateral arms which lie alongisde the lightly
sclerotized phalicata; ventral to this structure are two small ventrad curved
spines.
Female. — Unknown.
Holotype male. — Shirttail Creek near western edge Tahoe National For¬
est, 3500', Placer County, California, 9 June 1974, W. C. Fields, Jr.
It is with pleasure that I name this new species in honor of my former
teacher at California State University, Sacramento, Professor R. E. Darby.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
501
1.0 mm
Figs. 1-3. Fig. 1. Rhyacophila darbyi Fields, male genitalia, la, lateral aspect; lb, 9th
tergite, dorsal aspect; lc, preanal plates, dorsal aspect; Id, phallus complex, lateral aspect.
Fig. 2. Rhyacophila acuminata Fields, male and female genitalia; 2a, male genitalia, lateral
aspect; 2b, phallus complex, lateral aspect; 2c, female 8th segment, lateral aspect; 2d, bursa
copulatrix, lateral aspect; 2e, bursa copulatrix, ventral aspect. Fig. 3. Rhyacophila spinata
Denning, female genitalia; 3a, 8th segment, lateral aspect; 3b, 8th segment, dorsal aspect; 3c,
bursa copulatrix, lateral aspect.
502
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Rhyacophila acuminata, new species
(Figs. 2a-e)
This species is a member of the acropedes group and is probably closest
to R. incult a Ross and Spencer. Diagnostic characters are the prominent
bulbous projection of the dorsum of segment 9 and the peculiar dorsal pro¬
cess of the phallus complex.
Male. — Length 13 mm to tip of folded wings. General color brownish.
Wings faintly irrorate. Sternum 7 with minute mesal process; segment 5
with subpleural tubercle. Genitalia as in Fig. 2. Lateral margin segment 9
sinuate; tergum projecting dorsocaudad, bulbous, setose, distally acumi¬
nate, directed caudad approximately one-third length of segment 10 (Fig.
2a). Segment 10 similar to other members of the group; from lateral aspect
caudal margin curved dorsad, structure projected beyond basal clasper seg¬
ment. Phallus complex generally similar to other members of the acropedes
group; extensile semimembranous parameres with apical pads of dark brown
closely appressed setae; base of dorsal process bears dorsolateral flanges,
ventrolateral ridges, and a short ventral keel (Fig. 2b). Clasper basal seg¬
ment directed dorsocaudad, compressed laterally; apical segment gradually
narrowed caudally to obtuse apex with dense short black pubescence dor-
somedially.
Female. — Length 13 mm. Similar to male in general color and size. Ster¬
num 6 with minute mesal process. Genitalia as in Fig. 2c, d, e. Base of
segment 8 heavily sclerotized, pubescent, with median postero ventral keel,
distally obtuse and slightly separated from remainder of segment (Fig. 2c).
Bursa copulatrix a lightly sclerotized ring projecting anteriorly into dorsal
point, caudally into parallel arms and with a ventral keel, Fig. 2d, e.
Holotype male. — Shirttail Creek, near western edge Tahoe National For¬
est, 3500', Placer Co., Calif., 25 August 1974, W. C. Fields, Jr. Allotype
female, same data as for holotype. Paratypes, 5 males, 2 females, same data
as holotype. Additional specimens not in type series: 2 males, Lady’s Can¬
yon, 2300', tributary to Middle Fork American River southeast of Foresthill,
Placer Co., May 1978; 4 males, 1 female, Lady’s Canyon, 5 May 1978, W.
C. Fields, Jr. Larvae of the acropedes group have been collected from
Shirttail Creek, 25 August 1974, but until these can be reared I can only
postulate that they are the larvae of R. acuminata n. sp.
Rhyacophila spinata Denning
The unusual male of this species is described and figured by Denning
(1965). The female is described here for the first time.
Female. — Length 14 mm to tip of folded wings. General color dark brown,
darker than associated males; abdomen purplish brown dorsally. Wings
brown, irrorate. Sternum 6 with minute mesal process. Genitalia as in Fig,
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
503
3. From dorsal aspect, anterior margin of segment 8 heavily sclerotized with
pronounced emargination (Fig. 3b); from lateral aspect, deep triangular in¬
cision (Fig. 3a); segment expanded laterally. Segments 9, 10, and 11 may
be withdrawn entirely into segment 8. Bursa copulatrix elongate, lightly
sclerotized, scoop-shaped proximally, surmounted by a membranous lobe,
and distally attenuated (Fig. 3c).
Female. — Lady’s Canyon, 2300', southeast of Foresthill, Placer Co., Cal¬
if., 13 March 1976, W. C. Fields, Jr., 5 males, 2 females, same data.
I am indebted to Donald G. Denning for his inspection of my specimens
and suggestions regarding this paper.
Literature Cited
Denning, D. G. 1965. New Rhyacophilids and Limnephilids (Trichoptera: Rhyacophilidae and
Limnephilidae). Can. Entomol., 97:690-700.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 504-505
SCIENTIFIC NOTE
FIRST CALIFORNIA RECORD FOR DENDROSOTER PROTUBERANS
(NEES) (HYMENOPTERA: BRACONIDAE)
In June 1978, Dendrosoter protuberans (Nees) was reared from bolts of
Siberian elm wood ( Ulmus pumila L.) collected in Los Angeles and San
Bernardino Counties, California. This external braconid parasite was also
reared from English elm wood ( Ulmus procera Salisb.) collected in Sacra¬
mento County in June 1979. All of the wood from both locations was infested
with Scolytus multistriatus (Marsham), the smaller European elm bark bee¬
tle. D. protuberans is a parasite of S. multistriatus but had not previously
been reported from California.
Dendrosoter protuberans , a native of Russia, Europe and Asia Minor,
parasitizes several species of Cerambycidae and many species of Scolytidae
in its endemic area (Stary, 1957, Acta Soc. Entomol. Csl., 54:277-292).
Among its hosts is Scolytus multistriatus , a native European bark beetle.
This bark beetle was accidentally introduced into the United States in Mas¬
sachusetts in 1909 (Chapman, 1910, Psyche, 17:63-68). It spread westward
and became established in California in 1951 (Armitage, 1951, Calif. State
Dept. Agric. Bull., 40:111-118).
S> multistriatus is of scientific and public interest as it is one of the prin¬
cipal vectors of Dutch elm disease. Since S. multistriatus was introduced
into the United States, one of the strategies undertaken to control this beetle
has been classical biological control. Only a few native North American
natural enemies have been reported attacking S. multistriatus . Among the
many European hymenoptera parasitizing S. multistriatus, D. protuberans
was found to be a dominant parasite in eastern Austria (Schroeder, 1974,
Z. Angew. Entomol., 76:150-159). In 1964, this braconid was introduced to
the United States from Avignon, France and released in many states in the
East and Midwest (Kennedy, 1980, personal communication; Riedl, 1979,
personal communication). Studies of this species demonstrated that it could
easily be reared in the laboratory, could overwinter in the Midwest and
could reproduce under field conditions (Kennedy, 1970, Ann. Entomol. Soc.
Am., 63:351-358). Successful Successful establishment has occurred in
many of the release sites investigated, although the numbers of this parasite
are limited by the bark thickness of the wood through which it must oviposit
(Truchan, 1970, Ph.D. Thesis, Mich. St. Univ., 97 pp.). D. protuberans has
been reared from two alternate species of bark beetles in Colorado, Scolytus
rugulosus (Ratzeburg) and Leperisinus californicus Essig (Merlino, 1980,
personal communication).
The farthest west that D. protuberans has been intentionally released is
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
505
Colorado. It is not known how long this parasite has been in California, nor
how it arrived, but it appears to have become readily established. This
species was reared from only three of the eight counties sampled in 1978
and 1979. A program to distribute this parasite throughout California could
hasten the spread of the parasite and possibly provide increased control of
local populations of S. multistriatus.
The authors thank Dr. Leland Brown, University of California, Riverside,
for providing the infested bolts from southern California. We also thank Dr.
Bruce Kennedy, USFS, Northeastern Forest Experiment Station, Dela¬
ware, Ohio, Mr. Roger Fuester, USDA, Newark, Delaware and Dr. Helmut
Riedl, University of California, Berkeley, California for their encourage¬
ment and information on parasite releases in the United States. Dr. P. M.
Marsh, USDA Systematic Entomology Laboratory, Belts ville, Maryland
provided species identification.
Ann E. Hajek and D. L. Dahlsten, Division of Biological Control, Uni¬
versity of California, Berkeley 94720.
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
October 1981, Vol. 57, No. 4, pp. 506-508
PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
Marius Wasbauer David Kavanaugh R. E. Somerby Paul Arnaud, Jr.
President President-elect Secretary Treasurer
PROCEEDINGS
FOUR HUNDRED AND SECOND MEETING
The 402nd meeting was held on Friday, 17 October 1980, at 8:00 p.m., in the Goethe Room,
California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, with President Wasbauer
presiding. A total of about 80 persons were present.
Minutes of the meeting, held 18 April 1980, were summarized. One scientific note was given.
Dr. Wasbauer introduced Dr. Edward Laidlow Smith of the California Academy of Sciences
and San Francisco State University who presented a talk entitled “Decade of Discovery; The
New Morphology and Phylogeny of Insects and Other Arthropods.” The topic revealed a
concerted effort to revolutionize and simplify our concepts of the evolution of arthropods.
Refreshments were served in the Goethe Room following the meeting. — R. E. Somerby,
Secretary.
FOUR HUNDRED AND THIRD MEETING
The 403rd meeting was held on Friday, 21 November 1980, at 8:00 p.m., in the Goethe
Room, California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, with President
Wasbauer presiding. A total of about 90 persons were present, of which 36 members and 17
guests signed the register.
Minutes of the meeting held 17 October 1980 were summarized. The following individuals
were nominated to membership: Regular members, L. D. Corkum, H. Brailovsky, N. M.
Downie, S. Elliott, W. C. Fields, C. A. Toft, J. W. Johnson, and J. F. Peters; Student members,
T. N. O’Brien and B. K. Orr; Student-family membership, Mr. R. L. and Gretchen Pederson.
No scientific notes were given.
Dr. Wasbauer introduced Dr. Alan M. Barnes of the Plague Branch, Vector Borne Disease
Division, Communicable Disease Center Laboratory, Fort Collins, Colorado, who presented
a talk entitled “Bubonic Plague — New Information on the Epidemiology and Ecology of an
Ancient Disease.” The well presented talk stirred considerable interest and discussion. Much
new information was presented.
Refreshments were served in the Goethe Room following the meeting. — R. E. Somerby,
Secretary.
FOUR HUNDRED AND FOURTH MEETING
The 404th meeting was held on Friday, 12 December 1980, at 8:00 p.m. in the Goethe Room,
California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, with President Wasbauer
presiding. A total of about 53 persons were present of which 34 members and 14 guests signed
the register. Ms. Celuta H. Paganelli of the Museu de Zoologia, Sao Paulo was introduced as
a guest.
Minutes of the meeting, held on Friday, 21 November 1980, were summarized. The following
individuals were nominated to membership: Regular member, H. W. Oswald; Student mem¬
bers, E. A. Sugden and R. Bradberry. Next, the chairpersons of the standing committees were
asked to give reports.
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
507
Dr. Arnaud reported the Auditing Committee under the Chairmanship of Mr. H. Vannoy
Davis had reviewed the financial records of the Society and had prepared a statement of
income, expenditures and changes in fund balances that will be published in the forthcoming
Proceedings of Meetings.
Dr. Arnaud also reported the Treasurer’s office is indebted to Mrs. Vashti F. Getten (as
volunteer) and Mrs. L. Gail Freihofer (Entomology secretary) for their handling of the Society’s
accounts, billings, and mailing of publications, and to our member, Mr. H. Vannoy Davis, for
his annual audit and the completion of the Society's tax forms.
Three notes were presented. Edward Smith gave the first note on fossil insects with wing
folding ability. They were predatory mid-Carboniferous insects. Next, J. Gordon Edward gave
us an overview of the gypsy moth problem. He summarized the defoliated eastern U.S. acreage as
5.9 million acres. More damage is expected this year. In other studies it was found that Eucalyptus
and Manzanita are excellent hosts. The last note was given by Larry Bezark. He reported on
the presence of Dry ops arizonensis near the Colorado River in California, a new state record.
Dr. Wasbauer introduced the incoming president. Dr. David Kavanaugh, Curator of Co-
leoptera for the California Academy of Sciences, whose entomological interest includes Sil-
phidae, Amphizoidae and Carabidae.
Dr. Kavanaugh in turn introduced Dr. Wasbauer of the California State Department of Food
and Agriculture who presented a talk entitled, “Ethological Patterns in the Pompilidae, the
Spider Wasps." He reviewed the biology and ecology of the spider wasps noting that only 8%
of the genera are known ethologically. The simplest behaviors were discussed first followed
by more complex patterns.
Refreshments were served in the Goethe Room following the meeting. — R. E. Somerby,
Secretary.
FOUR HUNDRED AND FIFTH MEETING
The 405th meeting was held on Friday, 16 January 1981, at 8:00 p.m., in the Morrison
Auditorium, California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, with President
David Kavanaugh presiding. A total of about fifty persons were present.
Minutes of the meeting, held on Friday, 12 December 1980, were summarized. The following
individuals were nominated to membership: Regular member, A. R. Olsen; and Student mem¬
ber, L. Kirkendall. The President gave a note on a new species of Nebriu from the Trinity
Alps, Siskiyou County.
Dr. David Kavanaugh introduced Dr. Paul M. Tuskes, from Berkeley, who presented a talk
entitled “The Biology of California Aquatic Moths, with Discussion of Interspecific Compe¬
tition.” The talk was well illustrated and well received, with a number of questions being
answered.
Refreshments were served in the entomology laboratory following the meeting. — R. E. So¬
merby, Secretary.
FOUR HUNDRED AND SIXTH MEETING
The 406th meeting was held on Friday, 20 February 1981, at 8:00 p.m., in the Morrison
Auditorium, California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, with President
David Kavanaugh presiding. A total of about forty-one persons were present, of which 18
signed as regular members, and 21 as guests.
Minutes of the meeting held on Friday, 16 January 1981, were summarized. The following
individuals were nominated to membership: Regular members, H. P. Brown, J. Schmidt, and
D. O. Hathaway; Student members, Fu K. Wong and J. B. Whitfield,
Dr. Rust gave a note on the Nevada dunes in Churchill County. He mentioned 10 new
508
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
species which were taken from the dunes. Dr. Williams gave a second note in collaboration
with Dr. Philip concerning work involved with tabanid flies. Some rather primitive horse flies
were taken at a blacklight. The significance of this phenomenon among habitually day-flying
tabanids is not understood.
Dr. Kavanaugh introduced Mr. Larry Orsak, from the Department of Entomology at Berke¬
ley who presented a talk entitled “Why is the Bright Blue Copper So Rare?” He gave an in-depth
analysis of distribution, host preference and its quality to establish the ecological parameters
favorable to the Blue Copper. The talk was well illustrated and well received.
Refreshments were served in the entomology laboratory following the meeting. — R. E. So-
merby, Secretary.
FOUR HUNDRED AND SEVENTH MEETING
The 407th meeting was held on Friday, 24 April 1981, at 8:00 p.m., in the Morrison Audi¬
torium, California Academy of Sciences, Golden Gate Park, San Francisco, with President
David Kavanaugh presiding. A total of about fifth persons were present, of which 28 signed
as regular members, and 13 as guests.
Minutes of the meeting held on Friday, 20 February 1981, were summarized. The following
individuals were nominated to membership: Regular member, H. Arnett; Student members,
R. S. Anderson, V. P. Jones and D. B. Herbst.
Dr. Paul Arnaud announced the death of P. H. Timberlake of Riverside. Paul suggested
sending a letter of condolence to his daughter.
Dr. Kavanaugh introduced Dr. Harvey I. Scutter from California State College at Hayward
who presented “Upper Miocene Fossil Insects from Steward Valley, Nevada.” The talk was
well illustrated and well received.
Refreshments were served in the entomology conference room following the meeting. — R.
E. Somerby, Secretary.
THE PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
INDEX TO VOLUME 57
Allen and Chao - Siphlonurid Notes and Dis¬
tribution - 449
Ambrysus baeus - 399
colimanus - 397
spiculus - 400
Ameletus falsus - 449
velox - 450
Ammophila silvestris - 457
Amphizoa kasmirensis - 269
Balsbaugh - Nonarthra cyaneum
from Panama - 411
Bionomics
Carolella - 402
Coscinoptera - 369
Mallophora - 380
Nectopsyche - 327
Perarthrus - 492
Plecoma spp. - 461
Spanglerogyrus - 124
Tipula - 447
Tridepia - 443
Trypoxylon - 332
Bonnetia cornpta - 347
Brigham - A New Ectopria - 315
Brown - Dryopoid Distribution Survey - 133
Brown - New Elmid Huleechius - 228
Brown - New Larinae Genera and Key - 76
Cannings - Sympetrum madidum Larva De¬
scribed - 341
Carolella beevorana - 402
Chemsak and Linsley - New Pseudotypoce-
rus and Strangalia - 485
Cincindela columbica - 359
Coleoptera
Cerambycidae - 485, 492
Chrysomelidae - 364, 411
Cicindelidae - 359
Scarabaeidae - 461
Collecting Equipment - 245
Collembola - 493
Colymbetes - 43
Coscinoptera panochensis - 364
Coville - Trypoxylon Biology - 332
Daigle and Haddock - Nectopsyche Larval
Description - 327
Dendrosoter protuberans - 504
Desmopachria flavida - 61
glabricula - 59
leechi - 57
strigata - 63
volvata - 62
zimmermani - 61
Dicranocentrus deharvengi - 493
violaceus - 496
Diptera
Asilidae - 380
Empididae - 415, 422
Tachinidae - 347
Tipulidae - 447
Disersus - 103
Ectopria leechi - 313
Elliott - Alaska Plecoptera Distributions - 434
Ephemeroptera - 449
Falloporus - 153
triangularis - 170
pilot ei - 172
Fellin - Pleocoma Flight Behavior and Bio¬
nomics - 461
Fields - New California Rhyacophila - 500
Francke and Merickel - New Texas Pogono-
myrmex - 371
Gilbert - New California Coscinoptera - 364
Goeden and Ricker - Carolella Life History
- 402
Gordon - New Hydroporus - 105
Hajek and Dahlsten - New Dendrosoter Dis¬
tribution - 504
Hardy et al. - Laccobius Authorships - 303
Hartman and Zahary - Sympatric Tipula Ag¬
gregation - 447
Helichus spp. - 226
Helocombus bifidus - 52
Hemiptera
Naucoridae - 397
Saldidae - 321
Hispaniolara - 85
farri - 90
Homoptera
Delphacidae - 429
Hughbosdinius - 65
leechi - 67
509
510
PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST
Hughleechia giulianii - 295
Huleechius - 228
marroni - 237
carolus - 239
spinipes - 233
Hydroporus - 149, 176
alleghenianus - 190
boreus - 106
californicus - 1 18
cocheconis - 193
diversicornis - 196
elusivus - 121
fatigus - 119
folkertsi - 201
( Heterosternuta ) - 176
hirsutus - 1 17
jeanneae - 203
jenniferae - 205
laetus - 208
leechi - 108
niger-tenehrosus - 105
ohionis - 210
op po situs - 211
ovachitus - 213
pulcher - 214
signatus youngi - 1 10
simplex - 1 14
spangleri - 122
utahensis - 116
wickhami - 217
Hymenoptera
Braconidae - 504
Chrysididae - 351
Formicidae - 371
Sphecidae - 332, 457
Ischyromicrus - 264
cognitus - 267
julieae - 267
Kavanaugh and Arnaud - H. B. Leech biog¬
raphy - 3
Kavanaugh and Roughley - Amphizoa kash-
mirensis identity- 269
Kimsey - New Chrysidid Genus Minymischa
- 351
Kirkbride - New Ammophila - 457
Kruia - 220
chrysopelma - 223
Laccobius - 303
arenarius - 304
reflexipenis - 304
spangleri - 304
Larvae
Coleoptera - 52, 229, 239, 473
Diptera - 347
Ephemeroptera - 452, 453
Lepidoptera - 402
Odonata - 342
Trichoptera - 327
Leech, H. B.
Bibliography - 8
Biography - 3
New Taxa - 34
Patronyms - 38
Lepidoptera
Cochylidae - 402
Noctuidae - 443
Levine and Clement - Bonnetia compta Rear¬
ing Method - 347
Lindskog - Saldula laticollis Identity - 321
Malcolm - New Omicrini - 260
Mallophora schwarzi - 380
Mari Mutt - New Dicranocentrus - 493
Matta and Wolfe - Heterosternuta Revision
- 176
Mecoptera - 385
Methods - 347
Minymischa arenicola - 353
deserticola - 354
ventura - 354
Napodytes - 251
boki - 254
Nectopsyche tavara - 327
Nelson - Nearctic Helichus Notes - 226
Niphogenia eucera - 425
turneri - 427
Nonarthra cyaneum - 411
Notices - 148, 244
Odonata - 341
Omicrus brevipes - 260
milleri - 262
smetanai - 261
Orobittacus - 386
obscurus - 387
Ovolara - 90
Pagelmis amazonica - 286
Parapotamophilus - 94
gressitti - 96
Parasitism - 504
Perarthrus vittatus - 492
Peratogonus grandis - 263
Perkins - New Hydraenid Hughleechia - 295
Perkins and Spangler - Helocombus larva - 52
VOLUME 57, NUMBER 4
511
Perkins and Steiner - New Peruvian Xenelmis
- 306
Peters - Saltbush Pest Tridepia nova - 443
Plecoptera - 434
Pogonomyrmex bigbendensis - 371
texanus - 375
Polhemus and Polhemus - New Ambrysus -
397
Proceedings of PCES - 506
Pseudodisersus - 98
coquereli - 100
Pseudolopyga carrilloi - 356
taylori - 357
Pseudotypocerus ater - 486
auricornis - 488
dimidiatus - 487
vittatus - 487
Reimer and Goeden - Stobaera Immature
Stages - 429
Rhyacophila acuminata - 502
darbyi - 500
spinata - 502
Roederioides retroversa - 420
Roederoides distinctus - 419
junctus - 418
recurvatus - 419
wigginsi - 417
wirthi - 420
Roughley - Tachypachidae and Hydradepha-
ga Phylogeny - 273
Saldula laticollis - 322
spp. - 322
Scientific Notes - 226, 447, 492, 504
Shelly and Weinberger - Mallophora Court¬
ship and Diet - 380
Shook - Cicindela columbica Populations in
Idaho - 359
Siphlonurus occidentalis - 454
Spangler - Lightweight Net and Aspirator for
Aquatics - 245
Spangler - New Bidessine Genera - 65
Spangler - New Elmid Pagelmis - 286
Spangler and Perkins - New Hydrophilid
Kruia - 220
Spanglerogyrus albiventris - 124
Steiner - New Dytiscid Napodytes - 251
Steiner and Anderson - Gyrinid Natural His¬
tory - 124
Stobaera tricarinata - 429
Strangalia annae - 490
cavei - 489
Sympetrum madidum - 341
spp. - 346
Tipula acuta - 447
simplex - 447
Trichoptera - 327, 500
Tridepia nova - 443
Trypoxylon lactitarse - 335
nitidum schulthessi - 332
saussurei - 337
Tyson - New Perarthrus vittatus Host - 492
Villegas and Beyers - New Bittacid Orobit-
tacus - 385
Wilder - Review of Roederoides - 415
Wilder - Revision of Niphogenia - 422
Wolfe and Matta - Hydroporus Subgenera
Classification - 149
Xenelmis leechi - 306
marcapata - 309
Young - New Desmopachria - 57
Youngulus - 69
franki - 7 1
Zimmerman - Colymbetes Evolution - 43
Published by the
Pacific Coast Entomological Society
in cooperation with
The California Academy of Sciences
VOLUME FIFTY-SEVEN
1981
EDITORIAL BOARD
G. A. MARSH, Editor
C. PLEINES, Editorial Asst.
R. M. BOHART
HUGH B. LEECH
E. S. ROSS
J. A. CHEMSAK
P. H. ARNAUD, JR., Treasurer
PUBLICATION COMMITTEE
1981 1982 1983 1984
D. H. Kavanaugh G. A. H. McClelland, Chairman K. W. Cooper R. M. Bohart
W. G. litis F. G. Andrews J. E. Hafemik J. G. Edwards
San Francisco, California
1981
CONTENTS FOR VOLUME 57
Allen, R. K., and Chao, E. S. M.
Mayflies of the southwest. New records and notes of . 449
Balsbaugh, E. U., Jr.
Nonarthra cyaneum, a pan-Pacific flea beetle . 411
Brigham, W. U.
Ectopria leechi, a new false water penny from the United States . 313
Brown, H. P.
A distributional survey of the world genera of aquatic dryopoid beetles .... 133
Brown, H. P.
Huleechius, a new genus of beetle from Mexico and Arizona . 228
Brown, H. P.
Key to world genera of Larinae; descriptions of new genera from Hispaniola,
Colombia, Australia, and New Guinea . 76
Cannings, R. A.
The larva of Sympetrum madidum . 341
Chemsak, J. A., and Linsley, E. G.
Additions to the known species of Pseudotypocerus and Strangalia . 485
Coville, R. E.
Biological observations on three Trypoxylon wasps in the subgenus Trypar-
gilum from Costa Rica . . 332
Daigle, J. J., and Haddock, J. D.
Larval description and ecological notes of a caddisfly, Nectopsyche tavara
from central Florida . 327
Elliott, S. T.
Records of Plecoptera from southeastern Alaska . 434
Fellin, D. G.
Pleocoma spp. in western Oregon; observations on adult flight, egg and larval
biology . 461
Fields, W. C, Jr.
New species of Rhyacophila from California . 500
Francke, O. F., and Merickel, F. W.
Two new species of Pogonomyrmex harvester ants from Texas . 371
Gilbert, A. J.
A new species of Coscinoptera from California . 364
Goeden, R. D., and Ricker, D. W.
Life history of Carolella beevorana on Ambrosia dumosa in southern
California . 402
Gordon, R. D.
New species of North American Hydroporus, niger-tenebrosus group . 105
Hajek, A. E., and Dahlsten, D. L.
First California record for Dendrosoter protuberans . 504
Hardy, A. R., Cheary, B. S., and Malcolm, S. E.
A clarification of the authorship of some names in Laccobius . 303
Hartman, M. J., and Zahary, R. G.
Aggregation in two sympatric species of crane fly . 447
Kavanaugh, D. H., and Arnaud, P. H., Jr.
Hugh Bosdin Leech — A curator’s curator . 3
Kavanaugh, D. H., and Roughley, R. E.
On the identity of Amphizoa kashmirensis . 269
ill
Kimsey, L. S.
A new North American chrysidid genus and redescription of the genus
Pseudolopyga . 351
Kirkbride, D. M.
A new species of Ammophila from North America . 457
Levine, E., and Clement, S. L.
A laboratory method for rearing Bonnetia compta . 347
Lindskog, P.
On the identity of Saldula laticollis . 321
Malcolm, S. E.
Some Omicrini from the Oriental and Pacific Regions . 260
Man Mutt, J. A.
Two new Dicranocentrus from Nepal; key to Indian and Nepalese species . . 493
Matta, J. F., and Wolfe, G. W.
A revision of the subgenus Heterosternuta of Hydroporus . 176
Nelson, H. G.
Notes on nearctic Helichus . . ... . 226
Notices . 148, 244
Perkins, P. D.
Hughleechia guilianii, a new genus and new species of beetle from Australia . . 295
Perkins, P. D., and Spangler, P. J.
A description of the larva of Helocombus bifidus . 52
Perkins, P. D., and Steiner, W. E., Jr.
Two new Peruvian species of Xenelmis . 306
Peters, J. F.
Effects of an outbreak of Ttidepia nova on Atriplex canescens . . . . 443
Polhemus, J. J., and Polhemus, D. A.
Three new species of Ambry sus from Mexico . 397
Proceedings of the Pacific Coast Entomological Society . 506
Reimer, N. J., and Goeden, R. D.
Descriptions of the immature stages of Strobaera tricarinata . 429
Roughley, R. E.
Trachypachidae and Hydradephaga: A monophyletic unit? . 273
Shelly, T. E., and Weinberger, D. A.
Courtship and diet of the neotropical robber fly Mallophora schwarzi . 380
Shook, G.
The status of the Columbia tiger beetle Cicindela columbica in Idaho . 359
Spangler, P. J.
A durable, lightweight net and a manual aspirator for collecting aquatic
organisms . 245
Spangler, P. J.
Pagelmis amazonica, a new genus and species of water beetle from
Ecuador . 286
Spangler, P. J.
Two new genera, two new species of bidessine beetles from South America ... 65
Spangler, P. J., and Perkins, P. D.
A new genus and species of water scavenger beetle from Africa . 220
Steiner, W. E.
A new genus and new species of laccophiline beetle from Ecuador . 251
tv
Steiner, W. E., Jr., and Anderson, J. J.
Notes on the natural history of Spanglerogyrus albiventris, with new distri¬
bution record . 124
Tyson, W. H.
Artemisia California, a new host for Perarthrus vittatus . 492
Villegas, B., and Beyers, G. W.
Orobittacus obscurus, a new genus and species from California . 385
Wilder, D. D.
Review of the genus Roederiodes; description of new species . 415
Wilder, D. D.
Revision of the genus Niphogenia; description of new species . 422
Wolfe, G. W., and Matta, J. F.
Notes on nomenclature and classification of Hydroporus subgenera; descrip¬
tion of a new genus of Hydroporini . 149
Young, F. N.
Predacious water beetles of the genus Desmopachria; the leechi-glabricula
group . 57
Zimmerman, J. R.
Reticulate evolution in Colymbetes . 43
v
PUBLICATIONS
OF THE
PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL SOCIETY
PROCEEDINGS OF THE PACIFIC COAST ENTOMOLOGICAL
SOCIETY.
Vol. 1 (16 numbers, 179 pages) and Vol. 2 (9 numbers, 131
pages). 1901-1930. Price $5.00 per volume.
THE PAN-PACIFIC ENTOMOLOGIST.
Vol. 1 (1924) to Vol. 51 (1975), price $10.00 per volume of 4
numbers, or $2.50 per single issue. Vol. 52 (1976) and subse¬
quent issues, $15.00 per volume or $3.75 per single issue.
MEMOIR SERIES.
Volume 1. The Sucking Lice by G. F. Ferris. 320 pages. Pub¬
lished October 1951. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.00 postage and han¬
dling.)*
Volume 2. The Spider Mite Family Tetranychidae by A. Earl
Pritchard and Edward W. Baker. 472 pages. Published July
1955. Price $10.00 (Plus $1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 3. Revisionary Studies in the Nearctic Decticinae by
David C. Rentz and James D. Birchim. 173 pages. Published
July 1968. Price $4.00 (Plus $.75 postage and handling.)*
Volume 4. Autobiography of an Entomologist by Robert L.
Usinger. 343 pages. Published August 1972. Price $15.00. (Plus
$1.25 postage and handling.)*
Volume 5. Revision of the Millipede Family Andrognathidae
in the Nearctic Region by Michael R. Gardner. 61 pages. Pub¬
lished January 21, 1975. Price $3.00 (Plus $.75 postage and
handling.)*
*(Add 6% sales tax on all California orders (resident of Alameda, Contra
Costa, San Francisco, Santa Clara and Santa Cruz counties add 6lA%).
Members of the Society will receive a 20% discount.)
Send orders to:
Pacific Coast Entomological Society
c/o California Academy of Sciences
Golden Gate Park
San Francisco, California 94118